Electrical
installation guide
2013
According to
IEC international
standards
This guide has been written for electrical Engineers who have to design,
select electrical equipment, install these equipment and, inspect or
maintain low-voltage electrical installations in compliance with international
Standards of the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC).
“Which technical solution will guarantee that all relevant safety rules are
met?” This question has been a permanent guideline for the elaboration of
this document.
An international Standard such as the IEC 60364 series “Low voltage
Electrical Installations” specifies extensively the rules to comply with to
ensure safety and correct operational functioning of all types of electrical
installations. As the Standard must be extensive, and has to be applicable
to all types of equipment and the technical solutions in use worldwide, the
text of the IEC rules is complex, and not presented in a ready-to-use order.
The Standard cannot therefore be considered as a working handbook, but
only as a reference document.
The aim of the present guide is to provide a clear, practical and stepby-step explanation for the complete study of an electrical installation,
according to IEC 60364 series and other relevant IEC Standards. The first
chapter (A) presents the methodology to be used, and refers to all chapters
of the guide according to the different steps of the study.
We all hope that you, the reader, will find this handbook genuinely helpful.
Schneider Electric S.A.
This technical guide is the result of
a collective effort.
Illustrations and production:
AXESS - Valence -France
Printing:
Edition: 2013
Price: 40 €
ISBN: 978.2.9531643.3.6
N° dépôt légal: 1er semestre 2008
© Schneider Electric
All rights reserved in all countries
The Electrical Installation Guide is a single document covering the
techniques and standards related to low-voltage electrical installations.
It is intended for electrical professionals in companies, design offices,
inspection organisations, etc.
This Technical Guide is aimed at professional users and is only intended
to provide them guidelines for the definition of an industrial, tertiary or
domestic electrical installation. Information and guidelines contained in this
Guide are provided AS IS. Schneider Electric makes no warranty of any
kind, whether express or implied, such as but not limited to the warranties
of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose, nor assumes any
legal liability or responsibility for the accuracy, completeness, or usefulness
of any information, apparatus, product, or process disclosed in this Guide,
nor represents that its use would not infringe privately owned rights.
The purpose of this guide is to facilitate the implementation of International
installation standards for designers & contractors, but in all cases the
original text of International or local standards in force shall prevail.
This new edition has been published to take into account changes in
techniques, standards and regulations, in particular electrical installation
standard IEC 60364 series.
We thank all the readers of the previous edition of this guide for their
comments that have helped improve the current edition.
We also thank the many people and organisations, too numerous to name
here, who have contributed in one way or another to the preparation of this
guide.
Acknowlegements
This guide has been realized by a team of
experienced international experts, on the base
of IEC 60364 series of standard, and include the
latest developments in electrical standardization.
We shall mention particularly the following
experts and their area of expertise:
Chapter
Christian
Collombet
D
Bernard
Jover
R
Jacques
Schonek
Didier
Fulchiron
B
Didier
Mignardot
J, P
Eric
Bettega
Emmanuel
Genevray
D, G, L, M, N
E
E, P
Eric
Breuillé
F
Fleur
Janet
K
Franck
Mégret
G
Geoffroy
De-Labrouhe
K
Jean Marc
Lupin
L, M
Daniel
Barstz
N
Jérome
Lecomte
H
Matthieu
Guillot
F, H, P
Michel
Sacotte
B
Tools for more efficiency
in electrical installation design
Electrical installation Wiki
The Electrical Installation Guide is also available on-line as a wiki in 3 languages:
> in English
> in Russian
> in Chinese
electrical-installation.org
ru.electrical-installation.org
electrical-installation.org
Our experts constantly contribute to its evolution. Industry and academic
professionals can collaborate too!
English
Russian
Chinese
Online Electrical calculation Tools
Online tools
A set of tools designed to help you:
p display on one chart the time-current cuves of different circuit-breakers or fuses
p check the discrimination between two circuit-breakers or fuses, or two Residual
Current devices (RCD), search all the circuit-breakers or fuses that can be
selective/cascading with a defined circuit-breaker or fuse
p calculate the Cross Section Area of cables and build a cable schedule
p calculate the voltage drop of a defined cable and check the maximum length
> hto.power.schneider-electric.com
Power Management Blog
In the Schneider Electric blog, you will find the best tips about standards, tools,
software, safety and latest technical news shared by our experts. You will find even
more information about innovations and business opportunities. This is your place
to leave us your comments and to engage discussion about your expertise. You
might want to sharewith your Twitter or LinkedIn followers.
> blog.schneider-electric.com/power-management-metering-monitoring-power-quality
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Ecodial Advanced Calculation 4
The new Ecodial Advanced Calculation 4 software is dedicated to electrical
installation calculation in accordance with IEC60364 international standard or
national standards.
This 4th generation offers new features like:
p management of operating mode (parallel transformers, back-up generators…)
p discrimination analysis associating curves checking and discrimination tables,
direct access to protection settings
ID-Spec large
ID-Spec Large is a totally innovative software developed specifically to help you
design electrical systems of commercial & industrial buildings.
Main features:
p Define the general architecture of electrical installation
p Draw up the power summary
p Prepare the single line diagram
p Choose and size the MV/LV equipments
p Evaluate the Energy performance of the installation
p Edit the technical part of the specification for tender
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Electrical installation guide 2013
Foreword
Etienne TISON, International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) TC64
Chairman.
The task of the IEC Technical Committee 64 is to develop and keep up-todate requirements
- for the protection of persons against electrical shock, and
- for the design, verification and implementation of low voltage electrical
installations.
Series of standard such as IEC 60364 developed by IEC TC64 is
considered by the international community as the basis of the majority of
national low-voltage wiring rules.
IEC 60364 series is mainly focussed on safety due the use of electricity by
people who may not be aware of risk resulting from the use of electricity.
But modern electrical installations are increasingly complex, due to external
input such as
- electromagnetic disturbances
- energy efficiency
- ...
Consequently, designers, installers and consumers need guidance on the
selection and installation of electrical equipment.
Schneider Electric has developed this Electrical Installation Guide
dedicated to low voltage electrical installations. It is based on IEC TC64
standards such as IEC 60364 series and provides additional information
in order to help designers, contractors and controllers for implementing
correct low-voltage electrical installations.
As TC64 Chairman, it is my great pleasure and honour to introduce this
guide. I am sure it will be used fruitfully by all persons involved in the
implementation of all low-voltage electrical installations.
Etienne TISON
Etienne TISON has been working with Schneider
Electric since 1978. He has been always involved
is various activities in low voltage field.
In 2008, Etienne TISON has been appointed
Chairman of IEC TC64 as well as Chairman of
CENELEC TC64.
General rules of electrical
installation design
A
Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B
Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
C
MV & LV architecture selection
guide
D
LV Distribution
E
Protection against electric
shocks
F
Sizing and protection of
conductors
G
LV switchgear: functions &
selection
H
Overvoltage protection
J
Energy Efficiency in electrical
distribution
K
Power factor correction
L
Harmonic management
M
Characteristics of particular
sources and loads
N
Photovoltaic Installations
P
Residential and other special
locations
Q
EMC guidelines
R
General contents
A
General rules of electrical installation design
B
Connection to the MV utility distribution network
C
D
Connection to the LV utility distribution network
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
Methodology
Rules and statutory regulations
Installed power loads - Characteristics
Power loading of an installation
Supply of power at medium voltage
Procedure for the establishment of a new substation
Protection aspect
The consumer substation with LV metering
The consumer substation with MV metering
Constitution of MV/LV distribution substations
1 Low voltage utility distribution networks
2 Tariffs and metering
A2
A5
A11
A16
B2
B5
B7
B13
B22
B27
C2
C16
MV & LV architecture selection guide
1 Stakes for the user
2 Simplified architecture design process
3 Electrical installation characteristics
4 Technological characteristics
5 Architecture assessment criteria
6 Choice of architecture fundamentals
7 Choice of architecture details
8 Choice of equiment
9 Recommendations for architecture optimization
10 Glossary
11 ID-Spec software
12 Example: electrical installation in a printworks
E
LV Distribution
F
Protection against electric shocks
G
Sizing and protection of conductors
1 Earthing schemes
2 The installation system
3 External influences (IEC 60364-5-51)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
General
Protection against direct contact
Protection against indirect contact
Protection of goods due to insulation fault
Implementation of the TT system
Implementation of the TN system
Implementation of the IT system
Residual current differential devices RCDs
1 General
2 Practical method for determining the smallest allowable
cross-sectional area of circuit conductors
3 Determination of voltage drop
4 Short-circuit current
5 Particular cases of short-circuit current
6 Protective earthing conductor
7 The neutral conductor
8 Worked example of cable calculation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D3
D4
D7
D11
D13
D15
D19
D25
D26
D30
D31
D32
E2
E15
E26
F2
F4
F6
F17
F19
F23
F29
F36
G2
G7
G19
G23
G29
G36
G41
G45
General contents
H
LV switchgear: functions & selection
1
2
3
4
The basic functions of LV switchgear
The switchgear
Choice of switchgear
Circuit breaker
H2
H5
H10
H11
5 Maintenance of low voltage switchgear
H32
J
Overvoltage protection
K
Energy Efficiency in electrical distribution
L
Power Factor Correction
M
Harmonic management
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
Overvoltage characteristics of atmospheric origin
Principle of lightning protection
Design of the electrical installation protection system
Installation of SPDs
Application
Technical supplements
Introduction
Energy efficiency and electricity
Diagnosis through electrical measurement
Energy saving opportunities
How to evaluate energy savings
1 Power factor and Reactive power
2 Why to improve the power factor?
3 How to improve the power factor?
4 Where to install power correction capacitors?
5 How to decide the optimum level of compensation?
6 Compensation at the terminals of a transformer
7 Power factor correction of induction motors
8 Example of an installation before and after power factor correction
9 The effects of harmonics
10 Implementation of capacitor banks
1 The problem:
Why is it necessary to detect and eliminate harmonics?
2 Definition and origin of harmonics
3 Essential indicators of harmonic distortion and
measurement principles
4 Harmonic measurement in electrical networks
5 Main effects of hamronis in electrical installations
6 Standards
7 Solutions to attenuate harmonics
N
Characteristics of particular sources and loads
P
Photovoltaic installations
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
Protection of a LV generator set and the downstream circuits
Uninterruptible Power Supply Units (UPS)
Protection of LV/LV transformers
Lighting circuits
Asynchronous motors
Benefits of photovoltaic energy
Background and technology
PV System and Installation Rules
PV installation architectures
Monitoring
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J2
J7
J13
J24
J28
J32
K2
K3
K6
K8
K23
L2
L6
L8
L11
L13
L16
L19
L21
L22
L25
M2
M3
M7
M10
M13
M20
M21
N2
N11
N24
N27
N45
P2
P3
P10
P18
P31
General contents
Q
Residential and other special locations
R
EMC guidelines
1 Residential and similar premises
Q2
2 Bathrooms and showers
Q8
3 Recommendations applicable to special installations and locations Q12
1
2
3
4
5
Electrical distribution
Earthing principles and structures
Implementation
Coupling mechanism and counter-measures
Wiring recommendations
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R2
R3
R5
R22
R28
Chapter A
General rules of electrical
installation design
A1
Contents
3
4
Methodology
A2
Rules and statutory regulations
A5
2.1 Definition of voltage ranges
2.2 Regulations
2.3 Standards
2.4 Quality and safety of an electrical installation
2.5 Initial testing of an installation
2.6 Put in out of danger the existing electrical installations
2.7 Periodic check-testing of an installation
2.8 Conformity assessement (with standards and specifications) of
equipment used in the installation
2.9 Environment
A5
A6
A6
A7
A8
A8
A9
Installed power loads - Characteristics
A11
3.1 Induction motors
3.2 Resistive-type heating appliances and incandescent lamps
(conventional or halogen)
A11
Power loading of an installation
A16
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
A16
A16
A17
A19
A19
A20
A21
Installed power (kW)
Installed apparent power (kVA)
Estimation of actual maximum kVA demand
Example of application of factors ku and ks
Diversity factor
Choice of transformer rating
Choice of power-supply sources
A9
A10
A13
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
A - General rules of electrical installation design
1 Methodology
A2
For the best results in electrical installation design it is recommended to read and to
use all the chapters of this guide in the order in which they are presented.
A - General rules of electrical installation design
Rules and statutory regulations
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Range of low-voltage extends from 0 V to 1 000 V in a.c. and from 0 V to 1 500
V in d.c. One of the first decision id the selection of type of current between the
alternative current which corresponds to the most common type of current through
out the world and the direct current. Then designers have to select the most
appropriate rated voltage within these ranges of voltages. When connected to a LV
public network, the type of current and the rated voltage are already selected and
imposed by the Utility.
Compliance with national regulations is then the second priority of the designers
of electrical installation. Regulations may be based on national or international
standards such as the IEC 60364 series.
Selection of equipment complying with national or international product standards
and appropriate verification of the completed installation is a powerful mean for
providing a safe installation with the expected quality. Defining and complying with
the verification and testing of the electrical installation at its completion as well as
periodic time will guarantee the safety and the quality of this installation all along its
life cycle. Conformity of equipment according to the appropriate product standards
used within the installation is also of prime importance for the level of safety and
quality.
Environmental conditions will become more and more stringent and will need to
be considered at the design stage of the installation. This may include national or
regional regulations considering the material used in the equipment as well as the
dismantling of the installation at its end of life
A§3- Installed power loads - Characteristics
A§4- Power loading of an installation
Installed power loads - Characteristics
B – Connection to the MV utility distribution
network
Connection to the MV public distribution network
C - Connection to the LV utility distribution
network
Connection to the LV utility distribution network
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
MV & LV architecture selection guide
A review of all applications needing to be supplied with electricity is to be done. Any
possible extensions or modifications during the whole life of the electrical installation
are to be considered. Such a review aimed to estimate the current flowing in each
circuit of the installation and the power supplies needed.
The total current or power demand can be calculated from the data relative to the
location and power of each load, together with the knowledge of the operating modes
(steady state demand, starting conditions, non simultaneous operation, etc.)
Estimation of the maximum power demand may use various factors depending
on the type of application; type of equipment and type of circuits used within the
electrical installation.
From these data, the power required from the supply source and (where appropriate)
the number of sources necessary for an adequate supply to the installation is readily
obtained.
Local information regarding tariff structures is also required to allow the best choice
of connection arrangement to the power-supply network, e.g. at medium voltage or
low voltage level.
Where this connection is made at the Medium Voltage level a consumer-type
substation will have to be studied, built and equipped. This substation may be an
outdoor or indoor installation conforming to relevant standards and regulations (the
low-voltage section may be studied separately if necessary). Metering at mediumvoltage or low-voltage is possible in this case.
Where the connection is made at the Low Voltage level the installation will be
connected to the local power network and will (necessarily) be metered according to
LV tariffs.
The whole electrical system including the MV installation and the LV installation
is to be studied as a complete system. The customer expectations and technical
parameters will impact the architecture of the system as well as the electrical
installation characteristics.
Determination of the most suitable architecture of the MV/LV main distribution and LV
power distribution level is often the result of optimization and compromise.
Neutral earthing arrangements are chosen according to local regulations, constraints
related to the power-supply, and to the type of loads.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Methodology
A3
The distribution equipment (panelboards, switchgears, circuit connections, ...) are
determined from building plans and from the location and grouping of loads.
The type of premises and allocation can influence their immunity to external
disturbances.
LV distribution
E - LV Distribution
The system earthing is one protective measures commonly used for the protection
against electric shocks. These systems earthings have a major impact on the LV
electrical installation architecture and they need to be analysed as early as possible.
Advantages and drawbacks are to be analysed for a correct selection.
Another aspect needing to be considered at the earlier stage is the external
influences. In large electrical installation, different external influences may be
encountered and need to be considered independently. As a result of these external
influences proper selection of equipment according to their IP or IK codes has to be
made.
Protection against electric shocks
F - Protection against electric shocks
Protection against electric shock consists in providing provision for basic protection
(protection against direct contact) with provision for fault protection (protection
against indirect contact). Coordinated provisions result in a protective measure.
One of the most common protective measures consists in “automatic disconnection
of supply” where the provision for fault protection consists in the implementation of a
system earthing. Deep understanding of each standardized system (TT, TN and IT
system) is necessary for a correct implementation.
Sizing and protection of conductors
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Selection of cross-sectional-areas of cables or isolated conductors for line
conductors is certainly one of the most important tasks of the designing process
of an electrical installation as this greatly influences the selection of overcurrent
protective devices, the voltage drop along these conductors and the estimation of
the prospective short-circuits currents: the maximum value relates to the overcurrent
protection and the minimum value relates to the fault protection by automatic
disconnection of supply. This has to be done for each circuit of the installation.
Similar task is to be done for the neutral conductors and for the Protective Earth (PE)
conductor.
LV switchgear: functions & selection
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Once the short-circuit current are estimated, protective devices can be selected for
the overcurrent protection. Circuit-breakers have also other possible functions such
as switching and isolation. A complete understanding of the functionalities offered by
all switchgear and controlgear within the installation is necessary. Correct selection
of all devices can now be done.
A comprehensive understanding of all functionalities offered by the circuit-breakers is
of prime importance as this is the device offering the largest variety of functions.
Overvoltage protection
J – Protection against voltage surges in LV
Direct or indirect lightning strokes can damage electrical equipment at a distance of
several kilometres. Operating voltage surges, transient and industrial frequency overvoltage can also produce the same consequences.All protective measures against
overvoltage need to be assessed. One of the most used corresponds to the use of
Surge Protective Devices (SPD). Their selection; installation and protection within the
electrical installation request some particular attention.
Implementation of active energy efficiency measures within the electrical installation
can produce high benefits for the user or owner: reduced power consumption,
reduced cost of energy, better use of electrical equipment. These measures will
most of the time request specific design for the installation as measuring electricity
consumption either per application (lighting, heating, process…) or per area (floor,
workshop) present particular interest for reducing the electricity consumption still
keeping the same level of service provided to the user.
L - Power factor correction and harmonic filtering
Reactive energy
The power factor correction within electrical installations is carried out locally,
globally or as a combination of both methods. Improving the power factor has a direct
impact on the billing of consumed electricity and may also have an impact on the
energy efiiciency.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
K – Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
A - General rules of electrical installation design
1 Methodology
M - Harmonic management
Harmonics
A4
Harmonic currents in the network affect the quality of energy and are at the origin of
many disturbances as overloads, vibrations, ageing of equipment, trouble of sensitive
equipment, of local area networks, telephone networks. This chapter deals with the
origins and the effects of harmonics and explain how to measure them and present
the solutions.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and
loads
Particular supply sources and loads
P - Photovoltaic Installations
A green and economical energy
Particular items or equipment are studied:
b Specific sources such as alternators or inverters
b Specific loads with special characteristics, such as induction motors, lighting
circuits or LV/LV transformers
b Specific systems, such as direct-current networks
The solar energy development has to respect specific installation rules.
Generic applications
Q - Residential and other special locations
Certain premises and locations are subject to particularly strict regulations: the most
common example being residential dwellings.
EMC Guidelines
R - EMC guidelines
Some basic rules must be followed in order to ensure Electromagnetic Compatibility.
Non observance of these rules may have serious consequences in the operation of
the electrical installation: disturbance of communication systems, nuisance tripping of
protection devices, and even destruction of sensitive devices.
Ecodial software
A companion tool of the Electrical Installation
Guide
Ecodial software(1) provides a complete design package for LV installations, in
accordance with IEC standards and recommendations.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The following features are included:
b Construction of one-line diagrams
b Calculation of short-circuit currents according to several operating modes (normal,
back-up, load shedding)
b Calculation of voltage drops
b Optimization of cable sizes
b Required ratings and settings of switchgear and fusegear
b Discrimination of protective devices
b Optimization ofswitchgear using cascading
b Verification of the protection of people and circuits
b Comprehensive print-out of the foregoing calculated design data
(1) Ecodial is a Schneider Electric software available in several
languages and standard version.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Rules and statutory regulations
A5
Low-voltage installations are usually governed by a number of regulatory and
advisory texts, which may be classified as follows:
b Statutory regulations (decrees, factory acts, etc.)
b Codes of practice, regulations issued by professional institutions, job specifications
b National and international standards for installations
b National and international standards for products
2.1 Definition of voltage ranges
IEC voltage standards and recommendations
Three-phase four-wire or three-wire systems Single-phase three-wire systems
Nominal voltage (V)
Nominal voltage (V)
50 Hz
60 Hz
60 Hz
–
120/208
120/240(d)
230(c)
240(c)
–
230/400(c)
–
230/400(a)
277/480(a)
480
347/600
600
400/690(b)
–
1000
600
–
(a) The value of 230/400 V is the result of the evolution of 220/380 V and 240/415 V
systems which has been completed in Europe and many other countries. However,
220/380 V and 240/415 V systems still exist.
(b) The value of 400/690 V is the result of the evolution of 380/660 V systems which
has been completed in Europe and many other countries. However, 380/660 V systems
still exist.
(c) The value of 200 V or 220 V is also used in some countries.
(d) The values of 100/200 V are also used in some countries on 50 Hz or 60 Hz
systems.
Fig. A1 : Standard voltages between 100 V and 1000 V (IEC 60038 Edition 7.0 2009-06)
Nominal system
voltage (kV)
3.3(b)
3(b)
6.6(b)
6(b)
11
10
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
(15)
22
20
–
–
33(d)
30(d)
–
–
–
35(d)
Series II
Highest voltage
for equipment (kV)
4.40(b)
–
–
13.2(c)
13.97(c)
14.52(b)
–
–
26.4(c, e)
–
36.5(2)
–
Nominal system
voltage (kV)
4.16(b)
–
–
12.47(c)
13.2(c)
13.8(b)
–
–
24.94(c, e)
–
34.5(c)
–
Note 1: It is recommended that in any one country the ratio between two adjacent
nominal voltages should be not less than two.
Note 2: In a normal system of Series I, the highest voltage and the lowest voltage do
not differ by more than approximately ±10 % from the nominal voltage of the system.
In a normal system of Series II, the highest voltage does not differ by more than +5 %
and the lowest voltage by more than -10 % from the nominal voltage of the system.
(a) These systems are generally three-wire systems, unless otherwise indicated. The
values indicated are voltages between phases.
The values indicated in parentheses should be considered as non-preferred values. It is
recommended that these values should not be used for new systems to be constructed
in future.
(b) These values should not be used for new public distribution systems.
(c) These systems are generally four-wire systems and the values indicated are
voltages between phases. The voltage to neutral is equal to the indicated value divided
by 1.73.
(d) The unification of these values is under consideration.
(e) The values of 22.9 kV for nominal voltage and 24.2 kV or 25.8 kV for highest voltage
for equipment are also used in some countries.
Fig. A2 : AC 3 phases Standard voltages above 1 kV and not exceeding 35 kV
(IEC 60038 Edition 7.0 2009)(a)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Series I
Highest voltage
for equipment (kV)
3.6(b)
7.2(b)
12
–
–
–
(17.5)
24
–
36(d)
–
40.5(d)
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A6
2.2 Regulations
In most countries, electrical installations shall comply with more than one set of
regulations, issued by National Authorities or by recognized private bodies. It is
essential to take into account these local constraints before starting the design.
These regulations may be based on national standards derived from the IEC 60364:
Low-voltage electrical installations.
2.3 Standards
This Guide is based on relevant IEC standards, in particular IEC 60364. IEC 60364
has been established by engineering experts of all countries in the world comparing
their experience at an international level. Currently, the safety principles of IEC
60364 series, IEC 61140, 60479 series and IEC 61201 are the fundamentals of most
electrical standards in the world (see table below and next page).
IEC 60038
IEC 60076-2
IEC 60076-3
IEC 60076-5
IEC 60076-10
IEC 60146-1-1
IEC 60255-1
IEC 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
IEC 60282-1
IEC 60287-1-1
IEC 60364-1
IEC 60364-4-41
IEC 60364-4-42
IEC 60364-4-43
IEC 60364-4-44
IEC 60364-5-51
IEC 60364-5-52
IEC 60364-5-53
IEC 60364-5-54
IEC 60364-5-55
IEC 60364-6
IEC 60364-7-701
IEC 60364-7-702
IEC 60364-7-703
IEC 60364-7-704
IEC 60364-7-705
IEC 60364-7-706
IEC 60364-7-708
IEC 60364-7-709
IEC 60364-7-710
IEC 60364-7-711
IEC 60364-7-712
IEC 60364-7-713
IEC 60364-7-714
IEC 60364-7-715
IEC 60364-7-717
IEC 60364-7-718
IEC 60364-7-721
IEC 60364-7-729
IEC 60364-7-740
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
IEC 60364-7-753
IEC 60446
IEC 60479-1
IEC 60479-2
IEC 60479-3
IEC 60529
IEC 60644
IEC standard voltages
Power transformers - Temperature rise for liquid immersed transformers
Power transformers - Insulation levels, dielectric tests and external clearances in air
Power transformers - Ability to withstand short-circuit
Power transformers - Determination of sound levels
Semiconductor converters - General requirements and line commutated converters - Specifications of basic requirements
Measuring relays and protection equipment - Common requirements
Low-voltage fuses - General requirements
Low-voltage fuses - Supplementary requirements for fuses for use by authorized persons (fuses mainly for industrial applications) - Examples of
standardized systems of fuses A to J
High-voltage fuses - Current-limiting fuses
Electric cables - Calculation of the current rating - Current rating equations (100% load factor) and calculation of losses - General
Low-voltage electrical installations - Fundamental principles, assessment of general characteristics, definitions
Low-voltage electrical installations - Protection for safety - Protection against electric shock
Low-voltage electrical installations - Protection for safety - Protection against thermal effects
Low-voltage electrical installations - Protection for safety - Protection against overcurrent
Low-voltage electrical installations - Protection for safety - Protection against voltage disturbances and electromagnetic disturbances
Low-voltage electrical installations - Selection and erection of electrical equipment - Common rules
Low-voltage electrical installations - Selection and erection of electrical equipment - Wiring systems
Low-voltage electrical installations - Selection and erection of electrical equipment - Isolation, switching and control
Low-voltage electrical installations - Selection and erection of electrical equipment - Earthing arrangements and protective conductors
Low-voltage electrical installations - Selection and erection of electrical equipment - Other equipments
Low-voltage electrical installations - Verification
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Locations containing a bath or shower
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Swimming pools and fountains
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Rooms and cabins containing sauna heaters
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Construction and demolition site installations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Agricultural and horticultural premises
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Conducting locations with restrictive movement
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Caravan parks, camping parks and similar locations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Marinas and similar locations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Medical locations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Exhibitions, shows and stands
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Solar photovoltaic (PV) power supply systems
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Furniture
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - External lighting installations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Extra-low-voltage lighting installations
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Mobile or transportable units
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations – Communal facilities and workplaces
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations – Electrical installations in caravans and motor caravans
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations – Operating or maintenance gangways
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations - Temporary electrical installations for structures,
amusement devices and booths at fairgrounds, amusement parks and circuses
Low-voltage electrical installations - Requirements for special installations or locations – Floor and ceiling heating systems
Basic and safety principles for man-machine interface, marking and identification - Identification of equipment terminals, conductors terminations
and conductors
Effects of current on human beings and livestock - General aspects
Effects of current on human beings and livestock - Special aspects
Effects of current on human beings and livestock - Effects of currents passing through the body of livestock
Degrees of protection provided by enclosures (IP code)
Specification for high-voltage fuse-links for motor circuit applications
(Continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Rules and statutory regulations
A7
Insulation coordination for equipment within low-voltage systems
Dimensions of low-voltage switchgear and controlgear. Standardized mounting on rails for mechanical support of electrical devices in switchgear
and controlgear installations.
IEC 60724
Short-circuit temperature limits of electric cables with rated voltages of 1 kV (Um = 1.2 kV) and 3 kV (Um = 3.6 kV)
IEC 60755
General requirements for residual current operated protective devices
IEC 60787
Application guide for the selection of high-voltage current-limiting fuses-link for transformer circuit
IEC 60831-1
Shunt power capacitors of the self-healing type for a.c. systems having a rated voltage up to and including 1000 V - Part 1: General - Performance,
testing and rating - Safety requirements - Guide for installation and operation
IEC 60831-2
Shunt power capacitors of the self-healing type for a.c. systems having a rated voltage up to and including 1000 V - Part 2: Ageing test, self-healing
test and destruction test
IEC 60947-1
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear - General rules
IEC 60947-2
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Circuit-breakers
IEC 60947-3
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Switches, disconnectors, switch-disconnectors and fuse-combination units
IEC 60947-4-1
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Contactors and motor-starters - Electromechanical contactors and motor-starters
IEC 60947-6-1
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Multiple function equipment - Transfer switching equipment
IEC 61000 series Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
IEC 61140
Protection against electric shocks - common aspects for installation and equipment
IEC 61201
Use of conventional touch voltage limits – Application guide
IEC 61439-0
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - Specification guide
IEC 61439-1
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - general rules
IEC 61439-2
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - power switchgear and controlgear assemblies
IEC 61439-3
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - distribution boards intended to be operated by ordinary persons (DBO)
IEC 61439-4
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - Particular requirements for assemblies for construction sites (ACS)
IEC 61439-5
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - Assemblies for power distribution in public networks
IEC 61439-6
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear assemblies - Busbar trunking systems (busways)
IEC 61557-1
Electrical safety in low voltage distribution systems up to 1 000 V a.c. and 1 500 V d.c. - Equipment for testing, measuring or monitoring of
protective measures - General requirements
IEC 61557-8
Electrical safety in low voltage distribution systems up to 1 000 V a.c. and 1 500 V d.c. - Equipment for testing, measuring or monitoring of
protective measures - Insulation monitoring devices for IT systems
IEC 61557-9
Electrical safety in low voltage distribution systems up to 1000 V a.c. and 1500 V d.c. - Equipment for testing, measuring or monitoring of protective
measures - Equipment for insulation fault location in IT systems
IEC 61557-12
Electrical safety in low voltage distribution systems up to 1 000 V a.c. and 1 500 V d.c. - Equipment for testing, measuring or monitoring of
protective measures - Performance measuring and monitoring devices (PMD)
IEC 61558-2-6
Safety of transformers, reactors, power supply units and similar products for supply voltages up to 1100 V - Particular requirements and test for
safety isolating transformers and power supply units incorporating isolating transformers
IEC 61643-11 (2011) Low-voltage surge protective devices - Surge protective devices connected to low-voltage power systems - Requirements and test methods
IEC 61643-12
Low-voltage surge protective devices - Surge protective devices connected to low-voltage power distribution systems - Selection and application
principles
IEC 61643-21
Low voltage surge protective devices - Surge protective devices connected to telecommunications and signalling networks - Performance
requirements and testing methods
IEC 61643-22
Low-voltage surge protective devices - Surge protective devices connected to telecommunications and signalling networks - Selection and
application principles
IEC 61921
Power capacitors - Low-voltage power factor correction banks
IEC 62271-1
High-voltage switchgear and controlgear – Common specifications
IEC 62271-100 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Alternating-current circuit-breakers
IEC 62271-101 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Synthetic testing
IEC 62271-102 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Alternating current disconnectors and earthing switches
IEC 62271-103 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Switches for rated voltages above 1 kV up to and including 52 kV
IEC 62271-105 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Alternating current switch-fuse combinations for rated voltages above 1 kV up to and including 52 kV
IEC 62271-200 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Alternating current metal-enclosed switchgear and controlgear for rated voltages above 1 kV and up to
and including 52 kV
IEC 62271-202 High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - High-voltage/low voltage prefabricated substations
IEC 62305-1
Protection against lightning - Part 1: General principles
IEC 62305-2
Protection against lightning - Part 2: Risk management
IEC 62305-3
Protection against lightning - Part 3: Physical damage to structures and life hazard
IEC 62305-4
Protection against lightning - Part 4: Electrical and electronic systems within structures
(Concluded)
IEC 60664
IEC 60715
In so far as control procedures are respected, quality and safety will be assured
only if:
b The design has been done according to the latest edition of the appropriate wiring
rules
b The electrical equipment comply with relevant product standards
b The initial checking of conformity of the electrical installation with the standard and
regulation has been achieved
b The periodic checking of the installation recommended is respected.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
2.4 Quality and safety of an electrical installation
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A8
2.5 Initial testing of an installation
Before a utility will connect an installation to its supply network, strict precommissioning electrical tests and visual inspections by the authority, or by its
appointed agent, must be satisfied.
These tests are made according to local (governmental and/or institutional)
regulations, which may differ slightly from one country to another. The principles of
all such regulations however, are common, and are based on the observance of
rigorous safety rules in the design and realization of the installation.
IEC 60364-6 and related standards included in this guide are based on an
international consensus for such tests, intended to cover all the safety measures and
approved installation practices normally required for residential, commercial and (the
majority of) industrial buildings. Many industries however have additional regulations
related to a particular product (petroleum, coal, natural gas, etc.). Such additional
requirements are beyond the scope of this guide.
The pre-commissioning electrical tests and visual-inspection checks for installations
in buildings include, typically, all of the following:
b Electrical continuity and conductivity tests of protective, equipotential and earthbonding conductors
b Insulation resistance tests between live conductors and the protective conductors
connected to the earthing arrangement
b Test of compliance of SELV and PELV circuits or for electrical separation
b Insulation resistance/impedance of floors and walls
b Protection by automatic disconnection of the supply
v For TN, by measurement of the fault loop impedance, and by verification of
the characteristics and/or the effectiveness of the associated protective devices
(overcurrent protective device and RCD)
v For TT, by measurement of the resistance RA of the earth electrode of the
exposed-conductive-parts, and by verification of the characteristics and/or the
effectiveness of the associated protective devices (overcurrent protective device and
RCD)
v For IT, by calculation or measurement of the current Id in case of a fist fault at
the line conductor or at the neutral, and with the test done for TN system where
conditions are similar to TN system in case of a double insulation fault situation, with
the test done for TT system where the conditions are similar to TT system in case of
a double insulation fault situation.
b Additional protection by verifying the effectiveness of the protective
measureVerification
b Polarity test where the rules prohibit the installation of single pole switching devices
in the neutral conductor.
b Check of phase sequence in case of multiphase circuit
b Functional test of switchgear and controlgear by verifying their installation and
adjustment
b Voltage drop by measuring the circuit impedance or by using diagrams
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These tests and checks are basic (but not exhaustive) to the majority of installations,
while numerous other tests and rules are included in the regulations to cover
particular cases, for example: installations based on class 2 insulation, special
locations, etc.
The aim of this guide is to draw attention to the particular features of different types
of installation, and to indicate the essential rules to be observed in order to achieve
a satisfactory level of quality, which will ensure safe and trouble-free performance.
The methods recommended in this guide, modified if necessary to comply with any
possible variation imposed by a utility, are intended to satisfy all precommissioning
test and inspection requirements.
After verification and testing an initial report must be provided including records of
inspection, records of circuits tested together with the test result and possible repairs
or improvements of the installation.
2.6 Put in out of danger the existing electrical
installations
This subject is in real progress cause of the statistics with origin electrical
installation (number of old and recognised dangerous electrical installations, existing
installations not in adequation with the future needs etc...)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Rules and statutory regulations
A9
2.7 Periodic check-testing of an installation
In many countries, all industrial and commercial-building installations, together with
installations in buildings used for public gatherings, must be re-tested periodically by
authorized agents.
The following tests should be performed
b Verification of RCD effectiveness and adjustments
b Appropriate measurements for providing safety of persons against effects of
electric shock and protection against damage to property against fire and heat
b Confirmation that the installation is not damaged
b Identification of installation defects
Figure A3 shows the frequency of testing commonly prescribed according to the
kind of installation concerned.
Type of installation
Installations
which require
the protection
of employees
b Locations at which a risk of degradation,
fire or explosion exists
b Temporary installations at worksites
b Locations at which MV installations exist
b Restrictive conducting locations where
mobile equipment is used
Other cases
Installations in buildings
According to the type of establishment
used for public gatherings, and its capacity for receiving the public
where protection against
the risks of fire and panic
are required
Residential
According to local regulations
Testing frequency
Annually
Every 3 years
From one to
three years
Example : the REBT
in Belgium which
imposes a periodic
control each 20 years.
Fig A3 : Frequency of check-tests commonly recommended for an electrical installation
As for the initial verification, a reporting of periodic verification is to be provided.
2.8 Conformity assessement (with standards and
specifications) of equipment used in the installation
The conformity assessement of equipment with the relevant standards can be
attested:
b By mark of conformity granted by the certification body concerned, or
b By a certificate of conformity issued by a certification body, or
b By a declaration of conformity given by the manufacturer
Declaration of conformity
As business, the declaration of conformity, including the technical documentation, is
generally used in for high voltage equipments or for specific products. In Europe, the
CE declaration is a mandatory declaration of conformity.
Note: CE marking
In Europe, the European directives require the manufacturer or his authorized
representative to affix the CE marking on his own responsibility. It means that:
b The product meets the legal requirements
b It is presumed to be marketable in Europe
The CE marking is neither a mark of origin nor a mark of conformity, it completes the
declaration of conformity and the technical documents of the equipments
Certificate of conformity
A certificate of conformity can reinforce the manufacturer's declaration and the
customer's confidence. It could be requested by the regulation of the countries,
imposed by the customers (Marine, Nuclear,..), be mandatory to garanty the
maintenance or the consistency between the equipments
Mark of conformity
Marks of conformity are strong strategic tools to validate a durable conformity.
It consolidates the confidence with the brand of the manufacturer. A mark of
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Conformity of equipment with the relevant
standards can be attested in several ways
A - General rules of electrical installation design
2 Rules and statutory regulations
A10
conformity is delivered by certification body if the equipment meets the requirements
from an applicable referential (including the standard) and after verification of the
manufacturer’s quality management system.
Audit on the production and follow up on the equipments are made globally each year.
Quality assurance
A laboratory for testing samples cannot certify the conformity of an entire production
run: these tests are called type tests. In some tests for conformity to standards,
the samples are destroyed (tests on fuses, for example).
Only the manufacturer can certify that the fabricated products have, in fact,
the characteristics stated.
Quality assurance certification is intended to complete the initial declaration or
certification of conformity.
As proof that all the necessary measures have been taken for assuring the quality of
production, the manufacturer obtains certification of the quality control system which
monitors the fabrication of the product concerned. These certificates are issued
by organizations specializing in quality control, and are based on the international
standard ISO 9001: 2000.
These standards define three model systems of quality assurance control
corresponding to different situations rather than to different levels of quality:
b Model 3 defines assurance of quality by inspection and checking of final products.
b Model 2 includes, in addition to checking of the final product, verification of the
manufacturing process. For example, this method is applied, to the manufacturer of
fuses where performance characteristics cannot be checked without destroying the fuse.
b Model 1 corresponds to model 2, but with the additional requirement that the
quality of the design process must be rigorously scrutinized; for example, where it is
not intended to fabricate and test a prototype (case of a custom-built product made to
specification).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
2.9 Environment
The contribution of the whole electrical installation to sustainable development can
be significantly improved through the design of the installation. Actually, it has been
shown that an optimised design of the installation, taking into account operation
conditions, MV/LV substations location and distribution structure (switchboards,
busways, cables), can reduce substantially environmental impacts (raw material
depletion, energy depletion, end of life), especially in term of energy efficiency.
Beside its architecture, environmental specification of the electrical component
and equipment is a fundamental step for an eco-friendly installation. In particular to
ensure proper environmental information and anticipate regulation.
In Europe several Directives concerning electrical equipments have been published,
leading the worldwide move to more environment safe products.
a) RoHS Directive (Restriction of Hazardous Substances) : in force since July 2006
and revised on 2012. It aims to eliminate from products six hazardous substances:
lead, mercury, cadmium, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls (PBB) or
polybrominated diphenyl ethers (PBDE) from most of end user electrical products..
Though electrical installations being “large scale fixed installation” are not in the
scope, RoHS compliance requirement may be a recommendation for a sustainable
installation
b) WEEE Directive (Waste of Electrical and Electronic Equipment) : in force since
August 2005 and currently under revision. Its purpose is to improve the end of life
treatments for household and non household equipment, under the responsibility
of the manufacturers. As for RoHS, electrical installations are not in the scope of
this directive. However, End of Life Product information is recommended to optimise
recycling process and cost.
c) Energy Related Product , also called Ecodesign. Apart for some equipments
like lighting or motors for which implementing measures are compulsory, there
are no legal requirements that directly apply to installation. However, trend is to
provide electrical equipments with their Environmental Product Declarattion , as it is
becoming for Construction Products , to anticipate Building Market coming requirements.
d) REACh : (Registration Evaluation Authorisation of Chemicals). In force since
2009, it aims to control chemical use and restrict application when necessary to
reduce hazards to people and environment. With regards to EE and installations, it
implies any supplier shall, upon request, communicate to its customer the hazardous
substances content in its product (so called SVHC). Then, an installer should ensure
that its suppliers have the appropriate information available
In other parts of the world new legislations will follow the same objectives.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Installed power loads Characteristics
A11
The examination of actual values of apparent-power required by each load enables
the establishment of:
An examination of the actual apparentpower demands of different loads: a
necessary preliminary step in the design of a
LV installation
b A declared power demand which determines the contract for the supply of energy
b The rating of the MV/LV transformer, where applicable (allowing for expected
increased load)
b Levels of load current at each distribution board
The nominal power in kW (Pn) of a motor
indicates its rated equivalent mechanical power
output.
The apparent power in kVA (Pa) supplied to
the motor is a function of the output, the motor
efficiency and the power factor.
Pn
Pa =
η cosϕ
3.1 Induction motors
Current demand
The full-load current Ia supplied to the motor is given by the following formulae:
b 3-phase motor: Ia = Pn x 1,000 / 3 x U x x cos
b 1-phase motor: Ia = Pn x 1,000 / (U x x cos
where
Ia: current demand (in amps)
Pn: nominal power (in kW)
U: voltage between phases for 3-phase motors and voltage between the terminals
for single-phase motors (in volts). A single-phase motor may be connected phase-toneutral or phase-to-phase.
: per-unit efficiency, i.e. output kW / input kW
cos : power factor, i.e. kW input / kVA input
Subtransient current and protection setting
b Subtransient current peak value can be very high ; typical value is about 12
to 15 times the rms rated value Inm. Sometimes this value can reach 25 times Inm.
b Schneider Electric circuit-breakers, contactors and thermal relays are designed to
withstand motor starts with very high subtransient current (subtransient peak value
can be up to 19 times the rms rated value Inm).
b If unexpected tripping of the overcurrent protection occurs during starting, this
means the starting current exceeds the normal limits. As a result, some maximum
switchgear withstands can be reached, life time can be reduced and even some
devices can be destroyed. In order to avoid such a situation, oversizing of the
switchgear must be considered.
b Schneider Electric switchgears are designed to ensure the protection of motor
starters against short-circuits. According to the risk, tables show the combination of
circuit-breaker, contactor and thermal relay to obtain type 1 or type 2 coordination
(see chapter N).
Motor starting current
Although high efficiency motors can be found on the market, in practice their starting
currents are roughly the same as some of standard motors.
The use of start-delta starter, static soft start unit or variable speed drive allows to
reduce the value of the starting current (Example : 4 Ia instead of 7.5 Ia).
Compensation of reactive-power (kvar) supplied to induction motors
As discussed in chapter L, the apparent power (kVA) supplied to an induction motor
can be significantly reduced by the use of shunt-connected capacitors. Reduction
of input kVA means a corresponding reduction of input current (since the voltage
remains constant).
Compensation of reactive-power is particularly advised for motors that operate for
long periods at reduced power.
kW input
so that a kVA input reduction will increase
kVA input
(i.e. improve) the value of cos .
As noted above cos
=
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
It is generally advantageous for technical and financial reasons to reduce the current
supplied to induction motors. This can be achieved by using capacitors without
affecting the power output of the motors.
The application of this principle to the operation of induction motors is generally
referred to as “power-factor improvement” or “power-factor correction”.
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A12
The current supplied to the motor, after power-factor correction, is given by:
cos
I=Ia
cos '
where cos is the power factor before compensation and cos ’ is the power factor
after compensation, Ia being the original current.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Figure A4 below shows, in function of motor rated power, standard motor current
values for several voltage supplies.
kW
hp
230 V
0.18
0.25
0.37
0.55
0.75
1.1
1.5
2.2
3.0
3.7
4
5.5
7.5
11
15
18.5
22
30
37
45
55
75
90
110
132
150
160
185
200
220
250
280
300
1/2
3/4
1
1-1/2
2
3
7-1/2
10
15
20
25
30
40
50
60
75
100
125
150
200
250
300
350
400
-
A
1.0
1.5
1.9
2.6
3.3
4.7
6.3
8.5
11.3
15
20
27
38.0
51
61
72
96
115
140
169
230
278
340
400
487
609
748
-
380 415 V
A
1.3
1.8
2.3
3.3
4.3
6.1
9.7
14.0
18.0
27.0
34.0
44
51
66
83
103
128
165
208
240
320
403
482
560
636
-
400 V
A
0.6
0.85
1.1
1.5
1.9
2.7
3.6
4.9
6.5
8.5
11.5
15.5
22.0
29
35
41
55
66
80
97
132
160
195
230
280
350
430
-
440 480 V
A
1.1
1.6
2.1
3.0
3.4
4.8
7.6
11.0
14.0
21.0
27.0
34
40
52
65
77
96
124
156
180
240
302
361
414
474
-
Fig. A4 : Rated operational power and currents (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
500 V
690 V
A
0.48
0.68
0.88
1.2
1.5
2.2
2.9
3.9
5.2
6.8
9.2
12.4
17.6
23
28
33
44
53
64
78
106
128
156
184
224
280
344
-
A
0.35
0.49
0.64
0.87
1.1
1.6
2.1
2.8
3.8
4.9
6.7
8.9
12.8
17
21
24
32
39
47
57
77
93
113
134
162
203
250
-
3 Installed power loads Characteristics
A13
kW
hp
230 V
315
335
355
375
400
425
450
475
500
530
560
600
630
670
710
750
800
850
900
950
1000
540
500
-
A
940
1061
1200
1478
1652
1844
2070
2340
2640
2910
380 415 V
A
786
-
400 V
440 480 V
A
515
590
-
A
540
610
690
850
950
1060
1190
1346
1518
1673
500 V
690 V
A
432
488
552
680
760
848
952
1076
1214
1339
A
313
354
400
493
551
615
690
780
880
970
Fig. A4 : Rated operational power and currents (concluded)
3.2 Resistive-type heating appliances and
incandescent lamps (conventional or halogen)
The current demand of a heating appliance or an incandescent lamp is easily
obtained from the nominal power Pn quoted by the manufacturer (i.e. cos = 1)
(see Fig. A5).
Current demand (A)
1-phase 1-phase
127 V
230 V
0.79
0.43
1.58
0.87
3.94
2.17
7.9
4.35
11.8
6.52
15.8
8.70
19.7
10.9
23.6
13
27.6
15.2
31.5
17.4
35.4
19.6
39.4
21.7
47.2
26.1
55.1
30.4
63
34.8
71
39.1
79
43.5
3-phase
230 V
0.25
0.50
1.26
2.51
3.77
5.02
6.28
7.53
8.72
10
11.3
12.6
15.1
17.6
20.1
22.6
25.1
3-phase
400 V
0.14
0.29
0.72
1.44
2.17
2.89
3.61
4.33
5.05
5.77
6.5
7.22
8.66
10.1
11.5
13
14.4
Fig. A5 : Current demands of resistive heating and incandescent lighting (conventional or
halogen) appliances
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Nominal
power
(kW)
0.1
0.2
0.5
1
1.5
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
6
7
8
9
10
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A14
The currents are given by:
b 3-phase case: I a =
Pn
b 1-phase case: I a =
Pn (1)
U
(1)
3U
where U is the voltage between the terminals of the equipment.
For an incandescent lamp, the use of halogen gas allows a more concentrated light
source. The light output is increased and the lifetime of the lamp is doubled.
Note: At the instant of switching on, the cold filament gives rise to a very brief but
intense peak of current.
Fluorescent lamps and related equipment
The power Pn (watts) indicated on the tube of a fluorescent lamp does not include
the power dissipated in the ballast.
The current is given by:
Ia =
Pballast + Pn
U cos
Where U = the voltage applied to the lamp, complete with its related equipment.
If no power-loss value is indicated for the ballast, a figure of 25% of Pn may be used.
Standard tubular fluorescent lamps
With (unless otherwise indicated):
b cos = 0.6 with no power factor (PF) correction(2) capacitor
b cos = 0.86 with PF correction(2) (single or twin tubes)
b cos = 0.96 for electronic ballast.
If no power-loss value is indicated for the ballast, a figure of 25% of Pn may be used.
Figure A6 gives these values for different arrangements of ballast.
Arrangement
Tube power
of lamps, starters (W) (3)
and ballasts
Single tube
18
36
58
Twin tubes
2 x 18
2 x 36
2 x 58
(3) Power in watts marked on tube
Current (A) at 230 V
Magnetic ballast
Without PF
correction
capacitor
0.20
0.33
0.50
With PF
correction
capacitor
0.14
0.23
0.36
0.28
0.46
0.72
Electronic
ballast
Tube
length
(cm)
0.10
0.18
0.28
0.18
0.35
0.52
60
120
150
60
120
150
Fig. A6 : Current demands and power consumption of commonly-dimensioned fluorescent
lighting tubes (at 230 V-50 Hz)
Compact fluorescent lamps
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Compact fluorescent lamps have the same characteristics of economy and long life
as classical tubes. They are commonly used in public places which are permanently
illuminated (for example: corridors, hallways, bars, etc.) and can be mounted in
situations otherwise illuminated by incandescent lamps (see Fig. A7 next page).
(1) Ia in amps; U in volts. Pn is in watts. If Pn is in kW, then
multiply the equation by 1,000
(2) “Power-factor correction” is often referred to as
“compensation” in discharge-lighting-tube terminology.
Cos is approximately 0.95 (the zero values of V and I
are almost in phase) but the power factor is 0.5 due to the
impulsive form of the current, the peak of which occurs “late”
in each half cycle
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Installed power loads Characteristics
A15
Type of lamp
Separated
ballast lamp
Integrated
ballast lamp
Lamp power
(W)
10
18
26
8
11
16
21
Current at 230 V
(A)
0.080
0.110
0.150
0.075
0.095
0.125
0.170
Fig. A7 : Current demands and power consumption of compact fluorescent lamps (at 230 V - 50 Hz)
Discharge lamps
The power in watts indicated on the tube of
a discharge lamp does not include the power
dissipated in the ballast.
Figure A8 gives the current taken by a complete unit, including all associated
ancillary equipment.
Type of
lamp (W)
Power
demand
(W) at
230 V 400 V
Current In(A)
Starting
PF not
PF
Ia/In
corrected
corrected
230 V 400 V 230 V 400 V
High-pressure sodium vapour lamps
50
60
0.76
70
80
1
100
115
1.2
150
168
1.8
250
274
3
400
431
4.4
1000
1055
10.45
Low-pressure sodium vapour lamps
26
34.5
0.45
36
46.5
66
80.5
91
105.5
131
154
Period
(mins)
Luminous
efficiency
(lumens
per watt)
Average
timelife of
lamp (h)
Utilization
0.3
0.45
0.65
0.85
1.4
2.2
4.9
1.4 to 1.6 4 to 6
80 to 120
9000
b Lighting of
large halls
b Outdoor spaces
b Public lighting
0.17
0.22
0.39
0.49
0.69
1.1 to 1.3 7 to 15
100 to 200
8000
to 12000
b Lighting of
autoroutes
b Security lighting,
station
b Platform, storage
areas
Mercury vapour + metal halide (also called metal-iodide)
70
80.5
1
0.40
1.7
3 to 5
70 to 90
6000
b Lighting of very
150
172
1.80
0.88
6000
large areas by
250
276
2.10
1.35
6000
projectors (for
400
425
3.40
2.15
6000
example: sports
1000
1046
8.25
5.30
6000
stadiums, etc.)
2000
2092 2052 16.50 8.60 10.50 6
2000
Mercury vapour + fluorescent substance (fluorescent bulb)
50
57
0.6
0.30
1.7 to 2
3 to 6
40 to 60
8000
b Workshops
80
90
0.8
0.45
to 12000
with very high
125
141
1.15
0.70
ceilings (halls,
250
268
2.15
1.35
hangars)
400
421
3.25
2.15
b Outdoor lighting
700
731
5.4
3.85
b Low light output(1)
1000
1046
8.25
5.30
2000
2140 2080 15
11
6.1
(1) Replaced by sodium vapour lamps.
Note: these lamps are sensitive to voltage dips. They extinguish if the voltage falls to less than 50% of their nominal voltage, and will
not re-ignite before cooling for approximately 4 minutes.
Note: Sodium vapour low-pressure lamps have a light-output efficiency which is superior to that of all other sources. However, use of
these lamps is restricted by the fact that the yellow-orange colour emitted makes colour recognition practically impossible.
Fig. A8 : Current demands of discharge lamps
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These lamps depend on the luminous electrical discharge through a gas or vapour
of a metallic compound, which is contained in a hermetically-sealed transparent
envelope at a pre-determined pressure. These lamps have a long start-up time,
during which the current Ia is greater than the nominal current In. Power and current
demands are given for different types of lamp (typical average values which may
differ slightly from one manufacturer to another).
A - General rules of electrical installation design
4 Power loading of an installation
A16
In order to design an installation, the actual maximum load demand likely to be
imposed on the power-supply system must be assessed.
To base the design simply on the arithmetic sum of all the loads existing in the
installation would be extravagantly uneconomical, and bad engineering practice.
The aim of this chapter is to show how some factors taking into account the diversity
(non simultaneous operation of all appliances of a given group) and utilization
(e.g. an electric motor is not generally operated at its full-load capability, etc.) of
all existing and projected loads can be assessed. The values given are based on
experience and on records taken from actual installations. In addition to providing
basic installation-design data on individual circuits, the results will provide a
global value for the installation, from which the requirements of a supply system
(distribution network, MV/LV transformer, or generating set) can be specified.
4.1 Installed power (kW)
The installed power is the sum of the nominal
powers of all power consuming devices in the
installation.
This is not the power to be actually supplied in
practice.
Most electrical appliances and equipments are marked to indicate their nominal
power rating (Pn).
The installed power is the sum of the nominal powers of all power-consuming
devices in the installation. This is not the power to be actually supplied in practice.
This is the case for electric motors, where the power rating refers to the output power
at its driving shaft. The input power consumption will evidently be greater
Fluorescent and discharge lamps associated with stabilizing ballasts, are other
cases in which the nominal power indicated on the lamp is less than the power
consumed by the lamp and its ballast.
Methods of assessing the actual power consumption of motors and lighting
appliances are given in Section 3 of this Chapter.
The power demand (kW) is necessary to choose the rated power of a generating set
or battery, and where the requirements of a prime mover have to be considered.
For a power supply from a LV public-supply network, or through a MV/LV transformer,
the significant quantity is the apparent power in kVA.
4.2 Installed apparent power (kVA)
The installed apparent power is commonly
assumed to be the arithmetical sum of the kVA
of individual loads. The maximum estimated
kVA to be supplied however is not equal to the
total installed kVA.
The installed apparent power is commonly assumed to be the arithmetical sum of
the kVA of individual loads. The maximum estimated kVA to be supplied however is
not equal to the total installed kVA.
The apparent-power demand of a load (which might be a single appliance) is
obtained from its nominal power rating (corrected if necessary, as noted above for
motors, etc.) and the application of the following coefficients:
= the per-unit efficiency = output kW / input kW
cos = the power factor = kW / kVA
The apparent-power kVA demand of the load
Pa = Pn /( x cos )
From this value, the full-load current Ia (A)(1) taken by the load will be:
b Ia =
Pa x 103
V
for single phase-to-neutral connected load
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Ia =
(1) For greater precision, account must be taken of the factor
of maximum utilization as explained below in 4.3
Pa x 103
3xU
for three-phase balanced load where:
V = phase-to-neutral voltage (volts)
U = phase-to-phase voltage (volts)
It may be noted that, strictly speaking, the total kVA of apparent power is not the
arithmetical sum of the calculated kVA ratings of individual loads (unless all loads are
at the same power factor).
It is common practice however, to make a simple arithmetical summation, the result
of which will give a kVA value that exceeds the true value by an acceptable “design
margin”.
When some or all of the load characteristics are not known, the values shown
in Figure A9 next page may be used to give a very approximate estimate of VA
demands (individual loads are generally too small to be expressed in kVA or kW).
The estimates for lighting loads are based on floor areas of 500 m2.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Power loading of an installation
A17
Fluorescent lighting (corrected to cos = 0.86)
Type of application
Estimated (VA/m2)
Average lighting
fluorescent tube
level (lux = lm/m2)
(1)
with industrial reflector
Roads and highways
7
150
storage areas, intermittent work
Heavy-duty works: fabrication and
14
300
assembly of very large work pieces
Day-to-day work: office work
24
500
Fine work: drawing offices
41
800
high-precision assembly workshops
Power circuits
Type of application
Estimated (VA/m2)
Pumping station compressed air
3 to 6
Ventilation of premises
23
Electrical convection heaters:
private houses
115 to 146
flats and apartments
90
Offices
25
Dispatching workshop
50
Assembly workshop
70
Machine shop
300
Painting workshop
350
Heat-treatment plant
700
(1) example: 65 W tube (ballast not included), flux 5,100 lumens (Im),
luminous efficiency of the tube = 78.5 Im / W.
Fig. A9 : Estimation of installed apparent power
4.3 Estimation of actual maximum kVA demand
All individual loads are not necessarily operating at full rated nominal power nor
necessarily at the same time. Factors ku and ks allow the determination of the
maximum power and apparent-power demands actually required to dimension the
installation.
Factor of maximum utilization (ku)
In normal operating conditions the power consumption of a load is sometimes less
than that indicated as its nominal power rating, a fairly common occurrence that
justifies the application of an utilization factor (ku) in the estimation of realistic values.
This factor must be applied to each individual load, with particular attention to
electric motors, which are very rarely operated at full load.
In an industrial installation this factor may be estimated on an average at 0.75 for
motors.
For incandescent-lighting loads, the factor always equals 1.
For socket-outlet circuits, the factors depend entirely on the type of appliances being
supplied from the sockets concerned.
For Electric Vehicle the utilization factor will be systematically estimated to 1, as it
takes a long time to load completely the batteries (several hours) and a dedicated
circuit feeding the charging station or wall box will be required by standards.
It is a matter of common experience that the simultaneous operation of all installed
loads of a given installation never occurs in practice, i.e. there is always some degree
of diversity and this fact is taken into account for estimating purposes by the use of a
simultaneity factor (ks).
The factor ks is applied to each group of loads (e.g. being supplied from a distribution
or sub-distribution board). The determination of these factors is the responsibility
of the designer, since it requires a detailed knowledge of the installation and the
conditions in which the individual circuits are to be exploited. For this reason, it is not
possible to give precise values for general application.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Factor of simultaneity (ks)
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A18
Number of downstream
consumers
2 to 4
5 to 9
10 to 14
15 to 19
20 to 24
25 to 29
30 to 34
35 to 39
40 to 49
50 and more
Factor of
simultaneity (ks)
1
0.78
0.63
0.53
0.49
0.46
0.44
0.42
0.41
0.40
Fig. A10 : Simultaneity factors in an apartment block
Factor of simultaneity for an apartment block
Some typical values for this case are given in Figure A10, and are applicable
to domestic consumers supplied at 230/400 V (3-phase 4-wires). In the case of
consumers using electrical heat-storage units for space heating, a factor of 0.8 is
recommended, regardless of the number of consumers.
Example (see Fig. A11):
5 storeys apartment building with 25 consumers, each having 6 kVA of installed load.
The total installed load for the building is: 36 + 24 + 30 + 36 + 24 = 150 kVA
The apparent-power supply required for the building is: 150 x 0.46 = 69 kVA
From Figure A10, it is possible to determine the magnitude of currents in different
sections of the common main feeder supplying all floors. For vertical rising mains
fed at ground level, the cross-sectional area of the conductors can evidently be
progressively reduced from the lower floors towards the upper floors.
These changes of conductor size are conventionally spaced by at least 3-floor
intervals.
In the example, the current entering the rising main at ground level is:
150 x 0.46 x 103
400
= 100 A
3
the current entering the third floor is:
(36 + 24) x 0.63 x 103
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
400
= 55 A
3
4th
floor
6 consumers
36 kVA
3 rd
floor
4 consumers
24 kVA
2 nd
floor
5 consumers
30 kVA
1st
floor
6 consumers
36 kVA
ground
floor
4 consumers
24 kVA
0.78
0.63
0.53
0.49
0.46
Fig. A11 : Application of the factor of simultaneity (ks) to an apartment block of 5 storeys
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Power loading of an installation
A19
Factor of simultaneity for distribution switchboards
Figure A12 shows hypothetical values of ks for a distribution board supplying a
number of circuits for which there is no indication of the manner in which the total
load divides between them.
If the circuits are mainly for lighting loads, it is prudent to adopt ks values close to
unity.
Number of
circuits
2 and 3
4 and 5
6 to 9
10 and more
Factor of
simultaneity (ks)
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
Fig. A12 : Factor of simultaneity for distribution boards
Factor of simultaneity according to circuit function
ks factors which may be used for circuits supplying commonly-occurring loads, are
shown in Figure A13.
Circuit function
Factor of simultaneity (ks)
Lighting
1
Heating and air conditioning
1
Socket-outlets
0.1 to 0.2 (1)
Lifts and catering hoist (2) b For the most powerful
motor
1
b For the second most
powerful motor
0.75
b For all motors
0.60
(1) In certain cases, notably in industrial installations, this factor can be higher.
(2) The current to take into consideration is equal to the nominal current of the motor,
increased by a third of its starting current.
Fig. A13 : Factor of simultaneity according to circuit function
4.4 Example of application of factors ku and ks
An example in the estimation of actual maximum kVA demands at all levels of an
installation, from each load position to the point of supply is given Fig. A14.
In this example, the total installed apparent power is 126.6 kVA, which corresponds
to an actual (estimated) maximum value at the LV terminals of the MV/LV transformer
of 65 kVA only.
Note: in order to select cable sizes for the distribution circuits of an installation, the
current I (in amps) through a circuit is determined from the equation:
kVA x 103
I=
U 3
where kVA is the actual maximum 3-phase apparent-power value shown on the
diagram for the circuit concerned, and U is the phase to- phase voltage (in volts).
The term diversity factor, as defined in IEC standards, is identical to the factor of
simultaneity (ks) used in this guide, as described in 4.3. In some English-speaking
countries however (at the time of writing) diversity factor is the inverse of ks i.e. it is
always u 1.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
4.5 Diversity factor
A - General rules of electrical installation design
A20
Apparent Utilization
power
factor
(Pa)
max.
kVA
Utilization
Workshop A Lathe
Apparent
power
demand
max. kVA
Level 1
Level 2
Simultaneity Apparent
factor
power
demand
kVA
Simultaneity Apparent
factor
power
demand
kVA
no. 1
5
0.8
4
no. 2
5
0.8
4
no. 3
5
0.8
4
no. 4
Pedestalno. 1
drill
5
0.8
4
2
0.8
1.6
no. 2
5 socketoutlets 10/16 A
2
0.8
1.6
18
1
18
0.2
3.6
3
1
3
1
3
15
0.8
12
1
12 Socket-
30 fluorescent
lamps
Workshop B Compressor
3 socketoutlets 10/16 A
0.75
Power
circuit
14.4
10.6
0.4
4.3
1
1
1
1
1
Workshop C Ventilation no. 1
2.5
1
2.5
no. 2
2.5
1
2.5
Distribution
box
no. 1
15
1
15
no. 2
15
1
15
18
1
18
0.28
5
2
1
2
1
2
5 socketoutlets 10/16 A
20 fluorescent
lamps
Apparent
power
demand
kVA
1
Workshop A
distribution
box
0.9
Socketoulets
Lighting
circuit
Power
circuit
1
Oven
Simultaneity
factor
Distribution
box
10.6
10 fluorescent
lamps
Level 3
oulets
Workshop B
distribution
box
Lighting
circuit
18.9
Main
general
distribution
board
MGDB
LV / MV
15.6
65
0.9
0.9
Workshop C
distribution
35
Powver
box
circuit
0.9
37.8
Socketoulets
Lighting
circuit
Fig A14 : An example in estimating the maximum predicted loading of an installation (the factor values used are for demonstration purposes only)
4.6 Choice of transformer rating
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Apparent power
kVA
100
160
250
315
400
500
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
2500
3150
In (A)
237 V
244
390
609
767
974
1218
1535
1949
2436
3045
3898
4872
6090
7673
When an installation is to be supplied directly from a MV/LV transformer and
the maximum apparent-power loading of the installation has been determined, a
suitable rating for the transformer can be decided, taking into account the following
considerations (see Fig. A15):
b The possibility of improving the power factor of the installation (see chapter L)
b Anticipated extensions to the installation
b Installation constraints (e.g. temperature)
b Standard transformer ratings
410 V
141
225
352
444
563
704
887
1127
1408
1760
2253
2816
3520
4436
The nominal full-load current In on the LV side of a 3-phase transformer is given by:
In =
Pa x 103
U 3
where
b Pa = kVA rating of the transformer
b U = phase-to-phase voltage at no-load in volts (237 V or 410 V)
b In is in amperes.
Fig. A15 : Standard apparent powers for MV/LV transformers
and related nominal output currents
For a single-phase transformer:
In =
Pa x 103
V
where
b V = voltage between LV terminals at no-load (in volts)
Simplified equation for 400 V (3-phase load)
b In = kVA x 1.4
The IEC standard for power transformers is IEC 60076.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Power loading of an installation
A21
4.7 Choice of power-supply sources
The importance of maintaining a continuous supply raises the question of the use of
standby-power plant. The choice and characteristics of these alternative sources are
part of the architecture selection, as described in chapter D.
For the main source of supply the choice is generally between a connection to the
MV or the LV network of the power-supply utility. In some cases main source of
supply can be rotating generators in the case of remote installations with difficult
access to the local Utility public grid (MV or LV) or where the reliability of the public
grid does not have the minimum level of reliability expected.
In practice, connection to a MV source may be necessary where the load exceeds
(or is planned eventually to exceed) a certain level - generally of the order of
250 kVA, or if the quality of service required is greater than that normally available
from a LV network.
Moreover, if the installation is likely to cause disturbance to neighbouring consumers,
when connected to a LV network, the supply authorities may propose a MV service.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Supplies at MV can have certain advantages: in fact, a MV consumer:
b Is not disturbed by other consumers, which could be the case at LV
b Is free to choose any type of LV earthing system
b Has a wider choice of economic tariffs
b Can accept very large increases in load
It should be noted, however, that:
b The consumer is the owner of the MV/LV substation and, in some countries,
he must build equip and maintain it at his own expense. The power utility can, in
certain circumstances, participate in the investment, at the level of the MV line for
example
b A part of the connection costs can, for instance, often be recovered if a second
consumer is connected to the MV line within a certain time following the original
consumer’s own connection
b The consumer has access only to the LV part of the installation, access to the
MV part being reserved to the utility personnel (meter reading, operations, etc.).
However, in certain countries, the MV protective circuit-breaker (or fused load-break
switch) can be operated by the consumer
b The type and location of the substation are agreed between the consumer and
the utility
More and more renewable energy sources such as photovoltaic panels are used
to supply low-voltage electrical installations. In some case these PV panels
are connected in parallel to the Utility grid or these PV panels are used in an
autonomous mode without connection to the public grid. Conversion from d.c. to a.c.
is then necessary as rated voltage of these PV panels are higher and higher (few
hundreds volts) and also because PV panels produce d.c. currents.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter B
Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B1
Contents
1
Power supply at medium voltage
B2
1.1 Power supply characteristics of medium-voltage networks
1.2 Different types of MV power supply
1.3 Some practical issues concerning MV distribution networks
B2
B2
B3
2
Procedure for the establishment of a new substation
B5
2.1 Preliminary informations
B5
2.2 Project studies
2.3 Implementation
2.4 Commissioning
B6
B6
B6
3
Protection aspect
B7
3.1 Protection against electric shocks
3.2 Protection of transformer and circuits
3.3 Interlocks and conditioned operations
B7
B8
B10
4
The consumer substation with LV metering
B13
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
B13
B13
B15
B16
Functions of the substation with LV metering
Choosing MV equipment
Choice of MV switchgear panel for a transformer circuit
Choice of MV/LV transformer
B19
5
The consumer substation with MV metering
B22
5.1 Functions of the substation with MV metering
5.2 Choice of panels
5.3 Parallel operation of transformers
B22
B24
B25
6
Constitution of MV/LV distribution substations
B27
6.1 Different types of substation
6.2 Indoor substation
6.3 Outdoor substation
B27
B27
B29
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
4.5 Instructions for use of MV equipment
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
1 Power supply at medium voltage
B2
The term «medium voltage» is commonly used for distribution systems with voltages
above 1 kV and generally applied up to and including 52 kV(1). For technical and
economic reasons, the nominal voltage of medium-voltage distribution networks
rarely exceeds 35 kV.
In this chapter, networks which operate at 1000 V or less are referred to as lowvoltage (LV) networks, whereas networks requiring a step-down transformer to feed
LV networks are referred to as medium voltage (MV) networks.
1.1 Power supply characteristics of medium-voltage
networks
The main characteristics of an MV power
supply are:
b The nominal voltage
b The short-circuit current
b The rated current used
b The earthing system
The characteristics of the MV network determine which switchgear is used in the MV
or MV/LV substation and are specific to individual countries. Familiarity with these
characteristics is essential when defining and implementing connections.
1.2 Different types of MV power supply
The following power supply methods may be used as appropriate for the type of
medium-voltage network.
Connection to an MV radial network: Single-line service
The substation is supplied by a tee-off from the MV radial network (overhead or
cable), also known as a spur network. This type of network supports a single supply
for loads (see Fig. B1).
The substation usually consists of an incoming panel, and overall protection is
provided by a load-break switch and fuses with earthing switches as shown in
Figure B1.
In some countries, the “substation” comprises a pole-mounted transformer without
a load-break switch or fuses (installed on the pole). This type of distribution is very
common in rural areas. Protection and switching devices are located remotely from
the transformer. These usually control a main overhead line to which secondary
overhead lines are connected.
Overhead line
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B1 : Single-line service (single supply)
(1) According to the IEC there is no clear boundary between
medium and high voltage; local and historical factors play
a part, and limits are usually between 30 and 100 kV (see
IEV 601-01-28).The publication IEC 62271-1 "High-voltage
switchgear and controlgear; common specifications"
incorporates a note in its scope: "For the use of this standard,
high voltage (see IEV 601-01-27) is the rated voltage above
1 000 V. However, the term medium voltage (see IEV 601-0128) is commonly used for distribution systems with voltages
above 1 kV and generally applied up to and including 52 kV.".
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Power supply at medium voltage
Connection to an MV loop: Ring-main service
B3
The power supply for the substation is connected in series to the power line of the
medium-voltage distribution network to form a loop(1). This allows the line current
to pass through a busbar, making it possible for loads to have two different power
supplies (see Fig. B2).
The substation has three medium-voltage modular units or an integrated ring-main
unit supporting the following functions:
b 2 incoming panels, each with a load-break switch. These are part of the loop and
are connected to a busbar.
b 1 transformer feeder connected to the busbar. General protection is provided by
load-break switches, a combined load-break/isolating switch or a circuit breaker.
All these types of switchgear are fitted with earthing switches.
All switches and earthing switches have a making capacity which enables them to
close at the network’s short-circuit current. Under this arrangement, the user benefits
from a reliable power supply based on two MV feeders, with downtime kept to a
minimum in the event of faults or work on the supplier network(1).
This method is used for the underground MV distribution networks found in urban
areas.
Underground cable loop
Fig. B2 : Ring-main service (double supply). The transformer
is protected, in accordance with the applicable standards, by a
circuit breaker or load-break switch as shown in Figure B1.
Connection to two parallel MV cables: Parallel feeders service
If two parallel underground cables can be used to supply a substation, an MV
switchboard similar to that of a ring-main station can be used (see Fig. B3).
The main difference to the ring-main station is that both load-break switches are
interlocked. This means that only one of them can be closed at any one time (if one
is closed, the other must be open).
In the event of the loss of supply, the associated incoming load-break switch must be
open and the interlocking system must enable the switch which was open to close.
This sequence can be implemented either manually or automatically.
This method is used for networks in some densely-populated or expanding urban
areas supplied by underground cables.
1.3 Some practical issues concerning MV
distribution networks
Underground cables in parallel
Fig. B3 : Parallel feeders service (double supply). The
transformer is protected, in accordance with local standards, by
a circuit breaker or load-break switch as shown in Figure B1.
(1) A medium-voltage loop is an underground distribution
network based on cables from two MV substation feeders. The
two feeders are the two ‘ends’ of the loop and each is protected
by an MV circuit breaker.
The loop is usually open, i.e. divided into two sections (halfloops), each of which is supplied by a feeder. To support this
arrangement, the two incoming load-break switches on the
substations in the loop are closed, allowing current to circulate
around the loop. On one of the stations one switch is normally
left open, determining the start of the loop.
A fault on one of the half-loops will trigger the protection device
on the associated feeder, de-energising all substations within
that half loop. Once the fault on the affected cable segment
(between two adjacent substations) has been located, the
supply to these substations can be restored from the other
feeder.
This requires some reconfiguration of the loop, with the loadbreak switches being switched in order to move the start of
the loop to the substation immediately downstream of the fault
and open the switch on the substation immediately upstream
of the fault on the loop. These measures isolate the cable
segment where the fault has occurred and restore the supply
to the whole loop, or to most of it if the switches that have been
switched are not on substations on either side of the sole cable
segment affected by the fault.
Systems for fault location and loop reconfiguration with remote
control switches allow these processes to be automated.
Weather conditions such as wind and frost may bring wires into contact and cause
temporary (as opposed to permanent) short-circuits.
Ceramic or glass insulating materials may be broken by wind-borne debris or
carelessly discharged firearms. Shorting to earth may also result when insulating
material becomes heavily soiled.
Many of these faults are able to rectify themselves. For example, damaged insulating
materials can continue functioning undetected in a dry environment, although heavy
rain will probably cause flashover to earth (e.g. via a metallic support structure).
Similarly, heavily soiled insulating material usually causes flashover to earth in damp
conditions.
Almost invariably, fault current will take the form of an electric arc, whose intense
heat dries the current’s path and, to some extent, re-establishes insulating
properties. During this time, protection devices will normally have proved effective in
eliminating the fault (fuses will blow or the circuit breaker will trip).
Experience has shown that, in the vast majority of cases, the supply can be restored
by replacing fuses or reclosing the circuit breaker.
As such, it is possible to improve the service continuity of overhead networks
significantly by using circuit breakers with an automated reclosing facility on the
relevant feeders.
These automated facilities support a set number of reclosing operations if a first
attempt proves unsuccessful. The interval between successive attempts can be
adjusted (to allow time for the air near the fault to deionise) before the circuit breaker
finally locks out after all the attempts (usually three) have failed.
Remote control switches can be used on cable segments within networks to further
improve service continuity. Load-break switches can also be teamed with a reclosing
circuit breaker to isolate individual sections.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Overhead networks
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
1 Power supply at medium voltage
B4
Underground networks
Cable faults on underground networks can sometimes be caused by poorly arranged
cable boxes or badly laid cables. For the most part, however, faults are the result of
damage caused by tools such as pickaxes and pneumatic drills or by earthmoving
plant used by other public utilities.
Insulation faults sometimes occur in connection boxes as a result of overvoltage,
particularly at locations where an MV network is connected to an underground cable
network. In such cases, overvoltage is usually caused by atmospheric conditions,
and the reflection effects of electromagnetic waves at the junction box (where
circuit impedance changes sharply) may generate sufficient strain on the cable box
insulation for a fault to occur.
Devices to protect against overvoltages, such as lightning arresters, are often
installed at these locations.
Underground cable networks suffer from fewer faults than overhead networks, but
those which do occur are invariably permanent and take longer to locate and resolve.
In the event of a fault affecting an MV loop cable, the supply can be quickly restored
to users once the cable segment where the fault occurred has been located.
Having said this, if the fault occurs at a feeder for a radial supply, it can take several
hours to locate and resolve the fault, and all the users connected in a single branch
arrangement downstream of the fault will be affected.
In cases where service continuity is essential for all or part of the installation
concerned, provision must be made for an auxiliary supply.
The use of centralised remote control and
monitoring based on SCADA (Supervisory
Control And Data Acquisition) systems and
recent developments in digital communication
technology is increasingly common in
countries where the complexity associated with
highly interconnected networks justifies the
investment required.
Remote control and monitoring for MV networks
Remote control and monitoring of MV feeders makes it possible to reduce
loss of supply resulting from cable faults by supporting fast and effective loop
reconfiguration. This facility relies on switches with electric controls which are fitted
on a number of substations in the loop and linked to modified remote-control units.
All stations containing this equipment can have their supply restored remotely,
whereas other stations will require additional manual operations
Values of earth fault currents for MV power supply
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The values of earth fault currents on distribution networks depend on the MV
substation’s earthing system (or neutral earthing system). They must be limited to
reduce their impact on the network and restrict possible increased potential on user
substation frames caused by the coupling of earth switches (overhead networks),
and to reduce flashover with the station’s LV circuits capable of generating
dangerous levels of potential in the low voltage installation.
Where networks have both overhead and underground elements, an increased
cable earthing capacitance value may cause the earth fault current value to rise and
require measures to compensate this phenomenon. Earthing impedance will then
involve reactance (a resistor in parallel with an inductor) in line with the leakage rate:
the neutral earthing system is compensated. Compensatory impedance makes it
possible to both:
b Control earth fault current values, regardless of the amount of cabling within the
network, and
b Eliminate most temporary and semi-permanent single-phase faults naturally by
facilitating self rectification, thereby avoiding many short-term losses
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
2 Procedure for the establishment
of a new substation
Large consumers of electricity are invariably supplied at MV.
B5
On LV systems operating at 120/208 V (3-phase 4-wires), a load of 50 kVA might be
considered to be “large”, while on a 240/415 V 3-phase system a “large” consumer
could have a load in excess of 100 kVA. Both systems of LV distribution are common
in many parts of the world.
As a matter of interest, the IEC recommends a “world” standard of 230/400 V for
3-phase 4-wire systems. This is a compromise level and will allow existing systems
which operate at 220/380 V and at 240/415 V, or close to these values, to comply
with the proposed standard simply by adjusting the off-circuit tapping switches of
standard distribution transformers.
The distance over which the energy has to be transmitted is a further factor in
considering an MV or LV service. Services to small but isolated rural consumers are
obvious examples.
The decision of a MV or LV supply will depend on local circumstances and
considerations such as those mentioned above, and will generally be imposed by the
utility for the district concerned.
When a decision to supply power at MV has been made, there are two widelyfollowed methods of proceeding:
1 - The power-supplier constructs a standard substation close to the consumer’s
premises, but the MV/LV transformer(s) is (are) located in transformer chamber(s)
inside the premises, close to the load centre
2 - The consumer constructs and equips his own substation on his own premises, to
which the power supplier makes the MV connection
In method no. 1 the power supplier owns the substation, the cable(s) to the
transformer(s), the transformer(s) and the transformer chamber(s), to which he has
unrestricted access.
The transformer chamber(s) is (are) constructed by the consumer (to plans and
regulations provided by the supplier) and include plinths, oil drains, fire walls and
ceilings, ventilation, lighting, and earthing systems, all to be approved by the supply
authority.
The tariff structure will cover an agreed part of the expenditure required to provide
the service.
Whichever procedure is followed, the same principles apply in the conception and
realization of the project. The following notes refer to procedure no. 2.
The consumer must provide certain data to the
utility at the earliest stage of the project.
2.1 Preliminary information
Before any negotiations or discussions can be initiated with the supply authorities,
the following basic elements must be established:
Maximum anticipated power (kVA) demand
Determination of this parameter is described in Chapter A, and must take into
account the possibility of future additional load requirements. Factors to evaluate at
this stage are:
b The utilization factor (ku)
b The simultaneity factor (ks)
Degree of supply continuity required
The consumer must estimate the consequences of a supply failure in terms of its
duration:
b Loss of production
b Safety of personnel and equipment
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Layout plans and elevations showing location of proposed substation
Plans should indicate clearly the means of access to the proposed substation, with
dimensions of possible restrictions, e.g. entrances corridors and ceiling height,
together with possible load (weight) bearing limits, and so on, keeping in mind that:
b The power-supply personnel must have free and unrestricted access to the
MV equipment in the substation at all times
b Only qualified and authorized consumer’s personnel are allowed access to the
substation
b Some supply authorities or regulations require that the part of the installation operated
by the authority is located in a separated room from the part operated by the customer.
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
2 Procedure for the establishment
of a new substation
B6
The utility must give specific information to the
prospective consumer.
2.2 Project studies
From the information provided by the consumer, the power-supplier must indicate:
The type of power supply proposed, and define:
b The kind of power-supply system: overheadline or underground-cable network
b Service connection details: single-line service, ring-main installation, or parallel
feeders, etc.
b Power (kVA) limit and fault current level
The nominal voltage and rated voltage (Highest voltage for equipment)
Existing or future, depending on the development of the system.
Metering details which define:
b The cost of connection to the power network
b Tariff details (consumption and standing charges)
2.3 Implementation
The utility must give official approval of the
equipment to be installed in the substation,
and of proposed methods of installation.
Before any installation work is started, the official agreement of the power-supplier
must be obtained. The request for approval must include the following information,
largely based on the preliminary exchanges noted above:
b Location of the proposed substation
b Single-line diagram of power circuits and connections, together with earthingcircuit proposals
b Full details of electrical equipment to be installed, including performance
characteristics
b Layout of equipment and provision for metering components
b Arrangements for power-factor improvement if required
b Arrangements provided for emergency standby power plant (MV or LV) if eventually
required
After testing and checking of the installation by
an independent test authority, a certificate is
granted which permits the substation to be put
into service.
2.4 Commissioning
When required by the authority, commissioning tests must be successfully completed
before authority is given to energize the installation from the power supply system.
Even if no test is required by the authority it is better to do the following verification tests:
b Measurement of earth-electrode resistances
b Continuity of all equipotential earth-and safety bonding conductors
b Inspection and functional testing of all MV components
b Insulation checks of MV equipment
b Dielectric strength test of transformer oil (and switchgear oil if appropriate), if
applicable
b Inspection and testing of the LV installation in the substation
b Checks on all interlocks (mechanical key and electrical) and on all automatic
sequences
b Checks on correct protective-relay operation and settings
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
It is also imperative to check that all equipment is provided, such that any properly
executed operation can be carried out in complete safety. On receipt of the certificate
of conformity (if required):
b Personnel of the power-supply authority will energize the MV equipment and check
for correct operation of the metering
b The installation contractor is responsible for testing and connection of the
LV installation
When finally the substation is operational:
b The substation and all equipment belongs to the consumer
b The power-supply authority has operational control over all MV switchgear in the
substation, e.g. the two incoming load-break switches and the transformer MV switch
(or CB) in the case of a RingMainUnit, together with all associated MV earthing switches
b The power-supply personnel has unrestricted access to the MV equipment
b The consumer has independent control of the MV switch (or CB) of the transformer(s)
only, the consumer is responsible for the maintenance of all substation equipment,
and must request the power-supply authority to isolate and earth the switchgear to
allow maintenance work to proceed. The power supplier must issue a signed permitto-work to the consumers maintenance personnel, together with keys of locked-off
isolators, etc. at which the isolation has been carried out.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
3 Protection aspect
The subject of protection in the electrical power industry is vast: it covers all aspects
of safety for personnel, and protection against damage or destruction of property,
plant, and equipment.
B7
These different aspects of protection can be broadly classified according to the
following objectives:
b Protection of personnel and animals against the dangers of overvoltages and
electric shock, fire, explosions, and toxic gases, etc.
b Protection of the plant, equipment and components of a power system against
the stresses of short-circuit faults, atmospheric surges (lightning) and power-system
instability (loss of synchronism) etc.
b Protection of personnel and plant from the dangers of incorrect power-system
operation, by the use of electrical and mechanical interlocking. All classes of
switchgear (including, for example, tap-position selector switches on transformers,
and so on...) have well-defined operating limits. This means that the order in which
the different kinds of switching device can be safely closed or opened is vitally
important. Interlocking keys and analogous electrical control circuits are frequently
used to ensure strict compliance with correct operating sequences.
It is beyond the scope of a guide to describe in full technical detail the numerous
schemes of protection available to power-systems engineers, but it is hoped that the
following sections will prove to be useful through a discussion of general principles.
While some of the protective devices mentioned are of universal application,
descriptions generally will be confined to those in common use on MV and
LV systems only, as defined in Sub-clause 1.1 of this Chapter.
3.1 Protection against electric shocks
Protective measures against electric shock are based on two common dangers:
b Contact with an active conductor, i.e. which is live with respect to earth in normal
circumstances. This is referred to as a “direct contact” hazard.
b Contact with a conductive part of an apparatus which is normally dead, but which
has become live due to insulation failure in the apparatus. This is referred to as an
“indirect contact” hazard.
It may be noted that a third type of shock hazard can exist in the proximity of MV or
LV (or mixed) earth electrodes which are passing earth-fault currents. This hazard
is due to potential gradients on the surface of the ground and is referred to as a
“step-voltage” hazard; shock current enters one foot and leaves by the other foot, and
is particular dangerous for four-legged animals. A variation of this danger, known as
a “touch voltage” hazard can occur, for instance, when an earthed metallic part is
situated in an area in which potential gradients exist.
Touching the part would cause current to pass through the hand and both feet.
Animals with a relatively long front-to-hind legs span are particularly sensitive to
step-voltage hazards and cattle have been killed by the potential gradients caused by
a low voltage (230/400 V) neutral earth electrode of insufficiently low resistance.
Potential-gradient problems of the kind mentioned above are not normally
encountered in electrical installations of buildings, providing that equipotential
conductors properly bond all exposed metal parts of equipment and all extraneous
metal (i.e. not part of an electrical apparatus or the installation - for example
structural steelwork, etc.) to the protective-earthing conductor.
Direct-contact protection or basic protection
The main form of protection against direct contact hazards is to contain all live parts
in housings of insulating material or in metallic earthed housings, by placing out of
reach (behind insulated barriers or at the top of poles) or by means of obstacles.
Where insulated live parts are housed in a metal envelope, for example transformers,
electric motors and many domestic appliances, the metal envelope is connected to
the installation protective earthing system.
For MV switchgear, the IEC standard 62271-200 (Prefabricated Metal Enclosed
switchgear and controlgear for voltages up to 52 kV) specifies a minimum Protection
Index (IP coding) of IP2X which ensures the direct-contact protection. Furthermore,
the metallic enclosure has to demonstrate an electrical continuity, then establishing
a good segregation between inside and ouside of the enclosure. Proper grounding of
the enclosure further participates to the electrical protection of the operators under
normal operating conditions.
For LV appliances this is achieved through the third pin of a 3-pin plug and socket.
Total or even partial failure of insulation to the metal, can raise the voltage of the
envelope to a dangerous level (depending on the ratio of the resistance of the leakage
path through the insulation, to the resistance from the metal envelope to earth).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Protection against electric shocks and
overvoltages is closely related to the
achievement of efficient (low resistance)
earthing and effective application of the
principles of equipotential environments.
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B8
Indirect-contact protection or fault protection
A person touching the metal envelope of an apparatus with a faulty insulation, as
described above, is said to be making an indirect contact.
An indirect contact is characterized by the fact that a current path to earth exists
(through the protective earthing (PE) conductor) in parallel with the shock current
through the person concerned.
Case of fault on L.V. system
Extensive tests have shown that, providing the potential of the metal envelope is not
greater than 50 V with respect to earth, or to any conductive material within reaching
distance, no danger exists.
Indirect-contact hazard in the case of a MV fault
If the insulation failure in an apparatus is between a MV conductor and the metal
envelope, it is not generally possible to limit the rise of voltage of the envelope to
50 V or less, simply by reducing the earthing resistance to a low value. The solution
in this case is to create an equipotential situation, as described in Sub-clause 1.1
“Earthing systems”.
Earth connection resistance
Insulation faults affecting the MV substation’s equipment (internal) or resulting from
atmospheric overvoltages (external) may generate earth currents capable of causing
physical injury or damage to equipment.
Preventive measures essentially consist of:
b Interconnecting all substation frames and connecting them to the earth bar
b Minimising earth resistance
3.2 Protection of transformer and circuits
General
The electrical equipment and circuits in a substation must be protected in order
to avoid or to control damage due to abnormal currents and/or voltages. All
equipment normally used in power system installations have standardized short-time
withstand ratings for overcurrent and overvoltage. The role of protective scheme is
to ensure that this withstand limits can never be exceeded. In general, this means
that fault conditions must be cleared as fast as possible without missing to ensure
coordination between protective devices upstream and downstream the equipement
to be protected. This means, when there is a fault in a network, generally several
protective devices see the fault at the same time but only one must act.
These devices may be:
b Fuses which clear the faulty circuit directly or together with a mechanical tripping
attachment, which opens an associated three-phase load-break switch
b Relays which act indirectly on the circuit-breaker coil
Transformer protection
Stresses due to the supply network
Some voltage surges can occur on the network such as :
b Atmospheric voltage surges
Atmospheric voltage surges are caused by a stroke of lightning falling on or near an
overhead line.
b Operating voltage surges
A sudden change in the established operating conditions in an electrical network
causes transient phenomena to occur. This is generally a high frequency or damped
oscillation voltage surge wave.
For both voltage surges, the overvoltage protection device generally used is a
varistor (Zinc Oxide).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In most cases, voltage surges protection has no action on switchgear.
Stresses due to the load
Overloading is frequently due to the coincidental demand of a number of small
loads, or to an increase in the apparent power (kVA) demand of the installation,
due to expansion in a factory, with consequent building extensions, and so on. Load
increases raise the temperature of the wirings and of the insulation material. As
a result, temperature increases involve a reduction of the equipment working life.
Overload protection devices can be located on primary or secondary side of the
transformer.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection aspect
The protection against overloading of a transformer is now provided by a digital relay
which acts to trip the circuit-breaker on the secondary side of the transformer. Such
relay, generally called thermal overload relay, artificially simulates the temperature,
taking into account the time constant of the transformer. Some of them are able to
take into account the effect of harmonic currents due to non linear loads (rectifiers,
computer equipment, variable speed drives…).This type of relay is also able to
predict the time before overload tripping and the waiting time after tripping. So, this
information is very helpful to control load shedding operation.
B9
In addition, larger oil-immersed transformers frequently have thermostats with two
settings, one for alarm purposes and the other for tripping.
Dry-type transformers use heat sensors embedded in the hottest part of the windings
insulation for alarm and tripping.
Internal faults
The protection of transformers by transformer-mounted devices, against the effects
of internal faults, is provided on transformers which are fitted with airbreathing
conservator tanks by the classical Buchholz mechanical relay (see Fig. B4). These
relays can detect a slow accumulation of gases which results from the arcing of
incipient faults in the winding insulation or from the ingress of air due to an oil leak.
This first level of detection generally gives an alarm, but if the condition deteriorates
further, a second level of detection will trip the upstream circuit-breaker.
Fig. B4 : Transformer with conservator tank
An oil-surge detection feature of the Buchholz relay will trip the upstream circuitbreaker “instantaneously” if a surge of oil occurs in the pipe connecting the main tank
with the conservator tank.
Such a surge can only occur due to the displacement of oil caused by a rapidly
formed bubble of gas, generated by an arc of short-circuit current in the oil.
By specially designing the cooling-oil radiator elements to perform a concerting action,
“totally filled” types of transformer as large as 10 MVA are now currently available.
Expansion of the oil is accommodated without an excessive rise in pressure by the
“bellows” effect of the radiator elements. A full description of these transformers is
given in Sub-clause 4.4 (see Fig. B5).
Evidently the Buchholz devices mentioned above cannot be applied to this design; a
modern counterpart has been developed however, which measures:
b The accumulation of gas
b Overpressure
b Overtemperature
The first two conditions trip the upstream circuit-breaker, and the third condition trips
the downstream circuit-breaker of the transformer.
Internal phase-to-phase short-circuit
Internal phase-to-phase short-circuit must be detected and cleared by:
b 3 fuses on the primary side of the tranformer or
b An overcurrent relay that trips a circuit-breaker upstream of the transformer
Fig. B5 : Totally filled transformer
HV
LV
1
1
2
2
3
3
Internal phase-to-earth short-circuit
This is the most common type of internal fault. It must be detected by an earth fault
relay. Earth fault current can be calculated with the sum of the 3 primary phase
currents (if 3 current transformers are used) or by a specific core current transformer.
If a great sensitivity is needed, specific core current transformer will be prefered. In
such a case, a two current transformers set is sufficient (see Fig. B6).
Protection of circuits
N
E/F relay
Fig. B6 : Protection against earth fault on the MV winding
Discrimination between the protective devices upstream and
downstream of the transformer
The consumer-type substation with LV metering requires discriminative operation
between the MV fuses or MV circuit-breaker and the LV circuit-breaker or fuses.
The rating of the MV fuses will be chosen according to the characteristics of the
transformer.
The tripping characteristics of the LV circuit-breaker must be such that, for an
overload or short-circuit condition downstream of its location, the breaker will trip
sufficiently quickly to ensure that the MV fuses or the MV circuit-breaker will not be
adversely affected by the passage of overcurrent through them.
The tripping performance curves for MV fuses or MV circuit-breaker and LV circuitbreakers are given by graphs of time-to-operate against current passing through
them. Both curves have the general inverse-time/current form (with an abrupt
discontinuity in the CB curve at the current value above which “instantaneous”
tripping occurs).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Overcurrent relay
The protection of the circuits downstream of the transformer must comply with the
IEC 60364 requirements.
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B10
These curves are shown typically in Figure B7.
Time
Minimum pre-arcing
time of MV fuse
B/A u 1.35 at any
moment in time
D/C u 2 at any
current value
D
Circuit breaker
tripping
characteristic
C
Current
A
B
Fig. B7 : Discrimination between MV fuse operation and LV
circuit-breaker tripping, for transformer protection
U1
MV
LV
Fig. B8 : MV fuse and LV circuit-breaker configuration
U2
b In order to achieve discrimination (see Fig. B8):
All parts of the fuse or MV circuit-breaker curve must be above and to the right of the
CB curve.
b In order to leave the fuses unaffected (i.e. undamaged):
All parts of the minimum pre-arcing fuse curve must be located to the right of the CB
curve by a factor of 1.35 or more (e.g. where, at time T, the CB curve passes through
a point corresponding to 100 A, the fuse curve at the same time T must pass through
a point corresponding to 135 A, or more, and so on...) and, all parts of the fuse curve
must be above the CB curve by a factor of 2 or more (e.g. where, at a current level I
the CB curve passes through a point corresponding to 1.5 seconds, the fuse curve
at the same current level I must pass through a point corresponding to 3 seconds, or
more, etc.).
The factors 1.35 and 2 are based on standard maximum manufacturing tolerances
for MV fuses and LV circuit-breakers.
In order to compare the two curves, the MV currents must be converted to the
equivalent LV currents, or vice-versa.
Where a LV fuse-switch is used, similar separation of the characteristic curves of the
MV and LV fuses must be respected.
b In order to leave the MV circuit-breaker protection untripped:
All parts of the minimum MV circuit-breaker curve must be located to the right of
the LV CB curve by a factor of 1.35 or more (e.g. where, at time T, the LV CB curve
passes through a point corresponding to 100 A, the MV CB curve at the same time
T must pass through a point corresponding to 135 A, or more, and so on...) and, all
parts of the MV CB curve must be above the LV CB curve (time of LV CB curve must
be less or equal than MV CB curves minus 0.3 s)
The factors 1.35 and 0.3 s are based on standard maximum manufacturing
tolerances for MV current transformers, MV protection relay and LV circuit-breakers.
In order to compare the two curves, the MV currents must be converted to the
equivalent LV currents, or vice-versa.
Choice of protective device on the primary side of the
transformer
As explained before, for low reference current, the protection may be by fuses or by
circuit-breaker.
When the reference current is high, the protection will be achieved by circuit-breaker.
Protection by circuit-breaker provides a more sensitive transformer protection
compared with fuses. The implementation of additional protections (earth fault
protection, thermal overload protection) is easier with circuit-breakers.
3.3 Interlocks and conditioned operations
Mechanical and electrical interlocks are included on mechanisms and in the control
circuits of apparatus installed in substations, as a measure of protection against an
incorrect sequence of manœuvres by operating personnel.
Mechanical protection between functions located on separate equipment
(e.g. switchboard and transformer) is provided by key-transfer interlocking.
An interlocking scheme is intended to prevent any abnormal operational manœuvre.
Some of such operations would expose operating personnel to danger, some others
would only lead to an electrical incident.
Basic interlocking
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Basic interlocking functions can be introduced in one given functionnal unit; some
of these functions are made mandatory by the IEC 62271-200, for metal-enclosed
MV switchgear, but some others are the result of a choice from the user.
Considering access to a MV panel, it requires a certain number of operations
which shall be carried out in a pre-determined order. It is necessary to carry out
operations in the reverse order to restore the system to its former condition. Either
proper procedures, or dedicated interlocks, can ensure that the required operations
are performed in the right sequence. Then such accessible compartment will be
classified as “accessible and interlocked” or “accessible by procedure”. Even for
users with proper rigorous procedures, use of interlocks can provide a further help
for safety of the operators.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection aspect
Key interlocking
B11
Beyond the interlocks available within a given functionnal unit (see also 4.2), the
most widely-used form of locking/interlocking depends on the principle of key transfer.
The principle is based on the possibility of freeing or trapping one or several keys,
according to whether or not the required conditions are satisfied.
These conditions can be combined in unique and obligatory sequences, thereby
guaranteeing the safety of personnel and installation by the avoidance of an incorrect
operational procedure.
Non-observance of the correct sequence of operations in either case may have
extremely serious consequences for the operating personnel, as well as for the
equipment concerned.
Note: It is important to provide for a scheme of interlocking in the basic design stage
of planning a MV/LV substation. In this way, the apparatuses concerned will be
equipped during manufacture in a coherent manner, with assured compatibility of
keys and locking devices.
Service continuity
For a given MV switchboard, the definition of the accessible compartments as well
as their access conditions provide the basis of the “Loss of Service Continuity”
classification defined in the standard IEC 62271-200. Use of interlocks or only proper
procedure does not have any influence on the service continuity. Only the request for
accessing a given part of the switchboard, under normal operation conditions, results
in limiting conditions which can be more or less severe regarding the continuity of the
electrical distribution process.
Interlocks in substations
In a MV/LV distribution substation which includes:
b A single incoming MV panel or two incoming panels (from parallel feeders) or two
incoming/outgoing ring-main panels
b A transformer switchgear-and-protection panel, which can include a load-break/
disconnecting switch with MV fuses and an earthing switch, or a circuit-breaker and
line disconnecting switch together with an earthing switch
b A transformer compartment
Interlocks allow manœuvres and access to different panels in the following conditions:
Basic interlocks, embedded in single functionnal units
b Operation of the load-break/isolating switch
v If the panel door is closed and the associated earthing switch is open
b Operation of the line-disconnecting switch of the transformer switchgear - and
- protection panel
v If the door of the panel is closed, and
v If the circuit-breaker is open, and the earthing switch(es) is (are) open
b Closure of an earthing switch
v If the associated isolating switch(es) is (are) open(1)
b Access to an accessible compartment of each panel, if interlocks have been
specified
v If the isolating switch for the compartment is open and the earthing switch(es) for
the compartment is (are) closed
b Closure of the door of each accessible compartment, if interlocks have been
specified
v If the earthing switch(es) for the compartment is (are) closed
Practical example
In a consumer-type substation with LV metering, the interlocking scheme most
commonly used is MV/LV/TR (high voltage/ low voltage/transformer).
(1) If the earthing switch is on an incoming circuit, the
associated isolating switches are those at both ends of the
circuit, and these should be suitably interlocked. In such
situation, the interlocking function becomes a multi-units key
interlock.
The aim of the interlocking is:
b To prevent access to the transformer compartment if the earthing switch has not
been previously closed
b To prevent the closure of the earthing switch in a transformer switchgear-andprotection panel, if the LV circuit-breaker of the transformer has not been previously
locked “open” or “withdrawn”
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Functional interlocks involving several functional units or separate equipment
b Access to the terminals of a MV/LV transformer
v If the tee-off functional unit has its switch open and its earthing switch closed.
According to the possibility of back-feed from the LV side, a condition on the LV main
breaker can be necessary.
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
3 Protection aspect
B12
Access to the MV or LV terminals of a transformer, (protected upstream by a
MV switchgear-and-protection panel, containing a MV load-break / isolating
switch, MV fuses, and a MV earthing switch) must comply with the strict procedure
described below, and is illustrated by the diagrams of Figure B9.
Note: The transformer in this example is provided with plug-in type MV terminal
connectors which can only be removed by unlocking a retaining device common to
all three phase connectors(1).
The MV load-break / disconnecting switch is mechanically linked with the
MV earthing switch such that only one of the switches can be closed, i.e. closure
of one switch automatically locks the closure of the other.
Procedure for the isolation and earthing of the power transformer, and removal
of the MV plug-type shrouded terminal connections (or protective cover)
S
Initial conditions
b MV load-break/disconnection switch and LV circuit-breaker are closed
b MV earthing switch locked in the open position by key “O”
b Key “O” is trapped in the LV circuit-breaker as long as that circuit-breaker is closed
S
Step 1
b Open LV CB and lock it open with key “O”
b Key “O” is then released
MV switch and LV CB closed
Step 2
b Open the MV switch
b Check that the “voltage presence” indicators extinguish when the MV switch is
opened
O
S
O
Step 3
b Unlock the MV earthing switch with key “O” and close the earthing switch
b Key “O” is now trapped
Step 4
The access panel to the MV fuses can now be removed (i.e. is released by closure of
the MV earthing switch). Key “S” is located in this panel, and is trapped when the MV
switch is closed
b Turn key “S” to lock the MV switch in the open position
b Key “S” is now released
S
MV fuses accessible
S
Step 5
Key “S” allows removal of the common locking device of the plug-type MV terminal
connectors on the transformer or of the common protective cover over the terminals,
as the case may be.
In either case, exposure of one or more terminals will trap key “S” in the interlock.
O
The result of the foregoing procedure is that:
b The MV switch is locked in the open position by key “S”.
Key “S” is trapped at the transformer terminals interlock as long as the terminals are
exposed.
b The MV earthing switch is in the closed position but not locked, i.e. may be opened
or closed. When carrying out maintenance work, a padlock is generally used to lock
the earthing switch in the closed position, the key of the padlock being held by the
engineer supervizing the work.
b The LV CB is locked open by key “O”, which is trapped by the closed MV earthing
switch. The transformer is therefore safely isolated and earthed.
S
O
Transformer MV terminals accessible
Legend
Key absent
Key free
Key trapped
Panel or door
It may be noted that the upstream terminal of the load-break disconnecting switch
may remain live in the procedure described as the terminals in question are located
in a separate non accessible compartment in the particular switchgear under
discussion. Any other technical solution with exposed terminals in the accessed
compartment would need further de-energisation and interlocks.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B9 : Example of MV/LV/TR interlocking
(1) Or may be provided with a common protective cover over
the three terminals.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
4 The consumer substation
with LV metering
4.1 Functions of the substation with LV metering
B13
A consumer substation with LV metering is an electrical installation connected to a
utility supply system at a nominal voltage of 1 kV - 35 kV, and includes a single
MV/LV transformer generally not exceeding 1,250 kVA.
Functions
The substation
All component parts of the substation are located in one room, either in an existing
building, or in the form of a prefabricated housing exterior to the building.
Connection to the MV network
Connection at MV can be:
b Either by a single service cable or overhead line, or
b Via two mechanically interlocked load-break switches with two service cables from
duplicate supply feeders, or
b Via two load-break switches of a ring-main unit
The transformer
Since the use of PCB(1)-filled transformers is prohibited in most countries,
the preferred available technologies are:
b Oil-immersed transformers for substations located outside premises
b Dry-type, vacuum-cast-resin transformers for locations inside premises, e.g.
multistoreyed buildings, buildings receiving the public, and so on...
Metering
Metering at low voltage allows the use of small metering transformers at modest cost.
Most tariff structures take account of MV/LV transformer losses.
LV installation circuits
A low-voltage circuit-breaker, suitable for isolation duty and locking off facilities, to:
b Supply a distribution board
b Protect the transformer against overloading and the downstream circuits against
short-circuit faults.
Simplified electrical network diagram
The diagram on the following page (Figure B10) shows:
b Methods for connecting to the network (4 options):
v Spur network or single-line service
v Provisional network (can be transformed into a loop)
v Parallel feeders service
v Loop or ring-main service
b MV protection and MV/LV transformation methods
b LV metering and LV general isolation methods
b LV protection and distribution methods
b Zones accessible to different parties
4.2 Choosing MV equipment
Standards and specifications
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B11 : SM6 modular unit
Switchgear and equipment shall conform to the following international standards:
IEC 62271-1, 62271-200, 60265-1, 62271-102, 62271-100, 62271-105
Local regulations may also demand conformance to national standards. These
include:
b France: UTE
b United Kingdom: BS
b Germany: VDE
b USA: ANSI
(1) Polychlorinated biphenyl
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B14
Power supply
system
Service
connection
MV protection and
MV/LV transformation
Supplier/consumer
interface
LV metering
and isolation
Transformer
LV terminals
LV distribution
and protection
Downstream terminals
of LV isolator
Protection
Single-line service
Protection
Permitted if only one
transformer and rated power
low enough to accomodate
the limitations of fuses
Single-line service
(equipped for extension
to form a ring main)
Duplicatesupply
service
Protection
+
Auto-changeover
switch
Ring main
service
Protection
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Permitted
Fig. B10 : Consumer substation with LV metering
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Automatic
LV standby
source
4 The consumer substation
with LV metering
Choosing types of equipment
B15
Substations can be implemented in line with local standards and practices using
equipment such as:
b Modular units to support all types of layout and any subsequent expansion work
(whilst ensuring there is sufficient space)
b Compact arrangements based on the ring-main unit where the supply is provided
via a loop (single assembly comprising 3 functions). These are particularly suitable
where:
v Climatic conditions and/or pollution are very bad (integrated insulation)
v There is not enough space for a modular solution
Compartmentalised modular units in metallic enclosures
IEC 62271-200 standard
The IEC 62271-200 standard specifies «AC metal-enclosed switchgear and
controlgear for rated voltages above 1 kV and up to and including 52 kV».
The main precepts of the standard relate to:
b Switchgear types:
v AIS (Air Insulated Switchgear)
v GIS (Gas Insulated Switchgear)
b Functional units: «a switchgear component contained in a metallic enclosure and
incorporating all the main and auxiliary circuit equipment required to perform a single
function» - usually a modular unit
b Compartments: «a switchgear component contained in a closed metallic enclosure
(apart from the openings required for interconnection, control or ventilation)». The
manufacturer defines the content (e.g. busbar, cables, switchgear, etc.) and the
number of compartments able to house the following types of switchgear:
v Fixed
v Removable
b Accessibility of individual compartments:
v Controlled by interlocking or in accordance with procedures; for compartments
which can be opened during normal operation
v Using tools; for compartments which should not be opened during normal
operation
v Zero; for compartments which must not be opened
b The LSC (Loss of Service Continuity) defining the extent to which other
compartments can remain energised when one compartment is open
v LSC1, when opening a compartment requires the other functional units to be deenergised
v LSC2 A, when the other functional units can remain energised
v LSC2 B, when the other functional units and all the cable compartments can
remain energised
v The partition class between energised components and an open compartment,
based on the type of partition: «a switchgear component contained in a metallic
enclosure and separating one compartment from another»:
v PM: metallic partitions
v PI: insulating partitions
4.3 Choice of MV switchgear panel for a transformer
circuit
Seven parameters influence the optimum choice:
b The primary current of the transformer
b The insulating medium of the transformer
b The position of the substation with respect to the load centre
b The kVA rating of the transformer
b The distance from switchgear to the transformer
b The use of separate protection relays (as opposed to direct-acting trip coils).
Note: The fuses used in the load-break/switch fuses combination have striker-pins
which ensure tripping of the 3-pole switch on the operation of one (or more) fuse(s).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Three types of MV switchgear panel are generally available:
b Load-break switch and separate MV fuses in the panel
b Load-break switch/MV fuses combination
b Circuit-breaker
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B16
4.4 Choice of MV/LV transformer
Characteristic parameters of a transformer
A transformer is characterized in part by its electrical parameters, but also by its
technology and its conditions of use.
Electrical characteristics
b Rated power (Pn): the conventional apparent-power in kVA on which other designparameter values and the construction of the transformer are based. Manufacturing
tests and guarantees are referred to this rating
b Frequency: for power distribution systems of the kind discussed in this guide, the
frequency will be 50 Hz or 60 Hz
b Rated primary and secondary voltages: For a primary winding capable of operating at
more than one voltage level, a kVA rating corresponding to each level must be given.
The secondary rated voltage is its open circuit value
b Rated insulation levels are given by overvoltage-withstand test values at power
frequency, and by high voltage impulse tests values which simulate lightning
discharges. At the voltage levels discussed in this guide, overvoltages caused by
MV switching operations are generally less severe than those due to lightning, so
that no separate tests for switching-surge withstand capability are made
b Off-circuit tap-selector switch generally allows a choice of up to ± 2.5% and ± 5%
level about the rated voltage of the highest voltage winding. The transformer must be
de-energized before this switch is operated
b Winding configurations are indicated in diagrammatic form by standard symbols for
star, delta and inter-connected-star windings; (and combinations of these for special
duty, e.g. six-or twelve-phase rectifier transformers, etc.) and in an IEC-recommended
alphanumeric code. This code is read from left-to-right, the first letter refers to the
highest voltage winding, the second letter to the next highest, and so on:
v Capital letters refer to the highest voltage winding
D = delta
Y = star
Z = interconnected-star (or zigzag)
N = neutral connection brought out to a terminal
v Lower-case letters are used for tertiary and secondary windings
d = delta
y = star
z = interconnected-star (or zigzag)
n = neutral connection brought out to a terminal
v A number from 0 to 11, corresponding to those, on a clock dial (“0” is used instead
of “12”) follows any pair of letters to indicate the phase change (if any) which occurs
during the transformation.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A very common winding configuration used for distribution transformers is that
of a Dyn 11 transformer, which has a delta MV winding with a star-connected
secondary winding the neutral point of which is brought out to a terminal. The phase
change through the transformer is +30 degrees, i.e. phase 1 secondary voltage is
at “11 o’clock” when phase 1 of the primary voltage is at “12 o’clock”, as shown in
Figure B31 page B34. All combinations of delta, star and zigzag windings produce a
phase change which (if not zero) is either 30 degrees or a multiple of 30 degrees.
IEC 60076-4 describes the “clock code” in detail.
Characteristics related to the technology and utilization of the transformer
This list is not exhaustive:
b Choice of technology
The insulating medium is:
v Liquid (mineral oil) or
v Solid (epoxy resin and air)
b For indoor or outdoor installation
b Altitude (<= 1,000 m is standard)
b Temperature (IEC 60076-2)
v Maximum ambient air: 40 °C
v Daily maximum average ambient air: 30 °C
v Annual maximum average ambient air: 20 °C
For non-standard operating conditions, refer to “Influence of the Ambient temperature
and altitude on the rated current” on page B7.
Description of insulation techniques
There are two basic classes of distribution transformer presently available:
b Dry type (cast in resin)
b Liquid filled (oil-immersed)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 The consumer substation
with LV metering
Dry type transformers
The windings of these transformers are insulated by resin between turns and by
resin and air to other windings and to frame. The resin is usually cast under vacuum
process (which is patented by major manufacturers).
B17
It is recommended that the transformer be chosen according to the IEC 60076-11,
as follows:
b Environment class E2 (frequent condensation and/or high level of pollution)
b Climatic conditions class B2 (utilization, transport and stockage down to -25 °C)
b Fire resistance (transformers exposed to fire risk with low flammability and self
extinguishing in a given time)
The following description refers to the process developed by a leading European
manufacturer in this field.
The encapsulation of a winding uses three components:
b Epoxy-resin based on biphenol A with a viscosity that ensures complete
impregnation of the windings
b Anhydride hardener modified to introduce a degree of resilience in the moulding,
essential to avoid the development of cracks during the temperature cycles occurring
in normal operation
b Pulverulent additive composed of trihydrated alumina Al (OH)3 and silica which
enhances its mechanical and thermal properties, as well as giving exceptional
intrinsic qualities to the insulation in the presence of heat.
This three-component system of encapsulation gives Class F insulation ( = 100 K)
with excellent fire-resisting qualities and immediate self-extinction. These
transformers are therefore classified as nonflammable.
Fig. B12 : Dry-type transformer
The mouldings of the windings contain no halogen compounds (chlorine, bromine,
etc.) or other compounds capable of producing corrosive or toxic pollutants, thereby
guaranteeing a high degree of safety to personnel in emergency situations, notably
in the event of a fire.
It also performs exceptionally well in hostile industrial atmospheres of dust, humidity,
etc. (see Fig. B12).
Liquid-filled transformers
The most common insulating/cooling liquid used in transformers is mineral oil.
Mineral oils are specified in IEC 60296. Being flammable, safety measures are
obligatory in many countries, especially for indoor substations. The DGPT unit
(Detection of Gas, Pressure and Temperature) ensures the protection of oil-filled
transformers. In the event of an anomaly, the DGPT causes the MV supply to the
transformer to be cut off very rapidly, before the situation becomes dangerous.
Mineral oil is bio-degradable and does not contain PCB (polychlorinated biphenyl),
which was the reason for banning askerel, i.e. Pyralène, Pyrolio, Pyroline...
On request, mineral oil can be replaced by an alternative insulating liquid, by
adapting the transformer, as required, and taking appropriate additional precautions
if necessary.
Fig. B14 : Air-breathing conservator-type tank at atmosphere
pressure
There are two ways in which this pressure limitation is commonly achieved:
b Hermetically-sealed totally-filled tank (up to 10 MVA at the present time)
Developed by a leading French manufacturer in 1963, this method was adopted by the
national utility in 1972, and is now in world-wide service (see Fig. B13).
Expansion of the liquid is compensated by the elastic deformation of the oil-cooling
passages attached to the tank.
The “total-fill” technique has many important advantages over other methods:
v Oxydation of the dielectric liquid (with atmospheric oxygen) is entirely precluded
v No need for an air-drying device, and so no consequent maintenance (inspection
and changing of saturated dessicant)
v No need for dielectric-strength test of the liquid for at least 10 years
v Simplified protection against internal faults by means of a DGPT device is possible
v Simplicity of installation: lighter and lower profile (than tanks with a conservator)
and access to the MV and LV terminals is unobstructed
v Immediate detection of (even small) oil leaks; water cannot enter the tank
b Air-breathing conservator-type tank at atmospheric pressure
Expansion of the insulating liquid is taken up by a change in the level of liquid in
an expansion (conservator) tank, mounted above the transformer main tank, as
shown in Figure B14. The space above the liquid in the conservator may be filled
with air which is drawn in when the level of liquid falls, and is partially expelled
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The insulating fluid also acts as a cooling medium; it expands as the load and/or
the ambient temperature increases, so that all liquid-filled transformers must be
designed to accommodate the extra volume of liquid without the pressure in the tank
becoming excessive.
Fig. B13 : Hermetically-sealed totally-filled tank
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B18
when the level rises. When the air is drawn in from the surrounding atmosphere it is
admitted through an oil seal, before passing through a dessicating device (generally
containing silica-gel crystals) before entering the conservator. In some designs of
larger transformers the space above the oil is occupied by an impermeable air bag
so that the insulation liquid is never in contact with the atmosphere. The air enters
and exits from the deformable bag through an oil seal and dessicator, as previously
described. A conservator expansion tank is obligatory for transformers rated above
10 MVA (which is presently the upper limit for “total-fill” type transformers).
Choice of technology
As discussed above, the choice of transformer is between liquid-filled or dry type.
For ratings up to 10 MVA, totally-filled units are available as an alternative to
conservator-type transformers.
A choice depends on a number of considerations, including:
b Safety of persons in proximity to the transformer. Local regulations and official
recommendations may have to be respected
b Economic considerations, taking account of the relative advantages of each technique
The regulations affecting the choice are:
b Dry-type transformer:
v In some countries a dry-type transformer is obligatory in high apartment blocks
v Dry-type transformers impose no constraints in other situations
b Transformers with liquid insulation:
v This type of transformer is generally forbidden in high apartment blocks
v For different kinds of insulation liquids, installation restrictions, or minimum
protection against fire risk, vary according to the class of insulation used
v Some countries in which the use of liquid dielectrics is highly developed, classify
the several categories of liquid according to their fire performance. This latter is
assessed according to two criteria: the flash-point temperature, and the minimum
calorific power. The principal categories are shown in Figure B15 in which a
classification code is used for convenience.
Code
Dielectric fluid
O1
K1
K2
K3
L3
Mineral oil
High-density hydrocarbons
Esters
Silicones
Insulating halogen liquids
Flash-point
(°C)
< 300
> 300
> 300
> 300
-
Minimum calorific power
(MJ/kg)
48
34 - 37
27 - 28
12
Fig. B15 : Categories of dielectric fluids
The determination of optimal power
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Oversizing a transformer
It results in:
b Excessive investment and unecessarily high no-load losses, but
b Lower on-load losses
Undersizing a transformer
It causes:
b A reduced efficiency when fully loaded, (the highest efficiency is attained in the
range 50% - 70% full load) so that the optimum loading is not achieved
b On long-term overload, serious consequences for
v The transformer, owing to the premature ageing of the windings insulation, and in
extreme cases, resulting in failure of insulation and loss of the transformer
v The installation, if overheating of the transformer causes protective relays to trip
the controlling circuit-breaker.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 The consumer substation
with LV metering
Definition of optimal power
In order to select an optimal power (kVA) rating for a transformer, the following
factors must be taken into account:
b List the power of installed power-consuming equipment as described in Chapter A
b Decide the utilization (or demand) factor for each individual item of load
b Determine the load cycle of the installation, noting the duration of loads and overloads
b Arrange for power-factor correction, if justified, in order to:
v Reduce cost penalties in tariffs based, in part, on maximum kVA demand
v Reduce the value of declared load (P(kVA) = P (kW)/cos )
b Select, among the range of standard transformer ratings available, taking into
account all possible future extensions to the installation.
It is important to ensure that cooling arrangements for the transformer are adequate.
B19
4.5 Instructions for use of MV equipment
The purpose of this chapter is to provide general guidelines on how to avoid
or greatly reduce MV equipment degradation on sites exposed to humidity and
pollution.
Normal service conditions for indoor MV equipment
All MV equipments comply with specific standards and with the IEC 62271-1
standard “Common specifications for high-voltage switchgear and controlgear”,
which defines the normal conditions for the installation and use of such equipment.
For instance, regarding humidity, the standard mentions:
The conditions of humidity are as follows:
b The average value of the relative humidity, measured over a period of 24 h does
not exceed 90%;
b The average value of the water vapour pressure, over a period of 24 h does not
exceed 2.2 kPa;
b The average value of the relative humidity, over a period of one month does not
exceed 90%;
b The average value of water vapour pressure, over a period of one month does not
exceed 1.8 kPa;
Under these conditions, condensation may occasionally occur.
NOTE 1: Condensation can be expected where sudden temperature changes occur
in period of high humidity.
NOTE 2: To withstand the effects of high humidity and condensation, such as a
breakdown of insulation or corrosion of metallic parts, switchgear designed for such
conditions and tested accordingly shoul be used.
NOTE 3: Condensation may be prevented by special design of the building or
housing, by suitable ventilation and heating of the station or by use of dehumifying
equipment.
As indicated in the standard, condensation may occasionally occur even under
normal conditions. The standard goes on to indicate special measures concerning
the substation premises that can be implemented to prevent condensation.
Use under severe conditions
Under certain severe conditions concerning humidity and pollution, largely beyond
the normal conditions of use mentioned above, correctly designed electrical
equipment can be subject to damage by rapid corrosion of metal parts and surface
degradation of insulating parts.
Remedial measures for condensation problems
b Carefully design or adapt substation ventilation.
b Avoid temperature variations.
b Eliminate sources of humidity in the substation environment.
b Install an air conditioning system.
b Make sure cabling is in accordance with applicable rules.
Remedial measures for pollution problems
b Equip substation ventilation openings with chevron-type baffles to reduce entry
of dust and pollution.
b Keep substation ventilation to the minimum required for evacuation of transformer
heat to reduce entry of pollution and dust.
b Use MV cubicles with a sufficiently high degree of protection (IP).
b Use air conditioning systems with filters to restrict entry of pollution and dust.
b Regularly clean all traces of pollution from metal and insulating parts.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B15 : SM6 metal enclosed indoor MV eqpuipment
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B20
Ventilation
Substation ventilation is generally required to dissipate the heat produced by
transformers and to allow drying after particularly wet or humid periods.
However, a number of studies have shown that excessive ventilation can drastically
increase condensation.
Ventilation should therefore be kept to the minimum level required.
Furthermore, ventilation should never generate sudden temperature variations that
can cause the dew point to be reached.
For this reason:
Natural ventilation should be used whenever possible. If forced ventilation is
necessary, the fans should operate continuously to avoid temperature fluctuations.
Guidelines for sizing the air entry and exit openings of substations are presented
hereafter.
Calculation methods
A number of calculation methods are available to estimate the required size of
substation ventilation openings, either for the design of new substations or the
adaptation of existing substations for which condensation problems have occurred.
The basic method is based on transformer dissipation.
The required ventilation opening surface areas S and S’ can be estimated using the
following formulas:
S
1.8 x 10-4 P
H
and S' 1.10 x S
where:
S = Lower (air entry) ventilation opening area [m²] (grid surface deducted)
S’= Upper (air exit) ventilation opening area [m²] (grid surface deducted)
P = Total dissipated power [W]
P is the sum of the power dissipated by:
b The transformer (dissipation at no load and due to load)
b The LV switchgear
b The MV switchgear
H = Height between ventilation opening mid-points [m]
See Fig. B16
Note:
This formula is valid for a yearly average temperature of 20 °C and a maximum
altitude of 1,000 m.
It must be noted that these formulae are able to determine only one order of
magnitude of the sections S and S', which are qualified as thermal section, i.e. fully
open and just necessary to evacuate the thermal energy generated inside the MV/LV
substation.
The pratical sections are of course larger according ot the adopted technological
solution.
Indeed, the real air flow is strongly dependant:
b on the openings shape and solutions adopted to ensure the cubicle protection
index (IP): metal grid, stamped holes, chevron louvers,...
b on internal components size and their position compared to the openings:
transformer and/or retention oil box position and dimensions, flow channel between
the components, ...
b and on some physical and environmental parameters: outside ambient
temperature, altitude, magnitude of the resulting temperature rise.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The understanding and the optimization of the attached physical phenomena are
subject to precise flow studies, based on the fluid dynamics laws, and realized with
specific analytic software.
Example:
Transformer dissipation = 7,970 W
LV switchgear dissipation = 750 W
MV switchgear dissipation = 300 W
The height between ventilation opening mid-points is 1.5 m.
Calculation:
Dissipated Power P = 7,970 + 750 + 300 = 9,020 W
S
1.8 x 10-4 P
1.5
1.32 m2 and S' 1.1 x 1.32 1.46 m2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 The consumer substation
with LV metering
Ventilation opening locations
S'
200 mm
mini
B21
To favour evacuation of the heat produced by the transformer via natural convection,
ventilation openings should be located at the top and bottom of the wall near the
transformer. The heat dissipated by the MV switchboard is negligible.
To avoid condensation problems, the substation ventilation openings should be
located as far as possible from the switchboard (see Fig. B 17).
Type of ventilation openings
H
To reduce the entry of dust, pollution, mist, etc., the substation ventilation openings
should be equipped with chevron-blade baffles.
Always make sure the baffles are oriented in the right direction (see Fig. B18).
Temperature variations inside cubicles
S
Fig. B16 : Natural ventilation
To reduce temperature variations, always install anti-condensation heaters inside
MV cubicles if the average relative humidity can remain high over a long period of
time. The heaters must operate continuously, 24 hours a day all year long.
Never connect them to a temperature control or regulation system as this could lead
to temperature variations and condensation as well as a shorter service life for the
heating elements. Make sure the heaters offer an adequate service life (standard
versions are generally sufficient).
Temperature variations inside the substation
The following measures can be taken to reduce temperature variations inside the
substation:
b Improve the thermal insulation of the substation to reduce the effects of outdoor
temperature variations on the temperature inside the substation.
b Avoid substation heating if possible. If heating is required, make sure the regulation
system and/or thermostat are sufficiently accurate and designed to avoid excessive
temperature swings (e.g. no greater than 1 °C).
If a sufficiently accurate temperature regulation system is not available, leave the
heating on continuously, 24 hours a day all year long.
b Eliminate cold air drafts from cable trenches under cubicles or from openings in the
substation (under doors, roof joints, etc.).
Substation environment and humidity
Fig. B17 : Ventilation opening locations
Various factors outside the substation can affect the humidity inside.
b Plants
Avoid excessive plant growth around the substation.
b Substation waterproofing
The substation roof must not leak. Avoid flat roofs for which
waterproofing is difficult to implement and maintain.
b Humidity from cable trenches
Make sure cable trenches are dry under all conditions.
A partial solution is to add sand to the bottom of the cable trench.
Pollution protection and cleaning
Excessive pollution favours leakage current, tracking and flashover on insulators.
To prevent MV equipment degradation by pollution, it is possible to either protect the
equipment against pollution or regularly clean the resulting contamination.
Protection
Indoor MV switchgear can be protected by enclosures providing a sufficiently high
degree of protection (IP).
Cleaning
If not fully protected, MV equipment must be cleaned regularly to prevent
degradation by contamination from pollution.
Cleaning is a critical process. The use of unsuitable products can irreversibly
damage the equipment.
For cleaning procedures, please contact your Schneider Electric correspondent.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B18 : Chevron-blade baffles
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B22
A consumer substation with MV metering
is an electrical installation connected to a
utility supply system at a nominal voltage of
1 kV - 35 kV and generally includes a single
MV/LV transformer which exceeds 1,250 kVA,
or several smaller transformers.
The rated current of the MV switchgear does
not normally exceed 400 A.
5 The consumer substation
with MV metering
5.1 Functions of the substation with MV metering
Functions
The substation
According to the complexity of the installation and the manner in which the load is
divided, the substation:
b Might include one room containing the MV switchboard and metering panel(s),
together with the transformer(s) and low-voltage main distribution board(s),
b Or might supply one or more transformer rooms, which include local LV distribution
boards, supplied at MV from switchgear in a main substation, similar to that
described above.
These substations may be installed, either:
b Inside a building, or
b Outdoors in prefabricated housings.
Connection to the MV network
Connection at MV can be:
b Either by a single service cable or overhead line, or
b Via two mechanically interlocked load-break switches with two service cables from
duplicate supply feeders, or
b Via two load-break switches of a ring-main unit.
Metering
Before the installation project begins, the agreement of the power-supply utility
regarding metering arrangements must be obtained.
A metering panel will be incorporated in the MV switchboard. Voltage transformers
and current transformers, having the necessary metering accuracy, may be included
in the main incoming circuit-breaker panel or (in the case of the voltage transformer)
may be installed separately in the metering panel.
Transformer rooms
If the installation includes a number of transformer rooms, MV supplies from the main
substation may be by simple radial feeders connected directly to the transformers, or
by duplicate feeders to each room, or again, by a ring-main, according to the degree
of supply availability desired.
In the two latter cases, 3-panel ring-main units will be required at each transformer
room.
Local emergency generators
Emergency standby generators are intended to maintain a power supply to essential
loads, in the event of failure of the power supply system.
Capacitors
Capacitors will be installed, according to requirements:
b In stepped MV banks at the main substation, or
b At LV in transformer rooms.
Transformers
For additional supply-security reasons, transformers may be arranged for automatic
changeover operation, or for parallel operation.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
One-line diagrams
The diagrams shown in Figure B19 next page represent:
b The different methods of MV service connection, which may be one of four types:
v Single-line service
v Single-line service (equipped for extension to form a ring main)
v Duplicate supply service
v Ring main service
b General protection at MV, and MV metering functions
b Protection of outgoing MV circuits
b Protection of LV distribution circuits
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 The consumer substation
with MV metering
B23
Power supply
system
Service connection
Supplier/consumer
interface
MV protection
and metering
MV distribution and protection
of outgoing circuits
Downstream terminals of
MV isolator for the installation
Single-line service
LV distribution
and protection
LV terminals of
transformer
Protection
LV
Single-line service
(equipped for
extension to form
a ring main)
A single transformer
Automatic LV/MV
standby source
Duplicatesupply
service
Protection
+ automatic
changeover
feature
Protection
Ring-main
service
Automatic LV
standby source
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B19 : Consumer substation with MV metering
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B24
5.2 Choice of panels
A substation with MV metering includes, in addition to the panels described in 4.2,
panels specifically designed for metering and, if required, for automatic or manual
changeover from one source to another.
Metering and general protection
These two functions are achieved by the association of two panels:
b One panel containing the VT
b The main MV circuit-breaker panel containing the CTs for measurement and
protection
The general protection is usually against overcurrent (overload and short-circuit) and
earth faults. Both schemes use protective relays which are sealed by the powersupply utility.
Substation including generators
MV distribution
panels for
which standby Automatic
supply is
changeover
required
panel
Generator in stand alone operation
If the installation needs great power supply availability, a MV standby generator set
can be used. In such a case, the installation must include an automatic changeover.
In order to avoid any posssibility of parallel operation of the generator with the power
supply network, a specific panel with automatic changeover is needed (see Fig. B20).
Busbar
transition
panel
To remainder
of the MV
switchboard
b Protection
Specific protective devices are intended to protect the generator itself. It must be
noted that, due to the very low short-circuit power of the generator comparing with
the power supply network, a great attention must be paid to protection discrimination.
b Control
A voltage regulator controlling an alternator is generally arranged to respond to a
reduction of voltage at its terminals by automatically increasing the excitation current
of the alternator, until the voltage is restored to normal. When it is intended that
the alternator should operate in parallel with others, the AVR (Automatic Voltage
Regulator) is switched to “parallel operation” in which the AVR control circuit is
slightly modified (compounded) to ensure satisfactory sharing of kvars with the other
parallel machines.
When a number of alternators are operating in parallel under AVR control, an
increase in the excitation current of one of them (for example, carried out manually
after switching its AVR to Manual control) will have practically no effect on the voltage
level. In fact, the alternator in question will simply operate at a lower power factor
(more kVA, and therefore more current) than before.
From standby generator
P y 20,000 kVA
Fig. B20 : Section of MV switchboard including standby supply
panel
The power factor of all the other machines will automatically improve, such that the
load power factor requirements are satisfied, as before.
Generator operating in parallel with the utility supply network
To connect a generator set on the network, the agreement of the power supply utility
is usually required. Generally the equipement (panels, protection relays) must be
approved by the utility.
The following notes indicate some basic consideration to be taken into account for
protection and control.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Protection
To study the connection of generator set, the power supply utility needs some data
as follows :
v Power injected on the network
v Connection mode
v Short-circuit current of the generator set
v Voltage unbalance of the generator
v etc.
Depending on the connection mode, dedicated uncoupling protection functions are
required :
v Under-voltage and over-voltage protection
v Under-frequency and over-frequency protection
v Zero sequence overvoltage protection
v Maximum time of coupling (for momentary coupling)
v Reverse real power
For safety reasons, the switchgear used for uncoupling must also be provided
with the characteristics of a disconnector (i.e total isolation of all active conductors
between the generator set and the power supply network).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 The consumer substation
with MV metering
b Control
When generators at a consumer’s substation operate in parallel with all the
generation of the utility power supply system, supposing the power system voltage is
reduced for operational reasons (it is common to operate MV systems within a range
of ± 5% of nominal voltage, or even more, where load-flow patterns require it), an
AVR set to maintain the voltage within ± 3% (for example) will immediately attempt to
raise the voltage by increasing the excitation current of the alternator.
B25
Instead of raising the voltage, the alternator will simply operate at a lower power
factor than before, thereby increasing its current output, and will continue to do so,
until it is eventually tripped out by its overcurrent protective relays. This is a wellknown problem and is usually overcome by the provision of a “constant powerfactor” control switch on the AVR unit.
By making this selection, the AVR will automatically adjust the excitation current
to match whatever voltage exists on the power system, while at the same time
maintaining the power factor of the alternator constant at the pre-set value (selected
on the AVR control unit).
In the event that the alternator becomes decoupled from the power system, the AVR
must be automatically (rapidly) switched back to “constant-voltage” control.
5.3 Parallel operation of transformers
The need for operation of two or more transformers in parallel often arises due to:
b Load growth, which exceeds the capactiy of an existing transformer
b Lack of space (height) for one large transformer
b A measure of security (the probability of two transformers failing at the same time
is very small)
b The adoption of a standard size of transformer throughout an installation
Total power (kVA)
The total power (kVA) available when two or more transformers of the same
kVA rating are connected in parallel, is equal to the sum of the individual ratings,
providing that the percentage impedances are all equal and the voltage ratios are
identical.
Transformers of unequal kVA ratings will share a load practically (but not exactly)
in proportion to their ratings, providing that the voltage ratios are identical and the
percentage impedances (at their own kVA rating) are identical, or very nearly so.
In these cases, a total of more than 90% of the sum of the two ratings is normally
available.
It is recommended that transformers, the kVA ratings of which differ by more
than 2:1, should not be operated permanently in parallel.
Conditions necessary for parallel operation
All paralleled units must be supplied from the same network.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The inevitable circulating currents exchanged between the secondary circuits of
paralleled transformers will be negligibly small providing that:
b Secondary cabling from the transformers to the point of paralleling have
approximately equal lengths and characteristics
b The transformer manufacturer is fully informed of the duty intended for the
transformers, so that:
v The winding configurations (star, delta, zigzag star) of the several transformers
have the same phase change between primary and secondary voltages
v The short-circuit impedances are equal, or differ by less than 10%
v Voltage differences between corresponding phases must not exceed 0.4%
v All possible information on the conditions of use, expected load cycles, etc. should
be given to the manufacturer with a view to optimizing load and no-load losses
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B26
5 The consumer substation
with MV metering
Common winding arrangements
As described in 4.4 “Electrical characteristics-winding configurations” the
relationships between primary, secondary, and tertiary windings depend on:
b Type of windings (delta, star, zigzag)
b Connection of the phase windings
Depending on which ends of the windings form the star point (for example), a
star winding will produce voltages which are 180° displaced with respect to those
produced if the opposite ends had been joined to form the star point. Similar 180°
changes occur in the two possible ways of connecting phase-to-phase coils to form
delta windings, while four different combinations of zigzag connections are possible.
b The phase displacement of the secondary phase voltages with respect to the
corresponding primary phase voltages.
As previously noted, this displacement (if not zero) will always be a multiple of
30° and will depend on the two factors mentioned above, viz type of windings and
connection (i.e. polarity) of the phase windings.
By far the most common type of distribution transformer winding configuration is the
Dyn 11 connection (see Fig. B21).
Voltage vectors
1
1
V12
2
N
3
2
3
1
1
N
2
2
Windings
correspondence
3
V12 on the primary winding produces V1N in the
secondary winding and so on ...
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B21 : Phase change through a Dyn 11 transformer
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3
6 Constitution of
MV/LV distribution substations
MV/LV substations are constructed according to the magnitude of the load and the
kind of power system in question.
B27
Substations may be built in public places, such as parks, residential districts, etc. or
on private premises, in which case the power supply authority must have unrestricted
access. This is normally assured by locating the substation, such that one of its
walls, which includes an access door, coincides with the boundary of the consumers
premises and the public way.
6.1 Different types of substation
Substations may be classified according to metering arrangements (MV or LV) and
type of supply (overhead line or underground cable).
The substations may be installed:
b Either indoors in room specially built for the purpose, within a building, or
b An outdoor installation which could be :
v Installed in a dedicated enclosure prefabricated or not, with indoor equipment
(switchgear and transformer)
v Ground mounted with outdoor equipment (switchgear and transformers)
v Pole mounted with dedicated outdoor equipment (swithgear and transformers)
Prefabricated substations provide a particularly simple, rapid and competitive choice.
6.2 Indoor substation
Conception
Figure B22 shows a typical equipment layout recommended for a LV metering
substation.
Remark: the use of a cast-resin dry-type transformer does not need a fireprotection
oil sump. However, periodic cleaning is needed.
LV connections
from
transformer
MV connections to transformer
(included in a panel or free-standing)
LV switchgear
2 incoming
MV panels
MV
switching
and
protection
panel
Current
transformers
provided by
power-supply
authority
Connection to the powersupply network by single-core
or three-core cables,
with or without a cable trench
Transformer
Fig. B22 : Typical arrangment of switchgear panels for LV metering
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Oil sump
LV cable
trench
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B28
Service connections and equipment interconnections
At high voltage
b Connections to the MV system are made by, and are the responsibility of the utility
b Connections between the MV switchgear and the transformers may be:
v By short copper bars where the transformer is housed in a panel forming part of
the MV switchboard
v By single-core screened cables with synthetic insulation, with possible use of plugin type terminals at the transformer
At low voltage
b Connections between the LV terminals of the transformer and the LV switchgear
may be:
v Single-core cables
v Solid copper bars (circular or rectangular section) with heat-shrinkable insulation
Metering (see Fig. B23)
b Metering current transformers are generally installed in the protective cover of the
power transformer LV terminals, the cover being sealed by the supply utility
b Alternatively, the current transformers are installed in a sealed compartment within
the main LV distribution cabinet
b The meters are mounted on a panel which is completely free from vibrations
b Placed as close to the current transformers as possible, and
b Are accessible only to the utility
100
MV supply
LV distribution
Common earth busbar
for the substation
800 mini
Safety accessories
Meters
Fig. B23 : Plan view of typical substation with LV metering
Earthing circuits
The substation must include:
b An earth electrode for all exposed conductive parts of electrical equipment in the
substation and exposed extraneous metal including:
v Protective metal screens
v Reinforcing rods in the concrete base of the substation
Substation lighting
Supply to the lighting circuits can be taken from a point upstream or downstream
of the main incoming LV circuit-breaker. In either case, appropriate overcurrent
protection must be provided. A separate automatic circuit (or circuits) is (are)
recommended for emergency lighting purposes.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Operating switches, pushbuttons, etc. are normally located immediately adjacent to
entrances.
Lighting fittings are arranged such that:
b Switchgear operating handles and position indication markings are adequately
illuminated
b All metering dials and instruction plaques and so on, can be easily read
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Constitution of
MV/LV distribution substations
B29
Materials for operation and safety
According to local safety rules, generally, the substation is provided with:
b Materials for assuring safe exploitation of the equipment including:
v Insulating stool and/or an insulating mat (rubber or synthetic)
v A pair of insulated gloves stored in an envelope provided for the purpose
v A voltage-detecting device for use on the MV equipment
v Earthing attachments (according to type of switchgear)
b Fire-extinguishing devices of the powder or CO2 type
b Warning signs, notices and safety alarms:
v On the external face of all access doors, a DANGER warning plaque and
prohibition of entry notice, together with instructions for first-aid care for victims of
electrical accidents.
6.3 Outdoor substations
Outdoor substation with prefabricated enclosures
A prefabricated MV/LV substation complying with IEC 62271-202 standard includes :
b equipment in accordance with IEC standards
b a type tested enclosure, which means during its design, it has undergone a battery
of tests (see Fig. B24):
v Degree of protection
v Functional tests
v Temperature class
v Non-flammable materials
v Mechanical resistance of the enclosure
v Sound level
v Insulation level
v Internal arc withstand
v Earthing circuit test
v Oil retention,…
Use of equipment conform
to IEC standards:
Mechanical resistance
of the enclosure:
b Degree of protection
b Sound level
b Electromagnetic
compatibility
b Insulation level
b Functional tests
LV
MV
b Internal arcing
withstand
b Temperature class
b Non-flammable
materials
Earthing circuit test
Oil retention
Walk-in
Non walk-in
Half buried
Underground
a-
b-
Main benefits are :
b Safety:
v For public and operators thanks to a high reproducible quality level
b Cost effective:
v Manufactured, equipped and tested in the factory
b Delivery time
v Delivered ready to be connected.
IEC 62271-202 standard includes four main designs (see Fig. B25)
Fig. B25 : The four designs according to IEC 62271-202
standard and two pictures [a] walk-in type MV/LV substation;
[b] half buried type MV/LV substation
b Walk-in type substation :
v Operation protected from bad weather conditions
b Non walk-in substation
v Ground space savings, and outdoors operations
b Half buried substation
v Limited visual impact
b Underground substation
v Blends completely into the environment.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. B24 : Type tested substation according to IEC 62271-202 standard
B - Connection to the MV utility
distribution network
B30
6 Constitution of
MV/LV distribution substations
Outdoor substations without enclosures (see Fig. B26)
These kinds of outdoor substation are common in some countries, based on
weatherproof equipment exposed to the elements.
These substations comprise a fenced area in which three or more concrete plinths
are installed for:
b A ring-main unit, or one or more switch-fuse or circuit-breaker unit(s)
b One or more transformer(s), and
b One or more LV distribution panel(s).
Pole mounted substations
Field of application
These substations are mainly used to supply isolated rural consumers from MV
overhead line distribution systems.
Constitution
In this type of substation, most often, the MV transformer protection is provided by
fuses.
Lightning arresters are provided, however, to protect the transformer and consumers
as shown in Figure B27.
General arrangement of equipment
As previously noted the location of the substation must allow easy access, not only
for personnel but for equipment handling (raising the transformer, for example) and
the manœuvring of heavy vehicles.
Lightning
arresters
LV circuit breaker D1
Earthing conductor 25 mm2 copper
Protective conductor cover
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Safety earth mat
Fig. B26 : Outdoor substations without enclosures
Fig. B27 : Pole-mounted transformer substation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter C
Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
Contents
1
Low-voltage utility distribution networks
C2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
C2 C1
C10
C11
C15
2
Tariffs and metering
C16
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Low-voltage consumers
Low-voltage distribution networks
The consumer service connection
Quality of supply voltage
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
The most-common LV supplies are within the
range 120 V single phase to 240/415 V
3-phase 4-wires.
C2 Loads up to 250 kVA can be supplied at LV, but
power-supply organizations generally propose
a MV service at load levels for which their
LV networks are marginally adequate.
An international voltage standard for 3-phase
4-wire LV systems is recommended by the
IEC 60038 to be 230/400 V
1.1 Low-voltage consumers
In Europe, the transition period on the voltage tolerance to “230V/400V + 10% / - 10%”
has been extended for another 5 years up to the year 2008.
Low-voltage consumers are, by definition, those consumers whose loads can be
satisfactorily supplied from the low-voltage system in their locality.
The voltage of the local LV network may be 120/208 V or 240/415 V, i.e. the lower
or upper extremes of the most common 3-phase levels in general use, or at some
intermediate level, as shown in Figure C1.
An international voltage standard for 3-phase 4-wire LV systems is recommended
by the IEC 60038 to be 230/400 V.
Loads up to 250 kVA can be supplied at LV, but power-supply organizations
generally propose a MV service at load levels for which their LV networks are
marginally adequate.
Country
Algeria
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
50
220 (k)
50 ± 1.5
Angola
50
Antigua and Barbuda
60
Argentina
50 ± 2
Armenia
50 ± 5
Australia
50 ± 0.1
Austria
50 ± 0.1
230 (k)
Azerbaijan
50 ± 0.1
Bahrain
50 ± 0.1
208/120 (a)
240/120 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
Bangladesh
50 ± 2
Barbados
50 ± 6
Belarus
50
Belgium
50 ± 5
Bolivia
50 ± 0.5
230 (k)
Botswana
Brazil
50 ± 3
60 ± 3
220 (k)
220 (k, a)
127 (k, a)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
380/220 (a)
220/380 (a)
127/220 (a)
Brunei
50 ± 2
230
230
Bulgaria
50 ± 0.1
220
220/240
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Afghanistan
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
220/127 (e)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220/127 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
240 (k)
120 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
380/220 (a)
10,000
5,500
6,600
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
410/220 (a)
220 (k)
230/115 (j)
115 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
230 (k)
230 (a)
3N, 400
400/230 (a)
120/208 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
415/240 (a)
440/250 (a)
440 (m)
380/230 (a) (b)
230 (k)
208/120 (a)
240/120 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
410/220 (a)
230/115 (j)
200/115 (a)
220/115 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
230 (k)
230 (a)
3N, 400
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
400/230 (a)
120/208 (a)
380/220 (a)
22,000
11,000
6,600
415/240
440/250
5,000
380/220 (a)
11,000
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
11,000
410/220 (a)
230/400 (g)
230/155 (j)
380/220 (a)
6,600
10,000
11,000
15,000
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
69,000
23,200
13,800
11,200
220/380 (a)
127/220 (a)
11,000
68,000
1,000
690
380
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
Cambodia
Cameroon
Canada
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
50 ± 1
50 ± 1
60 ± 0.02
220 (k)
220/260 (k)
120/240 (j)
220/300
220/260 (k)
347/600 (a)
480 (f)
240 (f)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
Cape Verde
Chad
Chile
China
50 ± 1
50 ± 1
50 ± 0.5
220
220 (k)
220 (k)
220 (k)
Colombia
60 ± 1
Congo
50
Croatia
50
Cyprus
50 ± 0.1
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
240 (k)
220
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
120/240 (g)
120 (k)
240/120 (j)
120 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
415/240
220/380
220/380 (a)
7,200/12,500
347/600 (a)
120/208
600 (f)
480 (f)
240 (f)
380/400
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
13,200
120/240 (g)
380/220 (a)
Czech Republic
50 ± 1
230
500
230/400
Denmark
Djibouti
Dominica
Egypt
50 ± 1
50
50
50 ± 0.5
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Estonia
50 ± 1
Ethiopia
50 ± 2.5
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/231 (a)
Falkland Islands
Fidji Islands
50 ± 3
50 ± 2
Finland
50 ± 0.1
230 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
230 (k)
415/230 (a)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
400/230 (a)
France
50 ± 1
400/230 (a)
230 (a)
Gambia
Georgia
50
50 ± 0.5
Germany
50 ± 0.3
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230
690/400
590/100
220/380
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
Ghana
Gibraltar
Greece
50 ± 5
50 ± 1
50
220/240
415/240 (a)
220 (k)
230
220/240
415/240 (a)
6,000
380/220 (a)
Granada
Hong Kong
50
50 ± 2
230 (k)
220 (k)
Hungary
Iceland
50 ± 5
50 ± 0.1
220
230
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220
230/400
120/240 (g)
120 (k)
220 (k)
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
C3
400/230 (a)
11,000
415/240
400,000
220,000
110,000
35,000
22,000
10,000
6,000
3,000
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
66,000
33,000
20,000
11,000
6,600
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
15 000
380/231 (a)
415/230 (a)
11,000
415/240 (a)
690/400 (a)
400/230 (a)
20,000
10,000
230/400
380
380/220 (a)
20,000
10,000
6,000
690/400
400/230
415/240 (a)
415/240 (a)
22,000
20,000
15,000
6,600
400/230 (a)
11,000
386/220 (a)
220/380
230/400
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Country
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
C4
Country
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
India
50 ± 1.5
440/250 (a)
230 (k)
440/250 (a)
230 (k)
Indonesia
50 ± 2
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
Iran
50 ± 5
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
Iraq
50
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
Ireland
50 ± 2
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
Israel
50 ± 0.2
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
Italy
50 ± 0.4
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
Jamaica
50 ± 1
220/110 (g) (j)
220/110 (g) (j)
Japan (east)
+ 0.1
- 0.3
200/100 (h)
200/100 (h)
(up to 50 kW)
Jordan
50
380/220 (a)
Kazakhstan
50
Kenya
Kirghizia
50
50
Korea (North)
60 +0, -5
380/220 (a)
400/230 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
240 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
220 (k)
11,000
400/230 (a)
440/250 (a)
150,000
20,000
380/220 (a)
20,000
11,000
400/231 (a)
380/220 (a)
11,000
6,600
3,000
380/220 (a)
20,000
10,000
400/230 (a)
22,000
12,600
6,300
400/230 (a)
20,000
15,000
10,000
400/230 (a)
4,000
2,300
220/110 (g)
140,000
60,000
20,000
6,000
200/100 (h)
400 (a)
Korea (South)
Kuwait
Laos
Lesotho
Latvia
60
50 ± 3
50 ± 8
Lebanon
Libya
50
50
100 (k)
240 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220 (k)
230 (k)
127 (k)
Lithuania
50 ± 0.5
Luxembourg
50 ± 0.5
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
100/200 (j)
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
400/230 (a)
220/127 (a)
230 (k)
127 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
Macedonia
50
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Madagascar
50
220/110 (k)
380/220 (a)
50 ± 0.4
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
220/380 (a)
13,600
6,800
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
400/230 (a)
220/127 (a)
380/220 (a)
20,000
15,000
5,000
10,000
6,600
380/220 (a)
35,000
5,000
380/220
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
Country
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
Malaysia
50 ± 1
415/240 (a)
415/240 (a)
Malawi
50 ± 2.5
240 (k)
415 (a)
230 (k)
400 (a)
Mali
50
220 (k)
127 (k)
Malta
Martinique
50 ± 2
50
240 (k)
127 (k)
Mauritania
Mexico
50 ± 1
60 ± 0.2
230 (k)
127/220 (a)
220 (k)
120 (l)
400 (a)
230 (k)
380/220 (a)
220/127 (a)
220 (k)
127 (k)
415/240 (a)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
400/230 (a)
127/220 (a)
220 (k)
120 (l)
Moldavia
50
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Morocco
50 ± 5
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
380/220 (a)
220/110 (a)
Mozambique
50
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
Nepal
50 ± 1
220 (k)
Netherlands
50 ± 0.4
230/400 (a)
230 (k)
440/220 (a)
220 (k)
230/400 (a)
New Zealand
50 ± 1.5
Niger
50 ± 1
400/230 (e) (a)
230 (k)
460/230 (e)
230 (k)
380/220 (a)
Nigeria
50 ± 1
230 (k)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
Norway
50 ± 2
230/400
230/400
Oman
50
240 (k)
Pakistan
50
230 (k)
Papua New Guinea
50 ± 2
240 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
Paraguay
50 ± 0.5
220 (k)
Philippines (Rep of the)
60 ± 0.16
110/220 (j)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
13,800
4,160
2,400
110/220 (h)
Poland
50 ± 0.1
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
Portugal
50 ± 1
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Qatar
50 ± 0.1
415/240 (k)
15,000
5,000
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
415/240 (a)
400/230 (e) (a)
230 (k)
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
380/220 (a)
220/127 (a)
415/240 (a)
220/127 (a)
400/230 (a)
13,800
13,200
277/480 (a)
127/220 (b)
380/220 (a)
225,000
150,000
60,000
22,000
20,000
6,000
10,000
11,000
440/220 (a)
25,000
20,000
12,000
10,000
230/400
11,000
400/230 (a)
15,000
380/220 (a)
15,000
11,000
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
230/400
690
415/240 (a)
400/230 (a)
22,000
11,000
415/240 (a)
22,000
380/220 (a)
13,800
4,160
2,400
440 (b)
110/220 (h)
1,000
690/400
400/230 (a)
15,000
5,000
380/220 (a)
11,000
415/240 (a)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
380/220 (a)
C5
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
C6
Country
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
Romania
50 ± 0.5
220 (k)
220/380 (a)
220/380 (a)
Russia
50 ± 0.2
Rwanda
50 ± 1
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
20,000
10,000
6,000
220/380 (a)
380/220 (a)
Saint Lucia
50 ± 3
240 (k)
415/240 (a)
Samoa
San Marino
50 ± 1
400/230
230/220
380
Saudi Arabia
60
220/127 (a)
220/127 (a)
380/220 (a)
The Solomon Islands
Senegal
50 ± 2
50 ± 5
240
220 (a)
127 (k)
415/240
380/220 (a)
220/127 (k)
Serbia and Montenegro
50
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Seychelles
50 ± 1
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
Sierra Leone
50 ± 5
230 (k)
Singapore
50
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
Slovakia
Slovenia
50 ± 0.5
50 ± 0.1
230
220 (k)
230
380/220 (a)
Somalia
50
South Africa
50 ± 2.5
230 (k)
220 (k)
110 (k)
433/250 (a)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Spain
50 ± 3
Sri Lanka
50 ± 2
380/220 (a) (e)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
230 (k)
440/220 (j)
220/110 (j)
230 (k)
11,000
6,600
3,300
433/250 (a)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
220/127 (a) (e)
Sudan
50
240 (k)
Swaziland
50 ± 2.5
230 (k)
Sweden
50 ± 0.5
Switzerland
50 ± 2
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
Syria
50
220 (k)
115 (k)
Tadzhikistan
50
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
415/240 (a)
240 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
230 (k)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
200/115 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
15,000
6,600
380/220 (a)
11,000
415/240 (a)
15,000
380
11,000
7,200
380/220 (a)
415/240
90,000
30,000
6,600
10,000
6,600
380/220 (a)
11,000
400/230 (a)
11,000
400
22,000
6,600
400/230 (a)
230/400
10,000
6,600
380/220 (a)
440/220 (g)
220/110 (g)
11,000
6,600
3,300
500 (b)
380/220 (a)
15,000
11,000
380/220 (a)
11,000
400/230 (a)
415/240 (a)
11,000
400/230 (a)
6,000
400/230 (a)
20,000
10,000
3,000
1,000
690/500
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
Country
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
Tanzania
50
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
Thailand
50
220 (k)
Togo
50
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
11,000
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
Tunisia
50 ± 2
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Turkmenistan
50
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
Turkey
50 ± 1
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220/127 (a)
127 (k)
380/220 (a)
Uganda
+ 0.1
240 (k)
415/240 (a)
Ukraine
+ 0.2 / - 1.5
United Arab Emirates
50 ± 1
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
220 (k)
United Kingdom
(except Northern
Ireland)
50 ± 1
230 (k)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
United Kingdom
(Including Northern
Ireland)
United States of
America
Charlotte
(North Carolina)
50 ± 0.4
230 (k)
220 (k)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
60 ± 0.06
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
265/460 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
United States of
America
Detroit (Michigan)
60 ± 0.2
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
480 (f)
120/240 (h)
120/208 (a)
United States of
America
Los Angeles (California)
United States of
America
Miami (Florida)
60 ± 0.2
120/240 (j)
4,800
120/240 (g)
60 ± 0.3
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/240 (h)
120/208 (a)
United States of
America New York
(New York)
60
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
240 (f)
United States of
America
Pittsburg
(Pennsylvania)
60 ± 0.03
120/240 (j)
265/460 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
460 (f)
230 (f)
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
20,000
5,500
380/220 (a)
30,000
15,000
10,000
380/220 (a)
380/220 (a)
15,000
6,300
380/220 (a)
11,000
415/240 (a)
380/220 (a)
220 (k)
6,600
415/210 (a)
380/220 (a)
22,000
11,000
6,600
3,300
400/230 (a)
400/230 (a)
380/220 (a)
14,400
7,200
2,400
575 (f)
460 (f)
240 (f)
265/460 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
13,200
4,800
4,160
480 (f)
120/240 (h)
120/208 (a)
4,800
120/240 (g)
13,200
2,400
480/277 (a)
120/240 (h)
12,470
4,160
277/480 (a)
480 (f)
13,200
11,500
2,400
265/460 (a)
120/208 (a)
460 (f)
230 (f)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
380/220 (a)
C7
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
Country
C8
Frequency & tolerance
(Hz & %)
60
Domestic (V)
Commercial (V)
Industrial (V)
120/240 (j)
227/480 (a)
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
480 (f)
240 (f)
United States of
America
San Francisco
(California)
60 ± 0.08
120/240 (j)
277/480 (a)
120/240 (j)
United States of
America
Toledo (Ohio)
60 ± 0.08
120/240 (j)
120/208 (a)
277/480 (c)
120/240(h)
120/208 (j)
Uruguay
50 ± 1
220 (b) (k)
220 (b) (k)
Vietnam
50 ± 0.1
220 (k)
380/220 (a)
Yemen
Zambia
Zimbabwe
50
50 ± 2.5
50
250 (k)
220 (k)
225 (k)
440/250 (a)
380/220 (a)
390/225 (a)
19,900
12,000
7,200
2,400
277/480 (a)
120/208 (a)
480 (f)
240 (f)
20,800
12,000
4,160
277/480 (a)
120/240 (g)
12,470
7,200
4,800
4,160
480 (f)
277/480 (a)
120/208 (a)
15,000
6,000
220 (b)
35,000
15,000
10,000
6,000
440/250 (a)
380 (a)
11,000
390/225 (a)
United States of
America
Portland (Oregon)
Circuit diagrams
(a) Three-phase star;
Four-wire:
Earthed neutral
(f) Three-phase delta:
Three-wire
(b) Three-phase star:
Three-wire
(c) Three-phase star;
Three-wire:
Earthed neutral
(g) Three-phase delta;
Four-wire:
Earthed mid point of
one phase
(d) Three-phase star; (e) Two-phase star;
Four-wire:
Three-wire
Non-earthed neutral Earthed neutral
(h) Three-phase open delta;
Four-wire:
Earthed mid point of one
phase
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
V
(j) Single-phase;
Three-wire:
Earthed mid point
(k) Single-phase;
Two-wire:
Earthed end of phase
(l) Single-phase;
Two-wire
Unearthed
Vk
(m) Single-wire:
Earthed return (swer)
Fig. C1 : Voltage of local LV network and their associated circuit diagrams (concluded)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
(i) Three-phase
open delta:
Earthed junction
of phases
(n) DC:
Three-wire:
Unearthed
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
Residential and commercial consumers
The function of a LV “mains” distributor is to provide service connections
(underground cable or overhead line) to a number of consumers along its route.
The current-rating requirements of distributors are estimated from the number of
consumers to be connected and an average demand per consumer.
C9
The two principal limiting parameters of a distributor are:
b The maximum current which it is capable of carrying indefinitely, and
b The maximum length of cable which, when carrying its maximum current, will not
exceed the statutory voltage-drop limit
These constraints mean that the magnitude of loads which utilities are willing to
connect to their LV distribution mains, is necessarily restricted.
For the range of LV systems mentioned in the second paragraph of this sub-clause
(1.1) viz: 120 V single phase to 240/415 V 3-phase, typical maximum permitted loads
connected to a LV distributor might(1) be (see Fig. C2):
System
120 V 1-phase 2-wire
120/240 V 1-phase 3-wire
120/208 V 3-phase 4-wire
220/380 V 3-phase 4-wire
230/400 V 3-phase 4-wire
240/415 V 3-phase 4-wire
Assumed max. permitted current
per consumer service
60 A
60 A
60 A
120 A
120 A
120 A
kVA
7.2
14.4
22
80
83
86
Fig. C2 : Typical maximum permitted loads connected to a LV distributor
Practices vary considerably from one power supply organization to another, and no
“standardized” values can be given.
Factors to be considered include:
b The size of an existing distribution network to which the new load is to be connected
b The total load already connected to the distribution network
b The location along the distribution network of the proposed new load, i.e. close to
the substation, or near the remote end of the distribution network, etc
In short, each case must be examined individually.
The load levels listed above are adequate for all normal residential consumers, and
will be sufficient for the installations of many administrative, commercial and similar
buildings.
Medium-size and small industrial consumers (with dedicated
LV lines direct from a utility supply MV/LV substation)
Medium and small industrial consumers can also be satisfactorily supplied at lowvoltage.
For loads which exceed the maximum permitted limit for a service from a distributor,
a dedicated cable can usually be provided from the LV distribution fuse- (or switch-)
board, in the power utility substation.
(1) The Figure C2 values shown are indicative only, being
(arbitrarily) based on 60 A maximum service currents for the
first three systems, since smaller voltage drops are allowed at
these lower voltages, for a given percentage statutory limit.
The second group of systems is (again, arbitrarily) based on a
maximum permitted service current of 120 A.
In practice, however:
b Large loads (e.g. > 300 kVA) require correspondingly large cables, so that,
unless the load centre is close to the substation, this method can be economically
unfavourable
b Many utilities prefer to supply loads exceeding 200 kVA (this figure varies with
different suppliers) at medium voltage
For these reasons, dedicated supply lines at LV are generally applied (at 220/380 V
to 240/415 V) to a load range of 80 kVA to 250 kVA.
Consumers normally supplied at low voltage include:
b Residential dwellings
b Shops and commercial buildings
b Small factories, workshops and filling stations
b Restaurants
b Farms, etc
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Generaly, the upper load limit which can be supplied by this means is restricted only
by the available spare transformer capacity in the substation.
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
In cities and large towns, standardized
LV distribution cables form a network through
link boxes. Some links are removed, so that
C10 each (fused) distributor leaving a substation
forms a branched open-ended radial system,
as shown in Figure C3
1.2 LV distribution networks
In European countries the standard 3-phase 4-wire distribution voltage level is
230/400 V. Many countries are currently converting their LV systems to the latest IEC
standard of 230/400 V nominal (IEC 60038). Medium
to large-sized towns and cities have underground cable distribution systems.
MV/LV distribution substations, mutually spaced at approximately 500-600 metres,
are typically equipped with:
b A 3-or 4-way MV switchboard, often made up of incoming and outgoing loadbreak switches forming part of a ring main, and one or two MV circuit-breakers or
combined fuse/ load-break switches for the transformer circuits
b One or two 1,000 kVA MV/LV transformers
b One or two (coupled) 6-or 8-way LV 3-phase 4-wire distribution fuse boards, or
moulded-case circuit-breaker boards, control and protect outgoing 4-core distribution
cables, generally referred to as “distributors”
The output from a transformer is connected to the LV busbars via a load-break
switch, or simply through isolating links.
In densely-loaded areas, a standard size of distributor is laid to form a network,
with (generally) one cable along each pavement and 4-way link boxes located in
manholes at street corners, where two cables cross.
Recent trends are towards weather-proof cabinets above ground level, either against
a wall, or where possible, flush-mounted in the wall.
Links are inserted in such a way that distributors form radial circuits from the
substation with open-ended branches (see Fig. C3). Where a link box unites a
distributor from one substation with that from a neighbouring substation, the phase
links are omitted or replaced by fuses, but the neutral link remains in place.
4-way
link box
HV/LV
substation
Service
cable
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Phase links
removed
Fig. C3 : Showing one of several ways in which a LV distribution network may be arranged for
radial branched-distributor operation, by removing (phase) links
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
This arrangement provides a very flexible system in which a complete substation can
be taken out of service, while the area normally supplied from it is fed from link boxes
of the surrounding substations.
Moreover, short lengths of distributor (between two link boxes) can be isolated for
fault-location and repair.
In less-densely loaded urban areas a moreeconomic system of tapered radial distribution
is commonly used, in which conductors of
reduced size are installed as the distance from
a substation increases
C11
Where the load density requires it, the substations are more closely spaced, and
transformers up to 1,500 kVA are sometimes necessary.
Other forms of urban LV network, based on free-standing LV distribution pillars,
placed above ground at strategic points in the network, are widely used in areas of
lower load density. This scheme exploits the principle of tapered radial distributors in
which the distribution cable conductor size is reduced as the number of consumers
downstream diminish with distance from the substation.
In this scheme a number of large-sectioned LV radial feeders from the distribution
board in the substation supply the busbars of a distribution pillar, from which smaller
distributors supply consumers immediately surrounding the pillar.
Distribution in market towns, villages and rural areas generally has, for many years,
been based on bare copper conductors supported on wooden, concrete or steel
poles, and supplied from pole-mounted or ground-mounted transformers.
Improved methods using insulated twisted
conductors to form a pole mounted aerial cable
are now standard practice in many countries
In recent years, LV insulated conductors, twisted to form a two-core or 4-core self
supporting cable for overhead use, have been developed, and are considered to be
safer and visually more acceptable than bare copper lines.
This is particularly so when the conductors are fixed to walls (e.g. under-eaves
wiring) where they are hardly noticeable.
As a matter of interest, similar principles have been applied at higher voltages, and
self supporting “bundled” insulated conductors for MV overhead installations are now
available for operation at 24 kV.
Where more than one substation supplies a village, arrangements are made at poles
on which the LV lines from different substations meet, to interconnect corresponding
phases.
In Europe, each utility-supply distribution
substation is able to supply at LV an area
corresponding to a radius of approximately
300 metres from the substation.
North and Central American systems of
distribution consist of a MV network from which
numerous (small) MV/LV transformers each
supply one or several consumers, by direct
service cable (or line) from the transformer
location
North and Central American practice differs fundamentally from that in Europe, in
that LV networks are practically nonexistent, and 3-phase supplies to premises in
residential areas are rare.
The distribution is effectively carried out at medium voltage in a way, which again
differs from standard European practices. The MV system is, in fact, a 3-phase
4-wire system from which single-phase distribution networks (phase and neutral
conductors) supply numerous single-phase transformers, the secondary windings
of which are centre-tapped to produce 120/240 V single-phase 3-wire supplies.
The central conductors provide the LV neutrals, which, together with the MV neutral
conductors, are solidly earthed at intervals along their lengths.
Each MV/LV transformer normally supplies one or several premises directly from the
transformer position by radial service cable(s) or by overhead line(s).
Many other systems exist in these countries, but the one described appears to be
the most common.
Figure C4 (next page) shows the main features of the two systems.
1.3 The consumer-service connection
In the past, an underground cable service or the wall-mounted insulated conductors
from an overhead line service, invariably terminated inside the consumer’s premises,
where the cable-end sealing box, the utility fuses (inaccessible to the consumer) and
meters were installed.
A more recent trend is (as far as possible) to locate these service components in a
weatherproof housing outside the building.
The utility/consumer interface is often at the outgoing terminals of the meter(s) or,
in some cases, at the outgoing terminals of the installation main circuit-breaker
(depending on local practices) to which connection is made by utility staff, following a
satisfactory test and inspection of the installation.
A typical arrangement is shown in Figure C5 (next page).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Service components and metering equipment
were formerly installed inside a consumer’s
building. The modern tendency is to locate
these items outside in a weatherproof cabinet
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
C12
For primary voltages > 72.5 kV
(see note) primary
winding may be:
- Delta
- Earthed star
- Earthed zigzag
Depending on the country concerned
13.8 kV / 2.4-4.16 kV
N
1
2
Each MV/LV transformer shown
represents many similar units
3
Tertiary delta normally
(not always) used if the
primary winding is not delta
2
3
N
2.4 kV / 120-240 V
1 ph - 3 wire
distribution
transformer
1 ph MV / 230 V
service transformer
to isolated consumer(s)
(rural supplies)
}
HV (1)
Ph
N
1
1
N
MV (2)
N
Resistor replaced
by a Petersen
coil on O/H line
systems in some
countries
N
2
2
N
3 ph
MV / 230/400 V
4-wire distribution
transformer
1
2
3
N
N
N 1 2 3
LV distribution network
Main 3 ph and neutral
MV distributor
(1) 132 kV for example
(2) 11 kV for example
Note: At primary voltages greater than 72.5 kV in bulk-supply substations, it is common practice in some European countries
to use an earthed-star primary winding and a delta secondary winding. The neutral point on the secondary side is then
provided by a zigzag earthing reactor, the star point of which is connected to earth through a resistor.
Frequently, the earthing reactor has a secondary winding to provide LV 3-phase supplies for the substation. It is then referred
to as an “earthing transformer”.
Fig. C4 : Widely-used American and European-type systems
CB
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M
F
A
Fig. C5 : Typical service arrangement for TT-earthed systems
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
LV consumers are normally supplied according
to the TN or TT system, as described in
chapters F and G. The installation main circuitbreaker for a TT supply must include a residual
current earth-leakage protective device. For a
TN service, overcurrent protection by circuitbreaker or switch-fuse is required
A MCCB -moulded case circuit-breaker- which incorporates a sensitive residualcurrent earth-fault protective feature is mandatory at the origin of any LV installation
forming part of a TT earthing system. The reason for this feature and related
leakage-current tripping levels are discussed in Clause 3 of Chapter G.
A further reason for this MCCB is that the consumer cannot exceed his (contractual)
declared maximum load, since the overload trip setting, which is sealed by the
supply authority, will cut off supply above the declared value. Closing and tripping of
the MCCB is freely available to the consumer, so that if the MCCB is inadvertently
tripped on overload, or due to an appliance fault, supplies can be quickly restored
following correction of the anomaly.
C13
In view of the inconvenience to both the meter reader and consumer, the location of
meters is nowadays generally outside the premises, either:
b In a free-standing pillar-type housing as shown in Figures C6 and C7
b In a space inside a building, but with cable termination and supply authority’s fuses
located in a flush-mounted weatherproof cabinet accessible from the public way, as
shown in Figure C8 next page
b For private residential consumers, the equipment shown in the cabinet in
Figure C5 is installed in a weatherproof cabinet mounted vertically on a metal
frame in the front garden, or flush-mounted in the boundary wall, and accessible to
authorized personnel from the pavement. Figure C9 (next page) shows the general
arrangement, in which removable fuse links provide the means of isolation
M
F CB
A
In this kind of installation it is often necessary to place the main installation circuitbreaker some distance from the point of utilization, e.g. saw-mills, pumping stations,
etc.
Fig. C6 : Typical rural-type installation
CB
M
A
The main installation CB is located in the consumer’s premises in cases where it is
set to trip if the declared kVA load demand is exceeded.
Fig. C7 : Semi-urban installations (shopping precincts, etc.)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
F
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
C14
M
CB
F
A
The service cable terminates in a flushmounted wall cabinet which contains the
isolating fuse links, accessible from the public way. This method is preferred for
esthetic reasons, when the consumer can provide a suitable metering and mainswitch location.
Fig. C8 : Town centre installations
Interface
Utility
Service cable
Consumer
Installation
Isolation by
fuse links
Meter
Meter cabinet
Main
circuit
breaker
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. C9 : Typical LV service arrangement for residential consumers
In the field of electronic metering, techniques have developed which make their
use attractive by utilities either for electricity metering and for billing purposes, the
liberalisation of the electricity market having increased the needs for more data
collection to be returned from the meters. For example electronic metering can also
help utilities to understand their customers’ consumption profiles. In the same way,
they will be useful for more and more power line communication and radio-frequency
applications as well.
In this area, prepayment systems are also more and more employed when
economically justified. They are based on the fact that for instance consumers having
made their payment at vending stations, generate tokens to pass the information
concerning this payment on to the meters. For these systems the key issues are
security and inter-operability which seem to have been addressed successfully
now. The attractiveness of these systems is due to the fact they not only replace the
meters but also the billing systems, the reading of meters and the administration of
the revenue collection.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Low-voltage utility distribution
networks
An adequate level of voltage at the consumers
supply-service terminals is essential for
satisfactory operation of equipment and
appliances. Practical values of current, and
resulting voltage drops in a typical LV system,
show the importance of maintaining a high
Power Factor as a means of reducing voltage
drop.
1.4 Quality of supply voltage
The quality of the LV network supply voltage in its widest sense implies:
b Compliance with statutory limits of magnitude and frequency
b Freedom from continual fluctuation within those limits
b Uninterrupted power supply, except for scheduled maintenance shutdowns, or as a
result of system faults or other emergencies
b Preservation of a near-sinusoidal wave form
C15
In this Sub-clause the maintenance of voltage magnitude only will be discussed.
In most countries, power-supply authorities have a statutory obligation to maintain
the level of voltage at the service position of consumers within the limits of ± 5% (or
in some cases ± 6% or more-see table C1) of the declared nominal value.
Again, IEC and most national standards recommend that LV appliances be designed
and tested to perform satisfactorily within the limits of ± 10% of nominal voltage. This
leaves a margin, under the worst conditions (of minus 5% at the service position, for
example) of 5% allowable voltage drop in the installation wiring.
The voltage drops in a typical distribution system occur as follows: the voltage at
the MV terminals of a MV/LV transformer is normally maintained within a ± 2% band
by the action of automatic onload tapchangers of the transformers at bulk-supply
substations, which feed the MV network from a higher-voltage subtransmission
system.
If the MV/LV transformer is in a location close to a bulk-supply substation, the ± 2%
voltage band may be centered on a voltage level which is higher than the nominal
MV value. For example, the voltage could be 20.5 kV ± 2% on a 20 kV system. In this
case, the MV/LV distribution transformer should have its MV off-circuit tapping switch
selected to the + 2.5% tap position.
Conversely, at locations remote from bulk supply substations a value of 19.5 kV ±
2% is possible, in which case the off-circuit tapping switch should be selected to the
- 5% position.
The different levels of voltage in a system are normal, and depend on the system
powerflow pattern. Moreover, these voltage differences are the reason for the term
“nominal” when referring to the system voltage.
Practical application
With the MV/LV transformer correctly selected at its off-circuit tapping switch, an
unloaded transformer output voltage will be held within a band of ± 2% of its no-load
voltage output.
To ensure that the transformer can maintain the necessary voltage level when fully
loaded, the output voltage at no-load must be as high as possible without exceeding
the upper + 5% limit (adopted for this example). In present-day practice, the winding
ratios generally give an output voltage of about 104% at no-load(1), when nominal
voltage is applied at MV, or is corrected by the tapping switch, as described above.
This would result in a voltage band of 102% to 106% in the present case.
A typical LV distribution transformer has a short-circuit reactance voltage of 5%. If it
is assumed that its resistance voltage is one tenth of this value, then the voltage drop
within the transformer when supplying full load at 0.8 power factor lagging, will be:
V% drop = R% cos + X% sin
= 0.5 x 0.8 + 5 x 0.6
= 0.4 + 3 = 3.4%
The voltage band at the output terminals of the fully-loaded transformer will therefore
be (102 - 3.4) = 98.6% to (106 - 3.4) = 102.6%.
This means, in practical terms, that a medium-sized 230/400 V 3-phase 4-wire
distribution cable of 240 mm2 copper conductors would be able to supply a total load
of 292 kVA at 0.8 PF lagging, distributed evenly over 306 metres of the distributor.
Alternatively, the same load at the premises of a single consumer could be supplied
at a distance of 153 metres from the transformer, for the same volt-drop, and so on...
As a matter of interest, the maximum rating of the cable, based on calculations
derived from IEC 60287 (1982) is 290 kVA, and so the 3.6% voltage margin is not
unduly restrictive, i.e. the cable can be fully loaded for distances normally required in
LV distribution systems.
(1) Transformers designed for the 230/400 V IEC standard
will have a no-load output of 420 V, i.e. 105% of the nominal
voltage
Furthermore, 0.8 PF lagging is appropriate to industrial loads. In mixed semiindustrial areas 0.85 is a more common value, while 0.9 is generally used for
calculations concerning residential areas, so that the volt-drop noted above may be
considered as a “worst case” example.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The maximum allowable voltage drop along a distributor is therefore 98.6 - 95 = 3.6%.
C - Connection to the LV utility
distribution network
2 Tariffs and metering
No attempt will be made in this guide to discuss particular tariffs, since there appears
to be as many different tariff structures around the world as there are utilities.
Some tariffs are very complicated in detail but certain elements are basic to all of
them and are aimed at encouraging consumers to manage their power consumption
in a way which reduces the cost of generation, transmission and distribution.
C16
The two predominant ways in which the cost of supplying power to consumers can
be reduced, are:
b Reduction of power losses in the generation, transmission and distribution of
electrical energy. In principle the lowest losses in a power system are attained when
all parts of the system operate at unity power factor
b Reduction of the peak power demand, while increasing the demand at low-load
periods, thereby exploiting the generating plant more fully, and minimizing plant
redundancy
Reduction of losses
Although the ideal condition noted in the first possibility mentioned above cannot
be realized in practice, many tariff structures are based partly on kVA demand, as
well as on kWh consumed. Since, for a given kW loading, the minimum value of kVA
occurs at unity power factor, the consumer can minimize billing costs by taking steps
to improve the power factor of the load (as discussed in Chapter L). The kVA demand
generally used for tariff purposes is the maximum average kVA demand occurring
during each billing period, and is based on average kVA demands, over fixed periods
(generally 10, 30 or 60 minute periods) and selecting the highest of these values.
The principle is described below in “principle of kVA maximum-demand metering”.
Reduction of peak power demand
The second aim, i.e. that of reducing peak power demands, while increasing demand
at low-load periods, has resulted in tariffs which offer substantial reduction in the cost
of energy at:
b Certain hours during the 24-hour day
b Certain periods of the year
The simplest example is that of a residential consumer with a storage-type water
heater (or storage-type space heater, etc.). The meter has two digital registers, one
of which operates during the day and the other (switched over by a timing device)
operates during the night. A contactor, operated by the same timing device, closes
the circuit of the water heater, the consumption of which is then indicated on the
register to which the cheaper rate applies. The heater can be switched on and off at
any time during the day if required, but will then be metered at the normal rate. Large
industrial consumers may have 3 or 4 rates which apply at different periods during
a 24-hour interval, and a similar number for different periods of the year. In such
schemes the ratio of cost per kWh during a period of peak demand for the year, and
that for the lowest-load period of the year, may be as much as 10: 1.
Meters
It will be appreciated that high-quality instruments and devices are necessary to
implement this kind of metering, when using classical electro-mechanical equipment.
Recent developments in electronic metering and micro-processors, together with
remote ripple-control(1) from an utility control centre (to change peak-period timing
throughout the year, etc.) are now operational, and facilitate considerably the
application of the principles discussed.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In most countries, some tariffs, as noted above, are partly based on kVA demand,
in addition to the kWh consumption, during the billing periods (often 3-monthly
intervals). The maximum demand registered by the meter to be described, is, in fact,
a maximum (i.e. the highest) average kVA demand registered for succeeding periods
during the billing interval.
(1) Ripple control is a system of signalling in which a voice
frequency current (commonly at 175 Hz) is injected into the
LV mains at appropriate substations. The signal is injected
as coded impulses, and relays which are tuned to the signal
frequency and which recognize the particular code will operate
to initiate a required function. In this way, up to 960 discrete
control signals are available.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Tariffs and metering
Figure C10 shows a typical kVA demand curve over a period of two hours divided
into succeeding periods of 10 minutes. The meter measures the average value of
kVA during each of these 10 minute periods.
C17
kVA
Maximum average value
during the 2 hour interval
Average values
for 10 minute
periods
t
0
1
2 hrs
Fig. C10 : Maximum average value of kVA over an interval of 2 hours
Principle of kVA maximum demand metering
A kVAh meter is similar in all essentials to a kWh meter but the current and voltage
phase relationship has been modified so that it effectively measures kVAh (kilovolt-ampere-hours). Furthermore, instead of having a set of decade counter dials,
as in the case of a conventional kWh meter, this instrument has a rotating pointer.
When the pointer turns it is measuring kVAh and pushing a red indicator before it.
At the end of 10 minutes the pointer will have moved part way round the dial (it is
designed so that it can never complete one revolution in 10 minutes) and is then
electrically reset to the zero position, to start another 10 minute period. The red
indicator remains at the position reached by the measuring pointer, and that position,
corresponds to the number of kVAh (kilo-volt-ampere-hours) taken by the load in
10 minutes. Instead of the dial being marked in kVAh at that point however it can be
marked in units of average kVA. The following figures will clarify the matter.
Supposing the point at which the red indicator reached corresponds to 5 kVAh.
It is known that a varying amount of kVA of apparent power has been flowing for
10 minutes, i.e. 1/6 hour.
If now, the 5 kVAh is divided by the number of hours, then the average kVA for the
period is obtained.
In this case the average kVA for the period will be:
1
5x
= 5 x 6 = 30 kVA
1
6
Every point around the dial will be similarly marked i.e. the figure for average kVA will
be 6 times greater than the kVAh value at any given point. Similar reasoning can be
applied to any other reset-time interval.
At the end of the billing period, the red indicator will be at the maximum of all the
average values occurring in the billing period.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The red indicator will be reset to zero at the beginning of each billing period. Electromechanical meters of the kind described are rapidly being replaced by electronic
instruments. The basic measuring principles on which these electronic meters
depend however, are the same as those described above.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter D
MV & LV architecture selection
guide
Contents
1
2
3
D3
Simplified architecture design process
D4
2.1 The architecture design
2.2 The whole process
D4
D5
Electrical installation characteristics
D7
3.1 Activity
3.2 Site topology
3.3 Layout latitude
3.4 Service reliability
3.5 Maintainability
3.6 Installation flexibility
3.7 Power demand
3.8 Load distribution
3.9 Power interruption sensitivity
3.10 Disturbance sensitivity
3.11 Disturbance capability of circuits
3.12 Other considerations or constraints
D7
D7
D7
D8
D8
D8
D9
D9
D9
D10
D10
D10
4
Technological characteristics
D11
4.1 Environment, atmosphere
4.2 Service Index
4.3 Other considerations
D11
D11
D12
5
Architecture assessment criteria
D13
5.1 On-site work time
5.2 Environmental impact
5.3 Preventive maintenance level
5.4 Availability of electrical power supply
D13
D13
D14
D14
6
Choice of architecture fundamentals
D15
6.1 Connection to the upstream network
6.2 MV circuit configuration
6.3 Number and distribution of MV/LV transformation substations
6.4 Number of MV/LV transformers
6.5 MV back-up generator
D15
D16
D17
D18
D18
7
Choice of architecture details
D19
7.1 Layout
7.2 Centralized or distributed layout
7.3 Presence of back-up generators
7.4 Presence of an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)
7.5 Configuration of LV circuits
D19
D20
D21
D22
D22
8
Choice of equiment
D25
D1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Stakes for the user
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
Recommendations for architecture optimization
D26
9.1 On-site work time
9.2 Environmental impact
9.3 Preventive maintenance volume
9.4 Electrical power availability
D26
D26
D28
D29
10
11
12
Glossary
D30
ID-Spec software
D31
Example: electrical installation in a printworks
D32
12.1 Brief description
12.2 Installation characteristics
12.3 Technological characteristics
12.4 Architecture assessment criteria
12.5 Choice of technogical solutions
D32
D32
D32
D33
D35
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D2
9
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
1 Stakes for the user
Choice of distribution architecture
The choice of distribution architecture has a decisive impact on installation
performance throughout its lifecycle:
b right from the construction phase, choices can greatly influence the installation
time, possibilities of work rate, required competencies of installation teams, etc.
b there will also be an impact on performance during the operation phase in terms
of quality and continuity of power supply to sensitive loads, power losses in power
supply circuits,
b and lastly, there will be an impact on the proportion of the installation that can be
recycled in the end-of-life phase.
D3
The Electrical Distribution architecture of an installation involves the spatial
configuration, the choice of power sources, the definition of different distribution
levels, the single-line diagram and the choice of equipment.
The choice of the best architecture is often expressed in terms of seeking a
compromise between the various performance criteria that interest the customer who
will use the installation at different phases in its lifecycle. The earlier we search for
solutions, the more optimization possibilities exist (see Fig. D1).
Potential for
optimization
Ecodial
Preliminary
design
ID-Spec
Detailled
design
Installation
Exploitation
A successful search for an optimal solution is also strongly linked to the ability for
exchange between the various players involved in designing the various sections of
a project:
b the architect who defines the organization of the building according to user
requirements,
b the designers of different technical sections (lighting, heating, air conditioning,
fluids, etc.),
b the user’s representatives e.g. defining the process.
The following paragraphs present the selection criteria as well as the architecture
design process to meet the project performance criteria in the context of industrial
and tertiary buildings (excluding large sites).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D1 : Optimization potential
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
2 Simplified architecture design
process
2.1 The architecture design
The architecture design considered in this document is positioned at the Draft
Design stage. It generally covers the levels of MV/LV main distribution, LV power
distribution, and exceptionally the terminal distribution level. (see Fig. D2).
D4
MV/LV main
distribution
LV power
distribution
LV terminal
distribution
M
M
M
M
Fig. D2 : Example of single-line diagram
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The design of an electrical distribution architecture can be described by a 3-stage
process, with iterative possibilities. This process is based on taking account of the
installation characteristics and criteria to be satisfied.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Simplified architecture design
process
2.2 The whole process
The whole process is described briefly in the following paragraphs and illustrated on
Figure D3.
The process described in this document is not intended as the only solution. This
document is a guide intended for the use of electrical installation designers.
D5
Data
See § 3
Step
Installation
characteristics
Deliverable
See § 6
Step 1
Choice of
fundamentals
Schematic
diagram
See § 7
Step 2
Choice of
architecture details
Detailed
diagram
See § 4
Technological
characteristics
See § 8
Step 3
Choice of
equipment
Techno.
Solution
See § 5
Assessment
criteria
See § 9
ASSESSMENT
Optimisation
recommendations
Definitive
solution
Fig. D3 : Flow diagram for choosing the electrical distribution architecture
This involves defining the general features of the electrical installation. It is based
on taking account of macroscopic characteristics concerning the installation and its
usage.
These characteristics have an impact on the connection to the upstream network,
MV circuits, the number of transformer substations, etc.
At the end of this step, we have several distribution schematic diagram solutions,
which are used as a starting point for the single-line diagram. The definitive choice is
confirmed at the end of the step 2.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Step 1: Choice of distribution architecture fundamentals
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
2 Simplified architecture design
process
Step 2: choice of architecture details
This involves defining the electrical installation in more detail. It is based on the
results of the previous step, as well as on satisfying criteria relative to implementation
and operation of the installation.
The process loops back into step1 if the criteria are not satisfied. An iterative process
allows several assessment criteria combinations to be analyzed.
At the end of this step, we have a detailed single-line diagram.
D6
Step 3: choice of equipment
The choice of equipment to be implemented is carried out in this stage, and results
from the choice of architecture. The choices are made from the manufacturer
catalogues, in order to satisfy certain criteria.
This stage is looped back into step 2 if the characteristics are not satisfied.
Assessment
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
This assessment step allows the Engineering Office to have figures as a basis for
discussions with the customer and other players.
According to the result of these discussions, it may be possible to loop back into step 1.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
3 Electrical installation
characteristics
These are the main installation characteristics enabling the defining of the
fundamentals and details of the electrical distribution architecture. For each of these
characteristics, we supply a definition and the different categories or possible values.
3.1 Activity
Definition:
D7
Main economic activity carried out on the site.
Indicative list of sectors considered for industrial buildings:
b Manufacturing
b Food & Beverage
b Logistics
Indicative list of sectors considered for tertiary buildings:
b Offices buildings
b Hypermarkets
b Shopping malls
3.2 Site topology
Definition:
Architectural characteristic of the building(s), taking account of the number of
buildings, number of floors, and of the surface area of each floor.
Different categories:
b Single storey building,
b Multi-storey building,
b Multi-building site,
b High-rise building.
3.3 Layout latitude
Definition:
Characteristic taking account of constraints in terms of the layout of the electrical
equipment in the building:
b aesthetics,
b accessibility,
b presence of dedicated locations,
b use of technical corridors (per floor),
b use of technical ducts (vertical).
Different categories:
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Low: the position of the electrical equipment is virtually imposed
b Medium: the position of the electrical equipment is partially imposed, to the
detriment of the criteria to be satisfied
b High: no constraints. The position of the electrical equipment can be defined to
best satisfy the criteria.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
mini = 5mm
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
3.4 Service reliability
Definition:
The ability of a power system to meet its supply function under stated conditions for
a specified period of time.
Different categories:
D8
b Minimum: this level of service reliability implies risk of interruptions related to
constraints that are geographical (separate network, area distant from power
production centers), technical (overhead line, poorly meshed system), or economic
(insufficient maintenance, under-dimensioned generation).
b Standard
b Enhanced: this level of service reliability can be obtained by special measures
taken to reduce the probability of interruption (underground network, strong meshing,
etc.)
3.5 Maintainability
Definition:
Features input during design to limit the impact of maintenance actions on the
operation of the whole or part of the installation.
Different categories:
b Minimum: the installation must be stopped to carry out maintenance operations.
b Standard: maintenance operations can be carried out during installation
operations, but with deteriorated performance. These operations must be preferably
scheduled during periods of low activity. Example: several transformers with partial
redundancy and load shedding.
b Enhanced: special measures are taken to allow maintenance operations without
disturbing the installation operations. Example: double-ended configuration.
3.6 Installation flexibility
Definition:
Possibility of easily moving electricity delivery points within the installation, or to
easily increase the power supplied at certain points. Flexibility is a criterion which
also appears due to the uncertainty of the building during the pre-project summary
stage.
Different categories:
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b No flexibility: the position of loads is fixed throughout the lifecycle, due to the high
constraints related to the building construction or the high weight of the supplied
process. E.g.: smelting works.
b Flexibility of design: the number of delivery points, the power of loads or their
location are not precisely known.
b Implementation flexibility: the loads can be installed after the installation is
commissioned.
b Operating flexibility: the position of loads will fluctuate, according to process reorganization.
Examples:
v industrial building: extension, splitting and changing usage
v office building: splitting
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Electrical installation
characteristics
3.7 Power demand
Definition:
The sum of the apparent load power (in kVA), to which is applied a usage coefficient.
This represents the maximum power which can be consumed at a given time for the
installation, with the possibility of limited overloads that are of short duration.
Significant power ranges correspond to the transformer power limits most commonly
used:
b < 630kVA
b from 630 to 1250kVA
b from 1250 to 2500kVA
b > 2500kVA
D9
3.8 Load distribution
Definition:
A characteristic related to the uniformity of load distribution (in kVA / m²) over an area
or throughout the building.
Different categories:
b Uniform distribution: the loads are generally of an average or low unit power and
spread throughout the surface area or over a large area of the building (uniform
density).
E.g.: lighting, individual workstations
b intermediate distribution: the loads are generally of medium power, placed in
groups over the whole building surface area
E.g.: machines for assembly, conveying, workstations, modular logistics “sites”
b localized loads: the loads are generally high power and localized in several areas
of the building (non-uniform density).
E.g.: HVAC
3.9 Power Interruption Sensitivity
Definition:
The aptitude of a circuit to accept a power interruption.
Different categories:
b “Sheddable” circuit: possible to shut down at any time for an indefinite duration
b Long interruption acceptable: interruption time > 3 minutes *
b Short interruption acceptable: interruption time < 3 minutes *
b No interruption acceptable.
This is expressed in terms of the criticality of supplying of loads or circuits.
b Non-critical:
The load or the circuit can be “shed” at any time. E.g.: sanitary water heating circuit.
b Low criticality:
A power interruption causes temporary discomfort for the occupants of a building,
without any financial consequences. Prolonging of the interruption beyond the critical
time can cause a loss of production or lower productivity. E.g.: heating, ventilation
and air conditioning circuits (HVAC).
b Medium criticality
A power interruption causes a short break in process or service. Prolonging of
the interruption beyond a critical time can cause a deterioration of the production
facilities or a cost of starting for starting back up.
E.g.: refrigerated units, lifts.
b High criticality
Any power interruption causes mortal danger or unacceptable financial losses.
E.g.: operating theatre, IT department, security department.
* indicative value, supplied by standard EN50160:
“Characteristics of the voltage supplied by public distribution
networks”.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
We can distinguish various levels of severity of an electrical power interruption,
according to the possible consequences:
b No notable consequence,
b Loss of production,
b Deterioration of the production facilities or loss of sensitive data,
b Causing mortal danger.
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
3 Electrical installation
characteristics
3.10 Disturbance sensitivity
Definition
The ability of a circuit to work correctly in presence of an electrical power
disturbance.
D10
A disturbance can lead to varying degrees of malfunctioning. E.g.: stopping working,
incorrect working, accelerated ageing, increase of losses, etc
Types of disturbances with an impact on circuit operations:
b brown-outs,
b overvoltages
b voltage distortion,
b voltage fluctuation,
b voltage imbalance.
Different categories:
b low sensitivity: disturbances in supply voltages have very little effect on operations.
E.g.: heating device.
b medium sensitivity: voltage disturbances cause a notable deterioration in
operations.
E.g.: motors, lighting.
b high sensitivity: voltage disturbances can cause operation stoppages or even the
deterioration of the supplied equipment.
E.g.: IT equipment.
The sensitivity of circuits to disturbances determines the design of shared or
dedicated power circuits. Indeed it is better to separate “sensitive” loads from
“disturbing” loads. E.g.: separating lighting circuits from motor supply circuits.
This choice also depends on operating features. E.g.: separate power supply of
lighting circuits to enable measurement of power consumption.
3.11 Disturbance capability of circuits
Definition
The ability of a circuit to disturb the operation of surrounding circuits due to
phenomena such as: harmonics, in-rush current, imbalance, High Frequency
currents, electromagnetic radiation, etc.
Different categories
b Non disturbing: no specific precaution to take
b moderate or occasional disturbance: separate power supply may be necessary in
the presence of medium or high sensitivity circuits. E.g.: lighting circuit generating
harmonic currents.
b Very disturbing: a dedicated power circuit or ways of attenuating disturbances are
essential for the correct functioning of the installation. E.g.: electrical motor with a
strong start-up current, welding equipment with fluctuating current.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3.12 Other considerations or constraints
b Environment
E.g.: lightning classification, sun exposure
b Specific rules
E.g.: hospitals, high rise buildings, etc.
b Rule of the Energy Distributor
Example: limits of connection power for LV, access to MV substation, etc
b Attachment loads
Loads attached to 2 independent circuits for reasons of redundancy.
b Designer experience
Consistency with previous designs or partial usage of previous designs,
standardization of sub-assemblies, existence of an installed equipment base.
b Load power supply constraints
Voltage level (230V, 400V, 690V), voltage system (single-phase, three-phase with or
without neutral, etc)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
4 Technological characteristics
The technological solutions considered concern the various types of MV and LV
equipment, as well as Busbar Trunking Systems .
The choice of technological solutions is made following the choice of single-line
diagram and according to characteristics given below.
4.1 Environment, atmosphere
A notion taking account of all of the environmental constraints (average ambient
temperature, altitude, humidity, corrosion, dust, impact, etc.) and bringing together
protection indexes IP and IK.
Different categories:
b Standard: no particular environmental constraints
b Enhanced: severe environment, several environmental parameters generate
important constraints for the installed equipment
b Specific: atypical environment, requiring special enhancements
D11
4.2 Service Index
The service index (IS) is a value that allows us to characterize an LV switchboard
according to user requirements in terms of operation, maintenance, and scalability.
The different index values are indicated in the following table (Fig D4):
Operation (setting, measurement,
locking, padlocking)
Maintenance (cleaning, checking,
testing, repaining)
Upgrade (addition, modification,
site expansion)z
Level 1
IS = 1 • •
Operation may lead to complete
stoppage of the switchboard
IS = • 1 •
Operation may lead to complete
stoppage of the switchboard
IS = • • 1
Operation may lead to complete
stoppage of the switchboard
Level 2
IS = 2 • •
Operation may lead to stoppage of
only the functional unit
IS = • 2 •
Operation may lead to stoppage of
only the functional unit, with work on
connections
IS = • • 2
Operation may lead to stoppage
of only the functional unit, with
functional units provided for back-up
Level 3
IS = 3 • •
Operation may lead to stoppage of
the power of the functional unit only
IS = • 3 •
Operation may lead to stoppage of
only the functional unit, without work
on connections
IS = • • 3
Operation may lead to stoppage of
only the functional unit, with total
freedom in terms of upgrade
Fig. D4 : Different index values
There are a limited number of relevant service indices (see Fig. D5)
The types of electrical connections of functional units can be denoted by a threeletter code:
b The first letter denotes the type of electrical connection of the main incoming
circuit,
b The second letter denotes the type of electrical connection of the main outgoing
circuit,
b The third letter denotes the type of electrical connection of the auxiliary circuits.
Service ratings are related to other mechanical parameters, such as the Protection
Index (IP), form of internal separations, the type of connection of functional units or
switchgear (Fig. D5):
Technological examples are given in chapter E2.
b Definition of the protection index: see IEC 60529: “Degree of protection given by
enclosures (IP code)”,
b Definitions of the form and withdrawability: see IEC 61439-2: "Low-voltage
switchgear and controlgear assemblies – Part 2: Power switchgear and controlgear
assemblies".
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
mini = 5mm
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The following letters are used:
b F for fixed connections,
b D for disconnectable connections,
b W for withdrawable connections.
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
D12
4 Technological characteristics
Service rating IS
111
211
Protection Index
IP
2XX
2XB
212
223
232
233
332
333
2XB
2XB
2XB
2XB
2XB
Form
1
1
Functional Unit
Withdrawability
FFF
FFF
3b 2b 4a
3b
3b
3b
3b
3b
WFW
WFD
WFW
WWW
WWW
WWW
Operation
Switching off
the whole
switchboard
Individually switching off the functional unit and re-commissioning < 1H
Maintenance
Working time > 1 h with total unavailability
Working time
between 1/4
h and 1h,
with work on
connections
Working time between 1/4 h and 1h, without work on connections
Upgrade
Extention not planned
Possible
adding of
functional
units without
stopping the
switchboard
Possible adding
of functional
units with
stopping the
switchboard
Possible
adding of
functional units
with stopping
the switchboard
Possible adding
of functional
units without
stopping the
switchboard
Individually switching off
the functional unit and
re-commissioning < 1/4h
Possible adding
of functional
units with
stopping the
switchboard
Possible
adding of
functional
units without
stopping the
switchboard
Fig. D5 : correspondance between service index and other mechanical parameters and relevant service index
4.3 Other considerations
Other considerations have an impact on the choice of technological solutions:
b Designer experience,
b Consistency with past designs or the partial use of past designs,
b Standardization of sub-assemblies,
b The existence of an installed equipment base,
b Utilities requirements,
b Technical criteria: target power factor, backed-up load power, presence of harmonic
generators…
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These considerations should be taken into account during the detailed electrical
definition phase following the draft design stage.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
5 Architecture assessment criteria
Certain decisive criteria are assessed at the end of the 3 stages in defining
architecture, in order to validate the architecture choice. These criteria are listed
below with the different allocated levels of priority.
5.1 On-site work time
D13
Time for implementing the electrical equipment on the site.
Different levels of priority:
b Secondary: the on-site work time can be extended, if this gives a reduction in
overall installation costs,
b Special: the on-site work time must be minimized, without generating any
significant excess cost,
b Critical: the on-site work time must be reduced as far as possible, imperatively,
even if this generates a higher total installation cost,
5.2 Environmental impact
Taking into consideration environmental constraints in the installation design. This
takes account of: consumption of natural resources, Joule losses (related to CO2
emission), “recyclability” potential, throughout the installation’s lifecycle.
Different levels of priority:
b Non significant: environmental constraints are not given any special consideration,
b Minimal: the installation is designed with minimum regulatory requirements,
b Proactive: the installation is designed with a specific concern for protecting
the environment. Excess cost is allowed in this situation. E.g.: using low-loss
transformers.
The environmental impact of an installation will be determined according to the
method carrying out an installation lifecycle analysis, in which we distinguish
between the following 3 phases:
b manufacture,
b operation,
b end of life (dismantling, recycling).
In terms of environmental impact, 3 indicators (at least) can be taken into account
and influenced by the design of an electrical installation. Although each lifecycle
phase contributes to the three indicators, each of these indicators is mainly related to
one phase in particular:
b consumption of natural resources mainly has an impact on the manufacturing
phase,
b consumption of energy has an impact on the operation phase,
b “recycleability” potential has an impact on the end of life.
The following table details the contributing factors to the 3 environmental indicators
(Fig D7).
Indicators
Contributors
Natural resources consumption
Mass and type of materials used
Power consumption
Joule losses at full load and no load
«Recyclability» potential
Mass and type of material used
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig D7 : Contributing factors to the 3 environmental indicators
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
mini = 5mm
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
5 Architecture assessment criteria
5.3 Preventive maintenance level
Definition:
Number of hours and sophistication of maintenance carried out during operations in
conformity with manufacturer recommendations to ensure dependable operation of
the installation and the maintaining of performance levels (avoiding failure: tripping,
down time, etc).
D14
Different categories:
b Standard: according to manufacturer recommendations.
b Enhanced: according to manufacturer recommendations, with a severe
environment,
b Specific: specific maintenance plan, meeting high requirements for continuity of
service, and requiring a high level of maintenance staff competency.
5.4 Availability of electrical power supply
Definition:
This is the probability that an electrical installation be capable of supplying quality
power in conformity with the specifications of the equipment it is supplying. This is
expressed by an availability level:
Availability (%) = (1 - MTTR/ MTBF) x 100
MTTR (Mean Time To Repair): the average time to make the electrical system once
again operational following a failure (this includes detection of the reason for failure,
its repair and re-commissioning),
MTBF (Mean Time Between Failure): measurement of the average time for which
the electrical system is operational and therefore enables correct operation of the
application.
The different availability categories can only be defined for a given type of
installation. E.g.: hospitals, data centers.
Example of classification used in data centers:
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Tier 1: the power supply and air conditioning are provided by one single channel,
without redundancy, which allows availability of 99.671%,
Tier 2: the power supply and air conditioning are provided by one single channel,
with redundancy, which allows availability of 99.741%,
Tier 3: the power supply and air conditioning are provided by several channels, with
one single redundant channel, which allows availability of 99.982%,
Tier 4: the power supply and air conditioning are provided by several channels, with
redundancy, which allows availability of 99.995%.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
6 Choice of architecture
fundamentals
The single-line diagram can be broken down into different key parts, which are
determined throughout a process in 2 successive stages. During the first stage we
make the following choices:
b connection to the utilities network,
b configuration of MV circuits,
b number of power transformers,
b number and distribution of transformation substations,
b MV back-up generator
D15
6.1 Connection to the upstream network
The main configurations for possible connection are as follows (see Fig. D8 for MV
service):
b LV service,
b MV single-line service,
b MV ring-main service,
b MV duplicate supply service,
b MV duplicate supply service with double busbar.
Metering, protection, disconnection devices, located in the delivery substations are
not represented on the following diagrams. They are often specific to each utilities
company and do not have an influence on the choice of installation architecture.
For each connection, one single transformer is shown for simplification purposes, but
in the practice, several transformers can be connected.
(MLVS: Main Low Voltage Switchboard)
b) Ring-main:
MV
MV
LV
LV
MLVS
MLVS
c) Duplicate supply:
d) Double busbar with duplicate supply:
MV
MV
MV
LV
LV
LV
MLVS
MLVS1
MLVS2
Fig. D8 : MV connection to the utilities network
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
mini = 5mm
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
a) Single-line:
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
For the different possible configurations, the most probable and usual set of
characteristics is given in the following table:
Configuration
LV
D16
MV
Characteristic to
consider
Simple-line
Ring-main
Duplicate supply
Duplicate supply
with double
busbars
Activity
Any
Any
Any
Hi-tech, sensitive
office, health-care
Any
Site topology
Single building
Single building
Single building
Single building
Several buildings
Service reliability
Minimal
Minimal
Enhanced
Enhanced
< 630kVA
1250kVA
Standard
Power demand
> 2500kVA
> 2500kVA
Other connection
constraints
Any
Isolated site
High density
urban area
Urban area with
utility constraint
2500kVA
Low density urban
area
6.2 MV circuit configuration
The main possible connection configurations are as follows (Fig. D9):
b single feeder, one or several transformers
b open ring, one MV incomer
b open ring, 2 MV incomers
The basic configuration is a radial single-feeder architecture, with one single
transformer.
In the case of using several transformers, no ring is realised unless all of the
transformers are located in a same substation.
Closed-ring configuration is not taken into account.
a) Single feeder:
b) Open ring, 1 MV substation:
c) Open ring, 2 MV substations:
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
MV
LV
LV
LV
LV
LV
LV
LV
LV
MLVS 1
MLVS n
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
MLVS n
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D9 : MV circuit configuration
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
MLVS n
6 Choice of architecture
fundamentals
For the different possible configurations, the most probable and usual set of
characteristics is given in the table on Fig D10.
MV circuit configuration
Characteristic to
consider
Single feeder
Open ring
1 MV substation
Open ring
2 MV substations
Site topology
Any
< 25000m²
Building with one
level or several
buildings
25000m²
Several buildings
25000m²
Enhanced
Maintainability
Minimal or standard
Enhanced
Power demand
Any
> 1250kVA
> 2500kVA
Disturbance sensitivity
Long interruption
acceptable
Short interruption
acceptable
Short interruption
acceptable
D17
Fig. D10 : Typical values of the installation characteristics
Another exceptional configuration: power supply by 2 MV substations and connection
of the transformers to each of these 2 substations (MV “double ended” connection).
6.3 Number and distribution of MV/LV
transformation substations
Main characteristics to consider to determine the transformation substations:
b Surface area of building or site
b Power demand, (to be compared with standardized transformer power),
b Load distribution
The preferred basic configuration comprises one single substation. Certain factors
contribute to increasing the number of substations (> 1):
b A large surface area (> 25000m²),
b The site configuration: several buildings,
b Total power > 2500kVA,
b Sensitivity to interruption: need for redundancy in the case of a fire.
Configuration
Characteristic to
consider
1 substation with
N transformers
N substations
N transformers
(identical substations)
Building configuration
< 25000m²
Power demand
< 2500kVA
2500kVA
2500kVA
Load distribution
Localized loads
Uniform distribution
Medium density
25000m²
1 building with several
floors
N substations
M transformers
(different powers)
25000m²
several buildings
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D11 : Typical characteristics of the different configurations
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
6 Choice of architecture
fundamentals
6.4 Number of MV/LV transformers
D18
Main characteristics to consider to determine the number of transformers:
b Surface of building or site
b Total power of the installed loads
b Sensitivity of circuits to power interruptions
b Sensitivity of circuits to disturbances
b Installation scalability
The basic preferred configuration comprises a single transformer supplying the total
power of the installed loads. Certain factors contribute to increasing the number of
transformers (> 1), preferably of equal power:
b A high total installed power (> 1250kVA): practical limit of unit power
(standardization, ease of replacement, space requirement, etc),
b A large surface area (> 5000m²): the setting up of several transformers as close as
possible to the distributed loads allows the length of LV trunking to be reduced
b A need for partial redundancy (down-graded operation possible in the case of a
transformer failure) or total redundancy (normal operation ensured in the case a
transformer failure)
b Separating of sensitive and disturbing loads (e.g.: IT, motors)
6.5 MV back-up generator
Main characteristics to consider for the implementation of an MV back-up generator:
b Site activity
b Total power of the installed loads
b Sensitivity of circuits to power interruptions
b Availability of the public distribution network
The preferred basic configuration does not include an MV generator. Certain factors
contribute to installing an MV generator:
b Site activity: process with co-generation, optimizing the energy bill,
b Low availability of the public distribution network.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Installation of a back-up generator can also be carried out at LV level.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
7 Choice of architecture details
This is the second stage in designing of the electrical installation. During this stage
we carry out the following choices are carried out:
b Layout,
b Centralized or decentralized distribution,
b Presence of back-up generators,
b Presence of uninterruptible power supplies,
b Configuration of LV circuits,
b Architecture combinations.
D19
7.1 Layout
Position of the main MV and LV equipment on the site or in the building.
This layout choice is applied to the results of stage 1.
Selection guide:
b Place power sources as close as possible to the barycenter of power consumers,
b Reduce atmospheric constraints: building dedicated premises if the layout in the
workshop is too restrictive (temperature, vibrations, dust, etc.),
b Placing heavy equipment (transformers, generators, etc) close to walls or main
exists for ease of maintenance,
A layout example is given in the following diagram (Fig. D12):
Global current
consumer
Barycenter
Finishing
Panel
shop
Office
Painting
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D12 : The position of the global current consumer barycenter guides the positioning of power sources
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
mini = 5mm
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
7.2 Centralized or distributed layout
In centralized layout, current consumers are connected to the power sources
by a star-connection. Cables are suitable for centralized layout, with point to point
links between the MLVS and current consumers or sub-distribution boards (radial
distribution, star- distribution) (Fig. D13):
D20
Fig. D13: Example of centralized layout with point to point links
In decentralized layout, current consumers are connected to sources via a busway.
Busbar trunking systems are well suited to decentralized layout, to supply many
loads that are spread out, making it easy to change, move or add connections
(Fig D14):
Fig. D14 : Example of decentralized layout, with busbar trunking links
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Factors in favour of centralized layout (see summary table in Fig. D15):
b Installation flexibility: no,
b Load distribution: localized loads (high unit power loads).
Factors in favor of decentralized layout:
b Installation flexibility: "Implementation" flexibility (moving of workstations, etc…),
b Load distribution: uniform distribution of low unit power loads
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Choice of architecture details
Load distribution
Flexibility
Localized loads
Intermediate
distribution
Uniform distributed
No flexibility
Centralized
Design flexibility
Implementation
flexibility
Decentralized
Centralized
Decentralized
D21
Operation flexibility
Fig. D15 : Recommendations for centralized or decentralized layout
Power supply by cables gives greater independence of circuits (lighting, power
sockets, HVAC, motors, auxiliaries, security, etc), reducing the consequences of a
fault from the point of view of power availability.
The use of busbar trunking systems allows load power circuits to be combined and
saves on conductors by taking advantage of a clustering coefficient. The choice
between cable and busbar trunking, according to the clustering coefficient, allows us
to find an economic optimum between investment costs, implementation costs and
operating costs.
These two distribution modes are often combined.
7.3 Presence of back-up generators (Fig. D16)
Here we only consider LV back-up generators.
The electrical power supply supplied by a back-up generator is produced by an
alternator, driven by a thermal engine.
No power can be produced until the generator has reached its rated speed. This type
of device is therefore not suitable for an uninterrupted power supply.
According to the generator’s capacity to supply power to all or only part of the
installation, there is either total or partial redundancy.
A back-up generator functions generally disconnected from the network. A source
switching system is therefore necessary.
The generator can function permanently or intermittently. Its back-up time depends
on the quantity of available fuel.
G
LV switchboard
Fig. D16 : Connection of a back-up generator
The main characteristics to consider for implementing LV back-up generator:
b Sensitivity of loads to power interruption,
b Availability of the public distribution network,
b Other constraints (e.g.: generators compulsory in hospitals or high-vise buildings)
The presence of a back-up generator is essential if the loads cannot be shed for
an indefinite duration (long interruption only acceptable) or if the utility network
availability is low.
Determining the number of back-up generator units is in line with the same criteria
as determining the number of transformers, as well as taking account of economic
and availability considerations (redundancy, start-up reliability, maintenance facility).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The presence of generators can be decided to reduce the energy bill or due to the
opportunity for co-generation. These two aspects are not taken into account in this
guide.
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
7.4 Presence of an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)
The electrical power from a UPS is supplied from a storage unit: batteries or inertia
wheel. This system allows us to avoid any power failure. The back-up time of the
system is limited: from several minutes to several hours.
The simultaneous presence of a back-up generator and a UPS unit is used for
permanently supply loads for which no failure is acceptable (Fig. D17). The back-up
time of the battery or the inertia wheel must be compatible with the maximum time
for the generator to start up and be brought on-line.
A UPS unit is also used for supply power to loads that are sensitive to disturbances
(generating a “clean” voltage that is independent of the network).
D22
Main characteristics to be considered for implementing a UPS:
b Sensitivity of loads to power interruptions,
b Sensitivity of loads to disturbances.
The presence of a UPS unit is essential if and only if no failure is acceptable.
G
LV Switchboard
Normal
By-pass
Non-critical
circuit
MLVS
ASI
Fig. D18 : Radial single feeder configuration
Critical
circuit
Fig. D17 : Example of connection for a UPS
7.5 Configuration of LV circuits
MLVS
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D19 : Two-pole configuration
MLVS
NO
Fig. D20 : Two-pole configuration with two ½ MLVS and NO link
Main possible configurations (see figures D18 to D25):
b Radial single feeder configuration: This is the reference configuration and
the most simple. A load is connected to only one single source. This configuration
provides a minimum level of availability, since there is no redundancy in case of
power source failure.
b Two-pole configuration: The power supply is provided by 2 transformers,
connected to the same MV line. When the transformers are close, they are generally
connected in parallel to the same MLVS.
b Variant: two-pole with two ½ MLVS: In order to increase the availability in case
of failure of the busbars or authorize maintenance on one of the transformers,
it is possible to split the MLVS into 2 parts, with a normally open link (NO). This
configuration generally requires an Automatic Transfer Switch, (ATS).
b Shedable switchboard (simple disconnectable attachment): A series of
shedable circuits can be connected to a dedicated switchboard. The connection to
the MLVS is interrupted when needed (overload, generator operation, etc)
b Interconnected switchboards: If transformers are physically distant from one
another, they may be connected by a busbar trunking. A critical load can be supplied
by one or other of the transformers. The availability of power is therefore improved,
since the load can always be supplied in the case of failure of one of the sources.
The redundancy can be:
v Total: each transformer being capable of supplying all of the installation,
v Partial: each transformer only being able to supply part of the installation. In this
case, part of the loads must be disconnected (load-shedding) in the case of one of
the transformers failing.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Choice of architecture details
MLVS
LV swichboard
D23
b Double-ended power supply: This configuration is implemented in cases where
maximum availability is required. The principle involves having 2 independent power
sources, e.g.:
v 2 transformers supplied by different MV lines,
v 1 transformer and 1 generator,
v 1 transformer and 1 UPS.
An automatic transfer switch (ATS) is used to avoid the sources being parallel
connected. This configuration allows preventive and curative maintenance to be
carried out on all of the electrical distribution system upstream without interrupting
the power supply.
Fig. D21 : Shedable switchboard
MLVS
b Ring configuration: This configuration can be considered as an extension of the
configuration with interconnection between switchboards. Typically, 4 transformers
connected to the same MV line, supply a ring using busbar trunking. A given load
is then supplied power by several clustered transformers. This configuration is well
suited to extended installations, with a high load density (in kVA/m²). If all of the loads
can be supplied by 3 transformers, there is total redundancy in the case of failure
of one of the transformers. In fact, each busbar can be fed power by one or other
of its ends. Otherwise, downgraded operation must be considered (with partial load
shedding). This configuration requires special design of the protection plan in order
to ensure discrimination in all of the fault circumstances.
MLVS
b Configuration combinations: An installation can be made up of several subasssemblies with different configurations, according to requirements for the
availability of the different types of load. E.g.: generator unit and UPS, choice by
sectors (some sectors supplied by cables and others by busbar trunking).
Busbar
or
G or
UPS
Fig. D22 : Interconnected switchboards
MLVS
MLVS
Fig. D24 : Double-ended configuration with automatic transfer switch
Busbar
1
Busbar
2
3
G
Busbar
Busbar
MLVS
MLVS
Busbar
Fig. D23 : Ring configuration
MLVS
Fig. D25 : Example of a configuration combination
1: Single feeder, 2: Switchboard interconnection, 3: Double-ended
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
MLVS
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
7 Choice of architecture details
For the different possible configurations, the most probable and usual set of
characteristics is given in the following table:
Configuration
Radial
Two-pole
Sheddable load
Interconnected
switchboards
Ring
Double-ended
Site topology
Any
Any
Any
1 level
5 to 25000m²
1 level
5 to 25000m²
Any
Location latitude
Any
Any
Any
Medium of high
Medium or high
Any
Maintainability
Minimal
Standard
Minimal
Standard
Standard
Enhanced
Power demand
< 2500kVA
Any
Any
1250kVA
> 2500kVA
Any
Load distribution
Localized loads
Localized loads
Localized load
Intermediate or
uniforme distribution
Uniform distribution
Localized loads
Interruptions sensitivity
Long
interruption
acceptable
Long
interruption
acceptable
Sheddable
Long
interruption
acceptable
Long
interruption
acceptable
Short or no
interruption
Disturbances sensitivity
Low sensitivity
High sensitivity
Low sensitivity
High sensitivity
High sensitivity
High sensitivity
Other constraints
/
/
/
/
/
Double-ended
loads
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D24
Characteristic to be
considered
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8 Choice of equipment
The choice of equipment is step 3 in the design of an electrical installation. The aim
of this step is to select equipment from the manufacturers’ catalogues. The choice of
technological solutions results from the choice of architecture.
List of equipment to consider:
b MV/LV substation,
b MV switchboards,
b Transformers,
b LV switchboards,
b Busbar trunking,
b UPS units,
b Power factor correction and filtering equipment.
D25
Criteria to consider:
b Atmosphere, environment,
b Service index,
b Offer availability per country,
b Utilities requirements,
b Previous architecture choices.
The choice of equipment is basically linked to the offer availability in the country. This
criterion takes into account the availability of certain ranges of equipment or local
technical support.
The detailed selection of equipment is out of the scope of this document.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
9 Recommendations for
architecture optimization
These recommendations are intended to guide the designer towards architecture
upgrades which allow him to improve assessment criteria.
9.1 On-site work
To be compatible with the “special” or “critical” work-site time, it is recommended to
limit uncertainties by applying the following recommendations:
b Use of proven solutions and equipment that has been validated and tested by
manufacturers (“functional” switchboard or “manufacturer” switchboard according to
the application criticality),
b Prefer the implementation of equipment for which there is a reliable distribution
network and for which it is possible to have local support (supplier well established),
b Prefer the use of factory-built equipment (MV/LV substation, busbar trunking),
allowing the volume of operations on site to be limited,
b Limit the variety of equipment implemented (e.g. the power of transformers),
b Avoid mixing equipment from different manufacturers.
D26
9.2 Environmental impact
The optimization of the environmental assessment of an installation will involve
reducing:
b Power losses at full load and no load during installation operation,
b Overall, the mass of materials used to produce the installation.
Taken separately and when looking at only one piece of equipment, these 2
objectives may seem contradictory. However, when applied to whole installation, it
is possible to design the architecture to contribute to both objectives. The optimal
installation will therefore not be the sum of the optimal equipment taken separately,
but the result of an optimization of the overall installation.
Figure D26 gives an example of the contribution per equipment category to the
weight and energy dissipation for a 3500 kVA installation spread over 10000m².
b Installation is operating at 50% load on average, with 0,8 power factor
b Site is operating 6500 hours per years : 3 shifts + week ends with reduced activity
at night and week ends and full stop 1 month per year for site maintenance and
employees holidays.
b Power consumption is 9,1 GWh
b Reactive power is 6,8 GVARh. This reactive power will be invoiced in addition to
power consumption according to local energy
contract.
Losses
due to the
equipment
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Energy
Usage
on site
Losses
due to 0,8
powerfactor
Losses 4%
LV switchboard
and switchgear
LV switchboard
and switchgear
5%
10 %
LV cables
and trunking
LV cables
and trunking
75 %
46 %
Transformers
Transformers
20 %
44 %
77 %
19 %
Total power usage
considered : 9,1 GWh
Total loss for equipment considered: 414 MWh Total mass of equipment considered: 18,900 kg
Fig. D26 : Example of the spread of losses and the weight of material for each equipment category
These data helps to understand and prioritize energy consumption and costs factors.
b Very first factor of power consumption is... energy usage. This can be optimized
with appropriate metering and analysis of loads actual consumption.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
9 Recommendations for
architecture optimization
Second is reactive energy. This lead to additional load on electrical network. and
additional energy invoicing. This can be optimized with power factor correction
solutions.
b Third is cables. Cable losses can be reduced by appropriate organisation and
design of site and use of busbar truncking instead of cables wherever accurate.
b MV to LV transformers are fourth with approx. 1% of losses.
b MV and LV switchboards come last with approximately 0,25% of losses.
Generally speaking, LV cables and trunking as well as the MV/LV transformers are
the main contributors to operating losses and the weight of equipment used.
D27
Environmental optimization of the installation by the architecture will therefore
involve:
b reducing the length of LV circuits in the installation,
b clustering LV circuits wherever possible to take advantage of the factor of
simultaneity ks (see chapter A: General rules of electrical installation design, Chapter
– Power loading of an installation, 4.3 “Estimation of actual maximum kVA demand”)
Objectives
Resources
Reducing the length of LV
circuits
Placing MV/LV substations as close as possible to the barycenter
of all of the LV loads to be supplied
Clustering LV circuits
When the simultaneity factor of a group of loads to be supplied
is less than 0.7, the clustering of circuits allows us to limit the
volume of conductors supplying power to these loads.
In real terms this involves:
b setting up sub-distribution switchboards as close as possible to
the barycenter of the groups of loads if they are localized,
b setting up busbar trunking systems as close as possible to the
barycenter of the groups of loads if they are distributed.
The search for an optimal solution may lead to consider several
clustering scenarios.
In all cases, reducing the distance between the barycenter of
a group of loads and the equipment that supplies them power
allows to reduce environmental impact.
Fig. D27 : Environmental optimization : Objectives and Ressources.
As an example figure D28 shows the impact of clustering circuits on reducing
the distance between the barycenter of the loads of an installation and that of the
sources considered (MLVS whose position is imposed). This example concerns a
mineral water bottling plant for which:
b the position of electrical equipment (MLVS) is imposed in the premises outside of
the process area for reasons of accessibility and atmosphere constraints,
b the installed power is around 4 MVA.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In solution No.1, the circuits are distributed for each workshop.
In solution No. 2, the circuits are distributed by process functions (production lines).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
Solution
Barycenter position
Workshop 1
N°1
Workshop 2
Workshop 3
Storage
MLVS area
D28
Workshop 1
Barycenter
N°2
Workshop 2
Barycenter
Workshop 1
Workshop 2
Workshop 3
Barycenter
Workshop 3
Storage
MLVS area
Barycenter
line 1
Barycenter
line 2
Barycenter
line 3
Barycenter
line 3
Fig. D28 : Example of barycenter positioning
Without changing the layout of electrical equipment, the second solution allows us
to achieve gains of around 15% on the weight of LV cables to be installed (gain on
lengths) and a better uniformity of transformer power.
To supplement the optimizations carried out in terms of architecture, the following
points also contribute to the optimization:
b the setting up of LV power factor correction to limit losses in the transformers and
LV circuits if this compensation is distributed,
b the use of low loss transformers,
b the use of aluminum LV busbar trunking when possible, since natural resources of
this metal are greater.
9.3 Preventive maintenance volume
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Recommendations for reducing the volume of preventive maintenance:
b Use the same recommendations as for reducing the work site time,
b Focus maintenance work on critical circuits,
b Standardize the choice of equipment,
b Use equipment designed for severe atmospheres (requires less maintenance).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
9 Recommendations for
architecture optimization
9.4 Electrical power availability
Recommendations for improving the electrical power availability:
b Reduce the number of feeders per switchboard, in order to limit the effects of a
possible failure of a switchboard,
b Distributing circuits according to availability requirements,
b Using equipment that is in line with requirements (see Service Index, 4.2),
b Follow the selection guides proposed for steps 1 & 2 (see Fig. D3 page D5).
D29
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Recommendations to increase the level of availability:
b Change from a radial single feeder configuration to a two-pole configuration,
b Change from a two-pole configuration to a double-ended configuration,
b Change from a double-ended configuration to a uninterruptible configuration with a
UPS unit and a Static Transfer Switch
b Increase the level of maintenance (reducing the MTTR, increasing the MTBF)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
10 Glossary
Architecture: choice of a single-line diagram and technological solutions, from
connection to the utility network through to load power supply circuits.
Main MV/LV distribution: Level upstream of the architecture, from connection
to the network utility through to LV distribution equipment on the site (MLVS – or
equivalent).
MLVS – Main Low Voltage Switchboard: Main switchboard downstream of the
MV/LV transformer, starting point of power distribution circuits in the installation
D30
LV power distribution: intermediate level in the architecture, downstream of the
main level through to the sub-distribution switchboards (spatial and functional
distribution of electrical power in the circuits).
LV terminal distribution: Downstream level of the architecture, downstream of the
sub-distribution switchboards through to the loads. This level of distribution is not
dealt with in this guide.
Single-line diagram: general electrical schematic diagram to represent the main
electrical equipment and their interconnection.
MV substation, transformation substation: Enclosures grouping together MV
equipment and/or MV/LV transformers. These enclosures can be shared or separate,
according to the site layout, or the equipment technology. In certain countries, the
MV substation is assimilated with the delivery substation.
Technological solution: Resulting from the choice of technology for an installation
sub-assembly, from among the different products and equipment proposed by the
manufacturer.
Characteristics: Technical or environmental data relative to the installation, enabling
the best-suited architecture to be selected.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Criteria: Parameters for assessing the installation, enabling selection of the
architecture that is the best-suited to the needs of the customer.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
11 ID-Spec software
ID-Spec is a new software which aims at helping the designer to be more productive
in draft design phase and argue easily his design decisions.
It supports the designer in selecting the relevant single line diagram patterns for main
distribution and sub distribution and in adapting these patterns to his project. It also
supports the designer in equipment technology and rating selection. Its generates
automatically the corresponding design specification documentation including single
line diagram and its argument, list and specification of the corresponding equipment.
D31
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
12 Example: electrical installation
in a printworks
12.1 Brief description
Printing of personalized mailshots intended for mail order sales.
12.2 Installation characteristics
D32
Characteristic
Category
Activity
Mechanical
Site topology
single storey building,
10000m² (8000m² dedicated to the process, 2000m² for
ancillary areas)
Layout latitude
High
Service reliability
Standard
Maintainability
Standard
Installation flexibility
b No flexibility planned:
v HVAC
v Process utilities
v Office power supply
b Possible flexibility:
v finishing, putting in envelopes
v special machines, installed at a later date
v rotary machines (uncertainty at the draft design stage)
Power demand
3500kVA
Load distribution
Intermediate distribution
Power interruptions sensitivity
b Sheddable circuits:
v offices (apart from PC power sockets)
v air conditioning, office heating
v social premises
v maintenance premises
b long interruptions acceptable:
v printing machines
v workshop HVAC (hygrometric control)
v Finishing, envelope filling
v Process utilities (compressor, recycling of cooled water)
b No interruptions acceptable:
v servers, office PCs
Disturbance sensitivity
b Average sensitivity:
v motors, lighting
b High sensitivity:
v IT
No special precaution to be taken due to the connection to
the EdF network (low level of disturbance)
Disturbance capability
Non disturbing
Other constraints
b Building with lightning classification: lightning surge
arresters installed
b Power supply by overhead single feeder line
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
12.3 Technological characteristics
Criteria
Category
Atmosphere, environment
b IP: standard (no dust, no water protection)
b IK: standard (use of technical pits, dedicated premises)
b °C: standard (temperature regulation)
Service index
211
Offer availability by country
No problem (project carried out in France)
Other criteria
Nothing particular
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
12 Example: electrical installation
in a printworks
12.4 Architecture assessment criteria
Criteria
Category
On-site work time
Secondary
Environmental impact
Minimal: compliance with European standard regulations
Preventive maintenance costs
Standard
Power supply availability
Level I
D33
Step 1: Architecture fundamentals
Choice
Main criteria
Solution
Connection to upstream
network
Isolated site
single branch circuit
MV Circuits
Layout + criticality
single feeder
Number of transformers
Power > 2500kVA
2 x 2000kVA
Number and distribution of
substations
Surface area and power
distribution
2 possible solutions: 1
substation or 2 substations
b if 1 substations: NO link
between MLVS
b if 2 substations:
interconnected switchboards
MV Generator
Site activity
No
MV
MV
MV
MV
LV
LV
LV
LV
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
Trunking
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D29 : Two possible single-line diagrams
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
D - MV & LV architecture selection guide
Step 2: Architecture details
“1 substation” solution
Choice
Main criteria
Solution
Layout
Atmospheric constraint
Dedicated premises
Centralized or decentralized
layout
Uniform loads, distributed
power, scalability possibilities
b Decentralized with busbar
trunking:
v finishing sector, envelope
filling
b Centralized with cables:
v special machines,
rotary machines, HVAC,
process utilities, offices
(2 switchboards), office air
conditioning, social premises,
maintenance
D34
Non-uniform loads, direct link
from MLVS
Presence of back-up
generator
Criticality low
Network availability: standard
Presence of UPS
Criticality
UPS unit for servers and office
PCs
LV circuit configuration
2 transformers, possible
partial redundancy
b Two-pole, variant 2 ½ MLVS
+ NO link (reduction of the Isc
by MLVS, no redundancy
b process ( weak)
b sheddable circuit for noncritical loads
No back-up generator
MV
MV
LV
LV
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
Trunking
ASI
HVAC
Sheddable
Offices
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D30 : Detailed single-line diagram (1 substation)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Machines
12 Example: electrical installation
in a printworks
12.5 Choice of technological solutions:
Choice
Main criteria
Solution
MV/LV substation
Atmosphere, environment
indoor (dedicated premises)
MV switchboard
Offer availability by country
SM6 (installation produced in
France)
Transformers
Atmosphere, environment
cast resin transfo (avoids
constraints related to oil)
LV switchboard
Atmosphere, IS
MLVS: Prisma + P
Sub-distribution: Prisma +
Busbar trunking
Installed power to be
supplied
Canalis KS
UPS units
Installed power to be
supplied, back-up time
Galaxy PW
Power factor correction
Installed power, presence of
harmonics
LV, standard, automatic
(Average Q, ease of
installation)
D35
“2 substation” solution
Ditto apart from:
LV circuit: 2 remote MLVS connected via busbar trunking
MV
MV
LV
LV
MLVS 1
MLVS 2
Trunking
Trunking
HVAC
Sheddable
ASI
Machines
Offices
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. D31 : Detailed single-line diagram (2 substations)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter E
LV Distribution
Contents
1
Earthing schemes
E2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
E2
E3
E6
E8
E10
E11
Earthing connections
Definition of standardised earthing schemes
Characteristics of TT, TN and IT systems
Selection criteria for the TT, TN and IT systems
Choice of earthing method - implementation
Installation and measurements of earth electrodes
2
The installation system
E15
2.1 Distribution switchboards
2.2 Cables and busways
E15
E19
3
External influences (IEC 60364-5-51)
E26
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
E26
E26
E26
E29
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Definition and reference standards
Classification
List of external influences
Protection provided for enclosed equipment: codes IP and IK
E1
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
1 Earthing schemes
In a building, the connection of all metal parts
of the building and all exposed conductive parts
of electrical equipment to an earth electrode
prevents the appearance of dangerously high
voltages between any two simultaneously
accessible metal parts
E2
Extraneous
conductive
parts
4
3
3
Main
protective
conductor
Heating
Definitions
National and international standards (IEC 60364) clearly define the various elements
of earthing connections. The following terms are commonly used in industry and in
the literature. Bracketed numbers refer to Figure E1 :
b Earth electrode (1): A conductor or group of conductors in intimate contact with,
and providing an electrical connection with Earth (cf details in section 1.6 of Chapter E.)
b Earth: The conductive mass of the Earth, whose electric potential at any point is
conventionally taken as zero
b Electrically independent earth electrodes: Earth electrodes located at such a
distance from one another that the maximum current likely to flow through one of
them does not significantly affect the potential of the other(s)
b Earth electrode resistance: The contact resistance of an earth electrode with the
Earth
b Earthing conductor (2): A protective conductor connecting the main earthing
terminal (6) of an installation to an earth electrode (1) or to other means of earthing
(e.g. TN systems);
b Exposed-conductive-part: A conductive part of equipment which can be touched
and which is not a live part, but which may become live under fault conditions
b Protective conductor (3): A conductor used for some measures of protection against
electric shock and intended for connecting together any of the following parts:
v Exposed-conductive-parts
v Extraneous-conductive-parts
v The main earthing terminal
v Earth electrode(s)
v The earthed point of the source or an artificial neutral
b Extraneous-conductive-part: A conductive part liable to introduce a potential,
generally earth potential, and not forming part of the electrical installation (4).
For example:
v Non-insulated floors or walls, metal framework of buildings
v Metal conduits and pipework (not part of the electrical installation) for water, gas,
heating, compressed-air, etc. and metal materials associated with them
b Bonding conductor (5): A protective conductor providing equipotential bonding
b Main earthing terminal (6): The terminal or bar provided for the connection of
protective conductors, including equipotential bonding conductors, and conductors
for functional earthing, if any, to the means of earthing.
Connections
5
Water
4
3
Branched
protective
conductors
to individual
consumers
1.1 Earthing connections
The main equipotential bonding system
The bonding is carried out by protective conductors and the aim is to ensure that,
in the event of an incoming extraneous conductor (such as a gas pipe, etc.) being
raised to some potential due to a fault external to the building, no difference of
potential can occur between extraneous-conductive-parts within the installation.
The bonding must be effected as close as possible to the point(s) of entry into the
building, and be connected to the main earthing terminal (6).
However, connections to earth of metallic sheaths of communications cables require
the authorisation of the owners of the cables.
5
Gas 5
6
7
Supplementary equipotential connections
These connections are intended to connect all exposed-conductive-parts and all
extraneous-conductive-parts simultaneously accessible, when correct conditions
for protection have not been met, i.e. the original bonding conductors present an
unacceptably high resistance.
2
1
Connection of exposed-conductive-parts to the earth electrode(s)
The connection is made by protective conductors with the object of providing a lowresistance path for fault currents flowing to earth.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E1 : An example of a block of flats in which the main
earthing terminal (6) provides the main equipotential connection;
the removable link (7) allows an earth-electrode-resistance
check
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
Components (see Fig. E2)
Effective connection of all accessible metal fixtures and all exposed-conductive-parts
of electrical appliances and equipment, is essential for effective protection against
electric shocks.
Component parts to consider:
as exposed-conductive-parts
Cableways
b Conduits
b Impregnated-paper-insulated lead-covered
cable, armoured or unarmoured
b Mineral insulated metal-sheathed cable
(pyrotenax, etc.)
Switchgear
b cradle of withdrawable switchgear
Appliances
b Exposed metal parts of class 1 insulated
appliances
Non-electrical elements
b metallic fittings associated with cableways
(cable trays, cable ladders, etc.)
b Metal objects:
v Close to aerial conductors or to busbars
v In contact with electrical equipment.
Component parts not to be considered:
as exposed-conductive-parts
Diverse service channels, ducts, etc.
b Conduits made of insulating material
b Mouldings in wood or other insulating
material
b Conductors and cables without metallic sheaths
Switchgear
b Enclosures made of insulating material
Appliances
b All appliances having class II insulation
regardless of the type of exterior envelope
as extraneous-conductive-parts
Elements used in building construction
b Metal or reinforced concrete (RC):
v Steel-framed structure
v Reinforcement rods
v Prefabricated RC panels
b Surface finishes:
v Floors and walls in reinforced concrete
without further surface treatment
v Tiled surface
b Metallic covering:
v Metallic wall covering
E3
Building services elements other than electrical
b Metal pipes, conduits, trunking, etc. for gas,
water and heating systems, etc.
b Related metal components (furnaces, tanks,
reservoirs, radiators)
b Metallic fittings in wash rooms, bathrooms,
toilets, etc.
b Metallised papers
as extraneous-conductive-parts
b Wooden-block floors
b Rubber-covered or linoleum-covered floors
b Dry plaster-block partition
b Brick walls
b Carpets and wall-to-wall carpeting
Fig. E2 : List of exposed-conductive-parts and extraneous-conductive-parts
1.2 Definition of standardised earthing schemes
The choice of these methods governs the measures necessary for protection against
indirect-contact hazards.
The earthing system qualifies three originally independent choices made by the
designer of an electrical distribution system or installation:
b The type of connection of the electrical system (that is generally of the neutral
conductor) and of the exposed parts to earth electrode(s)
b A separate protective conductor or protective conductor and neutral conductor
being a single conductor
b The use of earth fault protection of overcurrent protective switchgear which clear
only relatively high fault currents or the use of additional relays able to detect and
clear small insulation fault currents to earth
In practice, these choices have been grouped and standardised as explained below.
Each of these choices provides standardised earthing systems with three
advantages and drawbacks:
b Connection of the exposed conductive parts of the equipment and of the neutral
conductor to the PE conductor results in equipotentiality and lower overvoltages but
increases earth fault currents
b A separate protective conductor is costly even if it has a small cross-sectional area
but it is much more unlikely to be polluted by voltage drops and harmonics, etc. than a
neutral conductor is. Leakage currents are also avoided in extraneous conductive parts
b Installation of residual current protective relays or insulation monitoring devices are
much more sensitive and permits in many circumstances to clear faults before heavy
damage occurs (motors, fires, electrocution). The protection offered is in addition
independent with respect to changes in an existing installation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The different earthing schemes (often referred
to as the type of power system or system
earthing arrangements) described characterise
the method of earthing the installation
downstream of the secondary winding of a
MV/LV transformer and the means used for
earthing the exposed conductive-parts of the
LV installation supplied from it
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
Neutral
Exposed conductive parts
Earth
Earth
TT system (earthed neutral) (see Fig. E3)
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
One point at the supply source is connected directly to earth. All exposed- and
extraneous-conductive-parts are connected to a separate earth electrode at the
installation. This electrode may or may not be electrically independent of the source
electrode. The two zones of influence may overlap without affecting the operation of
protective devices.
TN systems (exposed conductive parts connected to the
neutral)
The source is earthed as for the TT system (above). In the installation, all exposedand extraneous-conductive-parts are connected to the neutral conductor. The several
versions of TN systems are shown below.
Rn
E4
Fig. E3 : TT System
Neutral
Exposed conductive parts
Earth
Neutral
L1
L2
L3
PEN
Rn
Fig. E4 : TN-C system
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
TN-C system (see Fig. E4)
The neutral conductor is also used as a protective conductor and is referred to as
a PEN (Protective Earth and Neutral) conductor. This system is not permitted for
conductors of less than 10 mm2 or for portable equipment.
The TN-C system requires an effective equipotential environment within the
installation with dispersed earth electrodes spaced as regularly as possible since
the PEN conductor is both the neutral conductor and at the same time carries phase
unbalance currents as well as 3rd order harmonic currents (and their multiples).
The PEN conductor must therefore be connected to a number of earth electrodes in
the installation.
Caution: In the TN-C system, the “protective conductor” function has priority over
the “neutral function”. In particular, a PEN conductor must always be connected to
the earthing terminal of a load and a jumper is used to connect this terminal to the
neutral terminal.
TN-S system (see Fig. E5)
The TN-S system (5 wires) is obligatory for circuits with cross-sectional areas less
than 10 mm2 for portable equipment.
The protective conductor and the neutral conductor are separate. On underground
cable systems where lead-sheathed cables exist, the protective conductor is
generally the lead sheath. The use of separate PE and N conductors (5 wires)
is obligatory for circuits with cross-sectional areas less than 10 mm2 for portable
equipment.
TN-C-S system (see Fig. E6 below and Fig. E7 next page)
The TN-C and TN-S systems can be used in the same installation. In the TN-C-S
system, the TN-C (4 wires) system must never be used downstream of the TN-S
(5 wires) system, since any accidental interruption in the neutral on the upstream
part would lead to an interruption in the protective conductor in the downstream part
and therefore a danger.
Rn
Fig. E5 : TN-S system
5 x 50 mm2
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
PEN
PE
16 mm2
6 mm2
16 mm2
16 mm2
PEN
Bad
Bad
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
TN-C scheme not permitted
downstream of TN-S scheme
Fig. E6 : TN-C-S system
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
4 x 95 mm2
L1
L2
L3
PEN
16 mm2
10 mm2
6 mm2
PEN
6 mm2
PEN
N
Correct
Incorrect
Correct
PEN connected to the neutral
terminal is prohibited
Neutral
Exposed conductive parts
Isolated or
impedance-earthed
Earth
E5
IT system (isolated or impedance-earthed neutral)
Fig. E8 : IT system (isolated neutral)
MV/LV
R1
C2
S < 10 mm 2
TNC prohibited
Fig. E7 : Connection of the PEN conductor in the TN-C system
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
C1
Incorrect
R2
R3
C3
IT system (isolated neutral)
No intentional connection is made between the neutral point of the supply source
and earth (see Fig. E8).
Exposed- and extraneous-conductive-parts of the installation are connected to an
earth electrode.
In practice all circuits have a leakage impedance to earth, since no insulation
is perfect. In parallel with this (distributed) resistive leakage path, there is the
distributed capacitive current path, the two paths together constituting the normal
leakage impedance to earth (see Fig. E9).
Example (see Fig. E10)
In a LV 3-phase 3-wire system, 1 km of cable will have a leakage impedance due to
C1, C2, C3 and R1, R2 and R3 equivalent to a neutral earth impedance Zct of 3,000
to 4,000 , without counting the filtering capacitances of electronic devices.
IT system (impedance-earthed neutral)
An impedance Zs (in the order of 1,000 to 2,000 ) is connected permanently
between the neutral point of the transformer LV winding and earth (see Fig. E11).
All exposed- and extraneous-conductive-parts are connected to an earth electrode.
The reasons for this form of power-source earthing are to fix the potential of a small
network with respect to earth (Zs is small compared to the leakage impedance) and to
reduce the level of overvoltages, such as transmitted surges from the MV windings,
static charges, etc. with respect to earth. It has, however, the effect of slightly
increasing the first-fault current level.
Fig. E9 : IT system (isolated neutral)
MV/LV
MV/LV
Zct
Fig. E10 : Impedance equivalent to leakage impedances in an
IT system
Fig. E11 : IT system (impedance-earthed neutral)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Zs
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
1.3 Characteristics of TT, TN and IT systems
TT system (see Fig. E12)
The TT system:
b Technique for the protection of persons: the
exposed conductive parts are earthed and
residual current devices (RCDs) are used
b Operating technique: interruption for the first
insulation fault
E6
Fig. E12 : TT system
Note: If the exposed conductive parts are earthed at a number of points, an RCD
must be installed for each set of circuits connected to a given earth electrode.
Main characteristics
b Simplest solution to design and install. Used in installations supplied directly by the
public LV distribution network.
b Does not require continuous monitoring during operation (a periodic check on the
RCDs may be necessary).
b Protection is ensured by special devices, the residual current devices (RCD), which
also prevent the risk of fire when they are set to y 500 mA.
b Each insulation fault results in an interruption in the supply of power, however the
outage is limited to the faulty circuit by installing the RCDs in series (selective RCDs)
or in parallel (circuit selection).
b Loads or parts of the installation which, during normal operation, cause high leakage
currents, require special measures to avoid nuisance tripping, i.e. supply the loads
with a separation transformer or use specific RCDs (see section 5.1 in chapter F).
The TN system:
TN system (see Fig. E13 and Fig. E14 )
b Technique for the protection of persons:
v Interconnection and earthing of exposed
conductive parts and the neutral are mandatory
v Interruption for the first fault using overcurrent
protection (circuit-breakers or fuses)
b Operating technique: interruption for the first
insulation fault
PEN
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E13 : TN-C system
N
PE
Fig. E14 : TN-S system
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
Main characteristics
b Generally speaking, the TN system:
v requires the installation of earth electrodes at regular intervals throughout the
installation
v Requires that the initial check on effective tripping for the first insulation fault
be carried out by calculations during the design stage, followed by mandatory
measurements to confirm tripping during commissioning
v Requires that any modification or extension be designed and carried out by a
qualified electrician
v May result, in the case of insulation faults, in greater damage to the windings of
rotating machines
v May, on premises with a risk of fire, represent a greater danger due to the higher
fault currents
E7
b In addition, the TN-C system:
v At first glance, would appear to be less expensive (elimination of a device pole and
of a conductor)
v Requires the use of fixed and rigid conductors
v Is forbidden in certain cases:
- Premises with a risk of fire
- For computer equipment (presence of harmonic currents in the neutral)
b In addition, the TN-S system:
v May be used even with flexible conductors and small conduits
v Due to the separation of the neutral and the protection conductor, provides a clean
PE (computer systems and premises with special risks)
IT system (see Fig. E15)
IT system:
b Protection technique:
v Interconnection and earthing of exposed
conductive parts
v Indication of the first fault by an insulation
monitoring device (IMD)
v Interruption for the second fault using
overcurrent protection (circuit-breakers or fuses)
Cardew
IMD
Fig. E15 : IT system
Main characteristics
b Solution offering the best continuity of service during operation
b Indication of the first insulation fault, followed by mandatory location and clearing,
ensures systematic prevention of supply outages
b Generally used in installations supplied by a private MV/LV or LV/LV transformer
b Requires maintenance personnel for monitoring and operation
b Requires a high level of insulation in the network (implies breaking up the network
if it is very large and the use of circuit-separation transformers to supply loads with
high leakage currents)
b The check on effective tripping for two simultaneous faults must be carried out by
calculations during the design stage, followed by mandatory measurements during
commissioning on each group of interconnected exposed conductive parts
b Protection of the neutral conductor must be ensured as indicated in section 7.2 of
Chapter G
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Operating technique:
v Monitoring of the first insulation fault
v Mandatory location and clearing of the fault
v Interruption for two simultaneous insulation
faults
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
Selection does not depend on safety criteria.
The three systems are equivalent in terms
of protection of persons if all installation and
operating rules are correctly followed.
The selection criteria for the best system(s)
depend on the regulatory requirements,
the required continuity of service, operating
conditions and the types of network and loads.
E8
1.4 Selection criteria for the TT, TN and IT systems
In terms of the protection of persons, the three system earthing arrangements
(SEA) are equivalent if all installation and operating rules are correctly followed.
Consequently, selection does not depend on safety criteria.
It is by combining all requirements in terms of regulations, continuity of service,
operating conditions and the types of network and loads that it is possible to
determine the best system(s) (see Fig. E16).
Selection is determined by the following factors:
b Above all, the applicable regulations which in some cases impose certain types of
SEA
b Secondly, the decision of the owner if supply is via a private MV/LV transformer
(MV subscription) or the owner has a private energy source (or a separate-winding
transformer)
If the owner effectively has a choice, the decision on the SEA is taken following
discussions with the network designer (design office, contractor)
The discussions must cover:
b First of all, the operating requirements (the required level of continuity of service)
and the operating conditions (maintenance ensured by electrical personnel or not,
in-house personnel or outsourced, etc.)
b Secondly, the particular characteristics of the network and the loads
(see Fig. E17 next page)
TT
TN-S
TN-C
IT1(a)
IT2(b)
Comments
Electrical characteristics
Fault current
Fault voltage
-
--
--
+
+
--
Touch voltage
+/- -
-
-
+
-
Only the IT system offers virtually negligible first-fault currents
In the IT system, the touch voltage is very low for the first fault,
but is considerable for the second
In the TT system, the touch voltage is very low if system is
equipotential, otherwise it is high
Protection
Protection of persons against indirect contact
+
+
+
+
+
Protection of persons with emergency
generating sets
Protection against fire (with an RCD)
+
-
-
+
-
+
+
Not
+
allowed
+
Overvoltages
Continuous overvoltage
+
+
+
-
+
+
-
+
+
+
+
+
-
+
+
+
+
+
+
-
+
+
Transient overvoltage
Overvoltage if transformer breakdown
(primary/secondary)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Electromagnetic compatibility
Immunity to nearby lightning strikes
All SEAs (system earthing arrangement) are equivalent,
if the rules are followed
Systems where protection is ensured by RCDs are not sensitive
to a change in the internal impedance of the source
All SEAs in which RCDs can be used are equivalent.
The TN-C system is forbidden on premises where there is a risk of fire
A phase-to-earth overvoltage is continuous in the IT system
if there is a first insulation fault
Systems with high fault currents may cause transient overvoltages
In the TT system, there is a voltage imbalance between
the different earth electrodes. The other systems are interconnected
to a single earth electrode
In the TT system, there may be voltage imbalances between
the earth electrodes. In the TT system, there is a significant current
loop between the two separate earth electrodes
All SEAs are equivalent when a MV line takes a direct lightning strike
Connection of the PEN to the metal structures of the building is
conducive to the continuous generation of electromagnetic fields
The PE is no longer equipotential if there is a high fault current
Immunity to lightning strikes on MV lines
Continuous emission of an
electromagnetic field
Transient non-equipotentiality of the PE
Continuity of service
Interruption for first fault
Voltage dip during insulation fault
+
-
-
+
-
+
-
-
+
+
+
-
Only the IT system avoids tripping for the first insulation fault
The TN-S, TNC and IT (2nd fault) systems generate high fault
currents which may cause phase voltage dips
Installation
Special devices
-
+
+
-
-
Number of earth electrodes
-
+
+
-/+
-/+
Number of cables
-
-
+
-
-
The TT system requires the use of RCDs. The IT system requires
the use of IMDs
The TT system requires two distinct earth electrodes. The IT system
offers a choice between one or two earth electrodes
Only the TN-C system offers, in certain cases, a reduction in
the number of cables
Maintenance
Cost of repairs
-
--
--
-
--
Installation damage
+
-
-
++
-
The cost of repairs depends on the damage caused by
the amplitude of the fault currents
Systems causing high fault currents require a check on
the installation after clearing the fault
(a) IT-net when a first fault occurs.
(b) IT-net when a second fault occurs.
Fig. E16 : Comparison of system earthing arrangements
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
Type of network
Very large network with high-quality earth electrodes
for exposed conductive parts (10 max.)
Very large network with low-quality earth electrodes
for exposed conductive parts (> 30 )
Disturbed area (storms)
(e.g. television or radio transmitter)
Network with high leakage currents (> 500 mA)
Advised
TN
Possible
TT, TN, IT (1)
or mixed
TN-S
TN
TT
IT (1)
TN-C
IT (2)
TN (4)
IT (6)
TN (7)
Network with outdoor overhead lines
TT (5)
IT (4)
TT (3) (4)
TN (5) (6)
Emergency standby generator set
IT
TT
Not advised
E9
Type of loads
Loads sensitive to high fault currents (motors, etc.)
IT
TT
TN (8)
TN (9)
TT (9)
IT
TT (11)
IT (10)
TN-C (10)
IT (11)
Loads with a low insulation level (electric furnaces,
welding machines, heating elements, immersion heaters,
equipment in large kitchens)
Numerous phase-neutral single-phase loads
(mobile, semi-fixed, portable)
Loads with sizeable risks (hoists, conveyers, etc.)
TT (10)
TN-S
TN (11)
Numerous auxiliaries (machine tools)
TN-S
TN-C
IT (12 bis)
TT (12)
Miscellaneous
Supply via star-star connected power transformer (13)
TT
Premises with risk of fire
IT (15)
IT
without neutral
TN-S (15)
TT (15)
IT (13)
with neutral
TN-C (14)
LV
TT (16)
MV/LV
TT (17)
Installation where the continuity of earth circuits is uncertain
(work sites, old installations)
Electronic equipment (computers, PLCs)
Machine control-monitoring network, PLC sensors and actuators
TT (19)
TN-S
TN-S
IT (20)
TT
TN-S, TT
TN (18)
IT (18)
TN-C
IT (19)
TN-C
(1) When the SEA is not imposed by regulations, it is selected according to the level of operating characteristics (continuity of service that is
mandatory for safety reasons or desired to enhance productivity, etc.)
Whatever the SEA, the probability of an insulation failure increases with the length of the network. It may be a good idea to break up the
network, which facilitates fault location and makes it possible to implement the system advised above for each type of application.
(2) The risk of flashover on the surge limiter turns the isolated neutral into an earthed neutral. These risks are high for regions with frequent
thunder storms or installations supplied by overhead lines. If the IT system is selected to ensure a higher level of continuity of service, the
system designer must precisely calculate the tripping conditions for a second fault.
(3) Risk of RCD nuisance tripping.
(4) Whatever the SEA, the ideal solution is to isolate the disturbing section if it can be easily identified.
(5) Risks of phase-to-earth faults affecting equipotentiality.
(6) Insulation is uncertain due to humidity and conducting dust.
(7) The TN system is not advised due to the risk of damage to the generator in the case of an internal fault. What is more, when generator sets
supply safety equipment, the system must not trip for the first fault.
(8) The phase-to-earth current may be several times higher than In, with the risk of damaging or accelerating the ageing of motor windings, or of
destroying magnetic circuits.
(9) To combine continuity of service and safety, it is necessary and highly advised, whatever the SEA, to separate these loads from the rest of
the installation (transformers with local neutral connection).
(10) When load equipment quality is not a design priority, there is a risk that the insulation resistance will fall rapidly. The TT system with RCDs
is the best means to avoid problems.
(11) The mobility of this type of load causes frequent faults (sliding contact for bonding of exposed conductive parts) that must be countered.
Whatever the SEA, it is advised to supply these circuits using transformers with a local neutral connection.
(12) Requires the use of transformers with a local TN system to avoid operating risks and nuisance tripping at the first fault (TT) or a double fault (IT).
(12 bis) With a double break in the control circuit.
(13) Excessive limitation of the phase-to-neutral current due to the high value of the zero-phase impedance (at least 4 to 5 times the direct
impedance). This system must be replaced by a star-delta arrangement.
(14) The high fault currents make the TN system dangerous. The TN-C system is forbidden.
(15) Whatever the system, the RCD must be set to n y 500 mA.
(16) An installation supplied with LV energy must use the TT system. Maintaining this SEA means the least amount of modifications on the
existing network (no cables to be run, no protection devices to be modified).
(17) Possible without highly competent maintenance personnel.
(18) This type of installation requires particular attention in maintaining safety. The absence of preventive measures in the TN system means
highly qualified personnel are required to ensure safety over time.
(19) The risks of breaks in conductors (supply, protection) may cause the loss of equipotentiality for exposed conductive parts. A TT system or a
TN-S system with 30 mA RCDs is advised and is often mandatory. The IT system may be used in very specific cases.
(20) This solution avoids nuisance tripping for unexpected earth leakage.
Fig. E17 : Influence of networks and loads on the selection of system earthing arrangements
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Increase in power level of LV utility subscription,
requiring a private substation
Installation with frequent modifications
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
1.5 Choice of earthing method - implementation
After consulting applicable regulations, Figures E16 and E17 can be used as an aid
in deciding on divisions and possible galvanic isolation of appropriate sections of a
proposed installation.
Division of source
E10
This technique concerns the use of several transformers instead of employing one
high-rated unit. In this way, a load that is a source of network disturbances (large
motors, furnaces, etc.) can be supplied by its own transformer.
The quality and continuity of supply to the whole installation are thereby improved.
The cost of switchgear is reduced (short-circuit current level is lower).
The cost-effectiveness of separate transformers must be determined on a case by
case basis.
Network islands
The creation of galvanically-separated “islands” by means of LV/LV transformers
makes it possible to optimise the choice of earthing methods to meet specific
requirements (see Fig. E18 and Fig. E19 ).
MV/LV
IMD
IT system
LV/LV
TN-S system
Fig. E18 : TN-S island within an IT system
MV/LV
TN-S
LV/LV
LV/LV
IMD
IT
TN-S system
Hospital
IMD
IT
Operating room
Fig. E19 : IT islands within a TN-S system
Conclusion
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The optimisation of the performance of the whole installation governs the choice of
earthing system.
Including:
b Initial investments, and
b Future operational expenditures, hard to assess, that can arise from insufficient
reliability, quality of equipment, safety, continuity of service, etc.
An ideal structure would comprise normal power supply sources, local reserve
power supply sources (see section 1.4 of Chapter E) and the appropriate earthing
arrangements.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
A very effective method of obtaining a lowresistance earth connection is to bury a
conductor in the form of a closed loop in the
soil at the bottom of the excavation for building
foundations.
The resistance R of such an electrode (in
homogeneous soil) is given (approximately) in
ohms by: R =
2l
where
L
1.6 Installation and measurements of earth
electrodes
The quality of an earth electrode (resistance as low as possible) depends essentially
on two factors:
b Installation method
b Type of soil
Installation methods
L = length of the buried conductor in metres
= soil resistivity in ohm-metres
Three common types of installation will be discussed:
Buried ring (see Fig. E20)
This solution is strongly recommended, particularly in the case of a new building.
The electrode should be buried around the perimeter of the excavation made for
the foundations. It is important that the bare conductor be in intimate contact with
the soil (and not placed in the gravel or aggregate hard-core, often forming a base
for concrete). At least four (widely-spaced) vertically arranged conductors from the
electrode should be provided for the installation connections and, where possible,
any reinforcing rods in concrete work should be connected to the electrode.
The conductor forming the earth electrode, particularly when it is laid in an
excavation for foundations, must be in the earth, at least 50 cm below the hard-core
or aggregate base for the concrete foundation. Neither the electrode nor the vertical
rising conductors to the ground floor, should ever be in contact with the foundation
concrete.
For existing buildings, the electrode conductor should be buried around the outside
wall of the premises to a depth of at least 1 metre. As a general rule, all vertical
connections from an electrode to above-ground level should be insulated for the
nominal LV voltage (600-1,000 V).
E11
The conductors may be:
b Copper: Bare cable (u 25 mm2) or multiple-strip (u 25 mm2 and u 2 mm thick)
b Aluminium with lead jacket: Cable (u 35 mm2)
b Galvanised-steel cable: Bare cable (u 95 mm2) or multiple-strip (u 100 mm2
and u 3 mm thick)
The approximate resistance R of the electrode in ohms:
2l
R=
L
where
L = length of conductor in metres
= resistivity of the soil in ohm-metres (see “Influence of the type of soil” next page)
Earthing rods (see Fig. E21)
Vertically driven earthing rods are often used for existing buildings, and for improving
(i.e. reducing the resistance of) existing earth electrodes.
For n rods: R = 1 l
nL
The rods may be:
b Copper or (more commonly) copper-clad steel. The latter are generally 1 or
2 metres long and provided with screwed ends and sockets in order to reach
considerable depths, if necessary (for instance, the water-table level in areas of high
soil resistivity)
b Galvanised (see note (1) next page) steel pipe u 25 mm diameter or
rod u 15 mm diameter, u 2 metres long in each case.
Rods connected in parallel
Fig. E20 : Conductor buried below the level of the foundations,
i.e. not in the concrete
Fig. E21 : Earthing rods
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Lu3m
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
It is often necessary to use more than one rod, in which case the spacing between
them should exceed the depth to which they are driven, by a factor of 2 to 3.
The total resistance (in homogeneous soil) is then equal to the resistance of one rod,
divided by the number of rods in question. The approximate resistance R obtained is:
1l
R=
if the distance separating the rods > 4L
nL
where
L = the length of the rod in metres
= resistivity of the soil in ohm-metres (see “Influence of the type of soil” below)
n = the number of rods
E12
Vertical plates (see Fig. E22)
Rectangular plates, each side of which must be u 0.5 metres, are commonly used as
earth electrodes, being buried in a vertical plane such that the centre of the plate is
at least 1 metre below the surface of the soil.
For a vertical plate electrode: R = 0.8 l
L
The plates may be:
b Copper of 2 mm thickness
b Galvanised (1) steel of 3 mm thickness
The resistance R in ohms is given (approximately), by:
0.8 l
R=
L
L = the perimeter of the plate in metres
= resistivity of the soil in ohm-metres (see “Influence of the type of soil” below)
Influence of the type of soil
Measurements on earth electrodes in similar
soils are useful to determine the resistivity
value to be applied for the design of an earthelectrode system
Type of soil
Swampy soil, bogs
Silt alluvium
Humus, leaf mould
Peat, turf
Soft clay
Marl and compacted clay
Jurassic marl
Clayey sand
Siliceous sand
Stoney ground
Grass-covered-stoney sub-soil
Chalky soil
Limestone
Fissured limestone
Schist, shale
Mica schist
Granite and sandstone
Modified granite and sandstone
Mean value of resistivity
in m
1 - 30
20 - 100
10 - 150
5 - 100
50
100 - 200
30 - 40
50 - 500
200 - 300
1,500 - 3,000
300 - 500
100 - 300
1,000 - 5,000
500 - 1,000
50 - 300
800
1,500 - 10,000
100 - 600
Fig. E23 : Resistivity (m) for different types of soil
Type of soil
Fertile soil, compacted damp fill
Arid soil, gravel, uncompacted non-uniform fill
Stoney soil, bare, dry sand, fissured rocks
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
2 mm thickness (Cu)
Average value of resistivity
in m
50
500
3,000
Fig. E24 : Average resistivity (m) values for approximate earth-elect
Fig. E22 : Vertical plate
(1) Where galvanised conducting materials are used for earth
electrodes, sacrificial cathodic protection anodes may be
necessary to avoid rapid corrosion of the electrodes where
the soil is aggressive. Specially prepared magnesium anodes
(in a porous sack filled with a suitable “soil”) are available for
direct connection to the electrodes. In such circumstances, a
specialist should be consulted
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Earthing schemes
Measurement and constancy of the resistance between an
earth electrode and the earth
The resistance of the electrode/earth interface rarely remains constant
Among the principal factors affecting this resistance are the following:
b Humidity of the soil
The seasonal changes in the moisture content of the soil can be significant at depths
of up to 2 meters.
At a depth of 1 metre the resistivity and therefore the resistance can vary by a ratio
of 1 to 3 between a wet winter and a dry summer in temperate regions
b Frost
Frozen earth can increase the resistivity of the soil by several orders of magnitude.
This is one reason for recommending the installation of deep electrodes, in particular
in cold climates
E13
b Ageing
The materials used for electrodes will generally deteriorate to some extent for
various reasons, for example:
v Chemical reactions (in acidic or alkaline soils)
v Galvanic: due to stray DC currents in the earth, for example from electric railways,
etc. or due to dissimilar metals forming primary cells. Different soils acting on
sections of the same conductor can also form cathodic and anodic areas with
consequent loss of surface metal from the latter areas. Unfortunately, the most
favourable conditions for low earth-electrode resistance (i.e. low soil resistivity) are
also those in which galvanic currents can most easily flow.
b Oxidation
Brazed and welded joints and connections are the points most sensitive to oxidation.
Thorough cleaning of a newly made joint or connection and wrapping with a suitable
greased-tape binding is a commonly used preventive measure.
Measurement of the earth-electrode resistance
There must always be one or more removable links to isolate an earth electrode so
that it can be tested.
There must always be removable links which allow the earth electrode to be isolated
from the installation, so that periodic tests of the earthing resistance can be carried
out. To make such tests, two auxiliary electrodes are required, each consisting of a
vertically driven rod.
b Ammeter method (see Fig. E25)
U
t1
A
T
t2
A = RT + Rt1 =
UTt1
i1
B = Rt1 + Rt 2 =
Ut1t 2
i2
C = Rt 2 + RT =
Ut 2T
i3
When the source voltage U is constant (adjusted to be the same value for each test)
then:
U £ 1 1 1¥
RT = ² + < ´
2 ¤ i1 i3 i2 ¦
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E25 : Measurement of the resistance to earth of the earth electrode of an installation by
means of an ammeter
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
1 Earthing schemes
In order to avoid errors due to stray earth currents (galvanic -DC- or leakage currents
from power and communication networks and so on) the test current should be
AC, but at a different frequency to that of the power system or any of its harmonics.
Instruments using hand-driven generators to make these measurements usually
produce an AC voltage at a frequency of between 85 Hz and 135 Hz.
The distances between the electrodes are not critical and may be in different
directions from the electrode being tested, according to site conditions. A number of
tests at different spacings and directions are generally made to cross-check the test
results.
E14
b Use of a direct-reading earthing-resistance ohmmeter
These instruments use a hand-driven or electronic-type AC generator, together
with two auxiliary electrodes, the spacing of which must be such that the zone of
influence of the electrode being tested should not overlap that of the test electrode (C).
The test electrode (C) furthest from the electrode (X) under test, passes a current
through the earth and the electrode under test, while the second test electrode (P)
picks up a voltage. This voltage, measured between (X) and (P), is due to the test
current and is a measure of the contact resistance (of the electrode under test) with
earth. It is clear that the distance (X) to (P) must be carefully chosen to give accurate
results. If the distance (X) to (C) is increased, however, the zones of resistance of
electrodes (X) and (C) become more remote, one from the other, and the curve of
potential (voltage) becomes more nearly horizontal about the point (O).
In practical tests, therefore, the distance (X) to (C) is increased until readings taken
with electrode (P) at three different points, i.e. at (P) and at approximately 5 metres
on either side of (P), give similar values. The distance (X) to (P) is generally about
0.68 of the distance (X) to (C).
VG
G
I
V
X
P
C
voltage-drop due
to the resistance
of electrode (X)
O
VG
voltage-drop due
to the resistance
of electrode (C)
a) the principle of measurement is based on assumed homogeneous soil conditions. Where the
zones of influence of electrodes C and X overlap, the location of test electrode P is difficult to
determine for satisfactory results.
X
P
C
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
O
b) showing the effect on the potential gradient when (X) and (C) are widely spaced. The location
of test electrode P is not critical and can be easily determined.
Fig. E26 : Measurement of the resistance to the mass of earth of electrode (X) using an earthelectrode-testing ohmmeter.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
2 The installation system
Distribution switchboards, including the main
LV switchboard (MLVS), are critical to the
dependability of an electrical installation.
They must comply with well-defined standards
governing the design and construction of
LV switchgear assemblies
2.1 Distribution switchboards
A distribution switchboard is the point at which an incoming-power supply divides
into separate circuits, each of which is controlled and protected by the fuses or
switchgear of the switchboard. A distribution switchboard is divided into a number
of functional units, each comprising all the electrical and mechanical elements
that contribute to the fulfilment of a given function. It represents a key link in the
dependability chain.
Consequently, the type of distribution switchboard must be perfectly adapted to its
application. Its design and construction must comply with applicable standards and
working practises.
The distribution switchboard enclosure provides dual protection:
b Protection of switchgear, indicating instruments, relays, fusegear, etc. against
mechanical impacts, vibrations and other external influences likely to interfere with
operational integrity (EMI, dust, moisture, vermin, etc.)
b The protection of human life against the possibility of direct and indirect electric
shock (see degree of protection IP and the IK index in section 3.3 of Chapter E).
E15
Types of distribution switchboards
Distribution switchboards may differ according to the kind of application and the
design principle adopted (notably in the arrangement of the busbars).
The load requirements dictate the type of
distribution switchboard to be installed
Distribution switchboards according to specific applications
The principal types of distribution switchboards are:
b The main LV switchboard - MLVS - (see Fig. E27a)
b Motor control centres - MCC - (see Fig. E27b)
b Sub-distribution switchboards (see Fig. E28)
b Final distribution switchboards (see Fig. E29)
Distribution switchboards for specific applications (e.g. heating, lifts, industrial
processes) can be located:
b Adjacent to the main LV switchboard, or
b Near the application concerned
Sub-distribution and final distribution switchboards are generally distributed
throughout the site.
a
b
Fig. E27 : [a] A main LV switchboard - MLVS - (Prisma Plus P) with incoming circuits in the form
of busways - [b] A LV motor control centre - MCC - (Okken)
Fig. E28 : A sub-distribution switchboard (Prisma Plus G)
b
c
Fig. E29 : Final distribution switchboards [a] Prisma Plus G Pack; [b] Kaedra; [c] mini-Pragma
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
a
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
A distinction is made between:
b Traditional distribution switchboards in which
switchgear and fusegear, etc. are fixed to a
chassis at the rear of an enclosure
b Functional distribution switchboards for
specific applications, based on modular and
standardised design.
Two technologies of distribution switchboards
Traditional distribution switchboards
Switchgear and fusegear, etc. are normally located on a chassis at the rear of the
enclosure. Indications and control devices (meters, lamps, pushbuttons, etc.) are
mounted on the front face of the switchboard.
The placement of the components within the enclosure requires very careful study,
taking into account the dimensions of each item, the connections to be made to it,
and the clearances necessary to ensure safe and trouble-free operation. .
Functional distribution switchboards
Generally dedicated to specific applications, these distribution switchboards are
made up of functional modules that include switchgear devices together with
standardised accessories for mounting and connections, ensuring a high level of
reliability and a great capacity for last-minute and future changes.
E16
b Many advantages
The use of functional distribution switchboards has spread to all levels of LV
electrical distribution, from the main LV switchboard (MLVS) to final distribution
switchboards, due to their many advantages:
v System modularity that makes it possible to integrate numerous functions in a
single distribution switchboard, including protection, control, technical management
and monitoring of electrical installations. Modular design also enhances distribution
switchboard maintenance, operation and upgrades
v Distribution switchboard design is fast because it simply involves adding functional
modules
v Prefabricated components can be mounted faster
v Finally, these distribution switchboards are subjected to type tests that ensure a
high degree of dependability.
Fig. E30 : Assembly of a final distribution switchboard with
fixed functional units (Prisma Plus G)
The new Prisma Plus G and P ranges of functional distribution switchboards from
Schneider Electric cover needs up to 3200 A and offer:
v Flexibility and ease in building distribution switchboards
v Certification of a distribution switchboard complying with standard IEC 61439 and
the assurance of servicing under safe conditions
v Time savings at all stages, from design to installation, operation and modifications
or upgrades
v Easy adaptation, for example to meet the specific work habits and standards in
different countries
Figures E27a, E28 and E29 show examples of functional distribution switchboards
ranging for all power ratings and figure E27b shows a high-power industrial functional
distribution switchboard.
b Main types of functional units
Three basic technologies are used in functional distribution switchboards.
v Fixed functional units (see Fig. E30)
These units cannot be isolated from the supply so that any intervention for
maintenance, modifications and so on, requires the shutdown of the entire
distribution switchboard. Plug-in or withdrawable devices can however be used to
minimise shutdown times and improve the availability of the rest of the installation.
v Disconnectable functional units (see Fig. E31)
Each functional unit is mounted on a removable mounting plate and provided with a
means of isolation on the upstream side (busbars) and disconnecting facilities on the
downstream (outgoing circuit) side. The complete unit can therefore be removed for
servicing, without requiring a general shutdown.
v Drawer-type withdrawable functional units (see Fig. E32)
The switchgear and associated accessories for a complete function are mounted on
a drawer-type horizontally withdrawable chassis. The function is generally complex
and often concerns motor control.
Isolation is possible on both the upstream and downstream sides by the complete
withdrawal of the drawer, allowing fast replacement of a faulty unit without deenergising the rest of the distribution switchboard.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E31 : Distribution switchboard with disconnectable
functional units
Fig. E32 : Distribution switchboard with withdrawable functional
units in drawers
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The installation system
Standards
Compliance with applicable standards is
essential in order to ensure an adequate
degree of dependability
Three elements of standards IEC 61439-1 & 2
contribute significantly to dependability:
b Clear definition of functional units
b Forms of separation between adjacent
functional units in accordance with user
requirements
b Clearly defined verification tests and routine
verification
Different standards
Certain types of distribution switchboards (in particular, functional distribution
switchboards) must comply with specific standards according to the application or
environment involved.
The reference international standards are IEC 61439-x series (“Low-voltage
switchgear and controlgear assemblies”), in which:
b IEC 61439-1 is dedicated to General rules
b IEC 61439-2 is dedicated to Power switchgear and controlgear Assemblies (PSC)
Standards IEC 61439-1 & 2
b Assembly system concept & definitions
v Assembly system: full range of mechanical and electrical components as defined
by the Original Manufacturer (enclosures, busbars, functional units, including
switchgear and control gear, terminals, …) which can be assembled in accordance
with the Original Manufacturer’s instructions, either in its factory, or on the installation
site, in order to produce various ASSEMBLIES.
E17
Fig. E32b : Main rules defined by the IEC 61439-1&2 standard
v Original Manufacturer: The organisation that has carried out the original design and
the associated verification of an assembly system. He is responsible for the 'Design
verifications' listed by IEC 61439-2 including many electrical tests.
v Assembly manufacturer: The organisation (whether or not the same as the
OM) responsible for the completed assembly. He is responsible for 'Routine
verifications' on each panel produced, according to the standard. If he derivates
from the instructions of the original manufacturer he has to carry out again design
verifications.
v Specifier: Specifies the needs and constraints for design, installation, operation
and upgrading of the complete system. Checks that its requirements have been fully
integrated by the Assembly Manufacturer. Depending on the application, the specifier
could be the end-user or a design office.
v End User: Should ask for a certified LV switchboard. By systematically requesting
routine verifications, he ensures that the assembly system used is compliant.
b Functional units
The same standard defines functional units:
v Part of an assembly comprising all the electrical and mechanical elements that
contribute to the fulfilment of the same function
v The distribution switchboard includes an incoming functional unit and one or more
functional units for outgoing circuits, depending on the operating requirements of the
installation
What is more, distribution switchboard technologies use functional units that may be
fixed, disconnectable or withdrawable (see see section 4.2 of Chapter D & fig. E30,
E31, E32).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Note: the IEC 60439-1 two categories TTA (Type-tested LV switchgear and
controlgear assemblies) and PTTA (Partially type-tested LV switchgear and
controlgear assemblies) don’t exist anymore in IEC 61439-1.
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
b Forms (see Fig. E33)
Separation of functional units within the assembly is provided by forms that are
specified for different types of operation.
The various forms are numbered from 1 to 4 with variations labelled “a” or “b”. Each
step up (from 1 to 4) is cumulative, i.e. a form with a higher number includes the
characteristics of forms with lower numbers. The standard distinguishes:
v Form 1: No separation
v Form 2: Separation of busbars from the functional units
v Form 3: Separation of busbars from the functional units and separation of all
functional units, one from another, except at their output terminals
v Form 4: As for Form 3, but including separation of the outgoing terminals of all
functional units, one from another
The decision on which form to implement results from an agreement between the
manufacturer and the user.
The Prima Plus functional range offers solutions for forms 1, 2b, 3b, 4a, 4b.
E18
Form 1
Form 2a
Form 2b
Form 3a
Busbar
Separation
Form 3b
Form 4a
Form 4b
Fig. E33 : Representation of different forms of LV functional distribution switchboards
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Verification tests and routine verification
They ensure compliance of each distribution switchboard with the standard. The
availability of certificates of conformity issued by third-party bodies is a guarantee for
users.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The installation system
Two types of distribution are possible:
b By insulated wires and cables
b By busbar trunking (busways)
Remote monitoring and control of the electrical installation
Remote monitoring and control are no longer limited to large installations.
These functions are increasingly used and provide considerable cost savings.
The main potential advantages are:
b Reductions in energy bills
b Reductions in structural costs to maintain the installation in running order
b Better use of the investment, notably concerning optimisation of the installation life
cycle
b Greater satisfaction for energy users (in a building or in process industries) due to
improved power availability and/or quality
The above possibilities are all the more an option given the current deregulation of
the electrical-energy sector.
Modbus is increasingly used as the open standard for communication within the
distribution switchboard and between the distribution switchboard and customer
power monitoring and control applications. Modbus exists in two forms, twisted pair
(RS 485) and Ethernet-TCP/IP (IEEE 802.3).
The www.modbus.org site presents all bus specifications and constantly updates the
list of products and companies using the open industrial standard.
The use of web technologies has largely contributed to wider use by drastically
reducing the cost of accessing these functions through the use of an interface that is
now universal (web pages) and a degree of openness and upgradeability that simply
did not exist just a few years ago.
E19
2.2 Cables and busways
Distribution by insulated conductors and cables
Definitions
b Conductor
A conductor comprises a single metallic core with or without an insulating envelope.
b Cable
A cable is made up of a number of conductors, electrically separated, but joined
mechanically, generally enclosed in a protective flexible sheath.
b Cableway
The term cableway refers to conductors and/or cables together with the means of
support and protection, etc. for example : cable trays, ladders, ducts, trenches, and
so on… are all “cableways”.
Conductor marking
Conductor identification must always respect the following three rules:
b Rule 1
The double colour green and yellow is strictly reserved for the PE and PEN
protection conductors.
b Rule 2
v When a circuit comprises a neutral conductor, it must be light blue or marked “1” for
cables with more than five conductors
v When a circuit does not have a neutral conductor, the light blue conductor may be
used as a phase conductor if it is part of a cable with more than one conductor
b Rule 3
Phase conductors may be any colour except:
v Green and yellow
v Green
v Yellow
v Light blue (see rule 2)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Total accessibility of electrical information and
intelligent distribution switchboards are now a
reality
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
Conductors in a cable are identified either by their colour or by numbers (see Fig. E34).
Number of Circuit
conductors
in circuit
1
2
E20
3
4
5
>5
Fixed cableways
Insulated conductors
Protection or earth
Single-phase between phases
Single-phase between phase and neutral
Single-phase between phase and neutral
+ protection conductor
Three-phase without neutral
2 phases + neutral
2 phases + protection conductor
Single-phase between phase and neutral
+ protection conductor
Three-phase with neutral
Three-phase with neutral + protection conductor
2 phases + neutral + protection conductor
Three-phase with PEN conductor
Three-phase + neutral + protection conductor
G/Y: Green and yellow
BL: Black
b : As indicated in rule 3
Ph
Ph
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
Pn
N
PE
G/Y
LB
G/Y
b
LB
LB
G/Y
G/Y
Rigid and flexible multiconductor cables
Ph
Ph
Ph
N
BL
BL
BL
LB
BL
BL
BL
BL
B
B
LB
PE
LB
G/Y
LB
LB
LB
G/Y
G/Y
b
b
b
LB
BL
B
BL
LB
b
b
b
G/Y
BL
B
LB
G/Y
b
b
LB
G/Y
BL
B
LB
G/Y
b
b
b
G/Y
BL
B
LB
G/Y
b
b
b
LB
G/Y
BL
B
BL
LB
G/Y
Protection conductor: G/Y - Other conductors: BL: with numbering
The number “1” is reserved for the neutral conductor if it exists
LB: Light blue
B: Brown
Fig. E34 : Conductor identification according to the type of circuit
Note: If the circuit includes a protection conductor and if the available cable does not
have a green and yellow conductor, the protection conductor may be:
b A separate green and yellow conductor
b The blue conductor if the circuit does not have a neutral conductor
b A black conductor if the circuit has a neutral conductor
In the last two cases, the conductor used must be marked by green and yellow
bands or markings at the ends and on all visible lengths of the conductor.
Equipment power cords are marked similar to multi-conductor cables (see Fig. E35).
Distribution and installation methods (see Fig. E36)
Distribution takes place via cableways that carry single insulated conductors or
cables and include a fixing system and mechanical protection.
Final
distribution
swichboard
Floor subdistribution
swichboard
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
N
Main LV switchboard
(MLVS)
Black conductor
Heating, etc.
Light blue conductor
Building utilities sub-distribution swichboard
Fig. E35 : Conductor identification on a circuit-breaker with a
phase and a neutral
Fig. E36 : Radial distribution using cables in a hotel
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The installation system
Busways, also referred to as busbar trunking
systems, stand out for their ease of installation,
flexibility and number of possible connection
points
Busbar trunking (busways)
Busbar trunking is intended to distribute power (from 20 A to 5000 A) and lighting
(in this application, the busbar trunking may play a dual role of supplying electrical
power and physically holding the lights).
Busbar trunking system components
A busbar trunking system comprises a set of conductors protected by an enclosure
(see Fig. E37). Used for the transmission and distribution of electrical power, busbar
trunking systems have all the necessary features for fitting: connectors, straights,
angles, fixings, etc. The tap-off points placed at regular intervals make power
available at every point in the installation.
E21
Straight trunking
Power Unit
Tap-off points to
distribute current
Fixing system for ceilings, walls or
raised floor, etc.
Range of clip-on tap-off units to
connect a load (e.g.: a machine) to
the busbar trunking
End piece
Angle
Fig. E37 : Busbar trunking system design for distribution of currents from 25 to 4000 A.
The various types of busbar trunking:
Fig. E38 : Radial distribution using busways
We talk about a distributed network architecture.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Busbar trunking systems are present at every level in electrical distribution: from
the link between the transformer and the low voltage switch switchboard (MLVS)
to the distribution of power sockets and lighting to offices, or power distribution to
workshops.
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
There are essentially three categories of busways.
b Transformer to MLVS busbar trunking
Installation of the busway may be considered as permanent and will most likely never
be modified. There are no tap-off points.
Frequently used for short runs, it is almost always used for ratings above 1,600 /
2,000 A, i.e. when the use of parallel cables makes installation impossible. Busways
are also used between the MLVS and downstream distribution switchboards.
The characteristics of main-distribution busways authorize operational currents from
1,000 to 5,000 A and short-circuit withstands up to 150 kA.
E22
b Sub-distribution busbar trunking with low or high tap-off densities
Downstream of main-distribution busbar trunking , two types of applications must be
supplied:
v Mid-sized premises (industrial workshops with injection presses and metalwork
machines or large supermarkets with heavy loads). The short-circuit and current
levels can be fairly high (respectively 20 to 70 kA and 100 to 1,000 A)
v Small sites (workshops with machine-tools, textile factories with small machines,
supermarkets with small loads). The short-circuit and current levels are lower
(respectively 10 to 40 kA and 40 to 400 A)
Sub-distribution using busbar trunking meets user needs in terms of:
v Modifications and upgrades given the high number of tap-off points
v Dependability and continuity of service because tap-off units can be connected
under energized conditions in complete safety
The sub-distribution concept is also valid for vertical distribution in the form of 100 to
5,000 A risers in tall buildings.
b Lighting distribution busbar trunking
Lighting circuits can be distributed using two types of busbar trunking according to
whether the lighting fixtures are suspended from the busbar trunking or not.
v busbar trunking designed for the suspension of lighting fixtures
These busways supply and support light fixtures (industrial reflectors, discharge
lamps, etc.). They are used in industrial buildings, supermarkets, department stores
and warehouses. The busbar trunkings are very rigid and are designed for one or
two 25 A or 40 A circuits. They have tap-off outlets every 0.5 to 1 m.
v busbar trunking not designed for the suspension of lighting fixtures
Similar to prefabricated cable systems, these busways are used to supply all types
of lighting fixtures secured to the building structure. They are used in commercial
buildings (offices, shops, restaurants, hotels, etc.), especially in false ceilings. The
busbar trunking is flexible and designed for one 20 A circuit. It has tap-off outlets
every 1.2 m to 3 m.
Busbar trunking systems are suited to the requirements of a large number of
buildings.
b Industrial buildings: garages, workshops, farm buildings, logistic centers, etc.
b Commercial areas: stores, shopping malls, supermarkets, hotels, etc.
b Tertiary buildings: offices, schools, hospitals, sports rooms, cruise liners, etc.
Standards
Busbar trunking systems must meet all rules stated in IEC 61439-6.
This defines the manufacturing arrangements to be complied with in the design
of busbar trunking systems (e.g.: temperature rise characteristics, short-circuit
withstand, mechanical strength, etc.) as well as test methods to check them.
The new standard IEC61439-6 describes in particular the design verifications and
routine verifications required to ensure compliance.
By assembling the system components on the site according to the assembly
instructions, the contractor benefits from conformity with the standard.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The advantages of busbar trunking systems
Flexibility
b Easy to change configuration (on-site modification to change production line
configuration or extend production areas).
b Reusing components (components are kept intact): when an installation is subject
to major modifications, the busbar trunking is easy to dismantle and reuse.
b Power availability throughout the installation (possibility of having a tap-off point
every meter).
b Wide choice of tap-off units.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The installation system
Simplicity
b Design can be carried out independently from the distribution and layout of current
consumers.
b Performances are independent of implementation: the use of cables requires a lot
of derating coefficients.
b Clear distribution layout
b Reduction of fitting time: the trunking system allows fitting times to be reduced by
up to 50% compared with a traditional cable installation.
b Manufacturer’s guarantee.
b Controlled execution times: the trunking system concept guarantees that there are
no unexpected surprises when fitting. The fitting time is clearly known in advance
and a quick solution can be provided to any problems on site with this adaptable and
scalable equipment.
b Easy to implement: modular components that are easy to handle, simple and quick
to connect.
E23
Dependability
b Reliability guaranteed by being factory-built
b Fool-proof units
b Sequential assembly of straight components and tap-off units making it impossible
to make any mistakes
Continuity of service
b The large number of tap-off points makes it easy to supply power to any new
current consumer. Connecting and disconnecting is quick and can be carried out in
complete safety even when energized. These two operations (adding or modifying)
take place without having to stop operations.
b Quick and easy fault location since current consumers are near to the line
b Maintenance is non existent or greatly reduced
Major contribution to sustainable development
b Busbar trunking systems allow circuits to be combined. Compared with a
traditional cable distribution system, consumption of copper raw materials and
insulators is divided by 3 due to the busbar trunking distributed network concept
(see Fig. E39).
Distribution type
Conductors
Insulators
Consumption
Branched
ΣIxks
I1
R
I2
I3
R
R
I4
R
I5
R
I6
R
I7
R
ks: clustering coefficient= 0.6
Alu: 128 mm²
4 kg
Copper equivalent: 86 mm²
1 000 Joules
Copper: 250 mm²
1 600 Joules
Centralized
ΣIxks
I1
R
I2
R
I3
R
I4
R
I5
R
I6
R
I7
12 kg
R
ks: clustering coefficient= 0.6
Fig. E39 : Example: 30 m of Canalis KS 250A equipped with 10 25 A, four-pole feeders
b Reusable device and all of its components are fully recyclable.
b Does not contain PVC and does not generate toxic gases or waste.
b Reduction of risks due to exposure to electromagnetic fields.
Busbar trunking systems are getting even better. Among the new features we can
mention:
b Increased performance with a IP55 protection index and new ratings of 160 A
through to 1000 A (Ks).
b New lighting offers with pre-cabled lights and new light ducts.
b New fixing accessories. Quick fixing system, cable ducts, shared support with
“VDI” (voice, data, images) circuits.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
New functional features for Canalis
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
Busbar trunking systems are perfectly integrated with the environment:
b white color to enhance the working environment, naturally integrated in a range of
electrical distribution products.
b conformity with European regulations on reducing hazardous materials (RoHS).
Examples of Canalis busbar trunking systems
E24
Fig. E40 : Flexible busbar trunking not capable of supporting light fittings : Canalis KDP (20 A)
Fig. E41 : Rigid busbar trunking able to support light fittings : Canalis KBA or KBB (25 and 40 A)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E42 : Lighting duct : Canalis KBX (25 A)
Fig. E43 : A busway for medium power distribution : Canalis KN (40 up to 160 A)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The installation system
Fig. E44 : A busway for medium power distribution : Canalis KS (100 up to 1000 A)
E25
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. E45 : A busway for high power distribution : Canalis KT (800 up to 1000 A)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
3 External influences
(IEC 60364-5-51)
External influences shall be taken into account
when choosing:
b The appropriate measures to ensure the
safety of persons (in particular in special
locations or electrical installations)
b The characteristics of electrical equipment,
such as degree of protection (IP), mechanical
withstand (IK), etc.
3.1 Definition and reference standards
Every electrical installation occupies an environment that presents a variable degree
of risk:
b For people
b For the equipment constituting the installation
Consequently, environmental conditions influence the definition and choice of
appropriate installation equipment and the choice of protective measures for the
safety of persons.
The environmental conditions are referred to collectively as “external influences”.
Many national standards concerned with external influences include a classification
scheme which is based on, or which closely resembles, that of international standard
IEC 60364-5-51.
E26
If several external influences appear at the
same time, they can have independent or
mutual effects and the degree of protection must
be chosen accordingly
3.2 Classification
Each condition of external influence is designated by a code comprising a group of
two capital letters and a number as follows:
First letter (A, B or C)
The first letter relates to the general category of external influence :
b A = environment
b B = utilisation
b C = construction of buildings
Second letter
The second letter relates to the nature of the external influence.
Number
The number relates to the class within each external influence.
Additional letter (optional)
Used only if the effective protection of persons is greater than that indicated by the
first IP digit.
When only the protection of persons is to be specified, the two digits of the IP code
are replaced by the X’s.
Example: IP XXB.
Example
For example the code AC2 signifies:
A = environment
AC = environment-altitude
AC2 = environment-altitude > 2,000 m
3.3 List of external influences
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Figure E46 below is from IEC 60364-5-51, which should be referred to if further
details are required.
Code External influences
A - Environment
AA
Ambient temperature (°C)
Low
High
AA1
- 60 °C
+ 5 °C
AA2
- 40 °C
+ 5 °C
AA3
- 25 °C
+ 5 °C
AA4
- 5° C
+ 40 °C
AA5
+ 5 °C
+ 40 °C
AA6
+ 5 °C
+ 60 °C
AA7
- 25 °C
+ 55 °C
AA8
- 50 °C
+ 40 °C
Characteristics required for equipment
Specially designed equipment or appropriate arrangements
Normal (special precautions in certain cases)
Normal
Specially designed equipment or appropriate arrangements
Fig. E46 : List of external influences (taken from Appendix A of IEC 60364-5-51) (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 External influences
(IEC 60364-5-51)
AD8
AE
AE1
AE2
AE3
AE4
AE5
AE6
AF
AF1
AF2
AF3
AF4
AG
AG1
AG2
AG3
AH
AH1
AH2
AH3
AJ
AK
AH1
AH2
AL
AH1
AH2
AM
AM1
AM2
AM3
AM4
AM5
AM6
AM7
AM8
AM9
AM21
Characteristics required for equipment
Relative humidity %
Low
High
3
100
10
100
10
100
5
95
5
85
10
100
10
100
15
100
Absolute humidity g/m3
Low
High
0.003
7
0.1
7
0.5
7
1
29
1
25
1
35
0.5
29
0.04
36
Appropriate arrangements shall be made
Normal
Normal
Appropriate arrangements shall be made
E27
Normal
May necessitate precaution (derating factors)
Outdoor or non-weather protected locations
IPX0
IPX1 or IPX2
IPX3
IPX4
IPX5
IPX6
IPX7
Locations where hose water is used regularly
Seashore locations (piers, beaches, quays…)
Water 150 mm above the highest point and
equipment not more than 1m below the surface
Submersion
Equipment is permanently and totally covered
IPX8
Presence of foreign solid bodies
Smallest dimension
Example
Negligible
IP0X
Small objects
2.5 mm
Tools
IP3X
Very small objects
1 mm
Wire
IP4X
Light dust
IP5X if dust penetration is not harmful to functioning
Moderate dust
IP6X if dust should not penetrate
Heavy dust
IP6X
Presence of corrosive or polluting substances
Negligible
Normal
Atmospheric
According to the nature of the substance
Intermittent, accidental
Protection against corrosion
Continuous
Equipment specially designed
Mechanical stress impact
Low severity
Normal
Medium severity
Standard where applicable or reinforced material
High severity
Reinforced protection
Vibrations
Low severity
Household or similar
Normal
Medium severity
Usual industrial conditions
Specially designed equipment or special arrangements
High severity
Severe industrial conditions
Other mechanical stresses
Presence of flora and/or mould growth
No hazard
Normal
Hazard
Presence of fauna
No hazard
Normal
Hazard
Electromagnetic, electrostatic or ionising influences / Low frequency electromagnetic phenomena / Harmonics
Harmonics, interharmonics
Refer to applicable IEC standards
Signalling voltage
Voltage amplitude variations
Voltage unbalance
Power frequency variations
Induced low-frequency voltages
Direct current in a.c. networks
Radiated magnetic fields
Electric field
Induced oscillatory voltages or currents
Fig. E46 : List of external influences (taken from Appendix A of IEC 60364-5-51) (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Code External influences
A - Environment
AB
Atmospheric humidity
Air temperature °C
Low
High
AB1
- 60 °C
+ 5 °C
AB2
- 40 °C
+ 5 °C
AB3
- 25 °C
+ 5 °C
AB4
- 5° C
+ 40 °C
AB5
+ 5 °C
+ 40 °C
AB6
+ 5 °C
+ 60 °C
AB7
- 25 °C
+ 55 °C
AB8
- 50 °C
+ 40 °C
AC
Altitude
AC1
y 2000 m
AC2
> 2000 m
AD
Presence of water
AD1
Negligible
AD2
Free-falling drops
AD3
Sprays
AD4
Splashes
AD5
Jets
AD6
Waves
AD7
Immersion
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
E28
Code External influences
A - Environment
AM22 Conducted unidirectional transients of the nanosecond time scale
AM23 Conducted unidirectional transients of the microsecond to the millisecond
time scale
AM24 Conducted oscillatory transients
AM25 Radiated high frequency phenomena
AM31 Electrostatic discharges
AM41 Ionisation
AN
Solar radiation
AN1
Low
AN2
Medium
AN3
High
AP
Seismic effect
AP1
Negligible
AP2
Low severity
AP3
Medium severity
AP4
High severity
AQ
Lightning
AQ1
Negligible
AQ2
Indirect exposure
AQ3
Direct exposure
AR
Movement of air
AQ1
Low
AQ2
Medium
AQ3
High
AS
Wind
AQ1
Low
AQ2
Medium
AQ3
High
B - Utilization
BA
Capability of persons
BA1
Ordinary
BA2
Children
BA3
Handicapped
BA4
Instructed
BA5
Skilled
BB
Electrical resistance of human body
BC
Contact of persons with earth potential
BC1
None
BC2
Low
BC3
Frequent
BC4
Continuous
BD
Condition of evacuation in case of emergency
BD1
Low density / easy exit
BD2
Low density / difficult exit
BD3
High density / easy exit
BD4
High density / difficult exit
BE
Nature of processed or stored materials
BE1
No significant risks
BE2
Fire risks
BE3
Explosion risks
BE4
Contamination risks
C - Construction of building
CA
Construction materials
CA1
Non combustible
CA2
Combustible
CB
Building design
CB1
Negligible risks
CB2
Propagation of fire
CB3
Movement
CB4
lexible or unstable
Characteristics required for equipment
Refer to applicable IEC standards
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Class of equipment according to IEC61140
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Fig. E46 : List of external influences (taken from Appendix A of IEC 60364-5-51) (concluded)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 External influences
(IEC 60364-5-51)
3.4 Protection provided for enclosed equipment:
codes IP and IK
IP code definition (see Fig. E47)
The degree of protection provided by an enclosure is indicated in the IP code,
recommended in IEC 60529.
Protection is afforded against the following external influences:
b Penetration by solid bodies
b Protection of persons against access to live parts
b Protection against the ingress of dust
b Protection against the ingress of liquids
E29
Note: the IP code applies to electrical equipment for voltages up to and including
72.5 kV.
Elements of the IP Code and their meanings
A brief description of the IP Code elements is given in the following chart
(see Fig. E48).
Code letters
First
characteristic
numeral
Second
characteristic
numeral
IP
2
3
C
H
Code letters
(International Protection)
First characteristic numeral
(numerals 0 to 6, or letter X)
Additional
letter
(optional)
Second characteristic numeral
(numerals 0 to 6, or letter X)
Additional letter (optional)
(letters A, B, C, D)
Supplementary letter (optional)
(letters H, M, S, W)
Where a characteristic numeral is not required to be specified,
it shall be replaced by the letter "X" ("XX" if both numerals
are omitted). Additional letters and/or supplementary letters
may be omitted without replacement.
Fig. E47 : IP Code arrangement
Supplementary
letter
(optional)
Numerals
or letters
Meaning for the protection
of equipment
Meaning for the
protection of persons
Against ingress of solid foreign
objects
Against access to
hazardous parts with
(non-protected)
u 50 mm diameter
u 12.5 mm diameter
u 2.5 mm diameter
u 1.0 mm diameter
Dust-protected
Dust-tight
(non-protected)
Back of hand
Finger
Too l
Wire
Wire
Wire
IP
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
Against ingress of water with
harmful effects
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
(non-protected)
Vertically dripping
Dripping (15° tilted)
Spraying
Splashing
Jetting
Powerful jetting
Temporary immersion
Continuous immersion
Against access to
hazardous parts with
A
B
C
D
H
M
S
W
back of hand
Finger
Too l
Wire
Supplementary information specific to:
High-voltage apparatus
Motion during water test
Stationary during water test
Weather conditions
Fig. E48 : Elements of the IP Code
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Element
E - Distribution in low-voltage installations
3 External influences
(IEC 60364-5-51)
IK Code definition
Standard IEC 62262 defines an IK code that characterises the aptitude of equipment
to resist mechanical impacts on all sides (see Fig. E49).
IK code
E30
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
Impact energy
(in Joules)
0
y 0.14
y 0.20
y 0.35
y 0.50
y 0.70
y1
y2
y5
y 10
y 20
AG code
AG1
AG2
AG3
AG4
Fig. E49 : Elements of the IK Code
IP and IK code specifications for distribution switchboards
The degrees of protection IP and IK of an enclosure must be specified as a function
of the different external influences defined by standard IEC 60364-5-51, in particular:
b Presence of solid bodies (code AE)
b Presence of water (code AD)
b Mechanical stresses (no code)
b Capability of persons (code BA)
b…
Prisma Plus switchboards are designed for indoor installation.
Unless the rules, standards and regulations of a specific country stipulate otherwise,
Schneider Electric recommends the following IP and IK values (see Fig. E50 and
Fig. E51 )
IP recommendations
IP codes according to conditions
Normal without risk of vertically falling water
Normal with risk of vertically falling water
Very severe with risk of splashing water
from all directions
Technical rooms
Hallways
Workshops
30
31
54/55
Technical rooms
Hallways
07
08 (enclosure
with door)
10
Fig. E50 : IP recommendations
IK recommendations
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
IK codes according to conditions
No risk of major impact
Significant risk of major impact that could
damage devices
Maximum risk of impact that could damage
the enclosure
Fig. E51 : IK recommendations
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Workshops
Chapter F
Protection against electric shocks
Contents
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
General
F2
1.1 Electric shock
F2
1.2 Protection against electric shock
F3
1.3 Direct and indirect contact
F3
Protection against direct contact
F4
2.1 Measures of protection against direct contact
F4
2.2 Additional measure of protection against direct contact
F6
Protection against indirect contact
F6
3.1 Measures of protection: two levels
F6
3.2 Automatic disconnection for TT system
F7
3.3 Automatic disconnection for TN systems
F8
3.4 Automatic disconnection on a second fault in an IT system
F10
3.5 Measures of protection against direct or indirect contact
without automatic disconnection of supply
F13
Protection of goods in case of insulation fault
F17
4.1 Measures of protection against fire risk with RCDs
F17
4.2 Ground Fault Protection (GFP)
F17
Implementation of the TT system
F19
5.1 Protective measures
F19
5.2 Coordination of residual current protective devices
F20
Implementation of the TN system
F23
6.1 Preliminary conditions
F23
6.2 Protection against indirect contact
F23
6.3 High-sensitivity RCDs
F27
6.4 Protection in high fire-risk locations
F28
6.5 When the fault current-loop impedance is particularly high
F28
Implementation of the IT system
F29
7.1 Preliminary conditions
F29
7.2 Protection against indirect contact
F30
7.3 High-sensitivity RCDs
F34
7.4 Protection in high fire-risk locations
F35
7.5 When the fault current-loop impedance is particularly high
F35
Residual current differential devices (RCDs)
F36
8.1 Types of RCDs
F36
8.2 Description
F36
8.3 Sensitivity of RDCs to disturbances
F39
F1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
1 General
1.1 Electric shock
When a current exceeding 30 mA passes
through a part of a human body, the person
concerned is in serious danger if the current is
not interrupted in a very short time.
The protection of persons against electric
shock in LV installations must be provided in
conformity with appropriate national standards
statutory regulations, codes of practice, official
guides and circulars etc.
Relevant IEC standards include: IEC 60364,
IEC 60479 series, IEC 61008, IEC 61009 and
IEC 60947-2.
An electric shock is the pathophysiological effect of an electric current through the
human body.
Its passage affects essentially the muscular, circulatory and respiratory functions and
sometimes results in serious burns. The degree of danger for the victim is a function
of the magnitude of the current, the parts of the body through which the current
passes, and the duration of current flow.
IEC publication 60479-1 updated in 2005 defines four zones of current-magnitude/
time-duration, in each of which the pathophysiological effects are described
(see Fig F1). Any person coming into contact with live metal risks an electric shock.
Curve C1 shows that when a current greater than 30 mA passes through a human
being from one hand to feet, the person concerned is likely to be killed, unless the
current is interrupted in a relatively short time.
The point 500 ms/100 mA close to the curve C1 corresponds to a probability of heart
fibrillation of the order of 0.14%.
F2
The protection of persons against electric shock in LV installations must be provided
in conformity with appropriate national standards and statutory regulations, codes of
practice, official guides and circulars, etc. Relevant IEC standards include: IEC 60364
series, IEC 60479 series, IEC 60755, IEC 61008 series, IEC 61009 series and IEC
60947-2.
Duration of current
flow I (ms)
A
10,000
C1 C2 C3
B
5,000
AC-4.1
AC-4.2
2,000
AC-4.3
1,000
500
AC-1
AC-2
AC-3
AC-4
200
100
50
20
Body current
Is (mA)
10
0.1 0.2
0.5
1
2
5
10
20
50
100 200
500
2,000
10,000
1,000
5,000
AC-1 zone: Imperceptible
AC-2 zone: Perceptible
A curve: Threshold of perception of current
B curve: Threshold of muscular reactions
AC-3 zone : Reversible effects: muscular contraction
AC-4 zone: Possibility of irreversible effects
C1 curve: Threshold of 0% probability of ventricular
fibrillation
C2 curve: Threshold of 5% probability of ventricular
fibrillation
C3 curve: Threshold of 50% probability of ventricular
fibrillation
AC-4-1 zone: Up to 5%probability of heart fibrillation
AC-4-2 zone: Up to 50% probability of heart fibrillation
AC-4-3 zone: More than 50% probability of heart fibrillation
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F1 : Zones time/current of effects of AC current on human body when passing from left hand to feet
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 General
1.2 Protection against electric shock
The fundamental rule of protection against electric shock is provided by the
document IEC 61140 which covers both electrical installations and electrical
equipment.
Hazardous-live-parts shall not be accessible and accessible conductive parts shall
not be hazardous.
This requirement needs to apply under:
b Normal conditions, and
b Under a single fault condition
Various measures are adopted to protect against this hazard, and include:
b Automatic disconnection of the power supply to the connected electrical equipment
b Special arrangements such as:
v The use of class II insulation materials, or an equivalent level of insulation
v Non-conducting location, out of arm’s reach or interposition of barriers
v Equipotential bonding
F3
v Electrical separation by means of isolating transformers
1.3 Direct and indirect contact
Two measures of protection against direct
contact hazards are often required, since, in
practice, the first measure may not be infallible
Direct contact
A direct contact refers to a person coming into contact with a conductor which is live
in normal circumstances (see Fig. F2).
IEC 61140 standard has renamed “protection against direct contact” with the term
“basic protection”. The former name is at least kept for information.
Standards and regulations distinguish two kinds
of dangerous contact,
b Direct contact
b Indirect contact
and corresponding protective measures
Indirect contact
An indirect contact refers to a person coming into contact with an exposedconductive-part which is not normally alive, but has become alive accidentally (due
to insulation failure or some other cause).
The fault current raise the exposed-conductive-part to a voltage liable to be
hazardous which could be at the origin of a touch current through a person coming
into contact with this exposed-conductive-part (see Fig. F3).
IEC 61140 standard has renamed “protection against indirect contact” with the term
“fault protection”. The former name is at least kept for information.
1
1
2
3
2
3
PE
N
Id
Busbars
Insulation
failure
Is
Is
Fig. F2 : Direct contact
Fig F3 : Indirect contact
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Id: Insulation fault current
Is: Touch current
F - Protection against electric shock
2 Protection against direct contact
Two complementary measures are commonly used as protection against the
dangers of direct contact:
b The physical prevention of contact with live parts by barriers, insulation,
inaccessibility, etc.
b Additional protection in the event that a direct contact occurs, despite or due to
failure of the above measures. This protection is based on residual-current operating
device with a high sensitivity (In y 30 mA) and a low operating time. These devices
are highly effective in the majority of case of direct contact.
IEC and national standards frequently
distinguish two protections:
b Complete (insulation, enclosures)
b Partial or particular
2.1 Measures of protection against direct contact
Protection by the insulation of live parts
This protection consists of an insulation which complies with the relevant standards
(see Fig. F4). Paints, lacquers and varnishes do not provide an adequate protection.
F4
Fig. F4 : Inherent protection against direct contact by insulation of a 3-phase cable with outer
sheath
Protection by means of barriers or enclosures
This measure is in widespread use, since many components and materials are
installed in cabinets, assemblies, control panels and distribution boards (see Fig. F5).
To be considered as providing effective protection against direct contact hazards,
these equipment must possess a degree of protection equal to at least IP 2X or
IP XXB (see chapter E sub-clause 3.4).
Moreover, an opening in an enclosure (door, front panel, drawer, etc.) must only be
removable, open or withdrawn:
b By means of a key or tool provided for this purpose, or
b After complete isolation of the live parts in the enclosure, or
b With the automatic interposition of another screen removable only with a key or
a tool. The metal enclosure and all metal removable screen must be bonded to the
protective earthing conductor of the installation.
Partial measures of protection
b Protection by means of obstacles, or by placing out of arm’s reach
This protection is reserved only to locations to which skilled or instructed
persons only have access. The erection of this protective measure is detailed in
IEC 60364-4-41.
Particular measures of protection
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F5 : Example of isolation by envelope
b Protection by use of extra-low voltage SELV (Safety Extra-Low Voltage) or by
limitation of the energy of discharge.
These measures are used only in low-power circuits, and in particular circumstances,
as described in section 3.5.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Protection against direct contact
An additional measure of protection against
the hazards of direct contact is provided by the
use of residual current operating device, which
operate at 30 mA or less, and are referred to as
RCDs of high sensitivity
2.2 Additional measure of protection against direct
contact
All the preceding protective measures are preventive, but experience has shown
that for various reasons they cannot be regarded as being infallible. Among these
reasons may be cited:
b Lack of proper maintenance
b Imprudence, carelessness
b Normal (or abnormal) wear and tear of insulation; for instance flexure and abrasion
of connecting leads
b Accidental contact
b Immersion in water, etc. A situation in which insulation is no longer effective
In order to protect users in such circumstances, highly sensitive fast tripping
devices, based on the detection of residual currents to earth (which may or may
not be through a human being or animal) are used to disconnect the power
supply automatically, and with sufficient rapidity to prevent injury to, or death by
electrocution, of a normally healthy human being (see Fig. F6).
F5
These devices operate on the principle of differential current measurement, in which
any difference between the current entering a circuit and that leaving it (on a system
supplied from an earthed source) be flowing to earth, either through faulty insulation
or through contact of an earthed part, such as a person, with a live conductor.
Standardised residual-current devices, referred to as RCDs, sufficiently sensitive for
protection against direct contact are rated at 30 mA of differential current.
According to IEC 60364-4-41, additional protection by means of high sensitivity
RCDs (In y 30 mA) must be provided for circuits supplying socket-outlets with a
rated current y 20 A in all locations, and for circuits supplying mobile equipment with
a rated current y 32 A for use outdoors.
It is also recommended to limit the number of socket-outlets protected by a RCD
(e.g. 10 socket-outlets for one RCD).
Chapter P section 3 itemises various common locations in which RCDs of
high sensitivity are obligatory (in some countries), but in any case, are highly
recommended as an effective protection against both direct and indirect contact
hazards.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F6 : High sensitivity RCD
This additional protection is required in certain countries for circuits supplying socketoutlets rated up to 32 A, and even higher if the location is wet and/or temporary
(such as work sites for instance).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
3 Protection against indirect
contact
Exposed-conductive-parts used in the manufacturing process of an electrical
equipment is separated from the live parts of the equipment by the “basic insulation”.
Failure of the basic insulation will result in the exposed-conductive-parts being alive.
Touching a normally dead part of an electrical equipment which has become live due
to the failure of its insulation, is referred to as an indirect contact.
3.1 Measures of protection: two levels
Protection against indirect contact hazards
can be achieved by automatic disconnection of
the supply if the exposed-conductive-parts of
equipment are properly earthed
F6
Two levels of protective measures exist:
b 1st level: The earthing of all exposed-conductive-parts of electrical equipment in the
installation and the constitution of an equipotential bonding network (see chapter G
section 6).
b 2sd level: Automatic disconnection of the supply of the section of the installation
concerned, in such a way that the touch-voltage/time safety requirements are
respected for any level of touch voltage Uc(1) (see Fig. F7).
Earth
connection
Uc
Fig. F7 : Illustration of the dangerous touch voltage Uc
The greater the value of Uc, the greater the rapidity of supply disconnection required
to provide protection (see Fig. F8). The highest value of Uc that can be tolerated
indefinitely without danger to human beings is 50 V CA.
Reminder of the theoretical disconnecting-time limits
Uo (V)
50 < Uo y 120
System TN or IT 0.8
TT
0.3
120 < Uo y 230
0.4
0.2
230 < Uo y 400
0.2
0.07
Uo > 400
0.1
0.04
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F8 : Maximum safe duration of the assumed values of AC touch voltage (in seconds)
(1) Touch voltage Uc is the voltage existing (as the result of
insulation failure) between an exposed-conductive-part and
any conductive element within reach which is at a different
(generally earth) potential.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection against indirect
contact
3.2 Automatic disconnection for TT system
Automatic disconnection for TT system is
achieved by RCD having a sensitivity of
50
I 6n i
where RA is the resistance of the
RA
installation earth electrode
Principle
In this system all exposed-conductive-parts and extraneous-conductive-parts of
the installation must be connected to a common earth electrode. The neutral point
of the supply system is normally earthed at a pint outside the influence area of the
installation earth electrode, but need not be so. The impedance of the earth-fault loop
therefore consists mainly in the two earth electrodes (i.e. the source and installation
electrodes) in series, so that the magnitude of the earth fault current is generally
too small to operate overcurrent relay or fuses, and the use of a residual current
operated device is essential.
This principle of protection is also valid if one common earth electrode only is used,
notably in the case of a consumer-type substation within the installation area, where
space limitation may impose the adoption of a TN system earthing, but where all
other conditions required by the TN system cannot be fulfilled.
Protection by automatic disconnection of the supply used in TT system is by RCD of
sensitivity:
I 6n i
50
RA
F7
where
RA is the resistance of the earth electrode for the installation
In is the rated residual operating current of the RCD
For temporary supplies (to work sites, …) and agricultural and horticultural premises,
the value of 50 V is replaced by 25 V.
Example (see Fig. F9)
b The resistance of the earth electrode of substation neutral Rn is 10 .
b The resistance of the earth electrode of the installation RA is 20 .
b The earth-fault loop current Id = 7.7 A.
b The fault voltage Uf = Id x RA = 154 V and therefore dangerous, but
In = 50/20 = 2.5 A so that a standard 300 mA RCD will operate in about 30 ms
without intentional time delay and will clear the fault where a fault voltage exceeding
appears on an exposed-conductive-part.
Uo(1) (V)
T (s)
50 < Uo y 120
0.3
120 < Uo y 230
0.2
230 < Uo y 400
0.07
Uo > 400
0.04
(1) Uo is the nominal phase to earth voltage
Fig. F10 : Maximum disconnecting time for AC final circuits not exceeding 32 A
Rn = 10 Ω
RA = 20 Ω
Uf
Substation
earth
electrode
Installation
earth
electrode
Fig. F9 : Automatic disconnection of supply for TT system
Specified maximum disconnection time
The tripping times of RCDs are generally lower than those required in the majority
of national standards; this feature facilitates their use and allows the adoption of an
effective discriminative protection.
The IEC 60364-4-41 specifies the maximum operating time of protective devices
used in TT system for the protection against indirect contact:
b For all final circuits with a rated current not exceeding 32 A, the maximum
disconnecting time will not exceed the values indicated in Figure F10
b For all other circuits, the maximum disconnecting time is fixed to 1s. This limit
enables discrimination between RCDs when installed on distribution circuits.
RCD is a general term for all devices operating on the residual-current principle.
RCCB (Residual Current Circuit-Breaker) as defined in IEC 61008 series is a specific
class of RCD.
Type G (general) and type S (Selective) of IEC 61008 have a tripping time/current
characteristics as shown in Figure F11 next page. These characteristics allow a certain
degree of selective tripping between the several combination of ratings and types, as
shown later in sub-clause 4.3. Industrial type RCD according to IEC 60947-2 provide
more possibilities of discrimination due to their flexibility of time-delaying.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
2
3
N
PE
F - Protection against electric shock
x In
Domestic
Instantaneous
Type S
0.5
Industrial
Instantaneous
Time-delay (0.06)
Time-delay (other)
1
2
5
0.3
0.15
0.04
0.2
0.15
0.15
0.3
0.15
0.04
0.5
0.2
0.15
According to manufacturer
>5
0.04
0.04
0.15
Fig. F11 : Maximum operating time of RCD’s (in seconds)
3.3 Automatic disconnection for TN systems
F8
The automatic disconnection for TN system is
achieved by overcurrent protective devices or
RCD’s
Principle
In this system all exposed and extraneous-conductive-parts of the installation are
connected directly to the earthed point of the power supply by protective conductors.
As noted in Chapter E Sub-clause 1.2, the way in which this direct connection is
carried out depends on whether the TN-C, TN-S, or TN-C-S method of implementing
the TN principle is used. In figure F12 the method TN-C is shown, in which the
neutral conductor acts as both the Protective-Earth and Neutral (PEN) conductor. In
all TN systems, any insulation fault to earth results in a phase to neutral short-circuit.
High fault current levels allow to use overcurrent protection but can give rise to touch
voltages exceeding 50% of the phase to neutral voltage at the fault position during
the short disconnection time.
In practice for utility distribution network, earth electrodes are normally installed at
regular intervals along the protective conductor (PE or PEN) of the network, while
the consumer is often required to install an earth electrode at the service entrance.
On large installations additional earth electrodes dispersed around the premises are
often provided, in order to reduce the touch voltage as much as possible. In high-rise
apartment blocks, all extraneous conductive parts are connected to the protective
conductor at each level. In order to ensure adequate protection, the earth-fault
current
Uo
Uo
must be higher or equal to Ia, where:
or 0.8
Zs
Zc
b Uo = nominal phase to neutral voltage
b Id = the fault current
b Ia = current equal to the value required to operate the protective device in the time
specified
b Zs = earth-fault current loop impedance, equal to the sum of the impedances of the
source, the live phase conductors to the fault position, the protective conductors from
the fault position back to the source
b Zc = the faulty-circuit loop impedance (see “conventional method” Sub-clause 6.2)
Id =
Note: The path through earth electrodes back to the source will have (generally)
much higher impedance values than those listed above, and need not be considered.
A
B
1
2
3
PEN
F
E
N
NSX160
35 mm2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
50 m
35 mm2
D
C
Uf
Example (see Fig. F12)
230
= 115 V and is hazardous;
The fault voltage Uf =
2
The fault loop impedance Zs=ZAB + ZBC + ZDE + ZEN + ZNA.
If ZBC and ZDE are predominant, then:
L
= 64.3 m1 , so that
S
230
= 3,576 A ( 22 In based on a NSX160 circuit-breaker).
I d=
64.3 x10 -3
The “instantaneous” magnetic trip unit adjustment of the circuit-breaker is many time
less than this short-circuit value, so that positive operation in the shortest possible
time is assured.
Zs = 2l
Note: Some authorities base such calculations on the assumption that a voltage
drop of 20% occurs in the part of the impedance loop BANE.
This method, which is recommended, is explained in chapter F sub-clause 6.2
Fig. F12 : Automatic disconnection in TN system
“conventional method” and in this example will give an estimated fault current of
230 x 0.8 x 103
= 2,816 A ( 18 In).
64.3
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection against indirect
contact
Specified maximum disconnection time
The IEC 60364-4-41 specifies the maximum operating time of protective devices
used in TN system for the protection against indirect contact:
b For all final circuits with a rated current not exceeding 32 A, the maximum
disconnecting time will not exceed the values indicated in Figure F13
b For all other circuits, the maximum disconnecting time is fixed to 5s. This limit
enables discrimination between protective devices installed on distribution circuits
Note: The use of RCDs may be necessary on TN-earthed systems. Use of RCDs on
TN-C-S systems means that the protective conductor and the neutral conductor must
(evidently) be separated upstream of the RCD. This separation is commonly made at
the service entrance.
Uo(1) (V)
T (s)
50 < Uo y 120
0.8
120 < Uo y 230
0.4
230 < Uo y 400
0.2
Uo > 400
0.1
(1) Uo is the nominal phase to earth voltage
F9
Fig. F13 : Maximum disconnecting time for AC final circuits not exceeding 32 A
If the protection is to be provided by a circuitbreaker, it is sufficient to verify that the fault
current will always exceed the current-setting
level of the instantaneous or short-time delay
tripping unit (Im)
Protection by means of circuit-breaker (see Fig. F14)
Ia can be determined from the fuse
performance curve. In any case, protection
cannot be achieved if the loop impedance Zs
or Zc exceeds a certain value
Protection by means of fuses (see Fig. F15)
The instantaneous trip unit of a circuit-breaker will eliminate a short-circuit to earth in
less than 0.1 second.
In consequence, automatic disconnection within the maximum allowable time will
always be assured, since all types of trip unit, magnetic or electronic, instantaneous
or slightly retarded, are suitable: Ia = Im. The maximum tolerance authorised
by the relevant standard, however, must always be taken into consideration. It is
Uo
Uo
determined by calculation
sufficient therefore that the fault current
or 0.8
Zc
Zs
(or estimated on site) be greater than the instantaneous trip-setting current, or than
the very short-time tripping threshold level, to be sure of tripping within the permitted
time limit.
The value of current which assures the correct operation of a fuse can be
ascertained from a current/time performance graph for the fuse concerned.
Uo
Uo
or 0.8
The fault current
as determined above, must largely exceed that
Zc
Zs
necessary to ensure positive operation of the fuse. The condition to observe
Uo
Uo
or 0.8
therefore is that I a <
as indicated in Figure F15.
Zc
Zs
t
t
1: Short-time delayed trip
2: Instantaneous trip
2
I
Im
I
Ia Uo/Zs
Uo/Zs
Fig. F14 : Disconnection by circuit-breaker for a TN system
Fig. F15 : Disconnection by fuses for a TN system
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
tc = 0.4 s
1
F - Protection against electric shock
Example: The nominal phase to neutral voltage of the network is 230 V and
the maximum disconnection time given by the graph in Figure F15 is 0.4 s.
The corresponding value of Ia can be read from the graph. Using the voltage (230 V)
and the current Ia, the complete loop impedance or the circuit loop impedance can
230
230
be calculated from Zs =
. This impedance value must never be
or Zc = 0.8
Ia
Ia
exceeded and should preferably be substantially less to ensure satisfactory fuse
operation.
Protection by means of Residual Current Devices for
TN-S circuits
Residual Current Devices must be used where:
b The loop impedance cannot be determined precisely (lengths difficult to estimate,
presence of metallic material close to the wiring)
b The fault current is so low that the disconnecting time cannot be met by using
overcurrent protective devices
The rated tripping current of RCDs being in the order of a few amps, it is well below
the fault current level. RCDs are consequently well adapted to this situation.
F10
In practice, they are often installed in the LV sub distribution and in many countries,
the automatic disconnection of final circuits shall be achieved by Residual Current
Devices.
3.4 Automatic disconnection on a second fault in an
IT system
In this type of system:
b The installation is isolated from earth, or the neutral point of its power-supply
source is connected to earth through a high impedance
b All exposed and extraneous-conductive-parts are earthed via an installation earth
electrode.
First fault situation
In IT system the first fault to earth should not
cause any disconnection
On the occurrence of a true fault to earth, referred to as a “first fault”, the fault current
is very low, such that the rule Id x RA y 50 V (see F3.2) is fulfilled and no dangerous
fault voltages can occur.
In practice the current Id is low, a condition that is neither dangerous to personnel,
nor harmful to the installation.
However, in this system:
b A permanent monitoring of the insulation to earth must be provided, coupled with
an alarm signal (audio and/or flashing lights, etc.) operating in the event of a first
earth fault (see Fig. F16)
b The rapid location and repair of a first fault is imperative if the full benefits of the
IT system are to be realised. Continuity of service is the great advantage afforded by
the system.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For a network formed from 1 km of new conductors, the leakage (capacitive)
impedance to earth Zf is of the order of 3,500 per phase. In normal operation, the
capacitive current(1) to earth is therefore:
Uo
230
=
= 66 mA per phase.
Zf 3,500
During a phase to earth fault, as indicated in Figure F17 opposite page, the current
passing through the electrode resistance RnA is the vector sum of the capacitive
currents in the two healthy phases. The voltages of the healthy phases have
(because of the fault) increased to 3 the normal phase voltage, so that the capacitive
currents increase by the same amount. These currents are displaced, one from the
other by 60°, so that when added vectorially, this amounts to 3 x 66 mA = 198 mA, in
the present example.
The fault voltage Uf is therefore equal to 198 x 5 x 10-3 = 0.99 V, which is obviously
harmless.
The current through the short-circuit to earth is given by the vector sum of the
neutral-resistor current Id1 (=153 mA) and the capacitive current Id2 (198 mA).
Since the exposed-conductive-parts of the installation are connected directly to
earth, the neutral impedance Zct plays practically no part in the production of touch
voltages to earth.
Fig. F16 : Phases to earth insulation monitoring device
obligatory in IT system
(1) Resistive leakage current to earth through the insulation is
assumed to be negligibly small in the example.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection against indirect
contact
Id1 + Id2
Id1
1
2
3
N
PE
B
Zf
Zct = 1,500 Ω
Ω
RnA = 5 Ω
Id2
Uf
F11
Fig. F17 : Fault current path for a first fault in IT system
Second fault situation
On the appearance of a second fault, on a different phase, or on a neutral conductor,
a rapid disconnection becomes imperative. Fault clearance is carried out differently in
each of the following cases:
The simultaneous existence of two earth faults
(if not both on the same phase) is dangerous,
and rapid clearance by fuses or automatic
circuit-breaker tripping depends on the type of
earth-bonding scheme, and whether separate
earthing electrodes are used or not, in the
installation concerned
1st case
It concerns an installation in which all exposed conductive parts are bonded to a
common PE conductor, as shown in Figure F18.
In this case no earth electrodes are included in the fault current path, so that a high
level of fault current is assured, and conventional overcurrent protective devices are
used, i.e. circuit-breakers and fuses.
The first fault could occur at the end of a circuit in a remote part of the installation,
while the second fault could feasibly be located at the opposite end of the installation.
For this reason, it is conventional to double the loop impedance of a circuit, when
calculating the anticipated fault setting level for its overcurrent protective device(s).
Where the system includes a neutral conductor in addition to the 3 phase
conductors, the lowest short-circuit fault currents will occur if one of the (two) faults is
from the neutral conductor to earth (all four conductors are insulated from earth in an
IT scheme). In four-wire IT installations, therefore, the phase-to-neutral voltage must
Uo
u I a (1) where
be used to calculate short-circuit protective levels i.e. 0.8
2 Zc
Uo = phase to neutral voltage
Zc = impedance of the circuit fault-current loop (see F3.3)
Ia = current level for trip setting
If no neutral conductor is distributed, then the voltage to use for the fault-current
3 Uo
u I a (1)
2 Zc
b Maximum tripping times
calculation is the phase-to-phase value, i.e. 0.8
Disconnecting times for IT system depends on how the different installation and
substation earth electrodes are interconnected.
For final circuits supplying electrical equipment with a rated current not exceeding
32 A and having their exposed-conductive-parts connected to an independent earth
electrode electrically separated from the substation earth electrode, the maximum
tripping time is given in Figure F13. For the other circuits within the same group of
non interconnected exposed-conductive-parts, the maximum disconnecting time is
1s. This is due to the fact that any double fault situation resulting from one insulation
fault within this group and another insulation fault from another group will generate a
fault current limited by the different earth electrode resistances as in TT system.
(1) Based on the “conventional method” noted in the first
example of Sub-clause 3.3.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For final circuits supplying electrical equipment with a rated current not exceeding
32 A and having their exposed-conductive-parts bonded with the substation earth
electrode, the maximum tripping time is given in table F8. For the other circuits
within the same group of interconnected exposed-conductive-parts, the maximum
disconnecting time is 5 s. This is due to the fact that any double fault situation within
this group will result in a short-circuit current as in TN system.
F - Protection against electric shock
Id
K
A
B
J
F
NSX160
160 A
50 m
35 mm2
G
1
2
3
N
PE
E
50 m
35 mm2
H
D
C
RA
F12
Fig. F18 : Circuit-breaker tripping on double fault situation when exposed-conductive-parts are
connected to a common protective conductor
b Protection by circuit-breaker
In the case shown in Figure F18, the adjustments of instantaneous and short-time
delay overcurrent trip unit must be decided. The times recommended here above can
be readily complied with. The short-circuit protection provided by the NSX160 circuitbreaker is suitable to clear a phase to phase short-circuit occurring at the load ends
of the circuits concerned.
Reminder: In an IT system, the two circuits involved in a phase to phase short-circuit
are assumed to be of equal length, with the same cross sectional area conductors,
the PE conductors being the same cross sectional area as the phase conductors. In
such a case, the impedance of the circuit loop when using the “conventional method”
(sub clause 6.2) will be twice that calculated for one of the circuits in the TN case,
shown in Chapter F sub clause 3.3.
L
The resistance of circuit loop FGHJ = 2RJH = 2l in m1 where:
a
= resistance of copper rod 1 meter long of cross sectional area 1 mm2, in m
L = length of the circuit in meters
a = cross sectional area of the conductor in mm2
FGHJ = 2 x 22.5 x 50/35 = 64.3 m
and the loop resistance B, C, D, E, F, G, H, J will be 2 x 64.3 = 129 m.
The fault current will therefore be 0.8 x 3 x 230 x 103/129 = 2,470 A.
b Protection by fuses
The current Ia for which fuse operation must be assured in a time specified according
to here above can be found from fuse operating curves, as described in figure F15.
The current indicated should be significantly lower than the fault currents calculated
for the circuit concerned.
b Protection by Residual current circuit-breakers (RCCBs)
For low values of short-circuit current, RCCBs are necessary. Protection against
indirect contact hazards can be achieved then by using one RCCB for each circuit.
2nd case
b It concerns exposed conductive parts which are earthed either individually (each part
having its own earth electrode) or in separate groups (one electrode for each group).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
If all exposed conductive parts are not bonded to a common electrode system, then
it is possible for the second earth fault to occur in a different group or in a separately
earthed individual apparatus. Additional protection to that described above for
case 1, is required, and consists of a RCD placed at the circuit-breaker controlling
each group and each individually-earthed apparatus.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection against indirect
contact
The reason for this requirement is that the separate-group electrodes are “bonded”
through the earth so that the phase to phase short-circuit current will generally be
limited when passing through the earth bond by the electrode contact resistances
with the earth, thereby making protection by overcurrent devices unreliable. The
more sensitive RCDs are therefore necessary, but the operating current of the RCDs
must evidently exceed that which occurs for a first fault (see Fig. F19).
Leakage capacitance
(μF)
1
5
30
First fault current
(A)
0.07
0.36
2.17
Note: 1 µF is the 1 km typical leakage capacitance for
4-conductor cable.
F13
Fig. F19 : Correspondence between the earth leakage capacitance and the first fault current
For a second fault occurring within a group having a common earth-electrode
system, the overcurrent protection operates, as described above for case 1.
Note 1: See also Chapter G Sub-clause 7.2, protection of the neutral conductor.
Note 2: In 3-phase 4-wire installations, protection against overcurrent in the neutral
conductor is sometimes more conveniently achieved by using a ring-type current
transformer over the single-core neutral conductor (see Fig. F20).
Case 2
Case 1
RCD
N
RCD
N
Ω PIM
RCD
RCD
Ω PIM
Group
earth 1
Group
earth
Rn
RA
Rn
RA1
Group
earth 2
RA2
Fig. F20 : Application of RCDs when exposed-conductive-parts are earthed individually or by group on IT system
3.5 Measures of protection against direct or indirect
contact without automatic disconnection of supply
The use of SELV (Safety Extra-Low Voltage)
Safety by extra low voltage SELV is used in situations where the operation of electrical
equipment presents a serious hazard (swimming pools, amusement parks, etc.).
This measure depends on supplying power at extra-low voltage from the secondary
windings of isolating transformers especially designed according to national or to
international (IEC 60742) standard. The impulse withstand level of insulation between
the primary and secondary windings is very high, and/or an earthed metal screen
is sometimes incorporated between the windings. The secondary voltage never
exceeds 50 V rms.
Three conditions of exploitation must be respected in order to provide satisfactory
protection against indirect contact:
b No live conductor at SELV must be connected to earth
b Exposed-conductive-parts of SELV supplied equipment must not be connected to
earth, to other exposed conductive parts, or to extraneous-conductive-parts
b All live parts of SELV circuits and of other circuits of higher voltage must be
separated by a distance at least equal to that between the primary and secondary
windings of a safety isolating transformer.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Extra-low voltage is used where the risks
are great: swimming pools, wandering-lead
hand lamps, and other portable appliances for
outdoor use, etc.
F - Protection against electric shock
These measures require that:
b SELV circuits must use conduits exclusively provided for them, unless cables which
are insulated for the highest voltage of the other circuits are used for the SELV circuits
b Socket outlets for the SELV system must not have an earth-pin contact. The
SELV circuit plugs and sockets must be special, so that inadvertent connection to a
different voltage level is not possible.
Note: In normal conditions, when the SELV voltage is less than 25 V, there is no
need to provide protection against direct contact hazards. Particular requirements
are indicated in Chapter P, Clause 3: “special locations”.
The use of PELV (Protection by Extra Low Voltage) (see Fig. F21)
This system is for general use where low voltage is required, or preferred for safety
reasons, other than in the high-risk locations noted above. The conception is similar
to that of the SELV system, but the secondary circuit is earthed at one point.
IEC 60364-4-41 defines precisely the significance of the reference PELV. Protection
against direct contact hazards is generally necessary, except when the equipment
is in the zone of equipotential bonding, and the nominal voltage does not exceed
25 V rms, and the equipment is used in normally dry locations only, and large-area
contact with the human body is not expected. In all other cases, 6 V rms is the
maximum permitted voltage, where no direct contact protection is provided.
F14
230 V / 24 V
Fig. F21 : Low-voltage supplies from a safety isolating transformer
FELV system (Functional Extra-Low Voltage)
Where, for functional reasons, a voltage of 50 V or less is used, but not all of the
requirements relating to SELV or PELV are fulfilled, appropriate measures described
in IEC 60364-4-41 must be taken to ensure protection against both direct and
indirect contact hazards, according to the location and use of these circuits.
Note: Such conditions may, for example, be encountered when the circuit contains
equipment (such as transformers, relays, remote-control switches, contactors)
insufficiently insulated with respect to circuits at higher voltages.
The electrical separation of circuits is suitable
for relatively short cable lengths and high levels
of insulation resistance. It is preferably used for
an individual appliance
The electrical separation of circuits (see Fig. F22)
The principle of the electrical separation of circuits (generally single-phase circuits)
for safety purposes is based on the following rationale.
The two conductors from the unearthed single-phase secondary winding of a
separation transformer are insulated from earth.
If a direct contact is made with one conductor, a very small current only will flow into
the person making contact, through the earth and back to the other conductor, via
the inherent capacitance of that conductor with respect to earth. Since the conductor
capacitance to earth is very small, the current is generally below the level of perception.
As the length of circuit cable increases, the direct contact current will progressively
increase to a point where a dangerous electric shock will be experienced.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
230 V/230 V
Fig. F22 : Safety supply from a class II separation transformer
Even if a short length of cable precludes any danger from capacitive current, a low
value of insulation resistance with respect to earth can result in danger, since the
current path is then via the person making contact, through the earth and back to the
other conductor through the low conductor-to-earth insulation resistance.
For these reasons, relatively short lengths of well insulated cables are essential in
separation systems.
Transformers are specially designed for this duty, with a high degree of insulation
between primary and secondary windings, or with equivalent protection, such as an
earthed metal screen between the windings. Construction of the transformer is to
class II insulation standards.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection against indirect
contact
As indicated before, successful exploitation of the principle requires that:
b No conductor or exposed conductive part of the secondary circuit must be
connected to earth,
b The length of secondary cabling must be limited to avoid large capacitance values(1),
b A high insulation-resistance value must be maintained for the cabling and appliances.
These conditions generally limit the application of this safety measure to an
individual appliance.
In the case where several appliances are supplied from a separation transformer, it is
necessary to observe the following requirements:
b The exposed conductive parts of all appliances must be connected together by an
insulated protective conductor, but not connected to earth,
b The socket outlets must be provided with an earth-pin connection. The earth-pin
connection is used in this case only to ensure the interconnection (bonding) of all
exposed conductive parts.
In the case of a second fault, overcurrent protection must provide automatic
disconnection in the same conditions as those required for an IT system of power
system earthing.
F15
Class II equipment
Class II equipment symbol:
These appliances are also referred to as having “double insulation” since in class
II appliances a supplementary insulation is added to the basic insulation (see
Fig. F23).
No conductive parts of a class II appliance must be connected to a protective conductor:
b Most portable or semi-fixed equipment, certain lamps, and some types of
transformer are designed to have double insulation. It is important to take particular
care in the exploitation of class II equipment and to verify regularly and often that the
class II standard is maintained (no broken outer envelope, etc.). Electronic devices,
radio and television sets have safety levels equivalent to class II, but are not formally
class II appliances
b Supplementary insulation in an electrical installation: IEC 60364-4-41(Sub-clause
413-2) and some national standards such as NF C 15-100 (France) describe in
more detail the necessary measures to achieve the supplementary insulation during
installation work.
Active part
Basic insulation
Supplementary insulation
Fig. F23 : Principle of class II insulation level
A simple example is that of drawing a cable into a PVC conduit. Methods are also
described for distribution switchboards.
b For ASSEMBLIES, IEC 61439-1 describes a set of requirements, for what is
referred to as “total insulation”, equivalent to class II equipment
b Some cables are recognised as being equivalent to class II by many national standards
Out-of-arm’s reach or interposition of obstacles
By these means, the probability of touching a live exposed-conductive-part, while at
the same time touching an extraneous-conductive-part at earth potential, is extremely
low (see Fig. F24 next page). In practice, this measure can only be applied in a dry
location, and is implemented according to the following conditions:
b The floor and the wall of the chamber must be non-conducting, i.e. the resistance
to earth at any point must be:
v > 50 k (installation voltage y 500 V)
v > 100 k (500 V < installation voltage y 1000 V)
Resistance is measured by means of “MEGGER” type instruments (hand-operated
generator or battery-operated electronic model) between an electrode placed on the
floor or against the wall, and earth (i.e. the nearest protective earth conductor). The
electrode contact area pressure must be evidently be the same for all tests.
(1) It is recommended in IEC 364-4-41 that the product of the
nominal voltage of the circuit in volts and length in metres of
the wiring system should not exceed 100,000, and that the
length of the wiring system should not exceed 500 m.
Different instruments suppliers provide electrodes specific to their own product, so
that care should be taken to ensure that the electrodes used are those supplied with
the instrument.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In principle, safety by placing simultaneouslyaccessible conductive parts out-of-reach, or by
interposing obstacles, requires also a nonconducting floor, and so is not an easily applied
principle
F - Protection against electric shock
3 Protection against indirect
contact
b The placing of equipment and obstacles must be such that simultaneous contact
with two exposed-conductive-parts or with an exposed conductive-part and an
extraneous-conductive-part by an individual person is not possible.
b No exposed protective conductor must be introduced into the chamber concerned.
b Entrances to the chamber must be arranged so that persons entering are not at
risk, e.g. a person standing on a conducting floor outside the chamber must not be
able to reach through the doorway to touch an exposed-conductive-part, such as a
lighting switch mounted in an industrial-type cast-iron conduit box, for example.
Insulated
walls
Insulated
obstacles
F16
2.5 m
Electrical
apparatus
Electrical
apparatus
Electrical
apparatus
Insulated floor
>2m
<2m
Fig. F24 : Protection by out-of arm’s reach arrangements and the interposition of non-conducting obstacles
Earth-free equipotential chambers are
associated with particular installations
(laboratories, etc.) and give rise to a number of
practical installation difficulties
Earth-free equipotential chambers
In this scheme, all exposed-conductive-parts, including the floor (1) are bonded by
suitably large conductors, such that no significant difference of potential can exist
between any two points. A failure of insulation between a live conductor and the
metal envelope of an appliance will result in the whole “cage” being raised to phaseto-earth voltage, but no fault current will flow. In such conditions, a person entering
the chamber would be at risk (since he/she would be stepping on to a live floor).
Suitable precautions must be taken to protect personnel from this danger (e.g. nonconducting floor at entrances, etc.). Special protective devices are also necessary to
detect insulation failure, in the absence of significant fault current.
M
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Conductive
floor
Insulating material
Fig. F25 : Equipotential bonding of all exposed-conductive-parts simultaneously accessible
(1) Extraneous conductive parts entering (or leaving) the
equipotential space (such as water pipes, etc.) must be
encased in suitable insulating material and excluded from the
equipotential network, since such parts are likely to be bonded
to protective (earthed) conductors elsewhere in the installation.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
4 Protection of goods
in case of insulation fault
The standards consider the damage (mainly fire) of goods due to insulation faults
to be high. Therefore, for location with high risk of fire, 300 mA Residual Current
Devices must be used. For the other locations, some standards relies on technique
called « Ground Fault Protection » (GFP).
4.1 Measures of protection against fire risk with
RCDs
RCDs are very effective devices to provide
protection against fire risk due to insulation
fault because they can detect leakage current
(ex : 300 mA) wich are too low for the other
protections, but sufficient to cause a fire
RCDs are very effective devices to provide protection against fire risk due to
insulation fault. This type of fault current is actually too low to be detected by the
other protection (overcurrent, reverse time).
For TT, IT TN-S systems in which leakage current can appear, the use of 300 mA
sensitivity RCDs provides a good protection against fire risk due to this type of fault.
An investigation has shown that the cost of the fires in industrial and tertiary
buildings can be very great.
F17
The analysis of the phenomena shows that fire risk due to electicity is linked to
overheating due to a bad coordination between the maximum rated current of the
cable (or isolated conductor) and the overcurrent protection setting.
Overheating can also be due to the modification of the initial method of installation
(addition of cables on the same support).
This overheating can be the origin of electrical arc in humid environment. These
electrical arcs evolve when the fault current-loop impedance is greater than 0.6
and exist only when an insulation fault occurs. Some tests have shown that a
300 mA fault current can induce a real risk of fire (see Fig. F26).
4.2 Ground Fault Protection (GFP)
Beginning of fire
Different type of ground fault protections (see Fig. F27)
Three types of GFP are possible dependind on the measuring device installed :
b “Residual Sensing” RS
The “insulation fault” current is calculated using the vectorial sum of currents of
current transformers secondaries. The current transformer on the neutral conductor
is often outside the circuit-breaker.
Id << 300 mA
Humid dust
Some tests have shown that a very low leakage
current (a few mA) can evolve and, from 300 mA,
induce a fire in humid and dusty environment.
b “Source Ground Return” SGR
The « insulation fault current » is measured in the neutral – earth link of the
LV transformer. The current transformer is outside the circuit-breaker.
b “Zero Sequence” ZS
The « insulation fault » is directly measured at the secondary of the current
transformer using the sum of currents in live conductors. This type of GFP is only
used with low fault current values.
Fig. F26 : Origin of fires in buildings
RS system
SGR system
ZS system
R
R
L1
L1
L2
L3
N
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
N
N
PE
Fig. F27 : Different types of ground fault protections
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R
F - Protection against electric shock
4 Protection of goods
in case of insulation fault
Positioning GFP devices in the installation
Type / installation level
Source Ground Return
(SGR)
Main-distribution
v
Sub-distribution
Comments
Used
Residual Sensing (RS)
(SGR)
v
b
Often used
Zero Sequence
(SGR)
v
b
Rarely used
v Possible
b Recommended or required
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
F18
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
5 Implementation of the TT system
5.1 Protective measures
Protection against indirect contact
General case
Protection against indirect contact is assured by RCDs, the sensitivity n of which
50 V (1)
complies with the condition I 6n i
RA
The choice of sensitivity of the residual current device is a function of the resistance
RA of the earth electrode for the installation, and is given in Figure F28.
In
3A
1A
500 mA
300 mA
30 mA
Maximum resistance of the earth electrode
(50 V)
(25 V)
16
8
50
25
100
50
166
83
1666
833
F19
Fig. F28 : The upper limit of resistance for an installation earthing electrode which must not be
exceeded, for given sensitivity levels of RCDs at UL voltage limits of 50 V and 25 V
Case of distribution circuits (see Fig. F29)
IEC 60364-4-41 and a number of national standards recognize a maximum tripping
time of 1 second in installation distribution circuits (as opposed to final circuits). This
allows a degree of selective discrimination to be achieved:
b At level A: RCD time-delayed, e.g. “S” type
b At level B: RCD instantaneous
Case where the exposed conductive parts of an appliance, or group of
appliances, are connected to a separate earth electrode (see Fig. F30)
Protection against indirect contact by a RCD at the circuit-breaker level protecting
each group or separately-earthed individual appliance.
A
RCD
In each case, the sensitivity must be compatible with the resistance of the earth
electrode concerned.
High-sensitivity RCDs (see Fig. F31)
According to IEC 60364-4-41, high sensitivity RCDs (y 30 mA) must be used for
protection of socket outlets with rated current y 20 A in all locations. The use of such
RCDs is also recommended in the following cases:
b Socket-outlet circuits in wet locations at all current ratings
b Socket-outlet circuits in temporary installations
b Circuits supplying laundry rooms and swimming pools
b Supply circuits to work-sites, caravans, pleasure boats, and travelling fairs
See 2.2 and chapter P, section 3
RCD
Fig. F29 : Distribution circuits
RA1
RA2
Distant location
Fig. F30 : Separate earth electrode
Fig. F31 : Circuit supplying socket-outlets
(1) 25 V for work-site installations, agricultural establishments, etc.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
B
RCD
F - Protection against electric shock
In high fire risk locations (see Fig. F32)
RCD protection at the circuit-breaker controlling all supplies to the area at risk is
necessary in some locations, and mandatory in many countries.
The sensitivity of the RCD must be y 500 mA, but a 300 mA sensitivity is
recommended.
Protection when exposed conductive parts are not connected
to earth (see Fig. F33)
(In the case of an existing installation where the location is dry and provision of
an earthing connection is not possible, or in the event that a protective earth wire
becomes broken).
RCDs of high sensitivity (y 30 mA) will afford both protection against indirect-contact
hazards, and the additional protection against the dangers of direct-contact.
F20
Fire-risk
location
Fig. F32 : Fire-risk location
Fig. F33 : Unearthed exposed conductive parts (A)
5.2 Coordination of residual current protective
devices
Discriminative-tripping coordination is achieved either by time-delay or by subdivision
of circuits, which are then protected individually or by groups, or by a combination of
both methods.
Such discrimination avoids the tripping of any RCD, other than that immediately
upstream of a fault position:
b With equipment currently available, discrimination is possible at three or four
different levels of distribution :
v At the main general distribution board
v At local general distribution boards
v At sub-distribution boards
v At socket outlets for individual appliance protection
b In general, at distribution boards (and sub-distribution boards, if existing) and on
individual-appliance protection, devices for automatic disconnection in the event of
an indirect-contact hazard occurring are installed together with additional protection
against direct-contact hazards.
Discrimination between RCDs
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The general specification for achieving total discrimination between two RCDs is as
follow:
b The ratio between the rated residual operating currents must be > 2
b Time delaying the upstream RCD
Discrimination is achieved by exploiting the several levels of standardized sensitivity:
30 mA, 100 mA, 300 mA and 1 A and the corresponding tripping times, as shown
opposite page in Figure F34.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Implementation of the TT system
t (ms)
10,000
1,000
500
300
250
200
150
130
100
II
I
60
40
selective RCDs
domestic S
F21
and industrial
(settings I and II)
RCD 30 mA
general domestic
and industrial setting 0
Current
(mA)
1,000
300
60
500
600
30
150
15
100
10
1 1.5
10
100
500 1,000
(A)
Fig. F34 : Total discrimination at 2 levels
Discrimination at 2 levels (see Fig. F35)
A
b Level A: RCD time-delayed setting (for industrial device) or type S (for domestic
device) for protection against indirect contacts
b Level B: RCD instantaneous, with high sensitivity on circuits supplying socketoutlets or appliances at high risk (washing machines, etc.) See also Chapter P
Clause 3
Protection
RCD 300 mA
type S
RCD
30 mA
B
Schneider Electric solutions
b Level A: Compact or Acti 9 circuit-breaker with adaptable RCD module
(Vigicompact NSX160), setting I or S type
b Level B: Circuit-breaker with integrated RCD module (DPN Vigi) or adaptable
RCD module (e.g. Vigi iC60) or Vigicompact NSX
Fig. F35 : Total discrimination at 2 levels
Note: The setting of upstream RCCB must comply with selectivity rules and take into
account all the downstream earth leakage currents.
Relay with separate
toroidal CT 3 A
delay time 500 ms
B
Discrimination at 3 or 4 levels (see Fig. F36)
Protection
b Level A: RCD time-delayed (setting III)
b Level B: RCD time-delayed (setting II)
b Level C: RCD time-delayed (setting I) or type S
b Level D: RCD instantaneous
RCCB 1 A
delay time 250 ms
C
RCCB 300 A
delay time 50 ms
or type S
D
Fig. F36 : Total discrimination at 3 or 4 levels
RCCB
30 mA
Schneider Electric solutions
b Level A: Circuit-breaker associated with RCD and separate toroidal transformer
(Vigirex RH)
b Level B: Vigicompact NSX or Vigirex
b Level C: Vigirex, Vigicompact NSX or Vigi iC60
b Level D:
v Vigicompact NSX or
v Vigirex or
v Acti 9 with integrated or adaptable RCD module : Vigi iC60 or DPN Vigi
Note: The setting of upstream RCCB must comply with selectivity rules and take into
account all the downstream earth leakage currents
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A
F - Protection against electric shock
5 Implementation of the TT system
Discriminative protection at three levels (see Fig. F37)
Masterpact
MV/LV
F22
NSX400
NSX100 MA
Discont.
Vigicompact
NSX100
Setting 1
300 mA
Vigi NG125 LMA
instantaneous
300 mA
Vigi NG125
300 mA
selective
Leakage current
of the filter: 20 mA
Terminal
board
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Reflex
iC60 diff.
30 mA
Leakage current equal to 3.5 mA per
socket outlet (Information technology
equipement): max 4 sockets outlets.
Fig. F37 : Typical 3-level installation, showing the protection of distribution circuits in a TT-earthed system. One motor is provided with specific protection
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
6 Implementation of the TN system
6.1 Preliminary conditions
At the design stage, the maximum permitted lengths of cable downstream of a
protective circuit-breaker (or set of fuses) must be calculated, while during the
installation work certain rules must be fully respected.
Certain conditions must be observed, as listed below and illustrated in Figure F38.
1. PE conductor must be regularly connected to earth as much as possible.
2. The PE conductor must not pass through ferro-magnetic conduit, ducts, etc. or
be mounted on steel work, since inductive and/or proximity effects can increase the
effective impedance of the conductor.
3. In the case of a PEN conductor (a neutral conductor which is also used as a
protective conductor), connection must be made directly to the earth terminal of an
appliance (see 3 in Figure F38) before being looped to the neutral terminal of the
same appliance.
4. Where the conductor y 6 mm2 for copper or 10 mm2 for aluminium, or where a
cable is movable, the neutral and protective conductors should be separated (i.e. a
TN-S system should be adopted within the installation).
5. Earth faults may be cleared by overcurrent-protection devices, i.e. by fuses and
circuit-breakers.
The foregoing list indicates the conditions to be respected in the implementation of a
TN scheme for the protection against indirect contacts.
F23
5
2
2
5
PEN
1
5
PE N
4
3
TN-C system
TN-C-S system
RpnA
Notes:
b The TN scheme requires that the LV neutral of the MV/LV transformer, the exposed
conductive parts of the substation and of the installation, and the extraneous conductive
parts in the substation and installation, all be earthed to a common earthing system.
b For a substation in which the metering is at low-voltage, a means of isolation is required at
the origin of the LV installation, and the isolation must be clearly visible.
b A PEN conductor must never be interrupted under any circumstances. Control and
protective switchgear for the several TN arrangements will be:
v 3-pole when the circuit includes a PEN conductor,
v Preferably 4-pole (3 phases + neutral) when the circuit includes a neutral with a separate
PE conductor.
Fig. F38 : Implementation of the TN system of earthing
6.2 Protection against indirect contact
Methods of determining levels of short-circuit current
In TN-earthed systems, a short-circuit to earth will, in principle, always provide
sufficient current to operate an overcurrent device.
The source and supply mains impedances are much lower than those of the
installation circuits, so that any restriction in the magnitude of earth-fault currents
will be mainly caused by the installation conductors (long flexible leads to appliances
greatly increase the “fault-loop” impedance, with a corresponding reduction of shortcircuit current).
The most recent IEC recommendations for indirect-contact protection on TN earthing
systems only relates maximum allowable tripping times to the nominal system
voltage (see Figure F12 in Sub-clause 3.3).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Three methods of calculation are commonly
used:
b The method of impedances, based on the
trigonometric addition of the system resistances
and inductive reactances
b The method of composition
b The conventional method, based on an
assumed voltage drop and the use of prepared
tables
F - Protection against electric shock
The reasoning behind these recommendations is that, for TN systems, the current
which must flow in order to raise the potential of an exposed conductive part to 50 V
or more is so high that one of two possibilities will occur:
b Either the fault path will blow itself clear, practically instantaneously, or
b The conductor will weld itself into a solid fault and provide adequate current to
operate overcurrent devices
To ensure correct operation of overcurrent devices in the latter case, a reasonably
accurate assessment of short-circuit earth-fault current levels must be determined at
the design stage of a project.
A rigorous analysis requires the use of phase-sequence-component techniques
applied to every circuit in turn. The principle is straightforward, but the amount of
computation is not considered justifiable, especially since the zero-phase-sequence
impedances are extremely difficult to determine with any reasonable degree of
accuracy in an average LV installation.
Other simpler methods of adequate accuracy are preferred. Three practical methods
are:
F24
b The “method of impedances”, based on the summation of all the impedances
(positive-phase-sequence only) around the fault loop, for each circuit
b The “method of composition”, which is an estimation of short-circuit current at
the remote end of a loop, when the short-circuit current level at the near end of the
loop is known
b The “conventional method” of calculating the minimum levels of earth-fault
currents, together with the use of tables of values for obtaining rapid results
These methods are only reliable for the case in which the cables that make up the
earth-fault-current loop are in close proximity (to each other) and not separated by
ferro-magnetic materials.
For calculations, modern practice is to use
software agreed by National Authorities, and
based on the method of impedances, such as
Ecodial. National Authorities generally also
publish Guides, which include typical values,
conductor lengths, etc.
Method of impedances
This method summates the positive-sequence impedances of each item (cable, PE
conductor, transformer, etc.) included in the earth-fault loop circuit from which the
short-circuit earth-fault current is calculated, using the formula:
Uo
I=
2
2
∑R + ∑ X
(
) (
)
where
(R) 2 = (the sum of all resistances in the loop)2 at the design stage of a project.
and (X) 2 = (the sum of all inductive reactances in the loop) 2
and Uo = nominal system phase-to-neutral voltage.
The application of the method is not always easy, because it supposes a knowledge
of all parameter values and characteristics of the elements in the loop. In many
cases, a national guide can supply typical values for estimation purposes.
Method of composition
This method permits the determination of the short-circuit current at the end of
a loop from the known value of short-circuit at the sending end, by means of the
approximate formula:
Uo
I sc = I
U+ Zs I sc
where
Isc = upstream short-circuit current
I = end-of-loop short-circuit current
Uo = nominal system phase voltage
Zs = impedance of loop
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Note: in this method the individual impedances are added arithmetically(1) as
opposed to the previous “method of impedances” procedure.
Conventional method
This method is generally considered to be sufficiently accurate to fix the upper limit
of cable lengths.
Principle
(1) This results in a calculated current value which is less than
that it would actually flow. If the overcurrent settings are based
on this calculated value, then operation of the relay, or fuse, is
assured.
The principle bases the short-circuit current calculation on the assumption that the
voltage at the origin of the circuit concerned (i.e. at the point at which the circuit
protective device is located) remains at 80% or more of the nominal phase to neutral
voltage. The 80% value is used, together with the circuit loop impedance, to compute
the short-circuit current.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Implementation of the TN system
This coefficient takes account of all voltage drops upstream of the point considered.
In LV cables, when all conductors of a 3-phase 4-wire circuit are in close proximity
(which is the normal case), the inductive reactance internal to and between
conductors is negligibly small compared to the cable resistance.
This approximation is considered to be valid for cable sizes up to 120 mm2.
Above that size, the resistance value R is increased as follows:
The maximum length of any circuit of a
TN-earthed installation is: 0.8 Uo Sph
l(1+ m) I a
Core size (mm2)
S = 150 mm2
S = 185 mm2
S = 240 mm2
Value of resistance
R+15%
R+20%
R+25%
The maximum length of a circuit in a TN-earthed installation is given by the formula:
0.8 Uo Sph
Lmax =
l(1+ m) I a
where:
Lmax = maximum length in metres
Uo = phase volts = 230 V for a 230/400 V system
= resistivity at normal working temperature in ohm-mm2/metre
(= 22.5 10-3 for copper; = 36 10-3 for aluminium)
Ia = trip current setting for the instantaneous operation of a circuit-breaker, or
Ia = the current which assures operation of the protective fuse concerned, in the
specified time.
Sph
m=
SPE
F25
Sph = cross-sectional area of the phase conductors of the circuit concerned in mm2
SPE = cross-sectional area of the protective conductor concerned in mm2.
(see Fig. F39)
The following tables give the length of circuit
which must not be exceeded, in order that
persons be protected against indirect contact
hazards by protective devices
Tables
The following tables, applicable to TN systems, have been established according to
the “conventional method” described above.
The tables give maximum circuit lengths, beyond which the ohmic resistance of the
conductors will limit the magnitude of the short-circuit current to a level below that
required to trip the circuit-breaker (or to blow the fuse) protecting the circuit, with
sufficient rapidity to ensure safety against indirect contact.
Correction factor m
Figure F40 indicates the correction factor to apply to the values given in Figures F41
to F44 next pages, according to the ratio Sph/SPE, the type of circuit, and the
conductor materials.
A
The tables take into account:
b The type of protection: circuit-breakers or fuses
b Operating-current settings
b Cross-sectional area of phase conductors and protective conductors
b Type of system earthing (see Fig. F45 page F27)
b Type of circuit-breaker (i.e. B, C or D)(1)
B
PE
Imagn
The tables may be used for 230/400 V systems.
Id
Equivalent tables for protection by Compact and Acti 9 circuit-breakers (Schneider
Electric) are included in the relevant catalogues.
L
Sph
Circuit
C
3P + N or P + N
Fig. F39 : Calculation of L max. for a TN-earthed system, using
the conventional method
Conductor
material
Copper
Aluminium
m = Sph/SPE (or PEN)
m=1
m=2
m=3
1
0.67
0.50
0.62
0.42
0.31
Fig. F40 : Correction factor to apply to the lengths given in tables F41 to F44 for
TN systems
(1) For the definition of type B, C, D circuit-breakers, refer to
chapter H, clause 4.2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
m=4
0.40
0.25
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
SPE
F - Protection against electric shock
Circuits protected by general purpose circuit-breakers (Fig. F41)
F26
Nominal
crosssectional
area
of
conductors
mm2 50
63
1.5 100 79
2.5 167 133
4
267 212
6
400 317
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
Instantaneous or short-time-delayed tripping current Im (amperes)
80
63
104
167
250
417
100
50
83
133
200
333
125
40
67
107
160
267
427
160
31
52
83
125
208
333
200
25
42
67
100
167
267
417
250
20
33
53
80
133
213
333
467
320
16
26
42
63
104
167
260
365
495
400
13
21
33
50
83
133
208
292
396
500
10
17
27
40
67
107
167
233
317
560
9
15
24
36
60
95
149
208
283
417
630
8
13
21
32
53
85
132
185
251
370
700
7
12
19
29
48
76
119
167
226
333
452
800
6
10
17
25
42
67
104
146
198
292
396
875
6
10
15
23
38
61
95
133
181
267
362
457
1000
5
8
13
20
33
53
83
117
158
233
317
400
435
1120
4
7
12
18
30
48
74
104
141
208
283
357
388
459
1250
4
7
11
16
27
43
67
93
127
187
263
320
348
411
1600 2000 2500 3200 4000 5000 6300 8000 10000 12500
5
8
13
21
33
52
73
99
146
198
250
272
321
400
4
7
10
17
27
42
58
79
117
158
200
217
257
320
5
8
13
21
33
47
63
93
127
160
174
206
256
4
6
10
17
26
36
49
73
99
125
136
161
200
5
8
13
21
29
40
58
79
100
109
128
160
4
7
11
17
23
32
47
63
80
87
103
128
5
8
13
19
25
37
50
63
69
82
102
4
7
10
15
20
29
40
50
54
64
80
5
8
12
16
23
32
40
43
51
64
4
7
9
13
19
25
32
35
41
51
Fig. F41 : Maximum circuit lengths (in metres) for different sizes of copper conductor and instantaneous-tripping-current settings for general-purpose circuit-breakers
in 230/400 V TN system with m = 1
Circuits protected by Compact or Acti 9 circuit-breakers for industrial or
domestic use (Fig. F42 to Fig. F44)
Sph
mm2
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
Rated current (A)
1
2
3
1200 600
400
1000 666
1066
4
300
500
800
1200
6
200
333
533
800
10
120
200
320
480
800
16
75
125
200
300
500
800
20
60
100
160
240
400
640
25
48
80
128
192
320
512
800
32
37
62
100
150
250
400
625
875
40
30
50
80
120
200
320
500
700
50
24
40
64
96
160
256
400
560
760
63
19
32
51
76
127
203
317
444
603
80
15
25
40
60
100
160
250
350
475
100
12
20
32
48
80
128
200
280
380
125
10
16
26
38
64
102
160
224
304
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F42 : Maximum circuit lengths (in meters) for different sizes of copper conductor and rated currents for type B (1) circuit-breakers in a 230/400 V single-phase or
three-phase TN system with m = 1
Sph
mm2
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
Rated current (A)
1
2
3
600
300
200
500
333
533
4
150
250
400
600
6
100
167
267
400
667
10
60
100
160
240
400
640
16
37
62
100
150
250
400
625
875
20
30
50
80
120
200
320
500
700
25
24
40
64
96
160
256
400
560
760
32
18
31
50
75
125
200
312
437
594
40
15
25
40
60
100
160
250
350
475
50
12
20
32
48
80
128
200
280
380
63
9
16
25
38
63
101
159
222
301
80
7
12
20
30
50
80
125
175
237
100
6
10
16
24
40
64
100
140
190
125
5
8
13
19
32
51
80
112
152
Fig. F43 : Maximum circuit lengths (in metres) for different sizes of copper conductor and rated currents for type C (1) circuit-breakers in a 230/400 V single-phase or
three-phase TN system with m = 1
(1) For the definition of type B and C circuit-breakers refer to
chapter H clause 4.2.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Implementation of the TN system
Sph
mm2
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
Rated current (A)
1
2
3
429
214
143
714
357
238
571
381
857
571
952
4
107
179
286
429
714
6
71
119
190
286
476
762
10
43
71
114
171
286
457
714
16
27
45
71
107
179
286
446
625
20
21
36
80
120
200
320
500
700
848
25
17
29
46
69
114
183
286
400
543
32
13
22
36
54
89
143
223
313
424
40
11
18
29
43
71
114
179
250
339
50
9
14
23
34
57
91
143
200
271
63
7
11
18
27
45
73
113
159
215
80
5
9
14
21
36
57
89
125
170
100
4
7
11
17
29
46
71
80
136
125
3
6
9
14
23
37
57
100
109
Fig. F44 : Maximum circuit lengths (in metres) for different sizes of copper conductor and rated currents for type D (1) circuit-breakers in a 230/400 V single-phase or
three-phase TN system with m = 1
F27
Example
A 3-phase 4-wire (230/400 V) installation is TN-C earthed. A circuit is protected by a
type B circuit-breaker rated at 63 A, and consists of an aluminium cored cable with
50 mm2 phase conductors and a neutral conductor (PEN) of 25 mm2.
What is the maximum length of circuit, below which protection of persons against
indirect-contact hazards is assured by the instantaneous magnetic tripping relay of
the circuit-breaker?
Figure F42 gives, for 50 mm2 and a 63 A type B circuit-breaker, 603 metres, to which
Sph
must be applied a factor of 0.42 (Figure F40 for m =
= 2).
SPE
The maximum length of circuit is therefore:
603 x 0.42 = 253 metres.
RA1
RA2
Distant location
Particular case where one or more exposed conductive part(s)
is (are) earthed to a separate earth electrode
Protection must be provided against indirect contact by a RCD at the origin of any
circuit supplying an appliance or group of appliances, the exposed conductive parts
of which are connected to an independent earth electrode.
Fig. F45 : Separate earth electrode
The sensitivity of the RCD must be adapted to the earth electrode resistance (RA2 in
Figure F45). See specifications applicable to TT system.
6.3 High-sensitivity RCDs (see Fig. F31)
Fig. F46 : Circuit supplying socket-outlets
(1) For the definition of type D circuit-breaker refer to chapter H
Sub-clause 4.2.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
According to IEC 60364-4-41, high sensitivity RCDs (y 30 mA) must be used for
protection of socket outlets with rated current y 20 A in all locations. The use of such
RCDs is also recommended in the following cases:
b Socket-outlet circuits in wet locations at all current ratings
b Socket-outlet circuits in temporary installations
b Circuits supplying laundry rooms and swimming pools
b Supply circuits to work-sites, caravans, pleasure boats, and travelling fairs
See 2.2 and chapter P, al section 3.
F - Protection against electric shock
6 Implementation of the TN system
6.4 Protection in high fire-risk location
According to IEC 60364-422-3.10, circuits in high fire-risk locations must be
protected by RCDs of sensitivity y 500 mA. This excludes the TN-C arrangement and
TN-S must be adopted.
A preferred sensitivity of 300 mA is mandatory in some countries (see Fig. F47).
Fire-risk
location
6.5 When the fault current-loop impedance is
particularly high
Fig. F47 : Fire-risk location
When the earth-fault current is limited due to an inevitably high fault-loop impedance,
so that the overcurrent protection cannot be relied upon to trip the circuit within the
prescribed time, the following possibilities should be considered:
F28
Suggestion 1 (see Fig. F48)
b Install a circuit-breaker which has a lower instantaneous magnetic tripping level, for
example:
PE or PEN
2 y Irm y 4In
2In y Irm y 4In
Great length of cable
This affords protection for persons on circuits which are abnormally long. It must
be checked, however, that high transient currents such as the starting currents of
motors will not cause nuisance trip-outs.
Fig. F48 : Circuit-breaker with low-set instantaneous magnetic
tripping
Phases
Neutral
PE
b Schneider Electric solutions
v Type G Compact (2Im y Irm y 4Im)
v Type B Acti 9 circuit-breaker
Suggestion 2 (see Fig. F49)
b Install a RCD on the circuit. The device does not need to be highly-sensitive
(HS) (several amps to a few tens of amps). Where socket-outlets are involved, the
particular circuits must, in any case, be protected by HS (y 30 mA) RCDs; generally
one RCD for a number of socket outlets on a common circuit.
b Schneider Electric solutions
v RCD Vigi NG125 : In = 1 or 3 A
v Vigicompact REH or REM: In = 3 to 30 A
v Type B Acti 9 circuit-breaker
Suggestion 3
Increase the size of the PE or PEN conductors and/or the phase conductors, to
reduce the loop impedance.
Fig. F49 : RCD protection on TN systems with high earth-faultloop impedance
Suggestion 4
Add supplementary equipotential conductors. This will have a similar effect to that
of suggestion 3, i.e. a reduction in the earth-fault-loop resistance, while at the same
time improving the existing touch-voltage protection measures. The effectiveness
of this improvement may be checked by a resistance test between each exposed
conductive part and the local main protective conductor.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For TN-C installations, bonding as shown in Figure F50 is not allowed, and
suggestion 3 should be adopted.
Fig. F50 : Improved equipotential bonding
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
7 Implementation of the IT system
The basic feature of the IT earthing system is that, in the event of a short-circuit to
earth fault, the system can continue to operate without interruption. Such a fault is
referred to as a “first fault”.
In this system, all exposed conductive parts of an installation are connected via
PE conductors to an earth electrode at the installation, while the neutral point of the
supply transformer is:
b Either isolated from earth
b Or connected to earth through a high resistance (commonly 1,000 ohms or more)
This means that the current through an earth fault will be measured in milli-amps,
which will not cause serious damage at the fault position, or give rise to dangerous
touch voltages, or present a fire hazard. The system may therefore be allowed to
operate normally until it is convenient to isolate the faulty section for repair work. This
enhances continuity of service.
In practice, the system earthing requires certain specific measures for its satisfactory
exploitation:
b Permanent monitoring of the insulation with respect to earth, which must signal
(audibly or visually) the occurrence of the first fault
b A device for limiting the voltage which the neutral point of the supply transformer
can reach with respect to earth
b A “first-fault” location routine by an efficient maintenance staff. Fault location is
greatly facilitated by automatic devices which are currently available
b Automatic high-speed tripping of appropriate circuit-breakers must take place in
the event of a “second fault” occurring before the first fault is repaired. The second
fault (by definition) is an earth fault affecting a different live conductor than that of the
first fault (can be a phase or neutral conductor)(1).
F29
The second fault results in a short-circuit through the earth and/or through
PE bonding conductors.
7.1 Preliminary conditions (see Fig. F51 and Fig. F52)
Minimum functions required
Protection against overvoltages
at power frequency
Neutral earthing resistor
(for impedance earthing variation)
Components and devices
(1) Voltage limiter
Examples
Cardew C
(2) Resistor
Impedance Zx
Overall earth-fault monitor
with alarm for first fault condition
Automatic fault clearance
on second fault and
protection of the neutral
conductor against overcurrent
Location of first fault
(3) Permanent insulation
monitor PIM with alarm feature
(4) Four-pole circuit-breakers
(if the neutral is distributed)
all 4 poles trip
Vigilohm TR22A
or XM 200
Compact circuit-breaker
or RCD-MS
(5) With device for fault-location
on live system, or by successive
opening of circuits
Vigilohm system
Fig. F51 : Essential functions in IT schemes and examples with Schneider Electric products
4
L1
L2
L3
N
4
2 1
4
3
5
Fig. F52 : Positions of essential functions in 3-phase 3-wire IT-earthed system
(1) On systems where the neutral is distributed, as shown in
Figure F56.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
HV/LV
F - Protection against electric shock
7.2 Protection against indirect contact
Modern monitoring systems greatly facilitate
first-fault location and repair
First-fault condition
The earth-fault current which flows under a first-fault condition is measured in milliamps.
The fault voltage with respect to earth is the product of this current and the
resistance of the installation earth electrode and PE conductor (from the faulted
component to the electrode). This value of voltage is clearly harmless and could
amount to several volts only in the worst case (1,000 earthing resistor will pass
230 mA(1) and a poor installation earth-electrode of 50 ohms, would give 11.5 V, for
example).
An alarm is given by the permanent insulation monitoring device.
Principle of earth-fault monitoring
A generator of very low frequency a.c. current, or of d.c. current, (to reduce the
effects of cable capacitance to negligible levels) applies a voltage between the
neutral point of the supply transformer and earth. This voltage causes a small current
to flow according to the insulation resistance to earth of the whole installation, plus
that of any connected appliance.
F30
Low-frequency instruments can be used on a.c. systems which generate transient
d.c. components under fault conditions. Certain versions can distinguish between
resistive and capacitive components of the leakage current.
Modern equipment allow the measurement of leakage-current evolution, so that
prevention of a first fault can be achieved.
Fault-location systems comply with
IEC 61157-9 standard
Examples of equipment
b Manual fault-location (see Fig. F53)
The generator may be fixed (example: XM100) or portable (example: GR10X
permitting the checking of dead circuits) and the receiver, together with the magnetic
clamp-type pick-up sensor, are portable.
XM100
XM100
P12
GR10X
P50
P100
FF
ON/O
RM10N
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F53 : Non-automatic (manual) fault location
b Fixed automatic fault location (see Fig. F54 next page)
The monitoring relay XM100, together with the fixed detectors XD1 or XD12 (each
connected to a toroidal CT embracing the conductors of the circuit concerned)
provide a system of automatic fault location on a live installation.
Moreover, the level of insulation is indicated for each monitored circuit, and two
levels are checked: the first level warns of unusually low insulation resistance so that
preventive measures may be taken, while the second level indicates a fault condition
and gives an alarm.
(1) On a 230/400 V 3-phase system.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Implementation of the IT system
XM100
Toroidal CTs
XM100
1 to 12 circuits
F31
XD1
XD1
XD1
XD12
Fig. F54 : Fixed automatic fault location
b Automatic monitoring, logging, and fault location (see Fig. F55)
The Vigilohm System also allows access to a printer and/or a PC which provides
a global review of the insulation level of an entire installation, and records the
chronological evolution of the insulation level of each circuit.
The central monitor XM100, together with the localization detectors XD08 and XD16,
associated with toroidal CTs from several circuits, as shown below in Figure F55,
provide the means for this automatic exploitation.
XM100
XM100
XL08
XL16
897
678
Fig. F55 : Automatic fault location and insulation-resistance data logging
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
XD16
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
XD08
F - Protection against electric shock
Implementation of permanent insulation-monitoring (PIM) devices
b Connection
The PIM device is normally connected between the neutral (or articificial neutral)
point of the power-supply transformer and its earth electrode.
b Supply
Power supply to the PIM device should be taken from a highly reliable source. In
practice, this is generally directly from the installation being monitored, through
overcurrent protective devices of suitable short-circuit current rating.
b Level settings
Certain national standards recommend a first setting at 20% below the insulation
level of the new installation. This value allows the detection of a reduction of the
insulation quality, necessitating preventive maintenance measures in a situation of
incipient failure.
The detection level for earth-fault alarm will be set at a much lower level.
By way of an example, the two levels might be:
v New installation insulation level: 100 k
v Leakage current without danger: 500 mA (fire risk at > 500 mA)
v Indication levels set by the consumer:
- Threshold for preventive maintenance: 0.8 x 100 = 80 k
- Threshold for short-circuit alarm: 500
F32
Notes:
v Following a long period of shutdown, during which the whole, or part of the installation
remains de-energized, humidity can reduce the general level of insulation resistance.
This situation, which is mainly due to leakage current over the damp surface of
healthy insulation, does not constitute a fault condition, and will improve rapidly as the
normal temperature rise of current-carrying conductors reduces the surface humidity.
v The PIM device (XM) can measure separately the resistive and the capacitive
current components of the leakage current to earth, thereby deriving the true
insulation resistance from the total permanent leakage current.
The case of a second fault
A second earth fault on an IT system (unless occurring on the same conductor
as the first fault) constitutes a phase-phase or phase-to-neutral fault, and whether
occurring on the same circuit as the first fault, or on a different circuit, overcurrent
protective devices (fuses or circuit-breakers) would normally operate an automatic
fault clearance.
The settings of overcurrent tripping relays and the ratings of fuses are the basic
parameters that decide the maximum practical length of circuit that can be
satisfactorily protected, as discussed in Sub-clause 6.2.
Note: In normal circumstances, the fault current path is through common
PE conductors, bonding all exposed conductive parts of an installation, and so the
fault loop impedance is sufficiently low to ensure an adequate level of fault current.
Where circuit lengths are unavoidably long, and especially if the appliances of a
circuit are earthed separately (so that the fault current passes through two earth
electrodes), reliable tripping on overcurrent may not be possible.
In this case, an RCD is recommended on each circuit of the installation.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Where an IT system is resistance earthed, however, care must be taken to ensure
that the RCD is not too sensitive, or a first fault may cause an unwanted trip-out.
Tripping of residual current devices which satisfy IEC standards may occur at values
of 0.5 n to n, where n is the nominal residual-current setting level.
Three methods of calculation are commonly
used:
b The method of impedances, based on the
trigonometric addition of the system resistances
and inductive reactances
b The method of composition
b The conventional method, based on an
assumed voltage drop and the use of prepared
tables
Methods of determining levels of short-circuit current
A reasonably accurate assessment of short-circuit current levels must be carried out
at the design stage of a project.
A rigorous analysis is not necessary, since current magnitudes only are important for
the protective devices concerned (i.e. phase angles need not be determined) so that
simplified conservatively approximate methods are normally used. Three practical
methods are:
b The method of impedances, based on the vectorial summation of all the (positivephase-sequence) impedances around a fault-current loop
b The method of composition, which is an approximate estimation of short-circuit
current at the remote end of a loop, when the level of short-circuit current at the near
end of the loop is known. Complex impedances are combined arithmetically in this
method
b The conventional method, in which the minimum value of voltage at the origin of
a faulty circuit is assumed to be 80% of the nominal circuit voltage, and tables are
used based on this assumption, to give direct readings of circuit lengths.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Implementation of the IT system
These methods are reliable only for the cases in which wiring and cables which
make up the fault-current loop are in close proximity (to each other) and are not
separated by ferro-magnetic materials.
Methods of impedances
This method as described in Sub-clause 6.2, is identical for both the IT and
TN systems of earthing.
The software Ecodial is based on the “method
of impedance”
Methods of composition
This method as described in Sub-clause 6.2, is identical for both the IT and
TN systems of earthing.
Conventional method (see Fig. F56)
The principle is the same for an IT system as that described in Sub-clause 6.2 for a
TN system : the calculation of maximum circuit lengths which should not be exceeded
downstream of a circuit-breaker or fuses, to ensure protection by overcurrent devices.
The maximum length of an IT earthed circuit is:
b For a 3-phase 3-wire scheme
Lmax =
0.8 Uo 3 Sph
2 lI a(1+ m)
It is clearly impossible to check circuit lengths for every feasible combination of two
concurrent faults.
b For a 3-phase 4-wire scheme
Lmax =
All cases are covered, however, if the overcurrent trip setting is based on the
assumption that a first fault occurs at the remote end of the circuit concerned,
while the second fault occurs at the remote end of an identical circuit, as already
mentioned in Sub-clause 3.4. This may result, in general, in one trip-out only
occurring (on the circuit with the lower trip-setting level), thereby leaving the system
in a first-fault situation, but with one faulty circuit switched out of service.
0.8 Uo S1
2 lI a(1+ m)
F33
b For the case of a 3-phase 3-wire installation the second fault can only cause a
phase/phase short-circuit, so that the voltage to use in the formula for maximum
circuit length is 3 Uo.
The maximum circuit length is given by:
Lmax =
0.8 Uo 3 Sph metres
2 lI a(1+ m)
b For the case of a 3-phase 4-wire installation the lowest value of fault current will
occur if one of the faults is on a neutral conductor. In this case, Uo is the value to use
for computing the maximum cable length, and
Lmax =
0.8 Uo S1
metres
2 lI a(1+ m)
i.e. 50% only of the length permitted for a TN scheme (1)
N
N
B
D
A
C
Id
PE
Id
Id
Non distributed neutral
Fig. F56 : Calculation of Lmax. for an IT-earthed system, showing fault-current path for a double-fault condition
(1) Reminder: There is no length limit for earth-fault protection
on a TT scheme, since protection is provided by RCDs of high
sensitivity.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Id
Distributed neutral
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
PE
F - Protection against electric shock
In the preceding formulae:
Lmax = longest circuit in metres
Uo = phase-to-neutral voltage (230 V on a 230/400 V system)
= resistivity at normal operating temperature (22.5 x 10-3 ohms-mm2/m for copper,
36 x 10-3 ohms-mm2/m for aluminium)
Ia = overcurrent trip-setting level in amps, or Ia = current in amps required to clear
the fuse in the specified time
m=
Sph
SPE
SPE = cross-sectional area of PE conductor in mm2
S1 = S neutral if the circuit includes a neutral conductor
S1 = Sph if the circuit does not include a neutral conductor
The following tables(1) give the length of circuit
which must not be exceeded, in order that
F34 persons be protected against indirect contact
hazards by protective devices
Tables
The following tables have been established according to the “conventional method”
described above.
The tables give maximum circuit lengths, beyond which the ohmic resistance of
the conductors will limit the magnitude of the short-circuit current to a level below
that required to trip the circuit-breaker (or to blow the fuse) protecting the circuit,
with sufficient rapidity to ensure safety against indirect contact. The tables take into
account:
b The type of protection: circuit-breakers or fuses, operating-current settings
b Cross-sectional area of phase conductors and protective conductors
b Type of earthing scheme
b Correction factor: Figure F57 indicates the correction factor to apply to the lengths
given in tables F40 to F43, when considering an IT system
Circuit
3 phases
3ph + N or 1ph + N
Conductor
material
Copper
Aluminium
Copper
Aluminium
m = Sph/SPE (or PEN)
m=1
m=2
m=3
0.86
0.57
0.43
0.54
0.36
0.27
0.50
0.33
0.25
0.31
0.21
0.16
m=4
0.34
0.21
0.20
0.12
Fig. F57 : Correction factor to apply to the lengths given in tables F41 to F44 for TN systems
Example
A 3-phase 3-wire 230/400 V installation is IT-earthed.
One of its circuits is protected by a circuit-breaker rated at 63 A, and consists of an
aluminium-cored cable with 50 mm2 phase conductors. The 25 mm2 PE conductor
is also aluminum. What is the maximum length of circuit, below which protection of
persons against indirect-contact hazards is assured by the instantaneous magnetic
tripping relay of the circuit-breaker?
Figure F42 indicates 603 metres, to which must be applied a correction factor of 0.36
(m = 2 for aluminium cable).
The maximum length is therefore 217 metres.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
7.3 High-sensitivity RCDs
According to IEC 60364-4-41, high sensitivity RCDs (y 30 mA) must be used for
protection of socket outlets with rated current y 20 A in all locations. The use of such
RCDs is also recommended in the following cases:
b Socket-outlet circuits in wet locations at all current ratings
b Socket-outlet circuits in temporary installations
b Circuits supplying laundry rooms and swimming pools
b Supply circuits to work-sites, caravans, pleasure boats, and travelling fairs
See 2.2 and chapter P, al section 3
Fig. F62 : Circuit supplying socket-outlets
(1) The tables are those shown in Sub-clause 6.2 (Figures
F41 to F44). However, the table of correction factors (Figure
F57) which takes into account the ratio Sph/SPE, and of the
type of circuit (3-ph 3-wire; 3-ph 4-wire; 1-ph 2-wire) as well
as conductor material, is specific to the IT system, and differs
from that for TN.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Implementation of the IT system
7.4 Protection in high fire-risk locations
Protection by a RCD of sensitivity y 500 mA at the origin of the circuit supplying the
fire-risk locations is mandatory in some countries (see Fig. F59).
A preferred sensitivity of 300 mA may be adopted.
7.5 When the fault current-loop impedance is
particularly high
When the earth-fault current is restricted due to an inevitably high fault-loop
impedance, so that the overcurrent protection cannot be relied upon to trip the circuit
within the prescribed time, the following possibilities should be considered:
Suggestion 1 (see Fig. F60)
b Install a circuit-breaker which has an instantaneous magnetic tripping element with F35
an operation level which is lower than the usual setting, for example:
2In y Irm y 4In
This affords protection for persons on circuits which are abnormally long. It must
be checked, however, that high transient currents such as the starting currents of
motors will not cause nuisance trip-outs.
Fire-risk
location
Fig. F59 : Fire-risk location
b Schneider Electric solutions
v Compact NSX with G trip unit or Micrologic trip unit (2Im y Irm y 4Im)
v Type B Acti 9 circuit-breaker
Suggestion 2 (see Fig. F61)
Install a RCD on the circuit. The device does not need to be highly-sensitive (HS)
(several amps to a few tens of amps). Where socket-outlets are involved, the
particular circuits must, in any case, be protected by HS (y 30 mA) RCDs; generally
one RCD for a number of socket outlets on a common circuit.
b Schneider Electric solutions
v RCD Vigi NG125 : n = 1 or 3 A
v Vigicompact MH or ME: n = 3 to 30 A
PE
Suggestion 3
Increase the size of the PE conductors and/or the phase conductors, to reduce the
loop impedance.
2 y Irm y 4In
Great length of cable
Fig. F60 : A circuit-breaker with low-set instantaneous
magnetic trip
Suggestion 4 (see Fig. F62)
Add supplementary equipotential conductors. This will have a similar effect to that
of suggestion 3, i.e. a reduction in the earth-fault-loop resistance, while at the same
time improving the existing touch-voltage protection measures. The effectiveness
of this improvement may be checked by a resistance test between each exposed
conductive part and the local main protective conductor.
Phases
Fig. F61 : RCD protection
Fig. F62 : Improved equipotential bonding
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Neutral
PE
F - Protection against electric shock
8 Residual current devices (RCDs)
8.1 Description of RCDs
I1
Principle
I2
The essential features are shown schematically in Figure F63 below.
I3
A magnetic core encompasses all the current-carrying conductors of an electric
circuit and the magnetic flux generated in the core will depend at every instant on
the arithmetical sum of the currents; the currents passing in one direction being
considered as positive (1), while those passing in the opposite direction will be
negative (2).
In a normally healthy circuit 1 + 2 = 0 and there will be no flux in the magnetic core,
and zero e.m.f. in its coil.
An earth-fault current d will pass through the core to the fault, but will return to the
source via the earth, or via protective conductors in a TN-earthed system.
The current balance in the conductors passing through the magnetic core therefore
no longer exists, and the difference gives rise to a magnetic flux in the core.
F36
Fig. F63 : The principle of RCD operation
The difference current is known as the “residual” current and the principle is referred
to as the “residual current” principle.
The resultant alternating flux in the core induces an e.m.f. in its coil, so that a current
I3 flows in the tripping-device operating coil. If the residual current exceeds the value
required to operate the tripping device either directly or via an electronic relay, then
the associated circuit-breaker will trip.
8.2 Types of RCDs
Residual current devices (RCD) are commonly incorporated in or associated with the
following components:
b Industrial-type moulded-case circuit-breakers (MCCB) and air circuit-breakers
(ACB) conforming to IEC 60947-2 and its appendix B and M
b Industrial type miniature circuit-breakers (MCB) conforming to IEC 60947-2 and its
appendix B and M
b Household and similar miniature circuit-breakers (MCB) complying with IEC 60898,
IEC 61008, IEC 61009
b Residual load switch conforming to particular national standards
b Relays with separate toroidal (ring-type) current transformers, conforming to
IEC 60947-2 Appendix M
RCDs are mandatorily used at the origin of TT-earthed installations, where their
ability to discriminate with other RCDs allows selective tripping, thereby ensuring the
level of service continuity required.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Industrial circuit-breakers with an integrated
RCD are covered in IEC 60947-2 and its
appendix B
Industrial type circuit-breakers with integrated or adaptable
RCD module (see Fig. F64)
Industrial type circuit-breaker
Vigi Compact
Acti 9 DIN-rail industrial
Circuit-breaker with adaptable Vigi RCD module
Fig. F64 : Industrial-type CB with RCD module
Adaptable residual current circuit-breakers, including DIN-rail mounted units (e.g.
Compact or Acti 9), are available, to which may be associated an auxiliary RCD
module (e.g. Vigi).
The ensemble provides a comprehensive range of protective functions (isolation,
protection against short-circuit, overload, and earth-fault.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8 Residual current devices (RCDs)
Household and similar miniature circuit-breakers with RCD
Household or domestic circuit-breakers with
an integrated RCD are covered in IEC 60898,
IEC 61008 and IEC 61009
(see Fig. F65)
F37
The incoming-supply circuitbreaker can also have timedelayed characteristics and
integrate a RCD (type S).
“Monobloc” Déclic Vigi residual current circuit-breakers
intended for protection of terminal socket-outlet circuits
in domestic and tertiary sector applications.
Fig. F65 : Domestic residual current circuit-breakers (RCCBs) for earth leakage protection
Residual current load break switches are
covered by particular national standards.
RCDs with separate toroidal current
transformers are standardized in IEC 60947-2
appendix M
Residual current circuit-breakers and RCDs with separate
toroidal current transformer (see Fig. F66)
RCDs with separate toroidal CTs can be used in association with circuit-breakers or
contactors.
Fig. F66 : RCDs with separate toroidal current transformers (Vigirex)
In certain cases, aspects of the environment can disturb the correct operation of
RCDs:
b “nuisance” tripping: Break in power supply without the situation being really
hazardous. This type of tripping is often repetitive, causing major inconvenience and
detrimental to the quality of the user's electrical power supply.
b non-tripping, in the event of a hazard. Less perceptible than nuisance tripping,
these malfunctions must still be examined carefully since they undermine user safety.
This is why international standards define 3 categories of RCDs according to their
immunity to this type of disturbance (see below).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
8.3 Sensitivity of RCDs to disturbances
F - Protection against electric shock
Main disturbance types
Permanent earth leakage currents
Every LV installation has a permanent leakage current to earth, which is either due
to:
b Unbalance of the intrinsic capacitance between live conductors and earth for threephase circuits or
b Capacitance between live conductors and earth for single-phase circuits
The larger the installation the greater its capacitance with consequently increased
leakage current.
I
100%
90%
10 s (f = 100 kHz)
The capacitive current to earth is sometimes increased significantly by filtering
capacitors associated with electronic equipment (automation, IT and computerbased systems, etc.).
10%
t
F38
In the absence of more precise data, permanent leakage current in a given
installation can be estimated from the following values, measured at 230 V 50 Hz:
Single-phase or three-phase line: 1.5 mA /100m
b Heating floor: 1mA / kW
b Fax terminal, printer: 1 mA
b Microcomputer, workstation: 2 mA
b Copy machine: 1.5 mA
ca.0.5 s
60%
Fig. F67 : Standardized 0.5 µs/100 kHz current transient wave
Since RCDs complying with IEC and many national standards may operate under,
the limitation of permanent leakage current to 0.25 In, by sub-division of circuits
will, in practice, eliminate any unwanted tripping.
For very particular cases, such as the extension, or partial renovation of extended
IT-earthed installations, the manufacturers must be consulted.
U
High frequency components (harmonics, transients, etc.), are generated by
computer equipment power supplies, converters, motors with speed regulators,
fluorescent lighting systems and in the vicinity of high power switching devices and
reactive energy compensation banks.
Part of these high frequency currents may flow to earth through parasitic
capacitances. Although not hazardous for the user, these currents can still cause the
tripping of differential devices.
Umax
0.5U
1.2 s
Energization
The initial energization of the capacitances mentioned above gives rise to high
frequency transient currents of very short duration, similar to that shown in
Figure F67.
The sudden occurrence of a first-fault on an IT-earthed system also causes transient
earth-leakage currents at high frequency, due to the sudden rise of the two healthy
phases to phase/phase voltage above earth.
50 s
Fig. F68 : Standardized 1.2/50 µs voltage transient wave
Common mode overvoltages
Electrical networks are subjected to overvoltages due to lightning strikes or to abrupt
changes of system operating conditions (faults, fuse operation, switching, etc.).
These sudden changes often cause large transient voltages and currents in inductive
and capacitive circuits. Records have established that, on LV systems, overvoltages
remain generally below 6 kV, and that they can be adequately represented by the
conventional 1.2/50 µs impulse wave (see Fig. F68).
I
1
0.9
These overvoltages give rise to transient currents represented by a current impulse
wave of the conventional 8/20 µs form, having a peak value of several tens of
amperes (see Fig. F69).
The transient currents flow to earth via the capacitances of the installation.
0.5
0.1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
t
Fig. F69 : Standardized current-impulse wave 8/20 µs
Non-sinusoidal fault currents: RCDs type AC, A, B
Standard IEC 60755 (General requirements for residual current operated protective
devices) defines three types of RCD depending on the characteristics of the fault
current:
b Type AC
RCD for which tripping is ensured for residual sinusoidal alternating currents.
b Type A
RCD for which tripping is ensured:
v for residual sinusoidal alternating currents,
v for residual pulsating direct currents,
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8 Residual current devices (RCDs)
b Type B
RCD for which tripping is ensured:
v as for type A,
v for pure direct residual currents which may result from three-phase rectifying
circuits.
Cold: in the cases of temperatures under - 5 °C, very high sensitivity
electromechanical relays in the RCD may be “welded” by the condensation – freezing
action.
Type “Si” devices can operate under temperatures down to - 25 °C.
Atmospheres with high concentrations of chemicals or dust: the special alloys
used to make the RCDs can be notably damaged by corrosion. Dust can also block
the movement of mechanical parts.
See the measures to be taken according to the levels of severity defined by
standards in Fig. F70.
Regulations define the choice of earth leakage protection and its implementation.
The main reference texts are as follows:
b Standard IEC 60364-3:
v This gives a classification (AFx) for external influences in the presence of corrosive
or polluting substances.
v It defines the choice of materials to be used according to extreme influences.
Influence of
the electrical
network
Clean network
Superimmunized
residual current
protections
Type A SI: k
SI k
Super immunized
residual current
protections
Standard
immunized
residual current
protections
Type AC
SI k
Super immunized
residual current
protections
+
SI k
Super immunized
residual current
protections
+
Appropriate
additional
protection
(sealed cabinet
or unit)
Appropriate
additional
protection
(sealed cabinet
or unit +
overpressure)
AF1
AF2
AF3
AF4
b External
influences:
negligible,
b External
influences:
presence
of corrosive
or polluting
atmospheric
agents,
b External
influences:
intermittent
or accidental
action of
certain
common
chemicals,
b External
influences:
permanent
action of
corrosive
or polluting
chemicals
b Equipment
characteristics:
normal.
b Equipment
characteristics:
e.g. conformity
with salt mist
or atmospheric
pollution tests.
b Equipment
characteristics:
corrosion
protection.
b Equipment
characteristics:
specifically
studied
according to
the type of
products.
Examples of exposed sites
External influences
Iron and steel works.
Presence of sulfur, sulfur vapor, hydrogen
sulfide.
Marinas, trading ports, boats, sea edges, naval
shipyards.
Salt atmospheres, humid outside, low
temperatures.
Swimming pools, hospitals, food & beverage.
Chlorinated compounds.
Petrochemicals.
Hydrogen, combustion gases, nitrogen
oxides.
Breeding facilities, tips.
Hydrogen sulfide.
Fig. F70 : External influence classification according to IEC 60364-3 standard
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Disturbed
network
F39
F - Protection against electric shock
Immunity level for Schneider Electric residual current devices
The Schneider Electric range comprises various types of RCDs allowing earth
leakage protection to be adapted to each application. The table below indicates the
choices to be made according to the type of probable disturbances at the point of
installation.
Device type
F40
Nuisance
trippings
Non-trippings
High
frequency
leakage
current
Fault current
Rectified
alternating
AC
b
A
b
b
SI
b b b
b
B
b b b
b
Pure direct
Low
Corrosion
temperatures Dust
(down to
- 25 °C)
b
b
b
b
b
Fig. F71 : Immunity level of Schneider Electric RCDs
Immunity to nuisance tripping
Type SI RCDs have been designed to avoid nuisance tripping or non-tripping in case
of polluted network , lightning effect, high frequency currents, RF waves, etc. Figure
F72 below indicates the levels of tests undergone by this type of RCDs.
Disturbance type
Rated test wave
Immunity
Acti 9 :
ID-RCCB, DPN Vigi, Vigi iC60,
Vigi C120, Vigi NG125
SI type
Continuous disturbances
Harmonics
1 kHz
Earth leakage current = 8 x In
Lightning induced overvoltage
1.2 / 50 µs pulse (IEC/
EN 61000-4-5)
4.5 kV between conductors 5.5 kV
/ earth
Lightning induced current
8 / 20 µs pulse (IEC/EN
61008)
5 kA peak
Switching transient, indirect
lightning currents
0.5 µs / 100 kHz “ ring
wave ”
(IEC/EN 61008)
400 A peak
Downstream surge arrester
operation, capacitance loading
10 ms pulse
500 A
Inductive load switchings
fluorescent lights, motors, etc.)
Repeated bursts (IEC
61000-4-4)
5 kV / 2.5 kHz
4 kV / 400 kHz
Fluorescent lights, thyristor
controlled circuits, etc.
RF conducted waves
(level 4 IEC 61000-4-6)
(level 4 IEC 61000-4-16)
30 V (150 kHz to 230 MHz)
250 mA (15 kHz to 150 kHz)
RF waves (TV&
radio, broadcact,
telecommunications,etc.)
RF radiated waves
80 MHz to 1 GHz
(IEC 61000-4-3)
Transient disturbances
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Electromagnetic compatibility
30 V / m
Fig. F72 : Immunity to nuisance tripping tests undergone by Schneider Electric RCDs
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8 Residual current devices (RCDs)
Recommendations concerning the installation of RCDs with
separate toroidal current transformers
The detector of residual current is a closed magnetic circuit (usually circular) of
very high magnetic permeability, on which is wound a coil of wire, the ensemble
constituting a toroidal (or ring-type) current transformer.
Because of its high permeability, any small deviation from perfect symmetry of
the conductors encompassed by the core, and the proximity of ferrous material
(steel enclosure, chassis members, etc.) can affect the balance of magnetic forces
sufficiently, at times of large load currents (motor-starting current, transformer
energizing current surge, etc.) to cause unwanted tripping of the RCD.
Unless particular measures are taken, the ratio of operating current n to maximum
phase current ph (max.) is generally less than 1/1,000.
This limit can be increased substantially (i.e. the response can be desensitized) by
adopting the measures shown in Figure F73, and summarized in Figure F74.
F41
L
L = twice the diameter of
the magnetic ring core
Fig. F73 : Three measures to reduce the ratio nph (max.)
Measures
Diameter
(mm)
Sensitivity
diminution factor
Careful centralizing of cables through the ring core
Oversizing of the ring core
ø 50 ø 100
ø 80 ø 200
ø 120 ø 300
ø 50
3
2
2
6
4
Use of a steel or soft-iron shielding sleeve
b Of wall thickness 0.5 mm
b Of length 2 x inside diameter of ring core
b Completely surrounding the conductors and
ø 80
3
ø 120
3
ø 200
2
overlapping the circular core equally at both ends
These measures can be combined. By carefully centralizing the cables in a ring core
of 200 mm diameter, where a 50 mm core would be large enough, and using a sleeve,
the ratio 1/1,000 could become 1/30,000.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F74 : Means of reducing the ratio I n/Iph (max.)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
F - Protection against electric shock
8 Residual current devices (RCDs)
Choice of characteristics of a residual-current circuit-breaker
(RCCB - IEC 61008)
a
Rated current
The rated current of a RCCB is chosen according to the maximum sustained load
current it will carry.
b
b If the RCCB is connected in series with, and downstream of a circuit-breaker, the
rated current of both items will be the same, i.e. n u n1 (see Fig. F75a)
In1
b If the RCCB is located upstream of a group of circuits, protected by circuitbreakers, as shown in Figure F75b, then the RCCB rated current will be given by:
In
n u ku x ks (n1 + n2 + n3 + n4)
In
In1
In2
In3
F42
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. F75 : Residual current circuit-breakers (RCCBs)
In4
Electrodynamic withstand requirements
Protection against short-circuits must be provided by an upstream SCPD (ShortCircuit Protective Device) but it is considered that where the RCCB is located in the
same distribution box (complying with the appropriate standards) as the downstream
circuit-breakers (or fuses), the short-circuit protection afforded by these (outgoingcircuit) SCPDs is an adequate alternative. Coordination between the RCCB and
the SCPDs is necessary, and manufacturers generally provide tables associating
RCCBs and circuit-breakers or fuses.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter G
Sizing and protection of conductors
Contents
1
General
G2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
G2
G4
G4
G6
G6
2
Practical method for determining the smallest allowable
cross-sectional area of circuit conductors
G7
2.1 General method for cables
2.2 Recommended simplified approach for cables
2.3 Busbar trunking systems
G7
G15
G17
3
4
Determination of voltage drop
G19
3.1 Maximum voltage drop limit
3.2 Calculation of voltage drop in steady load conditions
G19
G20
Short-circuit current
G23 G1
4.1 Short-circuit current at the secondary terminals of
a MV/LV distribution transformer
4.2 3-phase short-circuit current (Isc) at any point within
a LV installation
4.3 Isc at the receiving end of a feeder in terms of the Isc
at its sending end
4.4 Short-circuit current supplied by an alternator or an inverter
G23
Methodology and definition
Overcurrent protection principles
Practical values for a protective scheme
Location of protective devices
Conductors in parallel
G24
G27
G28
5
Particular cases of short-circuit current
G29
5.1 Calculation of minimum levels of short-circuit current
5.2 Verification of the withstand capabilities of cables under
short-circuit conditions
G29
G34
6
Protective earthing conductor
G36
6.1 Connection and choice
6.2 Conductor sizing
6.3 Protective conductor between MV/LV transformer and
the main general distribution board (MGDB)
6.4 Equipotential conductor
G36
G37
G39
G40
7
The neutral conductor
G41
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
G41
G43
G43
G43
8
Worked example of cable calculation
G45
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Sizing the neutral conductor
Protection of the neutral conductor
Breaking of the neutral conductor
Isolation of the neutral conductor
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
1 General
1.1 Methodology and definition
Component parts of an electric circuit and its
protection are determined such that all normal
and abnormal operating conditions are satisfied
Methodology (see Fig. G1 )
Following a preliminary analysis of the power requirements of the installation, as
described in Chapter B Clause 4, a study of cabling(1) and its electrical protection is
undertaken, starting at the origin of the installation, through the intermediate stages
to the final circuits.
The cabling and its protection at each level must satisfy several conditions at the
same time, in order to ensure a safe and reliable installation, e.g. it must:
b Carry the permanent full load current, and normal short-time overcurrents
b Not cause voltage drops likely to result in an inferior performance of certain loads,
for example: an excessively long acceleration period when starting a motor, etc.
Moreover, the protective devices (circuit-breakers or fuses) must:
b Protect the cabling and busbars for all levels of overcurrent, up to and including
short-circuit currents
b Ensure protection of persons against indirect contact hazards, particularly in
TN- and IT- earthed systems, where the length of circuits may limit the magnitude
of short-circuit currents, thereby delaying automatic disconnection (it may be
remembered that TT- earthed installations are necessarily protected at the origin by
a RCD, generally rated at 300 mA).
G2
The cross-sectional areas of conductors are determined by the general method
described in Sub-clause 2 of this Chapter. Apart from this method some national
standards may prescribe a minimum cross-sectional area to be observed for reasons
of mechanical endurance. Particular loads (as noted in Chapter N) require that the
cable supplying them be oversized, and that the protection of the circuit be likewise
modified.
Power demand:
- kVA to be supplied
- Maximum load current IB
Conductor sizing:
- Selection of conductor type and insulation
- Selection of method of installation
- Taking account of correction factors for
different environment conditions
- Determination of cross-sectional areas using
tables giving the current carrying capability
Verification of the maximum voltage drop:
- Steady state conditions
- Motor starting conditions
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Calculation of short-circuit currents:
- Upstream short-circuit power
- Maximum values
- Minimum values at conductor end
Selection of protective devices:
- Rated current
- Breaking capability
- Implementation of cascading
- Check of discrimination
Fig. G1 : Flow-chart for the selection of cable size and protective device rating for a given circuit
(1) The term “cabling” in this chapter, covers all insulated
conductors, including multi-core and single-core cables and
insulated wires drawn into conduits, etc.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 General
Definitions
Maximum load current: B
b At the final circuits level, this current corresponds to the rated kVA of the load.
In the case of motor-starting, or other loads which take a high in-rush current,
particularly where frequent starting is concerned (e.g. lift motors, resistance-type
spot welding, and so on) the cumulative thermal effects of the overcurrents must be
taken into account. Both cables and thermal type relays are affected.
b At all upstream circuit levels this current corresponds to the kVA to be supplied,
which takes account of the factors of simultaneity (diversity) and utilization, ks and ku
respectively, as shown in Figure G2.
Main distribution
board
Combined factors of simultaneity
(or diversity) and utilization:
ks x ku = 0.69
IB = (80+60+100+50) x 0.69 = 200 A
G3
Sub-distribution
board
80 A
60 A
50 A
100 A
M
Normal load
motor current
50 A
Fig. G2 : Calculation of maximum load current B
Maximum permissible current: z
This is the maximum value of current that the cabling for the circuit can carry
indefinitely, without reducing its normal life expectancy.
The current depends, for a given cross sectional area of conductors, on several
parameters:
b Constitution of the cable and cable-way (Cu or Alu conductors; PVC or EPR etc.
insulation; number of active conductors)
b Ambient temperature
b Method of installation
b Influence of neighbouring circuits
Overcurrents
An overcurrent occurs each time the value of current exceeds the maximum load
current B for the load concerned.
Overcurrents of relatively short duration can however, occur in normal operation; two
types of overcurrent are distinguished:
b Overloads
These overcurrents can occur in healthy electric circuits, for example, due to a
number of small short-duration loads which occasionally occur co-incidentally: motor
starting loads, and so on. If either of these conditions persists however beyond a
given period (depending on protective-relay settings or fuse ratings) the circuit will be
automatically cut off.
b Short-circuit currents
These currents result from the failure of insulation between live conductors or/and
between live conductors and earth (on systems having low-impedance-earthed
neutrals) in any combination, viz:
v 3 phases short-circuited (and to neutral and/or earth, or not)
v 2 phases short-circuited (and to neutral and/or earth, or not)
v 1 phase short-circuited to neutral (and/or to earth)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
This current must be cut off with a rapidity that depends upon its magnitude, if
permanent damage to the cabling (and appliance if the overcurrent is due to a
defective load component) is to be avoided.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
1.2 Overcurrent protection principles
A protective device is provided at the origin of the circuit concerned (see Fig. G3 and
Fig. G4).
b Acting to cut-off the current in a time shorter than that given by the 2t
characteristic of the circuit cabling
b But allowing the maximum load current B to flow indefinitely
The characteristics of insulated conductors when carrying short-circuit currents
can, for periods up to 5 seconds following short-circuit initiation, be determined
approximately by the formula:
2t = k2 S2 which shows that the allowable heat generated is proportional to the
squared cross-sectional-area of the condutor.
where
t: Duration of short-circuit current (seconds)
S: Cross sectional area of insulated conductor (mm2)
: Short-circuit current (A r.m.s.)
k: Insulated conductor constant (values of k2 are given in Figure G52 )
For a given insulated conductor, the maximum permissible current varies according
to the environment. For instance, for a high ambient temperature (a1 > a2), z1 is
less than z2 (see Fig. G5). means “temperature”.
G4
Note:
v SC: 3-phase short-circuit current
v SCB: rated 3-ph. short-circuit breaking current of the circuit-breaker
v r (or rth)(1): regulated “nominal” current level; e.g. a 50 A nominal circuit-breaker
can be regulated to have a protective range, i.e. a conventional overcurrent tripping
level (see Fig. G6 opposite page) similar to that of a 30 A circuit-breaker.
t
Maximum
load
current
I2t cable
characteristic
1.3 Practical values for a protective scheme
Temporary
overload
The following methods are based on rules laid down in the IEC standards, and are
representative of the practices in many countries.
Circuit-breaker
tripping curve
General rules
I
IB I r I z
ISCB ICU
Fig. G3 : Circuit protection by circuit-breaker
A protective device (circuit-breaker or fuse) functions correctly if:
b Its nominal current or its setting current In is greater than the maximum load
current B but less than the maximum permissible current z for the circuit, i.e.
B y n y z corresponding to zone “a” in Figure G6
b Its tripping current 2 “conventional” setting is less than 1.45 z which corresponds
to zone “b” in Figure G6
The “conventional” setting tripping time may be 1 hour or 2 hours according to local
standards and the actual value selected for 2. For fuses, 2 is the current (denoted
f) which will operate the fuse in the conventional time.
t
I2t cable
characteristic
t
1
2
θa1 > θa2
Fuse curve
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Temporary
overload
5s
I2t = k2S2
I
IB
Ir cIz Iz
Fig. G4 : Circuit protection by fuses
I
Iz1 < Iz2
Fig. G5 : 2t characteristic of an insulated conductor at two different ambient temperatures
(1) Both designations are commonly used in different
standards.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 General
Circuit cabling
Iz
Loads
1.
45
M
nt
ax
rre
cu
im
um
ad
lo
lo
ad
Iz
cu
um
im
rre
ax
nt
M
IB
IB
1.45 Iz
Iz
Isc
0
In
I2
ISCB
zone a
zone c
Protective device
g
3
fa -ph
ul s
t-c ho
ur r t
re -ci
nt rc
br uit
ea
ki
ng
ra
tin
re
ur
rc
C
t r i o nv
p e
cu nt
rre ion
nt al
I 2 ov
e
N
its om
re ina
gu l c
la ur
te re
d n
cu t I
rre n o
nt r
Ir
nt
zone b
G5
B y n y z zone a
2 y 1.45 z zone b
SCB u SC zone c
Fig. G6 : Current levels for determining circuir breaker or fuse characteristics
b Its 3-phase short-circuit fault-current breaking rating is greater than the 3-phase
short-circuit current existing at its point of installation. This corresponds to zone “c” in
Figure G6.
Applications
Criteria for fuses:
B y n y z/k3 and SCF u SC.
b Protection by fuses
The condition 2 y 1.45 z must be taken into account, where 2 is the fusing (melting
level) current, equal to k2 x n (k2 ranges from 1.6 to 1.9) depending on the particular
fuse concerned.
k2
A further factor k3 has been introduced ( k3 =
) such that 2 y 1.45 z
1.45
will be valid if n y z/k3.
For fuses type gG:
n < 16 A k3 = 1.31
n u 16 A k3 = 1.10
Moreover, the short-circuit current breaking capacity of the fuse SCF must exceed
the level of 3-phase short-circuit current at the point of installation of the fuse(s).
b Association of different protective devices
The use of protective devices which have fault-current ratings lower than the fault
level existing at their point of installation are permitted by IEC and many national
standards in the following conditions:
v There exists upstream, another protective device which has the necessary shortcircuit rating, and
v The amount of energy allowed to pass through the upstream device is less than
that which can be withstood without damage by the downstream device and all
associated cabling and appliances.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Criteria for circuit-breakers:
B y n y z and SCB u SC.
b Protection by circuit-breaker
By virtue of its high level of precision the current 2 is always less than 1.45 n (or
1.45 r) so that the condition 2 y 1.45 z (as noted in the “general rules” above) will
always be respected.
v Particular case
If the circuit-breaker itself does not protect against overloads, it is necessary to
ensure that, at a time of lowest value of short-circuit current, the overcurrent device
protecting the circuit will operate correctly. This particular case is examined in Subclause 5.1.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
1 General
In pratice this arrangement is generally exploited in:
v The association of circuit-breakers/fuses
v The technique known as “cascading” or “series rating” in which the strong
current-limiting performance of certain circuit-breakers effectively reduces the
severity of downstream short-circuits
Possible combinations which have been tested in laboratories are indicated in certain
manufacturers catalogues.
1.4 Location of protective devices
A protective device is, in general, required at the
origin of each circuit
General rule (see Fig. G7a)
A protective device is necessary at the origin of each circuit where a reduction of
permissible maximum current level occurs.
Possible alternative locations in certain circumstances
(see Fig. G7b)
The protective device may be placed part way along the circuit:
b If AB is not in proximity to combustible material, and
b If no socket-outlets or branch connections are taken from AB
G6
a
P
P2
P3
50 mm2
P4
10 mm2
25 mm2
b
Three cases may be useful in practice:
b Consider case (1) in the diagram
v AB y 3 metres, and
v AB has been installed to reduce to a practical minimum the risk of a short-circuit
(wires in heavy steel conduit for example)
b Consider case (2)
v The upstream device P1 protects the length AB against short-circuits in
accordance with Sub-clause 5.1
b Consider case (3)
v The overload device (S) is located adjacent to the load. This arrangement is
convenient for motor circuits. The device (S) constitutes the control (start/stop) and
overload protection of the motor while (SC) is: either a circuit-breaker (designed for
motor protection) or fuses type aM
v The short-circuit protection (SC) located at the origin of the circuit conforms with
the principles of Sub-clause 5.1
Circuits with no protection (see Fig. G7c)
Either
b The protective device P1 is calibrated to protect the cable S2 against overloads
and short-circuits
P1
A
<3m
sc
B
B
P2
B
P3
Case (1)
Case (2)
Short-circuit
protective
device
s Overload
protective
device
Or
b Where the breaking of a circuit constitutes a risk, e.g.
v Excitation circuits of rotating machines
v circuits of large lifting electromagnets
v the secondary circuits of current transformers
No circuit interruption can be tolerated, and the protection of the cabling is of
secondary importance.
Case (3)
1.5 Conductors in parallel
Conductors of the same cross-sectional-area, the same length, and of the same
material, can be connected in parallel.
c
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P1: iC60 rated 15A
2.5 mm2
S2 :
1.5 mm2
Fig. G7 : Location of protective devices
The maximum permissible current is the sum of the individual-core maximum
currents, taking into account the mutual heating effects, method of installation, etc.
Protection against overload and short-circuits is identical to that for a single-cable
circuit.
The following precautions should be taken to avoid the risk of short-circuits on the
paralleled cables:
b Additional protection against mechanical damage and against humidity, by the
introduction of supplementary protection
b The cable route should be chosen so as to avoid close proximity to combustible
materials
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
The reference international standard for the study of cabling is IEC 60364-5-52:
“Electrical installation of buildings - Part 5-52: Selection and erection of electrical
equipment - Wiring system”.
A summary of this standard is presented here, with examples of the most commonly
used methods of installation. The current-carrying capacities of conductors in all
different situations are given in annex A of the standard. A simplified method for use
of the tables of annex A is proposed in informative annex B of the standard.
2.1 General method for cables
Possible methods of installation for different types of
conductors or cables
The different admissible methods of installation are listed in Figure G8, in
conjonction with the different types of conductors and cables.
Conductors and cables
Method of installation
Without Clipped
Conduit Cable trunking
fixings
direct
(including
skirting trunking,
flush floor trunking)
–
–
–
–
–
–
+
+
+
+
+
+
Bare conductors
Insulated conductors
Sheathed
Multi-core
cables
(including
armoured
Single-core 0
+
and
mineral
insulated)
+ Permitted.
– Not permitted.
0 Not applicable, or not normally used in practice.
+
+
Cable
Cable ladder
ducting Cable tray
Cable brackets
On
Support
insulators wire
–
+
+
–
–
+
+
+
0
–
–
+
+
+
0
+
G7
Fig. G8 : Selection of wiring systems (table 52-1 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Possible methods of installation for different situations:
Different methods of installation can be implemented in different situations. The
possible combinations are presented in Figure G9.
Situations
Building voids
Method of installation
Without With
Conduit
fixings
fixings
Cable channel
40, 46,
15, 16
56
0
15, 16,
41, 42
54, 55
56
Buried in ground
Embedded in structure
72, 73
57, 58
0
3
Surface mounted
–
20, 21
70, 71
1, 2,
59, 60
4, 5
Overhead
–
–
Immersed
80
80
– Not permitted.
0 Not applicable, or not normally used in practice.
Cable trunking
Cable
(including
ducting
skirting trunking,
flush floor trunking)
–
43
0
44, 45
–
50, 51, 52, 53
44, 45
0
6, 7, 8, 9, 12, 13, 14
22, 23
10, 11
6, 7,
8, 9
–
0
–
0
Fig. G9 : Erection of wiring systems (table 52-2 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Cable ladder
cable tray,
cable brackets
On
Support
insulators wire
30, 31, 32,
33, 34
30, 31, 32,
33, 34
70, 71
0
–
–
–
–
0
–
–
–
36
–
36
35
–
–
30, 31, 32,
33, 34
30, 31, 32
33, 34
0
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The number given in this table refer to the different wiring systems considered.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Examples of wiring systems and reference methods of
installations
An illustration of some of the many different wiring systems and methods of
installation is provided in Figure G10.
Several reference methods are defined (with code letters A to G), grouping
installation methods having the same characteristics relative to the current-carrying
capacities of the wiring systems.
Item No.
Methods of installation
Description
Reference method of
installation to be used to
obtain current-carrying
capacity
Insulated conductors or single-core
cables in conduit in a thermally
insulated wall
A1
Multi-core cables in conduit in a
thermally insulated wall
A2
4
Insulated conductors or single-core
cables in conduit on a wooden, or
masonry wall or spaced less than
0,3 x conduit diameter from it
B1
5
Multi-core cable in conduit on a
wooden, or mansonry wall or spaced
less than 0,3 x conduit diameter
from it
B2
20
Single-core or multi-core cables:
- fixed on, or sapced less than 0.3 x cable
diameter from a wooden wall
C
On unperforated tray
C
1
Room
G8
2
Room
30
0.3 D e
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
0.3 D e
Fig. G10 : Examples of methods of installation (part of table 52-3 of IEC 60364-5-52) (continued on next page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
Item No.
31
Methods of installation
0.3 D e
Description
Reference method of
installation to be used to
obtain current-carrying
capacity
On perforated tray
E or F
Bare or insulated conductors on
insulators
G
0.3 D e
36
G9
70
Multi-core cables in conduit or in cable
ducting in the ground
D
71
Single-core cable in conduit or in cable
ducting in the ground
D
Fig. G10 : Examples of methods of installation (part of table 52-3 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Maximum operating temperature:
The current-carrying capacities given in the subsequent tables have been
determined so that the maximum insulation temperature is not exceeded for
sustained periods of time.
For different type of insulation material, the maximum admissible temperature is
given in Figure G11.
Type of insulation
Polyvinyl-chloride (PVC)
Cross-linked polyethylene (XLPE) and ethylene
propylene rubber (EPR)
Mineral (PVC covered or bare exposed to touch)
Mineral (bare not exposed to touch and not in
contact with combustible material)
Temperature limit °C
70 at the conductor
90 at the conductor
70 at the sheath
105 at the seath
Fig. G11 : Maximum operating temperatures for types of insulation (table 52-4 of IEC 60364-5-52)
In order to take environnement or special conditions of installation into account,
correction factors have been introduced.
The cross sectional area of cables is determined using the rated load current B
divided by different correction factors, k1, k2, ...:
I' B =
IB
k1 ⋅ k 2 ...
I’B is the corrected load current, to be compared to the current-carrying capacity of
the considered cable.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Correction factors:
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
(see also Fig. G10)
b Ambient temperature
The current-carrying capacities of cables in the air are based on an average air
temperature equal to 30 °C. For other temperatures, the correction factor is given in
Figure G12 for PVC, EPR and XLPE insulation material.
The related correction factor is here noted k1.
Ambient temperature °C
G10
10
15
20
25
35
40
45
50
55
60
65
70
75
80
Insulation
PVC
1.22
1.17
1.12
1.06
0.94
0.87
0.79
0.71
0.61
0.50
-
XLPE and EPR
1.15
1.12
1.08
1.04
0.96
0.91
0.87
0.82
0.76
0.71
0.65
0.58
0.50
0.41
Fig. G12 : Correction factors for ambient air temperatures other than 30 °C to be applied to the
current-carrying capacities for cables in the air (from table A.52-14 of IEC 60364-5-52)
The current-carrying capacities of cables in the ground are based on an average
ground temperature equal to 20 °C. For other temperatures, the correction factor is
given in Figure G13 for PVC, EPR and XLPE insulation material.
The related correction factor is here noted k2.
Ground temperature °C
10
15
25
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
65
70
75
80
Insulation
PVC
1.10
1.05
0.95
0.89
0.84
0.77
0.71
0.63
0.55
0.45
-
XLPE and EPR
1.07
1.04
0.96
0.93
0.89
0.85
0.80
0.76
0.71
0.65
0.60
0.53
0.46
0.38
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G13 : Correction factors for ambient ground temperatures other than 20 °C to be applied to
the current-carrying capacities for cables in ducts in the ground (from table A.52-15 of
IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
b Soil thermal resistivity
The current-carrying capacities of cables in the ground are based on a ground
resistivity equal to 2.5 K.m/W. For other values, the correction factor is given in
Figure G14.
The related correction factor is here noted k3.
Thermal resistivity, K.m/W
Correction factor
1
1.18
1.5
1.1
2
1.05
2.5
1
3
0.96
Fig. G14 : Correction factors for cables in buried ducts for soil thermal resistivities other than 2.5
K.m/W to be applied to the current-carrying capacities for reference method D (table A52.16 of
IEC 60364-5-52)
Based on experience, a relationship exist between the soil nature and resistivity.
Then, empiric values of correction factors k3 are proposed in Figure G15, depending
on the nature of soil.
Nature of soil
Very wet soil (saturated)
Wet soil
Damp soil
Dry soil
Very dry soil (sunbaked)
G11
k3
1.21
1.13
1.05
1.00
0.86
Fig. G15 : Correction factor k3 depending on the nature of soil
b Grouping of conductors or cables
The current-carrying capacities given in the subsequent tables relate to single
circuits consisting of the following numbers of loaded conductors:
v Two insulated conductors or two single-core cables, or one twin-core cable
(applicable to single-phase circuits);
v Three insulated conductors or three single-core cables, or one three-core cable
(applicable to three-phase circuits).
Where more insulated conductors or cables are installed in the same group, a group
reduction factor (here noted k4) shall be applied.
Examples are given in Figures G16 to G18 for different configurations (installation
methods, in free air or in the ground).
Figure G16 gives the values of correction factor k4 for different configurations of
unburied cables or conductors, grouping of more than one circuit or multi-core
cables.
Number of circuits or multi-core cables
1
2
3
4
5
6
1.00
0.80
0.70
0.65
0.60
0.57
7
0.54
8
0.52
9
0.50
12
0.45
Reference methods
1.00
0.85
0.79
0.75
0.73
0.72
0.72
0.71
0.70
0.95
0.81
0.72
0.68
0.66
0.64
0.63
0.62
0.61
No further reduction
factor for more than
nine circuits or
multi-core cables
1.00
0.88
0.82
0.77
0.75
0.73
0.73
0.72
0.72
1.00
0.87
0.82
0.80
0.80
0.79
0.79
0.78
0.78
16
0.41
20
0.38
Fig. G16 : Reduction factors for groups of more than one circuit or of more than one multi-core cable (table A.52-17 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Methods A to F
Method C
Methods E and F
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Arrangement
(cables touching)
Bunched in air, on a
surface, embedded or
enclosed
Single layer on wall, floor
or unperforated tray
Single layer fixed directly
under a wooden ceiling
Single layer on a
perforated horizontal or
vertical tray
Single layer on ladder
support or cleats etc.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Figure G17 gives the values of correction factor k4 for different configurations of
unburied cables or conductors, for groups of more than one circuit of single-core
cables in free air.
Method of installation
Perforated
trays
Number
of tray
Vertical
perforated
trays
31
Ladder
supports,
cleats, etc...
32
1
2
3
1
0.98
0.91
0.87
2
0.96
0.87
0.81
20 mm
3
0.95
0.85
0.78
Touching
1
0.96
0.86
2
0.95
0.84
1
1.00
0.97
0.96
2
0.98
0.93
0.89
3
0.97
0.90
0.86
1
1.00
0.98
0.96
2
0.97
0.93
0.89
3
0.96
0.92
0.86
1
1.00
0.91
0.89
2
1.00
0.90
0.86
1
1.00
1.00
1.00
2
0.97
0.95
0.93
3
0.96
0.94
0.90
Touching
31
Number of three-phase
circuits
225 mm
Use as a
multiplier to
rating for
Three cables in
horizontal
formation
Three cables in
vertical
formation
G12
Touching
33
34
Three cables in
horizontal
formation
20 mm
Perforated
trays
31
2D e
De
20 mm
Vertical
perforated
trays
31
De
Spaced
225 mm
Three cables in
trefoil formation
2D e
Ladder
supports,
cleats, etc...
32
2D e
De
33
34
20 mm
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G17 : Reduction factors for groups of more than one circuit of single-core cables to be applied to reference rating for one circuit of single-core cables in free air
- Method of installation F. (table A.52.21 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
Figure G18 gives the values of correction factor k4 for different configurations of
cables or conductors laid directly in the ground.
Number
of circuits
2
3
4
5
6
a
Cable to cable clearance (a)a
Nil (cables One cable
0.125 m
touching)
diameter
0.75
0.80
0.85
0.65
0.70
0.75
0.60
0.60
0.70
0.55
0.55
0.65
0.50
0.55
0.60
0.5 m
0.90
0.80
0.75
0.70
0.70
0.90
0.85
0.80
0.80
0.80
Multi-core cables
a
a
0.25 m
a
Single-core cables
G13
a
a
Fig. G18 : Reduction factors for more than one circuit, single-core or multi-core cables laid
directly in the ground. Installation method D. (table 52-18 of IEC 60364-5-52)
b Harmonic current
The current-carrying capacity of three-phase, 4-core or 5-core cables is based on
the assumption that only 3 conductors are fully loaded.
However, when harmonic currents are circulating, the neutral current can be
significant, and even higher than the phase currents. This is due to the fact that the
3rd harmonic currents of the three phases do not cancel each other, and sum up in
the neutral conductor.
This of course affects the current-carrying capacity of the cable, and a correction
factor noted here k5 shall be applied.
In addition, if the 3rd harmonic percentage h3 is greater than 33%, the neutral current
is greater than the phase current and the cable size selection is based on the neutral
current. The heating effect of harmonic currents in the phase conductors has also to
be taken into account.
The values of k5 depending on the 3rd harmonic content are given in Figure G19.
Third harmonic content
of phase current %
0 - 15
15 - 33
33 - 45
> 45
Correction factor
Size selection is based
on phase current
1.0
0.86
Size selection is based
on neutral current
0.86
1.0 (1)
Fig. G19 : Correction factors for harmonic currents in four-core and five-core cables (table D.52.1
of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
(1) If the neutral current is more than 135 % of the phase current and the cable size is selected
on the basis of the neutral current then the three phase conductors will not be fully loaded. The
reduction in heat generated by the phase conductors offsets the heat generated by the neutral
conductor to the extent that it is not necessary to apply any reduction factor to the current
carrying capacity for three loaded conductors.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Admissible current as a function of nominal cross-sectional
area of conductors
IEC standard 60364-5-52 proposes extensive information in the form of tables
giving the admissible currents as a function of cross-sectional area of cables. Many
parameters are taken into account, such as the method of installation, type of
insulation material, type of conductor material, number of loaded conductors.
As an example, Figure G20 gives the current-carrying capacities for different
methods of installation of PVC insulation, three loaded copper or aluminium
conductors, free air or in ground.
Nominal
cross-sectional
area of conductors
(mm2)
G14
1
Copper
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
Aluminium
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
Installation methods
A1
A2
B1
B2
C
D
2
3
4
5
6
7
13.5
18
24
31
42
56
73
89
108
136
164
188
216
245
286
328
13
17.5
23
29
39
52
68
83
99
125
150
172
196
223
261
298
15.5
21
28
36
50
68
89
110
134
171
207
239
-
15
20
27
34
46
62
80
99
118
149
179
206
-
17.5
24
32
41
57
76
96
119
144
184
223
259
299
341
403
464
18
24
31
39
52
67
86
103
122
151
179
203
230
258
297
336
14
18.5
24
32
43
57
70
84
107
129
149
170
194
227
261
13.5
17.5
23
31
41
53
65
78
98
118
135
155
176
207
237
16.5
22
28
39
53
70
86
104
133
161
186
-
15.5
21
27
36
48
62
77
92
116
139
160
-
18.5
25
32
44
59
73
90
110
140
170
197
227
259
305
351
18.5
24
30
40
52
66
80
94
117
138
157
178
200
230
260
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G20 : Current-carrying capacities in amperes for different methods of installation, PVC insulation, three loaded conductors, copper or aluminium, conductor
temperature: 70 °C, ambient temperature: 30 °C in air, 20 °C in ground (table A.52.4 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
2.2 Recommended simplified approach for cables
In order to facilitate the selection of cables, 2 simplified tables are proposed, for
unburied and buried cables.
These tables summarize the most commonly used configurations and give easier
access to the information.
b Unburied cables:
Reference
methods
A1
A2
B1
B2
C
E
F
1
Size (mm2)
Copper
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
Aluminium
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
Number of loaded conductors and type of insulation
2
3
4
3 XLPE 2 XLPE
3 XLPE 2 XLPE
3 PVC 2 PVC
3 XLPE
2 PVC
3 XLPE 2 XLPE
3 PVC
2 PVC 3 XLPE
3 PVC
2 PVC
3 PVC
5
6
7
8
9
13
17.5
23
29
39
52
68
-
13.5
18
24
31
42
56
73
-
14.5
19.5
26
34
46
61
80
-
15.5
21
28
36
50
68
89
110
134
171
207
239
-
17
23
31
40
54
73
95
117
141
179
216
249
285
324
380
18.5
25
34
43
60
80
101
126
153
196
238
276
318
362
424
19.5
27
36
46
63
85
110
137
167
213
258
299
344
392
461
22
30
40
51
70
94
119
147
179
229
278
322
371
424
500
23
31
42
54
75
100
127
158
192
246
298
346
395
450
538
24
33
45
58
80
107
135
169
207
268
328
382
441
506
599
26
36
49
63
86
115
149
185
225
289
352
410
473
542
641
161
200
242
310
377
437
504
575
679
13.5
17.5
23
31
41
53
-
14
18.5
24
32
43
57
-
15
20
26
36
48
63
-
16.5
22
28
39
53
70
86
104
133
161
186
-
18.5
25
32
44
58
73
90
110
140
170
197
226
256
300
19.5
26
33
46
61
78
96
117
150
183
212
245
280
330
21
28
36
49
66
83
103
125
160
195
226
261
298
352
23
31
39
54
73
90
112
136
174
211
245
283
323
382
24
32
42
58
77
97
120
146
187
227
263
304
347
409
26
35
45
62
84
101
126
154
198
241
280
324
371
439
28
38
49
67
91
108
135
164
211
257
300
346
397
470
121
150
184
237
289
337
389
447
530
3 PVC
2 PVC
2 PVC
3 PVC
3 PVC
2 XLPE
2 XLPE
3 XLPE
2 XLPE
2 PVC 3 XLPE
2 XLPE
10
11
12
13
G15
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G21a : Current-carrying capacity in amperes (table B.52-1 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Correction factors are given in Figure G21b for groups of several circuits or multicore cables:
Arrangement
Number of circuits or multi-core cables
1
2
3
4
6
9
12
16
20
1.00 0.80 0.70 0.70 0.55 0.50 0.45 0.40 0.40
Embedded or enclosed
Single layer on walls, floors
or on unperforatedtrays
Single layer fixed directly
under a ceiling
Single layer on perforated
horizontal trays or on vertical trays
Single layer on cable
ladder supports or cleats, etc...
1.00 0.85 0.80 0.75 0.70 0.70 -
-
-
0.95 0.80 0.70 0.70 0.65 0.60 -
-
-
1.00 0.90 0.80 0.75 0.75 0.70 -
-
-
1.00 0.85 0.80 0.80 0.80 0.80 -
-
-
Fig. G21b : Reduction factors for groups of several circuits or of several multi-core cables
(table B.52-3 of IEC 60364-5-52)
G16
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Buried cables:
Installation Size
method
mm2
D
Copper
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
D
Aluminium
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
Number of loaded conductors and type of insulation
Two PVC
Three PVC Two XLPE
Three XLPE
22
29
38
47
63
81
104
125
148
183
216
246
278
312
361
408
18
24
31
39
52
67
86
103
122
151
179
203
230
258
297
336
26
34
44
56
73
95
121
146
173
213
252
287
324
363
419
474
22
29
37
46
61
79
101
122
144
178
211
240
271
304
351
396
22
29
36
48
62
80
96
113
140
166
189
213
240
277
313
18.5
24
30
40
52
66
80
94
117
138
157
178
200
230
260
26
34
42
56
73
93
112
132
163
193
220
249
279
322
364
22
29
36
47
61
78
94
112
138
164
186
210
236
272
308
Fig. G22 : Current-carrying capacity in amperes (table B.52-1 of IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
2.3 Busbar trunking systems
The selection of busbar trunking systems is very straightforward, using the data
provided by the manufacturer. Methods of installation, insulation materials, correction
factors for grouping are not relevant parameters for this technology.
The cross section area of any given model has been determined by the manufacturer
based on:
b The rated current,
b An ambient air temperature equal to 35 °C,
b 3 loaded conductors.
Rated current
The rated current can be calculated taking account of:
b The layout,
b The current absorbed by the different loads connected along the trunking system.
Ambient temperature
A correction factor has to be applied for temperature higher than 35 °C. The
correction factor applicable to medium and high power range (up to 4,000 A) is given
in Figure G23a.
°C
Correction factor
35
1
40
0.97
45
0.93
50
0.90
G17
55
0.86
Fig. G23a : Correction factor for air temperature higher than 35 °C
Neutral current
Where 3rd harmonic currents are circulating, the neutral conductor may be carrying a
significant current and the corresponding additional power losses must be taken into
account.
Figure G23b represents the maximum admissible phase and neutral currents (per
unit) in a high power busbar trunking system as functions of 3rd harmonic level.
Maximum admissible current (p.u)
1.4
Neutral conductor
1.2
1
0.8
0.6
Phase conductor
0.4
0.2
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
Fig. G23b : Maximum admissible currents (p.u.) in a busbar trunking system as functions of the
3rd harmonic level.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3rd harmonic current level (%)
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
2 Practical method for determining
the smallest allowable crosssectional area of circuit conductors
The layout of the trunking system depends on the position of the current consumers,
the location of the power source and the possibilities for fixing the system.
v One single distribution line serves a 4 to 6 meter area
v Protection devices for current consumers are placed in tap-off units, connected
directly to usage points.
v One single feeder supplies all current consumers of different powers.
Once the trunking system layout is established, it is possible to calculate the
absorbed current In on the distribution line.
In is equal to the sum of absorbed currents by the current In consumers: In = IB.
The current consumers do not all work at the same time and are not permanently on
full load, so we have to use a clustering coefficient kS : In = (IB . kS).
Application
Number of current consumers
Lighting, Heating
Distribution (engineering
workshop)
G18
Ks Coefficient
1
2...3
4...5
6...9
10...40
40 and over
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
Note : for industrial installations, remember to take account of upgrading of the machine
equipment base. As for a switchboard, a 20 % margin is recommended:
In IB x ks x 1.2.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig G24 : Clustering coefficient according to the number of current consumers
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Determination of voltage drop
The impedance of circuit conductors is low but not negligible: when carrying
load current there is a voltage drop between the origin of the circuit and the load
terminals. The correct operation of a load (a motor, lighting circuit, etc.) depends
on the voltage at its terminals being maintained at a value close to its rated value.
It is necessary therefore to determine the circuit conductors such that at full-load
current, the load terminal voltage is maintained within the limits required for correct
performance.
This section deals with methods of determining voltage drops, in order to check that:
b They comply with the particular standards and regulations in force
b They can be tolerated by the load
b They satisfy the essential operational requirements
3.1 Maximum voltage drop
Maximum allowable voltage-drop vary from one country to another. Typical values for
LV installations are given below in Figure G25.
Type of installations
A low-voltage service connection from
a LV public power distribution network
Consumers MV/LV substation supplied
from a public distribution MV system
Lighting
circuits
3%
Other uses
(heating and power)
5%
6%
8%
G19
Fig. G25 : Maximum voltage-drop between the service-connection point and the point of utilization
These voltage-drop limits refer to normal steady-state operating conditions and do
not apply at times of motor starting, simultaneous switching (by chance) of several
loads, etc. as mentioned in Chapter A Sub-clause 4.3 (factor of simultaneity, etc.).
When voltage drops exceed the values shown in Figure G25, larger cables (wires)
must be used to correct the condition.
The value of 8%, while permitted, can lead to problems for motor loads; for example:
b In general, satisfactory motor performance requires a voltage within ± 5% of its
rated nominal value in steady-state operation,
b Starting current of a motor can be 5 to 7 times its full-load value (or even higher).
If an 8% voltage drop occurs at full-load current, then a drop of 40% or more will
occur during start-up. In such conditions the motor will either:
v Stall (i.e. remain stationary due to insufficient torque to overcome the load torque)
with consequent over-heating and eventual trip-out
v Or accelerate very slowly, so that the heavy current loading (with possibly
undesirable low-voltage effects on other equipment) will continue beyond the normal
start-up period
b Finally an 8% voltage drop represents a continuous power loss, which, for continuous
loads will be a significant waste of (metered) energy. For these reasons it is
recommended that the maximum value of 8% in steady operating conditions should not
be reached on circuits which are sensitive to under-voltage problems (see Fig. G26).
LV consumer
8% (1)
5% (1)
Load
Fig. G26 : Maximum voltage drop
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
(1) Between the LV supply point and the load
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
MV consumer
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
3.2 Calculation of voltage drop in steady load
conditions
Use of formulae
Figure G27 below gives formulae commonly used to calculate voltage drop in a
given circuit per kilometre of length.
If:
b B: The full load current in amps
b L: Length of the cable in kilometres
b R: Resistance of the cable conductor in /km
R=
R=
G20
22.5 Ω mm2 / km
(
)
S c.s.a. in mm2
36 Ω mm2 / km
(
S c.s.a. in mm2
)
for copper
for aluminium
Note: R is negligible above a c.s.a. of 500 mm2
b X: inductive reactance of a conductor in/km
Note: X is negligible for conductors of c.s.a. less than 50 mm2. In the absence of any
other information, take X as being equal to 0.08/km.
b : phase angle between voltage and current in the circuit considered, generally:
v Incandescent lighting: cos = 1
v Motor power:
- At start-up: cos = 0.35
- In normal service: cos = 0.8
b Un: phase-to-phase voltage
b Vn: phase-to-neutral voltage
For prefabricated pre-wired ducts and bustrunking, resistance and inductive
reactance values are given by the manufacturer.
Circuit
Voltage drop (U)
in volts
in %
Single phase: phase/phase
∆U = 2 I B(R cos ϕ + X sin ϕ) L
100 ∆U
Un
Single phase: phase/neutral
∆U = 2 I B(R cos ϕ + X sin ϕ) L
100 ∆U
Vn
Balanced 3-phase: 3 phases
∆U = 3 I B(R cos ϕ + X sin ϕ) L
100 ∆U
Un
(with or without neutral)
Fig. G27 : Voltage-drop formulae
Simplified table
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Calculations may be avoided by using Figure G28 next page, which gives, with
an adequate approximation, the phase-to-phase voltage drop per km of cable per
ampere, in terms of:
b Kinds of circuit use: motor circuits with cos close to 0.8, or lighting with a cos
close to 1.
b Type of cable; single-phase or 3-phase
Voltage drop in a cable is then given by:
K x B x L
K is given by the table,
IB is the full-load current in amps,
L is the length of cable in km.
The column motor power “cos = 0.35” of Figure G28 may be used to compute the
voltage drop occurring during the start-up period of a motor (see example no. 1 after
the Figure G28).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Determination of voltage drop
c.s.a. in mm2
Cu
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
Al
10
16
25
35
50
70
120
150
185
240
300
400
500
Single-phase circuit
Motor power
Normal service Start-up
cos = 0.8
24
14.4
9.1
6.1
3.7
2.36
1.5
1.15
0.86
0.64
0.48
0.39
0.33
0.29
0.24
0.21
Lighting
cos = 0.35
10.6
6.4
4.1
2.9
1.7
1.15
0.75
0.6
0.47
0.37
0.30
0.26
0.24
0.22
0.2
0.19
cos = 1
30
18
11.2
7.5
4.5
2.8
1.8
1.29
0.95
0.64
0.47
0.37
0.30
0.24
0.19
0.15
Balanced three-phase circuit
Motor power
Normal service Start-up
cos = 0.8
20
12
8
5.3
3.2
2.05
1.3
1
0.75
0.56
0.42
0.34
0.29
0.25
0.21
0.18
cos = 0.35
9.4
5.7
3.6
2.5
1.5
1
0.65
0.52
0.41
0.32
0.26
0.23
0.21
0.19
0.17
0.16
Lighting
cos = 1
25
15
9.5
6.2
3.6
2.4
1.5
1.1
0.77
0.55
0.4
0.31
0.27
0.2
0.16
0.13
G21
Fig. G28 : Phase-to-phase voltage drop U for a circuit, in volts per ampere per km
Examples
Example 1 (see Fig. G29)
A three-phase 35 mm2 copper cable 50 metres long supplies a 400 V motor taking:
b 100 A at a cos = 0.8 on normal permanent load
b 500 A (5 In) at a cos = 0.35 during start-up
The voltage drop at the origin of the motor cable in normal circumstances (i.e. with
the distribution board of Figure G29 distributing a total of 1,000 A) is 10 V phase-tophase.
What is the voltage drop at the motor terminals:
b In normal service?
b During start-up?
Solution:
b Voltage drop in normal service conditions:
∆U
∆U% = 100
1,000 A
Un
Table G28 shows 1 V/A/km so that:
U for the cable = 1 x 100 x 0.05 = 5 V
U total = 10 + 5 = 15 V = i.e.
400 V
15
x 100 = 3.75%
400
This value is less than that authorized (8%) and is satisfactory.
b Voltage drop during motor start-up:
Ucable = 0.52 x 500 x 0.05 = 13 V
(500 A du ring start-up)
Owing to the additional current taken by the motor when starting, the voltage drop at
the distribution board will exceed 10 Volts.
Supposing that the infeed to the distribution board during motor starting is
900 + 500 = 1,400 A then the voltage drop at the distribution board will increase
approximately pro rata, i.e.
10 x 1,400
= 14 V
1,000
U distribution board = 14 V
U for the motor cable = 13 V
U total = 13 + 14 = 27 V i.e.
27
x 100 = 6.75%
400
Fig. G29 : Example 1
a value which is satisfactory during motor starting.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
50 m / 35 mm2 Cu
IB = 100 A
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
3 Determination of voltage drop
Example 2 (see Fig. G30)
A 3-phase 4-wire copper line of 70 mm2 c.s.a. and a length of 50 m passes a current
of 150 A. The line supplies, among other loads, 3 single-phase lighting circuits, each
of 2.5 mm2 c.s.a. copper 20 m long, and each passing 20 A.
It is assumed that the currents in the 70 mm2 line are balanced and that the three
lighting circuits are all connected to it at the same point.
What is the voltage drop at the end of the lighting circuits?
Solution:
b Voltage drop in the 4-wire line:
∆U
∆U% = 100
Un
Figure G28 shows 0.55 V/A/km
U line = 0.55 x 150 x 0.05 = 4.125 V phase-to-phase
which gives:
4 . 125
= 2.38 V phase to neutral.
3
b Voltage drop in any one of the lighting single-phase circuits:
U for a single-phase circuit = 18 x 20 x 0.02 = 7.2 V
G22
The total voltage drop is therefore
7.2 + 2.38 = 9.6 V
9.6 V
x 100 = 4.2%
230 V
This value is satisfactory, being less than the maximum permitted voltage drop of 6%.
50 m / 70 mm2 Cu
IB = 150 A
20 m / 2.5 mm2 Cu
IB = 20 A
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G30 : Example 2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
4 Short-circuit current
A knowledge of 3-phase symmetrical short-circuit current values (Isc) at strategic
points of an installation is necessary in order to determine switchgear (fault current
rating), cables (thermal withstand rating), protective devices (discriminative trip
settings) and so on...
In the following notes a 3-phase short-circuit of zero impedance (the so-called bolted
short-circuit) fed through a typical MV/LV distribution transformer will be examined.
Except in very unusual circumstances, this type of fault is the most severe, and is
certainly the simplest to calculate.
Short-circuit currents occurring in a network supplied from a generator and also in
DC systems are dealt with in Chapter N.
The simplified calculations and practical rules which follow give conservative results
of sufficient accuracy, in the large majority of cases, for installation design purposes.
Knowing the levels of 3-phase symmetrical
short-circuit currents (sc) at different points
in an installation is an essential feature of its
design
4.1 Short-circuit current at the secondary terminals
of a MV/LV distribution transformer
The case of one transformer
b In a simplified approach, the impedance of the MV system is assumed to be
negligibly small, so that: I sc =
I n x 100
Usc
where I n =
P x 103
and :
U20 3
G23
P = kVA rating of the transformer
U20 = phase-to-phase secondary volts on open circuit
n = nominal current in amps
sc = short-circuit fault current in amps
Usc = short-circuit impedance voltage of the transformer in %.
Typical values of Usc for distribution transformers are given in Figure G31.
Transformer rating
(kVA)
Usc in %
Oil-immersed
50 to 750
800 to 3,200
4
6
Cast-resin
dry type
6
6
Fig. G31 : Typical values of Usc for different kVA ratings of transformers with MV windings y 20 kV
b Example
400 kVA transformer, 420 V at no load
Usc = 4%
In =
400 x 103
= 550 A
420 x 3
I sc =
550 x 100
= 13.7 kA
4
The case of several transformers in parallel feeding a busbar
The value of fault current on an outgoing circuit immediately downstream of
the busbars (see Fig. G32) can be estimated as the sum of the Isc from each
transformer calculated separately.
Isc2
Isc3
Isc1 + Isc2 + Isc3
Fig. G32 : Case of several transformers in parallel
It is assumed that all transformers are supplied from the same MV network, in which
case the values obtained from Figure G31 when added together will give a slightly
higher fault-level value than would actually occur.
Other factors which have not been taken into account are the impedance of the
busbars and of the circuit-breakers.
The conservative fault-current value obtained however, is sufficiently accurate for
basic installation design purposes. The choice of circuit-breakers and incorporated
protective devices against short-circuit fault currents is described in Chapter H Subclause 4.4.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Isc1
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
4.2 3-phase short-circuit current (sc) at any point
within a LV installation
In a 3-phase installation Isc at any point is given by:
I sc =
U20
where
3 ZT
U20 = phase-to-phase voltage of the open circuited secondary windings of the power
supply transformer(s).
ZT = total impedance per phase of the installation upstream of the fault location (in)
Method of calculating ZT
Each component of an installation (MV network, transformer, cable, circuit-breaker,
busbar, and so on...) is characterized by its impedance Z, comprising an element
of resistance (R) and an inductive reactance (X). It may be noted that capacitive
reactances are not important in short-circuit current calculations.
The parameters R, X and Z are expressed in ohms, and are related by the sides of a
right angled triangle, as shown in the impedance diagram of Figure G33.
Z
The method consists in dividing the network into convenient sections, and to
calculate the R and X values for each.
X
G24
Where sections are connected in series in the network, all the resistive elements in
the section are added arithmetically; likewise for the reactances, to give RT and XT.
The impedance (ZT) for the combined sections concerned is then calculated from
R
Z T = RT 2 + X T 2
Fig. G33 : Impedance diagram
Any two sections of the network which are connected in parallel, can, if
predominantly both resistive (or both inductive) be combined to give a single
equivalent resistance (or reactance) as follows:
Let R1 and R2 be the two resistances connected in parallel, then the equivalent
resistance R3 will be given by:
R3 =
R1 x R2
R1 + R2
or for reactances X 3 = X1 x X2
X1 + X2
It should be noted that the calculation of X3 concerns only separated circuit without
mutual inductance. If the circuits in parallel are close togother the value of X3 will be
notably higher.
Determination of the impedance of each component
b Network upstream of the MV/LV transformer (see Fig. G34)
The 3-phase short-circuit fault level PSC, in kA or in MVA(1) is given by the power
supply authority concerned, from which an equivalent impedance can be deduced.
Psc
250 MVA
500 MVA
Uo (V)
420
420
Ra (m)
0.07
0.035
Xa (m)
0.7
0.351
Fig. G34 : The impedance of the MV network referred to the LV side of the MV/LV transformer
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A formula which makes this deduction and at the same time converts the impedance
to an equivalent value at LV is given, as follows:
U 2
Zs = 0
Psc
where
Zs = impedance of the MV voltage network, expessed in milli-ohms
Uo = phase-to-phase no-load LV voltage, expressed in volts
Psc = MV 3-phase short-circuit fault level, expressed in kVA
The upstream (MV) resistance Ra is generally found to be negligible compared with
the corresponding Xa, the latter then being taken as the ohmic value for Za. If more
accurate calculations are necessary, Xa may be taken to be equal to 0.995 Za and
Ra equal to 0.1 Xa.
(1) Short-circuit MVA: 3 EL Isc where:
b EL = phase-to-phase nominal system voltage expressed in
kV (r.m.s.)
b sc = 3-phase short-circuit current expressed in kA (r.m.s.)
(2) up to 36 kV
Figure G36 gives values for Ra and Xa corresponding to the most common MV(2)
short-circuit levels in utility power-supply networks, namely, 250 MVA and 500 MVA.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Short-circuit current
b Transformers (see Fig. G35)
The impedance Ztr of a transformer, viewed from the LV terminals, is given by the
formula:
U 2 Usc
Ztr = 20 x
Pn 100
where:
U20 = open-circuit secondary phase-to-phase voltage expressed in volts
Pn = rating of the transformer (in kVA)
Usc = the short-circuit impedance voltage of the transformer expressed in %
The transformer windings resistance Rtr can be derived from the total losses as
follows:
Pcu = 3 I n2 x Rtr so that Rtr =
Pcu x 103
in milli-ohms
3 I n2
where
Pcu = total losses in watts
n = nominal full-load current in amps
Rtr = resistance of one phase of the transformer in milli-ohms (the LV and
corresponding MV winding for one LV phase are included in this resistance value).
Xtr = Ztr 2 − Rtr 2
For an approximate calculation Rtr may be ignored since X Z in standard
distribution type transformers.
Rated
Oil-immersed
Usc (%)
Rtr (m)
Xtr (m)
Ztr (m)
Cast-resin
Power
(kVA)
100
160
200
250
315
400
500
630
800
1,000
1,250
1,600
2,000
Usc (%)
Rtr (m)
Xtr (m)
Ztr (m)
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
6
6
6
6
6
37.9
16.2
11.9
9.2
6.2
5.1
3.8
2.9
2.9
2.3
1.8
1.4
1.1
59.5
41.0
33.2
26.7
21.5
16.9
13.6
10.8
12.9
10.3
8.3
6.5
5.2
70.6
44.1
35.3
28.2
22.4
17.6
14.1
11.2
13.2
10.6
8.5
6.6
5.3
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
37.0
18.6
14.1
10.7
8.0
6.1
4.6
3.5
2.6
1.9
1.5
1.1
0.9
99.1
63.5
51.0
41.0
32.6
25.8
20.7
16.4
13.0
10.4
8.3
6.5
5.2
105.8
66.2
52.9
42.3
33.6
26.5
21.2
16.8
13.2
10.6
8.5
6.6
5.3
G25
Fig. G35 : Resistance, reactance and impedance values for typical distribution 400 V transformers with MV windings y 20 kV
b Circuit-breakers
In LV circuits, the impedance of circuit-breakers upstream of the fault location must
be taken into account. The reactance value conventionally assumed is 0.15 m per
CB, while the resistance is neglected.
b Circuit conductors
L
The resistance of a conductor is given by the formula: Rc = ρ
S
where
= the resistivity constant of the conductor material at the normal operating
temperature being:
v 22.5 m.mm2/m for copper
v 36 m.mm2/m for aluminium
L = length of the conductor in m
S = c.s.a. of conductor in mm2
(1) For 50 Hz systems, but 0.18 m/m length at 60 Hz
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Busbars
The resistance of busbars is generally negligible, so that the impedance is practically
all reactive, and amounts to approximately 0.15 m/metre(1) length for LV busbars
(doubling the spacing between the bars increases the reactance by about 10% only).
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Cable reactance values can be obtained from the manufacturers. For c.s.a. of less
than 50 mm2 reactance may be ignored. In the absence of other information, a value
of 0.08 m/metre may be used (for 50 Hz systems) or 0.096 m/metre (for 60 Hz
systems). For prefabricated bus-trunking and similar pre-wired ducting systems, the
manufacturer should be consulted.
b Motors
At the instant of short-circuit, a running motor will act (for a brief period) as a
generator, and feed current into the fault.
In general, this fault-current contribution may be ignored. However, if the total
power of motors running simultaneously is higher than 25% of the total power
of transformers, the influence of motors must be taken into account. Their total
contribution can be estimated from the formula:
scm = 3.5 n from each motor i.e. 3.5mn for m similar motors operating concurrently.
The motors concerned will be the 3-phase motors only; single-phase-motor
contribution being insignificant.
b Fault-arc resistance
Short-circuit faults generally form an arc which has the properties of a resistance.
The resistance is not stable and its average value is low, but at low voltage this
resistance is sufficient to reduce the fault-current to some extent. Experience has
shown that a reduction of the order of 20% may be expected. This phenomenon will
effectively ease the current-breaking duty of a CB, but affords no relief for its faultcurrent making duty.
G26
b Recapitulation table (see Fig. G36)
Parts of power-supply system
Supply network
Figure G34
Transformer
Figure G35
R (m)
X (m)
Ra
= 0.1
Xa
Xa = 0.995 Za; Za =
Rtr =
Circuit-breaker
Rtr is often negligible compared to Xtr
for transformers > 100 kVA
Negligible
Busbars
Negligible for S > 200 mm2 in the formula:
L
S
L
R=ρ
S
R=ρ
Circuit conductors(2)
M
Pcu x 103
3 I n2
Motors
(1)
Ztr 2 − Rtr 2
with
Ztr =
U202 Usc
x
Pn 100
XD = 0.15 m/pole
XB = 0.15 m/m
Cables: Xc = 0.08 m/m
(1)
See Sub-clause 4.2 Motors
(often negligible at LV)
Three-phase short
circuit current in kA
U20
I sc =
3
U202
Psc
RT 2 + XT 2
U20: Phase-to-phase no-load secondary voltage of MV/LV transformer (in volts).
Psc: 3-phase short-circuit power at MV terminals of the MV/LV transformers (in kVA).
Pcu: 3-phase total losses of the MV/LV transformer (in watts).
Pn: Rating of the MV/LV transformer (in kVA).
Usc: Short-circuit impedance voltage of the MV/LV transfomer (in %).
RT : Total resistance. XT: Total reactance
(1) = resistivity at normal temperature of conductors in service
b = 22.5 m x mm2/m for copper
b = 36 m x mm2/m for aluminium
(2) If there are several conductors in parallel per phase, then divide the resistance of one conductor by the number of
conductors. The reactance remains practically unchanged.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G36 : Recapitulation table of impedances for different parts of a power-supply system
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Short-circuit current
b Example of short-circuit calculations (see Fig. G37)
LV installation
MV network
Psc = 500 MVA
Transformer
20 kV/420 V
Pn = 1000 kVA
Usc = 5%
Pcu = 13.3 x 103 watts
Single-core cables
5 m copper
4 x 240 mm2/phase
Main
circuit-breaker
Busbars
10 m
Three-core cable
100 m
95 mm2 copper
Three-core cable
20 m
10 mm2 copper
final circuits
R (m)
X (m)
0.035
0.351
2.24
8.10
Rc =
22.5 5
x
= 0.12
4
240
Xc = 0.08 x 5 = 0.40
RT (m)
XT (m)
I sc =
2.41
8.85
Isc1 = 26 kA
420
3 RT 2 + XT 2
RD = 0
XD = 0.15
RB = 0
XB = 1.5
2.41
10.5
Isc2 = 22 kA
Xc = 100 x 0.08 = 8
26.1
18.5
Isc3 = 7.4 kA
Xc = 20 x 0.08 = 1.6
71.1
20.1
Isc4 = 3.2 kA
Rc = 22.5 x
Rc = 22.5 x
100
= 23.68
95
20
= 45
10
G27
Fig. G37 : Example of short-circuit current calculations for a LV installation supplied at 400 V (nominal) from a 1,000 kVA MV/LV transformer
4.3 Isc at the receiving end of a feeder as a function
of the Isc at its sending end
The network shown in Figure G38 typifies a case for the application of Figure G39
next page, derived by the «method of composition» (mentioned in Chapter F Subclause 6.2). These tables give a rapid and sufficiently accurate value of short-circuit
current at a point in a network, knowing:
b The value of short-circuit current upstream of the point considered
b The length and composition of the circuit between the point at which the shortcircuit current level is known, and the point at which the level is to be determined
It is then sufficient to select a circuit-breaker with an appropriate short-circuit fault
rating immediately above that indicated in the tables.
400 V
Isc = 28 kA
In this case 30 kA is the nearest to 28 kA on the high side. The value of short-circuit
current at the downstream end of the 20 metre circuit is given at the intersection of
the vertical column in which the length is located, and the horizontal row corresponding
to the upstream Isc (or nearest to it on the high side).
47,5 mm2, Cu
20 m
Isc = ?
This value in the example is seen to be 14.7 kA.
IB = 55 A
The procedure for aluminium conductors is similar, but the vertical column must be
ascended into the middle section of the table.
IB = 160 A
Fig. G38 : Determination of downstream short-circuit current
level Isc using Figure G39
In consequence, a DIN-rail-mounted circuit-breaker rated at 63 A and Isc of 25 kA
(such as a NG 125N unit) can be used for the 55 A circuit in Figure G38.
A Compact rated at 160 A with an Isc capacity of 25 kA (such as a NS160 unit) can
be used to protect the 160 A circuit.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
If more precise values are required, it is possible to make a detailed calculation
(see Sub-Clause 4.2) or to use a software package, such as Ecodial. In such a case,
moreover, the possibility of using the cascading technique should be considered,
in which the use of a current limiting circuit-breaker at the upstream position would
allow all circuit-breakers downstream of the limiter to have a short-circuit current
rating much lower than would otherwise be necessary (See chapter H Sub-Clause 4.5).
Method
Select the c.s.a. of the conductor in the column for copper conductors (in this
example the c.s.a. is 47.5 mm2).
Search along the row corresponding to 47.5 mm2 for the length of conductor equal
to that of the circuit concerned (or the nearest possible on the low side). Descend
vertically the column in which the length is located, and stop at a row in the middle
section (of the 3 sections of the Figure) corresponding to the known fault-current
level (or the nearest to it on the high side).
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
4 Short-circuit current
Copper 230 V / 400 V
G28
c.s.a. of phase
conductors (mm2)
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
47.5
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
2x120
2x150
2x185
553x120
3x150
3x185
Isc upstream
(in kA)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
7
5
4
3
2
1
Length of circuit (in metres)
1.6 2.3
1.2 1.8 2.5
1.5 2.1 2.9
1.8 2.6 3.7
2.2 3.1 4.4
2.3 3.2 4.6
2.5 3.5 5.0
2.9 4.2 5.9
3.4 4.9 6.9
3.7 5.3 7.5
4.4 6.2 8.8
Isc downstream
(in kA)
93
90
87
84
82
79
75
74
71
66
65
63
57
56
55
48
47
46
39
38
38
34
34
33
29
29
29
25
24
24
20
20
19.4
14.8 14.8 14.7
9.9 9.9 9.8
7.0 6.9 6.9
5.0 5.0 5.0
4.0 4.0 4.0
3.0 3.0 3.0
2.0 2.0 2.0
1.0 1.0 1.0
1.1
1.2 1.7
1.8 2.6
2.2 3.0 4.3
1.7 2.4 3.4 4.9 6.9
1.3 1.9 2.7 3.8 5.4 7.6 10.8
1.9 2.7 3.8 5.3 7.5 10.6 15.1
1.8 2.6 3.6 5.1 7.2 10.2 14.4 20
2.7 3.8 5.3 7.5 10.7 15.1 21
30
2.6 3.6 5.1 7.2 10.2 14.5 20
29
41
3.2 4.6 6.5 9.1 12.9 18.3 26
37
52
3.5 5.0 7.0 9.9 14.0 19.8 28
40
56
4.2 5.9 8.3 11.7 16.6 23
33
47
66
5.2 7.3 10.3 14.6 21
29
41
58
83
6.2 8.8 12.4 17.6 25
35
50
70
99
6.5 9.1 12.9 18.3 26
37
52
73
103
7.0 9.9 14.0 20
28
40
56
79
112
8.3 11.7 16.6 23
33
47
66
94
133
9.7 13.7 19.4 27
39
55
77
110 155
10.5 14.9 21
30
42
60
84
119 168
12.5 17.6 25
35
50
70
100 141 199
1.5
2.4
3.6
6.1
9.7
15.2
21
29
43
58
73
79
94
117
140
146
159
187
219
238
281
1.3
2.1
3.4
5.2
8.6
13.8
21
30
41
60
82
103
112
133
165
198
206
224
265
309
336
398
1.8
3.0
4.9
7.3
12.2
19.4
30
43
58
85
115
146
159
187
233
280
292
317
375
438
476
562
2.6
4.3
6.9
10.3
17.2
27
43
60
82
120
163
206
224
265
330
396
412
448
530
619
672
3.6
6.1
9.7
14.6
24
39
61
85
115
170
231
291
317
374
466
561
583
634
749
5.2
8.6
13.7
21
34
55
86
120
163
240
326
412
448
529
659
7.3
12.1
19.4
29
49
78
121
170
231
340
461
10.3
17.2
27
41
69
110
172
240
326
14.6
24
39
58
97
155
243
340
461
21
34
55
82
137
220
343
480
82
75
68
61
53
45
37
33
28
24
19.2
14.5
9.8
6.9
4.9
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
22
22
21
20
20
18.3
16.8
15.8
14.7
13.4
11.8
9.9
7.4
5.6
4.3
3.5
2.7
1.9
1.0
17.0
16.7
16.3
15.8
15.2
14.5
13.5
12.9
12.2
11.2
10.1
8.7
6.7
5.2
4.0
3.3
2.6
1.8
1.0
12.6
12.5
12.2
12.0
11.6
11.2
10.6
10.2
9.8
9.2
8.4
7.4
5.9
4.7
3.7
3.1
2.5
1.8
0.9
9.3
9.2
9.1
8.9
8.7
8.5
8.1
7.9
7.6
7.3
6.8
6.1
5.1
4.2
3.4
2.9
2.3
1.7
0.9
6.7
6.7
6.6
6.6
6.5
6.3
6.1
6.0
5.8
5.6
5.3
4.9
4.2
3.6
3.0
2.6
2.1
1.6
0.9
4.9
4.8
4.8
4.8
4.7
4.6
4.5
4.5
4.4
4.2
4.1
3.8
3.4
3.0
2.5
2.2
1.9
1.4
0.8
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.3
3.3
3.2
3.2
3.1
2.9
2.7
2.4
2.1
1.9
1.6
1.3
0.8
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.4
2.4
2.4
2.4
2.3
2.3
2.2
2.0
1.9
1.7
1.6
1.4
1.1
0.7
1.8
1.8
1.8
1.8
1.8
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.6
1.5
1.4
1.3
1.2
1.1
1.0
0.6
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.1
1.0
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.6
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.7
0.7
0.6
0.5
1.1
1.6
1.9 2.7
2.2 3.1 4.3
1.7 2.4 3.4 4.8 6.8
1.7 2.4 3.4 4.7 6.7 9.5
1.6 2.3 3.2 4.6 6.4 9.1 12.9
2.4 3.4 4.7 6.7 9.5 13.4 19.0
2.3 3.2 4.6 6.4 9.1 12.9 18.2 26
2.9 4.1 5.8 8.1 11.5 16.3 23
32
3.1 4.4 6.3 8.8 12.5 17.7 25
35
3.7 5.2 7.4 10.4 14.8 21
30
42
4.6 6.5 9.2 13.0 18.4 26
37
52
5.5 7.8 11.1 15.6 22
31
44
62
5.8 8.1 11.5 16.3 23
33
46
65
6.3 8.8 12.5 17.7 25
35
50
71
7.4 10.5 14.8 21
30
42
59
83
9.2 13.0 18.4 26
37
52
74
104
8.6 12.2 17.3 24
34
49
69
97
9.4 13.3 18.8 27
37
53
75
106
11.1 15.7 22
31
44
63
89
125
13.8 19.5 28
39
55
78
110 156
1.5
2.3
3.8
6.1
9.6
13.4
18.2
27
36
46
50
59
73
88
92
100
118
147
138
150
177
220
1.4
2.2
3.2
5.4
8.7
13.5
18.9
26
38
51
65
71
83
104
125
130
141
167
208
195
212
250
312
1.9
3.1
4.6
7.7
12.2
19.1
27
36
54
73
92
100
118
147
177
184
200
236
294
275
299
354
441
2.7
4.3
6.5
10.8
17.3
27
38
51
76
103
130
141
167
208
250
260
282
334
415
389
423
500
623
3.8
6.1
9.2
15.3
24
38
54
73
107
145
184
199
236
294
353
367
399
472
587
551
598
707
5.4
8.6
13.0
22
35
54
76
103
151
205
259
282
333
415
499
519
7.6
12.2
18.3
31
49
76
107
145
214
290
367
399
471
10.8
17.3
26
43
69
108
151
205
303
411
15.3
24
37
61
98
153
214
290
428
22
35
52
86
138
216
302
410
77
71
64
58
51
43
36
32
27
23
18.8
14.3
9.7
6.9
4.9
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
70
65
59
54
48
41
34
30
27
23
18.4
14.1
9.6
6.8
4.9
3.9
3.0
2.0
1.0
62
58
54
49
44
38
32
29
25
22
17.8
13.7
9.4
6.7
4.9
3.9
2.9
2.0
1.0
54
51
47
44
39
35
30
27
24
21
17.0
13.3
9.2
6.6
4.8
3.9
2.9
2.0
1.0
45
43
40
38
35
31
27
24
22
19.1
16.1
12.7
8.9
6.4
4.7
3.8
2.9
2.0
1.0
37
35
34
32
29
27
24
22
20
17.4
14.9
11.9
8.5
6.2
4.6
3.7
2.9
1.9
1.0
29
28
27
26
24
22
20
18.8
17.3
15.5
13.4
11.0
8.0
6.0
4.5
3.6
2.8
1.9
1.0
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Aluminium 230 V / 400 V
c.s.a. of phase
conductors (mm2)
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
47.5
70
95
120
150
185
240
300
2x120
2x150
2x185
2x240
3x120
3x150
3x185
3x240
Length of circuit (in metres)
1.2
1.4
1.4
1.6
1.9
2.3
2.2
2.3
2.8
3.5
1.6
2.0
2.0
2.2
2.6
3.3
3.1
3.3
3.9
4.9
2.3
2.8
2.9
3.1
3.7
4.6
4.3
4.7
5.5
6.9
2.6
3.3
3.9
4.1
4.4
5.2
6.5
6.1
6.6
7.8
9.8
Note: for a 3-phase system having 230 V between phases, divide the above lengths by 3
Fig. G39 : sc at a point downstream, as a function of a known upstream fault-current value and the length and c.s.a. of the intervening conductors,
in a 230/400 V 3-phase system
4.4 Short-circuit current supplied by a generator or
an inverter: Please refer to Chapter N
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
5 Particular cases of short-circuit
current
5.1 Calculation of minimum levels of short-circuit
current
If a protective device in a circuit is intended
only to protect against short-circuit faults, it is
essential that it will operate with certainty at the
lowest possible level of short-circuit current that
can occur on the circuit
In general, on LV circuits, a single protective device protects against all levels of
current, from the overload threshold through the maximum rated short-circuit currentbreaking capability of the device.
In certain cases, however, overload protective devices and separate short-circuit
protective devices are used.
Examples of such arrangements
Figures G40 to G42 show some common arrangements where overload and
short-circuit protections are achieved by separate devices.
aM fuses
(no protection
against overload)
G29
Load breaking contactor
with thermal overload relay
Circuit breaker with
instantaneous magnetic
short-circuit protective relay only
Fig. G40 : Circuit protected by aM fuses
As shown in Figures G40 and G41, the most common circuits using separate
devices control and protect motors.
Figure G42a constitutes a derogation in the basic protection rules, and is generally
used on circuits of prefabricated bustrunking, lighting rails, etc.
Fig. G41 : Circuit protected by circuit-breaker without thermal
overload relay
Circuit breaker D
S1
Variable speed drive
Figure G42b shows the functions provided by the variable speed drive, and if
necessary some additional functions provided by devices such as circuit-breaker,
thermal relay, RCD.
Protection to be provided
Protection generally provided
by the variable speed drive
Cable overload
Motor overload
Downstream short-circuit
Variable speed drive overload
Overvoltage
Undervoltage
Loss of phase
Upstream short-circuit
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Internal fault
Load with
incorporated
overload
protection
S2 < S1
Downstream earth fault
(indirect contact)
Direct contact fault
Fig. G42a : Circuit-breaker D provides protection against shortcircuit faults as far as and including the load
(self protection)
Additional protection
if not provided by the
variable speed drive
CB / Thermal relay
CB / Thermal relay
Circuit-breaker
(short-circuit tripping)
Circuit-breaker
(short-circuit and
overload tripping)
RCD u 300 mA
RCD y 30 mA
Figure G42b : Protection to be provided for variable speeed drive applications
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Load breaking contactor
with thermal overload relay
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
The protective device must fulfill:
b instantaneous trip setting m < scmin for a
circuit-breaker
b fusion current a < scmin for a fuse
Conditions to be fulfilled
The protective device must therefore satisfy the two following conditions:
b Its fault-current breaking rating must be greater than Isc, the 3-phase short-circuit
current at its point of installation
b Elimination of the minimum short-circuit current possible in the circuit, in a time tc
compatible with the thermal constraints of the circuit conductors, where:
(valid for tc < 5 seconds)
K 2S 2
tc i
I scmin2
Comparison of the tripping or fusing performance curve of protective devices, with
the limit curves of thermal constraint for a conductor shows that this condition is
satisfied if:
b sc (min) > m (instantaneous or short timedelay circuit-breaker trip setting current
level), (see Fig. G43)
b sc (min) > a for protection by fuses. The value of the current Ia corresponds to
the crossing point of the fuse curve and the cable thermal withstand curve
(see Fig. G44 and G45)
G30
t
t=
k2 S2
I2
I
Im
Fig. G43 : Protection by circuit-breaker
t
t=
k2 S2
I2
I
Ia
Fig. G44 : Protection by aM-type fuses
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
t
t=
k2 S2
I2
I
Ia
Fig. G45 : Protection by gG-type fuses
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Particular cases of short-circuit
current
In practice this means that the length of circuit
downstream of the protective device must not
exceed a calculated maximum length:
0.8 U Sph
Lmax =
2ρI m
Practical method of calculating Lmax
The limiting effect of the impedance of long circuit conductors on the value of
short-circuit currents must be checked and the length of a circuit must be restricted
accordingly.
The method of calculating the maximum permitted length has already been
demonstrated in TN- and IT- earthed schemes for single and double earth faults,
respectively (see Chapter F Sub-clauses 6.2 and 7.2). Two cases are considered
below:
1 - Calculation of Lmax for a 3-phase 3-wire circuit
The minimum short-circuit current will occur when two phase wires are shortcircuited at the remote end of the circuit (see Fig. G46).
P
0.8 U
Load
L
G31
Fig G46 : Definition of L for a 3-phase 3-wire circuit
Using the “conventional method”, the voltage at the point of protection P is assumed
to be 80% of the nominal voltage during a short-circuit fault, so that 0.8 U = Isc Zd,
where:
Zd = impedance of the fault loop
sc = short-circuit current (ph/ph)
U = phase-to-phase nominal voltage
For cables y 120 mm2, reactance may be neglected, so that
2L
Zd = ρ
(1)
Sph
where:
= resistivity of conductor material at the average temperature during a short-circuit,
Sph = c.s.a. of a phase conductor in mm2
L = length in metres
The condition for the cable protection is m y sc with m = magnetic trip current
setting of the CB.
This leads to m y 0.8 U
which gives L y 0.8 U Sph
Zd
with U = 400 V
= 1.25 x 0.018 = 0.023 .mm2/m(2) (Cu)
Lmax = maximum circuit length in metres
Lmax =
2ρI m
k Sph
Im
2 - Calculation of Lmax for a 3-phase 4-wire 230/400 V circuit
The minimum Isc will occur when the short-circuit is between a phase conductor and
the neutral.
A calculation similar to that of example 1 above is required, but using the following
formulae (for cable y 120 mm2 (1)).
b Where Sn for the neutral conductor = Sph for the phase conductor
Lmax =
3,333 Sph
Im
b If Sn for the neutral conductor < Sph, then
(1) For larger c.s.a.’s, the resistance calculated for the
conductors must be increased to account for the non-uniform
current density in the conductor (due to “skin” and “proximity”
effects)
Suitable values are as follows:
150 mm2: R + 15%
185 mm2: R + 20%
240 mm2: R + 25%
300 mm2: R + 30%
(2) The factor 1.25 applied to the copper resistivity is due
to the elevated temperature of the conductor when passing
short-circuit current. This value of 1.25 corresponds to the max
temperature of EPR or XLPE cables.
Sph 1
Sph
where m =
I m 1+ m
Sn
For larger c.s.a.’s than those listed, reactance values must be combined with those of
resistance to give an impedance. Reactance may be taken as 0.08 m/m for cables
(at 50 Hz). At 60 Hz the value is 0.096 m/m.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Lmax = 6,666
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Tabulated values for Lmax
Figure G47 below gives maximum circuit lengths (Lmax) in metres, for:
b 3-phase 4-wire 400 V circuits (i.e. with neutral) and
b 1-phase 2-wire 230 V circuits
protected by general-purpose circuit-breakers.
In other cases, apply correction factors (given in Figure G53) to the lengths obtained.
The calculations are based on the above methods, and a short-circuit trip level within
± 20% of the adjusted value m.
For the 50 mm2 c.s.a., calculation are based on a 47.5 mm2 real c.s.a.
G32
Operating current
level Im of the
instantaneous
magnetic tripping
element (in A)
50
63
80
100
125
160
200
250
320
400
500
560
630
700
800
875
1000
1120
1250
1600
2000
2500
3200
4000
5000
6300
8000
10000
12500
c.s.a. (nominal cross-sectional-area) of conductors (in mm2)
1.5
100
79
63
50
40
31
25
20
16
13
10
9
8
7
6
6
5
4
4
2.5
167
133
104
83
67
52
42
33
26
21
17
15
13
12
10
10
8
7
7
5
4
4
267
212
167
133
107
83
67
53
42
33
27
24
21
19
17
15
13
12
11
8
7
5
4
6
400
317
250
200
160
125
100
80
63
50
40
36
32
29
25
23
20
18
16
13
10
8
6
5
4
10
417
333
267
208
167
133
104
83
67
60
63
48
42
38
33
30
27
21
17
13
10
8
7
5
4
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
427
333
267
213
167
133
107
95
85
76
67
61
53
48
43
33
27
21
17
13
11
8
7
5
4
417
333
260
208
167
149
132
119
104
95
83
74
67
52
42
33
26
21
17
13
10
8
7
467
365
292
233
208
185
167
146
133
117
104
93
73
58
47
36
29
23
19
15
12
9
495
396
317
283
251
226
198
181
158
141
127
99
79
63
49
40
32
25
20
16
13
417
370
333
292
267
233
208
187
146
117
93
73
58
47
37
29
23
19
452
396
362
317
283
253
198
158
127
99
79
63
50
40
32
25
457
400
357
320
250
200
160
125
100
80
63
50
40
32
435
388
348
272
217
174
136
109
87
69
54
43
35
459
411
321
257
206
161
128
103
82
64
51
41
400
320
256
200
160
128
102
80
64
51
Fig. G47 : Maximum circuit lengths in metres for copper conductors (for aluminium, the lengths must be multiplied by 0.62)
Figures G48 to G50 next page give maximum circuit length (Lmax) in metres for:
b 3-phase 4-wire 400 V circuits (i.e. with neutral) and
b 1-phase 2-wire 230 V circuits
protected in both cases by domestic-type circuit-breakers or with circuit-breakers
having similar tripping/current characteristics.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In other cases, apply correction factors to the lengths indicated. These factors are
given in Figure G51 next page.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Particular cases of short-circuit
current
Rated current of
circuit-breakers (in A)
6
10
16
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
125
c.s.a. (nominal cross-sectional-area) of conductors (in mm2)
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
200
333
533
800
120
200
320
480
800
75
125
200
300
500
800
60
100
160
240
400
640
48
80
128
192
320
512
800
37
62
100
150
250
400
625
875
30
50
80
120
200
320
500
700
24
40
64
96
160
256
400
560
19
32
51
76
127
203
317
444
15
25
40
60
100
160
250
350
12
20
32
48
80
128
200
280
10
16
26
38
64
102
160
224
50
760
603
475
380
304
Fig. G48 : Maximum length of copper-conductor circuits in metres protected by B-type circuit-breakers
Rated current of
circuit-breakers (in A)
6
10
16
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
125
c.s.a. (nominal cross-sectional-area) of conductors (in mm2)
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
100
167
267
400
667
60
100
160
240
400
640
37
62
100
150
250
400
625
875
30
50
80
120
200
320
500
700
24
40
64
96
160
256
400
560
18.0
31
50
75
125
200
313
438
15.0
25
40
60
100
160
250
350
12.0
20
32
48
80
128
200
280
9.5
16.0
26
38
64
102
159
222
7.5
12.5
20
30
50
80
125
175
6.0
10.0
16.0
24
40
64
100
140
5.0
8.0
13.0
19.0
32
51
80
112
50
G33
760
594
475
380
302
238
190
152
Fig. G49 : Maximum length of copper-conductor circuits in metres protected by C-type circuit-breakers
Rated current of
circuit-breakers (in A)
1
2
3
4
6
10
16
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
125
c.s.a. (nominal cross-sectional-area) of conductors (in mm2)
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
429
714
214
357
571
857
143
238
381
571
952
107
179
286
429
714
71
119
190
286
476
762
43
71
114
171
286
457
714
27
45
71
107
179
286
446
625
21
36
57
86
143
229
357
500
17.0
29
46
69
114
183
286
400
13.0
22
36
54
89
143
223
313
11.0
18.0
29
43
71
114
179
250
9.0
14.0
23
34
57
91
143
200
7.0
11.0
18.0
27
45
73
113
159
5.0
9.0
14.0
21
36
57
89
125
4.0
7.0
11.0
17.0
29
46
71
100
3.0
6.0
9.0
14.0
23
37
57
80
50
848
679
543
424
339
271
215
170
136
109
Circuit detail
3-phase 3-wire 400 V circuit or 1-phase 2-wire 400 V circuit (no neutral)
1-phase 2-wire (phase and neutral) 230 V circuit
3-phase 4-wire 230/400 V circuit or 2-phase 3-wire 230/400 V circuit
(i.e with neutral)
Sph / S neutral = 1
Sph / S neutral = 2
1.73
1
1
0.67
Fig. G51 : Correction factor to apply to lengths obtained from Figures G47 to G50
Note: IEC 60898 accepts an upper short-circuit-current tripping range of 10-50 n for
type D circuit-breakers. European standards, and Figure G50 however, are based on
a range of 10-20 n, a range which covers the vast majority of domestic and similar
installations.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G50 : Maximum length of copper-conductor circuits in metres protected by D-type circuit-breakers
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Examples
Example 1
In a 1-phase 2-wire installation the protection is provided by a 50 A circuit-breaker
type NSX80HMA, the instantaneous short-circuit current trip, is set at 500 A
(accuracy of ± 20%), i.e. in the worst case would require 500 x 1,2 = 600 A to trip.
The cable c.s.a. = 10 mm2 and the conductor material is copper.
In Figure G47, the row m = 500 A crosses the column c.s.a. = 10 mm2 at the value
for Lmax of 67 m. The circuit-breaker protects the cable against short-circuit faults,
therefore, provided that its length does not exceed 67 metres.
Example 2
In a 3-phase 3-wire 400 V circuit (without neutral), the protection is provided by a
220 A circuit-breaker type NSX250N with an instantaneous short-circuit current trip
unit type MA set at 2,000 A (± 20%), i.e. a worst case of 2,400 A to be certain of
tripping. The cable c.s.a. = 120 mm2 and the conductor material is copper.
In Figure G47 the row m = 2,000 A crosses the column c.s.a. = 120 mm2 at the
value for Lmax of 200 m. Being a 3-phase 3-wire 400 V circuit (without neutral), a
correction factor from Figure G51 must be applied. This factor is seen to be 1.73.
The circuit-breaker will therefore protect the cable against short-circuit current,
provided that its length does not exceed 200 x 1.73= 346 metres.
G34
5.2 Verification of the withstand capabilities of
cables under short-circuit conditions
In general, verification of the thermal-withstand
capability of a cable is not necessary, except in
cases where cables of small c.s.a. are installed
close to, or feeding directly from, the main
general distribution board
Thermal constraints
When the duration of short-circuit current is brief (several tenths of a second
up to five seconds maximum) all of the heat produced is assumed to remain in
the conductor, causing its temperature to rise. The heating process is said to be
adiabatic, an assumption that simplifies the calculation and gives a pessimistic result,
i.e. a higher conductor temperature than that which would actually occur, since in
practice, some heat would leave the conductor and pass into the insulation.
For a period of 5 seconds or less, the relationship 2t = k2S2 characterizes the
time in seconds during which a conductor of c.s.a. S (in mm2) can be allowed to
carry a current , before its temperature reaches a level which would damage the
surrounding insulation.
The factor k2 is given in Figure G52 below.
Insulation
PVC
XLPE
Conductor copper (Cu)
13,225
20,449
Conductor aluminium (Al)
5,776
8,836
Fig. G52 : Value of the constant k2
The method of verification consists in checking that the thermal energy I2t per
ohm of conductor material, allowed to pass by the protecting circuit-breaker (from
manufacturers catalogues) is less than that permitted for the particular conductor (as
given in Figure G53 below).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
S (mm2)
1.5
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
PVC
Copper
0.0297
0.0826
0.2116
0.4761
1.3225
3.3856
8.2656
16.2006
29.839
Aluminium
0.0130
0.0361
0.0924
0.2079
0.5776
1.4786
3.6100
7.0756
13.032
XLPE
Copper
0.0460
0.1278
0.3272
0.7362
2.0450
5.2350
12.7806
25.0500
46.133
Aluminium
0.0199
0.0552
0.1414
0.3181
0.8836
2.2620
5.5225
10.8241
19.936
Fig. G53 : Maximum allowable thermal stress for cables 2t (expressed in ampere2 x second x 106)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Particular cases of short-circuit
current
Example
Is a copper-cored XLPE cable of 4 mm2 c.s.a. adequately protected by a
iC60N circuit-breaker?
Figure G53 shows that the 2t value for the cable is 0.3272 x 106, while the maximum
“let-through” value by the circuit-breaker, as given in the manufacturer’s catalogue, is
considerably less (< 0.1.106 A2s).
The cable is therefore adequately protected by the circuit-breaker up to its full rated
breaking capability.
Electrodynamic constraints
For all type of circuit (conductors or bus-trunking), it is necessary to take
electrodynamic effects into account.
To withstand the electrodynamic constraints, the conductors must be solidly fixed
and the connection must be strongly tightened.
For bus-trunking, rails, etc. it is also necessary to verify that the electrodynamic
withstand performance is satisfactory when carrying short-circuit currents. The peak
value of current, limited by the circuit-breaker or fuse, must be less than the busbar
system rating. Tables of coordination ensuring adequate protection of their products
are generally published by the manufacturers and provide a major advantage of such
systems.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
G35
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
6 Protective earthing conductor
(PE)
6.1 Connection and choice
Protective (PE) conductors provide the bonding connection between all exposed
and extraneous conductive parts of an installation, to create the main equipotential
bonding system. These conductors conduct fault current due to insulation failure
(between a phase conductor and an exposed conductive part) to the earthed neutral
of the source. PE conductors are connected to the main earthing terminal of the
installation.
The main earthing terminal is connected to the earthing electrode (see Chapter E)
by the earthing conductor (grounding electrode conductor in the USA).
PE conductors must be:
b Insulated and coloured yellow and green (stripes)
b Protected against mechanical and chemical damage
In IT and TN-earthed schemes it is strongly recommended that PE conductors
should be installed in close proximity (i.e. in the same conduits, on the same cable
tray, etc.) as the live cables of the related circuit. This arrangement ensures the
minimum possible inductive reactance in the earth-fault current carrying circuits.
It should be noted that this arrangement is originally provided by bus-trunking.
Connection
G36
PE conductors must:
b Not include any means of breaking the continuity of the circuit (such as a switch,
removable links, etc.)
b Connect exposed conductive parts individually to the main PE conductor, i.e. in
parallel, not in series, as shown in Figure G54
b Have an individual terminal on common earthing bars in distribution boards.
PE
TT scheme
The PE conductor need not necessarily be installed in close proximity to the live
conductors of the corresponding circuit, since high values of earth-fault current are
not needed to operate the RCD-type of protection used in TT installations.
Correct
PE
Incorrect
Fig. G54 : A poor connection in a series arrangement will leave
all downstream appliances unprotected
PEN
IT and TN schemes
The PE or PEN conductor, as previously noted, must be installed as close as
possible to the corresponding live conductors of the circuit and no ferro-magnetic
material must be interposed between them. A PEN conductor must always be
connected directly to the earth terminal of an appliance, with a looped connection
from the earth terminal to the neutral terminal of the appliance (see Fig. G55).
b TN-C scheme (the neutral and PE conductor are one and the same, referred to as
a PEN conductor)
The protective function of a PEN conductor has priority, so that all rules governing
PE conductors apply strictly to PEN conductors
b TN-C to TN-S transition
The PE conductor for the installation is connected to the PEN terminal or bar (see
Fig. G56) generally at the origin of the installation. Downstream of the point of
separation, no PE conductor can be connected to the neutral conductor.
PEN
PE
N
Fig. G56 : The TN-C-S scheme
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G55 : Direct connection of the PEN conductor to the earth
terminal of an appliance
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Espace avt et après illustration
6 Protective earthing conductor
(PE)
Types of materials
Materials of the kinds mentioned below in Figure G57 can be used for PE conductors,
provided that the conditions mentioned in the last column are satisfied.
Type of protective earthing conductor (PE) IT scheme
TN scheme
TT scheme Conditions to be respected
Supplementary
In the same cable
Strongly
Strongly recommended
Correct
The PE conductor must
conductor
as the phases, or in
recommended
be insulated to the same
the same cable run
level as the phases
Independent of the
Possible (1)
Possible (1) (2)
Correct
b The PE conductor may
phase conductors
be bare or insulated (2)
b The electrical continuity
Metallic housing of bus-trunking or of other
Possible (3)
PE possible (3)
Correct
prefabricated prewired ducting (5)
PEN possible (8)
must be assured by protection
against deterioration by
External sheath of extruded, mineral- insulated Possible (3)
PE possible (3)
Possible
mechanical, chemical and
conductors (e.g. «pyrotenax» type systems)
PEN not recommended (2)(3)
electrochemical hazards
Certain extraneous conductive elements (6)
Possible (4)
PE possible (4)
Possible
such as:
PEN forbidden
b Their conductance
b Steel building structures
must be adequate
b Machine frames
b Water pipes (7)
Metallic cable ways, such as, conduits (9),
Possible (4)
PE possible (4)
Possible
ducts, trunking, trays, ladders, and so on…
PEN not recommended (2)(4)
Forbidden for use as PE conductors, are: metal conduits (9), gas pipes, hot-water pipes, cable-armouring tapes (9) or wires (9)
G37
(1) In TN and IT schemes, fault clearance is generally achieved by overcurrent devices (fuses or circuit-breakers) so that the impedance
of the fault-current loop must be sufficiently low to assure positive protective device operation. The surest means of achieving a low loop
impedance is to use a supplementary core in the same cable as the circuit conductors (or taking the same route as the circuit conductors).
This solution minimizes the inductive reactance and therefore the impedance of the loop.
(2) The PEN conductor is a neutral conductor that is also used as a protective earth conductor. This means that a current may be flowing
through it at any time (in the absence of an earth fault). For this reason an insulated conductor is recommended for PEN operation.
(3) The manufacturer provides the necessary values of R and X components of the impedances (phase/PE, phase/PEN) to include in the
calculation of the earth-fault loop impedance.
(4) Possible, but not recomended, since the impedance of the earth-fault loop cannot be known at the design stage. Measurements on the
completed installation are the only practical means of assuring adequate protection for persons.
(5) It must allow the connection of other PE conductors. Note: these elements must carry an indivual green/yellow striped visual indication,
15 to 100 mm long (or the letters PE at less than 15 cm from each extremity).
(6) These elements must be demountable only if other means have been provided to ensure uninterrupted continuity of protection.
(7) With the agreement of the appropriate water authorities.
(8) In the prefabricated pre-wired trunking and similar elements, the metallic housing may be used as a PEN conductor, in parallel with the
corresponding bar, or other PE conductor in the housing.
(9) Forbidden in some countries only. Universally allowed to be used for supplementary equipotential conductors.
Fig. G57 : Choice of protective conductors (PE)
6.2 Conductor sizing
Figure G58 below is based on IEC 60364-5-54. This table provides two methods of
determining the appropriate c.s.a. for both PE or PEN conductors.
Adiabatic method
Minimum c.s.a. of
PE conductor (mm2)
Sph y 16
16 < Sph y 25
25 < Sph y 35
35 < Sph y 50
Sph > 50
Sph (2)
16
Any size
Sph /2
SPE/PEN =
I2 ⋅ t
Minimum c.s.a. of
PEN conductor (mm2)
Cu
Al
Sph (3) Sph (3)
16
25
Sph /2
Sph /2
(3) (4)
k
(1) Data valid if the prospective conductor is of the same material as the line conductor. Otherwise, a correction factor must be applied.
(2) When the PE conductor is separated from the circuit phase conductors, the following minimum values must be respected:
b 2.5 mm2 if the PE is mechanically protected
b 4 mm2 if the PE is not mechanically protected
(3) For mechanical reasons, a PEN conductor, shall have a cross-sectional area not less than 10 mm2 in copper or 16 mm2 in aluminium.
(4) Refer to table G53 for the application of this formula.
Fig. G58 : Minimum cross section area of protective conductors
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Simplified
method (1)
c.s.a. of phase
conductors Sph (mm2)
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
The two methods are:
b Adiabatic (which corresponds with that described in IEC 60724)
This method, while being economical and assuring protection of the conductor
against overheating, leads to small c.s.a.’s compared to those of the corresponding
circuit phase conductors. The result is sometimes incompatible with the necessity
in IT and TN schemes to minimize the impedance of the circuit earth-fault loop, to
ensure positive operation by instantaneous overcurrent tripping devices. This method
is used in practice, therefore, for TT installations, and for dimensioning an earthing
conductor (1).
b Simplified
This method is based on PE conductor sizes being related to those of the
corresponding circuit phase conductors, assuming that the same conductor material
is used in each case.
Thus, in Figure G58 for:
Sph y 16 mm2 SPE = Sph
16 < Sph y 35 mm2 SPE = 16 mm2
Sph
Sph > 35 mm2 SPE =
2
Note: when, in a TT scheme, the installation earth electrode is beyond the zone of
influence of the source earthing electrode, the c.s.a. of the PE conductor can be
limited to 25 mm2 (for copper) or 35 mm2 (for aluminium).
G38
The neutral cannot be used as a PEN conductor unless its c.s.a. is equal to or larger
than 10 mm2 (copper) or 16 mm2 (aluminium).
Moreover, a PEN conductor is not allowed in a flexible cable. Since a PEN conductor
functions also as a neutral conductor, its c.s.a. cannot, in any case, be less than that
necessary for the neutral, as discussed in Subclause 7.1 of this Chapter.
This c.s.a. cannot be less than that of the phase conductors unless:
b The kVA rating of single-phase loads is less than 10% of the total kVA load, and
b Imax likely to pass through the neutral in normal circumstances, is less than the
current permitted for the selected cable size.
Furthermore, protection of the neutral conductor must be assured by the protective
devices provided for phase-conductor protection (described in Sub-clause 7.2 of this
Chapter).
Values of factor k to be used in the formulae
These values are identical in several national standards, and the temperature rise
ranges, together with factor k values and the upper temperature limits for the different
classes of insulation, correspond with those published in IEC 60724 (1984).
The data presented in Figure G59 are those most commonly needed for LV installation
design.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
k values
Final temperature (°C)
Initial temperature (°C)
Insulated conductors
not incoporated in
cables or bare
conductors in contact
with cable jackets
Conductors of a
multi-core-cable
Nature of insulation
Polyvinylchloride (PVC)
Copper
Aluminium
Steel
160
30
143
95
52
Cross-linked-polyethylene
(XLPE)
Ethylene-propylene-rubber
(EPR)
250
30
176
116
64
Copper
Aluminium
115
76
143
94
Fig. G59 : k factor values for LV PE conductors, commonly used in national standards and
complying with IEC 60724
(1) Grounding electrode conductor
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Protective earthing conductor
(PE)
6.3 Protective conductor between MV/LV transformer
and the main general distribution board (MGDB)
All phase and neutral conductors upstream of the main incoming circuit-breaker
controlling and protecting the MGDB are protected by devices at the MV side of the
transformer. The conductors in question, together with the PE conductor, must be
dimensioned accordingly. Dimensioning of the phase and neutral conductors from
the transformer is exemplified in Sub-clause 7.5 of this chapter (for circuit C1 of the
system illustrated in Fig. G65).
Recommended conductor sizes for bare and insulated PE conductors from the
transformer neutral point, shown in Figure G60, are indicated below in Figure G61.
The kVA rating to consider is the sum of all (if more than one) transformers
connected to the MGDB.
G39
PE
MGDB
Main earth bar
for the LV installation
Fig. G60 : PE conductor to the main earth bar in the MGDB
The table indicates the c.s.a. of the conductors in mm2 according to:
b The nominal rating of the MV/LV transformer(s) in kVA
b The fault-current clearance time by the MV protective devices, in seconds
b The kinds of insulation and conductor materials
If the MV protection is by fuses, then use the 0.2 seconds columns.
In IT schemes, if an overvoltage protection device is installed (between the
transformer neutral point and earth) the conductors for connection of the device
should also be dimensioned in the same way as that described above for
PE conductors.
Transformer
rating in kVA
(230/400 V
output)
Conductor
material
Copper t(s)
Aluminium t(s)
Bare
conductors
0.2
0.5
0.2
y100
160
200
250
315
400
500
630
800
1,000
1,250
c.s.a. of PE
conductors
SPE (mm2)
25
25
25
25
35
50
50
70
70
95
95
25
25
35
35
50
70
70
95
120
120
150
0.5
PVC-insulated
conductors
0.2
0.5
0.2
0.5
XLPE-insulated
conductors
0.2
0.5
0.2
0.5
25
35
50
70
70
95
120
150
150
185
185
25
25
25
35
35
50
70
70
95
95
120
25
25
25
25
35
35
50
70
70
70
95
25
25
35
50
50
70
95
95
120
120
150
25
50
50
70
95
95
120
150
185
185
240
25
25
25
35
50
50
70
95
95
120
120
25
35
50
50
70
95
95
120
150
150
185
Fig. G61 : Recommended c.s.a. of PE conductor between the MV/LV transformer and the MGDB,
as a function of transformer ratings and fault-clearance times.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These conductors must be sized according to
national practices
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
6 Protective earthing conductor
(PE)
6.4 Equipotential conductor
The main equipotential conductor
This conductor must, in general, have a c.s.a. at least equal to half of that of the
largest PE conductor, but in no case need exceed 25 mm2 (copper) or 35 mm2
(aluminium) while its minimum c.s.a. is 6 mm2 (copper) or 10 mm2 (aluminium).
Supplementary equipotential conductor
This conductor allows an exposed conductive part which is remote from the nearest
main equipotential conductor (PE conductor) to be connected to a local protective
conductor. Its c.s.a. must be at least half of that of the protective conductor to which
it is connected.
If it connects two exposed conductive parts (M1 and M2 in Figure G62) its c.s.a.
must be at least equal to that of the smaller of the two PE conductors (for M1 and
M2). Equipotential conductors which are not incorporated in a cable, should be
protected mechanically by conduits, ducting, etc. wherever possible.
G40
Other important uses for supplementary equipotential conductors concern the
reduction of the earth-fault loop impedance, particulary for indirect-contact protection
schemes in TN- or IT-earthed installations, and in special locations with increased
electrical risk (refer to IEC 60364-4-41).
Between two exposed conductive parts
if SPE1 y SPE2
then S LS = SPE1
SPE1
Between an exposed conductive part
and a metallic structure
SPE
SLS =
2
SPE2
SPE1
SLS
M1
SLS
M2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G62 : Supplementary equipotential conductors
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M1
Metal structures
(conduits, girders…)
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
7 The neutral conductor
The c.s.a. and the protection of the neutral conductor, apart from its current-carrying
requirement, depend on several factors, namely:
b The type of earthing system, TT, TN, etc.
b The harmonic currents
b The method of protection against indirect contact hazards according to the
methods described below
The color of the neutral conductor is statutorily blue. PEN conductor, when insulated,
shall be marked by one of the following methods :
b Green-and-yellow throughout its length with, in addition, light blue markings at the
terminations, or
b Light blue throughout its length with, in addition, green-and-yellow markings at the
terminations
7.1 Sizing the neutral conductor
Influence of the type of earthing system
TT and TN-S schemes
b Single-phase circuits or those of c.s.a. y 16 mm2 (copper) 25 mm2 (aluminium): the
c.s.a. of the neutral conductor must be equal to that of the phases
b Three-phase circuits of c.s.a. > 16 mm2 copper or 25 mm2 aluminium: the c.s.a. of
the neutral may be chosen to be:
v Equal to that of the phase conductors, or
v Smaller, on condition that:
- The current likely to flow through the neutral in normal conditions is less than the
permitted value Iz. The influence of triplen(1) harmonics must be given particular
consideration or
- The neutral conductor is protected against short-circuit, in accordance with the
following Sub-clause G-7.2
- The size of the neutral conductor is at least equal to 16 mm2 in copper or 25 mm2 in
aluminium
G41
TN-C scheme
The same conditions apply in theory as those mentioned above, but in practice,
the neutral conductor must not be open-circuited under any circumstances since
it constitutes a PE as well as a neutral conductor (see Figure G58 “c.s.a. of PEN
conductor” column).
IT scheme
In general, it is not recommended to distribute the neutral conductor, i.e. a 3-phase
3-wire scheme is preferred. When a 3-phase 4-wire installation is necessary,
however, the conditions described above for TT and TN-S schemes are applicable.
Influence of harmonic currents
(1) Harmonics of order 3 and multiple of 3
I1 H1
+
I1 H3
I2 H1
+
I2 H3
I3 H1
+
I3 H3
3
3
IN =
Ik H1
+
Ik H3
1
1
0
+
3 IH3
Fig. G63a : Triplen harmonics are in phase and cumulate in the Neutral
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Effects of triplen harmonics
Harmonics are generated by the non-linear loads of the installation (computers,
fluorescent lighting, rectifiers, power electronic choppers) and can produce high
currents in the Neutral. In particular triplen harmonics of the three Phases have a
tendency to cumulate in the Neutral as:
b Fundamental currents are out-of-phase by 2/3 so that their sum is zero
b On the other hand, triplen harmonics of the three Phases are always positioned in
the same manner with respect to their own fundamental, and are in phase with each
other (see Fig. G63a).
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Figure G63b shows the load factor of the neutral conductor as a function of the
percentage of 3rd harmonic.
In practice, this maximum load factor cannot exceed 3.
INeutral
IPhase
2.0
1.8
1.6
1.4
1.2
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
G42
i 3 (%)
0
20
40
60
80
100
Fig. G63b : Load factor of the neutral conductor vs the percentage of 3rd harmonic
Reduction factors for harmonic currents in four-core and five-core cables with
four cores carrying current
The basic calculation of a cable concerns only cables with three loaded conductors
i.e there is no current in the neutral conductor. Because of the third harmonic current,
there is a current in the neutral. As a result, this neutral current creates an hot
environment for the 3 phase conductors and for this reason, a reduction factor for
phase conductors is necessary (see Fig. G63).
Reduction factors, applied to the current-carrying capacity of a cable with three
loaded conductors, give the current-carrying capacity of a cable with four loaded
conductors, where the current in the fourth conductor is due to harmonics. The
reduction factors also take the heating effect of the harmonic current in the phase
conductors into account.
b Where the neutral current is expected to be higher than the phase current, then the
cable size should be selected on the basis of the neutral current
b Where the cable size selection is based on a neutral current which is not
significantly higher than the phase current, it is necessary to reduce the tabulated
current carrying capacity for three loaded conductors
b If the neutral current is more than 135% of the phase current and the cable size is
selected on the basis of the neutral current then the three phase conductors will not
be fully loaded. The reduction in heat generated by the phase conductors offsets the
heat generated by the neutral conductor to the extent that it is not necessary to apply
any reduction factor to the current carrying capacity for three loaded conductors.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Compact NSX100 circuit breaker
b In order to protect cables, the fuse or circuit-breaker has to be sized taking into
account the greatest of the values of the line currents (phase or neutral). However,
there are special devices (for example the Compact NSX circuit breaker equipped
with the OSN tripping unit), that allow the use of a c.s.a. of the phase conductors
smaller than the c.s.a. of the neutral conductor. A big economic gain can thus be
made.
Third harmonic content
of phase current
(%)
0 - 15
15 - 33
33 - 45
> 45
Reduction factor
Size selection is based on
phase current
1.0
0.86
-
Size selection is based on
neutral current
0.86
1.0 (1)
(1) If the neutral current is more than 135 % of the phase current and the cable size is selected
on the basis of the neutral current then the three phase conductors will not be fully loaded. The
reduction in heat generated by the phase conductors offsets the heat generated by the neutral
conductor to the extent that it is not necessary to apply any reduction factor to the current
carrying capacity for three loaded conductors.
Fig. G63 : Reduction factors for harmonic currents in four-core and five-core cables
(according to IEC 60364-5-52)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 The neutral conductor
Examples
Consider a three-phase circuit with a design load of 37 A to be installed using fourcore PVC insulated cable clipped to a wall, installation method C. From Figure G24,
a 6 mm2 cable with copper conductors has a current-carrying capacity of 40 A and
hence is suitable if harmonics are not present in the circuit.
b If 20 % third harmonic is present, then a reduction factor of 0,86 is applied and the
design load becomes: 37/0.86 = 43 A.
For this load a 10 mm2 cable is necessary.
In this case, the use of a special protective device (Compact NSX equipped with the
OSN trip unit for instance) would allow the use of a 6 mm2 cable for the phases and
of 10 mm2 for the neutral.
b If 40 % third harmonic is present, the cable size selection is based on the neutral
current which is: 37 x 0,4 x 3 = 44,4 A and a reduction factor of 0,86 is applied,
leading to a design load of: 44.4/0.86 = 51.6 A.
For this load a 10 mm2 cable is suitable.
b If 50 % third harmonic is present, the cable size is again selected on the basis of
the neutral current, which is: 37 x 0,5 x 3 = 55,5 A .In this case the rating factor is
1 and a 16 mm2 cable is required.
In this case, the use of a special protective device (Compact NSX equipped with the
OSN trip for instance) would allow the use of a 6 mm2 cable for the phases and of
10 mm2 for the neutral.
G43
7.2 Protection of the neutral conductor
(see Fig. G64 next page)
Protection against overload
If the neutral conductor is correctly sized (including harmonics), no specific
protection of the neutral conductor is required because it is protected by the phase
protection.
However, in practice, if the c.s.a. of the neutral conductor is lower than the phase
c.s.a, a neutral overload protection must be installed.
Protection against short-circuit
If the c.s.a. of the neutral conductor is lower than the c.s.a. of the phase conductor,
the neutral conductor must be protected against short-circuit.
If the c.s.a. of the neutral conductor is equal or greater than the c.s.a. of the phase
conductor, no specific protection of the neutral conductor is required because it is
protected by the phase protection.
7.3 Breaking of the neutral conductor
(see Fig. G64 next page)
The need to break or not the neutral conductor is related to the protection against
indirect contact.
In TN-C scheme
The neutral conductor must not be open-circuited under any circumstances since it
constitutes a PE as well as a neutral conductor.
The action can only be achieved with fuses in an indirect way, in which the operation
of one or more fuses triggers a mechanical trip-out of all poles of an associated
series-connected load-break switch.
7.4 Isolation of the neutral conductor
(see Fig. G64 next page)
It is considered to be the good practice that every circuit be provided with the means
for its isolation.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In TT, TN-S and IT schemes
In the event of a fault, the circuit-breaker will open all poles, including the neutral
pole, i.e. the circuit-breaker is omnipolar.
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
7 The neutral conductor
TT
TN-C
TN-S
IT
Single-phase
(Phase-Neutral)
N
N (B)
N
N
or
or
N
N
Single-phase
(Phase-Phase)
(A)
(A)
or
or
Three-phase
four wires
Sn u Sph
G44
N
N
N (B)
N
or
N
Three-phase
four wires
Sn < Sph
N
N
or
N (B)
N
(A) Authorized for TT or TN-S systems if a RCD is installed at the origin of the circuit or upstream of it, and if no artificial
neutral is distributed downstream of its location
(B) The neutral overcurrent protection is not necessary:
b If the neutral conductor is protected against short-circuits by a device placed upstream, or,
b If the circuit is protected by a RCD which sensitivity is less than 15% of the neutral admissible current.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. G64 : The various situations in which the neutral conductor may appear
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
8 Worked example of cable
calculation
Worked example of cable calculation (see Fig. G65)
The installation is supplied through a 630 kVA transformer. The process requires
a high degree of supply continuity and part of the installation can be supplied by a
250 kVA standby generator. The global earthing system is TN-S, except for the most
critical loads supplied by an isolation transformer with a downstream IT configuration.
The single-line diagram is shown in Figure G65 below. The results of a computer
study for the circuit from transformer T1 down to the cable C7 is reproduced on
Figure G66. This study was carried out with Ecodial software (a Schneider Electric
product).
This is followed by the same calculations carried out by the simplified method
described in this guide.
630 kVA 400V 50 Hz
T1
G45
C1
Q1
G5
B2
Q16
Q3
G
250 kVA 400V 50 Hz
Q4
C5
Q5
C4
C16
R16
Q10
Q11
180 kvar
20 m
C11
C10
L10
T11
ku = 1.0
IB = 169,81 A
P = 100 kW
P = 125 kVA
U = 400 V
Q12
C12
C3
B13
Q7
Q8
Q14
Q15
C7
C8
C14
C15
L7
L8
L14
L15
ku = 1.0
IB = 254.71 A
P = 150 kW
ku = 1.0
IB = 254.71 A
P = 150 kW
Fig. G65 : Example of single-line diagram
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
ku = 1.0
IB = 84,90 A
P = 50 kW
ku = 1.0
IB = 84,90 A
P = 50 kW
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
B6
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
Calculation using software Ecodial
General network characteristics
Earthing system
Neutral distributed
Voltage (V)
Frequency (Hz)
Upstream fault level (MVA)
Resistance of MV network (m)
Reactance of MV network (m)
Transformer T1
Rating (kVA)
Short-circuit impedance voltage (%)
Transformer resistance RT (m)
G46
Transformer reactance XT (m)
3-phase short-circuit current Ik3 (kA)
Cable C1
Length (m)
Maximum load current (A)
Type of insulation
Ambient temperature (°C)
Conductor material
Single-core or multi-core cable
Installation method
Number of layers
Phase conductor selected csa (mm2)
Neutral conductor selected csa (mm2)
PE conductor selected csa (mm2)
Voltage drop U (%)
3-phase short-circuit current Ik3 (kA)
Courant de défaut phase-terre Id (kA)
Circuit-breaker Q1
Load current (A)
Type
Reference
Rated current (A)
Number of poles and protected poles
Tripping unit
Overload trip Ir (A)
Short-delay trip Im / Isd (A)
Tripping time tm (ms)
Switchboard B2
Reference
Rated current (A)
Circuit breaker Q3
Load current (A)
Type
Reference
Rated current (A)
Number of poles and protected poles
Tripping unit
Overload trip Ir (A)
Short-delay trip Im / Isd (A)
Cable C3
Length
Maximum load current (A)
Type of insulation
Ambient temperature (°C)
Conductor material
Single-core or multi-core cable
Installation method
Phase conductor selected csa (mm2)
Neutral conductor selected csa (mm2)
PE conductor selected csa (mm2)
TN-S
No
400
50
500
0.0351
0.351
630
4
3.472
10.64
21.54
Cable voltage drop U (%)
5
860
PVC
30
Copper
Single
F
1
2 x 240
2 x 240
1 x 120
0.122
21.5
15.9
860
Compact
NS1000N
1000
4P4d
Micrologic 5.0
900
9000
50
Linergy 1250
1050
509
Compact
NSX630F
630
Total voltage drop U (%)
3-phase short-circuit current Ik3 (kA)
1-phase-to-earth fault current Id (kA)
Switchboard B6
Reference
Rated current (A)
Circuit-breaker Q7
Load current (A)
Type
Reference
Rated current (A)
Number of poles and protected poles
Tripping unit
Overload trip Ir (A)
Short-delay trip Im / Isd (A)
Cable C7
Length
Maximum load current (A)
Type of insulation
Ambient temperature (°C)
Conductor material
Single-core or multi-core cable
Installation method
Phase conductor selected csa (mm2)
Neutral conductor selected csa (mm2)
PE conductor selected csa (mm2)
Cable voltage drop U (%)
Total voltage drop U (%)
3-phase short-circuit current Ik3 (kA)
1-phase-to-earth fault current Id (kA)
4P4d
Micrologic 2.3
510
5100
20
509
PVC
30
Copper
Single
F
2 x 95
2 x 95
1 x 95
0.53
0.65
19.1
11.5
Linergy 800
750
255
Compact
NSX400F
400
3P3d
Micrologic 2.3
258
2576
5
255
PVC
30
Copper
Single
F
1 x 95
1 x 50
0.14
0.79
18.0
10.0
Fig. G66 : Partial results of calculation carried out with Ecodial software (Schneider Electric)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The same calculation using the simplified method
recommended in this guide
b Dimensioning circuit C1
The MV/LV 630 kVA transformer has a rated no-load voltage of 420 V. Circuit C1
must be suitable for a current of:
IB =
630 x 103
= 866 A per phase
3 x 420
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8 Worked example of cable
calculation
Two single-core PVC-insulated copper cables in parallel will be used for each phase.
These cables will be laid on cable trays according to method F.
Each conductor will therefore carry 433A. Figure G21a indicates that for 3 loaded
conductors with PVC isolation, the required c.s.a. is 240mm².
The resistance and the inductive reactance, for the two conductors in parallel, and
for a length of 5 metres, are:
R=
22.5 x 5
= 0.23 mΩ (cable resistance: 22.5 m.mm2/m)
240 x 2
X = 0,08 x 5 = 0,4 m(cable reactance: 0.08 m/m)
b Dimensioning circuit C3
Circuit C3 supplies two 150kW loads with cos φ = 0.85, so the total load current is:
300 x 10 3
= 509 A
3 x 400 x 0.85
IB =
Two single-core PVC-insulated copper cables in parallel will be used for each phase.
These cables will be laid on cable trays according to method F.
Each conductor will therefore carry 255A. Figure G21a indicates that for 3 loaded
conductors with PVC isolation, the required c.s.a. is 95mm².
The resistance and the inductive reactance, for the two conductors in parallel, and
for a length of 20 metres, are:
R=
G47
22.5 x 20
= 2.37 mΩ (cable resistance: 22.5 mΩ.mm2/m)
95 x 2
X = 0.08 x 20 = 1.6 mΩ (cable reactance: 0.08 mΩ/m)
b Dimensioning circuit C7
Circuit C7 supplies one 150kW load with cos φ = 0.85, so the total load current is:
IB =
150 x 103
= 255 A
3 x 400 x 0.85
One single-core PVC-insulated copper cable will be used for each phase. The cables
will be laid on cable trays according to method F.
Each conductor will therefore carry 255A. Figure G21a indicates that for 3 loaded
conductors with PVC isolation, the required c.s.a. is 95mm².
The resistance and the inductive reactance for a length of 20 metres is:
R=
22.5 x 5
= 1.18 mΩ (cable resistance: 22.5 mΩ.mm2/m)
95
X = 0.08 x 5 = 0.4 mΩ (cable reactance: 0.08 mΩ/m)
Circuit components
Upstream MV network,
500MVA fault level
(see Fig. G34)
Transformer 630kVA, 4%
(see Fig. G35)
Cable C1
Sub-total
Cable C3
Sub-total
Cable C7
Sub-total
R (m)
0,035
X (m)
0,351
2.9
10.8
0.23
3.16
2.37
5.53
1.18
6.71
0.4
11.55
1.6
13.15
0.4
13.55
Fig. G67 : Example of short-circuit current evaluation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Z (m)
Ikmax (kA)
11.97
20.2
14.26
17
15.12
16
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Calculation of short-circuit currents for the selection of circuit-breakers Q1,
Q3, Q7 (see Fig. G67)
G - Sizing and protection of conductors
8 Worked example of cable
calculation
b The protective conductor
When using the adiabatic method, the minimum c.s.a. for the protective earth
conductor (PE) can be calculated by the formula given in Figure G58:
2
SPE = I .t
k
For circuit C1, I = 20.2kA and k = 143.
t is the maximum operating time of the MV protection, e.g. 0.5s
This gives:
I 2.t 20200 × 0.5
=
= 100 mm 2
k
143
SPE =
A single 120 mm2 conductor is therefore largely sufficient, provided that it also
satisfies the requirements for indirect contact protection (i.e. that its impedance is
sufficiently low).
Generally, for circuits with phase conductor c.s.a. Sph ≥ 50 mm2, the PE conductor
minimum c.s.a. will be Sph / 2. Then, for circuit C3, the PE conductor will be 95mm2,
and for circuit C7, the PE conductor will be 50mm2.
b Protection against indirect-contact hazards
G48
For circuit C3 of Figure G65, Figures F41 and F40, or the formula given page F25
may be used for a 3-phase 4-wire circuit.
The maximum permitted length of the circuit is given by:
L max =
L max =
0.8 x U0 x S ph
ρ x (1 + m) x I a
0.8 x 230 2 x 95
-3
22.5 x 10 x (1+2) x 630 x 11
= 75 m
(The value in the denominator 630 x 11 is the maximum current level at which the
instantaneous short-circuit magnetic trip of the 630 A circuit-breaker operates).
The length of 20 metres is therefore fully protected by “instantaneous” over-current
devices.
b Voltage drop
The voltage drop is calculated using the data given in Figure G28, for balanced
three-phase circuits, motor power normal service (cos φ = 0.8).
The results are summarized on figure G68:
C1
C3
C7
c.s.a.
2 x 240mm²
2 x 95mm²
1 x 95mm²
∆U per conductor
(V/A/km) see Fig. G28
0.21
0.42
0.42
Load current (A)
866
509
255
Length (m)
5
20
5
Voltage drop (V)
0.45
2.1
0.53
Voltage drop (%)
0.11
0.53
0.13
Fig. G68 : Voltage drop introduced by the different cables
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The total voltage drop at the end of cable C7 is then: 0.77%.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter H
LV switchgear: functions &
selection
Contents
1
The basic functions of LV switchgear
H2
1.1 Electrical protection
1.2 Isolation
1.3 Switchgear control
H2
H3
H4
2
The switchgear
H5
2.1 Elementary switching devices
2.2 Combined switchgear elements
H5
H9
3
Choice of switchgear
H10
3.1 Switchgear selection
3.2 Tabulated functional capabilities of LV switchgear
H10
H10
4
Circuit-breaker
H11
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
4.8
H11
H13
H15
H18 H1
H22
H28
H29
H29
5
Maintenance of low voltage switchgear
H32
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Standards and description
Fundamental characteristics of a circuit-breaker
Other characteristics of a circuit-breaker
Selection of a circuit-breaker
Coordination between circuit-breakers
Discrimination MV/LV in a consumer’s substation
Circuit- breakers suitable for IT systems
Ultra rapid circuit breaker
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
1 The basic functions of
LV switchgear
National and international standards define the manner in which electric circuits of
LV installations must be realized, and the capabilities and limitations of the various
switching devices which are collectively referred to as switchgear.
The role of switchgear is:
b Electrical protection
b Safe isolation from live parts
b Local or remote switching
The main functions of switchgear are:
b Electrical protection
b Electrical isolation of sections of an installation
b Local or remote switching
These functions are summarized below in Figure H1.
Electrical protection at low voltage is (apart from fuses) normally incorporated in
circuit-breakers, in the form of thermal-magnetic devices and/or residual-currentoperated tripping devices (less-commonly, residual voltage- operated devices
- acceptable to, but not recommended by IEC).
In addition to those functions shown in Figure H1, other functions, namely:
b Over-voltage protection
b Under-voltage protection
are provided by specific devices (lightning and various other types of voltage-surge
arrester, relays associated with contactors, remotely controlled circuit-breakers, and
with combined circuit-breaker/isolators… and so on)
Electrical protection
against
b Overload currents
b Short-circuit currents
b Insulation failure
H2
Isolation
Control
b Isolation clearly indicated
by an authorized fail-proof
mechanical indicator
b A gap or interposed insulating
barrier between the open
contacts, clearly visible
b Functional switching
b Emergency switching
b Emergency stopping
b Switching off for
mechanical maintenance
Fig. H1 : Basic functions of LV switchgear
Electrical protection assures:
b Protection of circuit elements against the
thermal and mechanical stresses of short-circuit
currents
b Protection of persons in the event of
insulation failure
b Protection of appliances and apparatus being
supplied (e.g. motors, etc.)
1.1 Electrical protection
The aim is to avoid or to limit the destructive or dangerous consequences of
excessive (short-circuit) currents, or those due to overloading and insulation failure,
and to separate the defective circuit from the rest of the installation.
A distinction is made between the protection of:
b The elements of the installation (cables, wires, switchgear…)
b Persons and animals
b Equipment and appliances supplied from the installation
The protection of circuits
v Against overload; a condition of excessive current being drawn from a healthy
(unfaulted) installation
v Against short-circuit currents due to complete failure of insulation between
conductors of different phases or (in TN systems) between a phase and neutral (or
PE) conductor
Protection in these cases is provided either by fuses or circuit-breaker, in the
distribution board at the origin of the final circuit (i.e. the circuit to which the load
is connected). Certain derogations to this rule are authorized in some national
standards, as noted in chapter H1 sub-clause 1.4.
The protection of persons
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
According to IEC61364 – 41, Automatic disconnection in case of fault is a protective
measure permitted for safety
v Circuit breaker or fuses can be used as protective devices that "automatically
interrupt the supply to the line conductor of a circuit or equipment in the event
of a fault of negligible impedance between the line conductor and an exposedconductive-part or a protective conductor in the circuit or equipment within the
disconnection time required " (IEC 60364-411)
v Against insulation failures. According to the system of earthing for the installation
(TN, TT or IT) the protection will be provided by fuses or circuit-breakers, residual
current devices, and/or permanent monitoring of the insulation resistance of the
installation to earth
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 The basic functions of
LV switchgear
The protection of electric motors
v Against overheating, due, for example, to long term overloading, stalled rotor,
single-phasing, etc. Thermal relays, specially designed to match the particular
characteristics of motors are used.
Such relays may, if required, also protect the motor-circuit cable against overload.
Short-circuit protection is provided either by type aM fuses or by a circuit-breaker
from which the thermal (overload) protective element has been removed, or
otherwise made inoperative.
A state of isolation clearly indicated by an
approved “fail-proof” indicator, or the visible
separation of contacts, are both deemed to
satisfy the national standards of many countries
1.2 Isolation
The aim of isolation is to separate a circuit or apparatus (such as a motor, etc.) from
the remainder of a system which is energized, in order that personnel may carry out
work on the isolated part in perfect safety.
In principle, all circuits of an LV installation shall have means to be isolated.
In practice, in order to maintain an optimum continuity of service, it is preferred to
provide a means of isolation at the origin of each circuit.
An isolating device must fulfil the following requirements:
b All poles of a circuit, including the neutral (except where the neutral is a PEN
conductor) must open(1)
b It must be provided with a locking system in open position with a key (e.g. by
means of a padlock) in order to avoid an unauthorized reclosure by inadvertence
b It must comply with a recognized national or international standard
(e.g. IEC 60947-3) concerning clearance between contacts, creepage distances,
overvoltage withstand capability, etc.:
Other requirements apply:
v Verification that the contacts of the isolating device are, in fact, open.
The verification may be:
- Either visual, where the device is suitably designed to allow the contacts to be seen
(some national standards impose this condition for an isolating device located at the
origin of a LV installation supplied directly from a MV/LV transformer)
- Or mechanical, by means of an indicator solidly welded to the operating shaft
of the device. In this case the construction of the device must be such that, in the
eventuality that the contacts become welded together in the closed position, the
indicator cannot possibly indicate that it is in the open position
v Leakage currents. With the isolating device open, leakage currents between the
open contacts of each phase must not exceed:
- 0.5 mA for a new device
- 6.0 mA at the end of its useful life
v Voltage-surge withstand capability, across open contacts. The isolating device,
when open must withstand a 1.2/50 s impulse, having a peak value of 6, 8 or 12 kV
according to its service voltage, as shown in Figure H2. The device must satisfy
these conditions for altitudes up to 2,000 metres. Correction factors are given in
IEC 60664-1 for altitudes greater than 2,000 metres.
H3
Consequently, if tests are carried out at sea level, the test values must be increased
by 23% to take into account the effect of altitude. See standard IEC 60947.
230/400
400/690
690/1,000
Impulse withstand
peak voltage category
(for 2,000 metres)
(kV)
III
IV
4
6
6
8
8
12
Fig. H2 : Peak value of impulse voltage according to normal service voltage of test specimen.
The degrees III and IV are degrees of pollution defined in IEC 60664-1
(1) the concurrent opening of all live conductors, while not
always obligatory, is however, strongly recommended (for
reasons of greater safety and facility of operation). The neutral
contact opens after the phase contacts, and closes before
them (IEC 60947-1).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Service (nominal
voltage
(V)
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
1 The basic functions of
LV switchgear
Switchgear-control functions allow system
operating personnel to modify a loaded system
at any moment, according to requirements,
and include:
b Functional control (routine switching, etc.)
b Emergency switching
b Maintenance operations on the power system
1.3 Switchgear control
In broad terms “control” signifies any facility for safely modifying a load-carrying
power system at all levels of an installation. The operation of switchgear is an
important part of power-system control.
Functional control
This control relates to all switching operations in normal service conditions for
energizing or de-energizing a part of a system or installation, or an individual piece
of equipment, item of plant, etc.
Switchgear intended for such duty must be installed at least:
b At the origin of any installation
b At the final load circuit or circuits (one switch may control several loads)
Marking (of the circuits being controlled) must be clear and unambiguous.
In order to provide the maximum flexibility and continuity of operation, particularly
where the switching device also constitutes the protection (e.g. a circuit-breaker or
switch-fuse) it is preferable to include a switch at each level of distribution, i.e. on
each outgoing way of all distribution and subdistribution boards.
The manœuvre may be:
b Either manual (by means of an operating lever on the switch) or
b Electric, by push-button on the switch or at a remote location (load-shedding and
reconnection, for example)
These switches operate instantaneously (i.e. with no deliberate delay), and those
that provide protection are invariably omni-polar(1).
H4
The main circuit-breaker for the entire installation, as well as any circuit-breakers
used for change-over (from one source to another) must be omni-polar units.
Emergency switching - emergency stop
An emergency switching is intended to de-energize a live circuit which is, or could
become, dangerous (electric shock or fire).
An emergency stop is intended to halt a movement which has become dangerous.
In the two cases:
b The emergency control device or its means of operation (local or at remote
location(s)) such as a large red mushroom-headed emergency-stop pushbutton must
be recognizable and readily accessible, in proximity to any position at which danger
could arise or be seen
b A single action must result in a complete switching-off of all live conductors (2) (3)
b A “break glass” emergency switching initiation device is authorized, but in
unmanned installations the re-energizing of the circuit can only be achieved by
means of a key held by an authorized person
It should be noted that in certain cases, an emergency system of braking, may
require that the auxiliary supply to the braking-system circuits be maintained until
final stoppage of the machinery.
Switching-off for mechanical maintenance work
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
This operation assures the stopping of a machine and its impossibility to be
inadvertently restarted while mechanical maintenance work is being carried out
on the driven machinery. The shutdown is generally carried out at the functional
switching device, with the use of a suitable safety lock and warning notice at the
switch mechanism.
(1) One break in each phase and (where appropriate) one
break in the neutral.
(2) Taking into account stalled motors.
(3) In a TN schema the PEN conductor must never be
opened, since it functions as a protective earthing wire as well
as the system neutral conductor.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
2 The switchgear
2.1 Elementary switching devices
Disconnector (or isolator) (see Fig. H5)
This switch is a manually-operated, lockable, two-position device (open/closed)
which provides safe isolation of a circuit when locked in the open position. Its
characteristics are defined in IEC 60947-3. A disconnector is not designed to make
or to break current(1) and no rated values for these functions are given in standards.
It must, however, be capable of withstanding the passage of short-circuit currents
and is assigned a rated short-time withstand capability, generally for 1 second,
unless otherwise agreed between user and manufacturer. This capability is normally
more than adequate for longer periods of (lower-valued) operational overcurrents,
such as those of motor-starting. Standardized mechanical-endurance, overvoltage,
and leakage-current tests, must also be satisfied.
Load-breaking switch (see Fig. H6)
This control switch is generally operated manually (but is sometimes provided with
electrical tripping for operator convenience) and is a non-automatic two-position
device (open/closed).
It is used to close and open loaded circuits under normal unfaulted circuit conditions.
It does not consequently, provide any protection for the circuit it controls.
IEC standard 60947-3 defines:
b The frequency of switch operation (600 close/open cycles per hour maximum)
b Mechanical and electrical endurance (generally less than that of a contactor)
b Current making and breaking ratings for normal and infrequent situations
When closing a switch to energize a circuit there is always the possibility that
an unsuspected short-circuit exists on the circuit. For this reason, load-break
switches are assigned a fault-current making rating, i.e. successful closure against
the electrodynamic forces of short-circuit current is assured. Such switches are
commonly referred to as “fault-make load-break” switches. Upstream protective
devices are relied upon to clear the short-circuit fault
H5
Category AC-23 includes occasional switching of individual motors. The switching
of capacitors or of tungsten filament lamps shall be subject to agreement between
manufacturer and user.
Fig. H5 : Symbol for a disconnector (or isolator)
The utilization categories referred to in Figure H7 do not apply to an equipment
normally used to start, accelerate and/or stop individual motors.
Example
A 100 A load-break switch of category AC-23 (inductive load) must be able:
b To make a current of 10 In (= 1,000 A) at a power factor of 0.35 lagging
b To break a current of 8 In (= 800 A) at a power factor of 0.45 lagging
b To withstand short duration short-circuit currents when closed
Fig. H6 : Symbol for a load-break switch
AC-21A
AC-21B
AC-22A
AC-22B
AC-23A
AC-23B
Typical applications
Connecting and disconnecting
under no-load conditions
Switching of resistive loads
including moderate overloads
Switching of mixed resistive
and inductive loads, including
moderate overloads
Switching of motor loads or
other highly inductive loads
Cos
Making
current x In
Breaking
current x In
-
-
-
0.95
1.5
1.5
0.65
3
3
0.45 for I y100 A 10
0.35 for I > 100 A
Fig. H7 : Utilization categories of LV AC switches according to IEC 60947-3
(1) i.e. a LV disconnector is essentially a dead system
switching device to be operated with no voltage on either side
of it, particularly when closing, because of the possibility of an
unsuspected short-circuit on the downstream side. Interlocking
with an upstream switch or circuit-breaker is frequently used.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
8
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Utilization category
Frequent
Infrequent
operations
operations
AC-20A
AC-20B
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Remote control switch (see Fig. H8)
This device is extensively used in the control of lighting circuits where the depression
of a pushbutton (at a remote control position) will open an already-closed switch or
close an opened switch in a bistable sequence.
Typical applications are:
b Two-way switching on stairways of large buildings
b Stage-lighting schemes
b Factory illumination, etc.
Auxiliary devices are available to provide:
b Remote indication of its state at any instant
b Time-delay functions
b Maintained-contact features
Contactor (see Fig. H9)
The contactor is a solenoid-operated switching device which is generally held
closed by (a reduced) current through the closing solenoid (although various
mechanically-latched types exist for specific duties). Contactors are designed to
carry out numerous close/open cycles and are commonly controlled remotely by
on-off pushbuttons. The large number of repetitive operating cycles is standardized in
table VIII of IEC 60947-4-1 by:
b The operating duration: 8 hours; uninterrupted; intermittent; temporary of 3, 10, 30,
60 and 90 minutes
b Utilization category: for example, a contactor of category AC3 can be used for the
starting and stopping of a cage motor
b The start-stop cycles (1 to 1,200 cyles per hour)
b Mechanical endurance (number of off-load manœuvres)
b Electrical endurance (number of on-load manœuvres)
b A rated current making and breaking performance according to the category of
utilization concerned
H6
Example:
A 150 A contactor of category AC3 must have a minimum current-breaking capability
of 8 In (= 1,200 A) and a minimum current-making rating of 10 In (= 1,500 A) at a
power factor (lagging) of 0.35.
Fig. H8 : Symbol for a bistable remote control switch
Discontactor(1)
Control
circuit
A contactor equipped with a thermal-type relay for protection against overloading
defines a “discontactor”. Discontactors are used extensively for remote push-button
control of lighting circuits, etc., and may also be considered as an essential element
in a motor controller, as noted in sub-clause 2.2. “combined switchgear elements”.
The discontactor is not the equivalent of a circuit-breaker, since its short-circuit
current breaking capability is limited to 8 or 10 In. For short-circuit protection
therefore, it is necessary to include either fuses or a circuit-breaker in series with,
and upstream of, the discontactor contacts.
Power
circuit
Fig. H9 : Symbol for a contactor
Two classes of LV cartridge fuse are very
widely used:
b For domestic and similar installations type gG
b For industrial installations type gG, gM or aM
Fuses (see Fig. H10)
The first letter indicates the breaking range:
b “g” fuse-links (full-range breaking-capacity fuse-link)
b “a” fuse-links (partial-range breaking-capacity fuse-link)
The second letter indicates the utilization category; this letter defines with accuracy
the time-current characteristics, conventional times and currents, gates.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For example
b “gG” indicates fuse-links with a full-range breaking capacity for general application
b “gM” indicates fuse-links with a full-range breaking capacity for the protection of
motor circuits
b “aM” indicates fuse-links with a partial range breaking capacity for the protection of
motor circuits
Fuses exist with and without “fuse-blown” mechanical indicators. Fuses break a
circuit by controlled melting of the fuse element when a current exceeds a given
value for a corresponding period of time; the current/time relationship being
presented in the form of a performance curve for each type of fuse. Standards define
two classes of fuse:
b Those intended for domestic installations, manufactured in the form of a cartridge
for rated currents up to 100 A and designated type gG in IEC 60269-1 and 3
b Those for industrial use, with cartridge types designated gG (general use); and gM
and aM (for motor-circuits) in IEC 60269-1 and 2
Fig. H10 : Symbol for fuses
(1) This term is not defined in IEC publications but is commonly
used in some countries.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The switchgear
The main differences between domestic and industrial fuses are the nominal
voltage and current levels (which require much larger physical dimensions) and
their fault-current breaking capabilities. Type gG fuse-links are often used for the
protection of motor circuits, which is possible when their characteristics are capable
of withstanding the motor-starting current without deterioration.
A more recent development has been the adoption by the IEC of a fuse-type gM for
motor protection, designed to cover starting, and short-circuit conditions. This type of
fuse is more popular in some countries than in others, but at the present time the
aM fuse in combination with a thermal overload relay is more-widely used.
A gM fuse-link, which has a dual rating is characterized by two current values. The
first value In denotes both the rated current of the fuse-link and the rated current of
the fuseholder; the second value Ich denotes the time-current characteristic of the
fuse-link as defined by the gates in Tables II, III and VI of IEC 60269-1.
These two ratings are separated by a letter which defines the applications.
For example: In M Ich denotes a fuse intended to be used for protection of
motor circuits and having the characteristic G. The first value In corresponds to
the maximum continuous current for the whole fuse and the second value Ich
corresponds to the G characteristic of the fuse link. For further details see note at the
end of sub-clause 2.1.
An aM fuse-link is characterized by one current value In and time-current
characteristic as shown in Figure H14 next page.
Important: Some national standards use a gI (industrial) type fuse, similar in all main
essentails to type gG fuses.
Type gI fuses should never be used, however, in domestic and similar installations.
gM fuses require a separate overload relay, as
described in the note at the end of this sub-clause
2.1.
H7
Fusing zones - conventional currents
The conditions of fusing (melting) of a fuse are defined by standards, according to
their class.
Class gG fuses
These fuses provide protection against overloads and short-circuits.
Conventional non-fusing and fusing currents are standardized, as shown in
Figure H12 and in Figure H13.
b The conventional non-fusing current Inf is the value of current that the fusible
element can carry for a specified time without melting.
Example: A 32 A fuse carrying a current of 1.25 In (i.e. 40 A) must not melt in less
than one hour (table H13)
b The conventional fusing current If (= I2 in Fig. H12) is the value of current which
will cause melting of the fusible element before the expiration of the specified time.
Example: A 32 A fuse carrying a current of 1.6 In (i.e. 52.1 A) must melt in one hour
or less
IEC 60269-1 standardized tests require that a fuse-operating characteristic lies
between the two limiting curves (shown in Figure H12) for the particular fuse under
test. This means that two fuses which satisfy the test can have significantly different
operating times at low levels of overloading.
t
Minimum
pre-arcing
time curve
1 hour
Rated current(1)
In (A)
In y 4 A
4 < In < 16 A
16 < In y 63 A
63 < In y 160 A
160 < In y 400 A
400 < In
Fuse-blow
curve
I
Conventional nonfusing current
Inf
Conventional
fusing current
I2
Conventional
time (h)
1.5 In
2.1 In
1
1.5 In
1.9 In
1
1.25 In
1.6 In
1
1.25 In
1.6 In
2
1.25 In
1.6 In
3
1.25 In
1.6 In
4
Fig. H12 : Zones of fusing and non-fusing for gG and gM fuses
Fig. H13 : Zones of fusing and non-fusing for LV types gG and gM class fuses (IEC 60269-1
and 60269-2-1)
(1) Ich for gM fuses
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Inf I2
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
b The two examples given above for a 32 A fuse, together with the foregoing notes
on standard test requirements, explain why these fuses have a poor performance in
the low overload range
b It is therefore necessary to install a cable larger in ampacity than that normally
required for a circuit, in order to avoid the consequences of possible long term
overloading (60% overload for up to one hour in the worst case)
By way of comparison, a circuit-breaker of similar current rating:
b Which passes 1.05 In must not trip in less than one hour; and
b When passing 1.25 In it must trip in one hour, or less (25% overload for up to one
hour in the worst case)
Class aM (motor) fuses
These fuses afford protection against short-circuit currents only and must necessarily
be associated with other switchgear (such as discontactors or circuit-breakers) in
order to ensure overload protection < 4 In. They are not therefore autonomous. Since
aM fuses are not intended to protect against low values of overload current, no levels
of conventional non-fusing and fusing currents are fixed. The characteristic curves for
testing these fuses are given for values of fault current exceeding approximately 4 In
(see Fig. H14), and fuses tested to IEC 60269 must give operating curves which fall
within the shaded area.
Class aM fuses protect against short-circuit
currents only, and must always be associated
with another device which protects against
overload
Note: the small “arrowheads” in the diagram indicate the current/time “gate” values
for the different fuses to be tested (IEC 60269).
Rated short-circuit breaking currents
A characteristic of modern cartridge fuses is that, owing to the rapidity of fusion
in the case of high short-circuit current levels(1), a current cut-off begins before
the occurrence of the first major peak, so that the fault current never reaches its
prospective peak value (see Fig. H15).
H8
This limitation of current reduces significantly the thermal and dynamic stresses
which would otherwise occur, thereby minimizing danger and damage at the fault
position. The rated short-circuit breaking current of the fuse is therefore based on the
rms value of the AC component of the prospective fault current.
t
No short-circuit current-making rating is assigned to fuses.
Minimum
pre-arcing
time curve
Reminder
Short-circuit currents initially contain DC components, the magnitude and duration of
which depend on the XL/R ratio of the fault current loop.
Fuse-blown
curve
Close to the source (MV/LV transformer) the relationship Ipeak / Irms (of
AC component) immediately following the instant of fault, can be as high as 2.5
(standardized by IEC, and shown in Figure H16 next page).
4 In
x In
Fig. H14 : Standardized zones of fusing for type aM fuses (all
current ratings)
I
Prospective
fault-current peak
rms value of the AC
component of the
prospective fault curent
Current peak
limited by the fuse
0.01 s
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Tf Ta
Ttc
t
0.005 s
0.02 s
Tf: Fuse pre-arc fusing time
Ta: Arcing time
Ttc: Total fault-clearance time
Fig. H15 : Current limitation by a fuse
At lower levels of distribution in an installation, as previously noted, XL is small
compared with R and so for final circuits Ipeak / Irms ~ 1.41, a condition which
corresponds with Figure H15.
The peak-current-limitation effect occurs only when the prospective rms
AC component of fault current attains a certain level. For example, in the Figure H16
graph, the 100 A fuse will begin to cut off the peak at a prospective fault current
(rms) of 2 kA (a). The same fuse for a condition of 20 kA rms prospective current
will limit the peak current to 10 kA (b). Without a current-limiting fuse the peak
current could attain 50 kA (c) in this particular case. As already mentioned, at lower
distribution levels in an installation, R greatly predominates XL, and fault levels are
generally low. This means that the level of fault current may not attain values high
enough to cause peak current limitation. On the other hand, the DC transients (in this
case) have an insignificant effect on the magnitude of the current peak, as previously
mentioned.
Note: On gM fuse ratings
A gM type fuse is essentially a gG fuse, the fusible element of which corresponds to
the current value Ich (ch = characteristic) which may be, for example, 63 A. This is
the IEC testing value, so that its time/ current characteristic is identical to that of a
63 A gG fuse.
This value (63 A) is selected to withstand the high starting currents of a motor, the
steady state operating current (In) of which may be in the 10-20 A range.
This means that a physically smaller fuse barrel and metallic parts can be used,
since the heat dissipation required in normal service is related to the lower figures
(10-20 A). A standard gM fuse, suitable for this situation would be designated 32M63
(i.e. In M Ich).
The first current rating In concerns the steady-load thermal performance of the
fuselink, while the second current rating (Ich) relates to its (short-time) startingcurrent performance. It is evident that, although suitable for short-circuit protection,
(1) For currents exceeding a certain level, depending on the
fuse nominal current rating, as shown below in Figure H16.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 The switchgear
Prospective fault
current (kA) peak
overload protection for the motor is not provided by the fuse, and so a separate
thermal-type relay is always necessary when using gM fuses. The only advantage
offered by gM fuses, therefore, when compared with aM fuses, are reduced physical
dimensions and slightly lower cost.
Maximum possible current
peak characteristic
i.e. 2.5 Irms (IEC)
100
20
(b)
10
Single units of switchgear do not, in general, fulfil all the requirements of the three
basic functions, viz: Protection, control and isolation.
160A
Nominal
100A fuse
50A ratings
Where the installation of a circuit-breaker is not appropriate (notably where the
switching rate is high, over extended periods) combinations of units specifically
designed for such a performance are employed. The most commonly-used
combinations are described below.
(a)
5
Peak current
cut-off
characteristic
curves
2
1
2.2 Combined switchgear elements
(c)
50
1
2
5
10 20
Switch and fuse combinations
50 100
AC component of prospective
fault current (kA) rms
Fig. H16 : Limited peak current versus prospective rms values
of the AC component of fault current for LV fuses
Two cases are distinguished:
b The type in which the operation of one (or more) fuse(s) causes the switch to open.
This is achieved by the use of fuses fitted with striker pins, and a system of switch
tripping springs and toggle mechanisms (see Fig. H17)
b The type in which a non-automatic switch is associated with a set of fuses in a
common enclosure.
In some countries, and in IEC 60947-3, the terms “switch-fuse” and “fuse-switch”
have specific meanings, viz:
v A switch-fuse comprises a switch (generally 2 breaks per pole) on the upstream
side of three fixed fuse-bases, into which the fuse carriers are inserted (see Fig. H18)
v A fuse-switch consists of three switch blades each constituting a double-break per
phase.
H9
These blades are not continuous throughout their length, but each has a gap in the
centre which is bridged by the fuse cartridge. Some designs have only a single break
per phase, as shown in Figure H19.
Fig. H17 : Symbol for an automatic tripping switch-fuse
Fig. H18 : Symbol for a non-automatic fuse-switch
Fig. H19 : Symbol for a non-automatic switch-fuse
The current range for these devices is limited to 100 A maximum at 400 V 3-phase,
while their principal use is in domestic and similar installations. To avoid confusion
between the first group (i.e. automatic tripping) and the second group, the term
“switch-fuse” should be qualified by the adjectives “automatic” or “non-automatic”.
Fig. H20 : Symbol for a fuse disconnector + discontactor
The fuse-disconnector must be interlocked with the discontactor such that no opening
or closing manœuvre of the fuse disconnector is possible unless the discontactor is
open ( Figure H20), since the fuse disconnector has no load-switching capability.
A fuse-switch-disconnector (evidently) requires no interlocking (Figure H21).
The switch must be of class AC22 or AC23 if the circuit supplies a motor.
Fig. H21 : Symbol for a fuse-switch disconnector + discontactor
Circuit-breaker + contactor
Circuit-breaker + discontactor
These combinations are used in remotely controlled distribution systems in which the
rate of switching is high, or for control and protection of a circuit supplying motors.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fuse – disconnector + discontactor
Fuse - switch-disconnector + discontactor
As previously mentioned, a discontactor does not provide protection against shortcircuit faults. It is necessary, therefore, to add fuses (generally of type aM) to perform
this function. The combination is used mainly for motor control circuits, where the
disconnector or switch-disconnector allows safe operations such as:
b The changing of fuse links (with the circuit isolated)
b Work on the circuit downstream of the discontactor (risk of remote closure of the
discontactor)
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
3 Choice of switchgear
3.1 Switchgear selection
Software is being used more and more in the field of optimal selection of switchgear.
Each circuit is considered one at a time, and a list is drawn up of the required
protection functions and exploitation of the installation, among those mentioned in
Figure H22 and summarized in Figure H1.
A number of switchgear combinations are studied and compared with each other
against relevant criteria, with the aim of achieving:
b Satisfactory performance
b Compatibility among the individual items; from the rated current In to the fault-level
rating Icu
b Compatibility with upstream switchgear or taking into account its contribution
b Conformity with all regulations and specifications concerning safe and reliable
circuit performance
In order to determine the number of poles for an item of switchgear, reference is
made to chapter G, clause 7 Fig. G64. Multifunction switchgear, initially more costly,
reduces installation costs and problems of installation or exploitation. It is often found
that such switchgear provides the best solution.
3.2 Tabulated functional capabilities of LV
switchgear
H10
After having studied the basic functions of LV switchgear (clause 1, Figure H1) and
the different components of switchgear (clause 2), Figure H22 summarizes the
capabilities of the various components to perform the basic functions.
Isolation
Switchgear
item
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Isolator (or
disconnector)(4)
Switch(5)
Residual
device
(RCCB)(5)
Switchdisconnector
Contactor
Remote control
switch
Fuse
Circuit
breaker
Circuit-breaker
disconnector(5)
Residual
and overcurrent
circuit-breaker
(RCBO)(5)
Point of
installation
(general
principle)
Control
Functional
Emergency
switching
Emergency
stop
(mechanical)
Switching for
mechanical
maintenance
Electrical protection
Overload
Short-circuit
Electric
shock
b
b
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b
b
b (1)
b (1) (2)
b
b
b
b
Origin of each
circuit
All points where,
for operational
reasons it may
be necessary
to stop the
process
In general at the
incoming circuit
to every
distribution
board
At the supply
point to each
machine
and/or on the
machine
concerned
At the supply
point to each
machine
Origin of each
circuit
Origin of each
circuit
Origin of circuits
where the
earthing system
is appropriate
TN-S, IT, TT
b
b
b (3)
(1) Where cut-off of all active conductors is provided
(2) It may be necessary to maintain supply to a braking system
(3) If it is associated with a thermal relay (the combination is commonly referred to as a “discontactor”)
(4) In certain countries a disconnector with visible contacts is mandatory at the origin of a LV installation supplied directly from a MV/LV transformer
(5) Certain items of switchgear are suitable for isolation duties (e.g. RCCBs according to IEC 61008) without being explicitly marked as such
Fig. H22 : Functions fulfilled by different items of switchgear
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
4 Circuit-breaker
The circuit-breaker/disconnector fulfills all of the
basic switchgear functions, while, by means of
accessories, numerous other possibilities exist
As shown in Figure H23 the circuit-breaker/ disconnector is the only item of
switchgear capable of simultaneously satisfying all the basic functions necessary in
an electrical installation.
Moreover, it can, by means of auxiliary units, provide a wide range of other functions,
for example: indication (on-off - tripped on fault); undervoltage tripping; remote
control… etc. These features make a circuit-breaker/ disconnector the basic unit of
switchgear for any electrical installation.
Functions
Isolation
Control
Protection
Functional
Emergency switching
Switching-off for mechanical
maintenance
Overload
Short-circuit
Insulation fault
Undervoltage
Remote control
Indication and measurement
Possible conditions
b
b
b (With the possibility of a tripping
coil for remote control)
b
b
b
b (With differential-current relay)
b (With undervoltage-trip coil)
b Added or incorporated
b (Generally optional with an
electronic tripping device)
H11
Fig. H23 : Functions performed by a circuit-breaker/disconnector
Power circuit terminals
Contacts and arc-diving
chamber
Fool-proof mechanical
indicator
Latching mechanism
Trip mechanism and
protective devices
Fig. H24 : Main parts of a circuit-breaker
4.1 Standards and description
Standards
For industrial LV installations the relevant IEC standards are, or are due to be:
b 60947-1: general rules
b 60947-2: part 2: circuit-breakers
b 60947-3: part 3: switches, disconnectors, switch-disconnectors and fuse
combination units
b 60947-4: part 4: contactors and motor starters
b 60947-5: part 5: control-circuit devices and switching elements
b 60947-6: part 6: multiple function switching devices
b 60947-7: part 7: ancillary equipment
b 60947-8: Part 8: Control units for built-in thermal protection (PTC) for rotating
electrical machines.
For domestic and similar LV installations, the appropriate standard is IEC 60898, or
an equivalent national standard.
Description
Figure H24 shows schematically the main parts of a LV circuit-breaker and its four
essential functions:
b The circuit-breaking components, comprising the fixed and moving contacts and
the arc-dividing chamber
b The latching mechanism which becomes unlatched by the tripping device on
detection of abnormal current conditions
This mechanism is also linked to the operation handle of the breaker.
b A trip-mechanism actuating device:
v Either: a thermal-magnetic device, in which a thermally-operated bi-metal strip
detects an overload condition, while an electromagnetic striker pin operates at
current levels reached in short-circuit conditions, or
v An electronic relay operated from current transformers, one of which is installed on
each phase
b A space allocated to the several types of terminal currently used for the main
power circuit conductors
Domestic circuit-breakers (see Fig. H25 next page) complying with IEC 60898 and
similar national standards perform the basic functions of:
b Isolation
b Protection against overcurrent
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Industrial circuit-breakers must comply with
IEC 60947-1 and 60947-2 or other equivalent
standards.
Domestic-type circuit-breakers must comply with
IEC standard 60898, or an equivalent national
standard
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Some models can be adapted to provide sensitive detection (30 mA) of earthleakage current with CB tripping, by the addition of a modular block, while other
models (RCBOs, complying with IEC 61009 and CBRs complying with IEC 60947-2
Annex B) have this residual current feature incorporated as shown in Figure H26.
Apart from the above-mentioned functions further features can be associated with
the basic circuit-breaker by means of additional modules, as shown in Figure H27;
notably remote control and indication (on-off-fault).
1
2
3
4
5
O--OFF
Fig. H25 : Domestic-type circuit-breaker providing overcurrent
protection and circuit isolation features
O--OFF
O-OFF
H12
Fig. H27 : “Acti 9” system of LV modular switchgear components
Moulded-case circuit-breakers complying with IEC 60947-2 are available from 100
to 630 A and provide a similar range of auxiliary functions to those described above
(see Figure H28).
Air circuit-breakers of large current ratings, complying with IEC 60947-2, are
generally used in the main switch board and provide protector for currents from
630 A to 6300 A, typically.(see Figure H29).
In addition to the protection functions, the Micrologic unit provides optimized
functions such as measurement (including power quality functions), diagnosis,
communication, control and monitoring.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H26 : Domestic-type circuit-breaker as above (Fig. H25)
with incorparated protection against electric shocks
Fig. H28 : Example of a Compact NSX industrial type of circuitbreaker capable of numerous auxiliary functions
Fig. H29 : Example of air circuit-breakers. Masterpact provides many control features in its
“Micrologic” tripping unit
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
4.2 Fundamental characteristics of a circuit-breaker
The fundamental characteristics of a circuit-breaker are:
b Its rated voltage Ue
b Its rated current In
b Its tripping-current-level adjustment ranges for overload protection (Ir(1) or Irth(1))
and for short-circuit protection (Im)(1)
b Its short-circuit current breaking rating (Icu for industrial CBs; Icn for domestictype CBs).
Rated operational voltage (Ue)
This is the voltage at which the circuit-breaker has been designed to operate, in
normal (undisturbed) conditions.
Other values of voltage are also assigned to the circuit-breaker, corresponding to
disturbed conditions, as noted in sub-clause 4.3.
Rated current (In)
This is the maximum value of current that a circuit-breaker, fitted with a specified
overcurrent tripping relay, can carry indefinitely at an ambient temperature stated by
the manufacturer, without exceeding the specified temperature limits of the current
carrying parts.
Example
A circuit-breaker rated at In = 125 A for an ambient temperature of 40 °C will be
equipped with a suitably calibrated overcurrent tripping relay (set at 125 A). The
same circuit-breaker can be used at higher values of ambient temperature however,
if suitably “derated”. Thus, the circuit-breaker in an ambient temperature of 50 °C
could carry only 117 A indefinitely, or again, only 109 A at 60 °C, while complying
with the specified temperature limit.
H13
Derating a circuit-breaker is achieved therefore, by reducing the trip-current setting
of its overload relay, and marking the CB accordingly. The use of an electronic-type
of tripping unit, designed to withstand high temperatures, allows circuit-breakers
(derated as described) to operate at 60 °C (or even at 70 °C) ambient.
Note: In for circuit-breakers (in IEC 60947-2) is equal to Iu for switchgear generally,
Iu being the rated uninterrupted current.
Frame-size rating
A circuit-breaker which can be fitted with overcurrent tripping units of different current
level-setting ranges, is assigned a rating which corresponds to the highest currentlevel-setting tripping unit that can be fitted.
Example
A Compact NSX630N circuit-breaker can be equipped with 11 electronic trip units
from 150 A to 630 A. The size of the circuit-breaker is 630 A.
Overload relay trip-current setting (Irth or Ir)
Rated current of
the tripping unit
In
Adjustment
range
160 A
360 A
The thermal-trip relays are generally adjustable from 0.7 to 1.0 times In, but when
electronic devices are used for this duty, the adjustment range is greater; typically 0.4
to 1 times In.
Circuit breaker
frame-size rating
Overload trip
current setting
Ir
400 A
Example (see Fig. H30)
A NSX630N circuit-breaker equipped with a 400 A Micrologic 6.3E overcurrent trip
relay, set at 0.9, will have a trip-current setting:
630 A
Fig. H30 : Example of a NSX630N circuit-breaker equipped with
a Micrologic 6.3E trip unit adjusted to 0.9, to give Ir = 360 A
Ir = 400 x 0.9 = 360 A
Note: For circuit-breakers equipped with non-adjustable overcurrent-trip relays,
Ir = In. Example: for iC60N 20 A circuit-breaker, Ir = In = 20 A.
(1) Current-level setting values which refer to the currentoperated thermal and “instantaneous” magnetic tripping
devices for over-load and short-circuit protection.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
0.4 In
Apart from small circuit-breakers which are very easily replaced, industrial circuitbreakers are equipped with removable, i.e. exchangeable, overcurrent-trip relays.
Moreover, in order to adapt a circuit-breaker to the requirements of the circuit
it controls, and to avoid the need to install over-sized cables, the trip relays are
generally adjustable. The trip-current setting Ir or Irth (both designations are
in common use) is the current above which the circuit-breaker will trip. It also
represents the maximum current that the circuit-breaker can carry without tripping.
That value must be greater than the maximum load current IB, but less than the
maximum current permitted in the circuit Iz (see chapter G, sub-clause 1.3).
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Short-circuit relay trip-current setting (Im)
Short-circuit tripping relays (instantaneous or slightly time-delayed) are intended to
trip the circuit-breaker rapidly on the occurrence of high values of fault current. Their
tripping threshold Im is:
b Either fixed by standards for domestic type CBs, e.g. IEC 60898, or,
b Indicated by the manufacturer for industrial type CBs according to related
standards, notably IEC 60947-2.
For the latter circuit-breakers there exists a wide variety of tripping devices which
allow a user to adapt the protective performance of the circuit-breaker to the
particular requirements of a load (see Fig. H31, Fig. H32 and Fig. H33).
H14
Type of
protective
relay
Overload
protection
Short-circuit protection
Domestic
breakers
IEC 60898
Thermalmagnetic
Ir = In
Low setting
type B
3 In y Im y 5 In
Standard setting
type C
5 In y Im y 10 In
High setting circuit
type D
10 In y Im y 20 In(1)
Modular
industrial(2)
circuit-breakers
Thermalmagnetic
Ir = In
fixed
Low setting
type B or Z
3.2 In y fixed y 4.8 In
Standard setting
type C
7 In y fixed y 10 In
High setting
type D or K
10 In y fixed y 14 In
Industrial(2)
circuit-breakers
IEC 60947-2
Thermalmagnetic
Ir = In fixed
Adjustable:
0.7 In y Ir y In
Electronic
Long delay
0.4 In y Ir y In
Fixed: Im = 7 to 10 In
Adjustable:
- Low setting : 2 to 5 In
- Standard setting: 5 to 10 In
Short-delay, adjustable
1.5 Ir y Im y 10 Ir
Instantaneous (I) fixed
I = 12 to 15 In
(1) 50 In in IEC 60898, which is considered to be unrealistically high by most European manufacturers (Schneider Electric = 10 to 14 In).
(2) For industrial use, IEC standards do not specify values. The above values are given only as being those in common use.
Fig. H31 : Tripping-current ranges of overload and short-circuit protective devices for LV circuit-breakers
t (s )
t (s )
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Ir
Ir
I(A
Im
Icu
Fig. H32 : Performance curve of a circuit-breaker thermalmagnetic protective scheme
Im
I(A
Ii
Icu
Ir: Overload (thermal or long-delay) relay trip-current
setting
Im: Short-circuit (magnetic or short-delay) relay tripcurrent setting
Ii: Short-circuit instantaneous relay trip-current setting.
Icu: Breaking capacity
Fig. H33 : Performance curve of a circuit-breaker electronic protective scheme
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
Isolating feature
A circuit-breaker is suitable for isolating a circuit if it fulfills all the conditions
prescribed for a disconnector (at its rated voltage) in the relevant standard (see
sub-clause 1.2). In such a case it is referred to as a circuit-breaker-disconnector and
marked on its front face with the symbol
All Acti 9, Compact NSX and Masterpact LV switchgear of Schneider Electric ranges
are in this category.
The short-circuit current-breaking performance
of a LV circuit-breaker is related (approximately)
to the cos of the fault-current loop. Standard
values for this relationship have been
established in some standards
Rated short-circuit breaking capacity (Icu or Icn)
The short-circuit current-breaking rating of a CB is the highest (prospective) value
of current that the CB is capable of breaking without being damaged. The value
of current quoted in the standards is the rms value of the AC component of the
fault current, i.e. the DC transient component (which is always present in the worst
possible case of short-circuit) is assumed to be zero for calculating the standardized
value. This rated value (Icu) for industrial CBs and (Icn) for domestic-type CBs is
normally given in kA rms.
Icu (rated ultimate s.c. breaking capacity) and Ics (rated service s.c. breaking
capacity) are defined in IEC 60947-2 together with a table relating Ics with Icu for
different categories of utilization A (instantaneous tripping) and B (time-delayed
tripping) as discussed in subclause 4.3.
Tests for proving the rated s.c. breaking capacities of CBs are governed by
standards, and include:
b Operating sequences, comprising a succession of operations, i.e. closing and
opening on short-circuit
b Current and voltage phase displacement. When the current is in phase with the
supply voltage (cos for the circuit = 1), interruption of the current is easier than
that at any other power factor. Breaking a current at low lagging values of cos is
considerably more difficult to achieve; a zero power-factor circuit being (theoretically)
the most onerous case.
H15
In practice, all power-system short-circuit fault currents are (more or less) at lagging
power factors, and standards are based on values commonly considered to be
representative of the majority of power systems. In general, the greater the level of
fault current (at a given voltage), the lower the power factor of the fault-current loop,
for example, close to generators or large transformers.
Figure H34 below extracted from IEC 60947-2 relates standardized values of cos
to industrial circuit-breakers according to their rated Icu.
b Following an open - time delay - close/open sequence to test the Icu capacity of a
CB, further tests are made to ensure that:
v The dielectric withstand capability
v The disconnection (isolation) performance and
v The correct operation of the overload protection
have not been impaired by the test.
Icu
cos
6 kA < Icu y 10 kA
0.5
10 kA < Icu y 20 kA
0.3
20 kA < Icu y 50 kA
0.25
50 kA < Icu
0.2
Fig. H34 : Icu related to power factor (cos ) of fault-current circuit (IEC 60947-2)
4.3 Other characteristics of a circuit-breaker
Rated insulation voltage (Ui)
This is the value of voltage to which the dielectric tests voltage (generally greater
than 2 Ui) and creepage distances are referred to.
The maximum value of rated operational voltage must never exceed that of the rated
insulation voltage, i.e. Ue y Ui.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Familiarity with the following characteristics of
LV circuit-breakers is often necessary when
making a final choice.
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Rated impulse-withstand voltage (Uimp)
This characteristic expresses, in kV peak (of a prescribed form and polarity) the value
of voltage which the equipment is capable of withstanding without failure, under test
conditions.
Generally, for industrial circuit-breakers, Uimp = 8 kV and for domestic types,
Uimp = 6 kV.
t (s)
Category (A or B) and rated short-time withstand current (Icw)
As already briefly mentioned (sub-clause 4.2) there are two categories of
LV industrial switchgear, A and B, according to IEC 60947-2:
b Those of category A, for which there is no deliberate delay in the operation of the
“instantaneous” short-circuit magnetic tripping device (see Fig. H35), are generally
moulded-case type circuit-breakers, and
b Those of category B for which, in order to discriminate with other circuit-breakers
on a time basis, it is possible to delay the tripping of the CB, where the fault-current
level is lower than that of the short-time withstand current rating (Icw) of the CB
(see Fig. H36). This is generally applied to large open-type circuit-breakers and
to certain heavy-duty moulded-case types. Icw is the maximum current that the B
category CB can withstand, thermally and electrodynamically, without sustaining
damage, for a period of time given by the manufacturer.
I(A)
Im
Rated making capacity (Icm)
Fig. H35 : Category A circuit-breaker
Icm is the highest instantaneous value of current that the circuit-breaker can
establish at rated voltage in specified conditions. In AC systems this instantaneous
peak value is related to Icu (i.e. to the rated breaking current) by the factor k, which
depends on the power factor (cos ) of the short-circuit current loop (as shown in
Figure H37 ).
H16
t (s )
Icu
cos
Icm = kIcu
6 kA < Icu y 10 kA
0.5
1.7 x Icu
10 kA < Icu y 20 kA
0.3
2 x Icu
20 kA < Icu y 50 kA
0.25
2.1 x Icu
50 kA y Icu
0.2
2.2 x Icu
Fig. H37 : Relation between rated breaking capacity Icu and rated making capacity Icm at
different power-factor values of short-circuit current, as standardized in IEC 60947-2
I(A )
Im
I
Icw
Icu
Example: A Masterpact NW08H2 circuit-breaker has a rated breaking capacity
Icu of 100 kA. The peak value of its rated making capacity Icm will be
Fig. H36 : Category B circuit-breaker
100 x 2.2 = 220 kA.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In a correctly designed installation, a circuitbreaker is never required to operate at its
maximum breaking current Icu. For this reason
a new characteristic Ics has been introduced.
It is expressed in IEC 60947-2 as a percentage
of Icu (25, 50, 75, 100%)
Rated service short-circuit breaking capacity (Ics)
The rated breaking capacity (Icu) or (Icn) is the maximum fault-current a circuitbreaker can successfully interrupt without being damaged. The probability of such
a current occurring is extremely low, and in normal circumstances the fault-currents
are considerably less than the rated breaking capacity (Icu) of the CB. On the other
hand it is important that high currents (of low probability) be interrupted under good
conditions, so that the CB is immediately available for reclosure, after the faulty
circuit has been repaired. It is for these reasons that a new characteristic (Ics) has
been created, expressed as a percentage of Icu, viz: 25, 50, 75, 100% for industrial
circuit-breakers. The standard test sequence is as follows:
b O - CO - CO(1) (at Ics)
b Tests carried out following this sequence are intended to verify that the CB is in a
good state and available for normal service
For domestic CBs, Ics = k Icn. The factor k values are given in IEC 60898 table XIV.
In Europe it is the industrial practice to use a k factor of 100% so that Ics = Icu.
(1) O represents an opening operation.
CO represents a closing operation followed by an opening
operation.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
Many designs of LV circuit-breakers feature
a short-circuit current limitation capability,
whereby the current is reduced and prevented
from reaching its (otherwise) maximum peak
value (see Fig. H38). The current-limitation
performance of these CBs is presented in
the form of graphs, typified by that shown in
Figure H39, diagram (a)
Fault-current limitation
The fault-current limitation capacity of a CB concerns its ability, more or less
effective, in preventing the passage of the maximum prospective fault-current,
permitting only a limited amount of current to flow, as shown in Figure H38.
The current-limitation performance is given by the CB manufacturer in the form of
curves (see Fig. H39).
b Diagram (a) shows the limited peak value of current plotted against the rms
value of the AC component of the prospective fault current (“prospective” faultcurrent refers to the fault-current which would flow if the CB had no current-limiting
capability)
b Limitation of the current greatly reduces the thermal stresses (proportional I2t) and
this is shown by the curve of diagram (b) of Figure H39, again, versus the rms value
of the AC component of the prospective fault current.
LV circuit-breakers for domestic and similar installations are classified in certain
standards (notably European Standard EN 60 898). CBs belonging to one class (of
current limiters) have standardized limiting I2t let-through characteristics defined by
that class.
In these cases, manufacturers do not normally provide characteristic performance
curves.
a)
b)
Limited
current
peak
(kA)
22
Limited
current peak
(A2 x s)
t
n
rre
cu s
c
d
i
ite ist
m r
-li acte
n
o r
N ha
c
H17
4,5.105
2.105
Prospective AC
component (rms)
Prospective AC
component (rms)
150 kA
150 kA
Fig. H39 : Performance curves of a typical LV current-limiting circuit-breaker
Current limitation reduces both thermal and
electrodynamic stresses on all circuit elements
through which the current passes, thereby
prolonging the useful life of these elements.
Furthermore, the limitation feature allows
“cascading” techniques to be used (see 4.5)
thereby significantly reducing design and
installation costs
The advantages of current limitation
The use of current-limiting CBs affords numerous advantages:
b Better conservation of installation networks: current-limiting CBs strongly attenuate
all harmful effects associated with short-circuit currents
b Reduction of thermal effects: Conductors (and therefore insulation) heating is
significantly reduced, so that the life of cables is correspondingly increased
b Reduction of mechanical effects: forces due to electromagnetic repulsion are lower,
with less risk of deformation and possible rupture, excessive burning of contacts, etc.
b Reduction of electromagnetic-interference effects:
v Less influence on measuring instruments and associated circuits,
telecommunication systems, etc.
Icc
Prospectice
fault-current peak
Limited
current peak
Example
On a system having a prospective shortcircuit current of 150 kA rms, a Compact L
circuit-breaker limits the peak current to less than 10% of the calculated prospective
peak value, and the thermal effects to less than 1% of those calculated.
Prospectice
fault-current
Limited
current
tc
Fig. H38 : Prospective and actual currents
t
Cascading of the several levels of distribution in an installation, downstream of a
limiting CB, will also result in important savings.
The technique of cascading, described in sub-clause 4.5 allows, in fact, substantial
savings on switchgear (lower performance permissible downstream of the limiting
CB(s)) enclosures, and design studies, of up to 20% (overall).
Discriminative protection schemes and cascading are compatible, in the Compact
NSX range, up to the full short-circuit breaking capacity of the switchgear.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These circuit-breakers therefore contribute towards an improved exploitation of:
b Cables and wiring
b Prefabricated cable-trunking systems
b Switchgear, thereby reducing the ageing of the installation
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
The choice of a range of circuit-breakers is
determined by: the electrical characteristics of
the installation, the environment, the loads and
a need for remote control, together with the type
of telecommunications system envisaged
Ambient
temperature
Temperature of air
surrouding the
circuit breakers
Ambient
temperature
4.4 Selection of a circuit-breaker
Choice of a circuit-breaker
The choice of a CB is made in terms of:
b Electrical characteristics of the installation for which the CB is intended
b Its eventual environment: ambient temperature, in a kiosk or switchboard
enclosure, climatic conditions, etc.
b Short-circuit current breaking and making requirements
b Operational specifications: discriminative tripping, requirements (or not) for
remote control and indication and related auxiliary contacts, auxiliary tripping coils,
connection
b Installation regulations; in particular: protection of persons
b Load characteristics, such as motors, fluorescent lighting, LV/LV transformers
The following notes relate to the choice LV circuit-breaker for use in distribution
systems.
Choice of rated current in terms of ambient temperature
Single CB
in free air
Circuit breakers installed
in an enclosure
Fig. H40 : Ambient temperature
The rated current of a circuit-breaker is defined for operation at a given ambient
temperature, in general:
b 30 C for domestic-type CBs
b 40 C for industrial-type CBs
Performance of these CBs in a different ambient temperature depends mainly on the
technology of their tripping units (see Fig. H40).
H18
Circuit-breakers with uncompensated thermal
tripping units have a trip current level that
depends on the surrounding temperature
Uncompensated thermal magnetic tripping units
Circuit-breakers with uncompensated thermal tripping elements have a trippingcurrent level that depends on the surrounding temperature. If the CB is installed
in an enclosure, or in a hot location (boiler room, etc.), the current required to trip
the CB on overload will be sensibly reduced. When the temperature in which the
CB is located exceeds its reference temperature, it will therefore be “derated”. For
this reason, CB manufacturers provide tables which indicate factors to apply at
temperatures different to the CB reference temperature. It may be noted from typical
examples of such tables (see Fig. H41) that a lower temperature than the reference
value produces an up-rating of the CB. Moreover, small modular-type CBs mounted
in juxtaposition, as shown typically in Figure H27, are usually mounted in a small
closed metal case. In this situation, mutual heating, when passing normal load
currents, generally requires them to be derated by a factor of 0.8.
Example
What rating (In) should be selected for a iC60N?
b Protecting a circuit, the maximum load current of which is estimated to be 34 A
b Installed side-by-side with other CBs in a closed distribution box
b In an ambient temperature of 50 C
A iC60N circuit-breaker rated at 40 A would be derated to 35.6 A in ambient air at
50 C (see Fig. H41). To allow for mutual heating in the enclosed space, however, the
0.8 factor noted above must be employed, so that, 35.6 x 0.8 = 28.5 A, which is not
suitable for the 34 A load.
A 50 A circuit-breaker would therefore be selected, giving a (derated) current rating
of 44 x 0.8 = 35.2 A.
Compensated thermal-magnetic tripping units
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These tripping units include a bi-metal compensating strip which allows the overload
trip-current setting (Ir or Irth) to be adjusted, within a specified range, irrespective of
the ambient temperature.
For example:
b In certain countries, the TT system is standard on LV distribution systems, and
domestic (and similar) installations are protected at the service position by a circuitbreaker provided by the supply authority. This CB, besides affording protection
against indirect-contact hazard, will trip on overload; in this case, if the consumer
exceeds the current level stated in his supply contract with the power authority. The
circuit-breaker (y 60 A) is compensated for a temperature range of - 5 C to + 40 C.
b LV circuit-breakers at ratings y 630 A are commonly equipped with compensated
tripping units for this range (- 5 C to + 40 C)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
iC60a, iC60H: curve C. iC60N: curves B and C (reference temperature: 30 °C)
Rating (A) 20 °C
25 °C
30 °C
35 °C
40 °C
45 °C
50 °C 55 °C
1
1.05
1.02
1.00
0.98
0.95
0.93
0.90
0.88
2
2.08
2.04
2.00
1.96
1.92
1.88
1.84
1.80
3
3.18
3.09
3.00
2.91
2.82
2.70
2.61
2.49
4
4.24
4.12
4.00
3.88
3.76
3.64
3.52
3.36
6
6.24
6.12
6.00
5.88
5.76
5.64
5.52
5.40
10
10.6
10.3
10.0
9.70
9.30
9.00
8.60
8.20
16
16.8
16.5
16.0
15.5
15.2
14.7
14.2
13.8
20
21.0
20.6
20.0
19.4
19.0
18.4
17.8
17.4
25
26.2
25.7
25.0
24.2
23.7
23.0
22.2
21.5
32
33.5
32.9
32.0
31.4
30.4
29.8
28.4
28.2
40
42.0
41.2
40.0
38.8
38.0
36.8
35.6
34.4
50
52.5
51.5
50.0
48.5
47.4
45.5
44.0
42.5
63
66.2
64.9
63.0
61.1
58.0
56.7
54.2
51.7
Compact NSX100-250 equippment with TM-D or TM-G trip units
Rating
Temperature (°C)
(A)
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
16
18.4 18.7 18
18
17
16.6 16
15.6 15.2
25
28.8 28
27.5 25
26.3 25.6 25
24.5 24
32
36.8 36
35.2 34.4 33.6 32.8 32
31.3 30.5
40
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
50
57.5 56
55
54
52.5 51
50
49
48
63
72
71
69
68
66
65
63
61.5 60
80
92
90
88
86
84
82
80
78
76
100
115 113 110 108 105 103 100 97.5 95
125
144 141 138 134 131 128 125 122 119
160
184 180 176 172 168 164 160 156 152
200
230 225 220 215 210 205 200 195 190
250
288 281 277 269 263 256 250 244 238
55
14.8
23.5
30
37
47
58
74
92.5
116
148
185
231
60
14.5
23
29.5
36
46
57
72
90
113
144
180
225
60 °C
0.85
1.74
2.37
3.24
5.30
7.80
13.5
16.8
20.7
27.5
33.2
40.5
49.2
65
14
22
29
35
45
55
70
87.5
109
140
175
219
70
13.8
21
28.5
34
44
54
68
85
106
136
170
213
H19
Fig. H41 : Examples of tables for the determination of derating/uprating factors to apply to CBs
with uncompensated thermal tripping units, according to temperature
Electronic trip units
An important advantage with electronic tripping units is their stable performance
in changing temperature conditions. However, the switchgear itself often imposes
operational limits in elevated temperatures, so that manufacturers generally provide
an operating chart relating the maximum values of permissible trip-current levels to
the ambient temperature (see Fig. H42).
Moreover, electronic trip units can provide information that can be used for a better
management of the electrical distribution, including energy efficiency and power
quality.
Masterpact NW20 version
H1/H2/H3
L1
Withdrawable with
horizontal plugs
Withdrawable with
on-edge plugs
40°C
45°C
50°C
55°C
60°C
In (A)
2,000
1
2,000
1
2,000
1
1,980
0.99
1,890
0.95
In (A)
Maximum
adjustment Ir
2,000
1
200
1
1,900
0.95
1,850
0.93
1,800
0.90
Maximum
adjustment Ir
Coeff. In (A)
1 2,000
NW20 withdrawable with
horizontal plugs
0.95 1,890
NW20 L1 withdrawable
with on edge plugs
0.90 1,800
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
θ°C
Fig. H42 : Derating of Masterpact NW20 circuit-breaker, according to the temperature
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Electronic tripping units are highly stable in
changing temperature levels
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Selection of an instantaneous, or short-time-delay, tripping
threshold
Figure H43 below summarizes the main characteristics of the instantaneous or
short-time delay trip units.
Type
t
Tripping unit
Low setting
type B
Applications
b Sources producing low short-circuitcurrent levels
(standby generators)
b Long lengths of line or cable
Standard setting
type C
b Protection of circuits: general case
High setting
type D or K
b Protection of circuits having high initial
transient current levels
(e.g. motors, transformers, resistive loads)
12 In
type MA
b Protection of motors in association with
discontactors
(contactors with overload protection)
I
t
I
t
H20
I
t
I
Fig. H43 : Different tripping units, instantaneous or short-time-delayed
The installation of a LV circuit-breaker requires
that its short-circuit breaking capacity (or that of
the CB together with an associated device) be
equal to or exceeds the calculated prospective
short-circuit current at its point of installation
Selection of a circuit-breaker according to the short-circuit
breaking capacity requirements
The installation of a circuit-breaker in a LV installation must fulfil one of the two
following conditions:
b Either have a rated short-circuit breaking capacity Icu (or Icn) which is equal to or
exceeds the prospective short-circuit current calculated for its point of installation, or
b If this is not the case, be associated with another device which is located
upstream, and which has the required short-circuit breaking capacity
In the second case, the characteristics of the two devices must be co-ordinated
such that the energy permitted to pass through the upstream device must not
exceed that which the downstream device and all associated cables, wires and other
components can withstand, without being damaged in any way. This technique is
profitably employed in:
b Associations of fuses and circuit-breakers
b Associations of current-limiting circuit-breakers and standard circuit-breakers.
The technique is known as “cascading” (see sub-clause 4.5 of this chapter)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The circuit-breaker at the output of the smallest
transformer must have a short-circuit capacity
adequate for a fault current which is higher
than that through any of the other transformer
LV circuit-breakers
The selection of main and principal circuit-breakers
A single transformer
If the transformer is located in a consumer’s substation, certain national standards
require a LV circuit-breaker in which the open contacts are clearly visible such as
Compact NSX withdrawable circuit-breaker.
Example (see Fig. H44 opposite page)
What type of circuit-breaker is suitable for the main circuit-breaker of an installation
supplied through a 250 kVA MV/LV (400 V) 3-phase transformer in a consumer’s
substation?
In transformer = 360 A
Isc (3-phase) = 8.9 kA
A Compact NSX400N with an adjustable tripping-unit range of 160 A - 400 A and a
short-circuit breaking capacity (Icu) of 50 kA would be a suitable choice for this duty.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
Several transformers in parallel (see Fig. H45)
b The circuit-breakers CBP outgoing from the LV distribution board must each be
capable of breaking the total fault current from all transformers connected to the
busbars, viz: Isc1 + Isc2 + Isc3
b The circuit-breakers CBM, each controlling the output of a transformer, must be
capable of dealing with a maximum short-circuit current of (for example) Isc2 + Isc3
only, for a short-circuit located on the upstream side of CBM1.
From these considerations, it will be seen that the circuit-breaker of the smallest
transformer will be subjected to the highest level of fault current in these
circumstances, while the circuit-breaker of the largest transformer will pass the
lowest level of short-circuit current
b The ratings of CBMs must be chosen according to the kVA ratings of the
associated transformers
Note: The essential conditions for the successful operation of 3-phase transformers
in parallel may be summarized as follows:
1. the phase shift of the voltages, primary to secondary, must be the same in all units
to be paralleled.
2. the open-circuit voltage ratios, primary to secondary, must be the same in all units.
3. the short-circuit impedance voltage (Zsc%) must be the same for all units.
For example, a 750 kVA transformer with a Zsc = 6% will share the load correctly
with a 1,000 kVA transformer having a Zsc of 6%, i.e. the transformers will be loaded
automatically in proportion to their kVA ratings. For transformers having a ratio of kVA
ratings exceeding 2, parallel operation is not recommended.
250 kVA
20 kV/400 V
Compact
NSX400N
Fig. H44 : Example of a transformer in a consumer’s substation
CBM
B2
B1
CBP
A3
CBM
B3
CBP
E
Fig. H45 : Transformers in parallel
Number and kVA ratings Minimum S.C breaking
of 20/0.4 kV transformers capacity of main CBs
(Icu) kA
2 x 400
14
3 x 400
28
2 x 630
22
3 x 630
44
2 x 800
19
3 x 800
38
2 x 1,000
23
3 x 1,000
47
2 x 1,250
29
3 x 1,250
59
2 x 1,600
38
3 x 1,600
75
2 x 2,000
47
3 x 2,000
94
Main circuit-breakers (CBM)
total discrimination with out
going circuit-breakers (CBP)
NW08N1/NS800N
NW08N1/NS800N
NW10N1/NS1000N
NW10N1/NS1000N
NW12N1/NS1250N
NW12N1/NS1250N
NW16N1/NS1600N
NW16N1/NS1600N
NW20N1/NS2000N
NW20N1/NS2000N
NW25N1/NS2500N
NW25N1/NS2500N
NW32N1/NS3200N
NW32N1/NS3200N
Minimum S.C breaking
capacity of principal CBs
(Icu) kA
27
42
42
67
38
56
47
70
59
88
75
113
94
141
Rated current In of
principal circuit-breaker
(CPB) 250A
NSX250F
NSX250N
NSX250N
NSX250S
NSX250N
NSX250H
NSX250N
NSX250H
NSX250H
NSX250S
NSX250S
NSX250L
NSX250S
NSX250L
Fig. H46 : Maximum values of short-circuit current to be interrupted by main and principal circuit-breakers (CBM and CBP respectively), for several transformers in parallel
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A2
CBM
Example (see Fig. H47 next page)
b Circuit-breaker selection for CBM duty:
For a 800 kVA transformer In = 1.126 A; Icu (minimum) = 38 kA (from Figure H46),
the CBM indicated in the table is a Compact NS1250N (Icu = 50 kA)
b Circuit-breaker selection for CBP duty:
The s.c. breaking capacity (Icu) required for these circuit-breakers is given in the
Figure H46 as 56 kA.
A recommended choice for the three outgoing circuits 1, 2 and 3 would be currentlimiting circuit-breakers types NSX400 L, NSX250 L and NSX100 L. The Icu rating in
each case = 150 kA.
LV
LV
LV
A1
Tr3
Tr2
Tr1
H21
Moreover, this table shows selected circuit-breakers of M-G manufacture
recommended for main and principal circuit-breakers in each case.
MV
MV
MV
Figure H46 indicates, for the most usual arrangement (2 or 3 transformers of
equal kVA ratings) the maximum short-circuit currents to which main and principal
CBs (CBM and CBP respectively, in Figure H45) are subjected. It is based on the
following hypotheses:
b The short-circuit 3-phase power on the MV side of the transformer is 500 MVA
b The transformers are standard 20/0.4 kV distribution-type units rated as listed
b The cables from each transformer to its LV circuit-breaker comprise 5 metres of
single core conductors
b Between each incoming-circuit CBM and each outgoing-circuit CBP there is
1 metre of busbar
b The switchgear is installed in a floormounted enclosed switchboard, in an ambientair temperature of 30 C
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
These circuit-breakers provide the advantages of:
v Absolute discrimination with the upstream (CBM) breakers
v Exploitation of the “cascading” technique, with its associated savings for all
downstream components
Choice of outgoing-circuit CBs and final-circuit CBs
Short-circuit fault-current levels at any point in
an installation may be obtained from tables
Use of table G40
From this table, the value of 3-phase short-circuit current can be determined rapidly
for any point in the installation, knowing:
b The value of short-circuit current at a point upstream of that intended for the CB
concerned
b The length, c.s.a., and the composition of the conductors between the two points
A circuit-breaker rated for a short-circuit breaking capacity exceeding the tabulated
value may then be selected.
Detailed calculation of the short-circuit current level
In order to calculate more precisely the short-circuit current, notably, when the shortcircuit current-breaking capacity of a CB is slightly less than that derived from the
table, it is necessary to use the method indicated in chapter G clause 4.
Two-pole circuit-breakers (for phase and neutral) with one protected pole only
These CBs are generally provided with an overcurrent protective device on the
phase pole only, and may be used in TT, TN-S and IT schemes. In an IT scheme,
however, the following conditions must be respected:
b Condition (B) of table G67 for the protection of the neutral conductor against
overcurrent in the case of a double fault
b Short-circuit current-breaking rating: A 2-pole phase-neutral CB must, by
convention, be capable of breaking on one pole (at the phase-to-phase voltage) the
current of a double fault equal to 15% of the 3-phase short-circuit current at the point
of its installation, if that current is y 10 kA; or 25% of the 3-phase short-circuit current
if it exceeds 10 kA
b Protection against indirect contact: this protection is provided according to the
rules for IT schemes
H22
Insufficient short-circuit current breaking rating
In low-voltage distribution systems it sometimes happens, especially in heavy-duty
networks, that the Isc calculated exceeds the Icu rating of the CBs available for
installation, or system changes upstream result in lower level CB ratings being
exceeded
b Solution 1: Check whether or not appropriate CBs upstream of the CBs affected
are of the current-limiting type, allowing the principle of cascading (described in subclause 4.5) to be applied
b Solution 2: Install a range of CBs having a higher rating. This solution is
economically interesting only where one or two CBs are affected
b Solution 3: Associate current-limiting fuses (gG or aM) with the CBs concerned, on
the upstream side. This arrangement must, however, respect the following rules:
v The fuse rating must be appropriate
v No fuse in the neutral conductor, except in certain IT installations where a double
fault produces a current in the neutral which exceeds the short-circuit breaking rating
of the CB. In this case, the blowing of the neutral fuse must cause the CB to trip on
all phases
3 Tr
800 kVA
20 kV/400 V
CBM
CBP1
400 A
CBP2
100 A
CBP3
200 A
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H47 : Transformers in parallel
The technique of “cascading” uses the
properties of current-limiting circuit-breakers
to permit the installation of all downstream
switchgear, cables and other circuit components
of significantly lower performance than would
otherwise be necessary, thereby simplifying and
reducing the cost of an installation
4.5 Coordination between circuit-breakers
Cascading or Back-up protection
Definition of the cascading technique
By limiting the peak value of short-circuit current passing through it, a current-limiting
CB permits the use, in all circuits downstream of its location, of switchgear and
circuit components having much lower short-circuit breaking capacities, and thermal
and electromechanical withstand capabilities than would otherwise be necessary.
Reduced physical size and lower performance requirements lead to substantial
economy and to the simplification of installation work. It may be noted that, while a
current-limiting circuit-breaker has the effect on downstream circuits of (apparently)
increasing the source impedance during short-circuit conditions, it has no such
effect in any other condition; for example, during the starting of a large motor (where
a low source impedance is highly desirable). The range of Compact NSX currentlimiting circuit-breakers with powerful limiting performances is particularly interesting.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
In general, laboratory tests are necessary to
ensure that the conditions of implementation
required by national standards are met and
compatible switchgear combinations must be
provided by the manufacturer
Conditions of implementation
Most national standards admit the cascading technique, on condition that the
amount of energy “let through” by the limiting CB is less than the energy all
downstream CBs and components are able to withstand without damage.
In practice this can only be verified for CBs by tests performed in a laboratory. Such
tests are carried out by manufacturers who provide the information in the form of
tables, so that users can confidently design a cascading scheme based on the
combination of recommended circuit-breaker types. As an example, Figure H48
indicates the cascading possibilities of circuit-breaker types iC60, C120 and NG125
when installed downstream of current-limiting CBs Compact NSX 250 N, H or L for a
230/400 V or 240/415 V 3-phase installation.
Short-circuit
breaking capacity
of the upstream
(limiter) CBs
Possible short-circuit
breaking capacity of
the downstream CBs
(benefiting from the
cascading technique)
kA rms
150
70
50
150
70
36
30
30
25
NSX250L
NSX250H
NSX250N
NG125L
NG125L
NG125N
iC60N/H<=32
iC60L<=25A
iC60H>=40A
iC120N/H
iC60N>=40A
NG125N
iC60N/H<=32A
iC60L<=25A
iC60H>=40A
iC120N/H
iC60N>=40A
20
A iC60N/H<=32A
iC60L<=25A
iC60H>=40A
iC120N/H
iC60N>=40A
H23
Fig. H48 : Example of cascading possibilities on a 230/400 V or 240/415 V 3-phase installation
Advantages of cascading
The current limitation benefits all downstream circuits that are controlled by the
current-limiting CB concerned.
The principle is not restrictive, i.e. current-limiting CBs can be installed at any point in
an installation where the downstream circuits would otherwise be inadequately rated.
The result is:
b Simplified short-circuit current calculations
b Simplification, i.e. a wider choice of downstream switchgear and appliances
b The use of lighter-duty switchgear and appliances, with consequently lower cost
b Economy of space requirements, since light-duty equipment have generally a
smaller volume
Principles of discriminative tripping (selectivity)
Discrimination (selectivity) is achieved by automatic protective devices if a fault
condition, occurring at any point in the installation, is cleared by the protective device
located immediately upstream of the fault, while all other protective devices remain
unaffected (see Fig. H49).
A
B
Isc
0
Total discrimination
Ir B
0
Isc B
Partial discrimination
B only opens A and B open
Ir B
Is
Isc B
Isc
Isc
Is = discrimination limit
Fig. H49 : Total and partial discrimination
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Discrimination may be total or partial, and
based on the principles of current levels, or
time-delays, or a combination of both. A more
recent development is based on the logic
techniques.
The Schneider Electric system takes
advantages of both current-limitation and
discrimination
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Discrimination between circuit-breakers A and B is total if the maximum value of
short-circuit-current on circuit B (Isc B) does not exceed the short-circuit trip setting
of circuit-breaker A (Im A). For this condition, B only will trip (see Fig. H50).
Discrimination is partial if the maximum possible short-circuit current on circuit B
exceeds the short-circuit trip-current setting of circuit-breaker A. For this maximum
condition, both A and B will trip (see Fig. H51).
Protection against overload : discrimination based on current levels
(see Fig. H52a)
This method is realized by setting successive tripping thresholds at stepped levels,
from downstream relays (lower settings) towards the source (higher settings).
Discrimination is total or partial, depending on particular conditions, as noted above.
As a rule of thumb, discrimination is achieved when:
b IrA/IrB > 2:
t
Protection against low level short-circuit currents : discrimination based on
stepped time delays (see Fig. H52b)
This method is implemented by adjusting the time-delayed tripping units, such that
downstream relays have the shortest operating times, with progressively longer
delays towards the source.
B
In the two-level arrangement shown, upstream circuit-breaker A is delayed
sufficiently to ensure total discrimination with B (for example: Masterpact with
electronic trip unit).
A
H24
Discrimination based on a combination of the two previous methods
(see Fig. H52c)
A time-delay added to a current level scheme can improve the overall discrimination
performance.
I
Ir B
Ir A Isc B Im A
The upstream CB has two high-speed magnetic tripping thresholds:
b Im A: delayed magnetic trip or short-delay electronic trip
b Ii: instantaneous strip
Fig. H50 : Total discrimination between CBs A and B
Discrimination is total if Isc B < Ii (instantaneous).
t
Protection against high level short-circuit currents: discrimination based on
arc-energy levels
This technology implemented in the Compact NSX range (current limiting circuitbreaker) is extremely effective for achievement of total discrimination.
B
Principle: When a very high level short-circuit current is detected by the two circuitsbreaker A and B, their contacts open simultaneously. As a result, the current is highly
limited.
b The very high arc-energy at level B induces the tripping of circuit-breaker B
b Then, the arc-energy is limited at level A and is not sufficient to induce the tripping
of A
A
I
Ir B
Ir A
Im A Is cB
B only opens
Is c A
As a rule of thumb, the discrimination between Compact NSX is total if the size ratio
between A and B is greater than 2.5.
A and B open
Fig. H51 : Partial discrimination between CBs A and B
a) t
b)
B
c) t
A
t
B
B
A
A
Isc B
A
∆t
I
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Ir B
Ir A
B
I
Isc B
Fig. H52 : Discrimination
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
I
Im A
delayed
Ii A
instantaneous
4 Circuit-breaker
Current-level discrimination
This technique is directly linked to the staging of the Long Time (LT) tripping curves
of two serial-connected circuit-breakers.
t
D2
D1
D1
D2
I
Ir2
Ir1
Isd 2 Isd1
Fig. H53 : Current discrimination
The discrimination limit ls is:
b Is = Isd2 if the thresholds lsd1 and lsd2 are too close or merge,
b Is = Isd1 if the thresholds lsd1 and lsd2 are sufficiently far apart.
As a rule, current discrimination is achieved when:
b Ir1 / Ir2 < 2,
b Isd1 / Isd2 > 2.
The discrimination limit is:
b Is = Isd1.
H25
Discrimination quality
Discrimination is total if Is > Isc(D2), i.e. Isd1 > Isc(D2).
This normally implies:
b a relatively low level Isc(D2),
b a large difference between the ratings of circuit-breakers D1 and D2.
Current discrimination is normally used in final distribution.
Discrimination based on time-delayed tripping
uses CBs referred to as “selective” (in some
countries).
Implementation of these CBs is relatively simple
and consists in delaying the instant of tripping
of the several series-connected circuit-breakers
in a stepped time sequence
Time discrimination
This is the extension of current discrimination and is obtained by staging over time
of the tripping curves. This technique consists of giving a time delay of t to the Short
Time (ST) tripping of D1.
D2
D1
t
D1
Δt
I
Ir2
Fig. H54 : Time discrimination
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Ir1
Isd 2 Isd1
Ii1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D2
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
The thresholds (Ir1, Isd1) of D1 and (Ir2, Isd2) comply with the staging rules of
current discrimination.
The discrimination limit ls of the association is at least equal to li1, the instantaneous
threshold of D1.
Masterpact NT06
630 A
Compact NSX
250 A
H26
Compact NSX
100 A
Acti 9
iC60
Discrimination quality
There are two possible applications:
b on final and/or intermediate feeders
A category circuit-breakers can be used with time-delayed tripping of the
upstream circuit-breaker. This allows extension of current discrimination up
to the instantaneous threshold li1 of the upstream circuit-breaker: Is = li1.
If Isc(D2) is not too high - case of a final feeder - total discrimination
can be obtained.
b on the incomers and feeders of the MSB
At this level, as continuity of supply takes priority, the installation
characteristics allow use of B category circuit-breakers designed for
time-delayed tripping. These circuit-breakers have a high thermal withstand
(Icw u 50% Icn for t = 1s): Is = Icw1.
Even for high lsc(D2), time discrimination normally provides total
discrimination: Icw1 > Icc(D2).
Note: Use of B category circuit-breakers means that the installation must withstand
high electrodynamic and thermal stresses.
Consequently, these circuit-breakers have a high instantaneous threshold li that can
be adjusted and disabled in order to protect the busbars if necessary.
Practical example of discrimination at several levels with Schneider Electric
circuit-breakers (with electronic trip units)
"Masterpact NT is totally selective with any moulded-case Compact NSX circuit
breaker, i.e., the downstream circuit-breaker will trip for any short-circuit value up to
its breaking capacity. Further, all Compact NSX CBs are totally selective, as long as
the ration between sizes is greater than 1.6 and the ratio between ratings is greater
than 2.5. The same rules apply for the total selectivity with the miniature circuitbreakers Acti 9 further downstream (see Fig. H55).
t
A
B
Non tripping
time of A
Current-breaking
time for B
Only B opens
I
Ir B
Icc B
Icc
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H55 : 4 level discrimination with Schneider Electric circuit breakers : Masterpact NT
Compact NSX and Acti 9
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
Energy discrimination with current limitation
Cascading between 2 devices is normally achieved by using the tripping of the
upstream circuit-breaker A to help the downstream circuit-breaker B to break the
current. The discrimination limit Is is consequently equal to the ultimate breaking
current Icu B of circuit-breaker B acting alone, as cascading requires the tripping of
both devices.
The energy discrimination technology implemented in Compact NSX circuit-breakers
allows to improve the discrimination limit to a value higher than the ultimate breaking
current Icu B of the downstream circuit-breaker. The principle is as follows:
b The downstream limiting circuit-breaker B sees a very high short-circuit current.
The tripping is very fast (<1 ms) and then, the current is limited
b The upstream circuit-breaker A sees a limited short-circuit current compared to its
breaking capability, but this current induces a repulsion of the contacts. As a result,
the arcing voltage increases the current limitation. However, the arc energy is not
high enough to induce the tripping of the circuit-breaker. So, the circuit-breaker A
helps the circuit-breaker B to trip, without tripping itself. The discrimination limit can
be higher than Icu B and the discrimination becomes total with a reduced cost of the
devices
Natural total discriminitation with Compact NSX
The major advantage of the Compact NSX range is to provide a natural total
discrimination between two series-connected devices if:
b The ratio of the two trip-unit current ratings is > 1.6
b The ratio of rated currents of the two circuit-breakers is > 2.5
Discrimination schemes based on logic
techniques are possible, using CBs equipped
with electronic tripping units designed for
the purpose (Compact, Masterpact) and
interconnected with pilot wires
Logic discrimination or “Zone Sequence Interlocking – ZSI”
H27
This type of discrimination can be achieved with circuit-breakers equipped with
specially designed electronic trip units (Compact, Masterpact): only the Short Time
Protection (STP) and Ground Fault Protection (GFP) functions of the controlled
devices are managed by Logic Discrimination. In particular, the Instantaneous
Protection function - inherent protection function - is not concerned.
Settings of controlled circuit-breakers
b time delay: there are no rules, but staging (if any)of the time delays of time
discrimination must be applied ( tD1 u tD2 u tD3),
b thresholds: there are no threshold rules to be applied, but natural staging of the
protection device ratings must be complied with (IcrD1 u IcrD2 u IcrD3).
Note: This technique ensures discrimination even with circuit-breakers of similar
ratings.
Principles
Activation of the Logic Discrimination function is via transmission of information on
the pilot wire:
b ZSI input:
pilot wire
D1
v low level (no downstream faults): the Protection function is on standby with a
reduced time delay (y 0,1 s),
v high level (presence of downstream faults): the relevant Protection function moves
to the time delay status set on the device.
interlocking
order
D2
b ZSI output:
v low level: the trip unit detects no faults and sends no orders,
v high level: the trip unit detects a fault and sends an order.
Fig. H56 : Logic discrimination.
Operation
A pilot wire connects in cascading form the protection devices of an installation
(see Fig. H56). When a fault occurs, each circuit-breaker upstream of the fault
(detecting a fault) sends an order (high level output) and moves the upstream circuitbreaker to its natural time delay (high level input). The circuitbreaker placed just
above the fault does not receive any orders (low level input) and thus trips almost
instantaneously.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
D3
interlocking
order
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Discrimination quality
This technique enables:
b easy achievement as standard of discrimination on 3 levels or more,
b elimination of important stresses on the installation, relating to timedelayed tripping of the protection device, in event of a fault directly on the
upstream busbars.
All the protection devices are thus virtually instantaneous,
b easy achievement of downstream discrimination with non-controlled
circuit-breakers.
4.6 Discrimination MV/LV in a consumer’s
substation
63 A
1,250 kVA
20 kV / 400 V
Full-load current
1,760 A
3-phase
short-circuit
current level
31.4 kA
H28
In general the transformer in a consumer’s substation is protected by MV fuses,
suitably rated to match the transformer, in accordance with the principles laid down
in IEC 60787 and IEC 60420, by following the advice of the fuse manufacturer.
The basic requirement is that a MV fuse will not operate for LV faults occurring
downstream of the transformer LV circuit-breaker, so that the tripping characteristic
curve of the latter must be to the left of that of the MV fuse pre-arcing curve.
Compact
NS2000
set at 1,800 A
Fig. H57 : Example
t
(s)
1,000
NS 2000
set at
1,800 A
200
100
Minimum pre-arcing
curve for 63 A HV fuses
(current referred to the
secondary side of the
transformer)
10
1
4
6
8
0.2
0.1
Step 4
Step 3
Step 2
0.50
Step 1
0.01
1,800 A
Ir
10 kA
Isc maxi
This requirement generally fixes the maximum settings for the LV circuit-breaker
protection:
b Maximum short-circuit current-level setting of the magnetic tripping element
b Maximum time-delay allowable for the short-circuit current tripping element
(see Fig. H57)
Example:
b Short-circuit level at MV terminals of transformer: 250 MVA
b Transformer MV/LV: 1,250 kVA 20/0.4 kV
b MV fuses: 63 A
b Cabling, transformer - LV circuit-breaker: 10 metres single-core cables
b LV circuit-breaker: Compact NSX 2000 set at 1,800 A (Ir)
What is the maximum short-circuit trip current setting and its maximum time delay
allowable?
The curves of Figure H58 show that discrimination is assured if the short-time delay
tripping unit of the CB is set at:
b A level y 6 Ir = 10.8 kA
b A time-delay setting of step 1 or 2
I
31.4 kA
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H58 : Curves of MV fuses and LV circuit-breaker
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Circuit-breaker
4.7 Circuit- breakers suitable for IT systems
Earthing system: IT
In IT system, circuit breakers may have to face an unusual situation called double
earth fault when a second fault to earth occurs in presence of a first fault on the
opposite side of a circuit breaker (see Fig : H59).
In that case circuit breaker has to clear the fault with phase to phase voltage across
a single pole instead of phase to neutral voltage. Breaking capacity of the breaker
may be modified in such a situation.
Annex H of IEC60947-2 deals with this situation and circuit breaker used in IT
system shall have been tested according to this annex.
When a circuit-breaker has not been tested according to this annex, a marking by
IT
the symbol
shall be used on the nameplate.
Regulation in some countries may add additional requirements.
Fig. H59 : Double earth fault situation
4.8 Ultra rapid circuit breaker
As installed power increases, electrical distribution has to shift from a LV design to
a HV design. Indeed, a high short-circuit level can be a threat to the installation and
make impossible the selection of low voltage equipments (Switchboard and bus bars,
circuit breaker…)
These situations could be met in the following applications: Bus bars coupling
onboard merchant vessels, off shore platform, loop networks (in industry), where
the current and energy are important because of the installed power (several
transformers or generators in parallel) and HV design not easy.
H29
Two solutions could be used:
b Pyrotechnic interruption switching device
b Power circuit breaker based solution
Some power circuit breakers with additionnal feature (based on the Thomson effect
technology for instance) provide an ultra rapid opening system on very high shortcircuit level (see Fig. H59). The breaking performance makes it possible to limit the
short-circuit current and prospective energy, and consequently protect the electrical
installation against the electrodynamic and thermal effects of short-circuit.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H60 : Example of ultra rapid power circuit breaker: Masterpact UR (Schneider Electric)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Example of limitation offered by Masterpact UR in decoupling bus bars in case
of short circuit (see Fig. H61):
When a short-circuit occurs downstream in the installation (A) with no tie breaker, the
short-circuit level will be the total sum of all the generated power (illustrated by curve 1).
I peak
G2
G1
G3
I1
G4
I3 = I1 + I2
non limited
I2
I1 - I2
non limited
I3
(A)
0
M2
M1
(ms)
Curve 1
I3 = I1 + I2
H30
Fig. H61 : Diagram of the network
By inserting a tie breaker (see Fig. H62) - Masterpact UR - to separate the sources
under fault conditions, the short circuit at (A) will consist in:
b a limited short circuit coming from generator G1 and G2 interrupted by the
Masterpact UR (see curve 2)
b a non limited short circuit from generators G3 and G4 (see curve 3).
I peak
G1
G4
G3
G2
I1
Masterpact
UR
I peak
I2
non limited
I1
non limited
I 1 limited by
Masterpact UR
I2
I3
0
(A)
(ms)
0
(ms)
M2
M1
I 3 = I 1 limited + I 2
Curve 2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H62 : diagram of the network
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Curve 3
4 Circuit-breaker
The resulting short circuit level is illustrated by curve 4 (see Fig.H63):
I peak
I 3 = I 1 limited + I 2
0
(ms)
Curve 4
Fig. H63 : diagram of the network
H31
The consequence of the strong limitation of the short circuit current and the
prospective energy allows the design of a LV network instead of a MV design.
This also prevents the network from being totally shutdown (black out) in case of
short circuit in the main switchboard.
The following table (Fig. H64) give some example of limitation with MAsterpact UR
as a tie breaker between source 1 & 2
Source 2
Source 1
50
169
207
183
229
193
240
203
251
213
262
224
273
234
284
244
295
254
306
264
317
274
327
295
349
55
176
229
189
240
199
251
210
262
220
273
230
284
240
295
250
306
260
317
270
327
281
338
301
360
60
178
240
191
251
201
262
211
273
220
284
230
295
240
306
249
317
259
327
269
338
278
349
298
371
65
181
251
194
262
204
273
214
284
223
295
233
306
242
317
252
327
262
338
272
349
281
360
301
382
70
185
262
198
273
207
284
217
295
226
306
236
317
246
327
255
338
265
349
275
360
284
371
304
393
75
189
273
201
284
211
295
220
306
230
317
240
327
249
338
259
349
268
360
278
371
288
382
307
404
80
192
284
205
295
214
306
224
317
233
327
243
338
252
349
262
360
272
371
281
382
291
393
310
415
85
196
295
208
306
218
317
227
327
237
338
246
349
256
360
265
371
275
382
284
393
294
404
313
426
90
199
306
212
317
221
327
231
338
240
349
249
360
259
371
268
382
278
393
288
404
297
415
316
437
95
204
317
216
327
225
338
235
349
244
360
253
371
263
382
272
393
282
404
291
415
301
426
320
448
100
209
327
221
338
230
349
239
360
249
371
258
382
268
393
277
404
287
415
296
426
306
437
325
458
110
218
349
230
360
239
371
248
382
258
393
267
404
276
415
286
426
295
437
305
448
314
458
333
480
50
55
60
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
110
Limited
No limited
Example
Fig. H64 : Example of limitation by Masterpact UR for 690 V - 60 hz network. (IEC 947-2)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
xxx
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
5 Maintenance of low voltage
switchgear
IEC60364-6 requires initial and periodic verifications of electrical installations. The
electrical switchboard and all its equipment continue to age whether they operate
or not. This aging process is due mainly to environmental influences and operating
conditions. To ensure that Low voltage switchgear and especially circuit breakers
retains the operating and safety characteristics specified in the catalogue for the
whole of its service life, it is recommended that:
b The device is installed in optimum environmental and operating conditions
b Routine inspections and regular maintenance are carried out by qualified
personnel.
A switchboard and the switchgear age, whether they are in operation or not. Ageing
is due primarily to the influence of the environment and the operating conditions.
Influence of the environment
A device placed in a given environment is subjected to its effects. The main
environmental factors that accelerate device ageing are:
- temperature
- vibration
- relative humidity
- salt environment
- dust
- corrosive atmospheres.
- percent load
- current harmonics
H32
Preventive maintenance
Preventive maintenance consists in carrying out, at predetermined intervals or
according to prescribed criteria, checks intended to reduce the probability of a failure
or deterioration in the operation of a system.
There are two types of preventive maintenance:
Periodic maintenance
For each type of product, maintenance recommendations are laid out by the
technical department. These verification procedures, intended to maintain systems or
their subassemblies in correct operating condition over the targeted service life, must
be carried out according to the time intervals stipulated in this document.
Conditional maintenance
To a certain extent, conditional-maintenance operations are a means to reduce (but
not eliminate) the recommended periodic-maintenance operations (thus limited to
the strict minimum) that require an annual shutdown of the installation.
These operations are launched when programmed alarms indicate that a predefined
threshold has been reached. (Number of operation > durability, aging indicators…)
Electronic trip units in power circuit breaker can propose such functions. Conditional
maintenance is the means to optimise installation maintenance.
Maintenance level
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
There are three recommended maintenance levels.
The table below indicates maintenance operations and their intervals according to
the level:
Level Maintenance
interval
Maintenance operations
Level II
1 year
Visual inspection and functional testing, replacement of
faulty accessories
Level III
2 years
As for level II plus servicing operation and subassembly
tests
Level IV
5 years
As for level III plus diagnostics and repairs (by
manufacturer)
Fig. H65 : Maintenance level
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Maintenance of low voltage
switchgear
The intervals stated are for normal environmental and
operating conditions.
Provided all the environmental conditions are more favourable, maintenance
intervals can be longer (for example, Level III maintenance can be carried out every
3 years).
If just one of the conditions is more severe, maintenance must be carried out more
frequently
Functions linked specifically to safety require particular intervals.
Note:
It is advisable to test that the remote safety stop commands and the earth leakage
protection (Vigi module) work at regular intervals (every 6 months).
Example of maintenance recommendation for Power Circuit Breaker (>630A)
The case
The case is an essential element in the circuit breaker.
First of all, it ensures a number of safety functions:
- functional insulation between the phases themselves and between the phases and
the exposed conductive parts in order to resist transient overvoltages caused by the
distribution system
- a barrier avoiding direct user contact with live parts
- protection against the effects of electrical arcs and overpressures caused by
short-circuits.
Secondly, it serves to support the entire pole operating mechanism as well as the
mechanical and electrical accessories of the circuit breaker.
On the case, there should be:
- no traces of grime (grease), excessive dust or condensation which all reduce
insulation
- no signs of burns or cracks which would reduce the mechanical solidity of the case
and thus its capacity to withstand short-circuits.
Preventive maintenance for cases consists of a visual inspection of its condition and
cleaning with a dry cloth or a vacuum cleaner. All cleaning products with solvents are
strictly forbidden. It is advised to measure the insulation every five years and following
trips due to a short-circuit. The product must be replaced if there are signs of burns or
cracks.
H33
Arc chutes (for Air Circuit breaker)
Fig. H66 : Example of maintenance recommendation for Power Circuit Breaker (>630A)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
During a short-circuit, the arc chute serves to extinguish the arc and to absorb the
high level of energy along the entire path of the short-circuit. It also contributes
to arc extinction under rated current conditions. An arc chute that is not in good
condition may not be capable of fully clearing the short-circuit and ultimately result
in the destruction of the circuit breaker. The arc chutes for air circuit breaker must
be regularly checked. The fins of the arc chutes may be blackened but must not be
significantly damaged. What is more, the filters must not be blocked to avoid internal
overpressures. It is advised to use a vacuum cleaner rather than a cloth to remove
dust from the outside of the arc chutes.
H - LV switchgear: functions & selection
Main contacts (for Air Circuit breaker)
The contacts make and break the current under normal conditions (rated current for
the installation) and under exceptional conditions (overloads and short-circuits). The
contacts are eroded by the many opening and closing cycles and can be particularly
deteriorated by short-circuit currents.
Worn contacts may result in abnormal temperature rise and accelerate device ageing.
It is imperative to remove the arc chutes and visually check contact wear at least once
a year and following each short-circuit.
The contact-wear indicators constitute an absolute minimum value that must not be
overrun.
Device and chassis mechanisms
Mechanical operation of the circuit breaker may be hindered by dust, knocks,
aggressive atmospheres, no greasing or excessive greasing. Operating safety is
ensured by dusting and general cleaning, proper greasing and regular opening and
closing of the circuit breaker.
H34
Operating cycles
The imperative need to ensure continuity of service in an installation generally means
that power circuit breakers are rarely operated. If, on the one hand, an excessive
number of operating cycles accelerates device ageing, it is also true that a lack of
operation over a long period can result in mechanical malfunctions. Regular operation
is required to maintain the normal performance level of each part involved in the
opening and closing cycles.
In installations where power circuit breakers are used in source changeover systems, it
is advised to periodically operate the circuit breaker for the alternate source.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H66 : Example of maintenance recommendation for Power Circuit Breaker (>630A) (continued)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Maintenance of low voltage
switchgear
Electronic trip unit
If an electric fault occurs in the installation, the electronic trip unit detects the fault
and orders the circuit breaker to open and thus protect life and property. Electronic
components and circuit boards are sensitive to the environment (ambient temperature,
humid and corrosive atmospheres) and to severe operating conditions (magnetic
fields, vibrations, etc.). To ensure correct operation, it is necessary to periodically
check:
- the chain of action resulting in a trip
- the response time as a function of the level of the fault current.
Depending on the operating and environment conditions, it is advised to estimate their
service life and to replace them if necessary to avoid any risk of non-operation when
they are needed.
Auxiliary circuits
Control auxiliaries
MX and XF shunt releases are respectively used to remotely open and close the circuit
breaker using an electrical order or by a supervisor via a communication network.
The MN undervoltage release is used to break the power circuit if the distribution
system voltage drops or fails in order to protect life (emergency off) or property.
Preventive maintenance consists in periodically checking operation at minimum values.
Depending on the operating and environment conditions, it is advised to
estimate their service life and to replace them if necessary to avoid any risk of
non-operation when they are needed.
H35
Auxiliary wiring
Auxiliary wiring is used to transmit orders to the various control devices and to transmit
status-condition information. Incorrect connections or damaged insulation may result in
either non-operation of the circuit breaker or nuisance tripping.
Auxiliary wiring must be regularly checked and replaced as needed, particularly if
there are vibrations, high ambient temperatures or corrosive atmospheres.
Indication contacts
The contacts indicating the status of the circuit-breaker (ON / OFF), of the chassis
(CE, CD, CT), a trip due to an electrical fault (SDE) or that the circuit breaker is
ready to close (PF) provide the operator with the status information required to react
correspondingly. Any incorrect indications may result in erroneous device operation
that could endanger life and property. Contact failure (wear, loose connections)
may result from vibrations, corrosion or abnormal temperature rise and preventive
maintenance must ensure that contacts correctly conduct or isolate according to their
positions.
Gear motor
The gear motor (MCH) automatically recharges the operating-mechanism springs
as soon as the circuit breaker is closed. The gear motor makes it possible to
instantaneously reclose the device following an opening. This function may be
indispensable for safety reasons. The charging lever serves simply as a backup
means if the auxiliary voltage fails. Given the mechanical forces exerted to charge the
mechanism, the gear motor wears quickly. Periodic checks on gear-motor operation
and the charging time are required to ensure the device closing function.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. H66 : Example of maintenance recommendation for Power Circuit Breaker (>630A) (continued)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter J
Overvoltage protection
Contents
2
3
4
5
6
J2
1.1 Overvoltage definitions
J2
1.2 Overvoltage characteristics of atmospheric origin
J3
1.3 Effects on electrical installations
J3
1.4 Characterization of the lightning wave
J6
Principle of lightning protection
J7
2.1 General rules
J7
2.2 Building protection system
J7
2.3 Electrical installation protection system
J9
2.4 The Surge Protection Device (SPD)
J10
Design of the electrical installation protection system
J13
3.1 Design rules
J13
3.2 Elements of the protection system
J14
3.3 Common characteristics of SPDs according to the installation
characteristics
J16
3.4 Selection of a Type 1 SPD
J19
3.5 Selection of a Type 2 SPD
J19
3.6 Selection of external Short Circuit Protection Device (SCPD)
J20
3.7 SPD and protection device coordination table
J22
Installation of SPDs
J24
4.1 Connection
J24
4.2 Cabling rules
J26
Application
J28
5.1 Installation examples
J28
5.2 SPD for photovoltaic applications
J29
Technical supplements
J32
6.1 Lightning protection standards
J32
6.2 The components of a SPD
J32
6.3 End-of-life indication
J34
6.4 Detailed characteristics of the external SCPD
J34
6.5 Propagation of a lightning wave
J36
6.6 Example of lightning current in TT system
J37
J1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
Overvoltage of atmospheric origin
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
1 Overvoltage of atmospheric
origin
1.1 Overvoltage definitions
1.1.1 Various types of overvoltage
An overvoltage is a voltage pulse or wave which is superimposed on the rated
voltage of the network (see Fig. J1).
Voltage
Lightning type impulse
(duration = 100 µs)
"Operating impulse"
type dumped ring wave
(F = 100 kHz to 1 MHz)
Irms
Fig. J1 : Examples of overvoltage
J2
This type of overvoltage is characterized by (see Fig. J2):
b the rise time tf (in µs);
b the gradient S (in kV/µs).
An overvoltage disturbs equipment and produces electromagnetic radiation.
Moreover, the duration of the overvoltage (T) causes an energy peak in the electric
circuits which could destroy equipment.
Voltage (V or kV)
U max
50 %
t
Rise time (tf)
Voltage surge duration (T)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J2 : Main characteristics of an overvoltage
Four types of overvoltage can disturb electrical installations and loads:
b Switching surges:
high-frequency overvoltages or burst disturbance (see Fig. J1) caused by a change
in the steady state in an electrical network (during operation of switchgear).
b Power-frequency overvoltages:
overvoltages of the same frequency as the network (50, 60 or 400 Hz) caused
by a permanent change of state in the network (following a fault: insulation fault,
breakdown of neutral conductor, etc.).
b Overvoltages caused by electrostatic discharge:
very short overvoltages (a few nanoseconds) of very high frequency caused by
the discharge of accumulated electric charges (for example, a person walking on a
carpet with insulating soles is electrically charged with a voltage of several kilovolts).
b Overvoltages of atmospheric origin.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Overvoltage of atmospheric
origin
1.2 Overvoltage characteristics of atmospheric
origin
Lightning strokes in a few figures:
Lightning flashes produce an extremely large
quantity of pulsed electrical energy (see Fig. J4)
b of several thousand amperes (and several
thousand volts),
b of high frequency (approximately 1
megahertz),
b of short duration (from a microsecond to a
millisecond).
Between 2000 and 5000 storms are constantly undergoing formation throughout the
world. These storms are accompanied by lightning strokes which represent a serious
hazard for persons and equipment. Lightning flashes hit the ground at an average of
30 to 100 strokes per second, i.e. 3 billion lightning strokes each year.
The table in Figure J3 shows the characteristic lightning strike values. As can be
seen, 50% of lightning strokes have a current exceeding 33 kA and 5% a current
exceeding 65 kA. The energy conveyed by the lightning stroke is therefore very high.
Cumulative probability
(%)
Peak current
(kA)
Gradient
(kA/μs)
95
7
9.1
50
33
24
5
65
65
1
140
95
0
270
Fig. J3 : Lightning discharge values given by the IEC 62305 standard
Lightning
current
Arc leader
l
Subsequent arcs
J3
l/2
t1
t2
t3
Time
Fig. J4 : Example of lightning current
Lightning also causes a large number of fires, mostly in agricultural areas (destroying
houses or making them unfit for use). High-rise buildings are especially prone to
lightning strokes.
1.3 Effects on electrical installations
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Lightning damages electrical and electronic systems in particular: transformers,
electricity meters and electrical appliances on both residential and industrial
premises.
The cost of repairing the damage caused by lightning is very high. But it is very hard
to assess the consequences of:
b disturbances caused to computers and telecommunication networks;
b faults generated in the running of programmable logic controller programs and
control systems.
Moreover, the cost of operating losses may be far higher than the value of the
equipment destroyed.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
Lightning is a high-frequency electrical
phenomenon which causes overvoltages on
all conductive items, especially on electrical
cabling and equipment.
1.3.1 Lightning stroke impacts
Lightning strokes can affect the electrical (and/or electronic) systems of a building in
two ways:
b by direct impact of the lightning stroke on the building (see Fig. J5 a);
b by indirect impact of the lightning stroke on the building:
v A lightning stroke can fall on an overhead electric power line supplying a building
(see Fig. J5 b). The overcurrent and overvoltage can spread several kilometres from
the point of impact.
v A lightning stroke can fall near an electric power line (see Fig. J5 c). It is the
electromagnetic radiation of the lightning current that produces a high current and an
overvoltage on the electric power supply network.
In the latter two cases, the hazardous currents and voltages are transmitted by the
power supply network.
v A lightning stroke can fall near a building (see Fig. J5 d). The earth potential
around the point of impact rises dangerously.
a
b
Electrical
installation
c
d
J4
Installation
earth lead
Fig. J5 : Various types of lightning impact
In all cases, the consequences for electrical installations and loads can be dramatic.
Lightning falls on an unprotected building.
Lightning falls near a building.
Electrical
installation
Electrical
installation
Electrical
installation
Installation
earth lead
Installation
earth lead
Installation
earth lead
The lightning current flows to earth via the more or
less conductive structures of the building with very
destructive effects:
b thermal effects: Very violent overheating of
materials, causing fire,
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Lightning falls near an overhead line.
The lightning current generates overvoltages
through electromagnetic induction in the distribution
system.
These overvoltages are propagated along the line to
the electrical equipment inside the buildings.
The lightning stroke generates the same types of
overvoltage as those described opposite.
In addition, the lightning current rises back from
the earth to the electrical installation, thus causing
equipment breakdown.
b mechanical effects: Structural deformation,
b thermal flashover: Extremely dangerous
phenomenon in the presence of flammable or
explosive materials (hydrocarbons, dust, etc.).
The building and the installations inside the
building are generally destroyed
The electrical installations inside the building are generally destroyed.
Fig. J6 : Consequence of a lightning stoke impact
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Overvoltage of atmospheric
origin
1.3.2 The various modes of propagation
b Common mode
Common-mode overvoltages appear between live conductors and earth: phase-toearth or neutral-to-earth (see Fig. J7). They are dangerous especially for appliances
whose frame is connected to earth due to risks of dielectric breakdown.
Ph
Equipment
Imc
N
Voltage surge
common mode
Imc
Fig. J7 : Common mode
b Differential mode
Differential-mode overvoltages appear between live conductors:
phase-to-phase or phase-to-neutral (see Fig. J8). They are especially dangerous for
electronic equipment, sensitive hardware such as computer systems, etc.
J5
Imd
Ph
N
U voltage surge
differential mode
Equipment
Imd
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J8 : Differential mode
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
1 Overvoltage of atmospheric
origin
1.4 Characterization of the lightning wave
Analysis of the phenomena allows definition of the types of lightning current and
voltage waves.
b 2 types of current wave are considered by the IEC standards:
v 10/350 µs wave: to characterize the current waves from a direct lightning stroke
(see Fig. J9);
I
Max.
100 %
50 %
t
(µs)
10
350
Fig. J9 : 10/350 µs current wave
v 8/20 µs wave: to characterize the current waves from an indirect lightning stroke
(see Fig. J10).
I
J6
Max.
100 %
50 %
t
(µs)
8
20
Fig. J10 : 8/20 µs current wave
These two types of lightning current wave are used to define tests on SPDs
(IEC standard 61643-11) and equipment immunity to lightning currents.
The peak value of the current wave characterizes the intensity of the lightning stroke.
b The overvoltages created by lightning strokes are characterized by a 1.2/50 µs
voltage wave (see Fig. J11).
This type of voltage wave is used to verify equipment's withstand to overvoltages of
atmospheric origin (impulse voltage as per IEC 61000-4-5).
V
Max.
100 %
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
50 %
1.2
50
Fig. J11 : 1.2/50 µs voltage wave
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
t
(µs)
J - Overvoltage protection
2 Principle of lightning protection
2.1 General rules
The system for protecting a building against the
effects of lightning must include:
b protection of structures against direct lightning
strokes;
b protection of electrical installations against
direct and indirect lightning strokes.
2.1.1 Procedure to prevent risks of lightning strike
The basic principle for protection of an installation against the risk of lightning strikes
is to prevent the disturbing energy from reaching sensitive equipment. To achieve
this, it is necessary to:
b capture the lightning current and channel it to earth via the most direct path
(avoiding the vicinity of sensitive equipment);
b perform equipotential bonding of the installation;
This equipotential bonding is implemented by bonding conductors, supplemented by
Surge Protection Devices (SPDs) or spark gaps (e.g., antenna mast spark gap).
b minimize induced and indirect effects by installing SPDs and/or filters.
Two protection systems are used to eliminate or limit overvoltages: they are known
as the building protection system (for the outside of buildings) and the electrical
installation protection system (for the inside of buildings).
2.2 Building protection system
The role of the building protection system is to protect it against direct lightning
strokes.
The system consists of:
b the capture device: the lightning protection system;
b down-conductors designed to convey the lightning current to earth;
b "crow's foot" earth leads connected together;
b links between all metallic frames (equipotential bonding) and the earth leads.
J7
When the lightning current flows in a conductor, if potential differences appear
between it and the frames connected to earth that are located in the vicinity, the
latter can cause destructive flashovers.
2.2.1 The 3 types of lightning protection system
Three types of building protection are used:
b The lightning rod (simple rod or with triggering system)
The lightning rod is a metallic capture tip placed at the top of the building. It is
earthed by one or more conductors (often copper strips) (see Fig. J12).
Simple
lightning rod
Earth
down-conductor
(copper strip)
"Crow's foot"
earth lead
Fig. J12 : Lightning rod (simple rod or with triggering system)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Check
terminal
J - Overvoltage protection
Tin plated copper 25 mm 2
Metal post
d > 0.1 h
h
Frame grounded earth belt
Fig. J13 : Taut wires
b The lightning rod with taut wires
These wires are stretched above the structure to be protected. They are used to
protect special structures: rocket launching areas, military applications and protection
of high-voltage overhead lines (see Fig. J13).
b The lightning conductor with meshed cage (Faraday cage)
This protection involves placing numerous down conductors/tapes symmetrically all
around the building. (see Fig. J14).
This type of lightning protection system is used for highly exposed buildings housing
very sensitive installations such as computer rooms.
J8
2.2.2 Consequences of building protection for the electrical
installation's equipment
50% of the lightning current discharged by the building protection system rises back
into the earthing networks of the electrical installation (see Fig. J15): the potential
rise of the frames very frequently exceeds the insulation withstand capability of
the conductors in the various networks (LV, telecommunications, video cable, etc.).
Moreover, the flow of current through the down-conductors generates induced
overvoltages in the electrical installation.
Fig. J14 : Meshed cage (Faraday cage)
As a consequence, the building protection
system does not protect the electrical
installation: it is therefore compulsory to provide
for an electrical installation protection system.
Electrical
installation
I
i
Installation
earth lead
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J15 : Direct lightning back current
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Principle of lightning protection
2.3 Electrical installation protection system
The main objective of the electrical installation protection system is to limit
overvoltages to values that are acceptable for the equipment.
The electrical installation protection system consists of:
b one or more SPDs depending on the building configuration;
b the equipotential bonding: metallic mesh of exposed conductive parts.
2.3.1 Implementation
The procedure to protect the electrical and electronic systems of a building is as
follows.
Search for information
b Identify all sensitive loads and their location in the building.
b Identify the electrical and electronic systems and their respective points of entry
into the building.
b Check whether a lightning protection system is present on the building or in the
vicinity.
b Become acquainted with the regulations applicable to the building's location.
b Assess the risk of lightning strike according to the geographic location, type of
power supply, lightning strike density, etc.
Solution implementation
b Install bonding conductors on frames by a mesh.
b Install a SPD in the LV incoming switchboard.
b Install an additional SPD in each subdistribution board located in the vicinity of
sensitive equipment (see Fig. J16).
J9
SPD
MV supply
SPD
SPD
SPD
Underground
MV supply
If L*>30m
SPD
SPD
SPD
Underground
MV supply
* the phenomena of wave reflection is increasing from L=10m
Fig. J16 : Example of protection of a large-scale electrical installation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
If L*>30m
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
MV supply
J - Overvoltage protection
Surge Protection Devices (SPD) are used for
electric power supply networks, telephone
networks, and communication and automatic
control buses.
2.4 The Surge Protection Device (SPD)
The Surge Protection Device (SPD) is a component of the electrical installation
protection system.
This device is connected in parallel on the power supply circuit of the loads that it
has to protect (see Fig. J17). It can also be used at all levels of the power supply
network.
This is the most commonly used and most efficient type of overvoltage protection.
Incoming
circuit breaker
Lightning
current
SPD
Sensitive loads
Fig. J17 : Principle of protection system in parallel
J10
Principle
SPD is designed to limit transient overvoltages of atmospheric origin and divert
current waves to earth, so as to limit the amplitude of this overvoltage to a value that
is not hazardous for the electrical installation and electric switchgear and controlgear.
SPD eliminates overvoltages:
b in common mode, between phase and neutral or earth;
b in differential mode, between phase and neutral.
In the event of an overvoltage exceeding the operating threshold, the SPD
b conducts the energy to earth, in common mode;
b distributes the energy to the other live conductors, in differential mode.
The three types of SPD:
b Type 1 SPD
The Type 1 SPD is recommended in the specific case of service-sector and industrial
buildings, protected by a lightning protection system or a meshed cage.
It protects electrical installations against direct lightning strokes. It can discharge
the back-current from lightning spreading from the earth conductor to the network
conductors.
Type 1 SPD is characterized by a 10/350 µs current wave.
b Type 2 SPD
The Type 2 SPD is the main protection system for all low voltage electrical
installations. Installed in each electrical switchboard, it prevents the spread of
overvoltages in the electrical installations and protects the loads.
Type 2 SPD is characterized by an 8/20 µs current wave.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Type 3 SPD
These SPDs have a low discharge capacity. They must therefore mandatorily be
installed as a supplement to Type 2 SPD and in the vicinity of sensitive loads.
Type 3 SPD is characterized by a combination of voltage waves (1.2/50 µs) and
current waves (8/20 µs).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Principle of lightning protection
b SPD normative definition
Direct lightning stroke
Indirect lightning stroke
IEC 61643-1
Class I test
Class II test
Class III test
IEC 61643-11/2007
Type 1 : T1
Type 2 : T2
Type 3 : T3
EN/IEC 61643-11
Type 1
Type 2
Type 3
Former VDE 0675v
B
C
D
Type of test wave
10/350
8/20
1.2/50 + 8/20
Note 1: There exist T1 + T2 SPD (or Type 1 + 2 SPD) combining protection of loads against direct and indirect lightning strokes.
Note 2: some T2 SPD can also be declared as T3 .
Fig. J18 : SPD standard definition
2.4.1
Characteristics of SPD
International standard IEC 61643-11 Edition 1.0 (03/2011) defines the characteristics
and tests for SPD connected to low voltage distribution systems (see Fig. J19).
b Common characteristics
v Uc: Maximum continuous operating voltage
This is the A.C. or D.C. voltage above which the SPD becomes active. This value is
chosen according to the rated voltage and the system earthing arrangement.
v Up: Voltage protection level (at In)
This is the maximum voltage across the terminals of the SPD when it is active. This
voltage is reached when the current flowing in the SPD is equal to In. The voltage
protection level chosen must be below the overvoltage withstand capability of the
loads (see section 3.2). In the event of lightning strokes, the voltage across the
terminals of the SPD generally remains less than Up.
v In: Nominal discharge current
This is the peak value of a current of 8/20 µs waveform that the SPD is capable of
discharging 15 times.
J11
U
In green, the guaranteed
operating range of the SPD.
Up
Uc
I
< 1 mA
In
Imax
b Type 1 SPD
v Iimp: Impulse current
This is the peak value of a current of 10/350 µs waveform that the SPD is capable of
discharging 5 times.
v Ifi: Autoextinguish follow current
Applicable only to the spark gap technology.
This is the current (50 Hz) that the SPD is capable of interrupting by itself after
flashover. This current must always be greater than the prospective short-circuit
current at the point of installation.
b Type 2 SPD
v Imax: Maximum discharge current
This is the peak value of a current of 8/20 µs waveform that the SPD is capable of
discharging once.
b Type 3 SPD
v Uoc: Open-circuit voltage applied during class III (Type 3) tests.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J19 : Time/current characteristic of a SPD with varistor
J - Overvoltage protection
2 Principle of lightning protection
2.4.2
Main applications
b Low Voltage SPD
Very different devices, from both a technological and usage viewpoint, are
designated by this term. Low voltage SPDs are modular to be easily installed inside
LV switchboards.
There are also SPDs adaptable to power sockets, but these devices have a low
discharge capacity.
b SPD for communication networks
These devices protect telephon networks, switched networks and automatic control
networks (bus) against overvoltages coming from outside (lightning) and those
internal to the power supply network (polluting equipment, switchgear operation,
etc.).
Such SPDs are also installed in RJ11, RJ45, ... connectors or integrated into loads.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
J12
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
3.1 Design rules
To protect an electrical installation in a building,
simple rules apply for the choice of
b SPD(s);
b its protection system.
For a power distribution system, the main characteristics used to define the lightning
protection system and select a SPD to protect an electrical installation in a building
are:
b SPD
v quantity of SPD;
v type;
v level of exposure to define the SPD's maximum discharge current Imax.
b Short circuit protection device
v maximum discharge current Imax;
v short-circuit current Isc at the point of installation.
The logic diagram in the Figure J20 below illustrates this design rule.
Surge Protective
Device (SPD)
No
Low
20 kA
Is there a lightning rod
on the building or within
50 metres of the building ?
Yes
Type2
SPD
Type 1 + Type2
or
Type 1+2
SPD
Risks level ?
Risks level ?
Medium
40 kA
High
65 kA
12,5 kA
mini.
Imax
J13
25 kA
Iimp
Isc
at the installation point ?
Short Circuit
Protection Device (SCPD)
Fig. J20 : Logic diagram for selection of a protection system
This sub-section J3 describes in greater detail the criteria for selection of the
protection system according to the characteristics of the installation, the equipment
to be protected and the environment.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The other characteristics for selection of a SPD are predefined for an electrical
installation.
b number of poles in SPD;
b voltage protection level Up;
b operating voltage Uc.
J - Overvoltage protection
A SPD must always be installed at the origin of
the electrical installation.
3.2 Elements of the protection system
3.2.1 Location and type of SPD
The type of SPD to be installed at the origin of the installation depends on whether
or not a lightning protection system is present. If the building is fitted with a lightning
protection system (as per IEC 62305), a Type 1 SPD should be installed.
For SPD installed at the incoming end of the installation, the IEC 60364 installation
standards lay down minimum values for the following 2 characteristics:
b Nominal discharge current In = 5 kA (8/20) μs;
b Voltage protection level
Up (at In) < 2.5 kV.
The number of additional SPDs to be installed is determined by:
b the size of the site and the difficulty of installing bonding conductors. On large
sites, it is essential to install a SPD at the incoming end of each subdistribution
enclosure.
b the distance separating sensitive loads to be protected from the incoming-end
protection device. When the loads are located more than 30 meters away from
the incoming-end protection device, it is necessary to provide for additional fine
protection as close as possible to sensitive loads. The phenomena of wave reflection
is increasing from 10 meters (see chapter 6.5)
b the risk of exposure. In the case of a very exposed site, the incoming-end SPD
cannot ensure both a high flow of lightning current and a sufficiently low voltage
protection level. In particular, a Type 1 SPD is generally accompanied by a Type 2
SPD.
The table in Figure J21 below shows the quantity and type of SPD to be set up on
the basis of the two factors defined above.
J14
No
Yes
Is there a lightning rod on the building or
within 50 metres of the building ?
one Type 1 and one Type 2 SPD (or one Type 1+2 SPD)
in the main switchboard
one Type 2 SPD in the main switchboard
D < 30 m
Incoming
circuit breaker
Distance (D) separating sensitive equipment from
lightning protection system installed
in main switchboard
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Incoming
circuit breaker
Type 1
+
Type 2
SPD
Type 2
SPD
D
D
one Type 2 SPD in main switchboard
one Type 2/Type 3 SPD in the enclosure close to sensitive equipment
one Type 1 and one Type 2 SPD (or one Type 1+2 SPD)
in the main switchboard
one Type 2/Type 3 SPD in the enclosure close to sensitive equipment
Incoming
circuit breaker
Type 2
SPD
Incoming
circuit breaker
Type 1
+
Type 2
SPD
Type 3
SPD
D > 30 m
Type 3
SPD
D
D
Fig. J21 : The 4 cases of SPD implementation
Note : The Type 1 SPD is installed in the electrical switchboard connected to the earth lead of the lightning protection system.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
3.2.2 Protection distributed levels
Several protection levels of SPD allows the energy to be distributed among several
SPDs, as shown in Figure J22 in which the three types of SPD are provided for:
b Type 1: when the building is fitted with a lightning protection system and located at
the incoming end of the installation, it absorbs a very large quantity of energy;
b Type 2: absorbs residual overvoltages;
b Type 3: provides "fine" protection if necessary for the most sensitive equipment
located very close to the loads.
Main LV
Switchboard
Subdistribution
Board
Fine Protection
Enclosure
(incoming protection)
90 %
9%
1%
Sensitive
Equipment
Type 1
SPD
Type 2
SPD
Type 3
SPD
J15
Discharge Capacity (%)
Fig. J22 : Fine protection architecture
Note: The Type 1 and 2 SPD can be combined in a single SPD
N
PRD1 25 r
L1
L2
L3
PRD1 25 r
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J23 : The PRD1 25r SPD fulfils the two functions of Type 1 and Type 2 (Type 1+2) in the same product
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
3.3 Common characteristics of SPDs according to
the installation characteristics
3.3.1 Operating voltage Uc
Depending on the system earthing arrangement, the maximum continuous operating
voltage Uc of SPD must be equal to or greater than the values shown in the table in
Figure J24.
SPDs connected
between
J16
System configuration of distribution network
TT
TN-C
TN-S
IT with
IT without
distributed distributed
neutral
neutral
Line conductor and
neutral conductor
1.1 Uo
NA
1.1 Uo
1.1 Uo
NA
Each line conductor and
PE conductor
1.1 Uo
NA
1.1 Uo
3Uo
Vo
Neutral conductor and PE
conductor
Uo
NA
Uo
Uo
NA
Each line conductor and
PEN conductor
NA
1.1 Uo
NA
NA
NA
NA: not applicable
NOTE 1: Uo is the line-to-neutral voltage, Vo is the line-to-line voltage of the low voltage system.
NOTE 2: This table is based on IEC 61643-1 amendment 1.
Fig. J24 : Stipulated minimum value of Uc for SPDs depending on the system earthing
arrangement (based on Table 53C of the IEC 60364-5-53 standard)
The most common values of Uc chosen according to the system earthing
arrangement.
TT, TN: 260, 320, 340, 350 V
IT:
440, 460 V
3.3.2 Voltage protection level Up (at In)
The 443-4 section of IEC 60364 standard, “Selection of equipment in the
installation”, helps with the choice of the protection level Up for the SPD in function
of the loads to be protected. The table of Figure J25 indicates the impulse withstand
capability of each kind of equipment.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Nominal voltage of
the installation(1) V
Three-phase Single-phase
systems(2)
systems with
middle point
230/400(2)
277/480(2)
400/690
1,000
120-240
-
Required impulse withstand voltage for
kV
Equipment at Equipment of
Appliances
the origin of
distribution and
the installation final circuits
(impulse
(impulse
(impulse
withstand
withstand
withstand
category IV)
category III)
category II)
4
2.5
1.5
6
4
2.5
-
8
6
4
Values subject to system engineers
Specially
protected
equipment
(impulse
withstand
category I)
0.8
1.5
2.5
(1) As per IEC 60038.
(2) In Canada and the United States, for voltages exceeding 300 V relative to earth, the impulse
withstand voltage corresponding to the immediately higher voltage in the column is applicable.
(3) This impulse withstand voltage is applicable between live conductors and the PE conductor
Fig. J25 : Equipment impulse withstand category for an installation in conformity with IEC 60364
(Table 44B).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
b Equipment of overvoltage category I is
only suitable for use in the fixed installation of
buildings where protective means are applied
outside the equipment – to limit transient
overvoltages to the specified level.
Examples of such equipment are those
containing electronic circuits like computers,
appliances with electronic programmes, etc.
b Equipment of overvoltage category II is
suitable for connection to the fixed electrical
installation, providing a normal degree of
availability normally required for current-using
equipment.
Examples of such equipment are household
appliances and similar loads.
b Equipment of overvoltage category III is for
use in the fixed installation downstream of,
and including the main distribution board,
providing a high degree of availability.
Examples of such equipment are distribution
boards, circuit-breakers, wiring systems
including cables, bus-bars, junction boxes,
switches, socket-outlets) in the fixed
installation, and equipment for industrial use
and some other equipment, e.g. stationary
motors with permanent connection to the
fixed installation.
b Equipment of overvoltage category IV is
suitable for use at, or in the proximity of,
the origin of the installation, for example
upstream of the main distribution board.
Examples of such equipment are electricity
meters, primary overcurrent protection
devices and ripple control units.
J17
Fig. J26 : Overvoltage category of equipment
The "installed" Up performance should be compared with the impulse withstand
capability of the loads.
SPD has a voltage protection level Up that is intrinsic, i.e. defined and tested
independently of its installation. In practice, for the choice of Up performance of a
SPD, a safety margin must be taken to allow for the overvoltages inherent in the
installation of the SPD (see Fig. J27).
U1
Up
Loads
to be
protected
Installed
= Up + U1 + U2
Up
Fig. J27 : "Installed" Up
The "installed" voltage protection level Up generally adopted to protect sensitive
equipment in 230/400 V electrical installations is 2.5 kV (overvoltage category II,
Note:
If the stipulated voltage protection level cannot be achieved
by the incoming-end SPD or if sensitive equipment items are
remote (see section 3.2.1), additional coordinated SPD must
be installed to achieve the required protection level.
see Fig. J28).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
U2
J - Overvoltage protection
3.3.3 Number of poles
b Depending on the system earthing arrangement, it is necessary to provide for a
SPD architecture ensuring protection in common mode (CM) and differential mode
(DM).
TT
TN-C
TN-S
IT
Phase-to-neutral (DM)
Recommended1
-
Recommended
Not useful
Phase-to-earth (PE or PEN) (CM)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Neutral-to-earth (PE) (CM)
Yes
-
Yes
Yes2
1
The protection between phase and neutral can either be incorporated in the SPD placed at the origin of the
installation, or be remoted close to the equipment to be protected
If neutal distributed
2
Fig. J28 : Protection need according to the system earthing arrangement
Note:
b Common-mode overvoltage
A basic form of protection is to install a SPD in common mode between phases and
the PE (or PEN) conductor, whatever the type of system earthing arrangement used.
b Differential-mode overvoltage
In the TT and TN-S systems, earthing of the neutral results in an asymmetry due to
earth impedances which leads to the appearance of differential-mode voltages, even
though the overvoltage induced by a lightning stroke is common-mode.
2P, 3P and 4P SPDs (see Fig. J29)
J18
b These are adapted to the TT and TN-S systems.
b They provide protection merely against common-mode overvoltages.
Fig. J29 : 2P, 3P, 4P SPDs
1P + N, 3P + N SPDs (see Fig. J30)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b These are adapted to the TT and TN-S systems.
b They provide protection against common-mode and differential-mode overvoltages.
Fig. J30 : 1P + N, 3P + N SPDs
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
3.4 Selection of a Type 1 SPD
3.4.1 Impulse current Iimp
b Where there are no national regulations or specific regulations for the type of
building to be protected:
the impulse current Iimp shall be at least 12.5 kA (10/350 µs wave) per branch in
accordance with IEC 60364-5-534.
b Where regulations exist:
standard 62305-2 defines 4 levels: I, II, III and IV
The table in Figure J31 shows the different levels of Iimp in the regulatory case.
Protection level
as per EN 62305-2
External lightning
protection system
designed to handle direct
flash of:
Minimum required Iimp for
Type 1 SPD for line-neutral
network
I
200 kA
25 kA/pole
II
150 kA
18.75 kA/pole
III / IV
100 kA
12.5 kA/pole
Fig. J31 : Table of Iimp values according to the building's voltage protection level (based on
IEC/EN 62305-2)
3.4.2 Autoextinguish follow current Ifi
J19
This characteristic is applicable only for SPDs with spark gap technology. The
autoextinguish follow current Ifi must always be greater than the prospective shortcircuit current Isc at the point of installation.
3.5 Selection of a Type 2 SPD
3.5.1 Maximum discharge current Imax
The maximum discharge current Imax is defined according to the estimated
exposure level relative to the building's location.
The value of the maximum discharge current (Imax) is determined by a risk analysis
(see table in Figure J32).
Exposure level
Low
Medium
High
Building environment
Building located in an urban
or suburban area of grouped
housing
Building located in a plain
Building where there is a
specific risk: pylon, tree,
mountainous region, wet area
or pond, etc.
Recommended Imax
value (kÂ)
20
40
65
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J32 : Recommended maximum discharge current Imax according to the exposure level
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
The protection devices (thermal and short
circuit) must be coordinated with the SPD to
ensure reliable operation, i.e.
b ensure continuity of service:
v withstand lightning current waves;
v not generate excessive residual voltage.
b ensure effective protection against all types of
overcurrent:
v overload following thermal runaway of the
varistor;
v short circuit of low intensity (impedant);
v short circuit of high intensity.
3.6 Selection of external Short Circuit Protection
Device (SCPD)
3.6.1 Risks to be avoided at end of life of the SPDs
b Due to ageing
In the case of natural end of life due to ageing, protection is of the thermal type. SPD
with varistors must have an internal disconnector which disables the SPD.
Note: End of life through thermal runaway does not concern SPD with gas discharge
tube or encapsulated spark gap.
b Due to a fault
The causes of end of life due to a short-circuit fault are:
v Maximum discharge capacity exceeded.
This fault results in a strong short circuit.
v A fault due to the distribution system (neutral/phase switchover, neutral
disconnection).
v Gradual deterioration of the varistor.
The latter two faults result in an impedant short circuit.
The installation must be protected from damage resulting from these types of fault:
the internal (thermal) disconnector defined above does not have time to warm up,
hence to operate.
A special device called "external Short Circuit Protection Device (external SCPD) ",
capable of eliminating the short circuit, should be installed. It can be implemented by
a circuit breaker or fuse device.
J20
3.6.2 Characteristics of the external SCPD
The external SCPD should be coordinated with the SPD. It is designed to meet the
following two constraints:
Lightning current withstand
The lightning current withstand is an essential characteristic of the SPD's external
Short Circuit Protection Device.
The external SCPD must not trip upon 15 successive impulse currents at In.
Short-circuit current withstand
b The breaking capacity is determined by the installation rules (IEC 60364
standard):
The external SCPD should have a breaking capacity equal to or greater than the
prospective short-circuit current Isc at the installation point (in accordance with the
IEC 60364 standard).
b Protection of the installation against short circuits
In particular, the impedant short circuit dissipates a lot of energy and should be
eliminated very quickly to prevent damage to the installation and to the SPD.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The right association between a SPD and its external SCPD must be given by the
manufacturer.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
3.6.3 Installation mode for the external SCPD
b Device "in series"
The SCPD is described as "in series" (see Fig. J33) when the protection is
performed by the general protection device of the network to be protected (for
example, connection circuit breaker upstream of an installation).
Fig. J33 : SCPD "in series"
b Device "in parallel"
The SCPD is described as "in parallel" (see Fig. J34) when the protection is
performed specifically by a protection device associated with the SPD.
b The external SCPD is called a "disconnecting circuit breaker" if the function is
performed by a circuit breaker.
b The disconnecting circuit breaker may or may not be integrated into the SPD.
J21
Fig. J34 : SCPD "in parallel"
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Note:
In the case of a SPD with gas discharge tube or encapsulated spark gap, the SCPD
allows the current to be cut immediately after use.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
3.6.4 Guarantee of protection
The external SCPD should be coordinated with the SPD, and tested and guaranteed
by the SPD manufacturer in accordance with the recommendations of the IEC
61643-11 standard (NF EN 61643-1) Chap. 7.7.3. It should also be installed in
accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations.
When this device is integrated, conformity with product standard IEC 61643-11
naturally ensures protection.
+
Fig. J35 : SPDs with external SCPD, non-integrated (iC60 + PRD 40r) and integrated (Quick
PRD 40r)
3.6.5 Summary of external SCPDs characteristics
A detailed analysis of the characteristics is given in section 6.4.
The table in Figure J36 shows, on an example, a summary of the characteristics
according to the various types of external SCPD.
J22
Installation mode for the
external SCPD
Surge protection of
equipment
Protection of installation
at end of life
Continuity of service at
end of life
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Maintenance at end
of life
In series
In parallel
Fuse protection
associated
=
Circuit breaker protection
associated
=
Circuit breaker protection
integrated
=
=
SPDs protect the equipment satisfactorily whatever the kind of associated external SCPD
No guarantee of protection
possible
-The complete installation is
shut down
-Shutdown of the installation
required
=
+
Manufacturer's guarantee
Protection from impedant short
circuits not well ensured
++
Full guarantee
Protection from short circuits perfectly ensured
+
+
+
+
+
Only the SPD circuit is shut down
=
Change of fuses
Immediate resetting
Fig. J36 : Characteristics of end-of-life protection of a Type 2 SPD according to the external SCPDs
3.7 SPD and protection device coordination table
The table in Figure J37 below shows the coordination of disconnecting circuit
breakers (external SCPD) for Type 1 and 2 SPDs of the Schneider Electric brand for
all levels of short-circuit currents.
Coordination between SPD and its disconnecting circuit breakers, indicated and
guaranteed by Schneider Electric, ensures reliable protection (lightning wave
withstand, reinforced protection of impedant short-circuit currents, etc.)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Design of the electrical
installation protection system
Isc (kA)
Type 2 - class II
Type 1 - class I
SCPD not integrated
SCPD integrated
70
Need a more specific study
50
NG125L
80A(1)
NG125L
80A(1)
PRF1(3)
12.5r
PRD1(3)
Master
NG125H
80A(1)
NG125H
80A(1)
PRF1(3)
12.5r
PRD1
Master
36
25
NG125N(2)
40A(2)
NG125N(2)
50A(2)
NG125N
80A(1)
iPF 20/
iPRD 20r
iPF 40/
iPRD 40r
iPF 65/
iPRD 65r
PRF1(3)
12.5r
iC60H
25A(1)
iC60H
40A(1)
iC60H
50A(1)
iPF 40/
iPRD 40r
iPF 65/
iPRD 65r
iC60L
20A(1)
iC60L
25A(1)
iPF 8/
iPRD 8r
iC60H
20A(1)
15
iQuick
PRDxx
iPF 8/
iPRD 8r
Quick
iPRD20r
iPF 20/
iPRD20r
Quick
iPRD 40r
C120H or
NG125N
80A(1)
J23
NG125N
80A(1)
PRF1(3)
12.5r
10
iC60N
20A(1)
iC60N
25A(1)
iC60N
40A(1)
iC60N
50A(1)
C120N
80A(1)
PRD1
25r
6
iPF 8/
iPRD 8r
iPF 20/
iPRD 20r
iPF 40/
iPRD 40r
iPF 65/
iPRD 65r
PRF1 12.5r(3)
Imax
8 kA
20 kA
40 kA
65 kA
Low risk
Medium risk
High risk
No lightning rod
Fig. J37 : Coordination table between SPDs and their disconnecting circuit breakers of the Schneider Electric brand
(1): All circuit breakers are C curve - (2): NG 125 L for 1P & 2P - (3): Also Type 2 (class II) tested
12.5 kA
25 kA
Maximum risk
Lightning rod on
the building or within
50 m of the building
3.7.1 Coordination with upstream protection devices
Note: S type residual current devices in conformity with the IEC
61008 or IEC 61009-1 standards comply with this requirement.
Coordination with overcurrent protection devices
In an electrical installation, the external SCPD is an apparatus identical to the
protection apparatus: this makes it possible to apply discrimination and cascading
techniques for technical and economic optimization of the protection plan.
Coordination with residual current devices
If the SPD is installed downstream of an earth leakage protection device, the latter
should be of the "si" or selective type with an immunity to pulse currents of at least 3
kA (8/20 µs current wave).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Dedicated protection to be added
when equipment is more than 30m
from switchboard.
J - Overvoltage protection
4 Installation of SPDs
4.1 Connection
Connections of a SPD to the loads should be as
short as possible in order to reduce the value of
the voltage protection level (installed Up) on the
terminals of the protected equipment.
The total length of SPD connections to the
network and the earth terminal block should not
exceed 50 cm.
One of the essential characteristics for the protection of equipment is the maximum
voltage protection level (installed Up) that the equipment can withstand at its
terminals. Accordingly, a SPD should be chosen with a voltage protection level
Up adapted to protection of the equipment (see Fig. J38). The total length of the
connection conductors is
L = L1+L2+L3.
For high-frequency currents, the impedance per unit length of this connection is
approximately 1 µH/m.
Hence, applying Lenz's law to this connection: ΔU = L di/dt
The normalized 8/20 µs current wave, with a current amplitude of 8 kA, accordingly
creates a voltage rise of 1000 V per metre of cable.
ΔU =1 x 10-6 x 8 x 103 /8 x 10-6 = 1000 V
U equipment
L1
disconnection
circuit-breaker
U1
L2
L = L1 + L2 + L3 < 50 cm
SPD
load to be
protected
Up
L3
U2
J24
Fig. J38 : Connections of a SPD L < 50 cm
As a result the voltage across the equipment terminals, installed Up, is:
installed Up = Up + U1 + U2
If L1+L2+L3 = 50 cm, and the wave is 8/20 µs with an amplitude of 8 kÂ, the voltage
across the equipment terminals will be Up + 500 V.
4.1.1 Connection in plastic enclosure
Figure J39a below shows how to connect a SPD in plastic enclosure.
L2
L1
Circuit breaker
L3
SPD
Earth auxiliairy
block
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Earth distribution
block
to load
Fig. J39a : Example of connection in plastic enclosure
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Installation of SPDs
4.1.2 Connection in metallic enclosure
In the case of a switchgear assembly in a metallic enclosure, it may be wise to
connect the SPD directly to the metallic enclosure, with the enclosure being used as
a protective conductor (see Fig. J39b).
This arrangement complies with standard IEC 61439-2 and the ASSEMBLY
manufacturer must make sure that the characteristics of the enclosure make this use
possible.
L1
Circuit breaker
L2
SPD
L3
Earth distribution
block
to load
Fig. J39b : Example of connection in metallic enclosure
J25
4.1.3 Conductor cross section
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The recommended minimum conductor cross section takes into account:
b The normal service to be provided: Flow of the lightning current wave under a
maximum voltage drop (50 cm rule).
Note: Unlike applications at 50 Hz, the phenomenon of lightning being highfrequency, the increase in the conductor cross section does not greatly reduce its
high-frequency impedance.
b The conductors' withstand to short-circuit currents: The conductor must resist a
short-circuit current during the maximum protection system cutoff time.
IEC 60364 recommends at the installation incoming end a minimum cross section of:
v 4 mm² (Cu) for connection of Type 2 SPD;
v 16 mm² (Cu) for connection of Type 1 SPD (presence of lightning protection
system).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
4.2 Cabling rules
b Rule 1:
The first rule to comply with is that the length of the SPD connections between the
network (via the external SCPD) and the earthing terminal block should not exceed
50 cm.
Figure J40 shows the two possibilities for connection of a SPD.
d1
d1
D
k PR
QuicPD
S
D
SCP
d2
d3
(8/20)
65kA(8/20)
Imax:
In: 20kA
1,5kV
Up: 340Va
Uc:
SPD
d3
J26
d2
d1 +
< 50
+ d3
cm
d1 +
d3
35 cm
Fig. 40 : SPD with separate or integrated external SCPD
b Rule 2:
The conductors of protected outgoing feeders:
b should be connected to the terminals of the external SCPD or the SPD;
b should be separated physically from the polluted incoming conductors.
They are located to the right of the terminals of the SPD and the SCPD (see
Fig. J41).
Power supply
Protected feeders
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
iQuick PRDxx
Fig. 41 : The connections of protected outgoing feeders are to the right of the SPD terminals
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Installation of SPDs
b Rule 3:
The incoming feeder phase, neutral and protection (PE) conductors should run one
beside another in order to reduce the loop surface (see Fig. J42).
b Rule 4:
The incoming conductors of the SPD should be remote from the protected outgoing
conductors to avoid polluting them by coupling (see Fig. J42).
b Rule 5:
The cables should be pinned against the metallic parts of the enclosure (if any) in
order to minimize the surface of the frame loop and hence benefit from a shielding
effect against EM disturbances.
In all cases, it must be checked that the frames of switchboards and enclosures are
earthed via very short connections.
Finally, if shielded cables are used, big lengths should be avoided, because they
reduce the efficiency of shielding (see Fig. J42).
Clean cables polluted by
neighbouring polluted cables
Clean cable paths separated
from polluted cable paths
protected
outgoing
feeders
NO
Intermediate
earth terminal
Main earth
terminal
Large
frame
loop
surface
Small
frame
loop
surface
YES
J27
Intermediate
earth
terminal
Main earth
terminal
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. 42 : Example of improvement of EMC by a reduction in the loop surfaces and common
impedance in an electric enclosure
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
5 Application
5.1 Installation examples
MV/LV transformer
160 kVA
Main
switchboard
iC60
40 A
PRD
40 kA
Switchboard 1
Switchboard
2
iC60
20 A
ID
"si"
ID
"si"
PRD
8 kA
J28
iC60
20 A
PRD
8 kA
Heating
Lighting
Storeroom lighting
Freezer Refrigerator
Power outlets
Fire-fighting system
Alarm
IT system Checkout
Fig. J43 : Application example: supermarket
Solutions and schematic diagram
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b The surge arrester selection guide has made it possible to determine the precise
value of the surge arrester at the incoming end of the installation and that of the
associated disconnection circuit breaker.
b As the sensitive devices (Uimp < 1.5 kV) are located more than 30 m from the
incoming protection device, the fine protection surge arresters must be installed as
close as possible to the loads.
b To ensure better continuity of service for cold room areas:
v"si" type residual current circuit breakers will be used to avoid nuisance tripping
caused by the rise in earth potential as the lightning wave passes through.
b For protection against atmospheric overvoltages:
v install a surge arrester in the main switchboard
v install a fine protection surge arrester in each switchboard (1 and 2) supplying the
sensitive devices situated more than 30 m from the incoming surge arrester
v install a surge arrester on the telecommunications network to protect the devices
supplied, for example fire alarms, modems, telephones, faxes.
Cabling recommendations
b Ensure the equipotentiality of the earth terminations of the building.
b Reduce the looped power supply cable areas.
Installation recommendations
Fig. J44 : Telecommunications network
b Install a surge arrester, Imax = 40 kA (8/20 µs) and a iC60 disconnection circuit
breaker rated at 20 A.
b Install fine protection surge arresters, Imax = 8 kA (8/20 µs) and the associated
iC60 disconnection circuit breakers rated at 20
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Application
5.2 SPD for Photovoltaic application
Overvoltage may occur in electrical installations for various reasons. It may be
caused by:
b The distribution network as a result of lightning or any work carried out.
b Lightning strikes (nearby or on buildings and PV installations, or on lightning
conductors).
b Variations in the electrical field due to lightning.
Like all outdoor structures, PV installations are exposed to the risk of lightning which
varies from region to region. Preventive and arrest systems and devices should be in
place.
5.2.1. Protection by equipotential bonding
The first safeguard to put in place is a medium (conductor) that ensures equipotential
bonding between all the conductive parts of a PV installation.
The aim is to bond all grounded conductors and metal parts and so create equal
potential at all points in the installed system.
5.2.2. Protection by surge protection devices (SPDs)
SPDs are particularly important to protect sensitive electrical equipments like AC/DC
Inverter, monitoring devices and PV modules, but also other sensitive equipments
powered by the 230 VAC electrical distribution network. The following method of risk
assessment is based on the evaluation of the critical length Lcrit and its comparison
with L the cumulative length of the d.c. lines.
SPD protection is required if L Lcrit.
Lcrit depends on the type of PV installation and is calculated as the following table
(Fig.J45) sets out:
Type of installation
Individual residential
premises
Terrestrial production
plant
Service/Industrial/
Agricultural/Buildings
Lcrit (in m)
L Lcrit
115/Ng
200/Ng
450/Ng
Surge protective device(s) compulsory on DC side
L < Lcrit
Surge protective device(s) not compulsory on DC side
J29
Fig. J45 : SPD DC choice
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L is the sum of:
b the sum of distances between the inverter(s) and the junction box(es),
taking into account that the lengths of cable located in the same conduit are
counted only once, and
b the sum of distances between the junction box and the connection points
of the photovoltaic modules forming the string, taking into account that the
lengths of cable located in the same conduit are counted only once.
Ng is arc lightning density (number of strikes/km²/year).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
Array box
SPD
1
Generator box
AC box
SPD
2
SPD
3
LDC
Main LV switch
board
LAC
SPD
4
SPD Protection
Location
PV modules or
Array boxes
Inverter
DC side
Inverter AC side
LAC
LDC
Criteria
< 10 m
> 10 m
Type of
SPD
No
need
"SPD 1"
Type 2*
Main board
"SPD 2"
Type 2*
Lightning rod
< 10 m
> 10 m
Yes
No
No need
"SPD 3"
Type 2*
"SPD 4"
Type 1*
"SPD 4"
Type 2 if
Ng > 2,5 &
overhead
line
* Type 1 separation distance according to EN 62305 is not observed.
Fig. J46 : SPD selection
J30
Installing an SPD
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The number and location of SPDs on the DC side depend on the length of
the cables between the solar panels and inverter. The SPD should be installed
in the vicinity of the inverter if the length is less than 10 metres. If it is greater
than 10 metres, a second SPD is necessary and should be located in the box
close to the solar panel, the first one is located in the inverter area.
To be efficient, SPD connection cables to the L+ / L- network and between
the SPD’s earth terminal block and ground busbar must be as short as
possible – less than 2.5 metres (d1+d2<50 cm).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Application
Safe and reliable photovoltaic energy generation
Depending on the distance between the "generator" part and the "conversion" part, it may be necessary to install two surge arresters or more, to ensure protection of
each of the two parts.
-+
-+
-+
d1
+
d2
-+
d3
IPRD-DC
1
d y 10 m
-+
N
L
+
-+
+
d1
d2
> 4 mm2
d1 + d2 < 50 cm
d1 + d3 < 50 cm
d2 + d3 < 50 cm
d3
J31
IPRD-DC
2
d >10 m
d1
d2
+
N
L
d3
IPRD-DC
1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J47 : SPD location
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
6 Technical supplements
6.1 Lightning protection standards
The IEC 62305 standard parts 1 to 4 (NF EN 62305 parts 1 to 4) reorganizes and
updates the standard publications IEC 61024 (series), IEC 61312 (series) and IEC
61663 (series) on lightning protection systems.
b Part 1 - General principles:
This part presents general information on lightning and its characteristics and
general data, and introduces the other documents.
b Part 2 - Risk management:
This part presents the analysis making it possible to calculate the risk for a structure
and to determine the various protection scenarios in order to permit technical and
economic optimization.
b Part 3 - Physical damage to structures and life hazard:
This part describes protection from direct lightning strokes, including the lightning
protection system, down-conductor, earth lead, equipotentiality and hence SPD with
equipotential bonding (Type 1 SPD).
b Part 4 - Electrical and electronic systems within structures:
This part describes protection from the induced effects of lightning, including the
protection system by SPD (Types 2 and 3), cable shielding, rules for installation of
SPD, etc.
This series of standards is supplemented by:
b the IEC 61643 series of standards for the definition of surge protection products
(see sub-section 2);
b the IEC 60364-4 and -5 series of standards for application of the products in LV
electrical installations (see sub-section 3).
J32
6.2 The components of a SPD
The SPD chiefly consists of (see Fig. J48):
1) one or more nonlinear components: the live part (varistor, gas discharge tube,
etc.);
2) a thermal protective device (internal disconnector) which protects it from thermal
runaway at end of life (SPD with varistor);
3) an indicator which indicates end of life of the SPD;
Some SPDs allow remote reporting of this indication;
4) an external SCPD which provides protection against short circuits (this device can
be integrated into the SPD).
4
3
2
1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J48 : Diagram of a SPD
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Technical supplements
6.2.1 Technology of the live part
Several technologies are available to implement the live part. They each have
advantages and disadvantages:
b Zener diodes;
b The gas discharge tube (controlled or not controlled);
b The varistor (zinc oxide varistor).
The table below shows the characteristics and the arrangements of 3 commonly
used technologies.
Component
Gas Discharge Tube
(GDT)
Encapsulated spark
gap
Zinc oxide varistor
GDT and varistor in
series
Encapsulated spark
gap and varistor in
parallel
Voltage switching
Voltage switching
Voltage limiting
Voltage-switching and
-limiting in series
Voltage-switching and
-limiting in parallel
Characteristics
Operating mode
Operating curves
u
u
I
I
Application
b Telecom network
b LV network
J33
LV network
LV network
LV network
LV network
Type 1
Type 1 ou Type 2
Type 1+ Type 2
Type 1+ Type 2
(associated with
varistor)
Type
Type 2
Fig. J49 : Summary performance table
Note: Two technologies can be installed in the same SPD (see Fig. J50)
N
L1
L2
L3
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J50 : The Schneider Electric brand PRD SPD incorporates a gas discharge tube between
neutral and earth and varistors between phase and neutral
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
J - Overvoltage protection
6.3 End-of-life indication
End-of-life indicators are associated with the internal disconnector and the external
SCPD of the SPD to informs the user that the equipment is no longer protected
against overvoltages of atmospheric origin.
Local indication
This function is generally required by the installation codes.
The end-of-life indication is given by an indicator (luminous or mechanical) to the
internal disconnector and/or the external SCPD.
When the external SCPD is implemented by a fuse device, it is necessary to provide
for a fuse with a striker and a base equipped with a tripping system to ensure this
function.
Integrated disconnecting circuit breaker
The mechanical indicator and the position of the control handle allow natural end-oflife indication.
6.3.1 Local indication and remote reporting
iQuick PRD SPD of the Schneider Electric brand is of the "ready to wire" type with an
integrated disconnecting circuit breaker.
Local indication
iQuick PRD SPD (see Fig. J51) is fitted with local mechanical status indicators:
b the (red) mechanical indicator and the position of the disconnecting circuit breaker
handle indicate shutdown of the SPD;
b the (red) mechanical indicator on each cartridge indicates cartridge end of life.
Fig. J51 : iQuick PRD 3P +N SPD of the Schneider
Electric brand
Remote reporting (see Fig. J52)
iQuick PRD SPD is fitted with an indication contact which allows remote reporting of:
b cartridge end of life;
b a missing cartridge, and when it has been put back in place;
b a fault on the network (short circuit, disconnection of neutral, phase/neutral
reversal);
b local manual switching.
As a result, remote monitoring of the operating condition of the installed SPDs
makes it possible to ensure that these protective devices in standby state are always
ready to operate.
J34
6.3.2 Maintenance at end of life
Fig. J52 : Installation of indicator light with a iQuick PRD
SPD
When the end-of-life indicator indicates shutdown, the SPD (or the cartridge in
question) must be replaced.
In the case of the iQuick PRD SPD, maintenance is facilitated:
b The cartridge at end of life (to be replaced) is easily identifiable by the Maintenance
Department.
b The cartridge at end of life can be replaced in complete safety, because a safety
device prohibits closing of the disconnecting circuit breaker if a cartridge is missing.
6.4 Detailed characteristics of the external SCPD
6.4.1 Current wave withstand
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The current wave withstand tests on external SCPDs show as follows:
b For a given rating and technology (NH or cylindrical fuse), the current wave
withstand capability is better with an aM type fuse (motor protection) than with a gG
type fuse (general use).
b For a given rating, the current wave withstand capability is better with a circuit
breaker than with a fuse device.
Figure J53 below shows the results of the voltage wave withstand tests:
b to protect a SPD defined for Imax = 20 kA, the external SCPD to be chosen is
either a MCCB 16 A or a Fuse aM 63 A,
Note: in this case, a Fuse gG 63 A is not suitable.
b to protect a SPD defined for Imax = 40 kA, the external SCPD to be chosen is
either a MCCB 63 A or a Fuse aM 125 A,
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Technical supplements
Fuse gG 125 A
MCB 63 A
MCB 40 A
Fuse aM 63 A
Fuse gG 63 A
MCB 16 A
10
30
20
40
Withstand
I kA
(8/20) µs
50
Melting or tripping
Fig. J53 : Comparison of SCPDs voltage wave withstand capabilities for Imax = 20 kA and Imax = 40 kA
6.4.2 Installed Up voltage protection level
In general:
b The voltage drop across the terminals of a circuit breaker is higher than that across
the terminals of a fuse device. This is because the impedance of the circuit-breaker
components (thermal and magnetic tripping devices) is higher than that of a fuse.
However:
b The difference between the voltage drops remains slight for current waves not
exceeding 10 kA (95% of cases);
b The installed Up voltage protection level also takes into account the cabling
impedance. This can be high in the case of a fuse technology (protection device
remote from the SPD) and low in the case of a circuit-breaker technology (circuit
breaker close to, and even integrated into the SPD).
Note: The installed Up voltage protection level is the sum of the voltage drops:
v in the SPD;
v in the external SCPD;
v in the equipment cabling.
J35
6.4.3 Protection from impedant short circuits
An impedant short circuit dissipates a lot of energy and should be eliminated very
quickly to prevent damage to the installation and to the SPD.
Figure J54 compares the response time and the energy limitation of a protection
system by a 63 A aM fuse and a 25 A circuit breaker.
These two protection systems have the same 8/20 µs current wave withstand
capability (27 kA and 30 kA respectively).
s
A²s
In green colour,
the impedant
short circuit area
2
0,01
350
2000
MCB 25 A
A
350
2000
Fuse aM 63 A
Fig. J54 : Comparison of time/current and energy limitations curves for a circuit
breaker and a fuse having the same 8/20 µs current wave withstand capability
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
A
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
104
J - Overvoltage protection
6.5 Propagation of a lightning wave
Electrical networks are low-frequency and, as a result, propagation of the voltage
wave is instantaneous relative to the frequency of the phenomenon: at any point of a
conductor, the instantaneous voltage is the same.
The lightning wave is a high-frequency phenomenon (several hundred kHz to a
MHz):
b The lightning wave is propagated along a conductor at a certain speed relative to
the frequency of the phenomenon. As a result, at any given time, the voltage does
not have the same value at all points on the medium (see Fig. J55).
Voltage wave
Cable
Fig. J55 : Propagation of a lightning wave in a conductor
J36
b A change of medium creates a phenomenon of propagation and/or reflection of the
wave depending on:
v the difference of impedance between the two media;
v the frequency of the progressive wave (steepness of the rise time in the case of a
pulse);
v the length of the medium.
In the case of total reflection in particular, the voltage value may double.
Example: case of protection by a SPD
Modelling of the phenomenon applied to a lightning wave and tests in laboratory
showed that a load powered by 30 m of cable protected upstream by a SPD at
voltage Up sustains, due to reflection phenomena, a maximum voltage of 2 x Up
(see Fig. J56). This voltage wave is not energetic.
Cable
Ui
Uo
V
Uo
2000
Ui
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Ui = Voltage at SPD level
Uo = Voltage at cable termination
9
10
µs
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. J56 : Reflection of a lightning wave at the termination of a cable
Corrective action
Of the three factors (difference of impedance, frequency, distance), the only one that
can really be controlled is the length of cable between the SPD and the load to be
protected. The greater this length, the greater the reflection.
Generally for the overvoltage fronts faced in a building, reflection phenomena are
significant from 10 m and can double the voltage from 30 m (see Fig. J57).
It is necessary to install a second SPD in fine protection if the cable length exceeds
10 m between the incoming-end SPD and the equipment to be protected.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Technical supplements
Up
2
1
0
0
10 m
20 m 30 m 40 m
50 m
Fig. J57 : Maximum voltage at the extremity of the cable according to its length to a
front of incident voltage =4kV/us
6.6 Example of lightning current in TT system
Common mode SPD between phase and PE or phase and PEN is installed whatever
type of system earthing arrangement (see Fig. J58).
The neutral earthing resistor R1 used for the pylons has a lower resistance than the
earthing resistor R2 used for the installation.
The lightning current will flow through circuit ABCD to earth via the easiest path. It
will pass through varistors V1 and V2 in series, causing a differential voltage equal to
twice the Up voltage of the SPD (Up1 + Up2) to appear at the terminals of A and C
at the entrance to the installation in extreme cases.
J37
I
I
I
SPD
I
Fig. J58 : Common protection only
To protect the loads between Ph and N effectively, the differential mode voltage
(between A and C) must be reduced.
Another SPD architecture is therefore used (see Fig. J59)
The lightning current flows through circuit ABH which has a lower impedance than
circuit ABCD, as the impedance of the component used between B and H is null (gas
filled spark gap). In this case, the differential voltage is equal to the residual voltage
of the SPD (Up2).
SPD
I
Fig. J59 : Common and differential protection
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
I
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
I
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter K
Energy efficiency
in electrical distribution
Contents
3
4
5
Energy Efficiency in brief
K2
Energy efficiency and electricity
K3
2.1 An international appetite for regulation
K3
2.2 NF EN 15232 standard
K3
2.3 How to achieve energy efficiency
K3
Diagnosis through electrical measurement
K6
3.1 Electrical measurements
K6
3.2 Adapted measuring instruments
K6
Energy saving opportunities
K8
4.1 Motor-related savings opportunities
K8
4.2 Lighting
K11
4.3 Power factor correction and harmonic filtering
K13
4.4 Load management
K14
4.5 Communication and information systems
K15
4.6 Designing information and monitoring systems
K18
How to evaluate energy savings
K23
5.1 IPMVP and EVO procedures
K23
5.2 Achieving sustainable performance
K25
K1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
1 Energy Efficiency in brief
The aim of this chapter is to facilitate communication between the designers of
electrical installations and the energy consumers who use them. Consumers
frequently require advice on how best to reduce consumption and the amount they
spend on energy.
While there are a number of factors influencing attitudes and opinions towards
energy efficiency, particularly the increasing cost of energy and a growing awareness
of our responsibilities towards the environment, legislation probably has the greatest
impact on changing behaviour and practices. Various governments across the world
are setting themselves energy saving targets and passing regulations to ensure
these are met. Reducing greenhouse gas emissions is a global target set at the
Kyoto Earth Summit in 1997 and was finally ratified by 169 countries in December
2006.
Under the Kyoto Protocol industrialised countries have agreed to reduce their
collective emissions of greenhouse gases by 5.2% compared to the year 1990
between 2008 and 2012 (this represents a 29% reduction in terms of the emissions
levels expected for 2012 prior to the Protocol). One of Europe’s targets is a 20%
reduction in for CO2 by 2020.
Given that 50% of CO2 emissions can be attributed to electricity consumption
associated with residential and commercial buildings, and that the use of domestic
appliances and other equipment such as ventilation and air conditioning systems
increases, a specific focus is done concerning buildings:
b All new buildings constructed must consume 50% less energy.
b 1 in 10 existing buildings must reduce consumption by 30% each year.
As far as most countries are concerned, it is clear that 80% of the buildings which
will be standing in 2020 have already been constructed. The refurbishment of
existing building stock and improving energy management is vital in meeting
emission reduction targets. Given that in the western world, most buildings have
already undergone thermal performance upgrades such as cavity wall insulation,
loft insulation and double-glazing, the only potential for further savings lies in
reducing the amount of energy consumed. Action to improve the thermal and energy
performance of existing buildings will almost certainly become compulsory in order to
meet the targets that have been set out.
Regarding the industrial segment, electrical energy represents 40% of consumed
energy. Amongst these 40%, the rate due to motors is 80%. Focusing efforts
on motors consumption reduction is clearly a good way to start to do savings.
Technology exists to help promote energy efficiency on many levels, from reducing
electricity consumption to managing other energy sources more efficiently. Ambitious
regulatory measures may be required to ensure these technologies are adopted
quickly enough to achieve the 2020 targets.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
K2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
2 Energy efficiency and
electricity
2.1 An international appetite for regulation
The Kyoto Protocol saw governments start to set out clear commitments in terms of
quantitative targets and specific agendas for reducing CO2 emissions.
Energy saving regulations affect all buildings,
both new and existing, as well as their electrical
installations.
In addition to their Kyoto obligations, many countries have set themselves fixed,
long-term targets in line with the latest EEIG (European Economic Interest Group)
recommendations to the UNFCCC (United Nations Framework Convention on
Climate Change) regarding energy saving and based on stabilising CO2 levels.
The European Union is setting a good example with its firm commitment, signed
by all the national EU leaders in March 2007, to a 20% reduction by 2020. Known
as 3x20, this agreement aims to reduce CO2 emissions by 20%, improve energy
efficiency by 20% and increase the contribution made by renewable energies to 20%.
Some European Countries are looking at a 50% reduction by 2050. Reaching these
targets, however, wiII require significant changes, with governments stepping up their
use of regulations, legislation and standardisation.
Across the world, legislation and regulations are serving to underline stakeholder
obligations and put taxation and financial structures in place.
b In the USA
v The Energy Policy Act of 2005,
v Construction regulations,
v Energy regulations (10CFR434),
v Energy management programmes for various states (10CFR420),
v Rules for energy conservation for consumer products (10CFR430).
b In China
v Energy conservation law,
v Architecture law (energy efficiency and construction),
v Renewable energy law,
b In the European Union
v The EU Emission Trading Scheme
v The Energy Performance of Building Directive
v The European Ecodesign Directive (Directive 2009/125/EC) concerning Energy
Using Products (EUP) and Energy Related Products (ERP)
v The Energy End-use Efficiency and Energy Services Directive.
K3
2.2 NF EN 15232 (for more information about french
regulations related to Energy Efficiency, see the french
version of the book, chapter "Efficacité énergétique de la
distribution électrique")
2.3 How to achieve energy efficiency
Whilst it is currently possible to obtain energy savings of up to 30%, this potential
reduction can only really be understood in terms of the differences which exist
between active and passive forms of energy efficiency.
Passive energy efficiency is achieved by such measures as reducing heat loss and
using equipment which requires little energy. Active energy efficiency is achieved by
putting in place an infrastructure for measuring, monitoring and controlling energy
use with a view to making lasting changes.
TIt is possible to build on the savings achieved here by performing analyses and
introducing more suitable remedial measures. For example, although savings of
between 5% and 15% may be obtained by improving how installations are used or
by optimising the equipment itself (decommissioning redundant systems, adjusting
motors and heating), more significant savings can also be achieved.
v Up to 40% on energy for motors by using control and automation mechanisms to
manage motorised systems,
v Up to 30% on lighting by introducing an automated management mechanism
based on optimal use.
It is important to remember, however, that savings may be lost through.
b Unplanned/unmanaged downtime affecting equipment and processes
b A lack of automation/adjustment mechanisms (motors, heating)
b A failure to ensure energy saving measures are adopted at all times.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Active and passive energy efficiency
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
A realistic approach would be to establish the identity of energy consumers and
adopt passive followed by active saving measures, before finally implementing
inspection and support devices to ensure that any savings made can be sustained
over the long term. This involves a four-stage process:
b The first stage is concerned with diagnosis and primarily aims to get a better idea
of where and how energy is being consumed. This requires the development of
initial measures and a comparative assessment process with a view to evaluating
performance, defining the main areas for improvement and estimating achievable
energy saving levels. The logic behind this approach is based on the realisation that
you can only improve what you can measure.
b The next stage involves establishing basic requirements in terms of passive
energy efficiency. These include:
v Replacing existing equipment/devices with low-consumption alternatives (bulbs,
motors, etc.),
v Improving thermal insulation and ensuring that energy quality auxiliaries work in a
stable environment where savings can be sustained over time.
b The stage that follows this involves automation and active energy efficiency.
Anything responsible for energy consumption must be subjected to a process of
active management aimed at achieving permanent savings.
Active energy efficiency does not require highly energy-efficient devices and
equipment to be already installed, as the approach can be applied to all types of
equipment. Good management is essential for maximum efficiency – there is no
point in having low-consumption bulbs if you are going to waste energy by leaving
them switched on in empty rooms!
All things considered, energy management is the key to optimising use and
eliminating waste.
b The final stage consists of implementing basic changes, introducing automation
and putting in place an infrastructure based around monitoring, support and
continuous improvement. This infrastructure and the ongoing processes associated
with it will underpin the pursuit of energy efficiency over future years (see Fig. K1).
K4
1 Quantifying
b Kilowatt hour meters
b Energy quality meters
2 Implementation of basic measures 3 Automation
4 Monitoring and improvement
b Low-consumption devices
b Thermal insulation materials
b Energy quality improvement
b Energy reliability improvement
b Power management software
b Remote monitoring systems
b Building management systems
b Lighting control systems
b Motor control systems
b Home control systems
Fig. K1 : Les 4 conditions de la pérennité des économies
The key to sustainable savings
As Figure K2 illustrates, energy savings amounting to 30% are readily achievable
as things stand, although annual losses of 8% must be expected if there is neither
proper support nor monitoring of key indicators. It is clear, therefore, that information
is crucial to ensuring that energy savings are sustained over the long term.
100 %
b Up to 8% lost per year without a
monitoring and support programme
b Up to 12% lost per year without
systems for control and adjustment
Usage optimised
by automation
Efficient devices
and equipment
Energy
consumption
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
70 %
Monitoring and support
Time
Fig. K2 : and monitoring technology ensures savings are sustained over the long term.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Energy efficiency and
electricity
Consequently, energy monitoring and information systems are essential and must be
put in place to deal with the challenges ahead.
Approaches to energy efficiency must have a proper structure if significant long-term
savings are to be achieved, but only those companies with sufficient resources to
actively intervene at any stage of a process will be in a position to pass the savings
promised on to their customers. This is where Schneider Electric can help with its
approach based on managing the life cycle of customer products (see Fig. K3).
Ultimately, the objectives set can only be achieved by sharing risks and developing a
win-win relationship between those involved in the approach.
The reports provided by the energy monitoring or information systems can be
used to formulate suitable energy efficiency projects in line with different strategies
acceptable to all those involved.
b Start with a simple project involving relatively little expense and geared towards
quick wins, before going on to make more significant investments (this is often the
preferred business solution).
b Think in terms of how the investment for a project can and must be recouped when
devising a project (this is a popular method for assessing and selecting projects). The
advantage of this method is the simplicity of the analysis involved. Its disadvantage is
the impossibility of tracking the full impact of a project over the long term.
Energy audit
and measurement
Industrial and
building processes
Adopt basic
measures
Low-consumption
devices, thermal
insulation, power
factor correction,
etc.
Optimisation via
adjustment and
automation
Monitor,
support,
improve
Variable speed drives
(when appropriate),
lighting/air conditioning
control, etc..
Installation of meters,
monitoring devices,
energy saving analysis software
Passive energy
efficiency
Control,
improve
K5
Active energy efficiency
Fig. K3 : Energy efficiency solutions based on the life cycle
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Other, more complex strategies may be selected. These involve an analysis of
various management parameters such as the current net value or the internal
return-on-investment rate. Whilst the analysis required under these strategies
demands more work, they provide a more precise indication of the overall impact
of the project.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
3 Diagnosis through electrical
measurement
3.1 Electrical measurements
Voltage and current, two key values for understanding (almost)
everything
As far as electrical measurements are concerned, voltage and current are the two
values on which other values are based (power, energy, power factor, etc.).
You should have a full range of measuring devices capable of providing the specific
measurements required for the application. You can significantly increase the value of
your information by obtaining other data from the same measurements:
b Operating positions for devices (start/stop, open/closed, etc.)
b Number of operating hours/switching operations
b Motor load
b Battery charge
b Equipment failures
b etc.
There is no such thing as a “one-size-fits-all” solution. It is a question of finding the
best compromise, in technological and financial terms, for the particular needs of the
given situation, whilst remembering that measurement accuracy involves costs which
have to be compared against the anticipated returns on investment.
In addition, when the operator’s electrical network is expected to undergo frequent
changes given the activities in which it is involved, these changes should prompt a
search for immediate and significant optimisation measures.
Approaches to energy efficiency also need to take other parameters into account
(temperature, light, pressure, etc.), since, assuming energy is transformed without
any losses, the energy consumed by a piece of equipment may exceed the useful
energy it produces. One example of this is a motor, which converts the energy it
consumes into heat as well as mechanical energy.
Collecating relevant electrical data for specific objectives
As well as contributing towards energy efficiency, the information gleaned from
electrical data is commonly used to support a number of other objectives:
b Increasing user understanding and providing opportunities for optimising
equipment and procedures
b Optimising functionality and extending the service life of equipment associated with
the electrical network
b Playing a pivotal role in increasing the productivity of associated processes
(industrial or even administrative/management procedures) by avoiding/reducing
periods of lost productivity and guaranteeing the availability of a high-quality energy
supply
K6
c = Current measurement
S : with external sensor, D : direct measurement
v = Voltage measurement
S : avec capteur extérieur, D : mesure directe
Temperature class
Active energy accuracy class
PMD / cv / Ktt / p
Unit of measurement PM700 (Schneider Electric)
Code : PMD/SD/K55/1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K4 : Identifying measuring devices in accordance
with IEC 61557-12
3.2 Adapted measuring instruments
Electronic equipment is increasingly replacing analogical equipment in electrical
installations. It supports more accurate measurement of new values and is able to
make these available to users at both local and remote locations.
All these various measuring devices (referred to as “PMD” for “Performance
Measuring and Monitoring Device”) have to meet the requirements of international
standard IEC 61557-12. According to this standard, devices have a code denoting
their installation options, operating temperature range and accuracy class.
As a result, it has become significantly easier to select and identify these
devices (see Fig. K4).
A number of devices have been designed for inclusion in this category. These include
Sepam overload and measuring relays, TeSys U motor controllers, NRC 12 capacitor
battery controllers and Galaxy outage-free supply devices. The new Masterpact and
Compact circuit breakers with integrated Micrologic measuring devices (see Fig. K5)
also simplify matters by multiplying measurement points.
It is also now possible to broadcast measurements via digital networks. The table
in Figure K6 shows examples of measurements available via Modbus, RS485 or
Ethernet.
Fig. K5 : Compact NSX circuit breaker equipped with a
Micrologic trip unit and TeSys U controller (Schneider Electric)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Diagnosis through electrical
measurement
Units of
measurement
MV measurement
and overload relays
LV measurement
and overload relays
Capacitor battery
controllers
Monitoring and
insulation devices
Circuit monitoring
device, kilowatt hour
meter
Sepam
Masterpact and
Compact Micrologic
circuit breakers
Varlogic
Vigilohm system
Energy, inst., max., min.
b
b
b
b
-
Energy, reclosing capability
b
b
b
-
-
Examples
Control of energy consumption
Power factor, inst.
b
b
b
-
Cos φ inst.
-
-
-
b
-
b
b
b
b
-
Improved energy availability
Current, inst., max., min., imbalance
Current, wave form capture
b
b
b
-
Voltage, inst., max., min., imbalance
b
b
b
b
-
Voltage, wave form capture
b
b
b
-
-
Device status
b
b
b
b
-
Fault history
b
b
b
-
-
Frequency, inst., max., min.
b
b
b
-
-
THDu, THDi
b
b
b
b
-
Improved electrical installation management
Load temperature, thermal state of
load and device
b
b
-
b
-
Insulation resistance
-
-
-
-
b
Motor controllers
LV variable speed
drives
LV soft starters
MV soft starters
Outage-free supply
devices
TeSys U
ATV.1
ATS.8
Motorpact RVSS
Galaxy
b
-
b
b
Examples
K7
Control of energy consumption
Energy, inst., max., min.
-
Energy, reclosing capability
-
b
b
b
-
Power factor, inst.
-
-
b
b
b
Improved energy availability
Current, inst., max., min., imbalance
b
b
b
b
b
Current, wave form capture
-
-
-
b
b
Device status
b
b
b
b
b
Fault history
b
b
b
b
-
THDu, THDi
-
b
-
-
-
Load temperature, thermal state of
load and device
b
b
b
b
b
Motor running hours
-
b
b
b
-
Battery follow up
-
-
-
-
b
Fig. K6 : Examples of measurements available via Modbus, RS485 or Ethernet
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Improved electrical installation management
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
4 Energy saving opportunities
A number of different measures can be adopted to save energy (see Fig. K7).
b Reduce energy use
These measures try to achieve the same results by consuming less (e.g. installing
highly energy-efficient lights which provide the same quality of light but consume less
energy) or reduce energy consumption by taking care to use no more energy than is
strictly necessary (e.g. another method would be to have fewer lights in a room which
is too brightly lit).
b Save energy
These measures reduce costs per unit rather than reducing the total amount of
energy used. For example, day-time activities could be performed at night to in order
to take advantage of cheaper rates. Similarly, work could be scheduled to avoid peak
hours and demand response programmes.
b Energy reliability
As well as contributing to operational efficiency by avoiding lost production, these
measures avoid the energy losses associated with frequent restarts and the extra
work generated when batches of products go to waste.
Overall strategy for
energy management
Reduce
consumption
Optimise
energy
costs
Improve
reliability and
availability
K8
Fig. K7 : An overall strategy for energy management
Everyone immediately thinks of equipment for transforming energy (motors, lighting/
heating devices) when considering areas where savings can be made. Less obvious,
perhaps, are the potential savings offered by the various control devices and
programmes associated with this type of equipment.
4.1 Motor-related savings opportunities
Motorised systems are one of the potential areas where energy savings can be
made.
Motors represent 80% of electrical energy
consumption in the industry segment
Choice/replacement of the motor
Those wishing to improve passive energy efficiency often consider replacing motors
as a starting point, especially if the existing motors are old and require rewinding.
This trend is reinforced by the determination of major countries to stop low-efficiency
motor sales in the near future.
Based on the IEC60034-30 Standard’s definition of three efficiency classes (IE1, IE2,
IE3), many countries have defined a plan to gradually force IE1 and IE2 motor sales
to meet IE3 requirements.
In the EU, for example, motors of less than 375 kW have to be IE3-compliant by
January 2015 (EC 640/2009).
95
Efficiency (%)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
90
85
IE1 4 poles
IE2 4 poles
80
IE3 4 poles
75
70
1
10
Nominal value (kW)
100
Fig. K8 : Definition of energy efficiency classes for LV motors,
according to Standard IEC60034-30
There are two reasons for replacing an old motor:
b To benefit from the advantages offered by new high-performance motors (see
Fig. K8)
Depending on their rated power, high-performance motors can improve operational
efficiency by up to 10% compared to standard motors. By comparison, motors which
have undergone rewinding see their efficiency reduced by 3% to 4% compared to the
original motor.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
Reduction in Lifecycle cost compared to IE1 (%)
IE2 1.1kW
IE2 11 kW
IE3 1.1 kW
IE3 11 kW
10%
8%
6%
4%
2%
0%
0
1000
2000
3000
4000
5000
6000
7000
8000
-2%
b To avoid oversizing
In the past, designers tended to install oversized motors in order to provide an
adequate safety margin and eliminate the risk of failure, even in conditions which
were highly unlikely to occur. Studies show that at least one-third of motors are
clearly oversized and operate at below 50% of their nominal load.
However:
v Oversized motors are more expensive.
v Oversized motors are sometimes less efficient than correctly sized motors: motors
are at their most effective working point when operating between 30% and 100%
of rated load and are built to sustain short periods at 120% of their rated load.
Efficiency declines rapidly when loads are below 30%.
v The power factor drops drastically when the motor does not work at full load, which
can lead to charges being levied for reactive power.
Knowing that energy costs account for over 97% of the lifecycle costs of a motor,
investing in a more expensive but more efficient motor can quickly be very profitable.
However, before deciding whether to replace a motor, it is essential:
b to take the motor’s remaining life cycle into consideration.
b to remember that the expense of replacing a motor even if it is clearly oversized,
may not be justified if its load is very small or if it is only used infrequently (e.g. less
than 800 hours per year see Fig. K9).
b to ensure that the new motor’s critical performance characteristics (such as speed)
are equivalent to those of the existing motor.
-4%
Operating hours per year
Fig. K9 : Life cycle cost reduction for IE2 and IE3 motors
compared to IE1 motors, depending on the number of
operating hours per year
Operation of the motor
Other approaches are also possible to improve the energy efficiency of motors:
b Improving active energy efficiency by simply stopping motors when they no longer
need to be running. This method may require improvements to be made in terms of
automation, training or monitoring, and operator incentives may have to be offered.
If an operator is not accountable for energy consumption, he/she may well forget to
stop a motor at times when it is not required.
b Monitoring and correcting all the components in drive chains, starting with those
on the larger motors, which may affect the overall efficiency. This may involve, for
example, aligning shafts or couplings as required. An angular offset of 0.6 mm in a
coupling can result in a power loss of as much as 8%.
Savings can be made by:
b Replacing an oversized old motor with an
appropriate high-efficiency motor
b Operating the motor cleverly
b Choosing an appropriate motor starter/
controller
K9
Control of the motor
To ensure the best overall energy efficiency, the motor’s control system must be
chosen carefully, depending on the motor’s application:
b For a constant speed application, motor starters provide cheap, low-energyconsumption solutions. Three kinds of starters can be used, depending on the
system’s constraints:
v Direct on line starter (contactor)
v Star Delta starter: to limit the inrush current, provided that the load allows a starting
torque of 1/3 of nominal torque
v Soft starter: when Star Delta starter is not suitable to perform a limited inrush
current function and if softbraking is needed.
Example of starter applications: ventilation, water storage pumps, waste water
treatment stirring units, constant speed conveyors, etc.
LC1 D65A••
LC3 D32A••
ATS48••
Fig. K10 : Motor starter examples: TeSys D Direct on line contactors, Star Delta starter, Altistart
softstarter
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The method for starting/controlling a motor
should always be based on a system-level
analysis, considering several factors such as
variable speed requirements, overall efficiency
and cost, mechanical constraints, reliability, etc.
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
b When the application requires varying the speed, a Variable Speed Drive (VSD)
provides a very efficient active solution as it limits the speed of the motor to limit
energy consumption.
It competes favourably with conventional mechanical solutions (valves, dampers and
throttles, etc.), used especially in pumps and fans, where their operating principle
causes energy to be lost by blocking ducts while motors are operating at full speed.
VSDs also offer improved control as well as reduced noise, transient effects and
vibration. Further advantages can be obtained by using these VSDs in conjunction
with control devices tailored to meet individual requirements.
As VSDs are expensive devices which generate additional energy losses and can
be a source of electrical pollution, their usage should be limited to applications that
intrinsically require variable speed.
Example of applications for VSDs: hoisting, positioning in machine tools, closed-loop
control: circular pumping or ventilation (without throttle) or booster pumps, complex
control electronics, etc.
Altivar 12 (< 4 kW )
K10
Altivar 21 (< 75 kW)
Altivar 71 (< 630 kW)
Fig. K11 : Altivar drives of various power ratings
4 external
pump
b To handle loads that change depending on application requirements, starters,
VSDs, or a combination of both with an appropriate control strategy (see cascading
pumps example Fig. K12) should be considered, in order to provide the most
efficient and profitable overall solution.
Example of applications: HVAC for buildings, goods transport, water supply systems,
etc.
Variable speed
pump
(joker pump)
The method for starting/controlling a motor should always be based on a systemlevel analysis, considering several factors such as variable speed requirements,
overall efficiency and cost, mechanical constraints, reliability, etc.
ATV61
Pressure
sensor
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K12 : Example of cascading pumps, which skilfully
combine starters and a variable speed drive to offer a flexible
but not too expensive solution
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
4.2 Lighting
Lighting can account for over 35% of energy consumption in buildings, depending on
the types of activities carried out in them. Lighting control is one of the easiest ways
to make substantial energy savings for very little investment and is one of the most
common energy saving measures.
Lighting systems for commercial buildings are governed by standards, regulations
and building codes. Lighting not only needs to be functional, but must also meet
occupational health and safety requirements and be fit for purpose.
In many cases office lighting is excessive and there is considerable scope for making
passive energy savings. These can be achieved by replacing inefficient luminaires,
by replacing obsolete lights with high-performance/low-consumption alternatives and
by installing electronic ballasts. These kinds of approach are especially appropriate
in areas where lighting is required constantly or for long periods and savings cannot
be achieved by simply switching lights off. The time taken to recoup investments
varies from case to case, but many projects require a period of around two years.
Lights and electronic ballasts
More efficient lights may be a possibility, depending on the needs, type and age of
the lighting system. For example, new fluorescent lights are now available, although
ballasts also need to be replaced when lights are changed.
New types of ballast are also available, offering significant energy savings compared
to the earlier electromagnetic ballasts. For example, T8 lights with electronic ballasts
use between 32% and 40% less electricity than T12 lights fitted with electromagnetic
ballasts.
Having said this, electronic ballasts do have a number of disadvantages compared
with magnetic ballasts. Their operating frequency (between 20,000 and 60,000 Hz)
can introduce harmonic noise or distortion into the electrical network and presents
the risk of overheating or reducing the service life of transformers, motors and
neutral lines. There is even a danger of overvoltage trips being deactivated and
electronic components sustaining damage. However, these problems are mainly
restricted to facilities with heavy lighting loads and a large number of electronic
ballasts. Most current types of electronic ballast feature passive filtering in order to
keep harmonic distortion to less than 20 percent of fundamental current, or even 5%
for more sensitive facilities (hospitals, sensitive manufacturing environments, and so
on).
K11
Other types of lighting may be more appropriate, depending on the conditions
involved. An assessment of lighting needs will focus on evaluating the activities
performed and the required levels of illumination and colour rendering. Many existing
lighting systems were designed to provide more light than required. Designing a new
system to closely fit lighting needs makes it easier to calculate and ultimately achieve
savings.
+
Reflectors
Above: Around 70% of a fluorescent tube’s
light is directed sideways and upwards.
Below: The new silver surfaces are designed to reflect
the maximum amount of light downwards.
+
Fig. K13 : Illustration of the general operating principle for highperformance reflectors
A less common passive energy efficiency measure, but one which is worth
considering in tandem with the use of lights fitted with ballasts, is to replace the
reflectors diverting light to areas where it is needed. Advances in materials and
design have resulted in better quality reflectors which can be fitted to existing lights.
These reflectors intensify useful light, so that fewer lights may be required in some
cases. Energy can be saved without having to compromise on lighting quality.
New, high-performance reflectors offer a spectral efficiency of over 90%
(see Fig. K13). This means:
b Two lights can be replaced by a single light, with potential savings of 50% or more
in terms of the energy costs associated with lighting.
b Existing luminaires can be retrofitted by installing mirror-type reflectors without
having to adjust the distance between them. This has the advantage of simplifying
the retrofitting process and reducing the work involved, with minimal changes made
to the existing ceiling design.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
+
Apart from the issue of savings, and without forgetting the importance of complying
with the relevant standards and regulations, there are other advantages associated
with retrofitting lighting systems. These include lower maintenance costs, the chance
to make adjustments based on needs (office areas, “walk-through” areas etc.),
greater visual comfort (by eradicating the frequency beat and flickering typically
associated with migraine and eye strain) and improved colour rendering.
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
Lighting control
The passive energy saving measures described above leave further scope for
making savings. The aim of lighting control programmes is to give users the required
levels of convenience and flexibility, whilst supporting active energy savings and cost
reduction by switching lights off as soon as they are no longer needed. There are a
number of technologies available with various degrees of sophistication, although
the time taken to recoup investments is generally short at six to twelve months. A
multitude of different devices are currently available too (see Fig. K14).
K12
Fig. K14 : A selection of lighting control devices: timers, light sensors, movement sensors
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Timers to turn off lights after a certain period has passed. These are best used in
areas where the typical time spent or period of activity is clearly defined (such as
corridors).
b Occupancy/movement sensors to turn off lights when no movement has been
detected for a certain period. These are particularly well suited to areas where
the time spent or period of activity cannot be accurately predicted (storerooms,
stairwells, etc.).
b Photoelectric cells/daylight harvesting sensors to control lights near windows.
When sufficient daylight is available, lights are turned off or switched to night-light
mode.
b Programmable clocks to switch lights on and off at predetermined times (shop
fronts, office lights at nights and weekends)
b Dimmable lights to provide a low level of illumination (night light) at off-peak
periods (e.g. a car park requiring full illumination until midnight, but where lower
levels will suffice between midnight and dawn)
b Voltage regulators, ballasts or special electronic devices to optimise energy
consumption for lights (fluorescent tubes, high-pressure sodium lights, etc.)
b Wireless remote control devices for simple and economical retrofitting of existing
applications
These various technologies may be combined and can also be used to create a
specific effect or atmosphere. For example, programmable lighting panels in meeting
areas (for board meetings, presentations, conferences, etc.) have a number of
different light settings which can be changed at the flick of a switch.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
Centralised lighting management
Some of the lighting control systems currently available, such as those based on the
KNX protocol, have the additional advantage of supporting integration into building
management systems (see Fig. K15).
They offer greater flexibility of management and centralised monitoring, and provide
more scope for energy savings by enabling lighting controls to be integrated into
other systems (e.g. air conditioning). Certain systems enable energy savings of 30%,
although efficiency levels will depend on the application involved and this must be
chosen with some care.
Trancent
pushbutton
Internal
movement sensor
Touch panel
KNX bus
K13
Binary input
module
Control station
External movement
sensor
Fig. K15 : An example of links established using Schneider Electric’s KNX system
If this type of system is to produce results, the design and implementation stage
must begin with an audit of energy consumption and a study of the lighting system
with a view to devising the best lighting solution and identifying potential reductions
in terms of both costs and energy consumption. As far as this kind of technology
is concerned, Schneider Electric also has solutions for offices as well as exterior
lighting, car parking facilities, parks and landscaped gardens.
b If the energy distribution company imposes penalties for reactive power
consumption, improving power factor correction is a typically passive energy saving
measure. It takes immediate effect after implementation and does not require any
changes to procedures or staff behaviour. The investment involved can be recouped
in less than a year.
See Chapter L for further details.
b Many types of equipment (variable speed drives, electronic ballasts, etc.) and
computers generate harmonics within their line supply. The effects produced can
sometimes be significant (transient overvoltages causing protection relays to trip,
or heat and vibration potentially reducing the efficiency and service life of such
equipment as capacitor banks used for power factor correction). Harmonic filtering is
another typical passive energy saving measure to consider.
See Chapter M for further details.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
4.3 Power factor correction and harmonic filtering
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
4.4 Load management
As part of their drive towards synchronizing the consumption and production of
electrical energy over the long term, energy distribution companies tailor their rates
to encourage consumers to reduce their requirements during peak periods.
A number of different strategies are possible, depending on consumption levels and
operating requirements: restricting demand (see Fig. K16), avoiding peak periods,
load scheduling or even generating additional energy on site.
kW
Peak demand
Peak demand rescheduled
to keep it below a given
threshold
Reduced peak
demand
Time
Fig. K16 : An example of a load-management strategy
K14
b Demand restriction
Energy distribution companies can use this solution in supply contracts containing
optional or emergency (involving compulsory limits) restrictive clauses whose
application is determined by the consumer (based on special rates). This
management policy is typically used during the hottest or coldest months of the
year when companies and private customers have very high requirements for
ventilation, air conditioning and heating, and when electricity consumption exceeds
normal demand considerably. Reducing consumption in this way can prove
problematic in residential and service sector environments, as they may considerably
inconvenience building occupants. Customers from industry may show more of an
interest in this type of scheme and could benefit from contracts reducing unit costs
by up to 30% if they have a high number of non-essential loads.
b Peak demand avoidance
This method involves moving consumption peaks in line with the different rates
available. The idea is to reduce bills, even if overall consumption remains the same
b Load scheduling
This management strategy is an option for companies able to benefit from lower
rates by scheduling consumption for all their processes where time of day is neither
important nor critical.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Additional energy generation on site
The use of generating sets to supply energy improves operational flexibility by
providing the energy needed to continue normal operations during periods of peak
or restricted demand. An automated control system can be configured to manage
this energy production in line with needs and the rates applicable at any given
time. When energy supplied from outside becomes more expensive than energy
generated internally, the control system automatically switches between the two.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
4.5 Communication and information systems
Information systems
Whether it relates to measurements, operating statuses or rate bases, raw data can
only be useful when converted into usable information and distributed on a needto-know basis to all those involved in energy efficiency with a view to improving the
expertise of all participants in the energy management process. Data must also
be explained, as people can only develop the management and intervention skills
integral to any effective energy saving policy if they fully understand the issues
involved. Data distribution must produce actions, and these actions will have to
continue if energy efficiency is to be sustained (see Fig. K19).
However, this cycle of operations requires an effective communication network to be
in place.
Communication
(information
aiding understanding)
Action
(understanding
aiding results)
Data analysis
(raw data converted
into usable information)
Data gathering
Fig. K17 : Operating cycle for data essential to energy efficiency
K15
The information system can then be used on a daily basis by the operators at the
various locations where electricity is consumed (for industrial processes, lighting,
air conditioning, and so on) to achieve the energy efficiency objectives specified by
company management. It can also ensure these same locations make a positive
contribution to company operations (in terms of product volumes, conditions for
supermarket shoppers, temperatures in cold rooms, etc.).
Monitoring systems
Communication networks
Information and monitoring systems are synonymous with both intranet and Internet
communication networks, with exchanges taking place within computer architectures
designed on a user-specific basis.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b For quick audits which can be performed on an ongoing basis.
Encouraging familiarity with data and distributing it can help keep everything up to
date, but electrical networks develop rapidly and are permanently raising questions
about their ability to cope with such new developments.
With this in mind, a system for monitoring the transfer and consumption of energy is
able to provide all the information needed to carry out a full audit of the site. As well
as electricity, this audit would cover water, air, gas and steam.
Measurements, comparative analyses and standardised energy consumption data
can be used to determine the efficiency of processes and industrial installations.
b For rapid, informed decision making
Suitable action plans can be implemented. These include control and automation
systems for lighting and buildings, variable speed drives, process automation, etc.
Recording information on effective equipment use makes it possible to determine
accurately the available capacity on the network or a transformer and to establish
how and when maintenance work should be performed (ensuring measures are
taken neither too soon nor too late).
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
b Intranet
For the most part, data exchange in the industrial sector uses Web technologies
permanently installed on the company’s communications network, typically an
intranet network for the sole use of the operator.
As far as industrial data exchange between systems connected via a physical
transmission link, such as RS485 and modem (GSM, radio, etc.), is concerned,
the Modbus protocol is very widely used with metering and protection devices for
electrical networks. Initially created by Schneider Electric, this is now a standard
protocol.
In practice, electrical data is recorded on industrial Web servers installed in
enclosures. The popular TCP/IP standard protocol is used for transmitting this data
in order to reduce the ongoing maintenance costs associated with any computer
network. This same principle is used by Schneider Electric to communicate data
associated with promoting energy efficiency. No additional software is needed – a
PC with an Internet browser is all that is required. The fact that enclosures are
autonomous removes the need for an additional computer system. As such, all
energy efficiency data is recorded and can be communicated in the usual manner via
intranet networks, GSM, fixed telephony, etc
b Internet
Remote monitoring and control improve data availability and accessibility, whilst
offering greater flexibility in terms of servicing. Figure K18 shows a diagram of this
type of installation. Connection to a server and a standard Web browser makes it
much easier to use data and export it to Microsoft Excel™ spreadsheets for the
purpose of tracing power curves in real time.
Internet
http://
Company
Intranet
K16
HTML server
http://
Modbus
serial link
PM850
power
meters
PM710
power
meters
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K18 : Example of an intranet information network protected by a server
(EGX400 – Schneider Electric) and monitored from the Internet network
b Architectures
Historically and for many years, monitoring and control systems were centralised and
based on SCADA automation systems (Supervisory Control And Data Acquisition).
These days, a distinction is made between three architecture levels (see Fig. 19 on
the next page).
v Level 1 architecture
Thanks to the new capabilities associated with Web technology, recent times
have witnessed the development of a new concept for intelligent equipment. This
equipment can be used at a basic level within the range of monitoring systems,
offering access to information on electricity throughout the site. Internet access can
also be arranged for all services outside the site.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
v Level 2 architecture
This system has been specifically designed for electricians and adapted to meet the
demands of electrical networks.
This architecture is based on a centralised monitoring system designed to satisfy
all the monitoring requirements for the electrical network. As might be expected,
installation and maintenance work requires less expertise than for Level 3, since all
the electrical distribution devices are already contained in a specialised library. In
addition, acquisition costs can be kept to a minimum, as there are few requirements
in terms of system integration.
Level 2 and Level 3 can be used side by side at certain sites.
v Level 3 architecture
Investment in this type of system is usually restricted to top-of-the-range facilities
consuming large amounts of energy or using equipment which is highly sensitive to
variations in energy quality and has high demands in terms of electricity availability.
To ensure these high demands for availability are met, the system often requires
responsibility to be taken for installation components as soon as the first fault
occurs. This should be done in a transparent manner (any impact should be clear).
In view of the substantial front-end costs, the expertise required to implement the
system correctly and the update costs generated as the network develops, potential
investors may be deterred and they may require highly detailed prior analyses to be
conducted.
Function
levels
General
monitoring
system
3
General
site
monitoring
Equipment
gateway
Other
services
Process
K17
Energy
management
equipment
Specialised
network
monitoring
Power Logic
ION Entreprise
specialised
monitoring
systems
2
Equipment
gateway
Energy
management
equipment
Standard
Web browser
1
Equipment
server
Intelligent
energy
management
equipment
Other services
Standard network
Vulnerable electrical networks
Fig. K19 : Layout of a monitoring system
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Top-of-the-range sites
System
complexity
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Basic
monitoring
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
4.6 Designing information and monitoring systems
In reality, systems for monitoring and energy control are physically very similar and
overlap with the electrical distribution architecture whose layout they often replicate.
The arrangements shown in Figure K20 to Figure K24 represent possible examples
and reflect the requirements typically associated with the distribution involved
(in terms of feeder numbers, the amount and quality of energy required, digital
networks, management mode, etc.). They help to visualise and explain all the various
services which can be used to promote energy efficiency.
http://
Installation monitoring
(PowerView software on PC)
Power
incomer
Intranet
Modbus - Ethernet TCP/IP
Main LV distribution board
Micrologic E
Modbus TCP/IP
Compact NSX 63
EGX100 gateway
to 630 A circuit
breaker
Modbus - RS485
Load-shedding
contactor
PM9C
power meters
K18
Receiver
feeder
Heating/air
conditioning feeder
Lighting
feeder
Unmonitored
feeders
(sockets, etc.)
Secondary
feeder which
has been shed
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K20 : Monitoring architecture for a small site which only supports sub-metering
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Energy saving opportunities
Optional centralised
PowerView monitoring
http://
Power
incomer
Monitoring and
control of sites
A and B (PC browser)
http://
Power
incomer
Ethernet TCP/IP
Internet
Main LV distribution
board for site B
Main LV distribution
board for site A
Compact NSX with
Micrologic control
EGX400
and measurement unit
Web server
PM9C
power meters
Receiver
feeder
Heating/air
conditioning
feeder
Unmonitored
feeders
(sockets, etc.)
Compact NSX
with Micrologic control
and measurement unit
EGX400
Web server
PM9C
power meters
Load-shedding
contactor
Lighting
feeder
Monitoring and
control of sites
A and B (PC browser)
Secondary
feeder
which has
been shed
Receiver
feeder
Heating/air
conditioning
feeder
Load-shedding
contactor
Lighting
feeder
Unmonitored
feeders
(sockets, etc.)
Secondary
feeder
which has
been shed
Fig. K21 : Monitoring and control architecture for a company with several small sites
Company’s energy
management system:
ION EEM
K19
http://
Other data
resources
relating to energy
Buildings and
automation
systems
Distributor
data
sources
Management
systems
(EAM, ERP)
Monitoring
and control
(PC browser)
Intranet
Site’s energy
management system:
ION Entreprise
http://
Site’s energy
management system:
ION Entreprise
Monitoring and
control (PC browser)
http://
Intranet
Monitoring and
control (PC browser)
Intranet
Large industrial site 2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Large industrial site 1
Fig. K22 : Architecture for large multiple-site arrangements
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
ION Entreprise
centralised monitoring
+ Web server
http://
Monitoring and
control (PC browser)
Power
incomer
Intranet
GE
Ethernet TCP/IP
Main LV
distribution
board
Meters
Water
ION 7850
power
meter
Masterpact
Gas
Automation
Compact NS
circuit breaker
with
Micrologic P
Compact NSX
circuit breakers
with
Micrologic E
PM9C
power
meter
image
??
Load-shedding
contactor
Remote control
Compact NSX source
changeover system
~
=
Load-shedding
contactor
=
Inverter
and bypass
~
Feeders which have been shed
K20
Secondary distribution board
Modbus
Ethernet
EGX100 gateway
Concentrator
Main high energy
availability
distribution board
Modbus
Ethernet
EGX100
gateway
Modbus - RS485
Modbus - RS485
Micrologic E
Compact NSX
63 to 630 A
circuit breakers
PM9C
power meter
Micrologic E
Compact
NSX circuit
breakers
ME3ZR
kilowatt
hour meter
Load-shedding
contactor
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Major feeders for
controlling big consumers
Secondary
feeder
which has
been shed
Load shedding
for consumption
peaks with
sub-metering
and monitoring
Sub-metering
and monitoring
EN40
kilowatt
hour meter
Sub-metering
only
Small feeders
without
sub-metering
Feeders with no preventive
maintenance or below 63 A,
but to be included in sub-metering
Fig. K23 : Monitoring and control architecture for a large, sensitive industrial site
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Sensitive feeders and term for service continuity and availability.
- Preventive/predictive/strategic maintenance
- Measurement of electrical parameters with harmonic
analyses and diagnostics
4 Energy saving opportunities
VISTA centralised
g
monitoring
Monitoring
and control
(PC browser)
http://
Power
incomer
Intranet
Lan Talk - Ethernet TCP/IP
Main LV distribution board
CVC controller and
Web server load shedding,
Xenta 731 Modbus-Ethernet gateway
Modbus - RS485
Meters
Water
Xenta 411
or 421 logic
input module
PM850
power
meter
Masterpact
Modbus - RS485
Gas
Compact NSX
circuit breakers
with
Micrologic E
PM9C
power
meter
PM9C
power
meter
ME3ZR
kilowatt
hour meter
Load-shedding
contactor
EN40
kilowatt
hour meter
Load-shedding
contactor
Sub-metering
and monitoring
Feeders which
have been shed
Secondary distribution board
Xenta 411
or 421 logic
input module
PM9C
power
meter
Sub-metering only
K21
Secondary distribution board
Lan Talk-FTT-10
CVC controller and
Web server
load shedding,
Xenta 731
Modbus-Ethernet
gateway
PM9C power
meter
CVC feeder
(fan coil units)
EN40
kilowatt
hour meter
Lighting
feeder
Lighting
feeder
CVC feeder
(fan coil units)
Unmonitored
feeders
(sockets, etc.)
Unmonitored
feeders
(sockets, etc.)
Sub-metering only
Fig. K24 : Architecture for a large service-industry site
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
ME3ZR
kilowatt
hour
meter
PM9C power
meter
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
4 Energy saving opportunities
In addition, these diagrams make it clear that the choice of components is
determined by the choice of architecture (for example, the sensors must be right
for the digital bus). The reverse also applies, however, since the initial choice of
architecture may be affected by a technological/economic assessment of component
installation and the results sought. In fact, the cost (in terms of purchase and
installation) of these components, which sometimes have the same name but
different characteristics, may vary widely and produce very variable results:
b A measuring device can measure one or more parameters with or without using
calculations (energy, power, cos ).
b Replacing a standard circuit breaker with a circuit breaker containing an electronic
control unit can provide a great deal of information on a digital bus (effective and
instantaneous measurements of currents, phase-to-neutral and phase-to-phase
voltages, imbalances of phase currents and phase-to-phase voltages, frequency,
total or phase-specific active and reactive power, etc.).
When designing these systems, therefore, it is very important to define objectives for
energy efficiency and be familiar with all the technological solutions, including their
respective advantages, disadvantages and any restrictions affecting their application
(see Fig. K27).
To cover all the various scenarios, it may be necessary to search through various
hardware catalogues or simply consult a manufacturer offering a wide range of
electrical distribution equipment and information systems. Certain manufacturers,
including Schneider Electric, offer advisory and research services to assist those
looking to select and implement all these various pieces of equipment.
Energy savings
K22
Variable speed drives
p p p
High-performance
motors and transformers
p p p
Supply for MV motors
p p p
Cost optimisation
p
Power factor correction
p
p p p
Harmonics management
p
p p
Circuit configuration
p p
Outage-free supply
devices (see page N11)
p
p p p
p p p
p
iMCC
Architecture based on
intelligent equipment
Level 1
p
p p p
Auxiliary generators
Smooth starting
Availability and
reliability
p
p p p
p p
p p
p p
p
Specialised, centralised
architecture for
electricians
Level 2
p p p
p p
p
General/conventional,
centralised architecture
Level 3
p
p p
p p p
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K27 : Solutions chart
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 How to evaluate energy savings
One of the main obstacles facing those interested in devising and implementing
energy efficiency projects is the lack of reliable financial data to provide a convincing
business case. The higher the investment, the greater the need for credible proof of
the proposed advantages. As such, it is very important to have reliable methods for
quantifying results when investing in energy efficiency.
5.1 IPMVP and EVO procedures
To cater for this need, EVO (Efficiency Evaluation Organization), the body
responsible for evaluating performance, has published the IPMVP (International
Performance Measurement and Verification Protocol). This guide describes the
procedures used when measuring, calculating and documenting the savings
achieved as a result of various energy efficiency projects. So far, EVO has
published three volumes of the IPMVP, the first of which, “Concepts and Options
for Determining Energy and Water Savings”, outlines methods of varying cost and
accuracy for establishing total savings made or those made solely in terms of energy
efficiency. Schneider Electric uses this document when putting together energy
efficiency projects.
IPMVP principles and features
Before implementing the energy efficiency solution, a study based on IPMVP
principles should be carried out over a specific period in order to define the
relationship which exists between energy use and operating conditions. During this
period, reference values are defined by taking direct measurements or by simply
studying the energy bills for the site.
After implementation, this reference data is used to estimate the amount of energy,
referred to as “adjusted-baseline energy”, which would have been consumed had
the solution not been implemented. The energy saved is the difference between this
“adjusted-baseline energy” and the energy which was actually measured.
If a verification and measurement plan is put together as part of an IPMVP
programme, it needs to be:
b Accurate
Verification and measurement reports should be as accurate as possible for the
budget available. The costs involved in verification and measurement should normally
be comparatively low in terms of the anticipated savings.
b Complete
The study of energy savings should reflect the full impact of the project.
b Conservative
Where doubts exist in terms of results, verification and measurement procedures
should underestimate the savings being considered.
b Consistent
The energy efficiency report should cover the following factors in a consistent
manner:
v The various types of energy efficiency project
v The various types of experts involved in each project
v The various periods involved in each project
v The energy efficiency projects and the new energy supply projects
b Relevant
Identifying savings must involve measuring performance parameters which are
relevant or less well known, with estimates being made for less critical or more
predictable parameters.
b Transparent
All the measurements involved in the verification and measurement plan must be
presented in a clear and detailed manner.
K23
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The information provided in this chapter is
taken from Volume 1 of the IPMVP guide
published by EVO (see www.evo-world.org)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
IPMVP options
Four study levels or “options” have been defined in line with the objectives assigned
to this energy efficiency approach:
b Retrofitting isolation systems with measurements of all key parameters = Option A
b Retrofitting isolation systems with measurements of all parameters = Option B
b Whole facility = Option C
b Calibrated simulation = Option D
Fig. K28 sets out these options in a table. The algorithm in Fig. K29 shows the
process of selecting options for a project.
Option A
Option B
Option C
Option D
Financial objective
Retrofit isolation systems: key
parameter measurement
Retrofit isolation systems: all
parameter measurement
Whole facility
Calibrated simulation
Description
Savings are calculated
using data from the main
performance parameter(s)
defining energy consumption
for the system involved in the
energy efficiency solution.
Estimates are used for
parameters not chosen for
actual measurements.
Savings are calculated using
actual energy consumption
data for the system involved in
the energy efficiency solution.
Savings are established using
actual energy consumption
data for the facility or a section
of it. Data for energy use
within the facility as a whole
is gathered on an ongoing
basis throughout the reporting
period.
Savings are established by
simulating energy consumption
for the facility or a section of it.
There must be evidence that
the simulation procedures are
providing an adequate model
of the facility’s actual energy
performance.
Savings calculation
An engineering calculation
is performed for the energy
consumed during the baseline
period and the reporting period
based on:
b Ongoing or short-term
measurements of the main
performance parameter(s),
b And estimated values.
Ongoing or short-term
measurements of the energy
consumed during the baseline
period and the reporting period
An analysis of data on the
energy consumed during
the baseline period and the
reporting period for the whole
facility. Routine adjustments
are required, using techniques
such as simple comparison or
regression analysis.
Energy use simulation,
calibrated with hourly or
monthly utility billing data
When to use option
On the one hand, the results
obtained using this option
are rather equivocal given
that some parameters are
estimated. Having said this,
it is a much less expensive
method than Option B.
Option B is more expensive
than Option A, as all
parameters are measured. It is
the better option, however, for
customers who require a high
level of accuracy.
For complex energy
management programmes
affecting many systems within
a facility, Option C supports
savings and helps to simplify
the processes involved.
Option D is only used when
there is no baseline data
available. This may be the
case where a site did not have
a meter before the solution
was implemented or where
acquiring baseline data would
involve too much time or
expense.
K24
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. K28 : Summary of IPMVP options
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 How to evaluate energy savings
Start
Measurement
of on-site
factors or ECM
performance
ECM performance
Able to isolate
ECM with meter(s)?
Facility performance
No
Expected
savings >10%?
No
Yes
Yes
Need proof
of full performance?
No
Analysis of
main meter data
Need to assess
each ECM
separately?
No
Yes
Yes
Install isolation meters for
key parameters, assess
interactive effects and
estimate well known
parameters.
Install isolation
meters for all
parameters and
assess interactive
effects.
Simulate
system
or facility.
Obtain
calibration
data
Calibrate
simulation.
Missing baseline
or reporting
period data?
Données de
référence ou données
de la période documentée
manquantes ?
Yes
Yes
Simulate with
and without
ECM(s).
No
No
Option B
Retrofit isolation:
measurement of
all parameters
Option A
Retrofit isolation:
measurement
of key parameters
Option C
Whole facility
Option D
Calibrated
simulation
K25
Fig. K29 : Process for selecting an IPMVP option for a project
5.2. Achieving sustainable performance
Once the energy audits have been completed, the energy saving measures have
been implemented and the savings have been quantified, it is essential to follow the
procedures below to ensure performance can be sustained over time. Performance
tends to deteriorate if there is no continuous improvement cycle in place (see Fig. K30).
Energy performance curve
Savings without proper maintenance
Energy
audit and
consulting
Energy
conservation
measures
Fig. K30 : Ensuring performance is sustainable over time
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Contact
with
support
services
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Savings with ongoing services
K - Energy efficiency in electrical distribution
5 How to evaluate energy savings
A continuous improvement cycle will only work if there is an energy monitoring
system in place, and this system is used effectively and maintained. The system
supports a continuous and proactive analysis of energy use at the site, and informs
recommendations for improving the electrical distribution system.
Support services, either on site or at a remote location (accessible via telephone,
e-mail, VPN (Virtual Private Network) or any other type of long-distance connection),
are often required to ensure optimal performance for this type of system and the best
use of the collected data. Thanks to their contribution in terms of experience and
availability, these services also complement the operator’s in-house services. The
services available may include:
b Monitoring the performance of measuring devices
b Updating and adapting software
b Managing databases (e.g. archives)
b Continuously adapting the monitoring system in line with changing control
requirements.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
K26
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter L
Power Factor Correction
Contents
1
Power factor and Reactive power
L2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
L2
L2
L4
L4
L4
L5
2
3
Why to improve the power factor?
L6
2.1 Reduction in the cost of electricity
2.2 Technical/economic optimization
L6
L6
How to improve the power factor?
L8
3.1 Theoretical principles
3.2 By using what equipment?
3.3 The choice between a fixed or automatically-regulated bank
of capacitors
L8
L8
L10
4
Where to install power factor correction capacitors?
L11
4.1 Global compensation
4.2 Compensation by sector
4.3 Individual compensation
L11
L11
L12
5
How to determine the optimum level of compensation?
L13
5.1 General method
5.2 Simplified method
5.3 Method based on the avoidance of tariff penalties
5.4 Method based on reduction of declared maximum apparent
power (kVA)
L13
L13
L15
L15
6
7
8
9
Compensation at the terminals of a transformer
L16
6.1 Compensation to increase the available active power output
6.2 Compensation of reactive energy absorbed by the transformer
L16
L17
Power factor correction of induction motors
L19
7.1 Connection of a capacitor bank and protection settings
7.2 How self-excitation of an induction motor can be avoided
L19
L20
Example of an installation before and
after power-factor correction
L21
The effects of harmonics
L22
9.1 Problems arising from power-system harmonics
9.2 Risk of resonance
9.3 Possible solutions
L22
L23
L23
10
Implementation of capacitor banks
L26
10.1 Capacitor elements
10.2 Choice of protection, control devices and connecting cables
L26
L27
L1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Definition of Power Factor
Definition of reactive power
The nature of reactive power
Reactive power of capacitors
Equipment and appliances requiring reactive energy
Practical values of Power Factor
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
1 Power factor and Reactive
power
1.1 Definition of power factor
The Power Factor is an indicator of the quality of design and management of an
electrical installation. It relies on two very basic notions: active and apparent power.
The active power P (kW) is the real power transmitted to loads such as motors,
lamps, heaters, and computers. The electrical active power is transformed into
mechanical power, heat or light.
In a circuit where the applied r.m.s. voltage is Vrms and the circulating r.m.s. current is
Irms, the apparent power S (kVA) is the product: Vrms x Irms.
The apparent power is the basis for electrical equipment rating.
The Power Factor is the ratio of the active power P (kW) to the apparent power S
(kVA):
P(kW)
S(kVA)
The load may be a single power-consuming item, or a number of items (for example
an entire installation).
The value of power factor will range from 0 to 1.
1.2 Definition of reactive power
Ia
For most electrical loads like motors, the current I is lagging behind the voltage V by
an angle.
V
If currents and voltages are perfectly sinusoidal signals, a vector diagram can
be used for representation.
In this vector diagram, the current vector can be split into two components: one
in phase with the voltage vector (component Ia), one in quadrature (lagging by
90 degrees) with the voltage vector (component Ir). See Fig. L1.
ϕ
Ia is called the "active" component of the current.
Ir is called the "reactive" component of the current.
Ir
I
L2
The previous diagram drawn up for currents also applies to powers, by multiplying
each current by the common voltage V.
We thus define:
Fig. L1 : Current vector diagram
P
Apparent power:
S = V x I (kVA)
Active power:
P = V x Ia (kW)
Reactive power:
Q = V x Ir (kvar)
In this diagram, we can see that:
b Power Factor: P/S = cos
ϕ
This formula is applicable for sinusoidal voltage and current. This is why the Power
Factor is then designated as "Displacement Power Factor".
b Q/S = sin
b Q/P = tan
Q
A simple formula is obtained, linking apparent, active and reactive power: S² = P² + Q²
S
Fig. L2 : Power vector diagram
A power factor close to unity means that the apparent power S is minimal. This
means that the electrical equipment rating is minimal for the transmission of a given
active power P to the load. The reactive power is then small compared with the active
power.
A low value of power factor indicates the opposite condition.
Useful formulae (for balanced and near-balanced loads on 4-wire systems):
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Active power P (in kW)
v Single phase (1 phase and neutral):
v Single phase (phase to phase):
P = V.I.cos
P = U.I.cos
v Three phase (3 wires or 3 wires + neutral): P = 3.U.I.cos
b Reactive power Q (in kvar)
v Single phase (1 phase and neutral):
v Single phase (phase to phase):
P = V.I.sin
Q = U.I.sin
v Three phase (3 wires or 3 wires + neutral): P = 3.U.I.sin
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Power factor and Reactive
power
b Apparent power S (in kVA)
v Single phase (1 phase and neutral):
S = V.I
v Single phase (phase to phase):
S = U.I
v Three phase (3 wires or 3 wires + neutral): P = 3.U.I
where:
V = Voltage between phase and neutral
U = Voltage between phases
I = Line current
= Phase angle between vectors V and I.
An example of power calculations (see Fig. L3)
Type of
circuit
Apparent power Active power
S (kVA)
P (kW)
Single-phase (phase and neutral)
S = VI
Single-phase (phase to phase)
Example
5 kW of load
cos = 0.5
S = UI
10 kVA
Three phase 3-wires or 3-wires + neutral S = 3 UI
Example
Motor Pn = 51 kW
65 kVA
cos = 0.86
= 0.91 (motor efficiency)
P = VI cos
P = UI cos
5 kW
Reactive power
Q (kvar)
Q = VI sin
Q = UI sin
8.7 kvar
P = 3 UI cos Q = 3 UI sin
56 kW
33 kvar
Fig. L3 : Example in the calculation of active and reactive power
The calculations for the three-phase example above are as follows:
Pn = delivered shaft power = 51 kW
P = active power consumed
Pn
51
P=
=
= 56 kW
ρ 0.91
S = apparent power
P
56
S=
=
= 65 kVA
cos ϕ 0.86
ϕ
L3
So that, on referring to diagram Figure L15 or using a pocket calculator, the value of
tan corresponding to a cos of 0.86 is found to be 0.59
Q = P tan = 56 x 0.59 = 33 kvar (see Figure L2b).
P = 56 kW
Alternatively
Q = S2 - P2 = 652 - 562 = 33 kvar
Q = 33 kvar
S=
65
kV
A
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. L2b : Calculation power diagram
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
1.3 The nature of reactive power
S
(kVA)
Q
(kvar)
All inductive (i.e. electromagnetic) machines and devices that operate on AC systems
convert electrical energy from the power system generators into mechanical work
and heat. This energy is measured by kWh meters, and is referred to as “active”
energy.
P
(kW)
In order to perform this conversion, magnetic fields have to be established in the
machines. The magnetic field is created by the circulation of current in coils, which
are mainly inductive. The current in these coils is therefore lagging by 90° relative to
the voltage, and represent the reactive current absorbed by the machine.
Fig. L4 : An electric motor requires active power P and reactive
power Q from the power system
It should be noted that while reactive current does not draw power from the system,
it does cause power losses in transmission and distribution systems by heating the
conductors.
In practical power systems, load currents are invariably inductive, and impedances
of transmission and distribution systems predominantly inductive as well. The
combination of inductive current passing through an inductive reactance produces
the worst possible conditions of voltage drop (i.e. in direct phase opposition to the
system voltage).
For these two reasons (transmission power losses and voltage drop), the Network
Operators work for reducing the amount of reactive (inductive) current as much as
possible.
1.4 Reactive power of capacitors
The current flowing through capacitors is leading the voltage by 90°. The
corresponding current vector is then in opposition to the current vector of inductive
loads. This why capacitors are commonly used in the electrical systems, in order to
compensate the reactive power absorbed by inductive loads such as motors.
Inductive-reactive power is conventionally positive (absorbed by an inductive load),
while capacitive-reactive power is negative (supplied by a capacitive load).
As reactive-inductive loads and line reactance are responsible for voltage drops,
reactive-capacitive currents have the reverse effect on voltage levels and produce
voltage-rises in power systems.
L4
1.5 Equipment and appliances requiring reactive
energy
All AC equipment and appliances that include electromagnetic devices, or depend
on magnetically coupled windings, require some degree of reactive current to create
magnetic flux.
The most common items in this class are transformers, reactors, motors and
discharge lamps with magnetic ballasts (see Fig. L5).
The proportion of reactive power (kvar) with respect to active power (kW) when a
piece of equipment is fully loaded varies according to the item concerned being:
b 65-75% for asynchronous motors (corresponding to a Power Factor 0.8 – 0.85)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b 5-10% for transformers (corresponding to a Power Factor close to 0.995)
Fig. L5 : Power consuming items that also require reactive
energy
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Power factor and Reactive
power
1.6 Practical values of power factor
Average power factor values for the most commonly-used equipment and
appliances (see Fig. L6)
Equipment and appliances
b Common
loaded at
induction motor
0%
25%
50%
75%
100%
b Incandescent lamps
b Fluorescent lamps (uncompensated)
b Fluorescent lamps (compensated)
b Discharge lamps
b Ovens using resistance elements
b Induction heating ovens (compensated)
b Dielectric type heating ovens
b Resistance-type soldering machines
b Fixed 1-phase arc-welding set
b Arc-welding motor-generating set
b Arc-welding transformer-rectifier set
b Arc furnace
cos
0.17
0.55
0.73
0.80
0.85
1.0
0.5
0.93
0.4 to 0.6
1.0
0.85
0.85
0.8 to 0.9
0.5
0.7 to 0.9
0.7 to 0.8
0.8
tan
5.80
1.52
0.94
0.75
0.62
0
1.73
0.39
2.29 to 1.33
0
0.62
0.62
0.75 to 0.48
1.73
1.02 to 0.48
1.02 to 0.75
0.75
Fig. L6 : Values of cos and tan for commonly-used equipment
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L5
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
2 Why to improve the power
factor?
Improvement of the power factor of an
installation presents several technical and
economic advantages, notably in the reduction
of electricity bills
2.1 Reduction in the cost of electricity
Good management in the consumption of reactive energy brings economic
advantages.
These notes are based on an actual tariff structure commonly applied in Europe,
designed to encourage consumers to minimize their consumption of reactive energy.
The installation of power-factor correction equipment on installations permits the
consumer to reduce his electricity bill by maintaining the level of reactive-power
consumption below a value contractually agreed with the power supply authority.
In this particular tariff, reactive energy is billed according to the tan criterion.
As previously noted:
tan
Q (kvar)
P (kW)
The same ratio applies to energies:
tan
Q (kvarh)
P (kWh)
The power supply authority delivers reactive energy for free:
b If the reactive energy represents less than 40% of the active energy (tan < 0.4)
for a maximum period of 16 hours each day (from 06-00 h to 22-00 h) during the
most-heavily loaded period (often in winter)
b Without limitation during light-load periods in winter, and in spring and summer.
During the periods of limitation, reactive energy consumption exceeding 40% of
the active energy (i.e. tan > 0.4) is billed monthly at the current rates. Thus, the
quantity of reactive energy billed in these periods will be:
kvarh (to be billed) = kWh (tan - 0.4) where:
v kWh is the active energy consumed during the periods of limitation
v kWh tan is the total reactive energy during a period of limitation
v 0.4 kWh is the amount of reactive energy delivered for free during a period of
limitation
tan = 0.4 corresponds to a power factor of 0.93 so that, if steps are taken to ensure
that during the limitation periods the power factor never falls below 0.93,
the consumer will have nothing to pay for the reactive power consumed.
Against the financial advantages of reduced billing, the consumer must balance the
cost of purchasing, installing and maintaining the power factor correction equipment
and controlling switchgear, automatic control equipment (where stepped levels of
compensation are required) together with the additional kWh consumed by the
losses of the equipment, etc. It may be found that it is more economic to provide
partial compensation only, and that paying for some of the reactive energy consumed
is less expensive than providing 100% compensation.
L6
The question of power-factor correction is a matter of optimization, except in very
simple cases.
Power factor improvement allows the use of
smaller transformers, switchgear and cables,
etc. as well as reducing power losses and
voltage drop in an installation
2.2 Technical/economic optimization
A high power factor allows the optimization of the components of an installation.
Overating of certain equipment can be avoided, but to achieve the best results, the
correction should be effected as close to the individual inductive items as possible.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Reduction of cable size
Figure L7 shows the required increase in the size of cables as the power factor is
reduced from unity to 0.4, for the same active power transmitted.
Multiplying factor
for the cross-sectional
area of the cable core(s)
cos
1
1.25
1.67
2.5
1
0.8
0.6
0.4
Fig. L7 : Multiplying factor for cable size as a function of cos
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Why to improve the power
factor?
Reduction of losses (P, kW) in cables
Losses in cables are proportional to the current squared, and are measured by the
kWh meter of the installation. Reduction of the total current in a conductor by 10% for
example, will reduce the losses by almost 20%.
Reduction of voltage drop
Power factor correction equipment reduce or even cancel completely the (inductive)
reactive current in upstream conductors, thereby reducing or eliminating voltage
drops.
Note: Over compensation will produce a voltage rise at the equipment level.
Increase in available power
By improving the power factor of a load supplied from a transformer, the current
through the transformer will be reduced, thereby allowing more load to be added. In
practice, it may be less expensive to improve the power factor (1), than to replace the
transformer by a larger unit.
This matter is further elaborated in clause 6.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L7
(1) Since other benefits are obtained from a high value of
power factor, as previously noted.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
3 How to improve the power factor?
Improving the power factor of an installation
requires a bank of capacitors which acts as a
source of reactive energy. This arrangement is
said to provide reactive energy compensation
a) Reactive current components only flow pattern
IL - IC
IC
C
IL
IL
R
L
Load
IC
C
IL
IL
R
L
An inductive load having a low power factor requires the generators and
transmission/distribution systems to pass reactive current (lagging the system
voltage by 90 degrees) with associated power losses and exaggerated voltage
drops, as noted in sub-clause 1.3. If a bank of shunt capacitors is added to the load,
its (capacitive) reactive current will take the same path through the power system
as that of the load reactive current. Since, as pointed out in sub-clause 1.3, this
capacitive current Ic (which leads the system voltage by 90 degrees) is in direct
phase opposition to the load reactive current (IL). The two components flowing
through the same path will cancel each other, such that if the capacitor bank is
sufficiently large and Ic = IL, there will be no reactive current flow in the system
upstream of the capacitors.
This is indicated in Figure L8 (a) and (b) which show the flow of the reactive
components of current only.
In this figure:
R represents the active-power elements of the load
L represents the (inductive) reactive-power elements of the load
C represents the (capacitive) reactive-power elements of the power-factor correction
equipment (i.e. capacitors).
It will be seen from diagram (b) of Figure L9, that the capacitor bank C appears
to be supplying all the reactive current of the load. For this reason, capacitors are
sometimes referred to as “generators of leading vars”.
In diagram (c) of Figure L9, the active-power current component has been added,
and shows that the (fully-compensated) load appears to the power system as having
a power factor of 1.
b) When IC = IL, all reactive power is supplied from the
capacitor bank
IL - IC = 0
3.1 Theoretical principles
Load
In general, it is not economical to fully compensate an installation.
Figure L9 uses the power diagram discussed in sub-clause 1.2 (see Fig. L2) to
illustrate the principle of compensation by reducing a large reactive power Q to a
smaller value Q’ by means of a bank of capacitors having a reactive power Qc.
In doing so, the magnitude of the apparent power S is seen reduced to S’.
Qc can be calculated by the following formula deduced from figure L9:
c) With load current added to case (b)
Qc=P.(tan()-tan()')
IR
IC
IL IR
IR + IL
C
L
L8
R
Load
Example:
A motor consumes 100 kW at a power factor of 0.75 (i.e. tan = 0.88). To improve
the power factor to 0.93 (i.e. tan = 0.4), the reactive power of the capacitor bank
must be : Qc = 100 (0.88 - 0.4) = 48 kvar
The selected level of compensation and the calculation of rating for the capacitor
bank depend on the particular installation. The factors requiring attention are
explained in a general way in clause 5, and in clauses 6 and 7 for transformers and
motors.
Fig. L8 : Showing the essential features of power-factor
correction
Note: Before starting a compensation project, a number of precautions should be
observed. In particular, oversizing of motors should be avoided, as well as the noload running of motors. In this latter condition, the reactive energy consumed by a
motor results in a very low power factor ( 0.17); this is because the kW taken by the
motor (when it is unloaded) are very small.
P
ϕ' ϕ
Q'
S'
Q
3.2 By using what equipment?
S
Qc
Compensation at LV
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. L9 : Diagram showing the principle of compensation:
Qc = P (tan - tan ’)
At low voltage, compensation is provided by:
b Fixed-value capacitor
b Equipment providing automatic regulation, or banks which allow continuous
adjustment according to requirements, as loading of the installation changes
Note: When the installed reactive power of compensation exceeds 800 kvar, and the
load is continuous and stable, it is often found to be economically advantageous to
install capacitor banks at the medium voltage level.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 How to improve the power factor?
Compensation can be carried out by a
fixed value of capacitance in favourable
circumstances
Fixed capacitors (see Fig. L10)
This arrangement employs one or more capacitor(s) to form a constant level of
compensation. Control may be:
b Manual: by circuit-breaker or load-break switch
b Semi-automatic: by contactor
b Direct connection to an appliance and switched with it
These capacitors are applied:
b At the terminals of inductive devices (motors and transformers)
b At busbars supplying numerous small motors and inductive appliance for which
individual compensation would be too costly
b In cases where the level of load is reasonably constant
Fig. L10 : Example of fixed-value compensation capacitors
Automatic capacitor banks (see Fig. L11)
This kind of equipment provides automatic control of compensation, maintaining the
power factor within close limits around a selected level. Such equipment is applied at
points in an installation where the active-power and/or reactive-power variations are
relatively large, for example:
b At the busbars of a general power distribution board
b At the terminals of a heavily-loaded feeder cable
L9
Fig. L11 : Example of automatic-compensation-regulating equipment
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Compensation is more-commonly effected by
means of an automatically-controlled stepped
bank of capacitors
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
3 How to improve the power factor?
Automatically-regulated banks of capacitors
allow an immediate adaptation of compensation
to match the level of load
The principles of, and reasons, for using automatic
compensation
A bank of capacitors is divided into a number of sections, each of which is controlled
by a contactor. Closure of a contactor switches its section into parallel operation with
other sections already in service. The size of the bank can therefore be increased or
decreased in steps, by the closure and opening of the controlling contactors.
A control relay monitors the power factor of the controlled circuit(s) and is arranged
to close and open appropriate contactors to maintain a reasonably constant
system power factor (within the tolerance imposed by the size of each step of
compensation). The current transformer for the monitoring relay must evidently
be placed on one phase of the incoming cable which supplies the circuit(s) being
controlled, as shown in Figure L12.
Power factor correction equipment including static contactors (thyristors) instead of
usual contactors is particularly suitable for a certain number of installations using
equipment with fast cycle and/or sensitive to transient surges.
The advantages of static contactors are :
b Immediate response to all power factor fluctuation (response time as low as 40 ms
according to regulator option)
b Unlimited number of operations
b Elimination of transient phenomena on the network on capacitor switching
b Fully silent operation
By closely matching compensation to that required by the load, the possibility of
producing overvoltages at times of low load will be avoided, thereby preventing
an overvoltage condition, and possible damage to appliances and equipment.
Overvoltages due to excessive reactive compensation depend partly on the value of
source impedance.
CT In / 5 A cl 1
U
I
Varmetric
relay
L10
Fig. L12 : The principle of automatic-compensation control
3.3 The choice between a fixed or automaticallyregulated bank of capacitors
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Commonly-applied rules
Where the kvar rating of the capacitors is less than, or equal to 15% of the supply
transformer rating, a fixed value of compensation is appropriate. Above the 15%
level, it is advisable to install an automatically-controlled bank of capacitors.
The location of low-voltage capacitors in an installation constitutes the mode of
compensation, which may be global (one location for the entire installation), partial
(section-by-section), local (at each individual device), or some combination of the
latter two. In principle, the ideal compensation is applied at a point of consumption
and at the level required at any instant.
In practice, technical and economic factors govern the choice.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Where to install power factor
correction capacitors?
4.1 Global compensation (see Fig. L13)
Where a load is continuous and stable, global
compensation can be applied
Principle
The capacitor bank is connected to the busbars of the main LV distribution board for
the installation, and remains in service during the period of normal load.
Advantages
The global type of compensation:
b Reduces the tariff penalties for excessive consumption of kvars
b Reduces the apparent power kVA demand, on which standing charges are usually
based
b Relieves the supply transformer, which is then able to accept more load if
necessary
Comments
b Reactive current still flows in all conductors of cables leaving (i.e. downstream of)
the main LV distribution board
b For the above reason, the sizing of these cables, and power losses in them, are
not improved by the global mode of compensation.
no.1
M
M
M
M
L11
Fig. L13 : Global compensation
Compensation by sector is recommended
when the installation is extensive, and where the
load/time patterns differ from one part of
the installation to another
4.2 Compensation by sector (see Fig. L14)
Principle
Capacitor banks are connected to busbars of each local distribution board, as shown
in Figure L14.
Advantages
The compensation by sector:
b Reduces the tariff penalties for excessive consumption of kvars
b Reduces the apparent power kVA demand, on which standing charges are usually
based
b Relieves the supply transformer, which is then able to accept more load if
necessary
b The size of the cables supplying the local distribution boards may be reduced, or
will have additional capacity for possible load increases
b Losses in the same cables will be reduced
no. 1
no. 2
no. 2
M
M
Fig. L14 : Compensation by sector
M
M
Comments
b Reactive current still flows in all cables downstream of the local distribution boards
b For the above reason, the sizing of these cables, and the power losses in them,
are not improved by compensation by sector
b Where large changes in loads occur, there is always a risk of overcompensation
and consequent overvoltage problems
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A significant part of the installation benefits from this arrangement, notably the feeder
cables from the main distribution board to each of the local distribution boards at
which the compensation measures are applied.
4 Where to install power factor
correction capacitors?
L - Power Factor Correction
Individual compensation should be considered
when the power of motor is significant with
respect to power of the installation
4.3 Individual compensation
Principle
Capacitors are connected directly to the terminals of inductive circuit (notably motors,
see further in Clause 7). Individual compensation should be considered when the
power of the motor is significant with respect to the declared power requirement
(kVA) of the installation.
The kvar rating of the capacitor bank is in the order of 25% of the kW rating of the
motor. Complementary compensation at the origin of the installation (transformer)
may also be beneficial.
Advantages
Individual compensation:
b Reduces the tariff penalties for excessive consumption of kvars
b Reduces the apparent power kVA demand
b Reduces the size of all cables as well as the cable losses
Comments
b Significant reactive currents no longer exist in the installation
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L12
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 How to determine the optimum
level of compensation?
5.1 General method
Listing of reactive power demands at the design stage
This listing can be made in the same way (and at the same time) as that for the
power loading described in chapter A. The levels of active and reactive power
loading, at each level of the installation (generally at points of distribution and subdistribution of circuits) can then be determined.
Technical-economic optimization for an existing installation
The optimum rating of compensation capacitors for an existing installation can be
determined from the following principal considerations:
b Electricity bills prior to the installation of capacitors
b Future electricity bills anticipated following the installation of capacitors
b Costs of:
v Purchase of capacitors and control equipment (contactors, relaying, cabinets, etc.)
v Installation and maintenance costs
v Cost of dielectric heating losses in the capacitors, versus reduced losses in cables,
transformer, etc., following the installation of capacitors
Several simplified methods applied to typical tariffs (common in Europe) are shown
in sub-clauses 5.3 and 5.4.
5.2 Simplified method
General principle
An approximate calculation is generally adequate for most practical cases, and may
be based on the assumption of a power factor of 0.8 (lagging) before compensation.
In order to improve the power factor to a value sufficient to avoid tariff penalties (this
depends on local tariff structures, but is assumed here to be 0.93) and to reduce
losses, volt-drops, etc. in the installation, reference can be made to Figure L15 next
page.
From the figure, it can be seen that, to raise the power factor of the installation from
0.8 to 0.93 will require 0.355 kvar per kW of load. The rating of a bank of capacitors
at the busbars of the main distribution board of the installation would be
Q (kvar) = 0.355 x P (kW).
This simple approach allows a rapid determination of the compensation capacitors
required, albeit in the global, partial or independent mode.
L13
Example
It is required to improve the power factor of a 666 kVA installation from 0.75 to 0.928.
The active power demand is 666 x 0.75 = 500 kW.
In Figure L15, the intersection of the row cos = 0.75 (before correction) with
the column cos = 0.93 (after correction) indicates a value of 0.487 kvar of
compensation per kW of load.
For a load of 500 kW, therefore, 500 x 0.487 = 244 kvar of capacitive compensation
is required.
Note: this method is valid for any voltage level, i.e. is independent of voltage.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L - Power Factor Correction
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
Before
compensation
L14
tan
2.29
2.22
2.16
2.10
2.04
1.98
1.93
1.88
1.83
1.78
1.73
1.69
1.64
1.60
1.56
1.52
1.48
1.44
1.40
1.37
1.33
1.30
1.27
1.23
1.20
1.17
1.14
1.11
1.08
1.05
1.02
0.99
0.96
0.94
0.91
0.88
0.86
0.83
0.80
0.78
0.75
0.72
0.70
0.67
0.65
0.62
0.59
0.57
0.54
0.51
0.48
cos
0.40
0.41
0.42
0.43
0.44
0.45
0.46
0.47
0.48
0.49
0.50
0.51
0.52
0.53
0.54
0.55
0.56
0.57
0.58
0.59
0.60
0.61
0.62
0.63
0.64
0.65
0.66
0.67
0.68
0.69
0.70
0.71
0.72
0.73
0.74
0.75
0.76
0.77
0.78
0.79
0.80
0.81
0.82
0.83
0.84
0.85
0.86
0.87
0.88
0.89
0.90
kvar rating of capacitor bank to install per kW of load, to improve cos (the power factor) or tan ,
to a given value
tan
cos
0.75
0.59
0.48
0.46
0.43
0.40
0.36
0.33
0.29
0.25
0.20
0.14
0.0
0.80
1.557
1.474
1.413
1.356
1.290
1.230
1.179
1.130
1.076
1.030
0.982
0.936
0.894
0.850
0.809
0.769
0.730
0.692
0.665
0.618
0.584
0.549
0.515
0.483
0.450
0.419
0.388
0.358
0.329
0.299
0.270
0.242
0.213
0.186
0.159
0.132
0.105
0.079
0.053
0.026
0.86
1.691
1.625
1.561
1.499
1.441
1.384
1.330
1.278
1.228
1.179
1.232
1.087
1.043
1.000
0.959
0.918
0.879
0.841
0.805
0.768
0.733
0.699
0.665
0.633
0.601
0.569
0.538
0.508
0.478
0.449
0.420
0.392
0.364
0.336
0.309
0.82
0.255
0.229
0.202
0.176
0.150
0.124
0.098
0.072
0.046
0.020
0.90
1.805
1.742
1.681
1.624
1.558
1.501
1.446
1.397
1.343
1.297
1.248
1.202
1.160
1.116
1.075
1.035
0.996
0.958
0.921
0.884
0.849
0.815
0.781
0.749
0.716
0.685
0.654
0.624
0.595
0.565
0.536
0.508
0.479
0.452
0.425
0.398
0.371
0.345
0.319
0.292
0.266
0.240
0.214
0.188
0.162
0.136
0.109
0.083
0.054
0.028
0.91
1.832
1.769
1.709
1.651
1.585
1.532
1.473
1.425
1.370
1.326
1.276
1.230
1.188
1.144
1.103
1.063
1.024
0.986
0.949
0.912
0.878
0.843
0.809
0.777
0.744
0.713
0.682
0.652
0.623
0.593
0.564
0.536
0.507
0.480
0.453
0.426
0.399
0.373
0.347
0.320
0.294
0.268
0.242
0.216
0.190
0.164
0.140
0.114
0.085
0.059
0.031
0.92
1.861
1.798
1.738
1.680
1.614
1.561
1.502
1.454
1.400
1.355
1.303
1.257
1.215
1.171
1.130
1.090
1.051
1.013
0.976
0.939
0.905
0.870
0.836
0.804
0.771
0.740
0.709
0.679
0.650
0.620
0.591
0.563
0.534
0.507
0.480
0.453
0.426
0.400
0.374
0.347
0.321
0.295
0.269
0.243
0.217
0.191
0.167
0.141
0.112
0.086
0.058
0.93
1.895
1.831
1.771
1.713
1.647
1.592
1.533
1.485
1.430
1.386
1.337
1.291
1.249
1.205
1.164
1.124
1.085
1.047
1.010
0.973
0.939
0.904
0.870
0.838
0.805
0.774
0.743
0.713
0.684
0.654
0.625
0.597
0.568
0.541
0.514
0.487
0.460
0.434
0.408
0.381
0.355
0.329
0.303
0.277
0.251
0.225
0.198
0.172
0.143
0.117
0.089
0.94
1.924
1.840
1.800
1.742
1.677
1.628
1.567
1.519
1.464
1.420
1.369
1.323
1.281
1.237
1.196
1.156
1.117
1.079
1.042
1.005
0.971
0.936
0.902
0.870
0.837
0.806
0.775
0.745
0.716
0.686
0.657
0.629
0.600
0.573
0.546
0.519
0.492
0.466
0.440
0.413
0.387
0.361
0.335
0.309
0.283
0.257
0.230
0.204
0.175
0.149
0.121
0.95
1.959
1.896
1.836
1.778
1.712
1.659
1.600
1.532
1.497
1.453
1.403
1.357
1.315
1.271
1.230
1.190
1.151
1.113
1.076
1.039
1.005
0.970
0.936
0.904
0.871
0.840
0.809
0.779
0.750
0.720
0.691
0.663
0.634
0.607
0.580
0.553
0.526
0.500
0.474
0.447
0.421
0.395
0.369
0.343
0.317
0.291
0.264
0.238
0.209
0.183
0.155
0.96
1.998
1.935
1.874
1.816
1.751
1.695
1.636
1.588
1.534
1.489
1.441
1.395
1.353
1.309
1.268
1.228
1.189
1.151
1.114
1.077
1.043
1.008
0.974
0.942
0.909
0.878
0.847
0.817
0.788
0.758
0.729
0.701
0.672
0.645
0.618
0.591
0.564
0.538
0.512
0.485
0.459
0.433
0.407
0.381
0.355
0.329
0.301
0.275
0.246
0.230
0.192
0.97
2.037
1.973
1.913
1.855
1.790
1.737
1.677
1.629
1.575
1.530
1.481
1.435
1.393
1.349
1.308
1.268
1.229
1.191
1.154
1.117
1.083
1.048
1.014
0.982
0.949
0.918
0.887
0.857
0.828
0.798
0.769
0.741
0.712
0.685
0.658
0.631
0.604
0.578
0.552
0.525
0.499
0.473
0.447
0.421
0.395
0.369
0.343
0.317
0.288
0.262
0.234
0.98
2.085
2.021
1.961
1.903
1.837
1.784
1.725
1.677
1.623
1.578
1.529
1.483
1.441
1.397
1.356
1.316
1.277
1.239
1.202
1.165
1.131
1.096
1.062
1.030
0.997
0.966
0.935
0.905
0.876
0.840
0.811
0.783
0.754
0.727
0.700
0.673
0.652
0.620
0.594
0.567
0.541
0.515
0.489
0.463
0.437
0.417
0.390
0.364
0.335
0.309
0.281
0.99
2.146
2.082
2.022
1.964
1.899
1.846
1.786
1.758
1.684
1.639
1.590
1.544
1.502
1.458
1.417
1.377
1.338
1.300
1.263
1.226
1.192
1.157
1.123
1.091
1.058
1.007
0.996
0.966
0.937
0.907
0.878
0.850
0.821
0.794
0.767
0.740
0.713
0.687
0.661
0.634
0.608
0.582
0.556
0.530
0.504
0.478
0.450
0.424
0.395
0.369
0.341
1
2.288
2.225
2.164
2.107
2.041
1.988
1.929
1.881
1.826
1.782
1.732
1.686
1.644
1.600
1.559
1.519
1.480
1.442
1.405
1.368
1.334
1.299
1.265
1.233
1.200
1.169
1.138
1.108
1.079
1.049
1.020
0.992
0.963
0.936
0.909
0.882
0.855
0.829
0.803
0.776
0.750
0.724
0.698
0.672
0.645
0.620
0.593
0.567
0.538
0.512
0.484
Value selected as an example on section 5.2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Value selected as an example on section 5.4
Fig. L15 : kvar to be installed per kW of load, to improve the power factor of an installation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 How to determine the optimum
level of compensation?
In the case of certain (common) types of
tariff, an examination of several bills covering
the most heavily-loaded period of the year
allows determination of the kvar level of
compensation required to avoid kvarh (reactiveenergy) charges. The pay-back period of a
bank of power-factor-correction capacitors
and associated equipment is generally about
18 months
5.3 Method based on the avoidance of tariff
penalties
The following method allows calculation of the rating of a proposed capacitor bank,
based on billing details, where the tariff structure corresponds with (or is similar to)
the one described in sub-clause 2.1 of this chapter.
The method determines the minimum compensation required to avoid these charges
which are based on kvarh consumption.
The procedure is as follows:
b Refer to the bills covering consumption for the 5 months of winter (in France these
are November to March inclusive).
Note: in tropical climates the summer months may constitute the period of heaviest
loading and highest peaks (owing to extensive air conditioning loads) so that a
consequent variation of high-tariff periods is necessary in this case. The remainder of
this example will assume Winter conditions in France.
b Identify the line on the bills referring to “reactive-energy consumed” and “kvarh
to be charged”. Choose the bill which shows the highest charge for kvarh (after
checking that this was not due to some exceptional situation).
For example: 15,966 kvarh in January.
b Evaluate the total period of loaded operation of the installation for that month, for
instance: 220 hours (22 days x 10 hours). The hours which must be counted are
those occurring during the heaviest load and the highest peak loads occurring on
the power system. These are given in the tariff documents, and are (commonly)
during a 16-hour period each day, either from 06.00 h to 22.00 h or from 07.00 h to
23.00 h according to the region. Outside these periods, no charge is made for kvarh
consumption.
b The necessary value of compensation in kvar = kvarh billed/number of hours of
operation(1) = Qc
The rating of the installed capacitor bank is generally chosen to be slightly larger
than that calculated.
Certain manufacturers can provide “slide rules” especially designed to facilitate
these kinds of calculation, according to particular tariffs. These devices and
accompanying documentation advice on suitable equipment and control schemes,
as well as drawing attention to constraints imposed by harmonic voltages on the
power system. Such voltages require either over dimensioned capacitors (in terms of
heat-dissipation, voltage and current ratings) and/or harmonic-suppression inductors
or filters.
P = 85.4 kW
ϕ' ϕ
Q'
Cos ϕ = 0.7
Cos ϕ'= 0.95
S = 122 kVA
S' = 90 kVA
Q = 87.1 kvar
Qc = 59 kvar
Q' = 28.1 kvar
S'
Q
S
Qc
Fig. L16 : Reduction of declared maximum kVA by powerfactor improvement
5.4 Method based on reduction of declared
maximum apparent power (kVA)
For consumers whose tariffs are based on a fixed charge per kVA declared, plus a
charge per kWh consumed, it is evident that a reduction in declared kVA would be
beneficial. The diagram of Figure L16 shows that as the power factor improves, the
kVA value diminishes for a given value of kW (P). The improvement of the power
factor is aimed at (apart from other advantages previously mentioned) reducing the
declared level and never exceeding it, thereby avoiding the payment of an excessive
price per kVA during the periods of excess, and/or tripping of the the main circuitbreaker. Figure L15 (previous page) indicates the value of kvar of compensation per
kW of load, required to improve from one value of power factor to another.
Example:
A supermarket has a declared load of 122 kVA at a power factor of 0.7 lagging, i.e.an
active-power load of 85.4 kW. The particular contract for this consumer was based on
stepped values of declared kVA (in steps of 6 kVA up to 108 kVA, and 12 kVA steps
above that value, this is a common feature in many types of two-part tariff). In the
case being considered, the consumer was billed on the basis of
132 kVA. Referring to Figure L15, it can be seen that a 60 kvar bank of capacitors
will improve the power factor of the load from 0.7 to 0.95 (0.691 x 85.4 = 59 kvar
85.4
in the figure). The declared value of kVA will then be
= 90 kVA , i.e. an
0.95
improvement of 30%.
(1) In the billing period, during the hours for which
reactive energy is charged for the case considered above:
15,996 kvarh
= 73 kvar
Qc =
220 h
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For 2-part tariffs based partly on a declared value
of kVA, Figure L17 allows determination of the
kvar of compensation required to reduce the
value of kVA declared, and to avoid exceeding it
L15
L - Power Factor Correction
6 Compensation at the terminals
of a transformer
The installation of a capacitor bank can avoid
the need to change a transformer in the event of
a load increase
6.1 Compensation to increase the available active
power output
Steps similar to those taken to reduce the declared maximum kVA, i.e. improvement
of the load power factor, as discussed in subclause 5.4, will maximise the available
transformer capacity, i.e. to supply more active power.
Cases can arise where the replacement of a transformer by a larger unit, to overcome
a load growth, may be avoided by this means. Figure L17 shows directly the power
(kW) capability of fully-loaded transformers at different load power factors, from
which the increase of active-power output can be obtained as the value of power
factor increases.
tan
cos
0.00
0.20
0.29
0.36
0.43
0.48
0.54
0.59
0.65
0.70
0.75
0.80
0.86
0.91
0.96
1.02
1
0.98
0.96
0.94
0.92
0.90
0.88
0.86
0.84
0.82
0.80
0.78
0.76
0.74
0.72
0.70
Nominal rating of transformers (in kVA)
100
160
250
315
400
100
160
250
315
400
98
157
245
309
392
96
154
240
302
384
94
150
235
296
376
92
147
230
290
368
90
144
225
284
360
88
141
220
277
352
86
138
215
271
344
84
134
210
265
336
82
131
205
258
328
80
128
200
252
320
78
125
195
246
312
76
122
190
239
304
74
118
185
233
296
72
115
180
227
288
70
112
175
220
280
500
500
490
480
470
460
450
440
430
420
410
400
390
380
370
360
350
630
630
617
605
592
580
567
554
541
529
517
504
491
479
466
454
441
800
800
784
768
752
736
720
704
688
672
656
640
624
608
592
576
560
1000
1000
980
960
940
920
900
880
860
840
820
800
780
760
740
720
700
1250
1250
1225
1200
1175
1150
1125
1100
1075
1050
1025
1000
975
950
925
900
875
1600
1600
1568
1536
1504
1472
1440
1408
1376
1344
1312
1280
1248
1216
1184
1152
1120
2000
2000
1960
1920
1880
1840
1800
1760
1720
1680
1640
1600
1560
1520
1480
1440
1400
Fig. L17 : Active-power capability of fully-loaded transformers, when supplying loads at different values of power factor
L16
Example: (see Fig. L18 )
An installation is supplied from a 630 kVA transformer loaded at 450 kW (P1) with a
450
mean power factor of 0.8 lagging. The apparent power S1 =
= 562 kVA
0.8
The corresponding reactive power
Q1 = S12 − P12 = 337 kvar
The anticipated load increase P2 = 100 kW at a power factor of 0.7 lagging.
The apparent power S2 = 100 = 143 kVA
The corresponding reactive0.7
power
Q2 = S22 − P22 = 102 kvar
What is the minimum value of capacitive kvar to be installed, in order to avoid a
change of transformer?
Total power now to be supplied:
P = P1 + P2 = 550 kW
The maximum reactive power capability of the 630 kVA transformer when delivering
550 kW is:
Q
Qm = S2 − P2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
S2
Q2
Q
P2
S1
S
P1
Q1
Qm = 6302 − 5502 = 307 kvar
Total reactive power required by the installation before compensation:
Q1 + Q2 = 337 + 102 = 439 kvar
So that the minimum size of capacitor bank to install:
Q m
P
Fig. L18 : Compensation Q allows the installation-load
extension S2 to be added, without the need to replace the
existing transformer, the output of which is limited to S
Qkvar = 439 - 307 = 132 kvar
It should be noted that this calculation has not taken account of load peaks and their
duration.
The best possible improvement, i.e. correction which attains a power factor of
1 would permit a power reserve for the transformer of 630 - 550 = 80 kW.
The capacitor bank would then have to be rated at 439 kvar.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
6 Compensation at the terminals
of a transformer
6.2 Compensation of reactive energy absorbed by
the transformer
Where metering is carried out at the MV side
of a transformer, the reactive-energy losses in
the transformer may need to be compensated
(depending on the tariff)
Perfect transformer
All previous references have been to shunt connected devices such as those used
in normal loads, and power factor-correcting capacitor banks etc. The reason for
this is that shunt connected equipment requires (by far) the largest quantities of
reactive energy in power systems; however, series-connected reactances, such as
the inductive reactances of power lines and the leakage reactance of transformer
windings, etc., also absorb reactive energy.
Leakage reactance
Secondary
winding
Primary
winding
The nature of transformer inductive reactances
Where metering is carried out at the MV side of a transformer, the reactive-energy
losses in the transformer may (depending on the tariff) need to be compensated. As
far as reactive-energy losses only are concerned, a transformer may be represented
by the elementary diagram of Figure L19. All reactance values are referred to
the secondary side of the transformer, where the shunt branch represents the
magnetizing-current path. The magnetizing current remains practically constant (at
about 1.8% of full-load current) from no load to full load, in normal circumstances,
i.e. with a constant primary voltage, so that a shunt capacitor of fixed value can be
installed at the MV or LV side, to compensate for the reactive energy absorbed.
Magnetizing
reactance
Fig. L19 : Transformer reactances per phase
The reactive power absorbed by a transformer
cannot be neglected, and can amount to (about)
5% of the transformer rating when supplying
its full load. Compensation can be provided by
a bank of capacitors. In transformers, reactive
power is absorbed by both shunt (magnetizing)
and series (leakage flux) reactances. Complete
compensation can be provided by a bank of
shunt-connected LV capacitors
Reactive-power absorption in series-connected
(leakage flux) reactance XL
A simple illustration of this phenomenon is given by the vector diagram of
Figure L20.
The reactive-current component through the load = I sin so that QL = VI sin .
The reactive-current component from the source = I sin ’ so that QE = EI sin ’.
It can be seen that E > V and sin ’ > sin .
The difference between EI sin ’ and VI sin gives the kvar per phase absorbed
by XL.
It can be shown that this kvar value is equal to I2XL (which is analogous to the I2R
active power (kW) losses due to the series resistance of power lines, etc.).
From the I2XL formula it is very simple to deduce the kvar absorbed at any load value
for a given transformer, as follows:
I
If per-unit values are used (instead of percentage values) direct multiplication of I
and XL can be carried out.
XL
E
Source
V
Load
L17
Example:
A 630 kVA transformer with a short-circuit reactance voltage of 4% is fully loaded.
What is its reactive-power (kvar) loss?
XL = 0.04 pu and I = 1 pu
loss = I2XL = 12 x 0.04 = 0.04 pu kvar
E
where 1 pu = 630 kVA
IXL
'
I
I sin
I sin '
Fig. L20 : Reactive power absorption by series inductance
The 3-phase kvar losses are 630 x 0.04 = 25.2 kvar (or, quite simply, 4% of 630 kVA).
At half load i.e. I = 0.5 pu the losses will be
0.52 x 0.04 = 0.01 pu = 630 x 0.01 = 6.3 kvar and so on...
This example, and the vector diagram of Figure L20 show that:
b The power factor at the primary side of a loaded transformer is different (normally
lower) than that at the secondary side (due to the absorption of vars)
b Full-load kvar losses due to leakage reactance are equal to the transformer
percentage reactance (4% reactance means a kvar loss equal to 4% of the kVA rating
of the transformer)
b kvar losses due to leakage reactance vary according to the current
(or kVA loading) squared
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
V
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
6 Compensation at the terminals
of a transformer
To determine the total kvar losses of a transformer the constant magnetizing-current
circuit losses (approx. 1.8% of the transformer kVA rating) must be added to the
foregoing “series” losses. Figure L21 shows the no-load and full-load kvar losses for
typical distribution transformers. In principle, series inductances can be compensated
by fixed series capacitors (as is commonly the case for long MV transmission lines).
This arrangement is operationally difficult, however, so that, at the voltage levels
covered by this guide, shunt compensation is always applied.
In the case of MV metering, it is sufficient to raise the power factor to a point where
the transformer plus load reactive-power consumption is below the level at which a
billing charge is made. This level depends on the tariff, but often corresponds to a
tan value of 0.31 (cos of 0.955).
Rated power (kVA)
100
160
250
315
400
500
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
Reactive power (kvar) to be compensated
No load
Full load
2.5
6.1
3.7
9.6
5.3
14.7
6.3
18.4
7.6
22.9
9.5
28.7
11.3
35.7
20
54.5
23.9
72.4
27.4
94.5
31.9
126
37.8
176
Fig. L21 : Reactive power consumption of distribution transformers with 20 kV primary windings
L18
As a matter of interest, the kvar losses in a transformer can be completely
compensated by adjusting the capacitor bank to give the load a (slightly) leading
power factor. In such a case, all of the kvar of the transformer is being supplied from
the capacitor bank, while the input to the MV side of the transformer is at unity power
factor, as shown in Figure L22.
E (Input voltage)
IXL
I
ϕ
V (Load voltage)
Load
current
I0 Compensation current
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. L22 : Overcompensation of load to completely compensate transformer reactive-power losses
In practical terms, therefore, compensation for transformer-absorbed kvar is included
in the capacitors primarily intended for power factor correction of the load, either
globally, partially, or in the individual mode. Unlike most other kvar-absorbing items,
the transformer absorption (i.e. the part due to the leakage reactance) changes
significantly with variations of load level, so that, if individual compensation is applied
to the transformer, then an average level of loading will have to be assumed.
Fortunately, this kvar consumption generally forms only a relatively small part of the
total reactive power of an installation, and so mismatching of compensation at times
of load change is not likely to be a problem.
Figure L21 indicates typical kvar loss values for the magnetizing circuit (“no-load
kvar” columns), as well as for the total losses at full load, for a standard range of
distribution transformers supplied at 20 kV (which include the losses due to the
leakage reactance).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
7 Power factor correction of
induction motors
Individual motor compensation is recommended
where the motor power (kVA) is large with
respect to the declared power of the installation
7.1 Connection of a capacitor bank and protection
settings
General precautions
Because of the small kW consumption, the power factor of a motor is very low at noload or on light load. The reactive current of the motor remains practically constant at
all loads, so that a number of unloaded motors constitute a consumption of reactive
power which is generally detrimental to an installation, for reasons explained in
preceding sections.
Two good general rules therefore are that unloaded motors should be switched off,
and motors should not be oversized (since they will then be lightly loaded).
Connection
The bank of capacitors should be connected directly to the terminals of the motor.
Special motors
It is recommended that special motors (stepping, plugging, inching, reversing motors,
etc.) should not be compensated.
Effect on protection settings
After applying compensation to a motor, the current to the motor-capacitor
combination will be lower than before, assuming the same motor-driven load
conditions. This is because a significant part of the reactive component of the motor
current is being supplied from the capacitor, as shown in Figure L23.
Where the overcurrent protection devices of the motor are located upstream of the
motor capacitor connection (and this will always be the case for terminal-connected
capacitors), the overcurrent relay settings must be reduced in the ratio:
cos before compensation / cos after compensation
For motors compensated in accordance with the kvar values indicated in Figure L24
(maximum values recommended for avoidance of self-excitation of standard
induction motors, as discussed in sub-clause 7.2), the above-mentioned ratio
will have a value similar to that indicated for the corresponding motor speed in
Figure L25.
After
compensation
Transformer
Power
made
available
Active
power
Motor
M
750
10
12.5
16
17
21
28
30
37
43
52
61
71
79
98
106
117
Figure L24 : Maximum kvar of power factor correction applicable to motor terminals without risk
of self excitation
C
M
L19
Reactive
power
supplied
by capacitor
Fig. L23 : Before compensation, the transformer supplies all
the reactive power; after compensation, the capacitor supplies
a large part of the reactive power
Speed in rpm
750
1000
1500
3000
Reduction factor
0.88
0.90
0.91
0.93
Fig. L25 : Reduction factor for overcurrent protection after compensation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Before
compensation
3-phase motors 230/400 V
Nominal power kvar to be installed
Speed of rotation (rpm)
kW
hp
3000
1500
1000
22
30
6
8
9
30
40
7.5
10
11
37
50
9
11
12.5
45
60
11
13
14
55
75
13
17
18
75
100
17
22
25
90
125
20
25
27
110
150
24
29
33
132
180
31
36
38
160
218
35
41
44
200
274
43
47
53
250
340
52
57
63
280
380
57
63
70
355
482
67
76
86
400
544
78
82
97
450
610
87
93
107
L - Power Factor Correction
When a capacitor bank is connected to the
terminals of an induction motor, it is important
to check that the size of the bank is less than
that at which self-excitation can occur
7 Power factor correction of
induction motors
7.2 How self-excitation of an induction motor can be
avoided
When a motor is driving a high-inertia load, the motor will continue to rotate (unless
deliberately braked) after the motor supply has been switched off.
The “magnetic inertia” of the rotor circuit means that an emf will be generated in the
stator windings for a short period after switching off, and would normally reduce to
zero after 1 or 2 cycles, in the case of an uncompensated motor.
Compensation capacitors however, constitute a 3-phase reactive load for this
decaying emf, which causes capacitive currents to flow through the stator windings.
These stator currents will produce a rotating magnetic field in the rotor which acts
exactly along the same axis and in the same direction as that of the decaying
magnetic field.
The rotor flux consequently increases; the stator currents increase; and the voltage
at the terminals of the motor increases; sometimes to dangerously-high levels. This
phenomenon is known as self-excitation and is one reason why AC generators
are not normally operated at leading power factors, i.e. there is a tendency to
spontaneously (and uncontrollably) self excite.
Notes:
1. The characteristics of a motor being driven by the inertia of the load are not
rigorously identical to its no-load characteristics. This assumption, however, is
sufficiently accurate for practical purposes.
2. With the motor acting as a generator, the currents circulating are largely reactive,
so that the braking (retarding) effect on the motor is mainly due only to the load
represented by the cooling fan in the motor.
3. The (almost 90° lagging) current taken from the supply in normal circumstances by
the unloaded motor, and the (almost 90° leading) current supplied to the capacitors
by the motor acting as a generator, both have the same phase relationship to
the terminal voltage. It is for this reason that the two characteristics may be
superimposed on the graph.
In order to avoid self-excitation as described above, the kvar rating of the capacitor
bank must be limited to the following maximum value:
Qc y 0.9 x Io x Un x 3 where Io = the no-load current of the motor and Un =
phase-to-phase nominal voltage of the motor in kV. Figure L24 previous page gives
appropriate values of Qc corresponding to this criterion.
L20
Example
A 75 kW, 3,000 rpm, 400 V, 3-phase motor may have a capacitor bank no larger
than 17 kvar according to Figure L24. The table values are, in general, too small to
adequately compensate the motor to the level of cos normally required. Additional
compensation can, however, be applied to the system, for example an overall bank,
installed for global compensation of a number of smaller appliances.
High-inertia motors and/or loads
In any installation where high-inertia motor driven loads exist, the circuit-breakers or
contactors controlling such motors should, in the event of total loss of power supply,
be rapidly tripped.
If this precaution is not taken, then self excitation to very high voltages is likely to
occur, since all other banks of capacitors in the installation will effectively be in
parallel with those of the high-inertia motors.
The protection scheme for these motors should therefore include an overvoltage
tripping relay, together with reverse-power checking contacts (the motor will feed
power to the rest of the installation, until the stored inertial energy is dissipated).
If the capacitor bank associated with a high inertia motor is larger than that
recommended in Figure L24, then it should be separately controlled by a circuitbreaker or contactor, which trips simultaneously with the main motor-controlling
circuit-breaker or contactor, as shown in Figure L26.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. L26 : Connection of the capacitor bank to the motor
Closing of the main contactor is commonly subject to the capacitor contactor being
previously closed.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
8 Example of an installation
before and after power-factor
correction
Installation before P.F. correction
→ → → (1)
kVA=kW+kvar
kVA
kW
kvar
630 kVA
b kvarh are billed heavily above the declared
level
b Apparent power kVA is significantly greater
than the kW demand
b The corresponding excess current causes
losses (kWh) which are billed
b The installation must be over-dimensioned
Characteristics of the installation
500 kW cos ϕ = 0.75
b Transformer is overloaded
b The power demand is
P
500
= 665 kVA
S=
=
cos ϕ 0.75
S = apparent power
Installation after P.F. correction
→→→
kVA=kW+kvar
kVA
kW
630 kVA
b The consumption of kvarh is
v Eliminated, or
v Reduced, according to the cos ϕ required
b The tariff penalties
v For reactive energy where applicable
v For the entire bill in some cases are
eliminated
b The fixed charge based on kVA demand is
adjusted to be close to the active power kW
demand
Characteristics of the installation
500 kW cos ϕ = 0.928
b Transformer no longer overloaded
b The power-demand is 539 kVA
b There is 14% spare-transformer capacity
available
400 V
400 V
b The current flowing into the installation
downstream of the circuit breaker is
P
I=
= 960 A
3U cos ϕ
b The current flowing into the installation
through the circuit breaker is 778 A
b Losses in cables are calculated as a
function of the current squared: 9602
P=I2R
b The losses in the cables are
7782
= 65% of the former value,
9602
thereby economizing in kWh consumed
cos ϕ = 0.75
b Reactive energy is supplied through the
transformer and via the installation wiring
b The transformer, circuit breaker, and cables
must be over-dimensioned
cos ϕ = 0.928
b Reactive energy is supplied by the capacitor
bank
reduced to
L21
250 kvar
Capacitor bank rating is 250 kvar
in 5 automatically-controlled steps of 50 kvar.
cos ϕ = 0.75
workshop
Note: In fact, the cos ϕ of the workshop remains at 0.75 but cos ϕ for all the
installation upstream of the capacitor bank to the transformer LV terminals
is 0.928.
As mentioned in Sub-clause 6.2 the cos ϕ at the HV side of the transformer
will be slightly lower (2), due to the reactive power losses in the transformer.
Fig. L27 : Technical-economic comparison of an installation before and after power-factor correction
(1) The arrows denote vector quantities.
(2) Particularly in the pre-corrected case.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
cos ϕ = 0.75
workshop
L - Power Factor Correction
9 The effects of harmonics
9.1 Problems arising from power-system harmonics
The presence of harmonics in electrical systems means that current and voltage are
distorted and deviate from sinusoidal waveforms.
Designers are requested to pay more and more attention to energy savings and
improved availability of electricity. This is why harmonics are a growing concern in the
management of electrical systems today.
Harmonics have existed from the earliest days of the industry and were (and still
are) caused by the non-linear magnetizing impedances of transformers, reactors,
fluorescent lamp ballasts, etc… In addition, power electronic devices have become
abundant today because of their capabilities for precise process control and energy
savings benefits. However, they also bring drawbacks to electrical distribution
systems: harmonics.
Harmonic currents caused by nonlinear loads connected to the distribution system
are flowing through the system impedances, and in turn distorts the supply voltage.
Such loads are increasingly more abundant in all industrial, commercial, and
residential installations and their percentage of the total load is growing steadily.
Examples include:
b Industrial equipment (welders, induction furnaces, battery chargers, DC power
supplies)
b Variable Speed Drives for AC and DC motors
b Uninterruptible Power Supplies (UPS)
b Office equipment (PCs, printers, servers, displays, etc.)
b Household appliances (TVs, microwave ovens, fluorescent lighting, washing
machines and dryers,light dimmers)
Harmonic currents increase the r.m.s. current in electrical systems and deteriorate
the supply voltage quality. They stress the electrical network and potentially damage
equipment. They may disrupt normal operation of devices and increase operating
costs.
Symptoms of problematic harmonic levels include overheating of transformers,
motors and cables, thermal tripping of protective devices and logic faults of digital
devices. In addition, the life span of many devices is reduced by elevated operating
temperatures.
L22
Capacitors are especially sensitive to harmonic components of the supply voltage
due to the fact that capacitive reactance decreases as the frequency increases. In
practice, this means that a relatively small percentage of harmonic voltage can cause
a significant current to flow in the capacitor circuit.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A number of features may be used in various ways to reduce the consequences of
harmonics. In this section, practical means of reducing the influence of harmonics
are recommended, with particular reference to capacitor banks. A more detailed
overview is presented in chapter M: Harmonic
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
9 The effects of harmonics
9.2 Risk of resonance
Supply network
Uh
Considering the simplified circuit represented on Figure L28 (no PFC capacitors
connected):
The voltage distortion Vh at the busbar level results from two different factors:
Ih
v connection of non-linear loads generating harmonic currents Ih,
v voltage distortion Uh present on the supply network due to non-linear loads outside
of the considered circuit (incoming harmonic voltage).
A significant indicator of harmonic importance is the percentage of non-linear loads
NLL, calculated by the formula:
Vh
NLL(%) =
Linear
load
The connection of PFC capacitors (without reactors) results in the amplification of
harmonic currents at the busbar level, and an increase of the voltage distortion.
Non-linear
loads
Capacitors are linear reactive devices, and consequently do not generate harmonics.
The installation of capacitors in a power system (in which the impedances are
predominantly inductive) can, however, result in total or partial resonance occurring
at one of the harmonic frequencies.
Fig. L28 : Simplified circuit diagram
Uh
Power of non-linear loads
Power of supply transformer
Because of harmonics, the current IC circulating through the PFC capacitors is
higher compared to the situation where only the fundamental current I1 is present.
Supply network
If the natural frequency of the capacitor bank/ power-system reactance combination
is close to a particular harmonic, then partial resonance will occur, with amplified
values of voltage and current at the harmonic frequency concerned. In this particular
case, the elevated current will cause overheating of the capacitor, with degradation of
the dielectric, which may result in its eventual failure.
Ih
The order h0 of the natural resonant frequency between the system inductance and
the capacitor bank is given by:
Vh
h0
Capacitor
bank
Non-linear
loads
Fig. L29 : Simplified circuit diagram
Where:
SSC = the level of system short-circuit power (kVA) at the point of connection of the
capacitor
Q = capacitor bank rating in kvar
h0 = the order of the natural frequency f0 , i.e. f0/50 for a 50 Hz system, or f0/60 for a
60 Hz system.
L23
For example:
Transformer power rating:
S = 630kVA
Short-circuit voltage:
uSC = 6%
Short-circuit power at the busbar level:
SSC ~ 10 MVA
Reactive power of the capacitor bank:
Q = 350 kvar
Then:
h0
SSC
Q
10.103
350
5.5
The natural frequency of the capacitor/system-inductance combination is close to the
5th harmonic frequency of the system.
For a 50Hz system, the natural frequency f0 is then equal to f0 = 50 x h0 = 50 x 5.5 =
275 Hz
9.3 Possible solutions
Standard capacitors
The presence of harmonics in the supply voltage results in abnormally high current
levels through the capacitors. An allowance is made for this by designing capacitors
for an r.m.s. value of current equal to 1.3 times the nominal rated current. All series
elements, such as connections, fuses, switches, etc., associated with the capacitors
are similarly oversized, between 1.3 to 1.5 times the nominal ratings.
Standard capacitors can be used if the percentage of non-linear loads is lower than
10% (NLL 10%).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Linear
load
SSC
Q
L - Power Factor Correction
Uh
Capacitors with increased current rating
Supply network
Capacitors with improved current capability ("heavy duty") can be used in order to
increase the safety margin. The technology of these capacitors allows a higher overcurrent compared to what is strictly requested by the standards.
Another possibility is to use capacitors with increased rated current and voltage.
Ih
As the same reactive power must be generated, the capacitors must have the same
capacitance.
With a rated voltage UN (higher than the system voltage U), the rated current IN and
the rated power
Vh
Linear
load
Non-linear
loads
Fig. L30 : Simplified circuit diagram
QN will be given by the formulas:
Capacitor
bank
+
detuned
reactor
IN
I
UN
U
and
QN
Q
UN
U
2
Capacitors with improved current rating can be used if the percentage of non-linear
loads is lower than 20% (NLL 20%).
Connection of Power Factor Correction capacitors with
detuned reactors
In order to attenuate the effects of harmonics (significant increase of capacitor
current as well as high current and voltage distortion ), reactors should be associated
to capacitors. Reactors and capacitors are configured in a series resonant circuit,
tuned so that the series resonant frequency is below the lowest harmonic frequency
present in the system.
The use of detuned reactors thus prevents harmonic resonance problems, avoids the
risk of overloading the capacitors and helps reduce voltage harmonic distortion in the
network.
The tuning frequency can be expressed by the relative impedance of the reactor (in
%, relative to the capacitor impedance), or by the tuning order, or directly in Hz.
The most common values of relative impedance are 5.7, 7 and 14 % (14 % is used
with high level of 3rd harmonic voltages).
L24
Relative impedance
(%)
Tuning order
Tuning frequency
@50Hz (Hz)
Tuning frequency
@60Hz (Hz)
5.7
4.2
210
250
7
3.8
190
230
14
2.7
135
160
Fig. L31 : Correspondance between relative impedance, tuning order and tuning frequency
In this arrangement, the presence of the reactor increases the fundamental
frequency voltage (50 or 60Hz) across the capacitor.
This feature is taken into account by using capacitors which are designed with
a rated voltage UN higher than the network service voltage US, as shown on the
following table.
Capacitor Rated Voltage UN (V)
Network Service Voltage US (V)
50 Hz
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Relative Impedance
(%)
5,7
60 Hz
400
690
400
480
600
480
830
480
575
690
7
14
480
Fig. L32 : Typical values of capacitor rated voltage
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
480
9 The effects of harmonics
Summary
Practical rules are given in the following table, for selection of the suitable
configuration, depending on the system parameters:
b SSC = 3-phase short-circuit power in kVA at the busbar level
b Sn = sum of the kVA ratings of all transformers supplying (i.e. directly connected to)
the busbar
b Gh = sum of the kVA ratings of all harmonic-generating devices (static converters,
inverters, variable speed drives, etc.) connected to the busbar. If the ratings of some
of these devices are quoted in kW only, assume an average power factor of 0.7 to
obtain the kVA ratings
General rule (for any size of transformer):
Gh SSC/120
Standard capacitors
SSC/120 < Gh SSC/70
SSC/70 < Gh SSC/30
Heavy Duty
capacitors or
capacitors with
voltage rating
increased by 10%
Heavy Duty
capacitors or
capacitors with
voltage rating
increased by 20%
+ detuned reactor
Gh > SSC/30
Harmonic filtering
necessary
See chapter M
"Harmonic
management"
Simplified rule (if transformer rating 2MVA):
Gh 0.1 x Sn
Standard capacitors
0.1 x Sn < Gh 0.2 x Sn 0.2 x Sn < Gh 0.5 x Sn
Heavy Duty
capacitors or
capacitors with
voltage rating
increased by 10%
Heavy Duty
capacitors or
capacitors with
voltage rating
increased by 20%
+ detuned reactor
Gh > 0.5 x Sn
Harmonic filtering
necessary
See chapter M
"Harmonic
management"
Fig. L33 : Simplified rules
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L25
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
L - Power Factor Correction
10 Implementation of capacitor
banks
10.1 Capacitor elements
Technology
Capacitors at low voltage are dry-type units (i.e. are not impregnated by liquid
dielectric) comprising metallised polypropylene self-healing film in the form of a twofilm roll.
Self-healing is a process by which the capacitor restores itself in the event of a fault
in the dielectric which can happen during high overloads, voltage transients, etc.
When insulation breaks down, a short duration arc is formed (Figure L34 - top). The
intense heat generated by this arc causes the metallization in the vicinity of the arc to
vaporise (Fig. L34 - middle).
Simultaneously it re-insulates the electrodes and maintains the operation and
integrity of the capacitor (Fig. L34 - bottom).
(a)
(b)
Figure 1 - (a) Metal layer - (b) Polypropylene film
Figure 2
L26
Figure 3
Fig. L34 : Illustration of self-healing phenomena
Protection scheme
Capacitors must be associated with overload protection devices (fuses, or circuit
breaker, or overload relay + contactor), in order to limit the consequences of overcurrents. This may occur in case of overvoltage or high harmonic distortion.
In addition to external protection devices, capacitors are protected by a high-quality
system (Pressure Sensitive Disconnector, also called ‘tear-off fuse’) which switches
off the capacitors if an internal fault occurs. This enables safe disconnection and
electrical isolation at the end of the life of the capacitor.
The protection system operates as follows:
b Current levels greater than normal, but insufficient to trigger the over-current
protection sometimes occur, e.g. due to a microscopic flow in the dielectric film. Such
“faults” often reseal due to local heating caused by the leakage current,
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b If the leakage current persists, the defect may produce gas by vaporizing of the
metallisation at the faulty location. This will gradually build up a pressure within the
container. Pressure can only lead to vertical expansion by bending lid outwards.
Connecting wires break at intended spots. Capacitor is disconnected irreversibly.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
10 Implementation of capacitor
banks
Cross-section wiew of a three-phase capacitor after
Pressure Sensitive Device operated: bended lid and
disconnected wires.
Fig. L35 : Cross-section view of a three-phase capacitor after Pressure Sensitive Device
operated: bended lid and disconnected wires
Main electrical characteristics, according to IEC standard 60831-1/2: "Shunt power
capacitors of the self-healing type for a.c. systems having a rated voltage up to and
including 1 000 V".
Electrical characteristics
Capacitance tolerance
–5 % to +10 % for units and banks up to 100 kvar
–5 % to +5 % for units and banks above 100 kvar
Temperature range
Min: from -50 to +5°C
Max: from +40 to +55°C
Permissible current overload
1.3 x IN
Permissible voltage overload
1.1 x UN, 8 h every 24 h
1.15 x UN, 30 min every 24 h
1.2 x UN, 5min
1.3 x UN, 1min
2.15 x UN for 10 s (type test)
Discharging unit
to 75 V in 3 min or less
L27
Fig. L36 : Main characteristics of capacitors according to IEC 60831-1/2
10.2 Choice of protection, control devices and
connecting cables
The choice of upstream cables, protection and control devices depends on the
current loading.
For capacitors, the current is a function of:
b The system voltage (fundamental and harmonics),
IN
Q
3.U
with:
b Q: power rating (kvar)
b U: phase-to-phase voltage (kV)
Overload protection devices have to be implemented and set according to the
expected harmonic distortion. The following table summarizes the harmonic voltages
to be considered in the different configurations, and the corresponding maximum
overload factor IMP/IN. (IMP = maximum permissible current)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b The power rating.
The rated current IN of a 3-phase capacitor bank is equal to:
L - Power Factor Correction
Configuration
Harmonic order
3
5
7
11
13
Standard capacitors
Heavy Duty capacitors
THDu
max (%)
IMP/IN
5
1.5
7
1.8
Capacitors + 5.7% reactor
0.5
5
4
3.5
3
10
1.31
Capacitors + 7% reactor
0.5
6
4
3.5
3
8
1.19
Capacitors + 14% reactor
3
8
7
3.5
3
6
1.12
Fig. L37 : Typical permissible overload currents
Short time delay setting of circuit breakers (short-circuit protection) should be set at
10 x IN in order to be insensitive to inrush current.
Example 1:
50 kvar – 400V – 50 Hz – Standard capacitors
IN
50
3 u 0.4
72A
Long time delay setting: 1.5 x 72 = 108 A
Short time delay setting: 10 x 72 = 720 A
Example 2:
50 kvar – 400V – 50 Hz – Capacitors + 5.7% detuned reactor
IN
72A
Long time delay setting: 1.31 x 72 = 94 A
Short time delay setting: 10 x IN = 720 A
Upstream cables
Figure L38 next page gives the minimum recommended cross section area of the
upstream cable for capacitor banks.
Cables for control
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
L28
The minimum cross section area of these cables will be 1.5 mm2 for 230 V. For the
secondary side of the current transformer, the recommended cross section area is
2.5 mm2.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
10 Implementation of capacitor
banks
Bank power
(kvar)
230 V
400 V
5
10
10
20
15
30
20
40
25
50
30
60
40
80
50
100
60
120
70
140
90-100
180
200
120
240
150
250
300
180-210
360
245
420
280
480
315
540
350
600
385
660
420
720
Copper
cross- section
(mm2)
2.5
4
6
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
240
2 x 95
2 x 120
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 240
2 x 300
3 x 150
3 x 185
Aluminium
cross- section
(mm2)
16
16
16
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
185
240
2 x 95
2 x 120
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 240
2 x 300
3 x 185
3 x 240
3 x 240
3 x 300
Fig L38 : Cross-section of cables connecting medium and high power capacitor banks(1)
Voltage transients
High-frequency voltage and current transients occur when switching a capacitor
bank into service. The maximum voltage peak does not exceed (in the absence of
harmonics) twice the peak value of the rated voltage when switching uncharged
capacitors.
In the case of a capacitor being already charged at the instant of switch closure,
however, the voltage transient can reach a maximum value approaching 3 times the
normal rated peak value.
L29
This maximum condition occurs only if:
b The existing voltage at the capacitor is equal to the peak value of rated voltage,
and
b The switch contacts close at the instant of peak supply voltage, and
b The polarity of the power-supply voltage is opposite to that of the charged
capacitor
In such a situation, the current transient will be at its maximum possible value, viz:
Twice that of its maximum when closing on to an initially uncharged capacitor, as
previously noted.
For any other values of voltage and polarity on the pre-charged capacitor, the
transient peaks of voltage and current will be less than those mentioned above.
In the particular case of peak rated voltage on the capacitor having the same polarity
as that of the supply voltage, and closing the switch at the instant of supply-voltage
peak, there would be no voltage or current transients.
The discharge delay time may be shortened, if necessary, by using discharge
resistors of a lower resistance value.
(1) Minimum cross-section not allowing for any correction
factors (installation mode, temperature, etc.). The calculations
were made for single-pole cables laid in open air at 30 °C.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Where automatic switching of stepped banks of capacitors is considered, therefore,
care must be taken to ensure that a section of capacitors about to be energized is
fully discharged.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter M
Harmonic management
Contents
1
2
3
The problem: why is it necessary to manage harmonics?
4
Harmonic measurement in electrical networks
M10
4.1 Procedures for harmonic measurement
4.2 Harmonic measurement devices
4.3 Which harmonic orders must be monitored and mitigated?
M10
M11
M12
5
Main effects of harmonics in electrical installations
M13
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
M13
M13
M15
M19
M19
6
7
Standards
M20
Solutions to mitigate harmonics
M21
7.1 Basic solutions
7.2 Harmonic filtering
7.3 The method
M21
M22
M24
M2
Definition and origin of harmonics
M3
2.1 Definition
2.2 Origin of harmonics
M3
M5
Essential indicators of harmonic distortion
and measurement principles
M7
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
M7
M8
M9
M9
M9
Power factor
Crest factor
Harmonic spectrum
r.m.s. values
Usefulness of the various indicators
M1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Resonance
Increased losses
Overload of equipment
Disturbances affecting sensitive loads
Economic impact
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
1 The problem: why is it necessary
to manage harmonics?
Harmonic disturbances
Harmonics flowing in distribution networks represent disturbances in the flow of
electricity. The quality of electrical power is deteriorated, and the efficiency of the
system is decreased.
Here are the main risks linked to harmonics:
b Overload of distribution networks due to the increase of r.m.s. currents,
b Overload of neutral conductors, which current can exceed the phase currents,
b Overload, vibration and premature ageing of generators, transformers and motors
as well as increased transformer hum,
b Overload and premature ageing of Power Factor Correction capacitors,
b Distortion of the supply voltage that can disturb sensitive loads,
b Disturbance in communication networks and telephone lines.
Economic impact of disturbances
All these disturbances have an economic impact:
b Premature ageing of equipment means it must be replaced sooner, unless
oversized right from the start,
b Overload on the distribution network means higher equipment rating, increased
subscribed power level for the industrial customer, and increased power losses,
b Unexpected current distortion can lead to nuisance tripping and production halt.
A necessary concern for the design and management of
electrical installations
Harmonics are the result of the always expanding number of power electronic
devices. They have become abundant today because of their capabilities for
precise process control and energy saving benefits. Typical examples are Variable
Speed Drives in the Industry, and Compact Fluorescent Lamps in commercial and
residential areas.
International standards have been published in order to help the designers of
equipment and installations. Harmonic emission limits have been set, so that no
unexpected and negative impact of harmonics should be encountered. In parallel to
a better understanding of effects, solutions have been developed by the Industry.
Harmonic consideration is now a full part of the design of electrical installations.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
2 Definition and origin of harmonics
2.1 Definition
The presence of harmonics in electrical systems means that current and voltage are
distorted and deviate from sinusoidal waveforms.
Harmonic currents are caused by non-linear loads connected to the distribution
system. A load is said to be non-linear when the current it draws does not have the
same waveform as the supply voltage. The flow of harmonic currents through system
impedances in turn creates voltage harmonics, which distort the supply voltage.
On Figure M1 are presented typical current waveforms for single-phase (top) and
three-phase non-linear loads (bottom).
Fig. M1 : Examples of distorted current waveforms
The Fourier theorem states that all non-sinusoidal periodic functions can be
represented as the sum of terms (i.e. a series) made up of:
b A sinusoidal term at the fundamental frequency,
b Sinusoidal terms (harmonics) whose frequencies are whole multiples of the
fundamental frequency,
b A DC component, where applicable.
M3
The harmonic of order h (commonly referred to as simply the hth harmonic) in a
signal is the sinusoidal component with a frequency that is h times the fundamental
frequency.
The equation for the harmonic expansion of a periodic function y (t) is presented
below:
y (t ) = Y0 +
h=∞
∑ Yh 2sin(hωt - ϕh )
h =1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
where:
b Y0: value of the DC component, generally zero and considered as such hereinafter,
b Yh: r.m.s. value of the harmonic of order h,
b : angular frequency of the fundamental frequency,
b h: displacement of the harmonic component at t = 0.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
Figure M2 shows an example of a current wave affected by harmonic distortion on
a 50Hz electrical distribution system. The distorted signal is the sum of a number of
superimposed harmonics:
b The value of the fundamental frequency (or first order harmonic) is 50 Hz,
b The 3rd order harmonic has a frequency of 150 Hz,
b The 5th order harmonic has a frequency of 250 Hz,
b Etc…
I peak
(Ic)
Total
I rms (IG)
Fundamental
50 Hz
Ih1
Harmonic
3 (150 Hz)
Ih3
Harmonic
5 (250 Hz)
Ih5
Harmonic
7 (350 Hz)
Harmonic
9 (450 Hz)
Ih7
Ih8
Fig. M2 : Example of a current containing harmonics and expansion of the overall current into its
harmonic orders 1 (fundamental), 3, 5, 7 and 9
Individual harmonic component (or harmonic component of
order h)
M4
The individual harmonic component is defined as the percentage of harmonics for
order h with respect to the fundamental. Particularly:
uh (% ) = 100
h
Uh
U1
(%) = 100 h
for harmonic voltages
for harmonic currents
1
Total Harmonic Distortion (THD)
The Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) is an indicator of the distortion of a signal. It is
widely used in Electrical Engineering and Harmonic management in particular.
For a signal y, the THD is defined as:
=
h=
h=
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
⎛
⎞
⎟ =
⎟
⎝ 1⎠
∑ ⎜⎜
h
+
+ ... +
1
THD is the ratio of the r.m.s. value of all the harmonic components of the signal y, to
the fundamental Y1.
H is generally taken equal to 50, but can be limited in most cases to 25.
Note that THD can exceed 1 and is generally expressed as a percentage.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Definition and origin of harmonics
Current or voltage THD
For current harmonics, the equation is:
THDi =
h=H ⎛ I
⎜h
⎞
2
∑ ⎜ ⎟⎟
h=2 ⎝ I1
⎠
By introducing the total r.m.s value of the current: Irms =
following relation:
⎛I
THDi = ⎜⎜ rms
⎝ I1
h=H
∑ Ih2
we obtain the
h=1
2
⎞
⎟ −1
⎟
⎠
Irms = I1 1 + THDi2
equivalent to:
Example: for THDi = 40%, we get:
Irms = I1 1 + (
)2
= I1 1 +
1 ≈ I1 × 1
For voltage harmonics, the equation is:
THD =
h=H ⎛
⎞
⎟
⎟
h=2 ⎝ 1 ⎠
∑ ⎜⎜
2
h
2.2 Origin of harmonics
Harmonic currents
Equipment comprising power electronics circuits are typical non-linear loads and
generate harmonic currents. Such loads are increasingly frequent in all industrial,
commercial and residential installations and their percentage in overall electrical
consumption is growing steadily.
Examples include:
b Industrial equipment (welding machines, arc and induction furnaces, battery
chargers),
b Variable Speed Drives for AC or DC motors,
b Uninterruptible Power Supplies,
b Office equipment (PCs, printers, servers, etc.),
b Household appliances (TV sets, microwave ovens, fluorescent lighting, light
dimmers).
M5
Harmonic voltages
In order to understand the origin of harmonic voltages, let's consider the simplified
diagram on Fig. M3.
A
Zh
B
Ih
Non-linear
load
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. M3 : Single-line diagram showing the impedance of the supply circuit for a non-linear load
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
2 Definition and origin of harmonics
The reactance of a conductor increases as a function of the frequency of the current
flowing through the conductor. For each harmonic current (order h), there is therefore
an impedance Zh in the supply circuit.
The total system can be split into different circuits:
b One circuit representing the flow of current at the fundamental frequency,
b One circuit representing the flow of harmonic currents.
Zl
I 50 Hz
Zh
Ih
Vh
Non-linear
load
Non-linear
load
Vh = Harmonic voltage
= Z h x Ih
Fig. M4 : Split of circuit into fundamental and harmonic circuits
When the harmonic current of order h flows through impedance Zh, it creates a
harmonic voltage Uh, where Uh = Zh x Ih (by Ohm's law).
The voltage at point B is therefore distorted. All devices supplied via point B receive
a distorted voltage.
For a given harmonic current, the voltage distortion is proportional to the impedance
in the distribution network.
Flow of harmonic currents in distribution networks
The non-linear loads can be considered to inject the harmonic currents upstream
into the distribution network, towards the source. The harmonic currents generated
by the different loads sum up at the busbar level creating the harmonic distortion.
Because of the different technologies of loads, harmonic currents of the same order
are generally not in phase. This diversity effect results in a partial summation.
Iha
Backup power
supply
M6
Rectifier
Arc furnace
Welding machine
G
Ihb
Variable-speed drive
Power-factor
correction
Ihd
Fluorescent or
discharge lamps
Ihe
Devices drawing rectified
current (televisions,
computer hardware, etc.)
MV/LV
A
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Harmonic
disturbances to
distribution network
and other users
Linear loads
(do not create
harmonics)
Fig. M5 : Flow of harmonic currents in a distribution network
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Essential indicators of harmonic
distortion and measurement
principles
A number of indicators are used to quantify and evaluate the harmonic distortion in
current and voltage waveforms, namely:
b Power factor
b Crest factor
b Harmonic spectrum
b R.m.s. value
These indicators are indispensable in determining any necessary corrective action.
3.1 Power factor
The power factor is the ratio of the active power P (kW) to the apparent power S
(kVA). See Chapter L.
kW )
ë= P(kW
S(kVA )
The Power Factor must not be mixed-up with the Displacement Power Factor (cos),
relative to fundamental signals only.
As the apparent power is calculated from the r.m.s. values, the Power Factor
integrates voltage and current distortion.
When the voltage is sinusoidal or virtually sinusoidal (THDu ~ 0), it may be said that
the active power is only a function of the fundamental current. Then:
P ≈ P1 = U1I1cosϕ
Consequently:
ë = P = U1I1cosϕ
S
U1Irms
I1
1
=
Irms
1 + THDi2
As:
(see 2.1), hence:
ë ≈
cosϕ
1 + THDi2
Figure M6 shows a graph of /cos as a function of THDi, for THDu ~ 0.
λ/cos ϕ
1.2
M7
1
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
0
20
40
60
80
THDi (%)
100
Fig. M6 : Variation of /cos as a function of THDi, for THDu ~ 0
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
120
140
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M - Harmonic management
M - Harmonic management
3.2 Crest factor
The crest factor is the ratio between the value of the peak current or voltage
(IM or UM) and its r.m.s. value.
b For a sinusoidal signal, the crest factor is therefore equal to 2.
b For a non-sinusoidal signal, the crest factor can be either greater than or less than 2.
The crest factor for the current drawn by non-linear loads is commonly much higher
than2. It is generally between 1.5 and 2 and can even reach 5 in critical cases.
A high crest factor signals high current peaks which, when detected by protection
devices, can cause nuisance tripping.
Examples:
Figure M7 represents the current absorbed by a compact fluorescent lamp.
Ir.m.s. :
0.16A
IM :
0.6A
THDi :
145%
Crest factor:
3.75
A
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6
-0.8
0
0
0.0s
0.01s
0.02s
0.03s
Fig. M7 : Typical current waveform of a compact fluorescent lamp
M8
Figure M8 represents the voltage supplying non-linear loads through a high
impedance line, with a typical "flat top" distorted waveform.
Vr.m.s. :
500V
VM :
670V
THDu :
6.2%
Crest factor:
1.34
V
600
400
200
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
0
-200
-400
-600
0.0s
0.02s
0.04s
Fig. M8 : Typical voltage waveform in case of high impedance line supplying non-linear loads
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Essential indicators of harmonic
distortion and measurement
principles
U(t)
3.3 Harmonic spectrum
The harmonic spectrum is the representation of the amplitude of each harmonic
order with respect to its frequency.
1
Figure M9 shows an example of harmonic spectrum for a rectangular signal.
t
Each type of device causing harmonics draws a particular form of current, with
a particular harmonic content. This characteristic can be displayed by using the
harmonic spectrum.
3.4 r.m.s. value
H%
The r.m.s. value of voltage and current can be calculated as a function of the r.m.s.
value of the various harmonic components:
100
Irms =
H
∑ Ih2 = I12 + I22 + ... + IH2
h =1
33
20
h
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
Vrms =
H
∑ Vh2 = V12 + V22 + ... + VH2
h=1
Fig. M9 : Harmonic spectrum for a rectangular signal U(t)
3.5 Usefulness of the various indicators
THDu is an indicator of the distortion of the voltage wave. Below are given indicative
values of THDu and the corresponding consequences in an installation:
b 5%: normal situation, no risk of malfunctions,
b 5 to 8%: significant harmonic distortion, some malfunctions are possible,
b 8%: major harmonic distortion, malfunctions are probable. In-depth analysis and
the installation of mitigation devices are required.
THDi is an indicator of the distortion of the current wave. The current distortion can
be different in the different parts of an installation. The origin of possible disturbances
can be detected by measuring the THDi of different circuits.
Below are given indicative values of THDi and the corresponding phenomena for a
whole installation:
b 10%: normal situation, no risk of malfunctions,
b 10 to 50%: significant harmonic distortion with a risk of temperature rise and the
resulting need to oversize cables and sources,
b 50%: major harmonic distortion, malfunctions are probable. In-depth analysis and
the installation of mitigation devices are required.
M9
Power factor is used to determine the rating for the different devices of the
installation.
Crest factor is used to characterise the aptitude of a generator (or UPS) to supply
high instantaneous currents. For example, computer equipment draws highly
distorted current for which the crest factor can reach 3 to 5.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Harmonic spectrum provides a different representation of electrical signals and can
be used to evaluate their distortion.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
4 Harmonic measurement in
electrical networks
4.1 Procedures for harmonic measurement
Harmonic measurements are carried out on industrial or commercial sites:
b Preventively, to obtain an overall idea on distribution-network status (network
mapping),
b In view of corrective action, to determine the origin of a disturbance and determine
the solutions required to eliminate it,
b To check the validity of a solution (followed by modifications in the distribution
network to check the reduction of harmonic disturbances)
The harmonic indicators can be measured:
b By an expert present on the site for a limited period of time (one day), giving
precise, but limited perception,
b By instrumentation devices installed and operating for a significant period of time
(at least one week) giving a reliable overview of the situation,
b Or by devices permanently installed in the distribution network, allowing a follow-up
of Power Quality.
One-shot or corrective actions
This kind of action is carried-out in case of observed disturbances, for which
harmonics are suspected. In order to determine the origin of the disturbances,
measurements of current and voltage are performed:
b At the supply source level,
b On the busbars of the main distribution switchboard (or on the MV busbars),
b On each outgoing circuit in the main distribution switchboard (or on the MV
busbars).
For accurate results, it is necessary to know the precise operating conditions of
the installation and particularly the status of the capacitor banks (operating or not,
number of connected steps).
The results of measurement will help the analysis in order to:
b Determine any necessary derating of equipment in the installation, or
b Quantify any necessary harmonic protection and filtering systems to be installed in
the distribution network, or
b Check the compliance of the electrical installation with the applicable standards or
Utility regulations (maximum permissible harmonic emission).
Long-term or preventive actions
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M10
For a number of reasons, the installation of permanent measurement devices in the
distribution network is very valuable.
b The presence of an expert on site is limited in time and it is not always possible
to observe all the possible situations. Only a number of measurements at different
points in the installation and over a sufficiently long period (one week to a month)
provide an overall view of operation and take into account all the situations that can
occur following:
v Fluctuations in the supply source,
v Variations in the operation of the installation,
v The addition of new equipment in the installation.
b Measurement devices installed in the distribution network prepare and facilitate the
diagnosis of the experts, thus reducing the number and duration of their visits.
b Permanent measurement devices detect any new disturbances arising following
the installation of new equipment, the implementation of new operating modes or
fluctuations in the supply network.
b For an overall evaluation of network status (preventive analysis), this avoids:
v Renting of measurement equipment,
v Calling in experts,
v Having to connect and disconnect the measurement equipment. For the overall
evaluation of network status, the analysis on the main low-voltage distribution
switchboards (MLVS) can often be carried out by the incoming device and/or the
measurement devices equipping each outgoing circuit,
b For corrective actions, it is possible to:
v Determine the operating conditions at the time of the incident,
v Draw-up a map of the distribution network and evaluate the implemented solution.
The diagnosis may be improved by the use of additional dedicated equipment in
case of specific problem.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Harmonic measurement in
electrical networks
4.2 Harmonic measurement devices
Measurement devices provide instantaneous and average information concerning
harmonics. Instantaneous values are used for analysis of disturbances linked to
harmonics. Average values are used for Power Quality assessment.
The most recent measurement devices are designed referring to IEC standard
61000-4-7: "Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) – Part 4-7: Testing and
measurement techniques – General guide on harmonics and interharmonics
measurements and instrumentation, for power supply systems and equipment
connected thereto".
The supplied values include:
b The harmonic spectrum of currents and voltages (amplitudes and percentage of
the fundamental),
b The THD for current and voltage,
b For specific analysis: the phase angle between harmonic voltage and current of
the same order and the phase of the harmonics with respect to a common reference
(e.g. the fundamental voltage).
Average values are indicators of the long-term Power Quality. Typical and relevant
statistical data are for example measures averaged by periods of 10 minutes, during
observation periods of 1 week.
In order to meet the Power Quality objectives, 95% of the measured values should
be less than specified values.
Fig. M10 gives the maximum harmonic voltage in order to meet the requirements
of standard EN50160: "Voltage characteristics of electricity supplied by public
distribution networks", for Low and Medium Voltage.
Odd harmonics
Not multiples of 3
Order h
Relative amplitude
Uh : %
5
6
7
5
11
3.5
13
3
17
2
19
1.5
23
1.5
25
1.5
Odd harmonic s
Multiples of 3
Order h
Relative amplitude
Uh : %
3
5
9
1.5
15
0.5
21
0.5
Even harmonic
Order h
2
4
6...24
Relative amplitude
Uh : %
2
1
0.5
M11
Fig. M10 : Values of individual harmonic voltages at the supply terminals for orders up to 25 given in percent of the fundamental voltage U1
Portable instruments
The traditional observation and measurement methods include:
b Oscilloscope
An initial indication on the distortion affecting a signal can be obtained by viewing the
current or the voltage on an oscilloscope.
The waveform, when it diverges from a sinusoidal, clearly indicates the presence of
harmonics. Current and voltage peaks can be observed.
Note, however, that this method does not offer precise quantification of the harmonic
components.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Digital analyser
Only recent digital analysers can determine the values of all the mentioned indicators
with sufficient accuracy.
They are using digital technology, specifically a high performance algorithm called
Fast Fourier Transform (FFT). Current or voltage signals are digitized and the
algorithm is applied on data relative to time windows of 10 (50Hz systems) or 12
periods (for 60Hz systems) of the power frequency.
The amplitude and phase of harmonics up to the 40th or 50th order are calculated,
depending on the class of measurement.
M - Harmonic management
4 Harmonic measurement in
electrical networks
Processing of the successive values calculated using the FFT (smoothing,
classification, statistics) can be carried out by the measurement device or by external
software.
Functions of digital analysers
b Calculate the values of the harmonic indicators (power factor, crest factor,
individual harmonic amplitude, THD)
b In multi-channel analysers, supply virtually in real time the simultaneous spectral
decomposition of the currents and voltages
b Carry out various complementary functions (corrections, statistical detection,
measurement management, display, communication, etc.)
b Storage of data
Fixed instruments
Fig. M11 : Implementation of a digital Power Quality recorder
in a cabinet
Panel instrumentation provides continuous information to the Manager of the
electrical installation. Data can be accessible through dedicated power monitoring
devices or through the digital trip units of circuit breakers.
Fig. M12 : Example of Power and Energy meter
4.3 Which harmonic orders must be monitored and
mitigated?
The most significant harmonic orders in three-phase distribution networks are the
odd orders (3, 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ….)
M12
Triplen harmonics (order multiple of 3) are present only in three-phase, four-wire
systems, when single phase loads are connected between phase and neutral.
Utilities are mainly focusing on low harmonic orders (5, 7, 11, and 13).
Generally speaking, harmonic conditioning of the lowest orders (up to 13) is
sufficient. More comprehensive conditioning takes into account harmonic orders up
to 25.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Harmonic amplitudes normally decrease as the frequency increases. Sufficiently
accurate measurements are obtained by measuring harmonics up to order 30.
Fig. M13 : Example of electronic trip units of circuit-breakers
providing harmonic related information
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Main effects of harmonics in
electrical installations
M - Harmonic management
5.1 Resonance
The simultaneous use of capacitive and inductive devices in distribution networks
may result in parallel or series resonance.
The origin of the resonance is the very high or very low impedance values at the
busbar level, at different frequencies. The variations in impedance modify the current
and voltage in the distribution network.
Here, only parallel resonance phenomena, the most common, will be discussed.
Consider the following simplified diagram (see Fig. M14) representing an installation
made up of:
b A supply transformer,
b Linear loads
b Non-linear loads drawing harmonic currents
b Power factor correction capacitors
For harmonic analysis, the equivalent diagram is shown on Figure M15 where:
LS = Supply inductance (upstream network + transformer + line)
C = Capacitance of the power factor correction capacitors
R = Resistance of the linear loads
Ih = Harmonic current
By neglecting R, the impedance Z is calculated by a simplified formula:
Z =
Ih
with:
= pulsation of harmonic currents
Resonance occurs when the denominator (1-LSC²) tends toward zero. The
corresponding frequency is called the resonance frequency of the circuit. At that
frequency, impedance is at its maximum and high amounts of harmonic voltages
appear because of the circulation of harmonic currents. This results in major voltage
distortion. The voltage distortion is accompanied, in the LS+C circuit, by the flow of
harmonic currents greater than those drawn by the loads, as illustrated on Figure M16.
C
Non-linear
load
jLsω
1-LsCω 2
Capacitor
bank
The distribution network and the power factor correction capacitors are subjected to
high harmonic currents and the resulting risk of overloads. To avoid resonance, antiharmonic reactors can be installed in series with the capacitors.
Linear
load
Fig. M14 : Diagram of an installation
5.2 Increased losses
Ls
C
R
Losses in conductors
Ih
M13
The active power transmitted to a load is a function of the fundamental component
I1 of the current.
When the current drawn by the load contains harmonics, the r.m.s. value of the
current, Ir.m.s., is greater than the fundamental I1.
Z
Fig. M15 : Equivalent diagram of the installation shown in
Figure M14
Uh
Uh
Supply network
Supply network
Ih
Ih
Vh
Linear
load
Non-linear
loads
Fig. M16 : Illustration of parallel resonance
C
Linear
load
Non-linear
loads
Capacitor
bank
C
Capacitor
bank
+
Detuned
reactor
Fig. M17 : Reduced circulation of harmonic currents with detuned reactors
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Vh
M - Harmonic management
The definition of THDi being:
2
⎛I
⎞
THDi = ⎜⎜ r.m.s.⎟⎟ − 1
⎝ I1 ⎠
2
it may be deduced that: Ir.m.s. = I1. 1 + THDi
Figure M18 shows, as a function of the harmonic distortion:
b The increase in the r.m.s. current Ir.m.s. for a load drawing a given fundamental
current
b The increase in Joule losses, not taking into account the skin effect. (The reference
point in the graph is 1 for Ir.m.s. and Joules losses, the case when there are no
harmonics)
The harmonic currents cause an increase of the Joule losses in all conductors in
which they flow and additional temperature rise in transformers, switchgear, cables,
etc.
2.2
2
1.8
1.6
1.4
1.2
1
0.8
0
20
40
60
80
100
120
THD
(%)
Joules losses
Irms
M14
Fig. M18 : Increase in rms current and Joule losses as a function of the THD
Losses in asynchronous machines
The harmonic voltages (order h) supplied to asynchronous machines cause the
flow of currents in the rotor with frequencies higher than 50 Hz that are the origin of
additional losses.
Orders of magnitude
b A virtually rectangular supply voltage causes a 20% increase in losses
b A supply voltage with harmonics u5 = 8% (of U1, the fundamental voltage),
u7 = 5%, u11 = 3%, u13 = 1%, i.e. total harmonic distortion THDu equal to 10%, results
in additional losses of 6%
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Losses in transformers
Harmonic currents flowing in transformers cause an increase in the “copper” losses
due to the Joule effect and increased “iron” losses due to eddy currents. The
harmonic voltages are responsible for “iron” losses due to hysteresis.
It is generally considered that losses in windings increase as the square of the THDi
and that core losses increase linearly with the THDu.
In Utility distribution transformers, where distortion levels are limited, losses increase
between 10 and 15%.
Losses in capacitors
The harmonic voltages applied to capacitors cause the flow of currents proportional
to the frequency of the harmonics. These currents cause additional losses.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Main effects of harmonics in
electrical installations
Example
A supply voltage has the following harmonics:
b Fundamental voltage U1,
b harmonic voltages u5 = 8% (of U1),
b u7 = 5%,
b u11 = 3%,
b u13 = 1%,
i.e. total harmonic distortion THDu equal to 10%. The amperage of the current is
multiplied by 1.19. Joule losses are multiplied by (1.19)², i.e. 1.4.
5.3 Overload of equipment
Generators
Generators supplying non-linear loads must be derated due to the additional losses
caused by harmonic currents.
The level of derating is approximately 10% for a generator where the overall load
is made up of 30% of non-linear loads. It is therefore necessary to oversize the
generator, in order to supply the same active power to loads.
Uninterruptible power systems (UPS)
The current drawn by computer systems has a very high crest factor. A UPS sized
taking into account exclusively the r.m.s. current may not be capable of supplying the
necessary peak current and may be overloaded.
Transformers
b The curve presented below (see Fig. M19) shows the typical derating required for
a transformer supplying electronic loads
kVA
(%)
100
90
80
70
M15
60
50
40
30
20
%
Electronic
load
10
0
0
20
40
60
80
100
Fig. M19 : Derating required for a transformer supplying electronic loads
Example: If the transformer supplies an overall load comprising 40% of electronic
loads, it must be derated by 40%.
k=
Th =
1
40
1+ 0.1 ∑ h1.6 Th2
h= 2
Ih
I1
Typical values:
b Current with a rectangular waveform (1/h spectrum): k = 0.86
b Frequency-converter current (THD 50%): k = 0.80
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Standard UTE C15-112 provides a derating factor for transformers as a function of
the harmonic currents.
M - Harmonic management
Asynchronous machines
Standard IEC60034-1 ("Rotating electrical machines – Rating and performance ")
defines a weighted harmonic factor (Harmonic voltage factor) for which the equation
and maximum value are provided below.
HVF =
13
∑
h= 2
Uh
i 0.02
h2
Example
A supply voltage has a fundamental voltage U1 and harmonic voltages u3 = 2% of
U1, u5 = 3%, u7 = 1%. The THDu is 3.7% and the HVF is 0.018. The HVF value is
very close to the maximum value above which the machine must be derated.
Practically speaking, asynchronous machines must be supplied with a voltage having
a THDu not exceeding 10%.
Capacitors
According to IEC 60831-1 standard ("Shunt power capacitors of the self-healing type
for a.c. systems having a rated voltage up to and including 1 000 V – Part 1: General
– Performance, testing and rating – Safety requirements – Guide for installation"), the
r.m.s. current flowing in the capacitors must not exceed 1.3 times the rated current.
Using the example mentioned above, the fundamental voltage U1, harmonic voltages
u5 = 8% (of U1), u7 = 5%, u11 = 3%, u13 = 1%, i.e. total harmonic distortion THDu
equal to 10%, the result is
Ir.m.s./I1 = 1.19, at the rated voltage. For a voltage equal to 1.1 times the rated voltage,
the current limit
Ir.m.s./I1 = 1.3 is reached and it is necessary to resize the capacitors.
Neutral conductors
Consider a system made up of a balanced three-phase source and three identical
single-phase loads connected between the phases and the neutral (see Fig. M20).
Figure M21 shows an example of the currents flowing in the three phases and the
resulting current in the neutral conductor.
In this example, the current in the neutral conductor has a rms value that is higher
than the rms value of the current in a phase by a factor equal to the square root of 3.
The neutral conductor must therefore be sized accordingly.
The current in the neutral may therefore exceed the current in each phase
in installation such as those with a large number of single-phase devices (IT
equipment, fluorescent lighting). This is the case in office buildings, computer
centers, Internet Data Centers, call centers, banks, shopping centers, retail lighting
M16
Ir
Load
Is
Load
It
Load
In
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. M20 : Flow of currents in the various conductors connected to a three-phase source
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Main effects of harmonics in
electrical installations
(A)
Ir
t
Is
t
It
t
In
t
0
20
40
t (ms)
Fig. M21 : Example of the currents flowing in the various conductors connected to a three-phase
load (In = Ir + Is + It)
M17
zones, etc.
This is not a general situation, due to the fact that power is being supplied
simultaneously to linear and/or three-phase loads (heating, ventilation, incandescent
lighting, etc.), which do not generate third order harmonic currents. However,
particular care must be taken when dimensioning the cross-sectional areas of neutral
conductors when designing new installations or when modifying them in the event of
a change in the loads being supplied with power.
A simplified approach can be used to estimate the loading of the neutral conductor.
For balanced loads, the current in the neutral IN is very close to 3 times the 3rd
harmonic current of the phase current (I3), i.e.:
IN 3.I3
This can be expressed as:
IN 3. i3 . I1
This equation simply links the overloading of the neutral (IN /IL) to the third harmonic
current ratio.
In particular, it shows that when this ratio reaches 33%, the current in the neutral
conductor is equal to the current in the phases. Whatever the distortion value, it has
been possible to use simulations to obtain a more precise law, which is illustrated in
Figure M22 next page.
The third harmonic ratio has an impact on the current in the neutral and therefore on
the capacity of all components in an installation:
b Distribution panels
b Protection and distribution devices
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For low distortion factor values, the r.m.s. value of the current is similar to the r.m.s.
value of the fundamental, therefore:
IN 3 . i3 IL
And:
IN /IL 3 . i3 (%)
M - Harmonic management
IN / IL
2.0
1.8
1.6
1.4
1.2
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
I3(%)
0
20
15
40
60
80
100
33
Fig. M22 : Loading of the neutral conductor based on the 3rd harmonic ratio
b Cables and trunking systems
According to the estimated third harmonic ratio, there are three possible scenarios:
ratio below 15%, between 15 and 33% or above 33%.
Third harmonic ratio below 15% (i3 ≤ 15%):
The neutral conductor is considered not to be carrying current. The cross-sectional
area of the phase conductors is determined solely by the current in the phases. The
cross-sectional area of the neutral conductor may be smaller than the cross-sectional
area of the phases if the cross sectional area is greater than 16 mm2 (copper) or
25 mm2 (aluminum).
Protection of the neutral is not obligatory, unless its cross-sectional area is smaller
than that of the phases.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M18
Third harmonic ratio between 15 and 33% (15 < i3 ≤ 33%), or in the absence of
any information about harmonic ratios:
The neutral conductor is considered to be carrying current.
The operating current of the multi-pole trunking must be reduced by a factor
of 0.84 (or, conversely, select trunking with an operating current equal to the current
calculated, divided by 0.84).
The cross-sectional area of the neutral MUST be equal to the cross-sectional area of
the phases.
Protection of the neutral is not necessary.
Third harmonic ratio greater than 33% (i3 > 33%)
This rare case represents a particularly high harmonic ratio, generating the
circulation of a current in the neutral, which is greater than the current in the phases.
Precautions therefore have to be taken when dimensioning the neutral conductor.
Generally, the operating current of the phase conductors must be reduced by a
factor of 0.84 (or, conversely, select trunking with an operating current equal to the
current calculated, divided by 0.84). In addition, the operating current of the neutral
conductor must be equal to 1.45 times the operating current of the phase conductors
(i.e. 1.45/0.84 times the phase current calculated, therefore approximately 1.73 times
the phase current calculated).
The recommended method is to use multi-pole trunking in which the cross-sectional
area of the neutral is equal to the cross-sectional area of the phases. The current in
the neutral conductor is therefore a key factor in determining the cross sectional area
of the conductors. Protection of the neutral is not necessary, although it should be
protected if there is any doubt in terms of the loading of the neutral conductor.
This approach is common in final distribution, where multi-pole cables have identical
cross sectional areas for the phases and for neutral.
With busbar trunking systems, precise knowledge of the temperature rises caused by
harmonic currents enables a less conservative approach to be adopted. The rating of
a busbar trunking system can be selected directly as a function of the neutral current
calculated.
For more details, see chapter E and "Cahier Technique ECT212: The neutral: A live
and unique conductor"
5.4 Disturbances affecting sensitive loads
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Main effects of harmonics in
electrical installations
Effects of distortion in the supply voltage
Distortion of the supply voltage can disturb the operation of sensitive devices:
b Regulation devices (temperature)
b Computer hardware
b Control and monitoring devices (protection relays)
Distortion of telephone signals
Harmonics cause disturbances in control circuits (low current levels). The level of
distortion depends on the distance that the power and control cables run in parallel,
the distance between the cables and the frequency of the harmonics.
5.5 Economic impact
Energy losses
Harmonics cause additional losses (Joule effect) in conductors and equipment.
Higher subscription costs
The presence of harmonic currents can require a higher subscribed power level
and consequently higher costs. What is more, Utilities will be increasingly inclined to
charge customers for major sources of harmonics.
Oversizing of equipment
b Derating of power sources (generators, transformers and UPSs) means they must
be oversized
b Conductors must be sized taking into account the flow of harmonic currents. In
addition, due the skin effect, the resistance of these conductors increases with
frequency. To avoid excessive losses due to the Joule effect, it is necessary to
oversize conductors
b Flow of harmonics in the neutral conductor means that it must be oversized as well
Reduced service life of equipment
When the level of distortion THDu of the supply voltage reaches 10%, the duration of
service life of equipment is significantly reduced. The reduction has been estimated
at:
b 32.5% for single-phase machines
b 18% for three-phase machines
b 5% for transformers
To maintain the service lives corresponding to the rated load, equipment must be
oversized.
M19
Nuisance tripping and installation shutdown
Circuit-breakers in the installation are subjected to current peaks caused by
harmonics. These current peaks may cause nuisance tripping of old technology
units, with the resulting production losses, as well as the costs corresponding to the
time required to start the installation up again.
Examples
Given the economic consequences for the installations mentioned below, it was
necessary to install harmonic filters.
Pharmaceutical laboratory
Harmonics caused the failure of a generator set and the interruption of a long
duration test on a new medication. The consequences were a loss estimated
at 17 M€.
Metallurgy factory
A set of induction furnaces caused the overload and destruction of three
transformers ranging from 1500 to 2500 kVA over a single year. The cost of the
interruptions in production were estimated at 20 k€ per hour.
Factory producing garden furniture
The failure of variable-speed drives resulted in production shutdowns estimated
at 10 k€ per hour.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Computer centre for an insurance company
In this centre, nuisance tripping of a circuit-breaker was calculated to have cost
100 k€ per hour of down time.
M - Harmonic management
6 Standards
Harmonic emissions are subject to various standards and regulations:
b Compatibility standards for distribution networks
b Emissions standards applying to the equipment causing harmonics
b Recommendations issued by Utilities and applicable to installations
In view of rapidly attenuating the effects of harmonics, a triple system of standards
and regulations is currently in force based on the documents listed below.
Standards governing compatibility between distribution networks and
products
These standards determine the necessary compatibility between distribution
networks and products:
b The harmonics caused by a device must not disturb the distribution network
beyond certain limits
b Each device must be capable of operating normally in the presence of
disturbances up to specific levels
b Standard IEC 61000-2-2 is applicable for public low-voltage power supply systems
b Standard IEC 61000-2-4 is applicable for LV and MV industrial installations
Standards governing the quality of distribution networks
b Standard EN 50160 stipulates the characteristics of electricity supplied by public
distribution networks
b Standard IEEE 519 presents a joint approach between Utilities and customers
to limit the impact of non-linear loads. What is more, Utilities encourage preventive
action in view of reducing the deterioration of power quality, temperature rise and the
reduction of power factor. They will be increasingly inclined to charge customers for
major sources of harmonics
Standards governing equipment
b Standard IEC 61000-3-2 for low-voltage equipment with rated current under 16 A
b Standard IEC 61000-3-12 for low-voltage equipment with rated current higher than
16 A and lower than 75 A
Maximum permissible harmonic levels
International studies have collected data resulting in an estimation of typical
harmonic contents often encountered in electrical distribution networks. Figure M23
presents the levels that, in the opinion of many Utilities, should not be exceeded.
M20
Odd harmonic orders
non-multiples of 3
Order h LV
5
6
7
5
11
3.5
13
3
17h49 2.27x17/h-0.27
Odd harmonic orders
multiples of 3
MV
HV
Order h LV
MV
5
2
3
5
4
4
2
9
1.5
1.2
3
1.5
15
0.4
0.3
2.5
1.5
21
0.3
0.2
1.9x17/h-0.2 1.2x17/h 21<h45 0.2
0.2
Even harmonic orders
HV
2
1
0.3
0.2
0.2
Order h
2
4
6
8
10h50
LV
2
1
0.5
0.5
0.25x10/h+0.25
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. M23 : Maximum admissible harmonic voltages and distortion (%)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
THDu
MV
1.8
1
0.5
0.5
0.25x10/h+0.22
HV
LV
1.4
8
0.8
0.4
0.4
0.19x10/h+0.16
MV HV
6.5 3
7 Solutions to mitigate harmonics
There are three different types of solutions to attenuate harmonics:
b Modifications in the installation
b Special devices in the supply system
b Filtering
7.1 Basic solutions
To limit the propagation of harmonics in the distribution network, different solutions
are available and should be taken into account particularly when designing a new
installation.
Position the non-linear loads upstream in the system
Overall harmonic disturbances increase as the short-circuit power decreases.
All economic considerations aside, it is preferable to connect the non-linear loads as
far upstream as possible (see Fig. M24).
Z2
Sensitive
loads
Z1
Non-linear
loads
Where impedance
Z1 < Z2
Fig. M24 : Non-linear loads positioned as far upstream as possible (recommended layout)
Group the non-linear loads
When preparing the single-line diagram, the non-linear devices should be separated
from the others (see Fig. M25). The two groups of devices should be supplied by
different sets of busbars.
Sensitive
loads
Yes
Line impedances
M21
No
Non-linear
load 1
Non-linear
load 2
Fig. M25 : Grouping of non-linear loads and connection as far upstream as possible
(recommended layout)
Create separate sources
In attempting to limit harmonics, an additional improvement can be obtained by
creating a source via a separate transformer as indicated in the Figure M26.
The disadvantage is the increase in the cost of the installation.
Non-linear
loads
MV
network
Linear
loads
Fig. M26 : Supply of non-linear loads via a separate transformer
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
M - Harmonic management
M - Harmonic management
Transformers with special connections
Different transformer connections can eliminate certain harmonic orders, as
indicated in the examples below:
b A Dyd connection suppresses 5th and 7th harmonics (see Fig. M27)
b A Dy connection suppresses the 3rd harmonic
b A DZ 5 connection suppresses the 5th harmonic
h5, h7, h11, h13
h11, h13
h5, h7, h11, h13
Fig. M27 : A Dyd transformer blocks propagation of the 5th and 7th harmonics to the upstream
network
Install reactors
When variable-speed drives are supplied, it is possible to smooth the current
by installing line reactors. By increasing the impedance of the supply circuit, the
harmonic current is limited.
Installation of harmonic suppression reactors on capacitor banks increases the
impedance of the reactor/capacitor combination for high-order harmonics.
This avoids resonance and protects the capacitors.
Select the suitable system earthing arrangement
TNC system
In the TNC system, a single conductor (PEN) provides protection in the event of an
earth fault and the flow of unbalance currents.
Under steady-state conditions, the harmonic currents flow in the PEN. Because
of the PEN impedance, this results in slight differences in potential (a few volts)
between devices that can cause electronic equipment to malfunction.
The TNC system must therefore be reserved for the supply of power circuits at the
head of the installation and must not be used to supply sensitive loads.
TNS system
This system is recommended if harmonics are present.
The neutral conductor and the protection conductor PE are completely separate and
the potential throughout the distribution network is therefore more uniform.
M22
7.2 Harmonic filtering
In cases where the preventive action presented above is insufficient, it is necessary
to equip the installation with filtering systems.
There are three types of filters:
b Passive
b Active
b Hybrid
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Passive filters
Typical applications
b Industrial installations with a set of non-linear loads representing more than
500 kVA (variable-speed drives, UPSs, rectifiers, etc.)
b Installations requiring power-factor correction
b Installations where voltage distortion must be reduced to avoid disturbing sensitive
loads
b Installations where current distortion must be reduced to avoid overloads
Operating principle
An LC circuit, tuned to each harmonic order to be filtered, is installed in parallel with
the non-linear load (see Fig. M28). This bypass circuit absorbs the harmonics, thus
avoiding their flow in the distribution network.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7 Solutions to mitigate harmonics
Generally speaking, the passive filter is tuned to a harmonic order close to the order
to be eliminated. Several parallel-connected branches of filters can be used if a
significant reduction in the distortion of a number of harmonic orders is required.
Active filters (active harmonic conditioner)
Typical applications
b Commercial installations with a set of non-linear loads representing less than
500 kVA (variable-speed drives, UPSs, office equipment, etc.)
b Installations where current distortion must be reduced to avoid overloads.
Operating principle
These systems, comprising power electronics and installed in series or parallel
with the non-linear load, compensate the harmonic current or voltage drawn by the
load. Figure M29 shows a parallel-connected active harmonic conditioner (AHC)
compensating the harmonic current (Ihar = -Iact).
The AHC injects in opposite phase the harmonics drawn by the non-linear load, such
that the line current Is remains sinusoidal.
Hybrid filters
Typical applications
b Industrial installations with a set of non-linear loads representing more than 500
kVA (variable-speed drives, UPSs, rectifiers, etc.)
b Installations requiring power-factor correction
b Installations where voltage distortion must be reduced to avoid disturbing sensitive
loads
b Installations where current distortion must be reduced to avoid overloads
b Installations where strict limits on harmonic emissions must be met
I har
Non-linear
load
Operating principle
Passive and active filters are combined in a single system to constitute a hybrid filter
(see Fig. M30). This new filtering solution offers the advantages of both types of
filters and covers a wide range of power and performance levels.
Filter
Fig. M28 : Operating principle of a passive filter
Is
I har
Is
I har
M23
Iact
Iact
AHC
Fig. M29 : Operating principle of an active filter
Linear
load
Non-linear
load
Hybride filter
Linear
load
Fig. M30 : Operating principle of a hybrid filter
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Non-linear
load
AHC
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
M - Harmonic management
7 Solutions to mitigate harmonics
Selection criteria
Passive filter
It offers both power-factor correction and high current-filtering capacity. Passive
filters also reduce the harmonic voltages in installations where the supply voltage is
disturbed. If the level of reactive power supplied is high, it is advised to turn off the
passive filter at times when the percent load is low.
Preliminary studies for a filter must take into account the possible presence of a
power factor correction capacitor bank which may have to be eliminated.
Active harmonic conditioners
They filter harmonics over a wide range of frequencies and can adapt to any type of
load. On the other hand, power ratings are limited.
Hybrid filters
They combine the performance of both active and passive filters.
Fig. M31 : Example of MV passive filter equipment
7.3 The method
The best solution, in both technical and financial terms, is based on the results of an
in-depth study.
Harmonic audit of MV and LV networks
Fig. M32 : Active Harmonic Conditionner (AccuSine range)
M24
By calling on an expert, you are guaranteed that the proposed solution will produce
effective results (e.g. a guaranteed maximum THDu).
A harmonic audit is carried out by an engineer specialised in the disturbances
affecting electrical distribution networks and equipped with powerful analysis and
simulation equipment and software.
The steps in an audit are the following:
b Measurement of disturbances affecting current and phase-to-phase and phase to
neutral voltages at the supply source, the disturbed outgoing circuits and the nonlinear loads
b Computer modelling of the phenomena to obtain a precise explanation of the
causes and determine the best solutions
b A complete audit report presenting:
v The current levels of disturbances
v The maximum permissible levels of disturbances (refer to IEC 61000, IEEE 519,
etc.)
b A proposal containing solutions with guaranteed levels of performance
b Finally, implementation of the selected solution, using the necessary means and
resources.
The entire audit process should be certified ISO 9002.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. M33 : Example of hybrid filter equipment
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter N
Characteristics of particular
sources and loads
Contents
1
Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
N2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
N2
N5
N5
N10
Generator protection
Downstream LV network protection
The monitoring functions
Generator Set parallel-connection
2
Uninterruptible Power Supply units (UPS)
N11
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
N11
N12
N15
N16
N18
N20
N22
N22
3
Protection of LV/LV transformers
N24
3.1 Transformer-energizing inrush current
3.2 Protection for the supply circuit of a LV/LV transformer
3.3 Typical electrical characteristics of LV/LV 50 Hz transformers
3.4 Protection of LV/LV transformers, using Schneider Electric
circuit-breakers
N24
N24
N25
4
Lighting circuits
N27
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
N27
N29
N34
N42
5
Asynchronous motors
N45
5.1 Motor control systems
5.2 Motor protection functions
5.3 Motor monitoring
5.4 Motor starter configurations
5.5 Protection coordination
5.6 Basic protection scheme: circuit-breaker + contactor +
thermal relay
5.7 Control and protection switching gear (CPS)
5.8 Intelligent Power and Motor Control Centre (iPMCC)
5.9 Communication
N45
N46
N49
N50
N51
Availability and quality of electrical power
Types of static UPSs
Batteries
System earthing arrangements for installations comprising UPSs
Choice of protection schemes
Installation, connection and sizing of cables
The UPSs and their environment
Complementary equipment
N51
N52
N54 N1
N56
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The different lamp technologies
Electrical characteristics of lamps
Constraints related to lighting devices and recommendations
Lighting of public areas
N25
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
Most industrial and large commercial electrical installations include certain important
loads for which a power supply must be maintained, in the event that the utility
electrical supply fails:
b Either, because safety systems are involved (emergency lighting, automatic fireprotection equipment, smoke dispersal fans, alarms and signalization, and so on…) or
b Because it concerns priority circuits, such as certain equipment, the stoppage of
which would entail a loss of production, or the destruction of a machine tool, etc.
One of the current means of maintaining a supply to the so-called “priority” loads, in
the event that other sources fail, is to install a diesel generator set connected, via a
change-over switch, to an emergency-power standby switchboard, from which the
priority services are fed (see Fig. N1).
G
HV
LV
Change-over switch
Non-priority circuits
Priority circuits
Fig N1 : Example of circuits supplied from a transformer or from an alternator
1.1 Generator protection
Figure N2 below shows the electrical sizing parameters of a Generator Set. Pn, Un
and In are, respectively, the power of the thermal motor, the rated voltage and the
rated current of the generator.
Un, In
Pn
R
Thermal
motor
N2
S
T
N
t (s)
Fig N2 : Block diagram of a generator set
1,000
Overload protection
The generator protection curve must be analysed (see Fig. N3).
Standards and requirements of applications can also stipulate specific overload
conditions. For example:
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
100
12
10
7
I/In
1.1
1.5
3
2
1
I
0
0 1.1 1.2 1.5
2
3
4
Fig N3 : Example of an overload curve t = f(I/In)
In
5
Overloads
t
>1h
30 s
The setting possibilities of the overload protection devices (or Long Time Delay) will
closely follow these requirements.
Note on overloads
b For economic reasons, the thermal motor of a replacement set may be strictly sized
for its nominal power. If there is an active power overload, the diesel motor will stall.
The active power balance of the priority loads must take this into account
b A production set must be able to withstand operating overloads:
v One hour overload
v One hour 10% overload every 12 hours (Prime Power)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
Short-circuit current protection
Making the short-circuit current
The short-circuit current is the sum:
b Of an aperiodic current
b Of a damped sinusoidal current
The short-circuit current equation shows that it is composed of three successive
phases (see Fig. N4).
I rms
1
2
3
≈ 3 In
1 - Subtransient conditions
2 - Transient conditions
3 - Steady state conditions
Generator with compound
excitation or over-excitation
In
Generator with serial
excitation
≈ 0.3 In
0
t (s)
0
10 to 20 ms
0.1 to 0.3 s
Fault appears
Fig N4 : Short-circuit current level during the 3 phases
b Subtransient phase
When a short-circuit appears at the terminals of a generator, the current is first made
at a relatively high value of around 6 to 12 In during the first cycle (0 to 20 ms).
The amplitude of the short-circuit output current is defined by three parameters:
v The subtransient reactance of the generator
v The level of excitation prior to the time of the fault and
v The impedance of the faulty circuit.
The short-circuit impedance of the generator to be considered is the subtransient
reactance x’’d expressed in % by the manufacturer. The typical value is 10 to 15%.
We determine the subtransient short-circuit impedance of the generator:
U2 x ′′d
X ′′d(ohms) = n
where S = 3 Un I n
100 S
b Steady state phase
The steady state occurs after 500 ms.
When the fault persists, the output voltage collapses and the exciter regulation seeks
to raise this output voltage. The result is a stabilised sustained short-circuit current:
v If generator excitation does not increase during a short-circuit (no field
overexcitation) but is maintained at the level preceding the fault, the current stabilises
at a value that is given by the synchronous reactance Xd of the generator. The typical
value of xd is greater than 200%. Consequently, the final current will be less than the
full-load current of the generator, normally around 0.5 In.
v If the generator is equipped with maximum field excitation (field overriding) or with
compound excitation, the excitation “surge” voltage will cause the fault current to
increase for 10 seconds, normally to 2 to 3 times the full-load current of the generator.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N3
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Transient phase
The transient phase is placed 100 to 500 ms after the time of the fault. Starting from
the value of the fault current of the subtransient period, the current drops to 1.5 to
2 times the current In.
The short-circuit impedance to be considered for this period is the transient
reactance x’d expressed in % by the manufacturer. The typical value is 20 to 30%.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Calculating the short-circuit current
Manufacturers normally specify the impedance values and time constants required
for analysis of operation in transient or steady state conditions (see Fig. N5).
(kVA)
x”d
x’d
xd
75
10.5
21
280
200
10.4
15.6
291
400
12.9
19.4
358
800
10.5
18
280
1,600
18.8
33.8
404
2,500
19.1
30.2
292
Fig N5 : Example of impedance table (in %)
Resistances are always negligible compared with reactances. The parameters for the
short-circuit current study are:
b Value of the short-circuit current at generator terminals
Short-circuit current amplitude in transient conditions is:
In 1
I sc3 =
(X’d in ohms)
X ′d 3
or
In
100 (x’d in%)
x ′d
Un is the generator phase-to-phase output voltage.
I sc3 =
Note: This value can be compared with the short-circuit current at the terminals of a
transformer. Thus, for the same power, currents in event of a short-circuit close to a
generator will be 5 to 6 times weaker than those that may occur with a transformer
(main source).
This difference is accentuated still further by the fact that generator set power is
normally less than that of the transformer (see Fig. N6).
Source 1
MV
2,000 kVA
GS
LV
42 kA
500 kVA
2.5 kA
NC
N4
NC
D1
NO
D2
Main/standby
Non-priority circuits
Priority circuits
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
NC: Normally closed
NO: Normally open
Fig N6 : Example of a priority services switchboard supplied (in an emergency) from a standby
generator set
When the LV network is supplied by the Main source 1 of 2,000 kVA, the short-circuit
current is 42 kA at the main LV board busbar. When the LV network is supplied by the
Replacement Source 2 of 500 kVA with transient reactance of 30%, the short-circuit
current is made at approx. 2.5 kA, i.e. at a value 16 times weaker than with the Main
source.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
1.2 Downstream LV network protection
Priority circuit protection
Choice of breaking capacity
This must be systematically checked with the characteristics of the main source
(MV/LV transformer).
Setting of the Short Time Delay (STD) tripping current
b Subdistribution boards
The ratings of the protection devices for the subdistribution and final distribution
circuits are always lower than the generator rated current. Consequently, except in
special cases, conditions are the same as with transformer supply.
b Main LV switchboard
v The sizing of the main feeder protection devices is normally similar to that of the
generator set. Setting of the STD must allow for the short-circuit characteristic of the
generator set (see “Short-circuit current protection” before)
v Discrimination of protection devices on the priority feeders must be provided
in generator set operation (it can even be compulsory for safety feeders). It is
necessary to check proper staggering of STD setting of the protection devices of
the main feeders with that of the subdistribution protection devices downstream
(normally set for distribution circuits at 10 In).
Note: When operating on the generator set, use of a low sensitivity Residual
Current Device enables management of the insulation fault and ensures very simple
discrimination.
Safety of people
In the IT (2nd fault) and TN grounding systems, protection of people against indirect
contacts is provided by the STD protection of circuit-breakers. Their operation on
a fault must be ensured, whether the installation is supplied by the main source
(Transformer) or by the replacement source (generator set).
Calculating the insulation fault current
Zero-sequence reactance formulated as a% of Uo by the manufacturer x’o.
The typical value is 8%.
The phase-to-neutral single-phase short-circuit current is given by:
Un 3
If =
2 X ′d + X ′o
The insulation fault current in the TN system is slightly greater than the three
phase fault current. For example, in event of an insulation fault on the system in the
previous example, the insulation fault current is equal to 3 kA.
1.3 The monitoring functions
Due to the specific characteristics of the generator and its regulation, the proper
operating parameters of the generator set must be monitored when special loads are
implemented.
N5
The behaviour of the generator is different from that of the transformer:
b The active power it supplies is optimised for a power factor = 0.8
b At less than power factor 0.8, the generator may, by increased excitation, supply
part of the reactive power
An off-load generator connected to a capacitor bank may self-excite, consequently
increasing its overvoltage.
The capacitor banks used for power factor regulation must therefore be disconnected.
This operation can be performed by sending the stopping setpoint to the regulator
(if it is connected to the system managing the source switchings) or by opening the
circuit-breaker supplying the capacitors.
If capacitors continue to be necessary, do not use regulation of the power factor relay
in this case (incorrect and over-slow setting).
Motor restart and re-acceleration
A generator can supply at most in transient period a current of between 3 and 5 times
its nominal current.
A motor absorbs roughly 6 In for 2 to 20 s during start-up.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Capacitor bank
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
If the sum of the motor power is high, simultaneous start-up of loads generates a
high pick-up current that can be damaging. A large voltage drop, due to the high
value of the generator transient and subtransient reactances will occur (20% to
30%), with a risk of:
b Non-starting of motors
b Temperature rise linked to the prolonged starting time due to the voltage drop
b Tripping of the thermal protection devices
Moreover, all the network and actuators are disturbed by the voltage drop.
Application (see Fig. N7)
A generator supplies a set of motors.
Generator characteristics: Pn = 130 kVA at a power factor of 0.8,
In = 150 A
x’d = 20% (for example) hence Isc = 750 A.
b The Pmotors is 45 kW (45% of generator power)
Calculating voltage drop at start-up:
PMotors = 45 kW, Im = 81 A, hence a starting current Id = 480 A for 2 to 20 s.
Voltage drop on the busbar for simultaneous motor starting:
ΔU ⎛ I d − I n ⎞ 100 in %
=⎜
U ⎝ I sc − I n
U = 55%
which is not tolerable for motors (failure to start).
b the Pmotors is 20 kW (20% of generator power)
Calculating voltage drop at start-up:
PMotors = 20 kW, Im = 35 A, hence a starting current Id = 210 A for 2 to 20 s.
Voltage drop on the busbar:
∆U I d − I n
=
100 in %
U I sc − I n
U = 10%
which is high but tolerable (depending on the type of loads).
G
PLC
N
F
N6
F
Remote control 1
F
F
Remote control 2
Motors
Resistive loads
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig N7 : Restarting of priority motors (P > 1/3 Pn)
Restarting tips
1
b If the Pmax of the largest motor > Pn , a soft starter must be
3
installed on this motor
b If Pmotors >
1
Pn , motor cascade restarting must be managed by a PLC
3
b If Pmotors < 1 Pn , there are no restarting problems
3
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
Non-linear loads – Example of a UPS
Non-linear loads
These are mainly:
b Saturated magnetic circuits
b Discharge lamps, fluorescent lights
b Electronic converters
b Information Technology Equipment: PC, computers, etc.
These loads generate harmonic currents: supplied by a Generator Set, this can
create high voltage distortion due to the low short-circuit power of the generator.
Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) (see Fig. N8)
The combination of a UPS and generator set is the best solution for ensuring quality
power supply with long autonomy for the supply of sensitive loads.
It is also a non-linear load due to the input rectifier. On source switching, the autonomy
of the UPS on battery must allow starting and connection of the Generator Set.
Electrical utility
HV incomer
G
NC
NO
Mains 2
feeder
By-pass
Mains 1
feeder
Uninterruptible
power supply
Non-sensitive
load
Sensitive feeders
Fig N8 : Generator set- UPS combination for Quality energy
N7
UPS power
UPS inrush power must allow for:
b Nominal power of the downstream loads. This is the sum of the apparent powers
Pa absorbed by each application. Furthermore, so as not to oversize the installation,
the overload capacities at UPS level must be considered (for example: 1.5 In for
1 minute and 1.25 In for 10 minutes)
b The power required to recharge the battery: This current is proportional to the
autonomy required for a given power. The sizing Sr of a UPS is given by:
Sr = 1.17 x Pn
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Figure N9 next page defines the pick-up currents and protection devices for
supplying the rectifier (Mains 1) and the standby mains (Mains 2).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Nominal power
Pn (kVA)
40
60
80
100
120
160
200
250
300
400
500
600
800
Current value (A)
Mains 1 with 3Ph battery
400 V - I1
86
123
158
198
240
317
395
493
590
793
990
1,180
1,648
Mains 2 or 3Ph application
400 V - Iu
60.5
91
121
151
182
243
304
360
456
608
760
912
1,215
Fig N9 : Pick-up current for supplying the rectifier and standby mains
Generator Set/UPS combination
b Restarting the Rectifier on a Generator Set
The UPS rectifier can be equipped with a progressive starting of the charger to
prevent harmful pick-up currents when installation supply switches to the Generator
Set (see Fig. N10).
Mains 1
GS starting
t (s)
UPS charger
starting
N8
20 ms
5 to 10 s
Fig N10 : Progressive starting of a type 2 UPS rectifier
b Harmonics and voltage distortion
Total voltage distortion is defined by:
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
τ(%) =
ΣUh2
U1
where Uh is the harmonic voltage of order h.
This value depends on:
v The harmonic currents generated by the rectifier (proportional to the power Sr of
the rectifier)
v The longitudinal subtransient reactance X”d of the generator
v The power Sg of the generator
We define U′ Rcc(%) = X ′′d Sr the generator relative short-circuit voltage, brought to
Sg
rectifier power, i.e. t = f(U’Rcc).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
Note 1: As subtransient reactance is great, harmonic distortion is normally too high
compared with the tolerated value (7 to 8%) for reasonable economic sizing of the
generator: use of a suitable filter is an appropriate and cost-effective solution.
Note 2: Harmonic distortion is not harmful for the rectifier but may be harmful for the
other loads supplied in parallel with the rectifier.
Application
A chart is used to find the distortion as a function of U’Rcc (see Fig. N11).
τ (%) (Voltage harmonic distortion)
18
Without filter
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
With filter
(incorporated)
4
3
2
1
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
U'Rcc = X''dSr
Sg
Fig N11 : Chart for calculating harmonic distorsion
The chart gives:
b Either as a function of U’Rcc
b Or U’Rcc as a function of
From which generator set sizing, Sg, is determined.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N9
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Example: Generator sizing
b 300 kVA UPS without filter, subtransient reactance of 15%
The power Sr of the rectifier is Sr = 1.17 x 300 kVA = 351 kVA
For a < 7%, the chart gives U’Rcc = 4%, power Sg is:
15
Sg = 351 x
≈ 1,400 kVA
4
b 300 kVA UPS with filter, subtransient reactance of 15%
For = 5%, the calculation gives U’Rcc = 12%, power Sg is:
15
Sg = 351 x
≈ 500 kVA
12
Note: With an upstream transformer of 630 kVA on the 300 kVA UPS without filter,
the 5% ratio would be obtained.
The result is that operation on generator set must be continually monitored for
harmonic currents.
If voltage harmonic distortion is too great, use of a filter on the network is the most
effective solution to bring it back to values that can be tolerated by sensitive loads.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
1 Protection of a LV generator set
and the downstream circuits
1.4 Generator Set parallel-connection
Parallel-connection of the generator set irrespective of the application type - Safety
source, Replacement source or Production source - requires finer management of
connection, i.e. additional monitoring functions.
Parallel operation
As generator sets generate energy in parallel on the same load, they must be
synchronised properly (voltage, frequency) and load distribution must be balanced
properly. This function is performed by the regulator of each Generator Set (thermal
and excitation regulation). The parameters (frequency, voltage) are monitored before
connection: if the values of these parameters are correct, connection can take place.
Insulation faults (see Fig. N12)
An insulation fault inside the metal casing of a generator set may seriously damage
the generator of this set if the latter resembles a phase-to-neutral short-circuit. The
fault must be detected and eliminated quickly, else the other generators will generate
energy in the fault and trip on overload: installation continuity of supply will no longer be
guaranteed. Ground Fault Protection (GFP) built into the generator circuit is used to:
b Quickly disconnect the faulty generator and preserve continuity of supply
b Act at the faulty generator control circuits to stop it and reduce the risk of damage
This GFP is of the “Residual Sensing” type and must be installed as close as
possible to the protection device as per a TN-C/TN-S (1) system at each generator set
with grounding of frames by a separate PE. This kind of protection is usually called
“Restricted Earth Fault”.
MV incomer
F
HV busbar
F
G
Generator no. 2
Generator no. 1
Protected
area
RS
RS
PE
Unprotected
area
PE
LV
PEN
PE
PEN
Phases
Fig N13 : Energy transfer direction – Generator Set as a
generator
N
N10
PE
MV incomer
Fig N12 : Insulation fault inside a generator
F
HV busbar
F
Generator Set operating as a load (see Fig. N13 and Fig. N14)
One of the parallel-connected generator sets may no longer operate as a generator
but as a motor (by loss of its excitation for example). This may generate overloading
of the other generator set(s) and thus place the electrical installation out of operation.
G
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
To check that the generator set really is supplying the installation with power
(operation as a generator), the proper flow direction of energy on the coupling busbar
must be checked using a specific “reverse power” check. Should a fault
occur, i.e. the set operates as a motor, this function will eliminate the faulty set.
Grounding parallel-connected Generator Sets
LV
Fig N14 : Energy transfer direction – Generator Set as a load
Grounding of connected generator sets may lead to circulation of earth fault currents
(triplen harmonics) by connection of neutrals for common grounding (grounding
system of the TN or TT type). Consequently, to prevent these currents from flowing
between the generator sets, we recommend the installation of a decoupling
resistance in the grounding circuit.
(1) The system is in TN-C for sets seen as the “generator” and
in TN-S for sets seen as “loads”
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
2.1 Availability and quality of electrical power
The disturbances presented above may affect:
b Safety of human life
b Safety of property
b The economic viability of a company or production process
Disturbances must therefore be eliminated.
A number of technical solutions contribute to this goal, with varying degrees of
effectiveness. These solutions may be compared on the basis of two criteria:
b Availability of the power supplied
b Quality of the power supplied
The availability of electrical power can be thought of as the time per year that power
is present at the load terminals. Availability is mainly affected by power interruptions
due to utility outages or electrical faults.
A number of solutions exist to limit the risk:
b Division of the installation so as to use a number of different sources rather than
just one
b Subdivision of the installation into priority and non-priority circuits, where the
supply of power to priority circuits can be picked up if necessary by another available
source
b Load shedding, as required, so that a reduced available power rating can be used
to supply standby power
b Selection of a system earthing arrangement suited to service-continuity goals, e.g.
IT system
b Discrimination of protection devices (selective tripping) to limit the consequences
of a fault to a part of the installation
Note that the only way of ensuring availability of power with respect to utility outages
is to provide, in addition to the above measures, an autonomous alternate source, at
least for priority loads (see Fig. N15).
2.5 kA
G
Alternate source
N11
Non-priority circuits
Priority circuits
This source takes over from the utility in the event of a problem, but two factors must
be taken into account:
b The transfer time (time required to take over from the utility) which must be
acceptable to the load
b The operating time during which it can supply the load
The quality of electrical power is determined by the elimination of the disturbances at
the load terminals.
An alternate source is a means to ensure the availability of power at the load
terminals, however, it does not guarantee, in many cases, the quality of the power
supplied with respect to the above disturbances.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N15 : Availability of electrical power
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Today, many sensitive electronic applications require an electrical power supply
which is virtually free of these disturbances, to say nothing of outages, with
tolerances that are stricter than those of the utility.
This is the case, for example, for computer centers, telephone exchanges and many
industrial-process control and monitoring systems.
These applications require solutions that ensure both the availability and quality of
electrical power.
The UPS solution
The solution for sensitive applications is to provide a power interface between the
utility and the sensitive loads, providing voltage that is:
b Free of all disturbances present in utility power and in compliance with the strict
tolerances required by loads
b Available in the event of a utility outage, within specified tolerances
UPSs (Uninterruptible Power Supplies) satisfy these requirements in terms of power
availability and quality by:
b Supplying loads with voltage complying with strict tolerances, through use of an
inverter
b Providing an autonomous alternate source, through use of a battery
b Stepping in to replace utility power with no transfer time, i.e. without any interruption
in the supply of power to the load, through use of a static switch
These characteristics make UPSs the ideal power supply for all sensitive applications
because they ensure power quality and availability, whatever the state of utility power.
A UPS comprises the following main components:
b Rectifier/charger, which produces DC power to charge a battery and supply an
inverter
b Inverter, which produces quality electrical power, i.e.
v Free of all utility-power disturbances, notably micro-outages
v Within tolerances compatible with the requirements of sensitive electronic devices
(e.g. for Galaxy, tolerances in amplitude ± 0.5% and frequency ± 1%, compared to
± 10% and ± 5% in utility power systems, which correspond to improvement factors
of 20 and 5, respectively)
b Battery, which provides sufficient backup time (8 minutes to 1 hour or more) to
ensure the safety of life and property by replacing the utility as required
b Static switch, a semi-conductor based device which transfers the load from the
inverter to the utility and back, without any interruption in the supply of power
2.2 Types of static UPSs
Types of static UPSs are defined by standard IEC 62040.
N12
The standard distinguishes three operating modes:
b Passive standby (also called off-line)
b Line interactive
b Double conversion (also called on-line)
These definitions concern UPS operation with respect to the power source including
the distribution system upstream of the UPS.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Standard IEC 62040 defines the following terms:
b Primary power: power normally continuously available which is usually supplied by
an electrical utility company, but sometimes by the user’s own generation
b Standby power: power intended to replace the primary power in the event of
primary-power failure
b Bypass power: power supplied via the bypass
Practically speaking, a UPS is equipped with two AC inputs, which are called the
normal AC input and bypass AC input in this guide.
b The normal AC input, noted as mains input 1, is supplied by the primary power, i.e.
by a cable connected to a feeder on the upstream utility or private distribution system
b The bypass AC input, noted as mains input 2, is generally supplied by standby
power, i.e. by a cable connected to an upstream feeder other than the one supplying
the normal AC input, backed up by an alternate source (e.g. by an engine-generator
set or another UPS, etc.)
When standby power is not available, the bypass AC input is supplied with primary
power (second cable parallel to the one connected to the normal AC input).
The bypass AC input is used to supply the bypass line(s) of the UPS, if they
exist. Consequently, the bypass line(s) is supplied with primary or standby power,
depending on the availability of a standby-power source.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
UPS operating in passive-standby (off-line) mode
Operating principle
The inverter is connected in parallel with the AC input in a standby (see Fig. N16).
b Normal mode
The load is supplied by utility power via a filter which eliminates certain disturbances
and provides some degree of voltage regulation (the standard speaks of “additional
devices…to provide power conditioning”). The inverter operates in passive standby
mode.
b Battery backup mode
When the AC input voltage is outside specified tolerances for the UPS or the utility
power fails, the inverter and the battery step in to ensure a continuous supply of
power to the load following a very short (<10 ms) transfer time.
The UPS continues to operate on battery power until the end of battery backup time
or the utility power returns to normal, which provokes transfer of the load back to the
AC input (normal mode).
Usage
This configuration is in fact a compromise between an acceptable level of protection
against disturbances and cost. It can be used only with low power ratings (< 2 kVA).
It operates without a real static switch, so a certain time is required to transfer the
load to the inverter. This time is acceptable for certain individual applications, but
incompatible with the performance required by more sophisticated, sensitive systems
(large computer centers, telephone exchanges, etc.).
What is more, the frequency is not regulated and there is no bypass.
Note: In normal mode, the power supplying the load does not flow through the
inverter, which explains why this type of UPS is sometimes called “Off-line”. This term
is misleading, however, because it also suggests “not supplied by utility power”, when
in fact the load is supplied by the utility via the AC input during normal operation. That
is why standard IEC 62040 recommends the term “passive standby”.
AC input
Charger
Battery
Inverter
UPS operating in line-interactive mode
Filter/
conditioner
Normal mode
Battery backup mode
Load
Fig. N16 : UPS operating in passive standby mode
Normal
AC input
Bypass
AC input
If only one AC input
Static
switch
Bypass
Operating principle
The inverter is connected in parallel with the AC input in a standby configuration,
but also charges the battery. It thus interacts (reversible operation) with the AC input
source (see Fig. N17).
b Normal mode
The load is supplied with conditioned power via a parallel connection of the AC input
and the inverter. The inverter operates to provide output-voltage conditioning and/or
charge the battery. The output frequency depends on the AC-input frequency.
b Battery backup mode
When the AC input voltage is outside specified tolerances for the UPS or the utility
power fails, the inverter and the battery step in to ensure a continuous supply of
power to the load following a transfer without interruption using a static switch which
also disconnects the AC input to prevent power from the inverter from flowing upstream.
The UPS continues to operate on battery power until the end of battery backup time
or the utility power returns to normal, which provokes transfer of the load back to the
AC input (normal mode).
b Bypass mode
This type of UPS may be equipped with a bypass. If one of the UPS functions fails,
the load can be transferred to the bypass AC input (supplied with utility or standby
power, depending on the installation).
N13
Usage
This configuration is not well suited to regulation of sensitive loads in the medium to
high-power range because frequency regulation is not possible.
For this reason, it is rarely used other than for low power ratings.
Inverter
Normal mode
Battery backup mode
Bypass mode
Load
Fig. N17 : UPS operating in line-interactive mode
Operating principle
The inverter is connected in series between the AC input and the application.
b Normal mode
During normal operation, all the power supplied to the load passes through the
rectifier/charger and inverter which together perform a double conversion (AC-DCAC), hence the name.
b Battery backup mode
When the AC input voltage is outside specified tolerances for the UPS or the utility
power fails, the inverter and the battery step in to ensure a continuous supply of
power to the load following a transfer without interruption using a static switch.
The UPS continues to operate on battery power until the end of battery backup time
or utility power returns to normal, which provokes transfer of the load back to the
AC input (normal mode).
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
UPS operating in double-conversion (on-line) mode
Battery
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
b Bypass mode
This type of UPS is generally equipped with a static bypass, sometimes referred to
as a static switch (see Fig. N18).
The load can be transferred without interruption to the bypass AC input (supplied
with utility or standby power, depending on the installation), in the event of the
following:
v UPS failure
v Load-current transients (inrush or fault currents)
v Load peaks
However, the presence of a bypass assumes that the input and output frequencies
are identical and if the voltage levels are not the same, a bypass transformer is
required.
For certain loads, the UPS must be synchronized with the bypass power to ensure
load-supply continuity. What is more, when the UPS is in bypass mode, a disturbance
on the AC input source may be transmitted directly to the load because the inverter
no longer steps in.
Note: Another bypass line, often called the maintenance bypass, is available for
maintenance purposes. It is closed by a manual switch.
Normal
AC input
Bypass
AC input
If only one AC input
Battery
Static
switch
(static
bypass)
Inverter
Manual
maintenance
bypass
Load
Normal mode
Battery backup mode
Bypass mode
N14
Fig. N18 : UPS operating in double-conversion (on-line) mode
Usage
In this configuration, the time required to transfer the load to the inverter is negligible
due to the static switch.
Also, the output voltage and frequency do not depend on the input voltage and
frequency conditions. This means that the UPS, when designed for this purpose, can
operate as a frequency converter.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Practically speaking, this is the main configuration used for medium and high
power ratings (from 10 kVA upwards).The rest of this chapter will consider only this
configuration.
Note: This type of UPS is often called “on-line”, meaning that the load is continuously
supplied by the inverter, regardless of the conditions on the AC input source. This
term is misleading, however, because it also suggests “supplied by utility power”,
when in fact the load is supplied by power that has been reconstituted by the doubleconversion system. That is why standard IEC 62040 recommends the term “double
conversion”.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
2.3 Batteries
Selection of battery type
A battery is made up of interconnected cells which may be vented or of the
recombination type.
There are two main families of batteries:
b Nickel-cadmium batteries
b Lead-acid batteries
b Vented cells (lead-antimony): They are equipped with ports to
v Release to the atmosphere the oxygen and hydrogen produced during the different
chemical reactions
v Top off the electrolyte by adding distilled or demineralized water
b Recombination cells (lead, pure lead, lead-tin batteries): The gas recombination
rate is at least 95% and they therefore do not require water to be added during
service life
By extension, reference will be made to vented or recombination batteries
(recombination batteries are also often called “sealed” batteries).
The main types of batteries used in conjunction with UPSs are:
b Sealed lead-acid batteries, used 95% of the time because they are easy to
maintain and do not require a special room
b Vented lead-acid batteries
b Vented nickel-cadmium batteries
The above three types of batteries may be proposed, depending on economic factors
and the operating requirements of the installation, with all the available service-life
durations.
Capacity levels and backup times may be adapted to suit the user’s needs.
The proposed batteries are also perfectly suited to UPS applications in that they are
the result of collaboration with leading battery manufacturers.
Selection of back up time
Selection depends on:
b The average duration of power-system failures
b Any available long-lasting standby power (engine-generator set, etc.)
b The type of application
The typical range generally proposed is:
b Standard backup times of 10, 15 or 30 minutes
b Custom backup times
The following general rules apply:
b Computer applications
Battery backup time must be sufficient to cover file-saving and system-shutdown
procedures required to ensure a controlled shutdown of the computer system.
Generally speaking, the computer department determines the necessary backup
time, depending on its specific requirements.
b Industrial processes
The backup time calculation should take into account the economic cost incurred by
an interruption in the process and the time required to restart.
N15
Selection table
In certain cases, however, vented batteries are preferred, notably for:
b Long service life
b Long backup times
b High power ratings
Vented batteries must be installed in special rooms complying with precise
regulations and require appropriate maintenance.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Figure N19 next page sums up the main characteristics of the various types of
batteries.
Increasingly, recombination batteries would seem to be the market choice for the
following reasons:
b No maintenance
b Easy implementation
b Installation in all types of rooms (computer rooms, technical rooms not specifically
intended for batteries, etc.)
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Sealed lead-acid
Vented lead-acid
Nickel-cadmium
Service life
Compact
5 or 10 years
5 or 10 years
5 or 10 years
+
+
++
Operatingtemperature
tolerances
+
++
+++
Frequency
of
maintenance
Low
Medium
High
Special
room
Cost
No
Yes
no
Low medium
Low
High
Fig. N19 : Main characteristics of the various types of batteries
Installation methods
Depending on the UPS range, the battery capacity and backup time, the battery is:
b Sealed type and housed in the UPS cabinet
b Sealed type and housed in one to three cabinets
b Vented or sealed type and rack-mounted. In this case the installation method may be
v On shelves (see Fig. N20)
This installation method is possible for sealed batteries or maintenance-free vented
batteries which do not require topping up of their electrolyte.
v Tier mounting (see Fig. N21)
This installation method is suitable for all types of batteries and for vented batteries
in particular, as level checking and filling are made easy.
v In cabinets (see Fig. N22)
This installation method is suitable for sealed batteries. It is easy to implement and
offers maximum safety.
Fig. N20 : Shelf mounting
2.4 System earthing arrangements for installations
comprising UPSs
Application of protection systems, stipulated by the standards, in installations
comprising a UPS, requires a number of precautions for the following reasons:
b The UPS plays two roles
v A load for the upstream system
v A power source for downstream system
b When the battery is not installed in a cabinet, an insulation fault on the DC system
can lead to the flow of a residual DC component
Fig. N21 : Tier mounting
This component can disturb the operation of certain protection devices, notably
RCDs used for the protection of persons.
Protection against direct contact (see Fig. N23)
All installations satisfy the applicable requirements because the equipment is housed
in cabinets providing a degree of protection IP 20. This is true even for the battery
when it is housed in a cabinet.
When batteries are not installed in a cabinet, i.e. generally in a special room, the
measures presented at the end of this chapter should be implemented.
N16
Note: The TN system (version TN-S or TN-C) is the most commonly recommended
system for the supply of computer systems.
Fig. N22 : Cabinet mounting
Type of arrangement
Operation
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Techniques for protection
of persons
Advantages and
disadvantages
IT system
b Signaling of first insulation fault
b Locating and elimination of first fault
b Disconnection for second insulation fault
b Interconnection and earthing of
conductive parts
b Surveillance of first fault using an
insulation monitoring device (IMD)
b Second fault results in circuit interruption
(circuit-breaker or fuse)
b Solution offering the best continuity of
service (first fault is signalled)
b Requires competent surveillance
personnel (location of first fault)
TT system
b Disconnection for first
insulation fault
TN system
b Disconnection for first insulation fault
b Earthing of conductive parts
combined with use of RCDs
b First insulation fault results in
interruption by detecting leakage
currents
b Interconnection and earthing of
conductive parts and neutral imperative
b First insulation fault results in
interruption by detecting overcurrents
(circuit-breaker or fuse)
b Easiest solution in terms of design
and installation
b No insulation monitoring device
(IMD) required
b However, each fault results in
interruption of the concerned circuit
b Low-cost solution in terms of installation
b Difficult design
(calculation of loop impedances)
b Qualified operating personnel required
b Flow of high fault currents
Fig. N23 : Main characteristics of system earthing arrangements
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
Essential points to be checked for UPSs
Figure N24 shows all the essential points that must be interconnected as well as the
devices to be installed (transformers, RCDs, etc.) to ensure installation conformity
with safety standards.
T0
T0 neutral
IMD 1
CB0
Earth 1
CB1
CB2
T1
T2
T1 neutral
T2 neutral
Bypass
neutral
Q1
UPS exposed
conductive
parts
Q4S
Q3BP
N
Q5N
UPS output
IMD 2
N17
Downstream
neutral
Earth 2
CB3
Load
exposed
conductive
parts
Fig. N24 : The essential points that must be connected in system earthing arrangements
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Earth
3
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
2.5 Choice of protection schemes
The circuit-breakers have a major role in an installation but their importance often
appears at the time of accidental events which are not frequent. The best sizing of
UPS and the best choice of configuration can be compromised by a wrong choice of
only one circuit-breaker.
Circuit-breaker selection
Figure N25 shows how to select the circuit-breakers.
Ir
Ir
down- upstream
stream
Select the breaking capacities of
CB1 and CB2 for the short-circuit
current of the most powerful source
(generally the transformer)
100
GE
CB2 curve
CB3 curve
However, CB1 and CB2 must
trip on a short-circuit supplied
by the least powerful source
(generally the generator)
10
Tripping time (in seconds)
Im
downstream
Im
upstream
1
Generator
short-circuit
CB2 must protect the UPS static
switch if a short circuit occurs
downstream of the switch
0.1
Thermal limit
of static power
0.01
CB2
CB1
CB2
The overload capacity of the static
switch is 10 to 12 In for 20 ms,
where In is the current flowing
through the UPS at full rated load
CB3
0.001
0.1
Energizing of
a transformer
1
10
Energizing of all
loads downstream
of UPS
100
I/In of upstream
circuit breaker
N18
The Im current of CB2 must be calculated for simultaneous
energizing of all the loads downstream of the UPS
The trip unit of CB3 muqt be set not to trip for the overcurrent when the load is energized
CB3
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
If bypass power is not used to handle overloads, the UPS current must trip the CB3 circuit
breaker with the highest rating
Ir
downstream
Uc
For distant short-circuits, the CB3 unit setting must not result in a dangerous touch voltage.
If necessary, install an RCD
Fig. N25 : Circuit-breakers are submitted to a variety of situations
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
Rating
The selected rating (rated current) for the circuit-breaker must be the one just above
the rated current of the protected downstream cable.
Breaking capacity
The breaking capacity must be selected just above the short-circuit current that can
occur at the point of installation.
Ir and Im thresholds
The table below indicates how to determine the Ir (overload ; thermal or longtime)
and Im (short-circuit ; magnetic or short time) thresholds to ensure discrimination,
depending on the upstream and downstream trip units.
Remark (see Fig. N26)
b Time discrimination must be implemented by qualified personnel because time
delays before tripping increase the thermal stress (I2t) downstream (cables, semiconductors, etc.). Caution is required if tripping of CB2 is delayed using the Im
threshold time delay
b Energy discrimination does not depend on the trip unit, only on the circuit-breaker
Type of downstream
circuit
Ir upstream /
Ir downstream
Im upstream /
Im downstream
Im upstream /
Im downstream
Downstream trip unit
Distribution
Asynchronous motor
ratio
All types
> 1.6
>3
ratio
Magnetic
>2
>2
ratio
Electronic
>1.5
>1.5
Fig. N26 : Ir and Im thresholds depending on the upstream and downstream trip units
Special case of generator short-circuits
Figure N27 shows the reaction of a generator to a short-circuit.
To avoid any uncertainty concerning the type of excitation, we will trip at the first
peak (3 to 5 In as per X”d) using the Im protection setting without a time delay.
Irms
3 In
Generator with
over-excitation
N19
In
Generator with
series excitation
0.3 In
t
Fig. N27 : Generator during short-circuit
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Transient conditions
100 to 300 ms
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Subtransient
conditions 10 to 20 ms
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
2.6 Installation, connection and sizing of cables
Ready-to-use UPS units
The low power UPSs, for micro computer systems for example, are compact readyto-use equipement. The internal wiring is built in the factory and adapted to the
characteristics of the devices.
Not ready-to-use UPS units
For the other UPSs, the wire connections to the power supply system, to the battery
and to the load are not included.
Wiring connections depend on the current level as indicated in Figure N28 below.
Iu
SW
Static switch
Mains 1
I1
Iu
Load
Rectifier/
charger
Inverter
Mains 2
Ib
Battery
capacity C10
Fig.N28 : Current to be taken into account for the selection of the wire connections
Calculation of currents I1, Iu
b The input current Iu from the power network is the load current
b The input current I1 of the charger/rectifier depends on:
v The capacity of the battery (C10) and the charging mode (Ib)
v The characteristics of the charger
v The efficiency of the inverter
b The current Ib is the current in the connection of the battery
These currents are given by the manufacturers.
Cable temperature rise and voltage drops
N20
The cross section of cables depends on:
b Permissible temperature rise
b Permissible voltage drop
For a given load, each of these parameters results in a minimum permissible cross
section. The larger of the two must be used.
When routing cables, care must be taken to maintain the required distances between
control circuits and power circuits, to avoid any disturbances caused by HF currents.
Temperature rise
Permissible temperature rise in cables is limited by the withstand capacity of cable
insulation.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Temperature rise in cables depends on:
b The type of core (Cu or Al)
b The installation method
b The number of touching cables
Standards stipulate, for each type of cable, the maximum permissible current.
Voltage drops
The maximum permissible voltage drops are:
b 3% for AC circuits (50 or 60 Hz)
b 1% for DC circuits
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
Selection tables
Figure N29 indicates the voltage drop in percent for a circuit made up of 100 meters
of cable. To calculate the voltage drop in a circuit with a length L, multiply the value in
the table by L/100.
b Sph: Cross section of conductors
b In: Rated current of protection devices on circuit
Three-phase circuit
If the voltage drop exceeds 3% (50-60 Hz), increase the cross section of conductors.
DC circuit
If the voltage drop exceeds 1%, increase the cross section of conductors.
a - Three-phase circuits (copper conductors)
50-60 Hz - 380 V / 400 V / 415 V three-phase, cos = 0.8, balanced system three-phase + N
In
Sph (mN2)
(A)
10
16
25
35
50
70
95
120
150
185
10
0.9
15
1.2
20
1.6
1.1
25
2.0
1.3
0.9
32
2.6
1.7
1.1
40
3.3
2.1
1.4
1.0
50
4.1
2.6
1.7
1.3
1.0
63
5.1
3.3
2.2
1.6
1.2
0.9
70
5.7
3.7
2.4
1.7
1.3
1.0
0.8
80
6.5
4.2
2.7
2.1
1.5
1.2
0.9
0.7
100
8.2
5.3
3.4
2.6
2.0
2.0
1.1
0.9
0.8
125
6.6
4.3
3.2
2.4
2.4
1.4
1.1
1.0
0.8
160
5.5
4.3
3.2
3.2
1.8
1.5
1.2
1.1
200
5.3
3.9
3.9
2.2
1.8
1.6
1.3
250
4.9
4.9
2.8
2.3
1.9
1.7
320
3.5
2.9
2.5
2.1
400
4.4
3.6
3.1
2.7
500
4.5
3.9
3.4
600
4.9
4.2
800
5.3
1,000
For a three-phase 230 V circuit, multiply the result by e
For a single-phase 208/230 V circuit, multiply the result by 2
b - DC circuits (copper conductors)
In
Sph (mN2)
(A)
25
35
100
5.1
3.6
125
4.5
160
200
250
320
400
500
600
800
1,000
1,250
50
2.6
3.2
4.0
70
1.9
2.3
2.9
3.6
95
1.3
1.6
2.2
2.7
3.3
120
1.0
1.3
1.6
2.2
2.7
3.4
150
0.8
1.0
1.2
1.6
2.2
2.7
3.4
185
0.7
0.8
1.1
1.3
1.7
2.1
2.8
3.4
4.3
240
300
0.9
1.2
1.4
1.9
2.3
2.9
3.6
4.4
6.5
0.9
1.2
1.5
1.9
2.4
3.0
3.8
4.7
240
0.5
0.6
0.6
1.0
1.3
1.6
2.1
2.6
3.3
4.2
5.3
300
0.4
0.5
0.7
0.8
1.0
1.3
1.6
2.1
2.7
3.4
4.2
5.3
N21
Special case for neutral conductors
In three-phase systems, the third-order harmonics (and their multiples) of singlephase loads add up in the neutral conductor (sum of the currents on the three
phases).
For this reason, the following rule may be applied:
neutral cross section = 1.5 x phase cross section
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N29 : Voltage drop in percent for [a] three-phase circuits and [b] DC circuits
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Example
Consider a 70-meter 400 V three-phase circuit, with copper conductors and a rated
current of 600 A.
Standard IEC 60364 indicates, depending on the installation method and the load, a
minimum cross section.
We shall assume that the minimum cross section is 95 mm2.
It is first necessary to check that the voltage drop does not exceed 3%.
The table for three-phase circuits on the previous page indicates, for a 600 A current
flowing in a 300 mm2 cable, a voltage drop of 3% for 100 meters of cable, i.e. for
70 meters:
3 x 70 = 2.1 %
100
Therefore less than 3%
A identical calculation can be run for a DC current of 1,000 A.
In a ten-meter cable, the voltage drop for 100 meters of 240 mN2 cable is 5.3%, i.e.
for ten meters:
5.3 x 10 = 0.53 %
100
Therefore less than 3%
2.7 The UPSs and their environment
The UPSs can communicate with electrical and computing environment. They can
receive some data and provide information on their operation in order:
b To optimize the protection
For example, the UPS provides essential information on operating status to the
computer system (load on inverter, load on static bypass, load on battery, low battery
warning)
b To remotely control
The UPS provides measurement and operating status information to inform and
allow operators to take specific actions
b To manage the installation
The operator has a building and energy management system which allow to obtain
and save information from UPSs, to provide alarms and events and to take actions.
This evolution towards compatibilty between computer equipment and UPSs has the
effect to incorporate new built-in UPS functions.
2.8 Complementary equipment
Transformers
N22
A two-winding transformer included on the upstream side of the static contactor of
circuit 2 allows:
b A change of voltage level when the power network voltage is different to that of the
load
b A change of system of earthing between the networks
Moreover, such a transformer :
b Reduces the short-circuit current level on the secondary, (i.e load) side compared
with that on the power network side
b Prevents third harmonic currents which may be present on the secondary side
from passing into the power-system network, providing that the primary winding is
connected in delta.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Anti-harmonic filter
The UPS system includes a battery charger which is controlled by thyristors or
transistors. The resulting regularly-chopped current cycles “generate” harmonic
components in the power-supply network.
These indesirable components are filtered at the input of the rectifier and for most
cases this reduces the harmonic current level sufficiently for all practical purposes.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Uninterruptible Power Supply
units (UPS)
In certain specific cases however, notably in very large installations, an additional
filter circuit may be necessary.
For example when :
b The power rating of the UPS system is large relative to the MV/LV transformer
suppllying it
b The LV busbars supply loads which are particularly sensitive to harmonics
b A diesel (or gas-turbine, etc,) driven alternator is provided as a standby power
supply
In such cases, the manufacturer of the UPS system should be consulted
Communication equipment
Communication with equipment associated with computer systems may entail the
need for suitable facilities within the UPS system. Such facilities may be incorporated
in an original design (see Fig. N30a ), or added to existing systems on request
(see Fig. N30b ).
Fig. N30b : UPS unit achieving disponibility and quality of computer system power supply
N23
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N30a : Ready-to-use UPS unit (with DIN module)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
3 Protection of LV/LV transformers
These transformers are generally in the range of several hundreds of VA to some
hundreds of kVA and are frequently used for:
b Changing the low voltage level for:
v Auxiliary supplies to control and indication circuits
v Lighting circuits (230 V created when the primary system is 400 V 3-phase
3-wires)
b Changing the method of earthing for certain loads having a relatively high
capacitive current to earth (computer equipment) or resistive leakage current
(electric ovens, industrial-heating processes, mass-cooking installations, etc.)
LV/LV transformers are generally supplied with protective systems incorporated,
and the manufacturers must be consulted for details. Overcurrent protection must,
in any case, be provided on the primary side. The exploitation of these transformers
requires a knowledge of their particular function, together with a number of points
described below.
Note: In the particular cases of LV/LV safety isolating transformers at extra-low
voltage, an earthed metal screen between the primary and secondary windings
is frequently required, according to circumstances, as recommended in European
Standard EN 60742.
3.1 Transformer-energizing inrush current
At the moment of energizing a transformer, high values of transient current (which
includes a significant DC component) occur, and must be taken into account when
considering protection schemes (see Fig. N31).
I
t
I 1st peak
10 to 25 In
5s
In
20
ms
t
Ir
Im
Ii
I
Fig N31 : Transformer-energizing inrush current
RMS value of
the 1st peak
N24
Fig N32 : Tripping characteristic of a Compact NS type STR
(electronic)
t
The magnitude of the current peak depends on:
b The value of voltage at the instant of energization
b The magnitude and polarity of the residual flux existing in the core of the
transformer
b Characteristics of the load connected to the transformer
The first current peak can reach a value equal to 10 to 15 times the full-load r.m.s.
current, but for small transformers (< 50 kVA) may reach values of 20 to 25 times
the nominal full-load current. This transient current decreases rapidly, with a time
constant of the order of several ms to severals tens of ms.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3.2 Protection for the supply circuit of a
LV/LV transformer
In
10In 14In
RMS value of
the 1st peak
Fig N33 : Tripping characteristic of a Acti 9 curve D
I
The protective device on the supply circuit for a LV/LV transformer must avoid the
possibility of incorrect operation due to the magnetizing inrush current surge, noted
above.It is necessary to use therefore:
b Selective (i.e. slighly time-delayed) circuit-breakers of the type Compact NS STR
(see Fig. N32) or
b Circuit-breakers having a very high magnetic-trip setting, of the types Compact NS
or Acti 9 curve D (see Fig. N33)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Protection of LV/LV transformers
Example
A 400 V 3-phase circuit is supplying a 125 kVA 400/230 V transformer (In = 180 A)
for which the first inrush current peak can reach 12 In, i.e. 12 x 180 = 2,160 A.
This current peak corresponds to a rms value of 1,530 A.
A compact NS 250N circuit-breaker with Ir setting of 200 A and Im setting at 8 x Ir
would therefore be a suitable protective device.
A particular case: Overload protection installed at the secondary side of the
transformer (see Fig. N34)
An advantage of overload protection located on the secondary side is that the shortcircuit protection on the primary side can be set at a high value, or alternatively a
circuit-breaker type MA (magnetic only) can be used. The primary side short-circuit
protection setting must, however, be sufficiently sensitive to ensure its operation in
the event of a short-circuit occuring on the secondary side of the transformer.
NS250N
Trip unit
STR 22E
3 x 70 mm2
400/230 V
125 kVA
Note: The primary protection is sometimes provided by fuses, type aM. This practice
has two disadvantages:
b The fuses must be largely oversized (at least 4 times the nominal full-load rated
current of the transformer)
b In order to provide isolating facilities on the primary side, either a load-break switch
or a contactor must be associated with the fuses.
Fig N34 : Example
3.3 Typical electrical characteristics of LV/LV 50 Hz
transformers
5
100
6.3
110
8
130
10
150
12.5 16
160 170
20
270
25
310
250
320
390
500
600
840
800
1180 1240 1530 1650 2150 2540 3700 3700 5900 5900 6500 7400 9300 9400 11400 13400
4.5
4.5
4.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
5
5
4.5
5
5
5.5
4.5
5.5
8
105
400
5
10
115
530
5
12.5
120
635
5
16
140
730
4.5
20
150
865
4.5
25
175
1065
4.5
31.5
200
1200
4
40
215
1400
4
50
265
1900
5
63
305
2000
5
80
450
2450
4.5
100
450
3950
5.5
125
525
3950
5
160
635
4335
5
1-phase
kVA rating
No-load losses (W)
Full-load losses (W)
Short-circuit voltage (%)
31.5 40
350 350
50
410
63
460
80
520
100
570
125
680
160
680
200
790
5
250
950
5
315 400 500 630 800
1160 1240 1485 1855 2160
4.5
6
6
5.5
5.5
3.4 Protection of LV/LV transformers, using
Schneider Electric circuit-breakers
Acti 9 circuit-breaker
Transformer power rating (kVA)
230/240 V 1-ph 230/240 V 3-ph
400/415 V 1-ph
0.05
0.09
0.11
0.18
0.21
0.36
0.33
0.58
0.67
1.2
1.1
1.8
1.7
2.9
2.1
3.6
2.7
4.6
3.3
5.8
4.2
7.2
5.3
9.2
6.7
12
8.3
14
11
18
13
23
N25
400/415 V 3-ph
Cricuit breaker
curve D or K
Size
(A)
0.16
0.32
0.63
1.0
2.0
3.2
5.0
6.3
8.0
10
13
16
20
25
32
40
iC60, NG125
iC60, NG125
iC60, NG125
iC60, NG125
iC60, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
iC60, C120, NG125
C120, NG125
C120, NG125
C120, NG125
0.5
1
2
3
6
10
16
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
125
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3-phase
kVA rating
No-load
losses (W)
Full-load
losses (W)
Short-circuit
voltage (%)
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Compact NS100…NS250 circuit-breakers with TM-D trip unit
Transformer power rating (kVA)
230/240 V 1-ph 230/240 V 3-ph
400/415 V 1-ph
3
5…6
5
8…9
7…9
13…16
12…15
20…25
16…19
26…32
18…23
32…40
23…29
40…50
29…37
51…64
37…46
64…80
Circuit-breaker
Trip unit
NS100N/H/L
NS100N/H/L
NS100N/H/L
NS100N/H/L
NS100N/H/L
NS160N/H/L
NS160N/H/L
NS250N/H/L
NS250N/H/L
TN16D
TM05D
TN40D
TN63D
TN80D
TN100D
TN125D
TN160D
TN200D
400/415 V 3-ph
9…12
14…16
22…28
35…44
45…56
55…69
69…87
89…111
111…139
Compact NS100…NS1600 and Masterpact circuit-breakers with STR or
Micrologic trip unit
Transformer power rating (kVA)
230/240 V 1-ph 230/240 V 3-ph
400/415 V 1-ph
4…7
6…13
9…19
16…30
15…30
5…50
23…46
40…80
37…65
64…112
37…55
64…95
58…83
100…144
58…150
100…250
74…184
107…319
90…230
159…398
115…288
200…498
147…368
256…640
184…460
320…800
230…575
400…1,000
294…736
510…1,280
Circuit-breaker
Trip unit
11…22
27…56
44…90
70…139
111…195
111…166
175…250
175…436
222…554
277…693
346…866
443…1,108
554…1,385
690…1,730
886…2,217
Setting
Ir max
400/415 V 3-ph
NS100N/H/L
NS100N/H/L
NS160N/H/L
NS250N/H/L
NS400N/H
NS400L
NS630N/H/L
NS800N/H - NT08H1
NS800N/H - NT08H1 - NW08N1/H1
NS1000N/H - NT10H1 - NW10N1/H1
NS1250N/H - NT12H1 - NW12N1/H1
NS1600N/H - NT16H1 - NW16N1/H1
NW20N1/H1
NW25N2/H3
NW32N2/H3
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
N26
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
STR22SE 40
STR22SE 100
STR22SE 160
STR22SE 250
STR23SE / 53UE 400
STR23SE / 53UE 400
STR23SE / 53UE 630
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.6
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
4 Lighting circuits
A source of comfort and productivity, lighting represents 15% of the quantity of
electricity consumed in industry and 40% in buildings. The quality of lighting (light
stability and continuity of service) depends on the quality of the electrical energy
thus consumed. The supply of electrical power to lighting networks has therefore
assumed great importance.
To help with their design and simplify the selection of appropriate protection devices,
an analysis of the different lamp technologies is presented. The distinctive features
of lighting circuits and their impact on control and protection devices are discussed.
Recommendations relative to the difficulties of lighting circuit implementation are given.
4.1 The different lamp technologies
Artificial luminous radiation can be produced from electrical energy according to two
principles: incandescence and electroluminescence.
Incandescence is the production of light via temperature elevation. The most
common example is a filament heated to white state by the circulation of an electrical
current. The energy supplied is transformed into heat by the Joule effect and into
luminous flux.
Luminescence is the phenomenon of emission by a material of visible or almost
visible luminous radiation. A gas (or vapors) subjected to an electrical discharge
emits luminous radiation (Electroluminescence of gases).
Since this gas does not conduct at normal temperature and pressure, the discharge
is produced by generating charged particles which permit ionization of the gas. The
nature, pressure and temperature of the gas determine the light spectrum.
Photoluminescence is the luminescence of a material exposed to visible or almost
visible radiation (ultraviolet, infrared).
When the substance absorbs ultraviolet radiation and emits visible radiation which
stops a short time after energization, this is fluorescence.
Incandescent lamps
Incandescent lamps are historically the oldest and the most often found in common
use.
They are based on the principle of a filament rendered incandescent in a vacuum or
neutral atmosphere which prevents combustion.
A distinction is made between:
b Standard bulbs
These contain a tungsten filament and are filled with an inert gas (nitrogen and
argon or krypton).
b Halogen bulbs
These also contain a tungsten filament, but are filled with a halogen compound
and an inert gas (krypton or xenon). This halogen compound is responsible for the
phenomenon of filament regeneration, which increases the service life of the lamps
and avoids them blackening. It also enables a higher filament temperature and
therefore greater luminosity in smaller-size bulbs.
a-
The main disadvantage of incandescent lamps is their significant heat dissipation,
resulting in poor luminous efficiency.
N27
Fluorescent lamps
This family covers fluorescent tubes and compact fluorescent lamps. Their
technology is usually known as “low-pressure mercury”.
b-
Fluorescent tubes dissipate less heat and have a longer service life than
incandescent lamps, but they do need an ignition device called a “starter” and a
device to limit the current in the arc after ignition. This device called “ballast” is
usually a choke placed in series with the arc.
Compact fluorescent lamps are based on the same principle as a fluorescent tube.
The starter and ballast functions are provided by an electronic circuit (integrated in
the lamp) which enables the use of smaller tubes folded back on themselves.
Compact fluorescent lamps (see Fig. N35) were developed to replace incandescent
lamps: They offer significant energy savings (15 W against 75 W for the same level of
brightness) and an increased service life.
Fig. N35 : Compact fluorescent lamps [a] standard,
[b] induction
Lamps known as “induction” type or “without electrodes” operate on the principle of
ionization of the gas present in the tube by a very high frequency electromagnetic
field (up to 1 GHz). Their service life can be as long as 100,000 hrs.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In fluorescent tubes, an electrical discharge causes electrons to collide with
ions of mercury vapor, resulting in ultraviolet radiation due to energization of the
mercury atoms. The fluorescent material, which covers the inside of the tubes, then
transforms this radiation into visible light.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Discharge lamps (see Fig. N36)
The light is produced by an electrical discharge created between two electrodes within
a gas in a quartz bulb. All these lamps therefore require a ballast to limit the current in
the arc. A number of technologies have been developed for different applications.
Low-pressure sodium vapor lamps have the best light output, however the color
rendering is very poor since they only have a monochromatic orange radiation.
High-pressure sodium vapor lamps produce a white light with an orange tinge.
In high-pressure mercury vapor lamps, the discharge is produced in a quartz or
ceramic bulb at high pressure. These lamps are called “fluorescent mercury discharge
lamps”. They produce a characteristically bluish white light.
Metal halide lamps are the latest technology. They produce a color with a broad color
spectrum. The use of a ceramic tube offers better luminous efficiency and better color
stability.
Light Emitting Diodes (LED)
The principle of light emitting diodes is the emission of light by a semi-conductor
as an electrical current passes through it. LEDs are commonly found in numerous
applications, but the recent development of white or blue diodes with a high light
output opens new perspectives, especially for signaling (traffic lights, exit signs or
emergency lighting).
LEDs are low-voltage and low-current devices, thus suitable for battery-supply.
A converter is required for a line power supply.
The advantage of LEDs is their low energy consumption. As a result, they operate
at a very low temperature, giving them a very long service life. Conversely, a simple
diode has a weak light intensity. A high-power lighting installation therefore requires
connection of a large number of units in series and parallel.
Fig. N36 : Discharge lamps
Technology
Standard
incandescent
Application
- Domestic use
- Localized decorative
lighting
Halogen
incandescent
- Spot lighting
- Intense lighting
Fluorescent tube
- Shops, offices, workshops
- Outdoors
Compact
fluorescent lamp
- Domestic use
- Offices
- Replacement of
incandescent lamps
- Workshops, halls, hangars
- Factory floors
HP mercury vapor
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
N28
High-pressure
sodium
Low-pressure
sodium
Metal halide
- Outdoors
- Large halls
- Outdoors
- Emergency lighting
- Large areas
- Halls with high ceilings
LED
- Signaling (3-color traffic
lights, “exit” signs and
emergency lighting)
Technology
Standard incandescent
Halogen incandescent
Fluorescent tube
Compact fluorescent lamp
HP mercury vapor
High-pressure sodium
Low-pressure sodium
Metal halide
LED
Power (watt)
3 – 1,000
5 – 500
4 – 56
5 – 40
40 – 1,000
35 – 1,000
35 – 180
30 – 2,000
0.05 – 0.1
Advantages
- Direct connection without
intermediate switchgear
- Reasonable purchase price
- Compact size
- Instantaneous lighting
- Good color rendering
- Direct connection
- Instantaneous efficiency
- Excellent color rendering
- High luminous efficiency
- Average color rendering
- Low light intensity of single unit
- Sensitive to extreme temperatures
- Good luminous efficiency
- Good color rendering
- High initial investment
compared to incandescent lamps
- Good luminous efficiency
- Acceptable color rendering
- Compact size
- Long service life
- Very good luminous efficiency
- Lighting and relighting time
of a few minutes
- Good visibility in foggy weather
- Economical to use
- Good luminous efficiency
- Good color rendering
- Long service life
- Insensitive to the number of
switching operations
- Low energy consumption
- Low temperature
Disadvantages
- Low luminous efficiency and
high electricity consumption
- Significant heat dissipation
- Short service life
- Average luminous efficiency
- Lighting and relighting time
of a few minutes
- Long lighting time (5 min.)
- Mediocre color rendering
- Lighting and relighting time
of a few minutes
- Limited number of colors
- Low brightness of single unit
Efficiency (lumen/watt)
10 – 15
15 – 25
50 – 100
50 – 80
25 – 55
40 – 140
100 – 185
50 – 115
10 – 30
Fig. N37 : Usage and technical characteristics of lighting devices
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Service life (hours)
1,000 – 2,000
2,000 – 4,000
7,500 – 24,000
10,000 – 20,000
16,000 – 24,000
16,000 – 24,000
14,000 – 18,000
6,000 – 20,000
40,000 – 100,000
4 Lighting circuits
4.2 Electrical characteristics of lamps
Incandescent lamps with direct power supply
Due to the very high temperature of the filament during operation (up to 2,500 °C),
its resistance varies greatly depending on whether the lamp is on or off. As the cold
resistance is low, a current peak occurs on ignition that can reach 10 to 15 times the
nominal current for a few milliseconds or even several milliseconds.
This constraint affects both ordinary lamps and halogen lamps: it imposes a
reduction in the maximum number of lamps that can be powered by devices such as
remote-control switches, modular contactors and relays for busbar trunking.
Extra Low Voltage (ELV) halogen lamps
b Some low-power halogen lamps are supplied with ELV 12 or 24 V, via a
transformer or an electronic converter. With a transformer, the magnetization
phenomenon combines with the filament resistance variation phenomenon at
switch-on. The inrush current can reach 50 to 75 times the nominal current for a few
milliseconds. The use of dimmer switches placed upstream significantly reduces this
constraint.
b Electronic converters, with the same power rating, are more expensive than
solutions with a transformer. This commercial handicap is compensated by a greater
ease of installation since their low heat dissipation means they can be fixed on a
flammable support. Moreover, they usually have built-in thermal protection.
New ELV halogen lamps are now available with a transformer integrated in their
base. They can be supplied directly from the LV line supply and can replace normal
lamps without any special adaptation.
Dimming for incandescent lamps
This can be obtained by varying the voltage applied to the lampere
This voltage variation is usually performed by a device such as a Triac dimmer
switch, by varying its firing angle in the line voltage period. The wave form of the
voltage applied to the lamp is illustrated in Figure N38a. This technique known
as “cut-on control” is suitable for supplying power to resistive or inductive circuits.
Another technique suitable for supplying power to capacitive circuits has been
developed with MOS or IGBT electronic components. This techniques varies the
voltage by blocking the current before the end of the half-period (see Fig. N38b) and
is known as “cut-off control”.
Switching on the lamp gradually can also reduce, or even eliminate, the current peak
on ignition.
a]
As the lamp current is distorted by the electronic switching, harmonic currents
are produced. The 3rd harmonic order is predominant, and the percentage of 3rd
harmonic current related to the maximum fundamental current (at maximum power)
is represented on Figure N39.
300
200
100
0
t (s)
Note that in practice, the power applied to the lamp by a dimmer switch can only vary
in the range between 15 and 85% of the maximum power of the lampere
N29
-100
-200
-300
i3 (%)
0
0.01
0.02
50.0
b]
45.0
300
40.0
200
35.0
100
30.0
0
t (s)
25.0
15.0
-200
10.0
-300
0
0.01
5.0
0.02
0
Fig. N38 : Shape of the voltage supplied by a light dimmer at
50% of maximum voltage with the following techniques:
a] “cut-on control”
b] “cut-off control”
Power (%)
0
10.0
20.0
30.0
40.0
50.0
60.0
70.0
80.0
90.0
100.0
Fig. N39 : Percentage of 3rd harmonic current as a function of the power applied to an
incandescent lamp using an electronic dimmer switch
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
20.0
-100
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
According to IEC standard 61000-3-2 setting harmonic emission limits for electric or
electronic systems with current y 16 A, the following arrangements apply:
b Independent dimmers for incandescent lamps with a rated power less than or
equal to 1 kW have no limits applied
b Otherwise, or for incandescent lighting equipment with built-in dimmer or dimmer
built in an enclosure, the maximum permissible 3rd harmonic current is equal to
2.30 A
Fluorescent lamps with magnetic ballast
Fluorescent tubes and discharge lamps require the intensity of the arc to be limited,
and this function is fulfilled by a choke (or magnetic ballast) placed in series with the
bulb itself (see Fig. N40).
This arrangement is most commonly used in domestic applications with a limited
number of tubes. No particular constraint applies to the switches.
Dimmer switches are not compatible with magnetic ballasts: the cancellation of the
voltage for a fraction of the period interrupts the discharge and totally extinguishes
the lampere
The starter has a dual function: preheating the tube electrodes, and then generating
an overvoltage to ignite the tube. This overvoltage is generated by the opening of a
contact (controlled by a thermal switch) which interrupts the current circulating in the
magnetic ballast.
During operation of the starter (approx. 1 s), the current drawn by the luminaire is
approximately twice the nominal current.
Since the current drawn by the tube and ballast assembly is essentially inductive, the
power factor is very low (on average between 0.4 and 0.5). In installations consisting
of a large number of tubes, it is necessary to provide compensation to improve the
power factor.
For large lighting installations, centralized compensation with capacitor banks is a
possible solution, but more often this compensation is included at the level of each
luminaire in a variety of different layouts (see Fig. N41).
a]
Ballast
b]
C
c]
Ballast
C
a
C
Lamp
a
Ballast
Lamp
Ballast
Lamp
Lamp
a
N30
Compensation layout
Application
Comments
Without compensation
Parallel [a]
Domestic
Offices, workshops,
superstores
Single connection
Risk of overcurrents for control devices
Series [b]
Duo [c]
Choose capacitors with high
operating voltage (450 to 480 V)
Avoids flicker
Fig. N41 : The various compensation layouts: a] parallel; b] series; c] dual series also called
“duo” and their fields of application
The compensation capacitors are therefore sized so that the global power factor is
greater than 0.85. In the most common case of parallel compensation, its capacity
is on average 1 µF for 10 W of active power, for any type of lampere However, this
compensation is incompatible with dimmer switches.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Constraints affecting compensation
Fig. N40 : Magnetic ballasts
The layout for parallel compensation creates constraints on ignition of the lampere
Since the capacitor is initially discharged, switch-on produces an overcurrent.
An overvoltage also appears, due to the oscillations in the circuit made up of the
capacitor and the power supply inductance.
The following example can be used to determine the orders of magnitude.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
Assuming an assembly of 50 fluorescent tubes of 36 W each:
b Total active power: 1,800 W
b Apparent power: 2 kVA
b Total rms current: 9 A
b Peak current: 13 A
With:
b A total capacity: C = 175 µF
b A line inductance (corresponding to a short-circuit current of 5 kA): L = 150 µH
The maximum peak current at switch-on equals:
C
175 x 10-6
= 230 2
= 350 A
L
150 x 10-6
I c = Vmax
The theoretical peak current at switch-on can therefore reach 27 times the peak
current during normal operation.
The shape of the voltage and current at ignition is given in Figure N42 for switch
closing at the line supply voltage peak.
There is therefore a risk of contact welding in electromechanical control devices
(remote-control switch, contactor, circuit-breaker) or destruction of solid state
switches with semi-conductors.
(V)
600
400
200
0
t (s)
-200
-400
-600
0
0.02
0.04
0.06
(A)
300
200
100
0
t (s)
-100
N31
-200
-300
0
0.02
0.04
0.06
Fig. N42 : Power supply voltage at switch-on and inrush current
Ignition of fluorescent tubes in groups implies one specific constraint. When a group
of tubes is already switched on, the compensation capacitors in these tubes which
are already energized participate in the inrush current at the moment of ignition of
a second group of tubes: they “amplify” the current peak in the control switch at the
moment of ignition of the second group.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
In reality, the constraints are usually less severe, due to the impedance of the cables.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
The table in Figure N43, resulting from measurements, specifies the magnitude of
the first current peak, for different values of prospective short-circuit current Isc. It is
seen that the current peak can be multiplied by 2 or 3, depending on the number of
tubes already in use at the moment of connection of the last group of tubes.
Number of tubes
already in use
0
14
28
42
Number of tubes
connected
14
14
14
14
Inrush current peak (A)
Isc = 3,000 A
233
250
558
556
608
607
618
616
Isc = 1,500 A
Isc = 6,000 A
320
575
624
632
Fig. N43 : Magnitude of the current peak in the control switch of the moment of ignition of a
second group of tubes
Nonetheless, sequential ignition of each group of tubes is recommended so as to
reduce the current peak in the main switch.
The most recent magnetic ballasts are known as “low-loss”. The magnetic circuit has
been optimized, but the operating principle remains the same. This new generation
of ballasts is coming into widespread use, under the influence of new regulations
(European Directive, Energy Policy Act - USA).
In these conditions, the use of electronic ballasts is likely to increase, to the
detriment of magnetic ballasts.
Fluorescent lamps with electronic ballast
Electronic ballasts are used as a replacement for magnetic ballasts to supply power
to fluorescent tubes (including compact fluorescent lamps) and discharge lamps.
They also provide the “starter” function and do not need any compensation capacity.
The principle of the electronic ballast (see Fig. N44) consists of supplying the lamp
arc via an electronic device that generates a rectangular form AC voltage with a
frequency between 20 and 60 kHz.
Supplying the arc with a high-frequency voltage can totally eliminate the flicker
phenomenon and strobe effects. The electronic ballast is totally silent.
During the preheating period of a discharge lamp, this ballast supplies the lamp with
increasing voltage, imposing an almost constant current. In steady state, it regulates
the voltage applied to the lamp independently of any fluctuations in the line voltage.
Since the arc is supplied in optimum voltage conditions, this results in energy
savings of 5 to 10% and increased lamp service life. Moreover, the efficiency of the
electronic ballast can exceed 93%, whereas the average efficiency of a magnetic
device is only 85%.
The power factor is high (> 0.9).
The electronic ballast is also used to provide the light dimming function. Varying the
frequency in fact varies the current magnitude in the arc and hence the luminous
intensity.
N32
Inrush current
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The main constraint that electronic ballasts bring to line supplies is the high
inrush current on switch-on linked to the initial load of the smoothing capacitors
(see Fig. N45).
Technology
Rectifier with PFC
Rectifier with choke
Magnetic ballast
Fig. N44 : Electronic ballast
Max. inrush current
30 to 100 In
10 to 30 In
y 13 In
Duration
y 1 ms
y 5 ms
5 to 10 ms
Fig. N45 : Orders of magnitude of the inrush current maximum values, depending on the
technologies used
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
In reality, due to the wiring impedances, the inrush currents for an assembly of lamps
is much lower than these values, in the order of 5 to 10 In for less than 5 ms.
Unlike magnetic ballasts, this inrush current is not accompanied by an overvoltage.
Harmonic currents
For ballasts associated with high-power discharge lamps, the current drawn from
the line supply has a low total harmonic distortion (< 20% in general and < 10% for
the most sophisticated devices). Conversely, devices associated with low-power
lamps, in particular compact fluorescent lamps, draw a very distorted current
(see Fig. N46). The total harmonic distortion can be as high as 150%. In these
conditions, the rms current drawn from the line supply equals 1.8 times the current
corresponding to the lamp active power, which corresponds to a power factor of 0.55.
(A)
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
t (s)
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6
0
0.02
Fig. N46 : Shape of the current drawn by a compact fluorescent lamp
In order to balance the load between the different phases, lighting circuits are usually
connected between phases and neutral in a balanced way. In these conditions,
the high level of third harmonic and harmonics that are multiple of 3 can cause an
overload of the neutral conductor. The least favorable situation leads to a neutral
current which may reach 3 times the current in each phase.
Harmonic emission limits for electric or electronic systems are set by IEC standard
61000-3-2. For simplification, the limits for lighting equipment are given here only for
harmonic orders 3 and 5 which are the most relevant (see Fig. N47).
Harmonic
order
3
5
Active input
power > 25W
% of fundamental
current
30
10
Active input power y 25W
one of the 2 sets of limits apply:
% of fundamental
Harmonic current relative
current
to active power
86
3.4 mA/W
61
1.9 mA/W
N33
Fig. N47 : Maximum permissible harmonic current
Electronic ballasts usually have capacitors placed between the power supply
conductors and the earth. These interference-suppressing capacitors are responsible
for the circulation of a permanent leakage current in the order of 0.5 to 1 mA per
ballast. This therefore results in a limit being placed on the number of ballasts that
can be supplied by a Residual Current Differential Safety Device (RCD).
At switch-on, the initial load of these capacitors can also cause the circulation of a
current peak whose magnitude can reach several amps for 10 µs. This current peak
may cause unwanted tripping of unsuitable devices.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Leakage currents
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
High-frequency emissions
Electronic ballasts are responsible for high-frequency conducted and radiated
emissions.
The very steep rising edges applied to the ballast output conductors cause current
pulses circulating in the stray capacities to earth. As a result, stray currents circulate
in the earth conductor and the power supply conductors. Due to the high frequency
of these currents, there is also electromagnetic radiation. To limit these HF emissions,
the lamp should be placed in the immediate proximity of the ballast, thus reducing
the length of the most strongly radiating conductors.
The different power supply modes (see Fig. N48)
Technology
Standard incandescent
Halogen incandescent
ELV halogen incandescent
Fluorescent tube
Compact fluorescent lamp
Mercury vapor
High-pressure sodium
Low-pressure sodium
Metal halide
Power supply mode
Direct power supply
Other device
Dimmer switch
Transformer
Magnetic ballast and starter
Electronic converter
Electronic ballast
Electronic dimmer +
ballast
Built-in electronic ballast
Magnetic ballast
Electronic ballast
Fig. N48 : Different power supply modes
4.3 Constraints related to lighting devices and
recommendations
The current actually drawn by luminaires
The risk
This characteristic is the first one that should be defined when creating an
installation, otherwise it is highly probable that overload protection devices will trip
and users may often find themselves in the dark.
It is evident that their determination should take into account the consumption of
all components, especially for fluorescent lighting installations, since the power
consumed by the ballasts has to be added to that of the tubes and bulbs.
N34
The solution
For incandescent lighting, it should be remembered that the line voltage can be more
than 10% of its nominal value, which would then cause an increase in the current
drawn.
For fluorescent lighting, unless otherwise specified, the power of the magnetic
ballasts can be assessed at 25% of that of the bulbs. For electronic ballasts, this
power is lower, in the order of 5 to 10%.
The thresholds for the overcurrent protection devices should therefore be calculated
as a function of the total power and the power factor, calculated for each circuit.
Overcurrents at switch-on
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The risk
The devices used for control and protection of lighting circuits are those such as
relays, triac, remote-control switches, contactors or circuit-breakers.
The main constraint applied to these devices is the current peak on energization.
This current peak depends on the technology of the lamps used, but also on the
installation characteristics (supply transformer power, length of cables, number of
lamps) and the moment of energization in the line voltage period. A high current
peak, however fleeting, can cause the contacts on an electromechanical control
device to weld together or the destruction of a solid state device with semiconductors.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
Two solutions
Because of the inrush current, the majority of ordinary relays are incompatible with
lighting device power supply. The following recommendations are therefore usually
made:
b Limit the number of lamps to be connected to a single device so that their total
power is less than the maximum permissible power for the device
b Check with the manufacturers what operating limits they suggest for the devices.
This precaution is particularly important when replacing incandescent lamps with
compact fluorescent lamps
By way of example, the table in Figure N49 indicates the maximum number of
compensated fluorescent tubes that can be controlled by different devices with
16 A rating. Note that the number of controlled tubes is well below the number
corresponding to the maximum power for the devices.
Tube unit power
requirement
(W)
Number of tubes
corresponding
to the power
16 A x 230 V
18
36
58
204
102
63
Maximum number of tubes that can be
controlled by
Contactors
Remote
CircuitGC16 A
control
breakers
CT16 A
switches
C60-16 A
TL16 A
15
50
112
15
25
56
10
16
34
Fig. N49 : The number of controlled tubes is well below the number corresponding to the
maximum power for the devices
But a technique exists to limit the current peak on energization of circuits with
capacitive behavior (magnetic ballasts with parallel compensation and electronic
ballasts). It consists of ensuring that activation occurs at the moment when the line
voltage passes through zero. Only solid state switches with semi-conductors offer
this possibility (see Fig. N50a). This technique has proved to be particularly useful
when designing new lighting circuits.
More recently, hybrid technology devices have been developed that combine a solid
state switch (activation on voltage passage through zero) and an electromechanical
contactor short-circuiting the solid state switch (reduction of losses in the semiconductors) (see Fig. N50b).
N35
a
b
c
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N50 : “Standard” CT+ contactor [a], CT+ contactor with manual override, pushbutton for
selection of operating mode and indicator lamp showing the active operating mode [b], and TL +
remote-control switch [c] (Schneider-Electric brand)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Modular contactors and impulse relays do
not use the same technologies. Their rating is
determined according to different standards.
For example, for a given rating, an impulse
relay is more efficient than a modular
contactor for the control of light fittings with
a strong inrush current, or with a low power
factor (non-compensated inductive circuit).
Type
of lamp
Unit power
and capacitance of power factor
correction capacitor
Basic incandescent lamps
LV halogen lamps
Replacement mercury vapour lamps (without ballast)
40 W
60 W
75 W
100 W
150 W
200 W
300 W
500 W
1000 W
1500 W
ELV 12 or 24 V halogen lamps
With ferromagnetic transformer 20 W
50 W
75 W
100 W
20 W
With electronic transformer
50 W
75 W
100 W
Fluorescent tubes with starter and ferromagnetic ballast
1 tube
15 W
without compensation (1)
18 W
N36
1 tube
with parallel compensation (2)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
2 or 4 tubes
with series compensation
20 W
36 W
40 W
58 W
65 W
80 W
115 W
15 W
18 W
20 W
36 W
40 W
58 W
65 W
80 W
115 W
2 x 18 W
4 x 18 W
2 x 36 W
2 x 58 W
2 x 65 W
2 x 80 W
2 x 115 W
Fluorescent tubes with electronic ballast
18 W
1 or 2 tubes
36 W
58 W
2 x 18 W
2 x 36 W
2 x 58 W
5 µF
5 µF
5 µF
5 µF
5 µF
7 µF
7 µF
7 µF
16 µF
Choice of relay rating according to lamp type
b Figure 51 below shows the maximum number of light fittings for each relay,
according to the type, power and configuration of a given lamp. As an indication, the
total acceptable power is also mentioned.
b These values are given for a 230 V circuit with 2 active conductors (single-phase
phase/neutral or two-phase phase/phase). For 110 V circuits, divide the values in the
table by 2.
b To obtain the equivalent values for the whole of a 230 V three-phase circuit,
multiply the number of lamps and the total acceptable power:
v by 3 (1.73) for circuits without neutral;
v by 3 for circuits with neutral.
Note: The power ratings of the lamps most commonly used are shown in bold.
Maximum number of light fittings for a single-phase circuit
and maximum power output per circuit
TL impulse relay
CT contactor
16 A
32 A
16 A
25 A
40 A
40
25
20
16
10
8
5
3
1
1
1500 W
to
1600 W
115
85
70
50
35
26
18
10
6
4
4600 W
to
5250 W
70
28
19
14
60
25
18
14
1350 W
to
1450 W
42
27
23
18
182
76
53
42
850 W
to
1950 W
83
70
62
35
31
21
20
16
11
60
50
45
25
22
16
13
11
7
56
1500 W
1200 W
to
1400 W
1250 W
to
1300 W
900 W
2000 W
28
28
17
15
12
8
80
40
26
40
20
13
106
66
53
42
28
21
13
8
4
2
4000 W
to
4200 W
180
74
50
37
160
65
44
33
3600 W
to
3750 W
213
186
160
93
81
55
50
41
29
160
133
120
66
60
42
37
30
20
148
4000 W
3200 W
to
3350 W
3200 W
to
3350 W
2400 W
5300 W
74
74
45
40
33
23
1450 W
to
1550 W
212
106
69
106
53
34
3800 W
to
4000 W
38
30
25
19
12
10
7
4
2
1
1550 W 57
to
45
2000 W 38
28
18
14
2100 W 10
6
3
2
2300 W
to
2850 W
15
10
8
6
62
25
20
16
300 W
to
600 W
23
15
12
8
1250 W 90
to
39
1600 W 28
22
450 W
to
900 W
22
330 W
to
850 W
22
22
20
20
13
13
10
7
15
15
15
15
15
10
10
10
5
30
30
16
16
10
10
9
6
30
30
28
28
17
17
15
10
200 W 20
to
20
800 W 20
20
20
15
15
15
7
1100 W 46
to
24
1500 W
24
16
16
13
10
74
38
25
36
20
12
1300 W 111
to
58
1400 W 37
55
30
19
3000 W
1850 W
to
2250 W
450 W
to
1200 W
300 W
to
1200 W
1650 W
to
2400 W
2000 W
to
2200 W
70
70
70
60
60
35
35
30
20
40
40
40
40
40
30
30
30
14
80
44
44
27
27
22
16
222
117
74
111
60
38
63 A
5500 W
to
6000 W
3650 W
to
4200 W
1050 W
to
2400 W
600 W
to
2400 W
2900 W
to
3800 W
4000 W
to
4400 W
172
125
100
73
50
37
25
15
8
5
6900 W
to
7500 W
63
42
35
27
275
114
78
60
1250 W
to
2850 W
100
100
100
90
90
56
56
48
32
60
60
60
60
60
43
43
43
20
123
68
68
42
42
34
25
333
176
111
166
90
57
Fig. N51 : Maximum number of light fittings for each relay, according to the type, power and configuration of a given lamp (Continued on opposite page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7500 W
to
8000 W
5500 W
to
6000 W
1500 W
to
3850 W
900 W
to
3500 W
4450 W
to
5900 W
6000 W
to
6600 W
4 Lighting circuits
Unit power
and capacitance of power factor
correction capacitor
Maximum number of light fittings for a single-phase circuit
and maximum power output per circuit
TL impulse relay
CT contactor
16 A
32 A
16 A
25 A
Compact fluorescent lamps
With external electronic ballast
5W
240 1200 W 630 3150 W 210
7W
171 to
457 to
150
9W
138 1450 W 366 3800 W 122
11 W
118
318
104
18 W
77
202
66
26 W
55
146
50
With integral electronic ballast 5 W
170 850 W
390 1950 W 160
(replacement for incandescent 7 W
121 to
285 to
114
lamps)
9W
100 1050 W 233 2400 W 94
11 W
86
200
78
18 W
55
127
48
26 W
40
92
34
High-pressure mercury vapour lamps with ferromagnetic ballast without ignitor
Replacement high-pressure sodium vapour lamps with ferromagnetic ballast with integral ignitor (3)
Without compensation (1)
50 W
not tested,
15
infrequent use
80 W
10
125 / 110 W (3)
8
250 / 220 W (3)
4
400 / 350 W (3)
2
700 W
1
With parallel compensation (2) 50 W
7 µF
10
80 W
8 µF
9
125 / 110 W (3)
10 µF
9
250 / 220 W (3)
18 µF
4
400 / 350 W (3)
25 µF
3
700 W
40 µF
2
1000 W
60 µF
0
Low-pressure sodium vapour lamps with ferromagnetic ballast with external ignitor
35 W
5
not tested,
Without compensation (1)
infrequent use
55 W
5
90 W
3
135 W
2
180 W
2
With parallel compensation (2) 35 W
20 µF
38
1350 W 102 3600 W 3
55 W
3
20 µF
24
63
90 W
26 µF
15
40
2
135 W
1
40 µF
10
26
180 W
45 µF
7
18
1
High-pressure sodium vapour lamps
Metal-iodide lamps
With ferromagnetic ballast with 35 W
not tested,
16
external ignitor, without
infrequent use
70 W
8
compensation (1)
150 W
4
250 W
2
400 W
1
1000 W
0
With ferromagnetic ballast with 35 W
6 µF
34
1200 W 88
3100 W 12
external ignitor and parallel
to
to
70 W
6
12 µF
17
45
compensation (2)
1350 W 22
3400 W 4
150 W
20 µF
8
250 W
3
32 µF
5
13
400 W
45 µF
3
8
2
1000 W
60 µF
1
3
1
2000 W
85 µF
0
1
0
3100 W 24
With electronic ballast
35 W
38
1350 W 87
to
to
70 W
18
29
77
2200 W 33
5000 W 9
150 W
14
1050 W 330
to
222
1300 W 194
163
105
76
800 W 230
to
164
900 W 133
109
69
50
750 W 20
to
15
1000 W 10
6
4
2
500 W 15
to
13
1400 W 10
6
4
2
1
270 W
to
360 W
100 W
to
180 W
600 W
9
9
6
4
4
5
5
4
2
2
24
12
7
4
3
1
450 W 18
to
9
1000 W 6
4
3
2
1
850 W 38
to
29
1350 W 14
40 A
1650 W
to
2000 W
670
478
383
327
216
153
470
335
266
222
138
100
1150 W
to
1300 W
1000 W
to
1600 W
750 W
to
1600 W
63 A
3350 W
to
4000 W
not tested
2350 W
to
2600 W
710
514
411
340
213
151
34
27
20
10
6
4
28
25
20
11
8
5
3
53
40
28
15
10
6
1400 W 43
to
38
3500 W 30
17
12
7
5
14
14
9
6
6
10
10
8
5
4
500 W
to
1100 W
42
20
13
8
5
2
31
16
10
7
5
3
2
68
51
26
1450 W
to
2000 W
320 W
to
720 W
175 W
to
360 W
850 W
to
1200 W
650 W
to
2000 W
1350 W
to
2200 W
1700 W
to
2800 W
350 W
to
720 W
1100 W
to
4000 W
2400 W
to
4000 W
3550 W
to
3950 W
2650 W
to
4200 W
2150 W
to
5000 W
24
24
19
10
10
15
15
11
7
6
850 W
to
1800 W
64
32
18
11
8
3
50
25
15
10
7
5
3
102
76
40
2250 W
to
3200 W
550 W
to
1100 W
1750 W
to
6000 W
3600 W
to
6000 W
(1) Circuits with non-compensated ferromagnetic ballasts consume twice as much current for a given lamp power output. This explains the small number of lamps in this
configuration.
(2) The total capacitance of the power factor correction capacitors in parallel in a circuit limits the number of lamps that can be controlled by a contactor. The total
downstream capacitance of a modular contactor of rating 16, 25, 40 or 63 A should not exceed 75, 100, 200 or 300 µF respectively. Allow for these limits to calculate the
maximum acceptable number of lamps if the capacitance values are different from those in the table.
(3) High-pressure mercury vapour lamps without ignitor, of power 125, 250 and 400 W, are gradually being replaced by high-pressure sodium vapour lamps with integral
ignitor, and respective power of 110, 220 and 350 W.
Fig. N51 : Maximum number of light fittings for each relay, according to the type, power and configuration of a given lamp (Concluded)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N37
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Type
of lamp
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Protection of lamp circuits: Maximum number of lamps and MCB rating versus
lamp type, unit power and MCB tripping curve
During start up of discharge lamps (with their ballast), the inrush current drawn by
each lamp may be in the order of:
b 25 x circuit start current for the first 3 ms
b 7 x circuit start current for the following 2 s
For fluorescent lamps with High Frequency Electronic control ballast, the protective
device ratings must cope with 25 x inrush for 250 to 350 µs.
However due to the circuit resistance the total inrush current seen by the MCB is
lower than the summation of all individual lamp inrush current if directly connected to
the MCB.
The tables below (see Fig. N52 to NXX) take into account:
b Circuits cables have a length of 20 meters from distribution board to the first lamp
and 7 meters between each additional fittings.
b MCB rating is given to protect the lamp circuit in accordance with the cable cross
section, and without unwanted tripping upon lamp starting.
b MCB tripping curve (C = instantaneous trip setting 5 to 10 In, D = instantaneous
trip setting 10 to 14 In).
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
14/18
14 x2
14 x3
14 x4
18 x2
18 x4
21/24
21/24 x2
28
28 x2
35/36/39
35/36 x2
38/39 x2
40/42
40/42 x2
49/50
49/50 x2
54/55
54/55 x2
60
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
13
MCB rating C & D tripping curve
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
10
6
10
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
10
6
10
6
16
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
6
10
6
10
6
16
6
6
6
6
10
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
6
10
6
16
6
16
10
6
6
10
10
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
10
10
6
10
6
16
6
16
10
6
6
10
10
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
10
10
6
10
6
16
10
16
10
6
6
10
10
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
10
10
6
16
6
16
10
16
10
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
N38
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N52 : Fluorescent tubes with electronic ballast - Vac = 230 V
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
6
9
11
13
14
15
16
17
18
20
21
23
25
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
13
MCB rating C & D tripping curve
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
Fig. N53 : Compact fluorescent lamps - Vac = 230 V
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
50
80
125
250
400
1000
6
6
6
6
6
16
6
6
6
10
16
32
6
6
6
10
20
40
6
6
10
16
25
50
6
6
10
16
25
50
6
6
10
16
32
50
6
6
10
16
32
50
6
6
10
16
32
63
50
80
125
250
400
1000
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
10
20
6
6
6
10
16
25
6
6
6
10
16
32
6
6
6
10
20
40
6
6
6
10
20
40
6
6
10
16
25
50
6
6
10
16
25
63
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
MCB rating C tripping curve
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
10
10
16
16
20
20
25
32
32
32
40
63
MCB rating D tripping curve
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
10
10
16
16
20
20
25
25
32
32
40
63
-
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
32
50
-
6
10
16
32
50
-
10
10
16
32
50
-
10
16
16
32
50
-
10
16
20
40
63
-
10
16
20
40
63
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
32
50
-
6
10
16
32
50
-
10
10
16
32
50
-
10
16
16
32
50
-
10
16
20
40
63
-
10
16
20
40
63
-
Fig. N54 : High pressure mercury vapour (with ferromagnetic ballast and PF correction) - Vac = 230 V
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
Ferromagnetic ballast
18
6
6
26
6
6
35/36
6
6
55
6
6
91
6
6
131
6
6
135
6
6
180
6
6
Electronic ballast
36
6
6
55
6
6
66
6
6
91
6
6
Ferromagnetic ballast
18
6
6
26
6
6
35/36
6
6
55
6
6
91
6
6
131
6
6
135
6
6
180
6
6
Electronic ballast
36
6
6
55
6
6
66
6
6
91
6
6
3
4
5
6
7
8
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
13
MCB rating C tripping curve
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
16
16
16
25
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
25
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
25
6
6
6
10
16
20
20
25
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
10
MCB rating D tripping curve
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
6
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
20
6
6
6
10
16
16
16
25
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
25
6
6
6
10
16
16
20
25
6
6
6
10
16
20
20
25
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
10
6
6
6
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
10
16
16
N39
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N55 : Low pressure sodium (with PF correction) - Vac = 230 V
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
Ferromagnetic ballast
50
6
6
70
6
6
100
6
6
150
6
6
250
6
10
400
10
16
1000
16
32
Electronic ballast
35
6
6
50
6
6
100
6
6
Ferromagnetic ballast
50
6
6
70
6
6
100
6
6
150
6
6
250
6
6
400
6
10
1000
10
20
Electronic ballast
35
6
6
50
6
6
100
6
6
3
4
5
6
7
8
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
13
MCB rating C tripping curve
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
6
6
10
16
20
40
6
6
6
10
16
25
50
6
6
6
10
16
32
50
6
6
6
10
20
32
50
6
6
6
10
20
32
50
6
6
6
10
20
32
63
6
6
10
6
20
32
63
6
10
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
16
32
50
-
6
10
16
20
32
50
-
10
10
16
20
32
50
-
10
16
16
20
32
50
-
10
16
16
25
40
63
-
10
16
16
25
40
63
-
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
10
10
MCB rating D tripping curve
6
10
10
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
6
6
6
10
16
32
6
6
6
6
10
16
32
6
6
6
6
16
20
40
6
6
6
10
16
20
40
6
6
6
10
16
25
50
6
6
6
10
16
25
63
6
6
10
10
16
25
63
6
6
10
16
20
32
-
6
10
10
16
20
32
-
6
10
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
16
32
50
-
6
10
16
20
32
50
-
10
10
16
20
32
50
-
10
16
16
20
32
50
-
10
16
16
25
40
63
-
10
16
16
25
40
63
-
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
10
10
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
6
10
16
20
32
-
6
10
10
16
20
32
-
6
10
10
16
25
40
-
Fig. N56 : High pressure sodium (with PF correction) - Vac = 230 V
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
Ferromagnetic ballast
35
6
6
70
6
6
150
6
6
250
6
10
400
6
16
1000
16
32
1800/2000
25
50
Electronic ballast
35
6
6
70
6
6
150
6
6
N40
Ferromagnetic ballast
35
6
6
70
6
6
150
6
6
250
6
6
400
6
10
1000
16
20
1800
16
32
2000
20
32
Electronic ballast
35
6
6
70
6
6
150
6
6
3
4
5
6
7
8
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
13
MCB rating C tripping curve
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
6
6
10
16
20
40
63
6
6
10
16
25
50
63
6
6
10
16
25
50
63
6
6
10
20
32
50
-
6
6
10
20
32
50
-
6
6
10
20
32
63
-
6
6
10
20
32
63
-
6
10
16
25
40
63
-
6
10
16
25
40
63
-
6
10
16
32
50
63
-
6
10
20
32
50
63
-
6
10
20
32
50
63
-
6
16
20
32
50
63
-
6
16
25
40
63
63
-
6
16
25
40
63
63
-
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
10
10
16
16
16
MCB rating D tripping curve
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
20
6
10
20
6
10
20
6
6
6
10
16
32
40
40
6
6
6
10
16
32
50
50
6
6
6
16
20
40
63
63
6
6
10
16
20
50
63
-
6
6
10
16
25
50
-
6
6
10
16
25
63
-
6
6
10
16
25
63
-
6
6
16
20
32
-
6
6
16
20
32
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
25
40
-
6
10
16
32
50
-
6
10
20
32
50
-
6
10
20
32
50
-
6
16
20
32
50
-
6
16
25
40
63
-
6
16
25
40
63
-
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
10
6
6
16
6
6
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
16
6
10
20
6
10
20
6
10
20
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
6
6
16
20
32
63
-
6
10
16
20
32
63
-
6
10
16
25
40
63
-
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. N57 : Metal halide (with PF correction) - Vac = 230 V
Lamp
power (W)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1800
2000
16
16
32
32
40
40
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
63
63
1800
2000
16
16
20
25
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
50
50
63
63
Number of lamps per circuit
9
10
11
12
MCB rating C tripping curve
63
63
MCB rating D tripping curve
63
-
Fig. N58 : Metal halide (with ferromagnetic ballast and PF correction) - Vac = 400 V
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
Overload of the neutral conductor
The risk
In an installation including, for example, numerous fluorescent tubes with electronic
ballasts supplied between phases and neutral, a high percentage of 3rd harmonic
current can cause an overload of the neutral conductor. Figure N59 below gives an
overview of typical H3 level created by lighting.
Lamp type
Incandescend lamp
with dimmer
ELV halogen lamp
Fluorescent tube
Discharge lamp
Typical power
100 W
Setting mode
Light dimmer
Typical H3 level
5 to 45 %
25 W
Electronic ELV
transformer
Magnetic ballast
Electronic ballast
+ PFC
Magnetic ballast
Electrical ballast
5%
100 W
< 25 W
> 25 W
100 W
10 %
85 %
30 %
10 %
30 %
Fig. N59 : Overview of typical H3 level created by lighting
The solution
Firstly, the use of a neutral conductor with a small cross-section (half) should be
prohibited, as requested by Installation standard IEC 60364, section 523–5–3.
As far as overcurrent protection devices are concerned, it is necessary to provide
4-pole circuit-breakers with protected neutral (except with the TN-C system for which
the PEN, a combined neutral and protection conductor, should not be cut).
This type of device can also be used for the breaking of all poles necessary to supply
luminaires at the phase-to-phase voltage in the event of a fault.
A breaking device should therefore interrupt the phase and Neutral circuit
simultaneously.
Leakage currents to earth
The risk
At switch-on, the earth capacitances of the electronic ballasts are responsible for
residual current peaks that are likely to cause unintentional tripping of protection
devices.
Two solutions
The use of Residual Current Devices providing immunity against this type of impulse
current is recommended, even essential, when equipping an existing installation
(see Fig. N60).
For a new installation, it is sensible to provide solid state or hybrid control devices
(contactors and remote-control switches) that reduce these impulse currents
(activation on voltage passage through zero).
N41
Overvoltages
The risk
As illustrated in earlier sections, switching on a lighting circuit causes a transient state
which is manifested by a significant overcurrent. This overcurrent is accompanied by a
strong voltage fluctuation applied to the load terminals connected to the same circuit.
These voltage fluctuations can be detrimental to correct operation of sensitive loads
(micro-computers, temperature controllers, etc.)
Sensitivity of lighting devices to line voltage disturbances
Short interruptions
b The risk
Discharge lamps require a relighting time of a few minutes after their power supply
has been switched off.
Fig. N60 : s.i. residual current devices with immunity against
impulse currents (Schneider-Electric brand)
b The solution
Partial lighting with instantaneous relighting (incandescent lamps or fluorescent
tubes, or “hot restrike” discharge lamps) should be provided if safety requirements so
dictate. Its power supply circuit is, depending on current regulations, usually distinct
from the main lighting circuit.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
The Solution
It is advisable to separate the power supply for these sensitive loads from the lighting
circuit power supply.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Voltage fluctuations
b The risk
The majority of lighting devices (with the exception of lamps supplied by electronic
ballasts) are sensitive to rapid fluctuations in the supply voltage. These fluctuations
cause a flicker phenomenon which is unpleasant for users and may even cause
significant problems. These problems depend on both the frequency of variations
and their magnitude.
Standard IEC 61000-2-2 (“compatibility levels for low-frequency conducted
disturbances”) specifies the maximum permissible magnitude of voltage variations as
a function of the number of variations per second or per minute.
These voltage fluctuations are caused mainly by high-power fluctuating loads (arc
furnaces, welding machines, starting motors).
b The solution
Special methods can be used to reduce voltage fluctuations. Nonetheless, it is
advisable, wherever possible, to supply lighting circuits via a separate line supply.
The use of electronic ballasts is recommended for demanding applications
(hospitals, clean rooms, inspection rooms, computer rooms, etc).
Developments in control and protection equipment
The use of light dimmers is more and more common. The constraints on ignition are
therefore reduced and derating of control and protection equipment is less important.
New protection devices adapted to the constraints on lighting circuits are being
introduced, for example Schneider Electric brand circuit-breakers and modular
residual current circuit-breakers with special immunity, such as s.i. type ID switches
and Vigi circuit-breakers. As control and protection equipment evolves, some now
offer remote control, 24-hour management, lighting control, reduced consumption,
etc.
4.4 Lighting of public areas
Normal lighting
Regulations governing the minimum requirements for buildings receiving the public in
most European countries are as follows:
b Installations which illuminates areas accessible to the public must be controlled
and protected independently from installations providing illumination to other areas
b Loss of supply on a final lighting circuit (i.e. fuse blown or CB tripped) must not
result in total loss of illumination in an area which is capable of accommodating more
than 50 persons
b Protection by Residual Current Devices (RCD) must be divided amongst several
devices (i.e. more than on device must be used)
Emergency lighting and other systems
N42
When we refer to emergency lighting, we mean the auxiliary lighting that is triggered
when the standard lighting fails.
Emergency lighting is subdivided as follows (EN-1838):
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Safety lighting
It originates from the emergency lighting and is intended to provide lighting for people to
evacuate an area safely or for those who try to fi nish a potentially dangerous operation before
leaving the area. It is intended to illuminate the means of evacuation and ensure continuous
visibility and ready usage in safety when standard or emergency lighting is needed.
Safety lighting may be further subdivided as follows:
Safety lighting for escape routes
It originates from the safety lighting, and is
intended to ensure that the escape means
can be clearly identifi ed and used safely
when the area is busy.
Anti-panic lighting in extended areas
It originates from the safety lighting, and is
intended to avoid panic and to provide the
necessary lighting to allow people to reach
a possible escape route area.
Emergency lighting and safety signs for escape routes
The emergency lighting and safety signs for escape routes are very important for all
those who design emergency systems. Their suitable choice helps improve safety
levels and allows emergency situations to be handled better.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Lighting circuits
Standard EN 1838 ("Lighting applications. Emergency lighting") gives some
fundamental concepts concerning what is meant by emergency lighting for escape
routes:
"The intention behind lighting escape routes is to allow safe exit by the occupants,
providing them with suffi cient visibility and directions on the escape route …"
The concept referred to above is very simple:
The safety signs and escape route lighting must be two separate things.
Functions and operation of the luminaires
The manufacturing specifi cations are covered by standard EN 60598-2-22,
"Particular Requirements - Luminaires for Emergency Lighting", which must be read
with EN 60598-1, "Luminaires – Part 1: General Requirements and Tests".
Duration
A basic requirement is to determine the duration required for the emergency lighting.
Generally it is 1 hour but some countries may have different duration requirements
according to statutory technical standards.
Operation
We should clarify the different types of emergency luminaires:
b Non-maintained luminaires
v The lamp will only switch on if there is a fault in the standard lighting
v The lamp will be powered by the battery during failure
v The battery will be automatically recharged when the mains power supply is
restored
b Maintained luminaires
v The lamp can be switched on in continuous mode
v A power supply unit is required with the mains, especially for powering the lamp,
which can be disconnected when the area is not busy
v The lamp will be powered by the battery during failure.
Design
The integration of emergency lighting with standard lighting must comply strictly with
electrical system standards in the design of a building or particular place.
All regulations and laws must be complied with in order to design a system which is
up to standard (see Fig. N61).
The main functions of an emergency lighting system
when standard lighting fails are the following:
b Clearly show the escape
route using clear signs.
b Provide sufficient emergency
lighting along the escape paths
so that people can safely find
their ways to the exits.
N43
Fig. N61 : The main functions of an emergency lighting system
European standards
The design of emergency lighting systems is regulated by a number of legislative
provisions that are updated and implemented from time to time by new
documentation published on request by the authorities that deal with European and
international technical standards and regulations.
Each country has its own laws and regulations, in addition to technical standards
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Ensure that alarms and
the fire safety equipment
present along the way out
are easily identifiable.
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
4 Lighting circuits
which govern different sectors. Basically they describe the places that must be
provided with emergency lighting as well as its technical specifi cations. The
designer's job is to ensure that the design project complies with these standards.
EN 1838
A very important document on a European level regarding emergency lighting is the
Standard EN 1838, "Lighting applications. Emergency lighting".
This standard presents specifi c requirements and constraints regarding the
operation and the function of emergency lighting systems.
CEN and CENELEC standards
With the CEN (Comité Européen de Normalisation) and CENELEC standards
(Comité Européen de Normalisation Electrotechnique), we are in a standardised
environment of particular interest to the technician and the designer. A number
of sections deal with emergencies. An initial distinction should be made between
luminaire standards and installation standards.
EN 60598-2-22 and EN-60598-1
Emergency lighting luminaires are subject to European standard EN 60598-222, "Particular Requirements - Luminaires for Emergency Lighting", which is an
integrative text (of specifi cations and analysis) of the Standard EN-60598-1,
Luminaires – "Part 1: General Requirements and Tests".
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
N44
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
The asynchronous (i.e. induction) motor is
robust and reliable, and very widely used.
95% of motors installed around the world are
asynchronous. The protection of these motors
is consequently a matter of great importance
in numerous applications.
The consequence of a motor failure due to an incorrect protection or inability of
control circuit to operate can include the following:
b For persons:
v Asphyxiation due to the blockage of motor ventilation
v Electrocution due to insulation failure in the motor
v Accident due to non stopping of the motor following a control circuit failure
b For the driven machine and the process:,
v Shaft couplings, axles, driving belts, … damaged due to a stalled rotor
v Lost production
v Delayed manufacturing
b For the motor itself:
v Motor windings burnt out due to stalled rotor
v Cost of repair
v Cost of replacement
t
I" = 8 to 12 In
Id = 5 to 8 In
In = rated current of the motor
td
1 to 10s
20 to
30 ms
I
Is
I"
Fig. N62 : Direct on-line starting current characteristics of an
induction motor
Therefore, safety of persons and goods, as well as reliability and availability levels,
are highly dependant on the selection of protective equipment.
In economic terms, the overall cost of failure must be considered. This cost
is increasing with the size of the motor and with the difficulties of access and
replacement. Loss of production is a further and evidently important factor.
Specific features of motor performance influence the power supply circuits required
for satisfactory operation
A motor power-supply circuit presents certain constraints not normally encountered
in other (common) distribution circuits. These are owing to the particular
characteristics of motors directly connected to the line, such as:
b High start-up current (see Fig. N62) which is mostly reactive, and can therefore be
the cause of important voltage drop
b Number and frequency of start-up operations are generally high
b The high start-up current means that motor overload protective devices must have
operating characteristics which avoid tripping during the starting period.
5.1 Motor control systems
Different kinds of motor control solution are compared in the following tables.
N45
Is / In
Ts / Tn
Speed control
Torque control
Direct on line
5-10
5-10
No
No
Star – Delta
2-3
1-2
No
No
Auto-transformer
2-3
1-2
No
No
Soft starter
3-5
1.5-2.5
No
Yes
Variable speed drive
1.5
1.5-2
Yes
Yes
Pros
Cons
Direct on line
Reduced cost high starting
torque
High in-rush current
Star – Delta
Reduced in-rush current
Reduced starting torque
Auto-tranformer
Reduced in-rush current
High weight
Soft starter
Reduced in-rush current
controlled start and stop
Reduced starting torque
Variable speed drive
Controlled speed Energy saving
at reduced speed
Higher cost
Fig. N63a : Comparison of different motor control solutions
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
In
Asynchronous motors are used in a wide variety of applications. Here are some
examples of driven machines:
v centrifugal pumps,
v fans and blowers,
v compressors,
v crushers,
v conveyors,
v lifts and cranes,
v…
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
5.2 Motor protection functions
These are the arrangements implemented in order to avoid operation of motors in
abnormal conditions which could result in negative events such as: overheating,
premature ageing, destruction of electrical windings, damage to coupling or gear
box, …
Four levels of protection schemes are commonly proposed: "Conventional",
"Advanced", "Advanced Plus", and "High Performance", which can be adopted
depending on the sophistication and power of the driven machine.
v "Conventional" protection functions apply for every type of motor or application,
v "Advanced" protection functions apply to more sophisticated machines requesting
special attention,
v "Advanced Plus", and "High performance" protection functions are justified for
high power motors, high demanding applications, or motors in critical process or
whenever ground current must be measured with high accuracy (~ 0,01A).
As shown in the following figure: “High performance “ protections are not based only
on current but also on voltage
Protection
Conventional
Advanced
Short-circuit / Instantaneous overcurrent
Thermal overload
Phase current imbalance
Phase current loss
Over-current (instantaneous and temporised)
Ground current / Instantaneous earth fault
Long start (stall) / Incomplete sequence
Jam (locked rotor)
Under-current
Phase current reversal
Motor temperature (by sensors)
Rapid cycle lock-out / Locking out
Load shedding
Notching or jogging / Number of starts
Phase voltage imbalance
Phase voltage loss
N46
Phase voltage reversal
Under-voltage
Over-voltage
Under-power
Over-power
Under power factor
Over power factor
Motor reclosing
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Fig. N64 : Classification of protection functions
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Advanced Plus
High
Performance
5 Asynchronous motors
Here is a list of motor protection functions and the result of activation.
Short-circuit: disconnection in case of a short-circuit at the motor terminals or inside
the motor windings.
Thermal overload: disconnection of motor in case of sustained operation with
a torque exceeding the nominal value. Overload is detected by measurement of
excessive stator current or by using PTC probes.
Phase current imbalance: disconnection of the motor in case of high current
imbalance, responsible for increased power losses and overheating.
Phase current loss: disconnection of the motor if one phase current is zero, as this is
revealing of cable or connection breaking.
Over-current: alarm or disconnection of the motor in case of high phase current,
revealing a shaft over-torque.
Ground fault: disconnection in case of a fault between a motor terminal and ground.
Even if the fault current is limited, a fast action could avoid a complete destruction of
the motor. It can be measured with the sum of the 3 phases if the accuracy required is
not high (~ 30%). If high accuracy is required then it must be measured with a ground
CT (0.01A accuracy).
Long start (stall): disconnection in case of a starting time longer than normal (due to
mechanical problem or voltage sag) in order to avoid overheating of the motor.
Jam: disconnection in order to avoid overheating and mechanical stress if motor is
blocked while running because of congestion.
Undercurrent: alarm or disconnection of the motor in case a low current value is
detected, revealing a no-load condition (e.g.: pump drain, cavitation, broken shaft, …)
Phase current reversal: disconnection when a wrong phase current sequence is
detected
Motor temperature (by sensors): alarm or disconnection in case of high temperature
detected by probes.
Rapid cycle lock-out: prevent connection and avoid overheating due to too frequent
start-up.
Load shedding: disconnection of the motor when a voltage drop is detected, in order
to reduce the supply load and return to normal voltage.
Phase voltage imbalance: disconnection of the motor in case of high voltage
imbalance, responsible for increased power losses and overheating.
Phase voltage loss: disconnection of motor if one phase of the supply voltage is
missing. This is necessary in order to avoid a single-phase running of a three-phase
motor, which results in a reduced torque, increased stator current, and inability to start.
Phase voltage reversal: prevent the connection and avoid the reverse rotation of the
motor in case of a wrong cabling of phases to the motor terminals, which could happen
during maintenance for example.
Under-voltage: prevent the connection of the motor or disconnection of the motor, as
a reduced voltage could not ensure a correct operation of the motor.
Over-voltage: prevent the connection of the motor or disconnection of the motor, as
an increased voltage could not ensure a correct operation of the motor.
N47
Under-power: alarm or disconnection of the motor in case of power lower than
normal, as this situation is revealing a pump drain (risk of destruction of the pump) or
broken shaft.
Over-power: alarm or disconnection of the motor in case of power higher than normal,
as this situation is revealing a machine overload.
Under power factor: can be used for detection of low power with motors having a
high no-load current.
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Over power factor: can be used for detection of end of the starting phase.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
The consequence of abnormal overheating is a reduced isolation capacity of
the materials, thus leading to a significant shortening of the motor lifetime. This
is illustrated on Figure N65, and justifies the importance of overload or overtemperature protection.
Lifetime
100%
e
50%
25%
12,5%
Overheating
0 = 25°C
=
In
10 K
=
1,05 In
20 K
=
1,09 In
30 K
=
1,14 In
Fig. N65 : Reduced motor lifetime as a consequence of overheating
Overload relays (thermal or electronic) protect motors against overloads, but they
must allow the temporary overload caused by starting, and must not trip unless the
starting time is abnormally long.
Depending on the application, the motor starting time can vary from a few seconds
(for no-load starting, low resistive torque, etc.) to several tens of seconds (for a high
resistive torque, high inertia of the driven load, etc.). It is therefore necessary to fit
relays appropriate to the starting time.
To meet this requirement, IEC Standard 60947-4-1 defines several classes of
overload relays, each characterized by its tripping curve (see Fig. N65a ).
The relay rating is to be chosen according to the nominal motor current and the
calculated starting time.
Trip class 10 is adapted to normal duty motors.
Trip class 20 is recommended for heavy duty motors
Trip class 30 is necessary for very long motor starting.
N48
t (S)
Class 30
30
Class 20
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
20
Class 10
10
1,05
1,50
1,20
Fig. N65a : Tripping curves of overload relays
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
7,2
I/Ir
5 Asynchronous motors
5.3 Motor monitoring
The objective of implementing measurement devices is to ensure a continuous
supervision of operating conditions of motors. The collected data can be used with
great benefit for improving Energy Efficiency, extending lifetime of motors, or for
programming maintenance operations.
Four levels of sophistication for monitoring scheme are commonly proposed:
"Conventional", "Advanced", "Advanced Plus", and "High Performance", which
can be made accessible, depending on the sophistication and power of the driven
machine and the criticality of the process.
Measurement
Conventional
Advanced
Advanced Plus
High
Performance
Line currents
Ground current
Average current
Phase current imbalance
Thermal capacity level
Motor temperature (by sensors)
Frequency
Phase to phase voltage
Phase voltage imbalance
Average voltage
Active power
Reactive power
Power factor
Active energy
Reactive energy
Fig. N65b : Classification of monitoring functions
Here is a list of the most useful variables to be monitored, and the benefit provided
by the measurement.
Currents: they are directly responsible for the conductors heating and thus for a
possible time life reduction. These are the most important variables to monitor. The
current measurement also gives a direct indication on the motor load and stress
applied to the driven machine.
Average current: to know the average load of the motor, whether the motor is well
adapted to the driven machine or not.
N49
Phase current imbalance: as imbalance is responsible for additional losses in the
motor, phase current imbalance is an important variable to monitor.
Thermal capacity level: knowledge of the remaining overload capability and safety
margin.
Motor temperature (by sensors): knowledge of the real thermal operating
conditions, taking account of motor load, ambient temperature, ventilation efficiency.
Phase to phase voltage: too high or too low phase voltages are responsible of
increased motor current for a given load. Voltage monitoring is thus indicating
whether the motor is operating in normal conditions or not.
Phase voltage imbalance: as imbalance is responsible for additional losses in the
motor, phase voltage imbalance is an important variable to monitor.
Active power: indication of the load level applied to the motor.
Reactive power: indication of the reactive power that could be necessary to
compensate by implementation of capacitors.
Power factor: indication of load level of the motor. If Power Factor is > 1: submit your
candidacy for the Physics Nobel Prize.
Active energy: possibility to relate the consumed energy to the operating time or the
quantity of goods produced by driven machine.
Reactive energy: possibility to determine the necessity of implementation of
capacitors in order to avoid payment of penalties to the Utility.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Fig. N65c : Example of intelligent motor management system
with “Advanced Plus” and "High performance" protection and
monitoring functions (TeSys T Schneider Electric)
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
5.4 Motor starter configurations
Different configurations of switchgear and control-gear are commonly proposed.
Some examples are shown on Figure N66.
Isolator-fuse:
b short-circuit protection,
b isolation for maintenance.
Thermal-magnetic circuit-breaker:
b isolation for maintenance,
b short-circuit protection,
b overload protection.
Contactor:
b on-off switching.
Contactor:
b on-off switching
Magnetic circuit-breaker:
b isolation for maintenance,
b short-cicuit protection.
Contactor :
b on-off switching,
b disconnection in case of fault.
Variable speed drive :
b progressive starting,
b variable speed control,
b motor protection,
b overload protection.
Overload relay:
b overload protection.
M
Motor
M
Motor
M
Motor
Fig. N66 : The various functions and their combinations forming a motor starter
The different applicable standards are listed on Figure N67.
Standard
N50
Title
IEC 60947-1
Low-voltage switchgear and controlgear – General rules
IEC 60947-4-1
Contactors and motor-starters –Electromechanical contactors and motorstarters
IEC 60947-4-2
Contactors and motor-starters – AC semiconductor motor controllers
and starters
IEC 60947-6-2
Multiple function equipment – Control and protective switching devices
(or equipment) (CPS)
IEC 61800
Adjustable speed electrical power drive systems
Fig. N67 : Applicable standards
Different utilization categories have been defined for contactors in IEC 60947-4-1.
The selection relative to asynchronous motor control is given in Figure N68.
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Category
Typical applications
AC-1
Non-inductive or slightly inductive loads, resistance furnaces
AC-2
Slip-ring motors: starting, switching off
AC-3
Squirrel-cage motors: starting, switching off motors during running
AC-4
Squirrel-cage motors: starting, plugging(1), inching(2)
1) By plugging is understood stopping or reversing the motor rapidly by reversing motor primary connections
while the motor is running.
2) By inching (jogging) is understood energizing a motor once or repeatedly for short periods to obtain small
movements of the driven mechanism
Fig. N68 : Different categories of AC contactors used for asynchronous motor control
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
5.5 Protection coordination
Type 1 and Type 2 coordination are defined in IEC 60947-4-1.
Total coordination is offered by some manufacturers.
Coordination
Consequence of a short circuit
Application field
Type 1
The contactor or starter shall cause no danger to
persons and installation and may not be suitable for
further service without repair and replacement of
parts.
General purpose application.
Basic machines.
Type 2
The contactor or starter shall cause no danger to
persons or installation and shall be suitable for
further use. The risk of contact welding is recognized,
in which case the manufacturer shall indicate the
Process with availability constraints, e.g.: continuous
measures to be taken as regards the maintenance of process, critical industrial machines.
the equipment.
Continuity of service (total
coordination)
No damage or maladjustment is permissible.
Must be able to restart immediately after fault is
corrected No special precaution is required.
Fig. N69 : Level of acceptable destruction according to the coordination types
5.6 Basic protection scheme: circuit-breaker +
contactor + thermal relay
The combination of these devices facilitates installation work, as well as operation
and maintenance, by:
b The reduction of the maintenance work load: the circuit-breaker avoids the need to
replace blown fuses and the necessity of maintaining a stock (of different sizes and
types)
b Better continuity performance: the installation can be re-energized immediately
following the elimination of a fault and after checking of the starter
b Additional complementary devices sometimes required on a motor circuit are
easily accommodated
b Tripping of all three phases is assured (thereby avoiding the possibility of “single
phasing”)
b Full load current switching possibility (by circuit-breaker) in the event of contactor
failure, e.g. contact welding
b Interlocking
b Diverse remote indications
b Better protection for the starter in case of over-current and in particular for
impedant short-circuit (2) corresponding to currents up to about 30 times In of motor
(see Fig. N67)
b Possibility of adding RCD:
v Prevention of risk of fire (sensitivity 500 mA)
v Protection against destruction of the motor (short-circuit of laminations) by the
early detection of earth fault currents (sensitivity 300 mA to 30 A).
(1) The combination of a contactor with a thermal relay is
commonly referred to as a «discontactor».
(2) In the majority of cases, short circuit faults occur at the
motor, so that the current is limited by the cable and the wiring
of starter and are called impedant short-circuits.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N51
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Among the many possible methods of
protecting a motor, the association of a
circuit breaker + contactor + thermal relay (1)
provides many advantages
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
t
1.05 to 1.20 In
Circuit
breaker
Magnetic
relay
Operating curve
of thermal relay
End of
start-up
period
Contactor
Thermal
relay
Cable thermal withstand limit
1 to
10 s
Limit of thermal relay constraint
Cable
Motor
Short circuit current breaking capacity
of the association (CB + contactor)
Operating curve of the
MA type circuit breaker
20 to
30 ms
In
Is
I" magn.
I
Short circuit current breaking capacity
of the CB
Fig. N70 : Tripping characteristics of a circuit-breaker + contactor + thermal relay
The combination of a circuit-breaker + contactor + thermal relay for the control and
protection of motor circuits is eminently appropriate when:
b The maintenance service for an installation is reduced, which is generally the case
in tertiary and small and medium sized industrial sites
b The job specification calls for complementary functions
b There is an operational requirement for a load breaking facility in the event of need
of maintenance.
5.7 Control and protection switching gear (CPS)
CPS or “starter-controllers” are designed to fulfil control and protection functions
simultaneously (overload and short-circuit). In addition, they are designed to carry
out control operations in the event of short-circuit.
They can also assure additional functions such as insulation, thereby totally fulfilling
the function of “motor starter unit”. They comply with standard IEC 60947-6-2,
which notably defines the assigned values and utilisation categories of a CPS, as
do standards IEC 60947-1 and 60947-4-1.The functions performed by a CPS are
combined and coordinated in such a way as to allow for uptime at all currents up
to the Ics working short circuit breaking capacity of the CPS. The CPS may or may
not consist of one device, but its characteristics are assigned as for a single device.
Furthermore, the guarantee of “total” coordination of all the functions ensures the
user has a simple choice with optimal protection which is easy to implement.
Although presented as a single unit, a CPS can offer identical or greater modularity
than the “three product” motor starter unit solution. This is the case with the
Schneider Electric “TeSys U” starter-controller (see Figure N71).
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
N52
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
Fig. N71 : Example of a CPS modularity (TeSys U starter controller by Schneider Electric)
Additional functionalities can also be installed with regard to:
b Power: reversing block, current limiter,
b Control:
v Function modules, alarms, motor load monitoring, automatic resetting, etc,
v Communication options such as Modbus-RTU (a.k.a. SL),, Profibus-DP,
DeviceNet, CAN-Open, AS-I, etc,
v Auxiliary contact modules.
Available functions
Standard
Advanced
Multi-function
Starter status (ready, running, with default)
Start and Stop controls
Thermal alarm
Remote resetting by bus
Indication of motor load
N53
Defaults differentiation
Alarms (overcurrents…)
Parameter setting and protection function reference
“Log file” function
“Monitoring” function
Information conveyed by bus and functions performed
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Fig. N72 : TeSys U Communication functions
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
5.8 Intelligent Power and Motor Control Centre
(iPMCC)
iPMCC is a system integrating intelligent Motor Protection Relays (IMPR) in a
highly dependable Power and Motor Control Centre switchboard. Connectivity to the
supervision and control system is provided through an industrial communications
network.
This solution is particularly used in large industrial sites and infrastructures, with
continuous or hybrid process, and whenever continuity of service is a priority.
intelligent Motor Protection Relay (IMPR)
IMPR is the key component of an iPMCC. It is a microprocessor controlled device.
Motor monitoring and protection is performed based on measurements from sensors,
such as current transformers, voltage transformers (embedded or external), thermal
sensor, earth leakage detector, … From these measurements and the settings, it
determines fault conditions or potential risks for motors and operators.
According to the motor protection model, an IMPR has the capability to detect
many kinds of faults. It is a great improvement compared to thermal relay protection.
Moreover, many complementary functions can be implemented by an IMPR:
monitoring, alarming, fault recording, statistics, communications, etc…
3
5
6
7
N54
2
1
4
1: Tesys T motor protection relay with native communications capability. The
protections are based on current and temperature.
2: Tesys T extension module integrating voltage measurement and protections.
4: Tesys T’s emdedded CT can measure the earth leakage current of 20%-500% of
FLC (full load current). External CT can be used to get a better accuracy (0.02-10A).
5, 6, 7: Different kinds of Human Machine Interfaces (1-to-1, 1-to-8, and 1-to-Many).
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Fig. N73: Example of motor control and protection architecture
Motor Control Centre
A Motor Control Centre (MCC) is an electrical switchboard which groups all motor
starters of a process, in order to build a centralised installation. Motor starters
management centralisation is requested in many industries and infrastructures, in
order to facilitate operation and maintenance. Withdrawable MCC functional units
(FU), a.k.a. drawers, are used in critical applications, as they are more convenient
to manage in case of fault. The faulty motor starter can be replaced quickly, without
shutting down the whole switchboard.
Fixed or disconnectable FUs can be used in less critical applications.
MCC-type ASSEMBLIES must be full-compliant to IEC 61439-1 and 614392 standards to guarantee availability, safety and reliability of the application. In
an iPMCC configuration, design verification, especially temperature rise test, is
essential because the IMPR (electronic device) is sensitive to heat. Furthermore,
MCC should provide a dependable and reliable communication bus connection
An MCC is different from a universal cabinet in the way that a universal cabinet can
only be used to accommodate a group of few motor starters. It has lower electrical
characteristics requirements, and it does not provide the separation between motor
starters in different functional units. Therefore, in an universal cabinet complete
shutdown will be necessary before maintenance operations or any reconfiguration of
the starters.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
LTME
3M drawer
LTMR
6M drawer
Fig. N74 : Example of iPMCC: Okken switchboard and drawers by Schneider Electric
Compared to traditional solutions, an iPMCC offers great advantages in both the
project design and execution stage as well as at the operations stage.
Value proposition for contractors during the project stage:
b It improves project efficiency
v Reduction of engineering work, as starters are more standardised over a wider
range of ratings,
v Reduction of on-site wiring time thanks to the use of field buses,
v Reduction of set-up time thanks to remote parametrization of control motor
devices.
b It reduces commissioning time by
v Allowing a better understanding of the process reactions thanks to detailed
diagnostics and statistics,
v Allowing faster error fixing and bug tracking,
v Helping to fix process start-up problems,
v Allowing time reduction thanks to pre-validated solutions (reference architectures).
Value proposition for end users during the operation stage:
b Improved Continuity of Service
v Increase process availability by better PROTECTING the motors & the loads,
- Using more accurate sensors,
- Using more accurate motor protection models.
b Reduced untimely DOWNTIME
v Alarms often give time to fix the problem before tripping occurs,
v Trip conditions are detailed to help corrective operations,
N55
v Statistics can be used for continuous improvement,
v Recording all protection parameters changes.
b Reduced Operational Costs
v Reduced ENERGY costs,
- Reduced energy consumption,
- Optimised energy consumption, benchmarking, costs allocation.
b Reduced MAINTENANCE costs
v Less downtime,
v Less spare parts stock,
v Preventive maintenance strategy.
b Reduced EVOLUTION costs and time
v Simplified engineering,
v No wiring required,
v Simplified set-up,
v Easier process tuning and commissioning.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
v Faster problem fixing,
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
A complete iPMCC concentrates the knowledge and experience of electrical
distribution, motor protection and control, automation and installation. This is why
only a few leading companies in electrical distribution and automation can propose
this kind of solution.
5.9 Communication
Lots of data are managed in an iPMCC application. An iPMCC application is typically
made of 50 to 1000 motor starters. In order to supervise the system, it is necessary
to send the motors’s information such as motor status, current value, alarm, etc. The
traditional wire-to-wire connection is not an efficient and cost-effective way when
there is a lot of data to be transmitted. Today, communications via a network is the
preferred way.
The communications need the support of a common language, which is the
communications protocol. The following chart shows the protocols most commonly
used in different levels of industrial communications networks. At the moment, the
most popular device bus protocols are Ethernet TCP/IP, Modbus-RTU, Profibus-DP
and DeviceNet.
Profibus-DP
DeviceNet
Profibus-PA
ASI
Sensor bus
CANopen
Device bus
Modbus-RTU
Control network
Ethernet
Information network
Fig. N75 : Different communication protocols
Modbus
Modbus is a message handling structure introduced by Modicon in 1979. Modbus
is an application level protocol based on the OSI model. It is independent of the
physical layer.
MODBUS APPLICATION LAYER
N56
Modbus on TCP
TCP
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
IP
Modbus+ / HDLC
Other
Fig. N76 : Modbus architecture
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
Modbus-RTU (a.k.a SL - Serial Line)
Modbus can be implemented on RS232, RS442 or RS485 links as well as other
media like Ethernet. Modbus RS485 has been the most common protocol in the
world. It supports communications speed up to 115kbps, but most devices support
only communication up to 19.2 kbps.
Modbus RS485 is a low cost communication implementation, and it has the largest
installation base and supplier network. The weak point of Modbus is the transmission
speed (since it is limited by serial line speeds) and the relatively small number of
devices that can be connected to one network. However, Modbus-RTU is still an
economical and reasonable choice to the majority of motor protection systems.
Modbus is based on a Master/Slave concept. One device is the master and sends
requests to read or write data to each slave in turn. Slaves answer to requests from
the Master. Even though you can have many devices connected to one serial line
only one device can talk at a time.
Communication may
only be initialized by
the Master
Master
Request
Response
1 to 247 slaves
Fig. N77 : Modbus-RTU architecture
Modbus/TCP
Modbus/TCP is an excellent choice for large sites applications. Modbus/TCP uses
the standard 100 Mbps Ethernet media in physical layers to carry the Modbus
message handling structure. It offers very fast speed and big number of devices in
one network; it is easier to integrate MCC into the Local Area Network (LAN) of a
company, so it is the choice of more and more customers.
Unlike Modbus-RTU, Modbus/TCP works on a Client/Server concept:
b A client initiates the requests and a server answers,
b Any device can be a client or a server,
b Many devices are both client and server at the same time,
b A network can consist of many clients.
N57
Client
Server
Function code
Initiate request
Data request
Perform the action initiate the response
Data response
Fig. N77a : Modbus/TCP architecture
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
Function code
Receive the response
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
Many clients can send requests at the same time and many servers can answer at
the same time:
b A client can talk to multiple servers at the same time,
b A server can answer to multiple clients at the same time,
b Ethernet switches take care of packet delivery to all a devices at the same time.
Fig. N78 : Typical communications architecture
Differences between Modbus/TCP and Modbus-RTU:
b Devices can be a client and a server at the same time.
b Everyone can talk at the same time: multiple devices can initiate communications,
not just one. Increases system response time by parallel communications.
b Multiple requests can be sent from one device to another without waiting for the
first request to be answered. A new piece of data is added to the Modbus frame
called the Modbus Transaction identifier to allow a response to be matched to a
specific request.
N58
b The Transmission speed is much increased:10Mb, 100Mb, 1Gb etc.
b The transmission media is much more flexible and costs are lower: fibre, radio etc.
b The number of nodes on a single network is almost unlimited: maximum
recommended is around 200, but routers can be used to join several networks.
b Gateways/Proxies allow transparent communications between Ethernet Modbus/
TCP and Modbus-RTU devices.
Modbus I/O Scanning
Modbus I/O Scanning is a feature in Schneider Electric Programmable Logic
Controllers (PLC) which allows simple Modbus transactions with a simple setup
screen. It is only requested to set the address, poll time and data to read and/or
write.
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
After configuration the communications system manages automatically all Modbus
exchanges with scanned devices.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Asynchronous motors
I/O scanning
Read and write MODBUS
Scanned
devices
I/O scanner manager
Gateway
IN
Sends
request
Device application
I/O data
Sends response
Fig. N79 : I/O Scanning architecture
Profibus
Profibus (PROcess Filed BUS) is a protocol introduced by a fieldbus working group
in 1987. It is supported by PI (Profibus & Profinet International).
Profibus-DP is the version of Profibus used at device level. It has been a
successful protocol in the last decades, especially in Europe. Profibus-DP. It
supports communications up to 12 Mbps it, but actually 1.5 Mbps is the most
practical maximum value in applications. In order to achieve a transmission speed
up to 12 Mbps it requires additional constraints such as the suppression of bus’
derivations.
The network topology is a bus. The number of devices in a bus is limited. The use
of specific repeaters may be required in order to achieve the theoretical maximum
number.
DeviceNet
DeviceNet is a protocol based on CAN, which is a protocol widely used in the
automotive industry. ODVA (Open DeviceNet Vendor Association) takes now the
responsibility to promote and provide technical support to DeviceNet specification.
ODVA is an international association comprised of members from the world's
leading automation companies. Collectively, ODVA and its members support network
technologies using the Common Industrial Protocol (CIP™). These currently include
DeviceNet™, EtherNet/IP™, CompoNet™ and the major extensions to CIP — CIP
Safety™, CIP Sync™, and CIP Motion™. ODVA manages the development of these
open technologies and assists manufacturers and users of CIP Networks through
tools, training and marketing activities.
N59
The network topology is a bus. The number of devices in a bus is limited.
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
DeviceNet provides communication with 3 possible speeds: 125, 250 or 500 kbps,
which depends on the bus length and cable as well as product consumption. The
maximum number of devices is 64, including master devices. The bus length is
limited to 100m at 500 kbps.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
N - Characteristics of particular sources and loads
5 Asynchronous motors
Synthetic view
The following table shows a short (non-exhaustive) comparison of these protocols:
Profibus-DP
DeviceNet
Ethernet Modbus TCP/IP
Speed
up to 115 Kbps
Modbus RTU
9.6 Kbps to 12 Mbps
125, 250 or 500 kbps
10 / 100 Mbps / 1 Gbps
Max. distance without
repeaters
1300 m
100 m at 12 Mbps
1.2 km at 10 kbps
100 m at 500 kbps
500 m at 125 kbps
Twisted pair: 100 m
Optical fibre:
. 2000 m (multi-mode)
. >2 km (mono-mode)
Max. number of devices
32 without repeater:
1 master and 247 slaves
126: mono or multi-masters, 122
slaves max with 3 repeaters
64: 1 master and 63 slaves
128 with I/O scanning; no limit
with others
400 to 4800 m according to
speed
Depends on the type of
repeater
10 km optical fibre
Max. distance with repeaters Depends on the type of
repeater
Fig. N80 : Comparison of communications protocols
© Schneider Electric - tous droits réservés
N60
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapitre P
Photovoltaic installations
Contents
2
3
4
5
Benefits of photovoltaic energy
P2
1.1 Practical benefits
P2
1.2 Environmental benefits
P2
Background and technology
P3
2.1 The photovoltaic effect
P3
2.2 Photovoltaic modules
P4
2.3 Inverters
P6
2.4 Connections
P7
2.5 Battery chargers
P7
2.6 Off grid or grid connected
P8
PV System and Installation Rules
P10
3.1 How to ensure safety during normal operation?
P10
3.2 Protection against overvoltage: Surge protection
P13
3.3 How to ensure safety during maintenance or emergency
P15
3.4 How to ensure safety during all the life cycle of the installation
P17
PV installation architectures
P18
4.1 Common characteristics of PV architectures
P18
4.2 Architectures for installations connected to the grid
P19
4.3 Sizing
P21
4.4 Installation type
P22
4.5 Electrical equipments selection
P23
Monitoring
P31
5.1 Types of monitoring systems
P31
5.2 Monitoring systems
P31
5.3 Sensors
P33
5.4 Security of the installation
P33
P1
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
1
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
1 Benefits of photovoltaic energy
1.1 Practical benefits
This technology enables to produce electricity directly from the sun light, which is a
source of renewable energy. There are two ways for this:
b Solar Thermal Energy is captured through an exchange between a circulating fluid
exposed to the sun and a load circuit (accumulation tank or heat pump).
b Solar photovoltaic Energy is produced using the principle of the photovoltaic cell
discovered by Edmond Becquerel in 1839.
It is particularly beneficial to use solar radiation reaching the Earth since:
b This radiation remains stable (to within 10%) on average from one year to the next;
b At ground level, it supplies an average of 1000 Wh/m² per day although this
depends on the following principal criteria:
v The latitude
v The angle of the surface and the direction faced
v The degree of pollution
v The time of year
v The thickness of the cloud layer
v The time of day
v The shade
The global horizontal irradiation, which is the amount of energy received yearly on a
plane varies from 700 kWh/m² per year in the North of Europe to 2500 kWh/m² per
year in African desert areas.
1.2 Environmental benefits
Using solar energy allows to reduce the consumption of “fossil” fuels which are the
likely cause of global warming and atmospheric pollution.
It contributes to sustainable development and is also in accordance with the policies
of the European Union, which passed a decree in March 2007 setting the following
targets to be met by 2020:
b Reduction of greenhouse emissions by 20%
b Reduction of energy consumption by 20%
b 20% renewable energy as a proportion of total energy consumption
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
2 Background and technology
2.1 The photovoltaic effect
This is the ability to transform solar energy into electricity and is achieved by using
photovoltaic (PV) cells.
A PV cell (see Fig. P1) is capable of generating voltage of between 0.5 V and 2 V
depending on the materials used and a current directly dependent on the surface
area (5 or 6 inch cells).
Its characteristics are shown in a current/voltage graph as shown in Figure 2.
Amperes
4
2
0
0,0
Fig. P1 : Photovoltaic cell manufactured in a silicon plate
(source: Photowatt)
0,2
0,4
0,6
0,8
Volts
Fig. P2 : Typical characteristic of a photovoltaic cell
The photovoltaic effect is dependent on two physical values (see Fig. P3)
– irradiance and temperature:
b As irradiance E (Wm²) increases, so do the current and power produced by the cell
b As the temperature (T°) of the cell increases, the output voltage decreases
significantly, the current increases only slightly, so overall the output power
decreases. In order to compare the performance of different cells, the standard has
set out Standard Test Conditions (STC) for irradiance of 1000 W/m² at 25°C.
Current
Current
1000 Wm2
MPP
800 Wm2
600 Wm2
75 °C
MPP
50 °C
400 Wm2
25 °C
2
200 Wm
0 °C
Voltage
An increase in solar radiation
increases the power generated by the cell
Voltage
P3
An increase in temperature
decreases the power generated by the cell
MPP : Maximum Power Point
To make it easier to use energy generated by photovoltaic cells, manufacturers offer
serial and/or parallel combinations grouped into panels or modules.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P3 : Irradiance and temperature influence the photovoltaic effect
P - Photovoltaic installations
2.2 Photovoltaic modules
These combinations of cells (see Fig. P4) enable the voltage and current to be
increased. To optimise the characteristics of the modules, these are made up of cells
with similar electrical characteristics.
Each module providing a voltage of several tens of volts is classified by its power
level measured in Watt peak (Wp). This relates to the power produced by a surface
area of one m² exposed to irradiation of 1000 W/m² at 25°C. However, identical
modules may produce different levels of power. Currently, the IEC standard specifies
a power variation of is ±3% (see table in Figure P5). Modules with typical power of
160 Wp include all modules with power of between 155 Wp (160 -3%) and 165 Wp
(160 +3%).
It is therefore necessary to compare their efficiency which is calculated by dividing
their power (W/m²) by 1000 W/m².
For example, for a module of 160 Wp with a surface area of 1.338m² (*), the peak
power is 160/1.338 which gives 120 Wp/m².
Therefore the efficiency of this module is: 120/1000 = 12%.
Fig. P4 : PW1400 photovoltaic module dimensions:
1237 x 1082 x 45 mm (source: Photowatt)
Nota: Manufacturers may have different production tolerance limits according to local
standards or habits (example: JISC8918 specifies ±10%), so it is recommended to
always check product catalogues for actual tolerance values.
Encapsulation
Glass/Tedlar
Cell size
125.50 x 125.5 mm
Number of cells
72
Voltage
24 V
Number of bypass diodes
4 bypass diodes
Typical power
150 Wp
160 Wp
170 Wp
Minimum power
145 Wp
155 Wp
165 Wp
Voltage at typical power
33.8 V
34.1 V
34.7 V
Current at typical power
4.45 A
4.7 A
4.9 A
Short circuit current
4.65 A
4.8 A
5.0 A
Open wire voltage
43 V
43.2 V
43.4 V
Maximum circuit voltage
1 000 V CC
Temperature coefficient
Power specifications at
= (dl/l)/dt # + 0.032 %/°C
= dV/dt # - 158 mV/°C
P/P = - 0.43 %/°C
1000 W/m²: 25°C: AM 1.5
Fig. P5 : Electrical characteristics of a PW1400 module (source: Photowatt)
However when photovoltaic cells are connected in series, a destructive phenomenon
known as the “hot spot” may occur if one of the cells is partially shaded. This cell
will operate as a receiver and the current passing through it may destroy it. To avoid
this risk, manufacturers include bypass diodes which bypass damaged cells. Bypass
diodes are usually fitted in the junction box behind the module and enable 18 to 22
cells to be shunted depending on the manufacturer.
P4
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
A faulty module within a string must be
replaced by an identical module and therefore
it is important to choose a supplier which is
likely to be in business in the long-term.
These modules are then connected in series to achieve the level of voltage required,
forming chains of modules or “strings”. Then the strings are arranged in parallel to
achieve the required level of power, thus forming a PV array.
Since there are increasing numbers of PV module manufacturers throughout
the world, it is important to consider the various options carefully when choosing
equipment. Installers should also:
b Ensure the compatibility of the electrical characteristics with the rest of the
installation (inverter input voltage).
b Ensure that they are compliant with the standards.
b Select suppliers likely to be in business in the long-term to ensure that faulty
modules can be replaced as these must be identical to those already installed.
This final point is important as installers are responsible for the warranty granted to
their clients.
(*) The dimensions of these modules (L x W x D) in mm are:
1237 x 1082 x 38.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Background and technology
Different technologies are currently being used to manufacture photovoltaic
generators. These are divided into two categories - crystalline modules and thin film
modules.
Crystalline silicon modules
There are two main categories of crystalline silicon modules – mono-crystalline
modules and multi-crystalline modules.
Mono-crystalline modules are currently best in terms of performance, with efficiency
of 16 – 18%. They are also more expensive.
The efficiency of multi-crystalline modules is between 12 and 14%. They are more
commonly used, especially in the residential and service sectors.
These modules have a service life of more than 20 years. They lose some of their
power over time (< 1% per year) but continue to produce electricity. Depending on
the look required, bi-glass modules are available with two plates of glass which
make the module semi-transparent, or Tedlar or Teflon glass modules which are less
expensive but completely opaque.
Thin film modules
Extensive research is currently being carried out on thin film modules and current
efficiency levels of 6 to 8% should increase in coming years. They are cheap and
suitable for large areas provided that the surface is not a valuable part of the facility.
This category of thin film modules includes a number of technologies of which there
are 3 main types:
b a-Si – thin film or amorphous silicon
b CdTe (cadmium telluride)
b CIS (copper indium selenide)
It should be noted that at present we do not yet have 20 years’ experience of this
type of technology and thus still do not know how these modules will age.
In their technical specifications, reputable manufacturers indicate initial and stabilised
values.
The table in Figure P6 provides a comparative overview of all these technologies.
Technologies
sc-Si
mc-Si
mono-crystalline multi-crystalline
a-Si
Thin film
CdTe
Thin film
CIS
Thin film
Maximum
20.4 %
16 %
10 %
14.4 %
15.5 %
Average
16 %
15 %
6%
11 %
11 %
Relative cost ($/Wp)
0.8 to 1
0.8 to 1
0.75
0.65
0.85
Temperature coefficient at
the power peak (%/°C)
-0.3 / -0.5
-0.3 / -0.5
-0.2
-0.2
-0.3
STC module efficiency
Fig. P6 : Comparison of technologies used in photovoltaic generators
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P5
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
2.3 Inverters
These devices which convert direct current into alternating current are special
inverters for photovoltaic power supply (see Fig. P7a). Different types of photovoltaic
inverters or “PV inverters” are available. They fulfil three main functions:
b Inverter function: Converts direct current into alternating current in the form
required (sinusoidal, square, etc.)
b MPPT function: Calculates the operating point on the photovoltaic surface or array
which produces the most power in terms of voltage and current - also known as the
Maximum Power Point Tracker (see Fig. P7b).
b Automatic disconnection from the network function: Automatically commands the
inverter to switch off and the system to disconnect from the network in the absence
of voltage on the electrical network. This protects the inverter and any maintenance
staff who may be working on the network.
Fig. P7a : Conext Core XC inverter specially designed for
photovoltaic power supply (Source: Schneider Electric)
Therefore, in the event of a network failure, the inverter no longer supplies energy
to the network and energy produced by the photovoltaic modules is wasted. “Grid
interactive” systems are nevertheless available which function in back-up mode.
Batteries need to be installed for these systems as well as an additional control
panel to ensure that the network is disconnected before supplying their own energy.
b Different models
Some “multi-MPPT” inverters have a double (or triple, quadruple, etc.) MPPT
function. This function enables PV supply to be optimised when the array includes
strings facing in different directions. There is however a risk of total loss of supply if
one inverter is faulty.
Nevertheless, it is possible to install one less powerful inverter per string, which is a
more expensive solution but increases the overall reliability of the system.
“Multi-string inverters” are also available. These inverters are not necessarily multiMPPT as described above. The name simply indicates that several strings can be
connected to the inverter and that they are paralleled inside the inverter.
180,00
6,00
160,00
Isc 5,00
Impp
140,00
4,00
120,00
100,00
3,00
2,00
Maximum
power point
80,00
60,00
40,00
1,00
20,00
0,00
P6
0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36 39 42 45
Vmpp
Voc
Isc : Module’s short circuit current
Voc : Module’s open wire voltage
0,00
P (V)
I (A)
Fig. P7b : Operating point of a photovoltaic array which produces the most power, also known as
the Maximum Power Point Tracker
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
European efficiency
In order to compare the various appliances, a level of efficiency has been determined
based on different operating points, simulating the average daily performance of an
inverter. This “European efficiency” is calculated using the following formula:
0.03 x ( 5%) + 0.06 x ( 10%) + 0.13 x ( 20%) + 0.1 x ( 30%) + 0.48 x ( 50%) +
0.2 x ( 100%)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Background and technology
IP and operating temperature
Ingress protection and temperature parameters are important when choosing an
inverter.
Almost all manufacturers of inverters offer IP65 inverters which can be installed
outdoors. However, this does not mean that they should be installed in full sunlight
as most inverters operate in degraded mode in temperatures over 40°C (50°C for
Xantrex inverters manufactured by Schneider Electric) and thus output power is
reduced.
Installing inverters outdoors in full sunlight also incurs the risk of premature aging
of some of the inverter’s components such as the chemical condensers. This
considerably reduces the inverter’s service life from 10 years to as few as 5 years!
2.4 Connections
Photovoltaic installations require special cables and connectors. Since modules are
installed outdoors they are subjected to climatic constraints associated with high
voltages caused by the installation of modules in series.
Besides being ingress protected, the equipment used must also be resistant to UV
rays and ozone. It must furthermore display a high level of mechanical resistance
and a high level of resistance to extreme variations in temperature.
Cables
The voltage drop between the PV array and the inverter must be calculated and this
must not exceed 3% for nominal current (UTE recommendation: 1%).
The DC cables used should be double-insulated single wire cables and since these
are not standardised, cables indicated by the manufacturer as being specifically for
PV should be used.
Connectors
In general, photovoltaic modules are supplied with two cables equipped with one
male and one female connector. Using these cables, it is possible to connect two
modules installed side by side, thus creating a series without any difficulties. The
male connector connects to the female connector of the following module and so on
until the required level of direct current is attained.
These special connectors including the Multi-Contact MC3 or MC4 with locking
systems offer protection if touched while they are disconnected. This protection
is necessary since as soon as a photovoltaic module is exposed to irradiation, it
supplies voltage. If the cables connecting the modules are handled (to alter or extend
them) they must either first be disconnected or the DC isolator for the DC circuit must
be activated at the input to the connection box.
It is also possible to use different connectors available on the market. These should
be chosen carefully for their quality, contact and male-female mating to avoid any
poor contact which may lead to overheating and destruction
2.5 Battery chargers
In remote locations, batteries need to be charged to supply energy after sunset.
There are two types of chargers:
b Current chargers – the voltage of the PV array must be the same as the charge
voltage of the battery and is regulated in terms of current.
b MPPT chargers – these chargers operate at the maximum power point. They
manage the charge of the battery, limit the current and voltage, and control floating.
This type of charger is more expensive than the type mentioned above but allows
an optimal number of PV modules to be installed and reduces the overall cost of the
installation.
P7
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
We strongly advise against installing an
inverter in a place exposed to the sun as this
will considerably reduce its service life.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
2.6 Off grid or grid connected
2.6.1 Off grid installation
Historically, these were the first places in which photovoltaic systems were used,
supplying telecommunication relay stations or remote settlements which were difficult
to access and could not be connected to the network.
They remain one of the only means of supplying electricity to 2 billion people who
currently do not have access to it.
In order to size these installations correctly, it is first necessary to identify the load
curve required and the number of days where the installation will not be exposed to
sunlight in order to identify how much energy needs to be stored in the batteries. This
information is used to determine the size and type of batteries required.
Then, the surface area of the photovoltaic sensors must be calculated to ensure that
the batteries can be recharged in the worst case scenario (shortest day of the year).
Specific issues
This method entails over-sizing the system to ensure continuity once or twice a year.
As a result, this type of installation is very expensive!
It should be noted that according to the EPIA (European Photovoltaic Industry
Association) this type of installation will account for 20% of the photovoltaic market in
2012 and 40% in 2030.
Storage
Storage is crucial to this type of installation. Several types of batteries are available:
b Lead batteries
These batteries operate in cycles (charge/discharge). Open batteries are
recommended to prevent inflating which may occur due to excessively rapid charging
and large emissions of hydrogen.
Their purchase price is certainly their main advantage although they have short
service lives. This is influenced by the depth of discharging but they last no more
than 2 or 3 years at a discharging rate of 50% and above. Furthermore, deep
discharging may “kill” the battery. Therefore, when operating such equipment at a
remote site, the batteries should be changed on a regular basis to maintain their
charging performance.
b Ni-Cd or Nickel Cadmium batteries
These batteries have the advantage of being much less sensitive to extreme
temperature conditions and deep charging or discharging. They have a much longer
service life (5 to 8 years) but are more expensive to purchase. However, the cost
of the Wh stored over the service life of the installation is lower than that of lead
batteries.
b Li-ion batteries
These are the batteries of the future for these types of operations. They are
insensitive to deep discharging and have a service life of up to 20 years. At present,
they are prohibitively expensive but prices are set to fall by 2012 with the start of
mass production. They will therefore become the most economic variety for this type
of usage.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P8
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Background and technology
2.6.2 Grid Connected installation
Owners of power generation systems connected to the grid have 2 options:
b Sell all the power they produce (option known as “total sale”). For this option, a
separate connection must be established to the network, apart from the connection
for consumption. This also requires an administrative declaration.
b Use the power they produce locally as required and only sell the excess (option
known as “sale of excess”) which has two benefits:
v The difference in the rates payable by the producer (purchase) and the consumer
(sale)
v It is not necessary to establish a new connection which may be expensive and
requires an administrative declaration.
Since different rates are charged, a profitability analysis should be carried out to
choose the best option.
Installations connected to the grid – 3 important points
The following points are important to note with regard to installations connected to
the network:
b In contrast to independent installations, no correlation is required between
consumption for the building and output.
For the “total sale” option, the two elements are completely independent.
For the “sale of excess” option, the network will compensate when production does
not cover consumption.
b The network must be present in order to supply and sell energy. Furthermore,
energy distributors require automatic disconnection systems to be in place in
case of incidents on the network. When activated, these stop supply and therefore
sales. Reconnection occurs automatically when the network returns to its nominal
operating conditions.
b As a general rule, no provision is made for local storage using batteries or other
means. This is true for mainland France where there is a high quality network with
the capacity to absorb all the energy produced.
However, the system does have one fault. If the network fails, owners of installations
who are also generally consumers are left with a power generation facility which
they cannot use (see previous point). In countries or towns with frequent network
incidents, systems are being developed which include batteries.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P9
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
3 PV System and Installation
Rules
IEC standard 60364 Part 712 sets out rules for ensuring that solar photovoltaic
power systems are safe and supplies a number of the definitions used in this pages
3.1 How to ensure safety during normal operation?
Two particular characteristics of PV generators are their DC voltage levels and the
fact they cannot be shut off as long as PV modules are exposed to the sun. The
short-circuit current produced by the PV module is too low to trigger the power
supply’s automatic disconnect. The most frequently used protective measures do
not therefore apply to PV systems. However, as PV modules are installed outdoors
they are exposed to the elements. And since they can be installed on roofs, critical
attention should be paid to the risk of fire and the protection of fire fighters and
emergency services staff.
3.1.1 Protecting people against electric shock
Paragraph 412.1.1 of IEC 60364 states:
Double or reinforced insulation is a protective
measure in which
b basic protection is provided by basic
insulation, and fault protection is provided by
supplementary insulation, or
b basic and fault protection is provided by
reinforced insulation between live parts and
accessible parts.
NB: This protective measure is intended to
prevent the appearance of dangerous voltage
on the accessible parts of electrical equipment
through a fault in the basic insulation.
IEC 60364-712 stipulates that PV systems whose maximum UOC MAX is higher
than 120V DC should use « double or reinforced insulation » as a protection against
electric shock.
Switchgear, such as fuses or circuit-breakers on the DC side, do not afford protection
against electric shock as there is no automatic disconnect of the power supply.
Overcurrent protection, when used, protects PV cells against reverse current and
cables against overload.
3.1.2 Risk of fire: protection against thermal effects
Generally speaking there are three situations that can lead to abnormally high
temperatures and the risk of fire in a PV system: insulation fault, a reverse current in
a PV module, and overloading cables or equipment.
Insulation fault detection
Double or reinforced insulation is a protective measure against electric shock but
it does not exclude all risk of insulation fault. (The assumption here is that the
likelihood of an insulation fault and of someone touching an energised part of the
installation at the same is very low. Insulation faults in themselves do happen more
frequently, however.) DC insulation fault could be more dangerous as arc has less
chance to extinguish by itself as it does in AC.
The PV generator should be checked to ensure it is insulated from earth.
b When there is no galvanic insulation between the AC side and the DC side:
v It is impossible to earth one pole.
v AC protection can be used to detect insulation faults.
b When the AC side and DC side are galvanically separated:
v An overcurrent protective device (which also detects insulation faults) should be
used to trip the grounded conductor in the event of a fault, if the PV cell technology
(e.g. thin films of amorphous silicon) requires one of the
conductors to be directly grounded.
v An insulation monitoring device should be used if the PV cell technology requires
one of the conductors to be resistance-grounded.
v An insulation monitoring device should also be used when PV cell technology
does not require either conductor to be earthed.
Insulation monitoring device shall be selected taking into consideration both UOC MAX
and the capacitance between poles and earth causes leakage current. In addition
cables and inverter capacitance should be also considered. An Insulation monitoring
device able to handle capacitance up to 500F is suitable for PV system.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
When an insulation fault is detected whatever
the solution is, inverter is stopped and
disconnected from AC side, but the fault is still
present on DC side and voltage between poles
is open circuit voltage of PV generator as long
as sun is shining.
This situation cannot be tolerated over a
long period and the fault has to be found and
cleared. If not, a second fault may develop on
the other pole, causing the current to circulate
P10 in the earthing conductors and metal parts
of the PV installation with no guarantee that
protective devices will operate properly. See
“Overcurrent protection”.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 PV System and Installation
Rules
The literature provided by manufacturers of photovoltaic modules yield the following
figures:
Maximum power usually
developed with a single
inverter
Surface necessary to
develop such a Power
Usual capacitance by m2
Usual capacitance between
lines and earth for a single
IT system
Frameless glass-glass
module with aluminium
frame on an assembly stand
(open air)
1 MW
8000 m2
1 nF / m2
8 µF
In-roof glass-glass module
with aluminium frame
100 kW
800 m2
5 nF / m2
4 µF
Thin-film PV module on
flexible substrate
100 kW
800 m2
50 nF / m2
40 µF
Some measurements made in European plants are giving the following figures:
Maximum power
developed with a
single inverter
Surface necessary
to develop such a
Power
Lowest capacitance
measurement
Highest capacitance
measurement
Maximum measured
capacitance by m²
Frameless glassglass module with
aluminium frame on
an assembly stand
(open air)
Plant 1: 1 MW
8000 m²
Sunny afternoon:
5 µF
Rainy morning:
10 µF
1,25 nF / m²
Plant 2: 750 kW
5000 m²
Sunny afternoon:
2 µF
Rainy morning:
4 µF
0,8 nF / m²
In-roof glassglass module with
aluminium frame
Plant 1: 100 kW
800 m²
Sunny afternoon:
2 µF
Rainy morning:
4 µF
5 nF / m²
Plant 2: 50 kW
400 m²
Sunny afternoon:
0,5 µF
Rainy morning:
1 µF
2,5 nF / m²
Thin-film PV module
on flexible substrate
Plant 1: 100 kW
800 m²
Sunny afternoon:
30 µF
Rainy morning:
50 µF
62,5 nF / m²
Plant 2: 50 kW
400 m²
Sunny afternoon:
15 µF
Rainy morning:
25 µF
62,5 nF / m²
Fig. P8 : Example of leakage capacitance in various PV systems
3.1.3 Protection of PV modules against reverse current
Inverter
=
~
A short circuit in a PV module, faulty wiring, or a related fault may cause reverse
current in PV strings. This occurs if the open-circuit voltage of one string is
significantly different from the open voltage of parallel strings connected to the same
inverter. The current flows from the healthy strings to the faulty one instead of flowing
to the inverter and supplying power to the AC network. Reverse current can lead
to dangerous temperature rises and fires in the PV module. PV module withstand
capability should therefore be tested in accordance with IEC 61730-2 standard and
the PV module manufacturer shall provide the maximum reverse current value (IRM)
P11
Fig. P9 : Reverse current
Reverse current into the faulty string = total current of the
remaining strings
String overcurrent protection is to be used if the total number of strings that could
feed one faulty string is high enough to supply a dangerous reverse current:
1.35 IRM < (Ns -1) ISC MAX
where:
b IRM is the maximum reverse current characteristic of PV cells defined in IEC 61730
b Ns is the total number of strings
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
There is no risk of reverse current when there
is only one string. When there are two strings
with same number of PV modules connected
in parallel, the reverse current will be always
lower than the maximum reverse current. So,
when the PV generator is made of one or
two strings only there is no need for reverse
current protection.
P - Photovoltaic installations
IEC 60364-712:
712.433.1 Overload protection may be omitted
to PV string and PV array cables when the
continuous current-carrying capacity of the
cable is equal to or greater than 1,25 times
ISC STC at any location.
712.433.2 Overload protection may be omitted
to the PV main cable if the continuous currentcarrying capacity is equal to or greater than
1,25 times ISC STC of the PV generator.
3.1.4 Protection against overcurrent
As in any installation, there should be protection against thermal effect of overcurrent
causing any danger.
Short-circuit current depends on solar irradiance, but it may be lower than the trip
value of overcurrent protection. Although this is not an issue for cables as the current
is within current-carrying capacity, the inverter will detect a voltage drop and stop
producing power. It is therefore recommended that the maximum trip current should
be significantly lower than ISTC MAX.
String protection
Where string overcurrent protection is required, each PV string shall be protected
with an overcurrent protection device.
The nominal overcurrent protection (Fuse or Circuit breaker) rating of the string
overcurrent protection device shall be greater than 1,25 times the string short circuit
current Isc stc_string.
Array protection
The nominal rated trip current (ITRIP) of overcurrent protection devices for PV arrays
(Fuses or Circuit breaker) shall be greater than 1,25 times the array short-circuit
current Isc stc_aray
The selection of overcurrent protection rating shall be done in order to avoid
unexpected trip in normal operation taking into account temperature. A protection
rating higher than 1.4 times the protected string or array short-circuit current Isc_stc. is
usually recommended.
3.1.5 Circuit breakers or Fuses
Circuit breakers or fuses can be used to provide overcurrent protection.
Fuses, usually on the fuse holder or directly connected to bars or cables, do not
provide a load-break switch function. So when fuses are used, load-break switches
should also be used to disconnect fuses from the inverter in order to allow cartridge
replacement. So an array box with fuses on fuse holders as string protection, for
example, should also incorporate a main switch.
Circuit breakers offer finetuned adjustment and greater accuracy than fuses in order
to allow the use of cables, especially for sub-array cables, that are smaller than fuses
Double earth faults
=
~
OCP
OCP
P12
Inverter
Switch
OCP
OCP
PV systems are either insulated from the earth or one pole is earthed through an
overcurrent protection. In both set-ups, therefore, there can be a ground fault in
which current leaks to the ground. If this fault is not cleared, it may spread to the
healthy pole and give rise to a hazardous situation where fire could break out. Even
though double insulation makes such an eventuality unlikely, it deserves full attention.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P10 : String overcurrent protection "OCP"
For the two following reasons the double fault situation shall be absolutely
avoided: Insulation monitoring devices or overcurrent protection in earthed
system shall detect first fault and staff shall look after the first fault and clear it
with no delay.
b The fault level could be low (e.g. two insulation faults or a low short-circuit
capability of the generator in weak sunlight) and below the tripping value of
overcurrent protection (circuit breaker or fuses). However, a DC arc fault does not
spend itself, even when the current is low. It could be a serious hazard, particularly
for PV modules on buildings.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 PV System and Installation
Rules
b Circuit breakers and switches used in PV systems are designed to break the rated
current or fault current with all poles at open-circuit maximum
voltage (UOC MAX). To break the current when UOC MAX is equal to 1000V, for
instance, four poles in series (two poles in series for each polarity) are required. In
double ground fault situations, the circuit breaker or switches must break the current
at full voltage with only two poles in series. Such switchgear is not designed for that
purpose and could sustain irremediable damage if used to break the current in a
double ground fault situation.
The ideal solution is prevent double ground faults arising. Insulation monitoring
devices or overcurrent protection in grounded systems detect the first fault. However,
although the insulation fault monitoring system usually stops the inverter, the fault is
still present. Staff must locate and clear it without delay. In large generators with subarrays protected by circuit breakers, it is highly advisable to disconnect each array
when that first fault has been detected but not cleared within the next few hours.
3.1.6 Switchgears and enclosure selection
Double insulation
Enclosures on the DC side shall provide double insulation.
Thermal issues
The thermal behaviour of switchgear and enclosures warrants careful monitoring.
PV generator boxes and array boxes are usually installed outdoors and exposed to
the elements. In the event of high ambient temperatures, high IP levels could reduce
air flow and thermal power dissipation. In addition, the way switchgear devices
achieve high voltage operation – i.e. through the use of poles in series – increases
their temperature. Special attention should therefore be paid to the temperature of
switchgear inside outdoor enclosures on the DC side.
Cable protection should comply with requirements of IEC 60364. Part 712 of the
standard stipulates that all enclosures on the DC side should meet the requirements
of IEC 61439. This standard covers low voltage switchgear and control gear
assemblies and sets out requirements that guarantee the risk of temperature rises
has been factored into the safe design of DC boxes (generator and array boxes).
Pollution degree of switchgear and enclosure selection
In addition to the standard criteria for selecting enclosures in PV systems with UOC
MAX of 1000V, some equipment may show IEC 606947 - 1 Pollution Degree 2 rather
than Pollution Degree 3.
If the switchgear is Pollution Degree 2, the IP level of the enclosure according
to IEC 60529 shall be at least IP5x.
3.2 Protection against overvoltage: Surge protection
Overvoltage may occur in electrical installations for various reasons. This may be
caused by:
The distribution network as a result of lightning or any work carried out
Lightning bolts (nearby/on buildings and PV installations, or on lightning conductors)
P13
Variations in the electrical field due to lightning.
Like all outdoor structures, photovoltaic installations are exposed to the risk of
lightning which varies from region to region. Preventive and arrest systems and
devices should be in place.
The first safeguard to put in place is a medium (conductor) that ensures equipotential
bonding between all the conductive parts of a PV installation. The aim is to bond all
grounded conductors and metal parts and so create equal potential at all points in
the installed system.
3.2.2 Protection by surge protection devices (SPD):
SPD are particularly important to protect sensitive electrical equipments like AC/DC
Inverter , monitoring devices and PV modules but also other sensitive equipments
powered by the 230VAC electrical distribution network. The following method of risk
assessment is based on the evaluation of the critical length Lcrit and its comparison
with L the cumulative length of the d.c. lines.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3.2.1 Protection by equipotential bonding:
P - Photovoltaic installations
Surge Protection Device is required if L Lcrit
Lcrit depends on the type of PV installation, and is calculated according to the
following table :
Type of installation
Individual residential
premises
Terrestrial production plant
Service/Industrial/Agricultural
Buildings
Lcrit (in m)
115/Ng
200/Ng
450/Ng
L Lcrit
Surge protective device(s) compulsory on DC side (2)
L Lcrit
Surge protective device(s) not compulsory on DC side (1)
Fig. P11 : Critical length Lcrit calculation
b L is the sum of :
v the sum of distances between the inverter(s) and the junction box(es), taking
into account that the lengths of cable located in the same conduit are counted only
once, and
v the sum of distances between the junction box and the connection points of
the photovoltaic modules forming the string, taking into account that the lengths of
cable located in the same conduit are counted only once.
b Ng: arc lightning density(nb of stike/km²/year)
Array box
Generator Box
AC Box
Main LV switch
board
=
LDC
SPD
1
~
SPD
2
LAC
SPD
3
SPD
4
SPD Protection
Location
PV Modules or Array boxe
Inverter DC side
P14
Criteria
<10m
>10m
Type of SPD
No need
SPD 1
Type 2 *
Inverter AC side
Main board
LAC
LDC
SPD 2
Type 2*
Ligthning rod
<10m
>10m
Yes
No
No need
SPD 3
Type 2
SPD 4
Type 1
SPD 4
Type 2 if Ng>2,5
& overhead line
* Type 1 if separation distance according to EN 62305 is not kept
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P12 : Type of SPD according to location
Installation of SPD
The number and location of SPD on the DC side depends on the length of the cables
between the solar panels and inverter (if this length is>10 metres a second SDP
is necessary and located in the box close to the solar panel, the first one is located in
the inverter area.
To be efficient, SPD connections cables to L+, L- network and also between
earth terminal block of SPD and ground busbar must be as short as possible
(d1+d2<50cm)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 PV System and Installation
Rules
Generator
d1
N
L
d2
d3
PRD-DC
1
Generator
Conversion
d1
d2
d1 + d2 < 50 cm
> 4 mm2 d1 + d3 < 50 cm
d2 + d3 < 50 cm
d3
PRD-DC
1
d1
N
L
d2
d3
PRD-DC
1
Conversion
Fig. P13 : SPD installation
Note: Switches used in PV systems are
designed to break the rated current of all poles
at Uocmax. To break the current when Uocmax
is equal to 1000V, for instance, four poles in
series (two poles in series for each polarity)
are required. In double ground fault situations,
the circuit breaker or switches must break the
current at full voltage with only two poles in
series. Such switchgear is not designed for
that purpose and could sustain irremediable
damage if used to break the current in a
double ground fault situation. For this reason
double ground faults must be avoided at
all costs. Insulation monitoring devices or
overcurrent protection in grounded system
detect the first fault. Staff shall locate it and
clear it without delay.
3.3 How to ensure safety during maintenance or
emergency
To ensure staff safety during maintenance and emergencies disconnect devices
should be appropriately located and enclosures installation should be failsafe.
3.3.1 Isolation switching and control
b The switch disconnectors on the AC side and DC side of the inverter shall be
installed for inverter service and maintenance.
b As many switch disconnectors should be installed as are needed to allow operation
on the PV generator, particularly to replace fuses in the array boxes and generator
junction boxes.
b For PV systems inside buildings, a remotely-controlled switch disconnector should
be mounted as closely as possible to the PV modules or to the point of entry of DC
cables in the event of an emergency.
P15
Array box
Generator Box
AC Box
Main LV switch
board
=
Fig. P15 : Switch disconnector location
Fig. P14 : Switch disconnector Compact NSX 200A with
heatsink and interphase barrier
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
~
P - Photovoltaic installations
3.3.2 Selecting and installing enclosures
Enclosures for different PV generator boxes and switch boards on the DC side need
to ensure double isolation, equipment protection against such outdoor hazards as
temperatures, the rain, vandalism, and shock.
Enclosure and their auxiliary equipment must ensure temperature and humidity
control to allow equipment to operate smoothly. It is, however, difficult to propose
a generic solution. Each installation needs to be analysed in order to optimize the
sizing of its enclosures and auxiliary equipment.
Cold
Heat
Thermostat O
Fans IP55
Heating resistance
Thermostat F
Humidity
Hygrostat
P16
Heating resistance
Thermal risks and heating / cooling solution shall be studied
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P16 : Temperature and moisture control
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 PV System and Installation
Rules
3.4 How to ensure safety during all the life cycle of
the installation
IEC60364-6 requires initial and periodic verifications of electrical installations.
Specificities of photovoltaic installation (outdoor, high DC voltage, unsupervised
installation) make periodic checking very important.
If usually the efficiency of all the system is checked in order to ensure the maximum
production, we recommend to perform periodic maintenance of equipment.
PV system operating conditions involve various environmental stresses: wide
temperature variations, humidity, and electrical stresses. In order to ensure
performances of equipment during all the life cycle of installation particular attention
shall be paid to the following:
b Enclosure integrity (Double isolation IP level)
b Switchgears operating condition and integrity
v to evaluate if any overheating has occurred
v to examine switchgears for the presence of dust, moisture…
b Visual check of electrical connections
b Functional test of equipment and auxiliaries
b Insulation monitoring device test
b Insulation resistance test
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P17
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
4 PV installation architectures
4.1 Common characteristics of PV architectures
A PV array is made up of a number of modules in series or parallel, corresponding
to the input characteristics of the inverter. However, since these modules are
interconnected, the array is very sensitive to shade or differences in terms of the
direction faced.
By following a few simple cabling rules, supply can be optimised and any operating
problems may be avoided.
Position of the panels
If, when installing a PV array on a roof, panels need to face in different directions, it is
essential to assemble at least one string per direction and ensure each string is facing
in just one direction to ensure optimised supply. Each string must be connected to a
specific inverter (or to inputs of a multi-MPPT inverter - see Section 3).
If this instruction is not observed, the array will not be damaged but supply will be
reduced, thus increasing the time needed for a return on investment.
Shade
Besides the risk of destruction of shaded modules within a PV array due to the “hot
spot phenomenon” as described in Paragraph 2.2 for which manufacturers have
devised solutions, research conducted by the Institut National des Energies Solaires
(INES – France’s national institute for solar energy) suggests that shading of 10% of
the surface area of a string may cause more than a 30% reduction in output!
It is therefore important to eliminate direct shading. However, in many cases this is
difficult (trees, chimney, neighbouring wall, pylon, etc.).
If a PV array includes several strings:
b If possible, shaded modules should be included in a single string
b Otherwise, a technology should be chosen which responds better to diffuse light
than direct light
Eliminating loops
When connecting components, the first precaution to take is to avoid loops in the
cabling within strings.
Even though direct lightning strikes on arrays are relatively rare, currents induced
by lightning are much more common and these currents are particularly destructive
where there are large areas of looping. Figure P17 shows how to improve an array
including a large loop.
P18
=
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
~
=
Charge
~
Fig. P17 : Avoiding loops when cabling strings
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Charge
4 PV installation architectures
4.2 Architectures for installations connected to the
grid
General Rules
Where photovoltaic installations are connected to the grid and energy is sold, it is
necessary to optimise efficiency and reduce installation costs. With this in mind,
a relatively high DC operating voltage of between 200 and 500 V is often used for
residential applications, with up to 1000 V being used for applications requiring a
higher level of power.
All the modules in a PV array should be identical (same brand and same type) and
selected to supply the same level of power. For example, the modules should all be
180 W, even though there exists other power levels in the same PV modules product
range (170 W, 180 W and 190 W).
In practice, the protection units (DC and AC units) should be positioned close to the
inverters for ease of maintenance.
PV array with a single string of modules
This is the simplest configuration (see Fig. P18). It is used for small PV arrays with
peak power of up to 3 kWp depending on the modules deployed. In most cases, it is
used for residential PV operations.
PV
DC unit
Inverter
AC unit
Meters
=
kWh
kWh
~
Fig. P18 : Diagram showing a single-string photovoltaic array
Modules are connected in series, supplying direct current of between 200 and 500
VDC in this instance. Optimal efficiency is obtained from the inverter within this
voltage range.
A single DC line is fed through to the inverter. The PV array can be isolated from the
inverter by means of a load break switch near the inverter.
PV array with several module strings in parallel
This configuration (see Fig. P19), mainly deployed on buildings or in small PV power
plants on the ground, is used for PV installations of up to thirty strings in parallel with
power output of some 100 kWp. This limit is imposed for technological and financial
reasons. If exceeded, the required width of the main DC cable would be impractical.
Direct current can be determined based on the number of modules in series per
string and in this instance is between 300 and 600 VDC. By paralleling identical
strings, the power required for the installation can be attained. The strings are
paralleled in a PV array box. This box includes the safety devices required for
paralleling the strings and appliances used to measure the strings’ current. A single
DC cable connects these boxes to the inverter. The PV array can be isolated from
the inverter by means a load break switch near the inverter.
PV
Meters
Inverter
PV array box
AC
enclosure
DC
enclosure
P19
Supply point
=
kWh
Network
kWh
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
~
Fig. P19 : Diagram showing a multi-string photovoltaic array with one inverter
P - Photovoltaic installations
As a variation on this diagram, several single-phase inverters can be installed in a
three-phase arrangement (see Fig. P20).
PV
PV array box
DC enclosure
AC enclosure
Inverter
=
~
=
~
=
~
Fig. P20 : Diagram showing a multi-string photovoltaic array with several single-phase inverters
connected in a three-phase arrangement
PV array with several strings divided into several groups
When power levels exceed 50 or 100 kW, photovoltaic arrays are split into subgroups
(see Fig. P21) to make it easier to connect the various components. Strings are
paralleled on two levels.
b Strings in each subgroup are paralleled in subgroup PV array boxes. These boxes
are fitted with safety devices, the necessary measuring equipment and monitoring
devices.
b The outputs of these boxes are paralleled in a PV array box near the inverter.
This box is also fitted with the required safety devices as well as the measuring and
monitoring equipment necessary for paralleling the subgroups.
The array can be isolated from the inverter using a load block switch which may or
may not be fitted in the PV array box. The array’s direct current is approximately
1000 VDC.
PV
PV array box
DC enclosure
P20
AC enclosure
Inverter
=
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
~
Fig. P20 : Diagram showing a photovoltaic array consisting of several groups
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 PV installation architectures
4.3 Sizing
Calculating a photovoltaic array
It is absolutely essential to take account of location (geographic location, latitude,
altitude, shade, etc.) and installation factors (direction faced, angle, etc.).
Firstly, the approximate power output may be calculated based on the available
surface area:
10 m² = 1 kWp
7140 m² (=football ground) = 700 kWp
The PV array should always be arranged around the inverter. The calculations
involved should compare the characteristics of the modules and those of the inverter
with a view to identifying the optimal configuration.
b String composition:
NB: Number of modules x Voc (at t° min) < inverter Vmax
The no load voltage of the string (Voc x number of modules in series) at the
minimum temperature of the installation location must be lower than the inverter’s
maximum input voltage.
=> This must be strictly observed. Otherwise the inverter may be destroyed.
Apart from the aforementioned rule for preventing destruction of the inverter
Number of modules x Voc (at t° min) < inverter Vmax – two other limits must be
observed:
v Number of modules x Vmpp (at t° max) > inverter Vmin
The operating voltage (Vm x number of modules in series at all temperatures at the
installation location) should fall within the inverter’s MPPT voltage range. Otherwise,
the inverter will stall and energy supply will cease.
v Isc strings < inverter I max
The total Isc current for strings in parallel must be lower than the maximum input
current for the inverter. Otherwise, the inverter limits the supply of energy delivered to
the network.
Inverter specifications
b In Europe, the power level of the inverter must be between 0.8 and 1 times the
power of the array:
0.8 < Pinverter / Parray < 1
v Below this (under 0.8 Parray), the inverter limits power significantly. The energy
sold to the network will thus be inferior to that which the panels are capable of
supplying and therefore it will take longer to secure a return on investment.
v Above this (over Parray), the inverter is too large for the power level of the array.
Again, it will take longer to secure a return on investment.
b Single-phase or three-phase
A decision should be made over these two options in consultation with the local
energy distributor based on the devices available in manufacturers’ product ranges,
often within the following limits:
v Inverter Pn < 10 kW => single phase inverter
v 10 kW < Pn < 100 kW => either three-phase inverter(s) or single-phase inverters
split between the three phases and neutral. The management of unbalances
between phases needs to be checked in this instance.
v Pn > 100 kW => three-phase inverter(s)
P21
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
b Configuration software
Manufacturers of inverters help design offices and installers to size strings for
residential and service sector installations based on the equipment available by
supplying sizing software.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
4.4 Installation type
The installation type is a factor which should not be neglected since, in countries
including France, the purchase price for power supplied is dependent on this. Along
with shading, it should be taken into account when choosing a module.
There are three installation types – building integrated, partially integrated and
ground-based:
b Building Integrated PhotoVoltaic (BIPV)
This installation type fulfils a dual role (energy supply and roof waterproofing,
shading, etc.).
b Partially integrated
This is the simplest assembly to install and, most importantly, does not alter the
water resistance of a roof. However, its major drawback is that, in France, operators
cannot charge the highest rate for it. This installation type is most commonly used in
Germany and Switzerland.
b Ground-based
This installation type is used for power supply plants covering large areas
(photovoltaic farms). Again, in France it is not eligible for the highest purchase price.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P22
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 PV installation architectures
4.5 Electrical equipments selection
4.5.1 Grid connected PV system <= 10kW (Residential)
One single phase inverter
Typically, a 5kW grid-connected single-phase inverter. with UOC MAX 600V. One
or two strings – Isctc < 25A, IAC < 32A. In this design there is no string protection.
A PV main switch is necessary. When the inverter is indoors, an additional remotecontrolled switch at the DC cable entry point is recommended for emergencies
services.
E1
E2
Inverter with or without
galvanic isolation
E3
Q1
Q2
Q3
~
SPD
2
Outdoor
Needs
To grid
connection
=
SPD
3
Indoor
String junction box
PV main switch
Inverter
AC box (230V P/N)
•
• (d)
(a)
• (d)
•
DC21B
• (d)
DC21B
(a)
• (d)
• (b)
• (d)
(e)
• (d)
Switchgears and control
Isolation
Switching
(Making & breaking rated
current)
Control
Over-current protection
(c)
• (f)
Protection against
Insulation fault
(h)
Surge protection
Enclosure
Metering
Outdoor
Double insulation
(h)
RCD type B or A SI
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Indoor
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
Inverter relevant parameters
Energy
b a PV array main switch could be included in the inverter. This solution makes inverter service or replacement more difficult.
b b Remote switching for emergency services located as closely as possible to the PV modules or to the point of entry of DC cables in the building.
b c No protection is required when the number of string does not exceed 2.
b d Service and emergency switching
b e Inverter shall include a protection for anti-islanding (in accordance with VDE 0126 for example)
b f Overload and short-circuit protection B curve recommended.
b g This SPD could be unnecessary if there is another SPD in the AC installation at a distance of less than 10 metres.
b h If the inverter provides no galvanic separation a RCD protection is necessary on AC side. IEC 60364-712 specifies RCD type B Some local regulations require
RCD type A SI
P23
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P22 : Grid connected <= 10kW
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
4.5.2 10 to 100kW grid connected PV system (Small building)
One three phase multi input inverter without array box
Typically, 10kW to 36kW grid-connected inverters, UOC MAX probably higher than
600V (i.e. 800V or 1000V), Isctc < 125A, Iac < 63A. In this range of power, inverters
usually have between 2 and 4 maximum power point tracking (MPPT) inputs, so the
number of strings in the same DC sub-network is equal to one or two. There is no
need for string protection. A PV main switch for each MPPT input is necessary. When
an inverter is indoors, additional remote-controlled switches at DC cable entry point
are recommended for emergencies services.
SPD
11
E2
Q11
Q21
Q12
Q22
SPD
12
Inverter with or without
galvanic isolation
SPD
21
E3
=
To grid
connection
E1
Q3
~
SPD
22
SPD
3
Indoor
Indoor / Outdoor
Needs
String junction box
PV array main switch
Inverter
AC box (400V)
•
• (d)
(a)
• (d)
•
DC21B
• (d)
DC21B
(a)
• (d)
• (b)
• (d)
(e)
• (d)
Switchgears and control
Isolation
Switching
(Making & breaking rated
current)
Control
Over-current protection
(c)
• (f)
Protection against
Insulation fault
(h)
Surge protection
Enclosure
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Indoor IP5x
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
Energy
Metering
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P24
(h)
RCD type B or A SI
b a PV array main switch could be included in the inverter. This solution makes inverter service or replacement difficult.
b b Remote switching for emergency services located as closely as possible to the PV modules or to the point of entry of DC cables in the building.
b c No protection is required when the number of string does not exceed 2.
b d Service and emergency switching
b e Inverter shall include a protection for anti-islanding (in accordance with VDE 0126 for example)
b f Overload and short-circuit protection (B curve recommended).
b g If there is no SPD in the inverter or if the distance between DC box and inverter exceeds 10m a SPD is necessary in this box.
bh
v If the inverter provides no galvanic separation a RCD protection is necessary on AC side. IEC 60364-712 specifies RCD type B Some local regulations require
RCD type A SI
v If the inverter provides at least simple separation
- Without functional earthing: insulation monitoring is necessary, it's usually done by the inverter in this range of power.
- With functional earthing: the earthing shall be done with a DC MCB breaker (C60PV 4P series 2 – 10A) or a fuse.
Fig. P23 : 10-100kW single multi MPPT inverter
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 PV installation architectures
One three phases inverter with One Array box
Typically, 30kW to 60kW grid-connected inverters. UOC max is generally higher than
600V (up to 1000V), Isctc does not exceed 200A, I AC does not exceed 100A. This
design has more than 2 strings. Reverse current protection is therefore necessary. A
main PV switch is required. When an inverter is inside, additional remote-controlled
switch at DC cable entry point is recommended for emergencies.
E1
Q0
E2
Inverter with or without
galvanic isolation
E3
Q1
Q3
Q2
Q0
SPD
1
To grid
connection
=
Q0
~
SPD
2
Q0
SPD
3
Indoor
Outdoor
Needs
String / Array junction box
PV array main switch
Inverter
AC box (400V)
Switchgears and control
Isolation
Switching
(Making & breaking rated
current)
Control
Over-current protection
•
• (d)
(a)
• (d)
•
DC21B
• (d)
DC21B
(a)
• (d)
• (b)
• (d)
(e)
• (d)
•
(c)
Protection against
Insulation fault
(h)
Surge protection
Enclosure
• (f)
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
(h)
RCD type B or A SI
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Indoor IP5x
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
P,Q, PF, Energy
Metering
b a PV array main switch could be included in the inverter. This solution makes inverter service or replacement difficult.
b b Remote switching for emergency services located as closely as possible to the PV modules or to the point of entry of DC cables in the building. The main switch
in array box can be equipped with tripping coil and motor mechanism for remote reclosing for that purpose.
b d Service and emergency switching
b e Inverter shall include a protection for anti-islanding (in accordance with VDE 0126 for example)
b f Overload and short-circuit protection (B curve recommended).
b g If there is no SPD in the inverter or if the distance between DC box and inverter exceeds 10m a SPD is necessary in this box.
bh
v If the inverter provides no galvanic separation a RCD protection is necessary on AC side. IEC 60364-712 specifies RCD type B Some local regulations require
RCD type A SI
v If the inverter provides at least simple separation
- Without functional earthing: insulation monitoring is necessary
- With functional earthing: the earthing shall be done with a DC MCB breaker (C60PV 4P series 2 – 10A) or a fuse.
P25
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P24 : 10-100kW single MPPT inverter
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
Multi single phase inverters design
Typically, 6x5 to 20x5kW grid-connected inverters. The design used for residential
building can be duplicated as often as necessary. In that case, the DC system is very
simple and the AC system is very similar to usual AC systems.
E1
Indoor
=
E3
Q1
~
SPD
1
Q3
Outdoor
E1
=
Q1
SPD
1
E1
~
Q3
~
Q3
~
Q3
~
Q3
~
Q3
=
Q1
SPD
1
E1
Q4
=
Q1
SPD
1
E1
SPD
3
=
Q1
SPD
1
E1
=
Q1
SPD
1
Needs
Switchgears and control
Surge protection
Enclosure
P26
PV array main switch
Inverter
See 5kW design
AC box (400V)
(h)
• (d)
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
Energy
Metering
P,Q, PF, Energy, unbalance
b h If the inverter provides no galvanic separation a RCD protection is necessary on AC side. IEC 60364-712 specifies RCD type B Some local regulations require
RCD type A SI
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P25 : 10-100kW multi single MPPT inverter
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 PV installation architectures
Three phases inverter with two Array boxes (Na <=2)
Typically, 60kW to 100kW grid-connected inverters with 2 arrays. Array cable
protection is not necessary for 2 or 3 arrays.
The Isctc array 200A, Isctc 400A, and Imax AC 200A. A PV main switch
is required close to the inverter. Remotely operated switches in array boxes allow
disconnects to be located close to the PV modules in the event of emergencies.
E1
Q0
E2
Q1
SPD
1
=
Q3
Q2
Outdoor
E3
To grid
connection
Q0
Inverter with or without
galvanic isolation
E1
~
SPD
2
Q0
SPD
3
Q1
Q0
SPD
1
Indoor
Outdoor
Needs
String / Array junction box
PV array main switch
Inverter
AC box (400V)
•
• (d)
(a)
• (d)
•
DC21B
• (d)
DC21B
(a)
• (d)
• (b)
• (d)
(e)
• (d)
•
(c)
Switchgears and control
Control
Over-current protection
Protection against
Insulation fault
Surge protection
Enclosure
• (f)
(h)
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
(h)
RCD type B or A SI
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Indoor IP5x
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
P,Q, PF, Energy
Metering
b a PV array main switch could be included in the inverter. This solution makes inverter service or replacement difficult.
b b If switching for emergency services is required, the main switch in array box can be equipped with tripping coil and motor mechanism for remote reclosing.
b c No protection is required when the number of arrays <= 3 (No cable sizing benefit)
b d Service and emergency switching
b e Inverter shall include a protection for anti-islanding (in accordance with VDE 0126 for example)
b f Overload and short-circuit protection.
b g If there is no SPD in the inverter or if the distance between DC box and inverter exceeds 10m a SPD is necessary in this box.
bh
v If the inverter provides no galvanic separation a RCD protection is necessary on AC side. IEC 60364-712 specifies RCD type B Some local regulations require
RCD type A SI
v If the inverter provides at least simple separation
- Without functional earthing: insulation monitoring is necessary
- With functional earthing: the earthing shall be done with a DC MCB breaker (C60PV 4P series 2 – 10A) or a fuse.
Fig. P26 : 10-100kW single MPPT inverter with 2 arrays
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P27
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Isolation
Switching
(Making & breaking rated
current)
P - Photovoltaic installations
4.5.4 150kW to 500kW Grid connected PV system (Large
building and farm)
Three phases inverter with more than two Array boxes
Typically, 150kW to 500kW single inverter. This design is very similar to the
previous one except that it has more arrays, which requires array cable protection.
Istc <= 400A, IAC <= 600A.
E1
Q0
Q2
Q1
E2
Inverter without
galvanic isolation
SPD
0
=
Q2
Outdoor
E1
Q0
SPD
1
Needs
String
Q3
~
SPD
3
Q2
Q1
Q0
Q21
To LV/MV
transformer
E3
Q0
Indoor
SPD
0
Array junction box
Generator junction box
Inverter
AC box 400V or other
voltage (Transfoless inveter)
•
•
• (a)
• (d)
•
DC22A
•
DC22A
• (a)
• (d)
• (a)
• (d)
Switchgears and control
Isolation
•
Switching
(Making & breaking
rated current)
Control
Over-current protection
• (b)
•
• (c )
Protection against
Insulation fault
Surge protection
Enclosure
Metering
P28
• (f)
• (h)
• (h)
(g)
• type 2
• type 1 or 2
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
Indoor
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
Energy
P,Q, PF, Energy, Alarm, THD,
individual harmonics
b a PV array main switch could be included in the inverter. This solution makes inverter service or replacement more difficult.
b b If switching for emergency services is required, the main switch in array box can be equipped with tripping coil and motor mechanism for remote reclosing.
b c Array cable protection is recommended to prevent cable overszing. To ensure fast trip of protections 6 to 8 arrays are recommended.
b e Inverter shall include a protection for anti-islanding (in accordance with VDE 0126 for example)
b f Overload and short-circuit protection.
b g If there is no SPD in the inverter or if the distance between DC box and inverter exceeds 10m a SPD is necessary in this box.
b h Galvanic insulation is provided by LV/MV transformer,
v PV system without functional earthing: insulation monitoring is necessary: IMD - IM20 and accessory IMD-IM20-1700
v PV system With functional earthing: the earthing shall be done with a DC MCB breaker (C60PV 4P series 2 – 10A) or a fuse.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P27 : 150-500kW single MPPT inverter with N arrays > 2
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 PV installation architectures
Multi three phases inverters design without array box
Typically 10x20 to 20x30kW grid connected inverters
Uoc max <=1000V one or two string per inverter. IAC max 50A for one
inverter.
E1
SPD
11
Indoor
=
Q11
Q12
~
=
SPD
12
~
=
~
=
E3
Q5
Q5
Q5
Q6
~
=
SPD
11
Q11
Q5
~
=
Q12
Needs
Q5
~
SPD
12
SPD
3
Q5
~
=
E1
Q5
~
=
Q5
String junction box
AC Combiner Box
Switchgears and control
See 10 to 36kW design
• type 2
Surge protection
Enclosure
• type 1 or 2
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
Standard AC requirement +
grid code requirement
Energy
Metering
P,Q, PF, Energy, Alarm,
Fig. P28 : 150-500kW multi 3-phases inverters
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
P29
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
4 PV installation architectures
Multi MW Grid connected PV system (Large building and farm)
Typically 500kW -630kW inverters with LV/MV transformers and MV substation.
E1
Q0
E5
Q2
Q1
E2
SPD
0
Q0
=
Q3
b
Outdoor
E1
Q0
SPD
1
Needs
Q5
~ SPD
3
Q2
Q1
SPD
0
Q0
Q4
SPD
2
E4
E3
2nd inverter similar scheme
Indoor
String
Array junction box
Generator junction box
Inverter
AC box 400V or other
voltage (Transfoless inveter)
•
•
• (a)
See next page
•
•
DC22A
• (a)
See next page
•
See next page
•
See next page
• (f)
Switchgears and control
Isolation
Switching
(Making & breaking
rated current)
Control
Over-current protection
• (b)
•
• (c )
Protection against
Insulation fault
See next page
(g)
• type 2
Outdoor IP5x
Double insulation
Indoor
Double insulation (i)
Surge protection
Enclosure
Metering
P30
Energy
(g)
• type 1 or 2
P,Q, PF, Energy, Alarm, Power
quality
b a PV array main switch is usually included in the inverter panel.
b b If switching for emergency services is required, the main switch in array box can be equipped with tripping coil and motor mechanism for remote reclosing.
b c Array cable protection is recommended to prevent cable overszing. To ensure fast trip of protections 6 to 8 arrays are recommended.
b f Overload and short-circuit protection.
b g If there is no SPD in the inverter or if the between DC box and inverter >10m a SPD is necessary in this box.
b h Galvanic insulation is provided by LV/MV transformer,
v PV system without functional earthing: insulation monitoring is necessary: IMD - IM20 and accessory IMD-IM20-1700
v PV system With functional earthing: the earthing shall be done with a DC MCB breaker (C60PV 4P series 2 – 10A) or a fuse.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P29 : 500-630kW inverters with LV/MV transformers
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Monitoring
Since the profitability of photovoltaic installations depends mainly on operational
uptime, it is essential to ensure that they are permanently up and running. The best
way of ensuring this is to install a monitoring system covering key equipments of the
installation. This system should notify all faults immediately, be capable of detecting
drifts in output, and possibly control equipment remotely.
5.1 Types of monitoring systems
Several types of monitoring systems are available for installations, depending mainly
of the size of the installation.
Systems for Residential up to commercial, 1 to 1000 kWp, are able to monitor the
inverters – status, measurements and alarms - and key electrical values related to
the output of the installation.
These systems are based on a data -logger, mostly equipped with a RS232/485
serial port to communicate with the inverters, using Modbus or a proprietary protocol.
Data acquisition is based on low speed polling rate, every 10 minutes in average.
Data may be stored locally in the data-logger, for free, but for a short period of time,
or pushed to an external server which store the data over the years and deliver a
front end, providing an annual service fee. In that case, the communication with the
distant server can be or via GPRS, or via Ethernet
The data-logger can also be equipped with auxiliary inputs, such as analogue inputs
to monitor temperature or irradiance sensors, digital input to monitor the status of an
equipment and/or pulse input to connect with an energy meter equipped with digital
output.
Systems for large commercial up to Utility scale power plant, from 500 kWp upwards,
are able to monitor the complete installation, from the string input to the point of
connection to the grid.
These systems are based on a SCADA (Supervision Control And Data Acquisition)
system, which enable multi site monitoring, DC & AC measurements, remote control
of motorized equipments, smart alarming, generation of reports, performance
indication and other capabilities such as in-depth analysis.
These systems also include other equipment to run the site more efficiently, such
as weather station ( temperatures, wind rain gauge ), irradiance sensors, a plant
controller - device which communicate with the grid operator, to adapt the production
of the site to the grid variation ( Voltage, Power Factor ) – and specific meters such
as revenue grade meters, close the popint of connection
These scada systems can be local and/or remote, with redundancy capabilities and
high performance for data processing.
This type of installation is mostly served by a Service contract for Operations
& Maintenance and in many cases, with performance objectives which can be
production, performance ratio or availability.
5.2 Monitoring systems
P31
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
These systems may be autonomous or include remote monitoring, accessible from
the "cloud".
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
P - Photovoltaic installations
5 Monitoring
Large
screen
display
SMS
@mail
Files
GSM
GPRS
SMTP
FTP
Data logger
=
Sensors
=
~
Inverter 1
=
~
Inverter 2
~
Inverter 3
Fig. P30 : Example of an autonomous monitoring system mostly used in residential to
commercial PV installations
Once the data is collected locally, the system sends output data and alerts as soon
as they are generated to a remote monitoring system capable of managing stand-by
periods for maintenance work. This enables the installation to be monitored closely,
which is essential where operators of photovoltaic installations are not necessarily
the site occupants.
Remote
Site 2
Site 1
Large screen
display and
control in a
control room
On-site server
Router
TCP/IP Ethernet network
SCADA
RS485 - TCP/IP
Sensors
=
~
Equipment status,
measurements Inverter 1
Ethernet TCP/IP network
=
=
~
~
Inverter 2
Inverter 3
P32
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P31 : Example of a system for remote monitoring mostly used in utility scale power plants
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Operation & Maintenance
Remote monitoring system
5 Monitoring
5.3 Sensors
Sensors provide data to the monitoring systems and include:
b A sensor for measuring instantaneous luminous flux such as a pyranometer (heat
flow sensor used to measure the quantity of solar energy in natural light (W/m²), see
Fig. P32). This is the standard reference for the installation. It may be used to identify
shifts over time and is recommended to all suppliers wishing to conduct comparative
analyses and compile statistics for their installations.
b A temperature sensor – this is an important factor for photovoltaic power supply
(see Paragraph 2.1). This sensor either serves as an external probe or is attached to
the back of a module.
b A kilowatt hour meter
When selling power, only the kilowatt hour meter operated by the energy distributor
purchasing the electricity may be used as a reference.
The other meters fitted within an installation (in the inverter or next to the official
meter) are only indicators with their own specific levels of accuracy. Variations of
more than 10% may occur between the values given by an installation’s devices and
that given by the official meter. However, these variations are not only due to different
levels of accuracy. They are also caused by energy lost in the cables and safety
devices downstream from the inverter.
It is therefore important to use cables of minimal length and clearly identify:
v The location where the installation will be connected to the network
v The locations where the energy distributor’s meters will be connected
5.4 Security of the installation
Since modules are expensive and in some cases openly accessible, sites need to be
monitored by security cameras.
NB – although this type of surveillance is authorised for private sites, filming of public
highways is prohibited.
P33
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. P32
2 : Pyranometer – Kipp & Zonen
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter Q
Residential and other special
locations
Contents
1
Residential and similar premises
Q2
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
Q2
Q2
Q4
Q6
Q7
2
Bathrooms and showers
Q8
2.1 Classification of zones
2.2 Equipotential bonding
2.3 Requirements prescribed for each zone
Q8
Q11
Q11
3
Recommendations applicable to special installations
and locations
Q12
General
Distribution boards components
Protection of people
Circuits
Protection against overvoltages and lightning
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q1
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Q - Residential and other special locations
1 Residential and similar premises
1.1 General
Electrical installations for residential premises
need a high standard of safety and reliability
Related standards
Most countries have national regulations and-or standards governing the rules
to be strictly observed in the design and realization of electrical installations for
residential and similar premises. The relevant international standard is the publication
IEC 60364.
The power distribution utility connects the LV
neutral point to its MV/LV distribution tranformer
to earth.
All LV installations must be protected by RCDs.
All exposed conductive parts must be bonded
together and connected to the earth.
The power network
The vast majority of power distribution utilities connect the low voltage neutral point
of their MV/LV distribution transformers to earth.
The protection of persons against electric shock therefore depends, in such case, on
the principle discussed in chapter F. The measures required depend on whether the
TT, TN or IT scheme of earthing is adopted.
RCDs are essential for TT and IT earthed installations. For TN installations, high
speed overcurrent devices or RCDs may provide protection against direct contact
of the electrical circuits. To extend the protection to flexible leads beyond the fixed
socket outlets and to ensure protection against fires of electrical origin RCDs shall
be installed.
The quality of electrical equipment used in
residential premises is commonly ensured by a
mark of conformity situated on the front of each
item
1.2 Distribution boards components (see Fig. Q1)
Distribution boards (generally only one in residential premises) usually include
the meter(s) and in some cases (notably where the supply utilities impose a TT
earthing system and/or tariff conditions which limit the maximum permitted current
consumption) an incoming supply differential circuit-breaker which includes an
overcurrent trip. This circuit-breaker is freely accessible to the consumer.
Enclosure
Service connection
Distribution board
Lightning protection
Incoming-supply
circuit breaker
Combi surge arrester
Overcurrent
protection
and isolation
Protection against
direct and indirect
contact,
and protection
against fire
Q2
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Remote control
MCB phase and neutral
Differential
MCB
Differential load
switch
Remote control switch
TL 16 A
Energy management
Programmable thermostat
THP
Load shedding switch
CDSt
Programmable time switch
IHP
Contactors, off-peak
or manual control CT
Fig. Q1 : Presentation of realizable functions on a consumer unit
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Residential and similar premises
On installations which are TN earthed, the supply utilities usually protect the
installation simply by means of sealed fuse cut-outs immediately upstream of the
meter(s) (see Fig. Q2). The consumer has no access to these fuses.
Meter
Fuse …
or …
Circuit breaker
depending on
earthing system
Distribution
board
Fig. Q2 : Components of a control and distribution board
The incoming supply circuit-breaker (see Fig. Q3)
Fig. Q3 : Incoming-supply circuit-breaker
The consumer is allowed to operate this CB if necessary (e.g to reclose it if the
current consumption has exceeded the authorized limit; to open it in case of
emergency or for isolation purposes).
The rated residual current of the incoming circuit-breaker in the earth leakage
protection shall be 300 mA.
If the installation is TT, the earth electrode resistance shall be less than
50 V
166 . In practice, the earth electrode resistance of a new installation
300 mA
R
shall be less than 80 ( ) .
2
R
The control and distribution board (consumer unit) (see Fig. Q4)
This board comprises:
b A control panel for mounting (where appropriate) the incoming supply circuitbreaker and other control auxiliaries, as required
b A distribution panel for housing 1, 2 or 3 rows (of 24 Acti 9 units) or similar MCBs
or fuse units, etc.
b Installation accessories for fixing conductors, and rails for mounting MCBs, fuses
bases, etc, neutral busbar and earthing bar, and so on
b Service cable ducts or conduits, surface mounted or in cable chases embedded in
the wall
Note: to facilitate future modifications to the installation, it is recommended to keep
all relevant documents (photos, diagrams, characteristics, etc.) in a suitable location
close to the distribution board.
The board should be installed at a height such that the operating handles,
indicating dials (of meters) etc., are between 1 metre and 1.80 metres from the floor
(1.30 metres in situations where handicapped or elderly people are concerned).
Fig. Q4 : Control and distribution board
Lightning arresters
The installation of lightning arresters at the service position of a LV installation is
strongly recommended for installations which include sensitive (e.g electronic)
equipment.
Q3
Resistance value of the earth electrode
In the case where the resistance to earth exceeds 80 , one or several 30 mA RCDs
should be used in place of the earth leakage protection of the incoming supply
circuit-breaker.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
If, in a TT scheme, the value of 80 for the
resistance of the electrode can not be met then,
30 mA RCDs must be installed to take over the
function of the earth leakage protection of the
incoming supply circuit-breaker
These devices must automatically disconnect themselves from the installation in
case of failure or be protected by a MCB. In the case of residential installations, the
use of a 300 mA differential incoming supply circuit-breaker type S (i.e slightly timedelayed) will provide effective earth leakage protection, while, at the same time, will
not trip unnecessarily each time a lightning arrester discharges the current (of an
overvoltage-surge) to earth.
Q - Residential and other special locations
Where utility power supply systems and
consumers’ installations form a TT earthed
system, the governing standards impose the use
of RCDs to ensure the protection of persons
1.3 Protection of people
On TT earthed systems, the protection of persons is ensured by the following
measures:
b Protection against indirect contact hazards by RCDs (see Fig. Q5) of medium
sensitivity (300 mA) at the origin of the installation (incorporated in the incoming
supply circuit-breaker or, on the incoming feed to the distribution board). This
measure is associated with a consumer installed earth electrode to which must be
connected the protective earth conductor (PE) from the exposed conductive parts of
all class I insulated appliances and equipment, as well as those from the earthing
pins of all socket outlets
b When the CB at the origin of an installation has no RCD protection, the protection
of persons shall be ensured by class II level of insulation on all circuits upstream
of the first RCDs. In the case where the distribution board is metallic, care shall be
taken that all live parts are double insulated (supplementary clearances or insulation,
use of covers, etc.) and wiring reliably fixed
b Obligatory protection by 30 mA sensitive RCDs of socket outlet circuits, and
circuits feeding bathroom, laundry rooms, and so on (for details of this latter
obligation, refer to clause 3 of this chapter)
300 mA
30 mA
Diverse
circuits
Socket-outlets
circuit
30 mA
Bathroom and/or
shower room
Fig. Q5 : Installation with incoming-supply circuit-breaker having instantaneous differential
protection
Incoming supply circuit-breaker with instantaneous differential
relay
In this case:
b An insulation fault to earth could result in a shutdown of the entire installation
b Where a lightning arrester is installed, its operation (i.e. discharging a voltage
surge to earth) could appear to an RCD as an earth fault, with a consequent
shutdown of the installation
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q4
Recommendation of suitable Schneider Electric components
b Incoming supply circuit-breaker with 300 mA differential and
b High sensitivity 30 mA RCD (for example differential circuit-breaker 1P + N type
Declic Vigi) on the circuits supplying socket outlets
b High sensitivity 30 mA RCD (for example differential load switch type ID’clic) on
circuits to bathrooms, shower rooms, laundry rooms, etc. (lighting, heating, socket
outlets)
Incoming supply circuit-breaker with type S time delayed
differential relay
This type of CB affords protection against fault to earth, but by virtue of a short time
delay, provides a measure of discrimination with downstream instantaneous RCDs.
Tripping of the incoming supply CB and its consequences (on deep freezers, for
example) is thereby made less probable in the event of lightning, or other causes of
voltage surges. The discharge of voltage surge current to earth, through the surge
arrester, will leave the type S circuit-breaker unaffected.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Residential and similar premises
Recommendation of suitable Schneider Electric components (see Fig. Q6)
b Incoming supply circuit-breaker with 300 mA differential type S and
b High sensitivity 30 mA RCD (for example differential circuit-breaker 1P + N type
Declic Vigi) on the circuits supplying washing machines and dish-washing machine
b High sensitivity 30 mA RCD (for example differential load switch type ID’clic) on
circuits to bathrooms, shower rooms, laundry rooms, etc. (lighting, heating, socket
outlets)
300 mA - type S
30 mA
30 mA
30 mA
1
Diverse High-risk location Socketoutlet
circuits (laundry room)
circuit
2
Bathroom and/or
shower room
Fig. Q6 : Installation with incoming-supply circuit-breaker having short time delay differential
protection, type S
Incoming supply circuit-breaker without differential protection
5
300 mA
3
4
30 mA
30 mA
30 mA
Bathroom and/or
shower room
Diverse
circuits
High-risk circuit
(dish-washing
machine)
Fig. Q7 : Installation with incoming-supply circuit-breaker
having no differential protection
Recommendation of suitable Schneider Electric components
Figure P7 refers:
1. Incoming-supply circuit-breaker without differential protection
2. Automatic disconnection device (if a lightning arrester is installed)
3. 30 mA RCD (for example differential circuit-breaker 1P + N type Declic Vigi) on
each circuit supplying one or more socket-outlets
4. 30 mA RCD (for example differential load swith type ID’clic) on circuits to
bathrooms and shower rooms (lighting, heating and socket-outlets) or a 30 mA
differential circuit-breaker per circuit
5. 300 mA RCD (for example differential load swith) on all the other circuits
Q5
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Socket-outlet
circuit
In this case the protection of persons must be ensured by:
b Class II level of insulation up to the downstream terminals of the RCDs
b All outgoing circuits from the distribution board must be protected by 30 mA or
300 mA RCDs according to the type of circuit concerned as discussed in chapter F.
Where a voltage surge arrester is installed upstream of the distribution board
(to protect sensitive electronic equipment such as microprocessors, videocassette recorders, TV sets, electronic cash registers, etc.) it is imperative that the
device automatically disconnects itself from the installation following a rare (but
always possible) failure. Some devices employ replaceable fusing elements; the
recommended method however as shown in Figure Q7, is to use a circuit-breaker.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Q - Residential and other special locations
The distribution and division of circuits provides
comfort and facilitates rapid location of fault
1.4 Circuits
Subdivision
National standards commonly recommend the subdivision of circuits according to the
number of utilization categories in the installation concerned (see Fig. Q8):
b At least 1 circuit for lighting. Each circuit supplying a maximum of 8 lighting points
b At least 1 circuit for socket-outlets rated 10/16 A, each circuit supplying a maximum
of 8 sockets. These sockets may be single or double units (a double unit is made up
of two 10/16 A sockets mounted on a common base in an embedded box, identical
to that of a single unit
b 1 circuit for each appliance such as water heater, washing machine, dish-washing
machine, cooker, refrigerator, etc. Recommended numbers of 10/16 A (or similar)
socket-outlets and fixed lighting points, according to the use for which the various
rooms of a dwelling are intended, are indicated in Figure Q9
Room function
Socketoutlets
Lighting
Heating
Washing Cooking
machine apparatus
Fig. Q8 : Circuit division according to utilization
The inclusion of a protective conductor in all
circuits is required by IEC and most national
standards
Minimum number
of fixed lighting points
1
1
Minimum number
of 10/16 A socket-outlets
5
3
Living room
Bedroom, lounge,
bureau, dining room
Kitchen
2
4 (1)
Bathroom, shower room
2
1 or 2
Entrance hall, box room
1
1
WC, storage space
1
Laundry room
1
(1) Of which 2 above the working surface and 1 for a specialized circuit: in addition
an independent socket-outlet of 16 A or 20 A for a cooker and a junction box or
socket-outlet for a 32 A specialized circuit
Fig Q9 : Recommended minimum number of lighting and power points in residential premises
Protective conductors
IEC and most national standards require that each circuit includes a protective
conductor. This practice is strongly recommended where class I insulated appliances
and equipment are installed, which is the general case.
The protective conductors must connect the earthing-pin contact in each socketoutlet, and the earthing terminal in class I equipment, to the main earthing terminal
at the origin of the installation.
Furthermore, 10/16 A (or similarly sized) socket-outlets must be provided with
shuttered contact orifices.
Cross-sectional-area (c.s.a.) of conductors (see Fig. Q10)
The c.s.a. of conductors and the rated current of the associated protective device
depend on the current magnitude of the circuit, the ambient temperature, the kind of
installation, and the influence of neighbouring circuits (refer to chapter G)
Moreover, the conductors for the phase wires, the neutral and the protective
conductors of a given circuit must all be of equal c.s.a. (assuming the same material
for the conductors concerned, i.e. all copper or all aluminium).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q6
Fig. Q10 : Circuit-breaker 1 phase + N - 2 x 9 mm spaces
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Residential and similar premises
Figure Q11 indicates the c.s.a. required for commonly-used appliances
Protective devices 1 phase + N in 2 x 9 mm spaces comply with requirements for
isolation, and for marking of circuit current rating and conductor sizes.
Type of circuit
single-phase 230 V
1 ph + N or 1 ph + N + PE
Fixed lighting
c. s. a. of the
conductors
Maximum power
Protective device
1.5 mm2
(2.5 mm2)
2,300 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
16 A
10 A
2.5 mm2
(4 mm2)
4,600 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
25 A
20 A
2.5 mm2
(4 mm2)
4,600 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
25 A
20 A
Dish-washing machine
2.5 mm2
(4 mm2)
4,600 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
25 A
20 A
Clothes-washing machine
2.5 mm2
(4 mm2)
4,600 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
25 A
20 A
Cooker or hotplate (1)
6 mm2
(10 mm2)
7,300 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
40 A
32 A
Electric space heater
1.5 mm2
(2.5 mm2)
2,300 W
Circuit-breaker
Fuse
16 A
10 A
10/16 A
Individual-load circuits
Water heater
(1) In a 230/400 V 3-phase circuit, the c. s. a. is 4 mm2 for copper or 6 mm2 for aluminium, and protection is provided by a 32 A
circuit-breaker or by 25 A fuses.
Fig. Q11 : C. s. a. of conductors and current rating of the protective devices in residential installations (the c. s. a. of aluminium conductors are shown in brackets)
1.5 Protection against overvoltages and lightning
The choice of surge arrester is described in chapter J
Installation rules
Three principal rules must be respected:
1 - It is imperative that the three lengths of cable used for the installation of the surge
arrester each be less than 50 cm i.e.:
b the live conductors connected to the isolating switch
b from the isolating switch to the surge arrester
b from the surge arrester to the main distribution board (MDB) earth bar (not
to be confused with the main protective-earth (PE) conductor or the main earth
terminal for the installation.The MDB earth bar must evidently be located in the
same cabinet as the surge arrester.
Q7
3 - In the interest of a good continuity of supply it is recommended that the
circuit-breaker be of the time-delayed or selective type.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
2 - It is necessary to use an isolating switch of a type recommended by the
manufacturer of the surge arrester.
Q - Residential and other special locations
2 Bathrooms and showers
Bathrooms and showers rooms are areas of high risk, because of the very low
resistance of the human body when wet or immersed in water.
Precaution to be taken are therefore correspondingly rigorous, and the regulations
are more severe than those for most other locations.
The relevant standard is IEC 60364-7-701.
Precautions to observe are based on three aspects:
b The definition of zones, numbered 0,1, 2, 3 in which the placement (or exclusion)
of any electrical device is strictly limited or forbidden and, where permitted, the
electrical and mechanical protection is prescribed
b The establishment of an equipotential bond between all exposed and extraneous
metal parts in the zones concerned
b The strict adherence to the requirements prescribed for each particular zones, as
tabled in clause 3
2.1 Classification of zones
Sub-clause 701.32 of IEC 60364-7-701 defines the zones 0, 1, 2, 3 as shown in the
following diagrams (see Fig. Q12 below to Fig Q18 opposite and next pages):
Zone 1*
Zone 1*
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 0
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 0
0.60 m
2.40 m
2.40 m
0.60 m
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
2.25 m
Zone 1
Zone 0
0.60 m
2.40 m
(*) Zone 1 is above the bath as shown in the vertical cross-section
Fig. Q12 : Zones 0, 1, 2 and 3 in proximity to a bath-tub
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q8
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Bathrooms and showers
Zone 0
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 0
Zone 1
Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 3
2.40 m
0.60 m
2.40 m
0.60 m
Zone 2
Zone 1
Zone 3
2.25 m
Zone 1
Zone 0
0.60 m
2.40 m
Fig. Q13 : Zones 0, 1, 2 and 3 in proximity of a shower with basin
Fixed shower
head (1)
Fixed shower
head (1)
0.60 m
Zone 1
0.60 m
Zone 2
0.60 m
Zone 1
0.60 m
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 1
2.40 m
Zone
2
2.40 m
Zone 3
Zone 3
2.25 m
(1) When the shower head is at the end of a flexible tube, the vertical central axis of
a zone passes through the fixed end of the flexible tube
Fig. Q14 : Zones 0, 1, 2 and 3 in proximity of a shower without basin
0.60 m
Q9
0.60 m
Fig. Q15 : No switch or socket-outlet is permitted within 60 cm of the door opening of a shower
cabinet
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Prefabricated
shower
cabinet
Q - Residential and other special locations
Classes
of external
influences
Classes
of external
influences
AD 3
BB 2
BC 3
AD 3
BB 2
BC 3
Zone 3
Dressing cubicles (zone 2)
AD 3
BB 3
BC 3
AD 7
BB 3
BC 3
AD 3
WC BB 2
BC 3
Shower cabinets (zone 1)
Fig. QP16 : Individual showers with dressing cubicles
Classes
of external
influences
Classes
of external
influences
h < 1.10m
AD 5
1.10m < h < 2.25m
AD 3
BB 3
BC 3
h < 1.10m
AD 5
1.10m < h < 2.25m
AD 3
BB 3
BC 3
Dressing cubicles
AD 7
BB 3
BC 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
WC
AD 3
BB 2
BC 3
Fig. Q17 : Individual showers with separate individual dressing cubicles
Classes
of external
influences
Classes
of external
influences
AD 3
BB 2
BC 3
h < 1.10m
AD 5
1.10m < h < 2.25m
AD 3
BB 3
BC 3
h < 1.10m
AD 5
1.10m < h < 2.25m
AD 3
BB 3
BC 3
Dressing room
Zone 2
Zone 2
Zone 1
AD 7
BB 3
BC 3
Fig. Q18 : Communal showers and common dressing room
Note: Classes of external influences (see Fig.Q46).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q10
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
2 Bathrooms and showers
2.2 Equipotential bonding (see Fig. Q19)
To the earth
electrode
Metallic pipes
hi 2m
Water-drainage
piping
Socket-outlet
Gaz
Radiator
Lighting
Metal bath
Equipotential conductors
for a bathroom
Metal
door-frame
Fig. Q19 : Supplementary equipotential bonding in a bathroom
2.3 Requirements prescribed for each zone
The table of clause 3 describes the application of the principles mentioned in the
foregoing text and in other similar or related cases
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q11
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Q - Residential and other special locations
3 Recommendations applicable to
special installations and locations
Figure Q20 below summarizes the main requirements prescribed in many national
and international standards.
Note: Section in brackets refer to sections of IEC 60364-7
Locations
Protection principles
IP
level
20
Domestic dwellings
and other habitations
Bathrooms or shower
rooms (section 701)
Zone 0
b TT or TN-S systems
b Differential protection
v 300 mA if the earth electrode
resistance is y 80 ohms instantaneous
or short time delay (type S)
v 30 mA if the earth electrode
resistance is u 500 ohms
b surge arrester at the origin of the
installation if
v supply is from overhead line with bare
conductors, and if
v the keraunic level > 25
b a protective earth (PE) conductor
on all circuits
Supplementary equipotential bonding
in zones 0, 1, 2 and 3
SELV 12 V only
27
Zone 1
SELV 12 V
25
Zone 2
SELV 12 V or 30 mA RCD
24
Zone 3
Swimming baths
(section 702)
Zone 0
Wiring
and cables
28
Class II
limited to
strict minimum
Class II
limited to
strict minimum
Class II
limited to
strict minimum
Zone 2
22
(indoor)
24
(outdoor)
24
Class II
44
Special appliances
Special aplliances
Water heater
Special appliances
Water heater
Class II luminaires
Class II
limited to
strict minimum
Class II
limited to
strict minimum
25
Conventional voltage limit UL
reduced to 25 V
Conventional voltage limit UL
reduced to 25 V
Protection against fire risks
by 500 mA RCDs
Special appliances
Special appliances
Only socket-outlets protected by :
b 30 mA RCD or
b electrical separation or
b SELV 50 V
Mechanically
protected
35
2x
Q12
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Installation
materials
Only socket-outlets protected by :
b 30 mA RCD or
b Electrical separation or
b SELV 50 V
Zone 1
Saunas
(section 703)
Work sites
(section 704)
Agricultural and
horticultural
establishments
(section 705)
Restricted conductive
locations (section 706)
Socket-outlets
Switch operating handles Protection by
and similar devices on
30 mA RCDs
distribution panels,
to be mounted
between 1 metre and
1.80 metre above the floor
21
Supplementary equipotential bonding
in zones 0, 1, and 2
SELV 12 V
Switchgear
Fig. Q20 : Main requirements prescribed in many national and international standards (continued on opposite page)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Adapted to temperature
Protection by
30 mA RCDs
Protection by
30 mA RCDs
Protection of:
b Portable tools by:
v SELV or
v Electrical separation
b Hand-held lamps
v By SELV
b Fixed equipement by
v SELV
v Electrical separation
v 30 mA RCDs
v Special supplementary
equipotential bonding
3 Recommendations applicable to
special installations and locations
Locations
Protection principles
Fountains
(section 702)
Protection by 30 mA RCDs and
equipotential bonding of all exposed
and extraneous conductive parts
TN-S system recommended
TT system if leakage current is limited.
Protective conductor 10 mm2 minimum
in aluminium. Smaller sizes (in copper)
must be doubled.
Data processing
(section 707)
Caravan park
(section 708)
Marinas and pleasure
craft (section 709)
The cable length for connection to
pleasure craft must not exceeded 25 m
Medical locations
Group 2 : Operating
theatres and similar
(section 710)
IT medical system equipotential
grouding, limited to one operating
theatre and not exceeding 10 kVA
Medical locations
Group 1 :
Hospitalization and
similar (section 710)
Exhibitions, shows and
stands (section 711)
Balneotherapy
(cure-centre baths)
TT or TNS
Motor-fuel filling
stations
Motor vehicules
TT or TN-S systems
IP
level
Wiring
and cables
55
Flexible cable of
25 metres
length
Switchgear
Only magnetic
protection for the
primary of LV/LV
transformer. Monitoring
of secondary loads
and transformer
temperature
Socket-outlets
Installation
materials
Socket-outlets
shall be placed
at a height of
0.80 m to 1.50 m
from the ground.
Protection of
circuits by
30 mA RCDs
(one per 6
socket-outlets)
Protection of
circuits by
30 mA RCDs
(one per 6
socket-outlets)
Protection of circuits
by thermal-magnetic
protection only. One
to three per circuit.
Protection by
30 mA RCDs
4x
Individual: see section 701
(volumes 0 and 1)
Collective: see section 702
(volumes 0 and 1)
Explosion risks in security zones
Protection by
30 mA RCDs
Limited to the
necessary minimum
Protection by RCDs or by
electrical separation
External lighting
installations
(section 714)
Mobile or transportable The use of TN-C system is not
units (section 717)
permitted inside any unit
23
Protection by
30 mA RCDs
30 mA RCDs
must be used for
all socket-outlets
supplying
equipment
outside the unit
Fig. Q20 : Main requirements prescribed in many national and international standards (concluded)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Q13
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Chapter R
EMC guidelines
Contents
1
2
3
Electrical distribution
R2
Earthing principles and structures
R3
Implementation
R5
3.1 Equipotential bonding inside and outside buildings
3.2 Improving equipotential conditions
3.3 Separating cables
3.4 Raised floor
3.5 Cable running
3.6 Busway
3.7 Implementation of shielded cables
3.8 Communication networks
3.9 Implementation of surge arresters
3.10 Cabinet cabling
3.11 Standards
R5
R5
R7
R7
R8
R11
R11
R13
R15
R17
R20
4
Coupling mechanisms and counter-measures
R22
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
R22
R23
R24
R25
R26
5
Wiring recommendations
R28
5.1 Signal classes
5.2 Wiring recommendations
R28
R28
General
Common-mode impedance coupling
Capacitive coupling
Inductive coupling
Radiated coupling
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R1
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
1 Electrical distribution
R - EMC guidelines
The system earthing arrangement must be properly selected to ensure the
safety of life and property. The behaviour of the different systems with respect
to EMC considerations must be taken into account. Figure R1 below presents a
summary of their main characteristics.
European standards (see EN 50174-2, EN 50310 and HD 60364-4-444) recommend
the TN-S eathing system which causes the fewest EMC problems for installations
comprising information-technology equipment (including telecom equipment).
Safety of persons
Safety of property
Availability of energy
EMC performance
TT
Correct
Use of residual current
devices (circuit breaker)
is mandatory
Correct
Medium ground-fault
current
(< about ten amps)
Correct
Correct
- Risk of overvoltages
- Equipotential
problems
- Need to manage
devices with high
leakage currents
TN-S
IT
TN-C
Correct
Continuity of the PE conductor must be ensured throughout the installation
Poor
High ground-fault
current (about 1 kA)
Correct
Excellent
- Good equipotential
situation
- Need to manage
devices with high
leakage currents
- High ground-fault
currents (transient
disturbances)
Correct
Low ground-fault current
for first fault
(< about ten mA),
but high for second fault
Excellent
Poor (to be avoided)
- Risk of overvoltages
- Common-mode filters
and surge arrestors
must handle the phaseto-phase voltages
- RCDs subject to
nuisance tripping if
common-mode
capacitors are present
- Equivalent to
TN system for second
fault
Poor
High ground-fault current
(about 1 kA)
Correct
Poor
(not recommended)
- Neutral and PE are
combined
- 50/60 Hz and
harmonics currents
circulate in the earthing
and grounding structures
- High ground-fault
currents
(transient disturbances)
Fig. R1 : Main characteristics of the different earthing sytems
When an installation includes high-power equipment (motors, air-conditioning, lifts,
power electronics, etc.), it is advised to install one or more transformers specifically
for these systems. Electrical distribution must be organised in a star system and all
outgoing circuits must exit the main low-voltage switchboard (MLVS).
Electronic systems (control/monitoring, regulation, measurement instruments, etc.)
must be supplied by a dedicated transformer in a TN-S system.
Figure R2 below illustrates these recommendations.
Transformer
Disturbing Sensitive
devices
devices
Disturbing Sensitive
devices
devices
Not recommended
Preferable
Fig. R2 : Recommendations of separated distributions
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Air conditioning
Lighting
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R2
Disturbing
devices
Sensitive
devices
Excellent
2 Earthing principles and
structures
This section deals with the earthing and equipotential bonding of information-technology
devices and other similar devices requiring interconnections for signalling purposes.
Earthing networks are designed to fulfil a number of functions. They can be
independent or operate together to provide one or more of the following:
b Safety of persons with respect to electrical hazards
b Protection of equipment with respect to electrical hazards
b A reference value for reliable, high-quality signals
b Satisfactory EMC performance
The system earthing arrangement is generally designed and installed in view of
obtaining a low impedance capable of diverting fault currents and HF currents away
from electronic devices and systems. There are different types of system earthing
arrangements and some require that specific conditions be met. These conditions
are not always met in typical installations. The recommendations presented in this
section are intended for such installations.
For professional and industrial installations, a common bonding network (CBN) may
be useful to ensure better EMC performance with respect to the following points:
b Digital systems and new technologies
b Compliance with the EMC essential requirements of Directive 2004/108/EC
(emission and immunity)
b The wide number of electrical applications
b A high level of system safety and security, as well as reliability and/or availability
For residential premises, however, where the use of electrical devices is limited, an
isolated bonding network (IBN) or, even better, a mesh IBN may be a solution.
It is now recognised that independent, dedicated earth electrodes, each serving a
separate earthing network, are a solution that is not acceptable in terms of EMC,
but also represent a serious safety hazard. In certain countries, the national building
codes forbid such systems.
Use of a separate “clean” earthing network for electronics and a “dirty” earthing
network for energy is not recommended in view of obtaining correct EMC, even
when a single electrode is used (see Fig. R3 and Fig. R4). In the event of a lightning
strike, a fault current or HF disturbances as well as transient currents will flow in the
installation. Consequently, transient voltages will be created and result in failures or
damage to the installation. If installation and maintenance are carried out properly,
this approach may be dependable (at power frequencies), but it is generally not
suitable for EMC purposes and is not recommended for general use.
lightning rods
"Clean"
earthing network
Electrical
earthing network
Separate earth electrodes
Fig. R3 : Independent earth electrodes, a solution generally not acceptable for safety and EMC
reasons
R3
lightning rods
"Clean"
earthing network
Electrical
earthing network
Single earth electrode
Fig. R4 : Installation with a single earth electrode
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R - EMC guidelines
R - EMC guidelines
2 Earthing principles and
structures
The recommended configuration for the earthing network and electrodes is two or
three dimensional (see Fig. R5). This approach is advised for general use, both
in terms of safety and EMC. This recommendation does not exclude other special
configurations that, when correctly maintained, are also suitable.
Equipotential bonding required for
multi-level buildings
lightning rods
"Electrical" and "communication"
earthing as needed
Multiple interconnected earth electrodes
Fig. R5 : Installation with multiple earth electrodes
In a typical installation for a multi-level building, each level should have its
own earthing network (generally a mesh) and all the networks must be both
interconnected and connected to the earth electrode. At least two connections are
required (built in redundancy) to ensure that, if one conductor breaks, no section of
the earthing network is isolated.
Practically speaking, more than two connections are made to obtain better symmetry
in current flow, thus reducing differences in voltage and the overall impedance
between the various levels in the building.
The many parallel paths have different resonance frequencies. If one path has a high
impedance, it is most probably shunted by another path with a different resonance
frequency. On the whole, over a wide frequency spectrum (dozens of Hz and MHz), a
large number of paths results in a low-impedance system (see Fig. R6).
Fig. R6 : Each level has a mesh and the meshes are
interconnected at several points between levels. Certain
ground-floor meshes are reinforced to meet the needs of
certain areas
Each room in the building should have earthing-network conductors for equipotential
bonding of devices and systems, cableways, trunking systems and structures. This
system can be reinforced by connecting metal pipes, gutters, supports, frames, etc.
In certain special cases, such as control rooms or computers installed on false floors,
ground reference plane or earthing strips in areas for electronic systems can be used
to improve earthing of sensitive devices and protection interconnection cables.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R4
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
3.1 Equipotential bonding inside and outside
buildings
The fundamental goals of earthing and bonding are the following:
b Safety
By limiting the touch voltage and the return path of fault currents
b EMC
By avoiding differences in potential and providing a screening effect.
Stray currents are inevitably propagated in an earthing network. It is impossible to
eliminate all the sources of disturbances for a site. Earth loops are also inevitable.
When a magnetic field affects a site, e.g. the field created by lightning, differences in
potential are created in the loops formed by the various conductors and the currents
flowing in the earthing system. Consequently, the earthing network is directly
affected by any counter-measures taken outside the building.
As long as the currents flow in the earthing system and not in the electronic circuits,
they do no damage. However, when earthing networks are not equipotential, e.g.
when they are star connected to the earth electrode, the HF stray currents will flow
wherever they can, including in control wires. Equipment can be disturbed, damaged
or even destroyed.
The only inexpensive means to divide the currents in an earthing system and
maintain satisfactory equipotential characteristics is to interconnect the earthing
networks. This contributes to better equipotential bonding within the earthing
system, but does not remove the need for protective conductors. To meet legal
requirements in terms of the safety of persons, sufficiently sized and identified
protective conductors must remain in place between each piece of equipment and
the earthing terminal. What is more, with the possible exception of a building with a
steel structure, a large number of conductors for the ligthning rods or the lightningprotection network must be directly connected to the earth electrode.
The fundamental difference between a protective conductor (PE) and a ligthning
rod down-conductor is that the first conducts internal currents to the neutral of the
MV/LV transformer whereas the second carries external current (from outside the
installation) to the earth electrode.
In a building, it is advised to connect an earthing network to all accessible conducting
structures, namely metal beams and door frames, pipes, etc. It is generally sufficient
to connect metal trunking, cable trays and lintels, pipes, ventilation ducts, etc. at
as many points as possible. In places where there is a large amount of equipment
and the size of the mesh in the bonding network is greater than four metres, an
equipotential conductor should be added. The size and type of conductor are not of
critical importance.
It is imperative to interconnect the earthing networks of buildings that have shared
cable connections. Interconnection of the earthing networks must take place via a
number of conductors and all the internal metal structures of the buildings or linking
the buildings (on the condition that they are not interrupted).
In a given building, the various earthing networks (electronics, computing, telecom,
etc.) must be interconnected to form a single equipotential bonding network.
This earthing-network must be as meshed as possible. If the earthing network is
equipotential, the differences in potential between communicating devices will be low
and a large number of EMC problems disappear. Differences in potential are also
reduced in the event of insulation faults or lightning strikes.
If equipotential conditions between buildings cannot be achieved or if the distance
between buildings is greater than ten metres, it is highly recommended to use
optical fibre for communication links and galvanic insulators for measurement and
communication systems.
R5
These measures are mandatory if the electrical supply system uses the IT or
TN-C system.
3.2 Improving equipotential conditions
Bonding networks
Even though the ideal bonding network would be made of sheet metal or a fine
mesh, experience has shown that for most disturbances, a three-metre mesh size is
sufficient to create a mesh bonding network.
Examples of different bonding networks are shown in Figure R7 next page. The
minimum recommended structure comprises a conductor (e.g. copper cable or strip)
surrounding the room.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R - EMC guidelines
R - EMC guidelines
Mesh BN
IBN
PE
Mesh BN
Mesh IBN
Local mesh
Local mesh
IBN
Trunk
Tree structure
IBN
Star (IBN)
CBN
BN: Bonding network
CBN: Common bonding network
IBN: Isolated bonding network
Fig. R7 : Examples of bonding networks
The length of connections between a structural element and the bonding network
does not exceed 50 centimetres and an additional connection should be installed
in parallel at a certain distance from the first. The inductance of the connection
between the earthing bar of the electrical enclosure for a set of equipment and the
bonding network (see below) should be less than one µHenry (0.5 µH, if possible).
For example, it is possible to use a single 50 cm conductor or two parallel conductors
one meter long, installed at a minimum distance from one another (at least 50 cm) to
reduce the mutual inductance between the two conductors.
Where possible, connection to the bonding network should be at an intersection to
divide the HF currents by four without lengthening the connection. The profile of the
bonding conductors is not important, but a flat profile is preferable. The conductor
should also be as short as possible.
Parallel earthing conductor (PEC)
The purpose of a parallel earthing conductor is to reduce the common-mode current
flowing in the conductors that also carry the differential-mode signal (the commonmode impedance and the surface area of the loop are reduced).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R6
The parallel earthing conductor must be designed to handle high currents when it
is used for protection against lightning or for the return of high fault currents. When
cable shielding is used as a parallel earthing conductor, it cannot handle such high
currents and the solution is to run the cable along metal structural elements or
cableways which then act as other parallel earthing conductors for the entire cable.
Another possibility is to run the shielded cable next to a large parallel earthing
conductor with both the shielded cable and the parallel earthing conductor connected
at each end to the local earthing terminal of the equipment or the device.
For very long distances, additional connections to the network are advised for
the parallel earthing conductor, at irregular distances between the devices. These
additional connections form a shorter return path for the disturbing currents flowing
through the parallel earthing conductor. For U-shaped trays, shielding and tubes, the
additional connections should be external to maintain the separation with the interior
(“screening” effect).
Bonding conductors
Bonding conductors may be metal strips, flat braids or round conductors. For highfrequency systems, metal strips and flat braids are preferable (skin effect) because a
round conductor has a higher impedance than a flat conductor with the same cross
section. Where possible, the length to width ratio should not exceed 5.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
3.3 Separating cables
The physical separation of high and low-current cables is very important for EMC,
particularly if low-current cables are not shielded or the shielding is not connected
to the exposed conductive parts (ECPs). The sensitivity of electronic equipment is in
large part determined by the accompanying cable system.
If there is no separation (different types of cables in separate cableways, minimum
distance between high and low-current cables, types of cableways, etc.),
electromagnetic coupling is at its maximum. Under these conditions, electronic
equipment is sensitive to EMC disturbances flowing in the affected cables.
Use of busbar trunking systems such as Canalis or busbar ducts for high power
ratings is strongly advised. The levels of radiated magnetic fields using these types of
trunking systems is 10 to 20 times lower than standard cables or conductors.
The recommendations in the “Cable running” and “Wiring recommendations”
sections should be taken into account.
3.4 Raised floors
The inclusion of the floors in the mesh contributes to equipotentiality of the area and
consequently to the distribution and dilution of disturbing LF currents.
The screening effect of a raised floor is directly related to its equipotentiality. If the
contact between the floor tiles is poor (rubber antistatic joints, for example) or if
the contact between the support brackets is faulty (pollution, corrosion, dust, etc.
or if there are no support brackets), it is necessary to add an equipotential mesh.
In this case, it is sufficient to ensure effective electrical connections between the
metal pedestals. Small spring clips are available on the market to connect the metal
pedestals to the equipotential mesh. Ideally, each pedestal should be connected, but
it is often sufficient to connect every other pedestals in each direction. A mesh 1.5 to
2 metres in size is suitable in most cases. The recommended cross-sectional area of
the copper is 10 mm2 or more. In general, a flat braid is used. To reduce the effects of
corrosion, it is advised to use tin-plated copper (see Fig. R8).
Perforated floor tiles act like normal floor tiles when they have a cellular steel
structure.
Preventive maintenance is required for the floor tiles approximately every five years
(depending on the type of tile plate and the environment, including humidity, dust
and corrosion). Rubber or polymer antistatic joints must be maintained, similar to the
bearing surfaces of the floor tiles (cleaning with a suitable product).
Raised floor
Spring clips
Metal pedestals
u 10 mm2
Fig. R8 : Raised floor implementation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R7
R - EMC guidelines
3.5 Cable running
Selection of materials and their shape depends on the following criteria:
b Severity of the EM environment along cableways (proximity of sources of
conducted or radiated EM disturbances)
b Authorised level of conducted and radiated emissions
b Type of cables (shielded?, twisted?, optical fibre?)
b EMI withstand capacity of the equipment connected to the wiring system
b Other environmental constraints (chemical, mechanical, climatic, fire, etc.)
b Future extensions planned for the wiring system
Non-metal cableways are suitable in the following cases:
b A continuous, low-level EM environment
b A wiring system with a low emission level
b Situations where metal cableways should be avoided (chemical environment)
b Systems using optical fibres
For metal cableways, it is the shape (flat, U-shape, tube, etc.) rather than the crosssectional area that determines the characteristic impedance. Closed shapes are
better than open shapes because they reduce common-mode coupling. Cableways
often have slots for cable straps. The smaller the better. The types of slots causing
the fewest problems are those cut parallel and at some distance from the cables.
Slots cut perpendicular to the cables are not recommended (see Fig. R9).
Lower
OK
Better
Fig. R9 : CEM performance of various types of metal cableways
In certain cases, a poor cableway in EMI terms may be suitable if the
EM environment is low, if shielded cables or optical fibres are employed, or separate
cableways are used for the different types of cables (power, data processing, etc.).
It is a good idea to reserve space inside the cableway for a given quantity of
additional cables. The height of the cables must be lower than the partitions of the
cableway as shown below. Covers also improve the EMC performance of cableways.
In U-shaped cableways, the magnetic field decreases in the two corners.
That explains why deep cableways are preferable (see Fig. R10).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R8
NO!
YES!
Area protected against external EM field
Fig. R10 : Installation of different types of cables
Different types of cables (power and low-level cables) should not be installed in the
same bundle or in the same cableway. Cableways should never be filled to more than
half capacity.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
It is recommended to electromagnetically separate groups from one another, either
using shielding or by installing the cables in different cableways. The quality of the
shielding determines the distance between groups. If there is no shielding, sufficient
distances must be maintained (see Fig. R11).
The distance between power and control cables must be at least 5 times the radius
of the larger power cable.
Forbidden
Ideal
Correct
Power cables
Auxiliary circuits (relay contacts)
Control (digital)
Measurements (analogue)
Note: All metal parts must be electrically interconnected
Fig. R11 : Recommendation to install groups of cables in metal cableways
Metal building components can be used for EMC purposes. Steel beams (L, H, U
or T shaped) often form an uninterrupted earthed structure with large transversal
sections and surfaces with numerous intermediate earthing connections. Cables
should if possible be run along such beams. Inside corners are better than the
outside surfaces (see Fig. R12).
Recommended
Acceptable
Not recommended
Fig. R12 : Recommendation to install cables in steel beams
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R9
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Both ends of metal cableways must always be connected to local earth network.
For very long cableways, additional connections to the earthing system are
recommended between connected devices. Where possible, the distance between
these earthing connections should be irregular (for symmetrical wiring systems) to
avoid resonance at identical frequencies. All connections to the earthing system
should be short.
Metal and non-metal cableways are available. Metal solutions offer better
EMC characteristics. A cableway (cable trays, conduits, cable brackets, etc.) must
offer a continuous, conducting metal structure from beginning to end.
An aluminium cableway has a lower DC resistance than a steel cableway of the
same size, but the transfer impedance (Zt) of steel drops at a lower frequency,
particularly when the steel has a high relative permeability µr. Care must be taken
when different types of metal are used because direct electrical connection is not
authorised in certain cases to avoid corrosion. That could be a disadvantage in terms
of EMC.
When devices connected to the wiring system using unshielded cables are not
affected by low-frequency disturbances, the EMC of non-metal cableways can be
improved by adding a parallel earthing conductor (PEC) inside the cableway. Both
ends must be connected to the local earthing system. Connections should be made
to a metal part with low impedance (e.g. a large metal panel of the device case).
The PEC should be designed to handle high fault and common-mode currents.
R - EMC guidelines
Implementation
When a metal cableway is made up of a number of short sections, care is required to
ensure continuity by correctly bonding the different parts. The parts should preferably
be welded along all edges. Riveted, bolted or screwed connections are authorised as
long as the contact surfaces conduct current (no paint or insulating coatings) and are
protected against corrosion. Tightening torques must be observed to ensure correct
pressure for the electrical contact between two parts.
When a particular shape of cableway is selected, it should be used for the entire
length. All interconnections must have a low impedance. A single wire connection
between two parts of the cableway produces a high local impedance that cancels its
EMC performance.
Starting at a few MHz, a ten-centimetre connection between two parts of the cableway
reduces the attenuation factor by more than a factor of ten (see Fig. R13).
NO!
NOT RECOMMENDED
YES!
Fig. R13 : Metal cableways assembly
Each time modifications or extensions are made, it is very important to make sure
they are carried out according to EMC rules (e.g. never replace a metal cableway by
a plastic version!).
Covers for metal cableways must meet the same requirements as those applying to
the cableways themselves. A cover should have a large number of contacts along the
entire length. If that is not possible, it must be connected to the cableway at least at
the two ends using short connections (e.g. braided or meshed connections).
When cableways must be interrupted to pass through a wall (e.g. firewalls), lowimpedance connections must be used between the two parts (see Fig. R14).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R10
Mediocre
OK
Better
Fig. R14 : Recommendation for metal cableways assembly to pass through a wall
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
3.6 Busway
Fig. R14a : Power cables and metallic busways magnetic field
radiations
Busways reduce the risk of exposure to electromagnetic fields.
According to the WHO (World Health Organisation), exposure to electromagnetic
fields can be a health hazard starting at levels as low as 0.2 micro-Teslas and could
represent a long-term risk of cancer. Some countries have created standards that
stipulate limits (e.g. 0.2 µT at 1 metre in Sweden).
All electrical conductors generate magnetic fields proportional to the distance
between them. The design of busbar trunking with tightly spaced conductors in a
metal enclosure helps to considerably reduce radiated electromagnetic fields.
The electromagnetic field characteristics of busbar trunking are welldefined
and measurements show that they are far below potentially dangerous levels
(see Fig. R14b).
In specific cases, where particularly low values are required (computer rooms,
medical rooms, some offices), it is important to minimize the magnetic induction
generated by power cables.
Magnetic induction is:
b proportional to the current
b proportional to the distance between the conductors
b inversely proportional to the square of the distance with respect to the busbar.
Busbar with a steel casing provides a good screening effect compared to power
cables: magnetic field reduced from 2 to 30 times, depending on the Canalis model.
This is particularly low because of the short distance between the bars and the
additional attenuation provided by the steel casing.
1000
B (µT)
100
10
1.0
0.1
100
1000
10000
Distance from the center of the Busbar (mm)
KTA10 (1000 A)
KTA16 (1600 A)
KTA20 (2000 A)
KTA40 (4000 A)
Fig. R14b : Canalis busbar trunking system data
R11
When the decision is made to use shielded cables, it is also necessary to determine
how the shielding will be bonded (type of earthing, connector, cable entry, etc.),
otherwise the benefits are considerably reduced. To be effective, the shielding should
be bonded over 360°. Figure R15 below show different ways of earthing the cable
shielding.
For computer equipment and digital links, the shielding should be connected at each
end of the cable.
Connection of the shielding is very important for EMC and the following points should
be noted.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
3.7 Implementation of shielded cables
R - EMC guidelines
If the shielded cable connects equipment located in the same equipotential bonding
area, the shielding must be connected to the exposed conductive parts (ECP) at
both ends. If the connected equipment is not in the same equipotential bonding area,
there are a number of possibilities.
b Connection of only one end to the ECPs is dangerous. If an insulation fault occurs,
the voltage in the shielding can be fatal for an operator or destroy equipment. In
addition, at high frequencies, the shielding is not effective.
b Connection of both ends to the ECPs can be dangerous if an insulation fault
occurs. A high current flows in the shielding and can damage it. To limit this problem,
a parallel earthing conductor (PEC) must be run next to the shielded cable. The size
of the PEC depends on the short-circuit current in the given part of the installation.
It is clear that if the installation has a well meshed earthing network, this problem
does not arise.
All bonding connections must be made to bare metal
Acceptable
Not acceptable
Collar, clamp, etc.
Bonding bar
connected
to the chassis
Bonding wire
(“pigtail”)
Poorly connected shielding = reduced effectiveness
Correct
Collar, clamp, etc.
Ideal
Cable gland = circumferential contact to
equipotential metal panel
Equipotential metal panel
Fig. R15 : Implementation of shielded cables
The following figure shows how to prepare the screen when EMC clamps are used.
Screen
Cable
insulated
coat
Screen
Cable
insulated
coat
R12
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Screen
Cable
insulated
coat
Added
insulated
coat
Fig. R16 : recommended screen preparation
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
EMC clamp
width
3 Implementation
3.8 Communication networks
It is highly recommended to follow the European Standards EN 50173 series to
perform Information Technology cablings.
To ensure a reliable data transmission, the quality of the whole link shall be
homogeneous. That means the category of the different cables shall be the same,
the connecting interfaces shall be adapted to the cables.
Cables and connections of different categories may be mixed within a channel
however the resultant performance will be determined by the category of the lowest
performing component.
The shield continuity of the whole link (patch cords, Terminal Outlets, horizontal
cable) shall be ensured and controlled by tests.
The Terminal Outlets (TO) could be used to earth the screen terminations in the
cabinet. The choice of these TO is very important.
Communication networks are mostly extensive. They interconnect equipment located
in different areas where the feeding power supplies could have different earthing
systems.
Equipment 1
TO
Patch cord
Apparatus
Main link
Apparatus
Patch cord
Equipment 2
TO
Dirturbing
currents
Equipment 1
TO
Patch cord
Apparatus
Main link
Apparatus
Patch cord
Equipment 2
TO
Dirturbing
currents
R13
If these different areas are not well equipotential, harsh transient currents could
appear (lightning, main power fault, etc.) causing high voltage potential differences
between interconnected equipment.
Communication interfaces (board, module, etc.) could be disturbed or damaged by
this common mode over voltages.
The use of TN-S earthing system and well equipotential installation minimize this
issue.
In any case, the use of Surge Protective Device (SPD) installed in Common Mode
and/or Differential Mode is recommended.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. R17 : How to reduce disturbing currents loop
R - EMC guidelines
If the different areas/zones are not equipotential, if the power supply earthing system
is TN-C or IT, or if there is a doubt and the previous 2 points, optical fiber links are
highly recommended.
To avoid electrical safety issue, the optical fiber link should not have any metallic
parts.
Protection against coils disturbances
AC and mostly DC Coils (relay, contactor, actuator, etc.) are very disturbing sources.
x
x
Arcing voltage
Arcing voltage
Coil
Relay
Un
Un
Coil
Relay
TVS
Fig. R18 : TVS reduces the arcing voltage
To minimize these High Frequency disturbances the following solutions could be
implemented. (In grey, the preferred choice).
Symbol
R14
Transient Voltage
Suppression type
For
AC
For
DC
Overvoltage
limitation
Contact fall time
R-C network
Y
Y
2 to 3 . Un
1 to 2 times the
standard time
Metal Oxide Varistor
Y
Y
< 3 . Un
1.1 to 1.5 times the
standard time
Transient Voltage
Suppression Diode
Bidirectional
Y
Y
< 2. Un
1.1 to 1.5 times the
standard time
Transient Voltage
Suppression Diode
Directional
N
Y
Un + 0.7 V
3 to 10 times the
standard time
Free wheeling diode
N
Y
Un + 0.7 V
3 to 10 times the
standard time
Resistor
Y
Y
< 4 . Un
1.5 to 2.5 times the
standard time
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. R19 : TVS table information
To be efficient, the TVS shall be installed closely to the coil.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
3.9 Implementation of surge arresters
Connections
They must be as short as possible. In fact, one of the essential characteristics
for equipment protection is the maximum level of voltage that the equipment can
withstand at its terminals. A surge arrester with a protection level suitable for the
equipment to be protected should be chosen (see Fig. 20). The total length of the
connections is L = L1 + L2 + L3. It represents an impedance of roughly 1 µH/m for
high frequency currents.
Application of the rule U = L di
dt
with an 8/20 µs wave and a current of 8 kA leads to a voltage of 1,000 V peak per
metre of cable.
U = 1.10-6 x 8.103 = 1,000 V
8.10-6
U equipment
L1
disconnection
circuit-breaker
U1
L2
L = L1 + L2 + L3 < 50 cm
surge arrester
Up
L3
load to be
protected
U2
Fig. R20 : Surge arrester connection: L < 50 cm
This gives U equipment = Up + U1 + U2.
If L1 + L2 + L3 = 50 cm, this will result in a voltage surge of 500 V for a current of
8 kA.
Wiring rules
b Rule 1
The first rule to be respected is not to exceed a distance of 50 cm when connecting
the surge arrester to its disconnection circuit-breaker. The surge arrester connections
are shown in Figure R21.
d1
d1
R15
D
k PR
Quic PD
S
tor
nnec
d2
d3
(8/20)
65kA(8/20)
Imax:
In: 20kA
1,5kV
Up: 340Va
Uc:
SPD
d3
0 cm
3y5
2+d
d
d1 +
Fig. R21 : SPD with separate or integrated disconnector
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
m
3
2+d
d
d1 +
35 c
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
disco
R - EMC guidelines
b Rule 2
The outgoing feeders of the protected conductors must be connected right at the
terminals of the surge arrester and disconnection circuit-breaker (see Fig. R22).
Power supply
Protected feeders
L < 35 cm
Quick PRD
Fig. R22 : Connections are right at the SPD's terminals
b Rule 3
The phase, neutral and PE incoming wires must be tightly coupled to reduce the loop
surfaces (see Fig. R23).
Clean cables polluted by
neighbouring polluted cables
Clean cable paths separated
from polluted cable paths
protected
outgoing
feeders
Large
frame
loop
surface
NO
YES
Intermediate
earth terminal
R16
LN
Intermediate
earth
terminal
Small
frame
loop
surface
Main earth
terminal
LN
Main earth
terminal
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. R23 : Example of wiring precautions to be taken in a box (rules 2, 3, 4, 5)
b Rule 4
The surge arrester's incoming wires must be moved away from the outgoing wires to
avoid mixing the polluted cables with the protected cables (see Fig. R19).
b Rule 5
The cables must be flattened against the metallic frames of the box in order to
minimise the frame loops and thus benefit from a disturbance screening effect.
If the box is made of plastic and the loads particularly sensitive, it must be replaced
by a metal box.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
In all cases, you must check that the metallic frames of the boxes or cabinets are
frame grounded by very short connections.
Finally, if screened cables are used, extra lengths which serve no purpose
("pigtails"), must be cut off as they reduce screening effectiveness.
3.10 Cabinet cabling (Fig. R24)
Each cabinet must be equipped with an earthing bar or a ground reference metal
sheet. All shielded cables and external protection circuits must be connected to this
point. Anyone of the cabinet metal sheets or the DIN rail can be used as the ground
reference.
Plastic cabinets are not recommended. In this case, the DIN rail must be used as
ground reference.
Potential
Reference Plate
Fig. R24 : Grounding and bonding examples
Cabinet cabling recommendations
Each cabinet, cubicle or enclosure shall be fitted, as a minimum, with an earthing bar
and a reference metallic plate or grid (grounding plate). All the metallic parts (frames,
panels, roof, door, etc.) shall be interconnected together with adapted features.
The use of specific washer is recommended. Some examples of preferred ones are
shown below:
Fig. R25 : Preferred washers examples
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R17
R - EMC guidelines
Fig. R26 : Some examples of washers, bolt and lugs mounting.
PE EMC
LF - HF
Painted
sheet metal
Ensure metal-to-metal
contact
Long PE
paint
HF
paint
HF
L < 10 cm
Fig. R27 : Earthing and bonding examples
All the cables shall be laid on the grounded/earthed metallic structures.
All EMC components (e.g. EMI filter, EMC clamps) shall be fixed directly on the
metallic plates without any insulating coating (e.g. free of paint or varnish).
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R18
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
Screened cables coming or going out from the cubicle shall be bonded to the
earthing bar or grounding plate if these cables are coming from long distance and/or
from non equipotential zones.
The goal is to divert the disturbing currents at the cabinet entrance and not inside the
cabinet.
Non metallic cabinet are not recommended for EMC purposes.
To protect electronics equipment against low frequency magnetic field, it is
recommended to use (galvanized) steel cabinets.
Non magnetic metals (e.g. aluminum, stainless steel) are more efficient for high
frequencies environment.
Power and low level apparatus shall be physically separated and cables segregation
and distances between power and sensitive cables shall also be respected as shown
on the figures below.
LOW level
Partition panel
Power
To power components
Mains
Actuators
Fig. R28 : Correct EMC design inside a same cabinet
Probes
Detectors
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R19
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R - EMC guidelines
LOW level
Power
Metal cable trough
Fig. R29 : Correct EMC design inside two separate cabinets
3.11 Standards
It is absolutely essential to specify the standards and recommendations that must be
taken into account for installations.
Below are several documents that may be used:
b EN 50174-1
Information technology - Cabling installation.
Part 1: Specification and quality assurance
b EN 50174-2
Information technology - Cabling installation.
Part 2: Installation planning and practices inside buildings
b EN 50310
Application of equipotential bonding and earthing in buildings
with information technology equipment.
b EN 50173
Information Technology - Generic cabling systems
b HD 60364-4-444 Low-voltage electrical installations
Part 4-444: Protection for safety - Protection against voltage
disturbances and electromagnetic disturbances
Electrostatic discharge protection
Normally, the use of specific tools or packages is required to handle or carry
electronics boards or components (CPU, memory, analog, PCMCIA modules, etc.)
which are sensitive to Electrostatic discharge (ESD).
R20
Our products comply with standard ESD tests but ESD conditions are in some cases
over the specs.
ESD threat could cause semiconductors aging and failures. Without any care, the
semiconductor devices could be damaged or burned without users noticing.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Solution
The use of specific anti ESD wrist strap is highly recommended. This wrist strap
shall be installed inside each cabinet and correctly connected to the earthed cabinet
metallic frame.
Provide a procedure which depicts the good conditions of use.
An example is shown below.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
3 Implementation
ESD Wrist Strap
Static is produced by the contact and separation of materials: Shoes and floors,
clothes and the human body, parts being moved on or from surfaces. The generated
charge will reside on the body until it is discharged - the familiar "zap" that all of
us have experienced. It's the "zap" that does the damage. If we can prevent any
static charge from building up on the body, then there is essentially nothing to be
discharged. A properly grounded wrist strap effectively prevents any static charge
from building up. Any static charge that would tend to be created is instantly
"drained" by the wirst strap. The wrist strap maintains the potential equilibrium that is
accomplished the hard way with the "zap".
Fig. R30 : ESD wrist strap examples
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R21
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R - EMC guidelines
4 Coupling mechanisms and
counter-measures
4.1 General
An EM interference phenomenon may be summed up in Figure R31 below.
Source
Coupling
Victim
Origin of
emitted disturbances
Means by which
disturbances are
transmitted
Equipment likely
to be disturbed
Example:
Radiated waves
Walkie-talkie
TV set
Fig. R31 : EM interference phenomenon
The different sources of disturbances are:
b Radio-frequency emissions
v Wireless communication systems (radio, TV, CB, radio telephones, remote controls)
v Radar
b Electrical equipment
v High-power industrial equipment (induction furnaces, welding machines, stator
control systems)
v Office equipment (computers and electronic circuits, photocopy machines, large
monitors)
v Discharge lamps (neon, fluorescent, flash, etc.)
v Electromechanical components (relays, contactors, solenoids, current interruption
devices)
b Power systems
v Power transmission and distribution systems
v Electrical transportation systems
b Lightning
b Electrostatic discharges (ESD)
b Electromagnetic nuclear pulses (EMNP)
The potential victims are:
b Radio and television receivers, radar, wireless communication systems
b Analogue systems (sensors, measurement acquisition, amplifiers, monitors)
b Digital systems (computers, computer communications, peripheral equipment)
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
R22
The different types of coupling are:
b Common-mode impedance (galvanic) coupling
b Capacitive coupling
b Inductive coupling
b Radiated coupling (cable to cable, field to cable, antenna to antenna)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Coupling mechanisms and
counter-measures
4.2 Common-mode impedance coupling
Definition
Two or more devices are interconnected by the power supply and communication
cables (see Fig. R32). When external currents (lightning, fault currents, disturbances)
flow via these common-mode impedances, an undesirable voltage appears between
points A and B which are supposed to be equipotential. This stray voltage can
disturb low-level or fast electronic circuits.
All cables, including the protective conductors, have an impedance, particularly at
high frequencies.
Device 1
Device 2
Z sign.
Stray
overvoltage
I2
ECPs
Signal line
ECPs
I1
Z1
Z2
The exposed conductive parts (ECP) of devices 1 and 2 are connected to a common
earthing terminal via connections with impedances Z1 and Z2.
The stray overvoltage flows to the earth via Z1. The potential of device 1 increases
to Z1 I1. The difference in potential with device 2 (initial potential = 0) results in the
appearance of current I2.
I2
Z1
Z1 I 1 = (Zsign + Z2) I 2 ⇒
=
I 1 (Zsign + Z2)
Current I2, present on the signal line, disturbs device 2.
Fig. R32 : Definition of common-mode impedance coupling
Examples (see Fig. R33)
b Devices linked by a common reference conductor (e.g. PEN, PE) affected by fast
or intense (di/dt) current variations (fault current, lightning strike, short-circuit, load
changes, chopping circuits, harmonic currents, power factor correction capacitor
banks, etc.)
b A common return path for a number of electrical sources
Disturbed
cable
Device 2
Signal cable
Disturbing
current
Difference in
potential
ZMC
Fig. R33 : Example of common-mode impedance coupling
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Fault
currents
R23
Lightning
strike
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Device 1
R - EMC guidelines
Counter-measures (see Fig. R34)
If they cannot be eliminated, common-mode impedances must at least be as low as
possible. To reduce the effects of common-mode impedances, it is necessary to:
b Reduce impedances:
v Mesh the common references,
v Use short cables or flat braids which, for equal sizes, have a lower impedance than
round cables,
v Install functional equipotential bonding between devices.
b Reduce the level of the disturbing currents by adding common-mode filtering and
differential-mode inductors
Device 1
Z sign.
Stray
overvoltage
Device 2
I2
Z sup.
Z1
PEC
I1
Z2
If the impedance of the parallel earthing conductor PEC (Z sup) is very low
compared to Z sign, most of the disturbing current flows via the PEC, i.e. not
via the signal line as in the previous case.
The difference in potential between devices 1 and 2 becomes very low and the
disturbance acceptable.
Fig. R34 : Counter-measures of common-mode impedance coupling
4.3 Capacitive coupling
U
Vsource
Definition
The level of disturbance depends on the voltage variations (dv/dt) and the value of
the coupling capacitance between the disturber and the victim.
t
Vvictim
R24
t
Capacitive coupling increases with:
b The frequency
b The proximity of the disturber to the victim and the length of the parallel cables
b The height of the cables with respect to a ground referencing plane
b The input impedance of the victim circuit (circuits with a high input impedance are
more vulnerable)
b The insulation of the victim cable (r of the cable insulation), particularly for tightly
coupled pairs
Figure R35 shows the results of capacitive coupling (cross-talk) between two cables.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Examples (see Fig. R36 opposite page)
Fig. R35 : Typical result of capacitive coupling (capacitive
cross-talk)
b Nearby cables subjected to rapid voltage variations (dv/dt)
b Start-up of fluorescent lamps
b High-voltage switch-mode power supplies (photocopy machines, etc.)
b Coupling capacitance between the primary and secondary windings of
transformers
b Cross-talk between cables
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
4 Coupling mechanisms and
counter-measures
Differential mode
Common mode
Source
Vs
DM
Iv
Victim
Vs
Iv
CM
CM
DM
Source
Victim
Vs DM: Source of the disturbing voltage (differential mode)
Iv DM: Disturbing current on victim side (differential mode)
Vs CM: Source of the disturbing voltage (common mode)
Iv CM: Disturbing current on victim side (common mode)
Metal shielding
Fig. R36 : Example of capacitive coupling
Counter-measures (see Fig. R37)
C
Victim
Fig. R37 : Cable shielding with perforations reduces capacitive
coupling
4.4 Inductive coupling
Definition
The disturber and the victim are coupled by a magnetic field. The level of disturbance
depends on the current variations (di/dt) and the mutual coupling inductance.
Inductive coupling increases with:
b The frequency
b The proximity of the disturber to the victim and the length of the parallel cables,
b The height of the cables with respect to a ground referencing plane,
b The load impedance of the disturbing circuit.
Examples (see Fig. R38 next page)
b Nearby cables subjected to rapid current variations (di/dt)
b Short-circuits
b Fault currents
b Lightning strikes
b Stator control systems
b Welding machines
b Inductors
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R25
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Source
b Limit the length of parallel runs of disturbers and victims to the strict minimum
b Increase the distance between the disturber and the victim
b For two-wire connections, run the two wires as close together as possible
b Position a PEC bonded at both ends and between the disturber and the victim
b Use two or four-wire cables rather than individual conductors
b Use symmetrical transmission systems on correctly implemented, symmetrical
wiring systems
b Shield the disturbing cables, the victim cables or both (the shielding must be
bonded)
b Reduce the dv/dt of the disturber by increasing the signal rise time where possible
R - EMC guidelines
Disturbing
cable
Disturbing
cable
H
H
Victim loop
Victim pair
i
i
Victim loop
Differential mode
Common mode
Fig. R38 : Example of inductive coupling
Counter-measures
b Limit the length of parallel runs of disturbers and victims to the strict minimum
b Increase the distance between the disturber and the victim
b For two-wire connections, run the two wires as close together as possible
b Use multi-core or touching single-core cables, preferably in a triangular layout
b Position a PEC bonded at both ends and between the disturber and the victim
b Use symmetrical transmission systems on correctly implemented, symmetrical
wiring systems
b Shield the disturbing cables, the victim cables or both (the shielding must be
bonded)
b Reduce the dv/dt of the disturber by increasing the signal rise time where possible
(series-connected resistors or PTC resistors on the disturbing cable, ferrite rings on
the disturbing and/or victim cable)
4.5 Radiated coupling
Definition
The disturber and the victim are coupled by a medium (e.g. air). The level of
disturbance depends on the power of the radiating source and the effectiveness
of the emitting and receiving antenna. An electromagnetic field comprises both an
electrical field and a magnetic field. The two fields are correlated. It is possible to
analyse separately the electrical and magnetic components.
The electrical field (E field) and the magnetic field (H field) are coupled in wiring
systems via the wires and loops (see Fig. R39).
E field
H field
i
R26
V
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Field-to-cable coupling
Fig. R39 : Definition of radiated coupling
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Field-to-loop coupling
4 Coupling mechanisms and
counter-measures
When a cable is subjected to a variable electrical field, a current is generated in the
cable. This phenomenon is called field-to-cable coupling.
Similarly, when a variable magnetic field flows through a loop, it creates a counter
electromotive force that produces a voltage between the two ends of the loop. This
phenomenon is called field-to-loop coupling.
Examples (see Fig. R40)
b Radio-transmission equipment (walkie-talkies, radio and TV transmitters, mobile
services)
b Radar
b Automobile ignition systems
b Arc-welding machines
b Induction furnaces
b Power switching systems
b Electrostatic discharges (ESD)
b Lighting
E field
EM field
Signal
cable
Device 1
Device 2
i
Device
h
h
Area of the
earth loop
Ground reference plane
Example of field-to-cable coupling
Example of field-to-loop coupling
Fig. R40 : Examples of radiated coupling
Counter-measures
To minimise the effects of radiated coupling, the measures below are required.
For field-to-cable coupling
b Reduce the antenna effect of the victim by reducing the height (h) of the cable with
respect to the ground referencing plane
b Place the cable in an uninterrupted, bonded metal cableway (tube, trunking, cable
tray)
b Use shielded cables that are correctly installed and bonded
b Add PECs
b Place filters or ferrite rings on the victim cable
Radiated coupling can be eliminated using the Faraday cage principle. A possible
solution is a shielded cable with both ends of the shielding connected to the metal
case of the device. The exposed conductive parts must be bonded to enhance
effectiveness at high frequencies.
Radiated coupling decreases with the distance and when symmetrical transmission
links are used.
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
R27
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
For field-to-loop coupling
b Reduce the surface of the victim loop by reducing the height (h) and the length
of the cable. Use the solutions for field-to-cable coupling. Use the Faraday cage
principle.
R - EMC guidelines
5 Wiring recommendations
5.1 Signal classes (see Fig. R41)
1 - Power connections
(supply + PE)
Unshielded cables of
different groups
Shielded cables of
different groups
2 - Relay
connections
Device
e
h
NO!
Ground
reference
plane
YES!
4 - Analogue link
(sensor)
3 - Digital link
(bus)
Risk of cross-talk in common mode if e < 3 h
Fig. R41 : Internal signals can be grouped in four classes
Sensitive
cable
Sensitive
cable
Disturbing
cable
Disturbing
cable
Four classes of internal signals are:
b Class 1
Mains power lines, power circuits with a high di/dt, switch-mode converters, powerregulation control devices.
This class is not very sensitive, but disturbs the other classes (particularly in
common mode).
b Class 2
Relay contacts.
This class is not very sensitive, but disturbs the other classes (switching, arcs when
contacts open).
u1m
30 cm
NO!
Cross incompatible
cables at right angles
YES!
Fig. R42 : Wiring recommendations for cables carrying different
types of signals
NO!
b Class 4
Analogue input/output circuits (low-level measurements, active sensor supply
circuits). This class is sensitive.
It is a good idea to use conductors with a specific colour for each class to
facilitate identification and separate the classes. This is useful during design and
troubleshooting.
YES!
Standard cable
b Class 3
Digital circuits (HF switching).
This class is sensitive to pulses, but also disturbs the following class.
Two distinct pairs
5.2 Wiring recommendations
Poorly implemented
ribbon cable
Correctly implemented
ribbon cable
Digital connection
Analogue pair
Bonding wires
R28
Disturbing cables (classes 1 and 2) must be placed at some distance from the
sensitive cables (classes 3 and 4) (see Fig. R32 and Fig. R43)
In general, a 10 cm separation between cables laid flat on sheet metal is sufficient
(for both common and differential modes). If there is enough space, a distance of
30 cm is preferable. If cables must be crossed, this should be done at right angles to
avoid cross-talk (even if they touch). There are no distance requirements if the cables
are separated by a metal partition that is equipotential with respect to the ECPs.
However, the height of the partition must be greater than the diameter of the cables.
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Fig. R43 : Use of cables and ribbon cable
Cables carrying different types of signals must be physically separated
(see Fig. R42 above)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
5 Wiring recommendations
A cable should carry the signals of a single group (see Fig. R44)
If it is necessary to use a cable to carry the signals of different groups, internal
shielding is necessary to limit cross-talk (differential mode). The shielding, preferably
braided, must be bonded at each end for groups 1, 2 and 3.
It is advised to overshield disturbing and sensitive cables (see Fig. R45)
The overshielding acts as a HF protection (common and differential modes) if it
is bonded at each end using a circumferential connector, a collar or a clampere
However, a simple bonding wire is not sufficient.
NO!
Shielded pair
Electronic
control
device
Sensor
Unshielded cable for stator control
Electromechanical
device
YES!
Bonded using a clamp
Shielded pair + overshielding
Electronic
control
device
Sensor
Shielded cable for stator control
Electromechanical
device
Fig. R45 : Shielding and overshielding for disturbing and/or sensitive cables
NO!
Power +
analogue
Digital +
relay contacts
YES!
Power +
relay contacts
Digital +
analogue
Avoid using a single connector for different groups (see Fig. R46)
Except where necessary for groups 1 and 2 (differential mode). If a single connector
is used for both analogue and digital signals, the two groups must be separated by at
least one set of contacts connected to 0 V used as a barrier.
All free conductors (reserve) must always be bonded at each end
(see Fig. R47)
For group 4, these connections are not advised for lines with very low voltage
and frequency levels (risk of creating signal noise, by magnetic induction, at the
transmission frequencies).
Shielding
Power connections
Digital connections
Relay I/O connections
Analogue connections
Fig. R44 : Incompatible signals = different cables
NO!
YES!
Electronic
system
NO!
Electronic
system
YES!
Wires not
equipotentially
bonded
R29
Analogue connections
Fig. R46 : Segregation applies to connectors as well!
Equipotential sheet metal panel
Fig. R47 : Free wires must be equipotentially bonded
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Equipotential sheet metal panel
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Digital connections
R - EMC guidelines
5 Wiring recommendations
The two conductors must be installed as close together as possible
(see Fig. R48)
This is particularly important for low-level sensors. Even for relay signals with a
common, the active conductors should be accompanied by at least one common
conductor per bundle. For analogue and digital signals, twisted pairs are a minimum
requirement. A twisted pair (differential mode) guarantees that the two wires remain
together along their entire length.
NO!
Area of
loop too large
PCB with
relay contact
I/Os
YES!
PCB with
relay contact
I/Os
+
Power supply
+
Power supply
Fig. R48 : The two wires of a pair must always be run close together
Group-1 cables do not need to be shielded if they are filtered
But they should be made of twisted pairs to ensure compliance with the previous
section.
Cables must always be positioned along their entire length against the bonded
metal parts of devices (see Fig. R49)
For example: Covers, metal trunking, structure, etc. In order to take advantage of the
dependable, inexpensive and significant reduction effect (common mode) and anticross-talk effect (differential mode).
NO!
NO!
YES!
Chassis 1
Chassis 1
Chassis 2
Chassis 2
Chassis 3
Chassis 3
YES!
Metal tray
Power
supply
R30
Power or disturbing cables
Relay cables
I/O interface
Power
supply
I/O interface
All metal parts (frame, structure, enclosures, etc.) are equipotential
Fig. R49 : Run wires along their entire length against the bonded metal parts
© Schneider Electric - all rights reserved
Measurement or sensitive cables
Fig. R50 : Cable distribution in cable trays
The use of correctly bonded metal trunking considerably improves
internal EMC (see Fig. R50)
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Schneider Electric - Electrical installation guide 2013
Make the most of your energy
Schneider Electric Industries SAS
35, rue Joseph Monier
CS30323
F-92506 Rueil-Malmaison Cedex
RCS Nanterre 954 503 439
Capital social 896 313 776 €
www.schneider-electric.com
EIGED306001EN
ART.822690
As standards, specifications and designs change from time to time, please ask for confirmation
of the information given in this pubication.
This document has been
printed on ecological paper
06/2013